F-1 1 s001529x1_f1.htm F-1

TABLE OF CONTENTS

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on February 13, 2017

Registration No. 333-      

UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549

FORM F-1
REGISTRATION STATEMENT
UNDER
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)

Bermuda
6029
N/A
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
(Primary Standard Industrial
Classification Code Number)
(IRS Employer
Identification Number)

65 Front Street
Hamilton, HM 12
Bermuda
+1 441 295 1111
(Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including
area code, of registrant's principal executive offices)

C T Corporation System
111 Eighth Avenue
New York, NY 10011
(212) 590-9070
(Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number, including
area code, of agent for service)

Copies to:

Catherine M. Clarkin
Sullivan & Cromwell LLP
125 Broad Street
New York, New York 10004
+1 (212) 558-4000
John B. Meade, Esq.
Davis Polk & Wardwell LLP
450 Lexington Avenue
New York, New York 10017
+1 (212) 450-4000

Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public:
As promptly as practicable after this Registration Statement becomes effective.

If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, please check the following box. o

If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, please check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. o

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. o

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. o

CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE:

Title of Each Class of Securities
to be Registered
Proposed
Maximum
Aggregate
Offering Price(1)(2)
Amount of
Registration Fee
Common shares, BM$0.01(3) par value
$
100,000,000
 
$
11,590
 

(1)Estimated solely for the purpose of computing the amount of the registration fee pursuant to Rule 457(o) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
(2)Includes common shares that the underwriters have the option to purchase pursuant to the option to purchase additional common shares from the selling shareholders.
(3)The Bermuda Dollar is pegged to the US Dollar on a one-to-one basis at BM$1.00 = US$1.00.

The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or until the Registration Statement shall become effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The information in this preliminary prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We and the selling shareholders identified in this preliminary prospectus may not sell these securities until the Registration Statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This preliminary prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and it is not soliciting offers to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where such offer or sale is not permitted.

SUBJECT TO COMPLETION
PRELIMINARY PROSPECTUS DATED FEBRUARY 13, 2017

PROSPECTUS

       Shares

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited


Common Shares

The selling shareholders named in this prospectus are offering       voting ordinary shares (“common shares”) of The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited (the “Bank”). The Bank will not receive any proceeds from the sale of the common shares by the selling shareholders.

Our common shares are listed on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) under the symbol “NTB” and on the Bermuda Stock Exchange (“BSX”) under the symbol “NTB.BH”. The closing price of our common shares on the NYSE on February 10, 2017 was $32.59 and the closing price of our common shares on the BSX on February 10, 2017 was $32.00.

We are an “emerging growth company” as defined in the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012 and, as a result, can take advantage of reduced public company reporting and disclosure requirements. We have elected to take advantage of certain reduced public company reporting and disclosure requirements in this prospectus.

Our common shares are not saving accounts or deposits and are not insured by any government agency.

Investing in the common shares involves significant risks. See “Risk Factors” beginning on page 26 of this prospectus for a discussion of certain risks you should consider before deciding to invest in our common shares.

Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or passed on the adequacy or accuracy of this prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

 
Price per
common share
Total
Public offering price
$
     
 
$
     
 
Underwriting discounts and commissions(1)
$
 
 
$
 
 
Proceeds before expenses to the selling shareholders
$
 
 
$
 
 
(1)See “Underwriting” for a detailed description of compensation payable to the underwriters. We have agreed to reimburse the underwriters for certain expenses in connection with this offering.

The selling shareholders have granted the underwriters an option to purchase up to an additional       common shares at the public offering price less the underwriting discount, within 30 days from the date of this prospectus.

The underwriters expect to deliver the common shares against payment in New York, New York on or about         , 2017.

Joint Book-Running Managers

Goldman, Sachs & Co.
Citigroup
Sandler O'Neill + Partners, L.P.
Keefe, Bruyette & Woods
 
 
 
A Stifel Company

Co-Managers

Prospectus dated         , 2017

TABLE OF CONTENTS

EXPLANATORY NOTE

In this prospectus, unless the context indicates otherwise, the term:

Bank” or “Butterfield” refers to:
The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited;
BMA” refers to:
The Bermuda Monetary Authority;
Board” refers to:
The board of directors of the Bank;
IPO” refers to:
Our initial public offering of 12,234,042 common shares completed on September 21, 2016;
common shares” refers to:
The voting ordinary shares of par value BM$ 0.01 each in the Bank;
Principal Shareholder” refers to:
The Carlyle Group;
selling shareholders” refers to:
               ;
we”, “our”, “us”, “the Company” and “the Group” refer to:
The Bank and its consolidated subsidiaries.

ABOUT THIS PROSPECTUS

We, the selling shareholders and the underwriters have not authorized anyone to provide any information other than that contained in this prospectus or in any free writing prospectus prepared by or on behalf of us or to which we have referred you. We, the selling shareholders and the underwriters take no responsibility for, and can provide no assurance as to the reliability of, any other information that others may give you. We are not, the selling shareholders and the underwriters are not, making an offer of these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer is not permitted. You should not assume that the information contained in this prospectus is accurate as of any date other than the date on the front of this prospectus. This prospectus includes references to information contained on, or that can be accessed through, our website. Information contained on, or that can be accessed through our website is not part of, and is not incorporated into, this prospectus.

Securities may be offered or sold in Bermuda only in compliance with the provisions of the Investment Business Act 2003 and the Exchange Control Act 1972 and related regulations. In addition, the permission of the Bermuda Monetary Authority is required, pursuant to the provisions of the Exchange Control Act 1972 and related regulations, for all issuances and transfers of shares (which includes the common shares) of Bermuda companies to or from a non-resident of Bermuda for exchange control purposes, other than in cases where the Bermuda Monetary Authority has granted a general permission. The Bermuda Monetary Authority, in its notice to the public dated June 1, 2005, has granted a general permission for the issue and subsequent transfer of any securities of a Bermuda company from and/or to a non-resident of Bermuda for exchange control purposes for so long as any “Equity Securities” of the company (which would include the common shares) are listed on an “Appointed Stock Exchange” (which would include the Bermuda Stock Exchange and the New York Stock Exchange). In granting the general permission, the Bermuda Monetary Authority does not accept any responsibility for our financial soundness or the correctness of any of the statements made or opinions expressed in this registration statement.

i

TABLE OF CONTENTS

PRESENTATION OF FINANCIAL AND OTHER INFORMATION

In this prospectus, references to “BMD”, “BM$”, or “Bermuda Dollars” are to the lawful currency of Bermuda, and “USD”, “US$”, “$” and “US Dollars” are to the lawful currency of the United States of America. The Bermuda Dollar is pegged to the US Dollar on a one-to-one basis and therefore, for all periods presented, BM$1.00 = US$1.00.

Certain monetary amounts, percentages and other figures included in this prospectus have been subject to rounding adjustments. Accordingly, figures shown as totals in certain tables may not be the arithmetic aggregation of the figures that precede them, and figures expressed as percentages in the text may not total 100% or, as applicable, when aggregated may not be the arithmetic aggregation of the percentages that precede them.

Our consolidated financial statements as of and for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 have been audited, as stated in the report appearing herein, by PricewaterhouseCoopers Ltd., Bermuda, and are included in this prospectus and are referred to as our audited consolidated financial statements. We have prepared these financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America (“US GAAP”).

We believe that the non-GAAP measures included in this prospectus provide valuable information to readers because they enable the reader to identify the financial measures we use to track the performance of our business and guide management. Furthermore, these measures provide readers with valuable information regarding our core activities, which allows for a more meaningful evaluation of relevant trends when considered in conjunction with measures calculated in accordance with US GAAP. Non-GAAP measures used in this prospectus are not a substitute for US GAAP measures and readers should consider the US GAAP measures as well. For more information on non-GAAP measures, including a reconciliation to the most directly comparable US GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.

INDUSTRY AND MARKET DATA

Some of the discussion contained in this prospectus relies on certain market and industry data obtained from third-party sources that we believe to be reliable. Market estimates are calculated by using independent industry publications and third-party forecasts in conjunction with our assumptions about our markets. While we believe the industry and market data to be reliable as of the date of this prospectus, this information is subject to change based on various factors, including those discussed under the headings “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements” and “Risk Factors” in this prospectus.

TRADEMARKS AND SERVICE MARKS

We own or have rights to trademarks and service marks for use in connection with the operation of our business, including, but not limited to, the word Butterfield. All other trademarks or service marks appearing in this prospectus that are not identified as marks owned by us are the property of their respective owners. Solely for convenience, the trademarks, service marks and trade names referred to in this prospectus are listed without the ®, (TM) and (sm) symbols, but we will assert, to the fullest extent under applicable law, our applicable rights in these trademarks, service marks and trade names.

IMPLICATIONS OF BEING AN EMERGING GROWTH COMPANY AND
A FOREIGN PRIVATE ISSUER

As a company with less than $1.0 billion in revenues during our last fiscal year, we are an “emerging growth company” as defined under the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012 (the “JOBS Act”). An emerging growth company may take advantage of reduced reporting requirements and is relieved of certain other significant requirements that are otherwise generally applicable to public companies. As an emerging growth company:

we are exempt from the requirement to obtain an attestation and report from our auditors on management’s assessment of our internal control over financial reporting under the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002;

ii

TABLE OF CONTENTS

we may provide reduced disclosure regarding our executive compensation arrangements pursuant to the rules applicable to foreign private issuers and emerging growth companies, which means we do not have to include a compensation discussion and analysis and certain other disclosure regarding our executive compensation; and
we are not required to seek a nonbinding advisory vote on executive compensation or golden parachute arrangements.

We have elected to take advantage of the scaled disclosure requirements and other relief described above in this prospectus and may take advantage of these exemptions for so long as we remain an emerging growth company. We will remain an emerging growth company until the earliest of (1) the end of the fiscal year during which we have total annual gross revenues of $1.0 billion or more, (2) the end of the fiscal year following the fifth anniversary of the completion of our IPO, (3) the date on which we have, during the previous three-year period, issued more than $1.0 billion in nonconvertible debt and (4) the end of the fiscal year, after we have been subject to the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), for a period of 12 calendar months and have filed at least one annual report pursuant to those sections, in which the market value of the Bank’s equity securities that are held by non-affiliates exceeds $700 million as of June 30 of that year.

In addition to scaled disclosure and the other relief described above, the JOBS Act permits us an extended transition period for complying with new or revised accounting standards affecting public companies. We do not intend to take advantage of this extended transition period, which means that the financial statements included in this prospectus, as well as any financial statements that we file in the future, will be subject to all new or revised accounting standards generally applicable to public companies.

We are a foreign private issuer, and so long as we qualify as a foreign private issuer under the Exchange Act, we will be exempt from certain provisions of the Exchange Act that are applicable to US domestic public companies, including:

the sections of the Exchange Act regulating the solicitation of proxies, consents or authorizations in respect of a security registered under the Exchange Act;
the sections of the Exchange Act requiring insiders to file public reports of their share ownership and trading activities and liability for insiders who profit from trades made in a short period of time;
the rules under the Exchange Act requiring the filing with the Securities and Exchange Commission of quarterly reports on Form 10-Q containing unaudited financial and other specified information, or current reports on Form 8-K, upon the occurrence of specified significant events; and
Regulation Fair Disclosure, or Regulation FD, which regulates selective disclosures of material information by issuers.

We are, however, required to file an annual report on Form 20-F within four months of the end of each fiscal year. In addition, we have published and intend to continue to publish our results on a quarterly basis through press releases, distributed pursuant to the rules and regulations of the NYSE. Press releases related to financial results and material events have been and will continue to be furnished to the SEC on Form 6-K. However, the information we are required to file with or furnish to the SEC is less extensive and less timely compared to that required to be filed with the SEC by US domestic issuers. As a result, you may not be afforded the same protections or information that would be made available to you, were you investing in a US domestic issuer. For additional discussion on our foreign private issuer status, see “Management — Foreign Private Issuer Status”.

iii

TABLE OF CONTENTS

PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

This summary highlights information contained in other parts of this prospectus. Because it is only a summary, it does not contain all of the information that you should consider before investing in the common shares and it is qualified in its entirety by, and should be read in conjunction with, the more detailed information appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. You should read the entire prospectus carefully, especially “Risk Factors”, “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements”, “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Conditions and Results of Operations”, and our financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus, before deciding to buy the common shares. See “Explanatory Note” on page i of this prospectus for use of certain terms used herein.

Overview

We are a full service bank and wealth manager headquartered in Hamilton, Bermuda. We operate our business through six geographic segments: Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, and Guernsey, where our principal banking operations are located; and The Bahamas, Switzerland, and the United Kingdom, where we offer specialized financial services. We offer banking services, comprised of retail and corporate banking, and wealth management, which consists of trust, private banking, and asset management. In our Bermuda and Cayman Islands segments, we offer both banking and wealth management. In our Guernsey, Bahamas, and Switzerland segments, we offer wealth management. In our United Kingdom segment, we offer residential property lending.

For the year ended December 31, 2016 we generated $406.0 million in net revenue before provision for credit losses and other gains/losses (“Net Revenue”). Our Net Revenue for the year ended December 31, 2016 consisted of 57% from our Bermuda segment, 30% from our Cayman Islands segment, 10% from our Guernsey segment, 1% from our United Kingdom segment, and 1% from each of our Bahamas and Switzerland segments. As of December 31, 2016, we had $11.1 billion in total assets, $3.6 billion in net loans, $10.0 billion in customer deposits (67% USD deposits, 18% USD-pegged deposits), $98.0 billion of trust assets under administration (“AUA”), and $4.7 billion of assets under management (“AUM”).

In our Bermuda and Cayman Islands segments, our bank provides a full range of retail and corporate banking services to individuals, local businesses, captive insurers, reinsurance companies, trust companies, and hedge funds. The key products we offer include personal and business deposit services, residential and commercial mortgages, small and medium-sized enterprise and corporate loans, credit and debit card suite, merchant acquiring, mobile / online banking, and cash management. With seven branches and 51 ATMs as of December 31, 2016, we have a 39% Bermudian Dollar (“BMD”) deposit market share in Bermuda and a 35% local deposit market share in the Cayman Islands as of December 31, 2015 based on data from the Bermuda Monetary Authority (“BMA”) and the Cayman Islands Monetary Authority (“CIMA”), respectively. We were named “Bermuda Bank of the Year” and “Cayman Bank of the Year” in 2013, 2014 and 2015, and once again “Bermuda Bank of the Year” in 2016 by The Banker and “Best Developed Market Bank in Bermuda” by Global Finance in 2015 and 2016.

In all of our segments except the United Kingdom, we offer wealth management to high net worth and ultra-high net worth individuals, family offices, and institutional and corporate clients. Our wealth management platform has three lines of business: trust, private banking, and asset management. The wealth management business has received a number of industry awards from Euromoney, the Society of Trust and Estate Practitioners (“STEP”), Citiwealth, PWM/The Banker, and Global Finance, including “Trust Company of the Year” at the STEP Private Client Awards in 2015 and “Best Private Bank 2015, Bermuda” by both PWM/The Banker and Global Finance in 2015.

The trust business line, which utilizes specialists in each of our geographic areas, meets client needs in estate and succession planning, administration of complex asset holdings, and efficient coordination of family affairs. In addition, the business provides pension and employee benefits services for multinational corporations, as well as services that involve administration of and fiduciary responsibility for customized trust structures holding a wide range of asset types including financial assets, property, business assets, and art. As of December 31, 2016, trust AUA totaled $98.0 billion.

1

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Our private banking business line offers access to a suite of services, targeted toward high net worth individuals, trusts, and family offices, that can be customized to each client's needs and preferences and delivered as part of a coordinated strategy by a dedicated private banker. We provide clients in our Bermuda, Cayman Islands, and Guernsey segments with an integrated model that combines traditional wealth management with banking, lending, cash management, foreign exchange services, custody and access to asset management and trust professionals within Butterfield. We also provide our clients with immediate access to their account information through the use of internet banking. As of December 31, 2016, total deposits and loans in our private banking business were $3.3 billion and $0.9 billion, respectively.

Our asset management business line provides a broad range of portfolio management services to institutional and private clients. Our target client base includes institutions such as pension funds and captive insurance companies with investable assets over $10 million and private clients such as high net worth individuals, families, and trusts with investable assets over $1 million. Our principal services include discretionary investment management, managed portfolio services, money market, and mutual fund offerings. We also offer advisory and self-directed brokerage options. Over 90% of the business's discretionary investment mandates call for balanced growth to conservative allocations. We focus on delivery of reasonable appreciation with an emphasis on capital preservation. The Bank relies on well-recognized and leading third parties to provide research and investment management expertise, while our own services are concentrated on portfolio construction and managing client relationships. We also provide customized reporting to meet specific needs of our major clients. As of December 31, 2016 our asset management AUM were $4.7 billion.

From 2012 to 2016, our GAAP net income to common shareholders and our core net income to common shareholders (“Core Net Income to Common”) had compound annual growth rates (“CAGRs”) of 67% and 35%, respectively(1). These results were achieved despite a low interest rate environment. We attribute this financial performance to the attractive markets in our segments, leading position in those markets, strong operating discipline, conservative balance sheet deployment, and ability to grow our award-winning wealth management business. Our earnings generation has allowed us to build capital to return to shareholders and invest strategically, both organically and through acquisitions, to further enhance the growth prospects of our Company. We aim to continue to build excess capital in the future, which we can redeploy into growing our business and return to shareholders.

2

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following charts show the trajectory of our performance from 2012 to 2016:


(1)Core Net Income to Common is a non-GAAP financial measure that is calculated by adjusting net income for income or expense items which management considers not to be representative of the ongoing operations of our business and preference share dividends, guarantee fees and premiums paid on preference share buybacks and redemptions. For a reconciliation of Core Net Income to Common to GAAP net income to common, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data – Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(2)Core Earnings per Common Share Fully Diluted is a non-GAAP financial measure that is calculated by dividing Core Earnings to Common by the weighted average shares outstanding. For a reconciliation of Core Earnings per Common Share Fully Diluted to GAAP earnings per share, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data – Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.

3

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Our History

The origin of The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited traces back to 1758, to the founding of the trading firm of Nathaniel Butterfield. In 1858, our company was established as a bank in Bermuda and has been instrumental to the local economy ever since. The Bank was later incorporated under a special act of the local Parliament in 1904. In the 1960s, as international businesses began contributing substantially to Bermuda's economy, we developed services to meet their needs. In 1967, we opened offices in the Cayman Islands and by the 1980s had expanded our operations to include retail banking, investment management, and fund administration. In 1973, we opened our Guernsey office in order to provide customers with access to the Pound Sterling after Bermuda's departure from the British Sterling zone. In addition to being Bermuda's first bank, we have a long history of innovating financial services on the island: we opened the first ATMs in Bermuda in the 1980s and launched Bermuda's first internet banking service in 2001. In 1998, we listed our common shares on the Bermuda Stock Exchange under the ticker symbol “NTB.BH”. In 2016, we listed our common shares on the New York Stock Exchange under the ticker symbol “NTB”.

In 2008 and 2009, as a result of the global financial crisis, we realized losses attributable primarily to US non-agency mortgage backed securities in our investment portfolio, as well as write-downs on local market hospitality loans. To raise capital to offset these losses, the Bank executed a $200 million preference share offering in June 2009. In 2009 and 2010, we implemented a comprehensive restructuring plan for the Company: we hired a new management team, de-risked our balance sheet, and raised $550 million of common equity from a group of investors that included Carlyle Global Financial Services and related entities (collectively, “The Carlyle Group” or “Carlyle”) and Canadian Imperial Bank of Commerce (“CIBC”), as well as existing shareholders. As part of the transaction, we launched a rights offering of $130 million on April 12, 2010, so as to allow the pre-transaction shareholders to participate in the recapitalization of the Company. The rights offering, which closed on May 12, 2010, was fully subscribed to, and the proceeds were used to repurchase shares from the recapitalization investors. As a result, the recapitalization investors' total investment was reduced to $420 million.

Since our restructuring, we have pursued a strategy to focus on our core strengths in banking and wealth management. We have executed upon our strategy by streamlining the Company's operations through exiting non-core markets, repositioning our balance sheet, investing in efficiency initiatives, and continuing to invest in our core business lines to grow both organically and through acquisitions. By following this strategy, we have significantly improved our financial results including growing Core Earnings to Common every year since 2011 and have been able to initiate a capital return policy for investors. The following items were key steps in executing our strategy:

In 2010, we sold our operations in Hong Kong and Malta, and in 2012, we sold our operations in Barbados as they were no longer consistent with our strategy.
In 2010, we sold $820 million of asset-backed securities to cleanse our investment portfolio.
In 2013, we implemented an annual cash dividend of $0.40 per year plus a $0.10 per year special dividend.
In 2014, we completed two acquisitions, which allowed us to both expand and complement our existing business lines: Legis Group Holdings' Guernsey-based trust and corporate services business as well as a significant portion of HSBC's corporate and retail banking business in the Cayman Islands.
In April 2015, CIBC sold its 19% ownership stake. We repurchased and retired 8 million shares for a total of $120 million, and The Carlyle Group purchased CIBC's remaining 2.3 million shares and subsequently sold them to other existing investors.
In December 2015, we repositioned our balance sheet to better match the duration of our assets and liabilities and to reclassify a portion of our Available for Sale (“AFS”) portfolio as Held to Maturity (“HTM”).
In February 2016, we commenced an orderly wind down (“OWD”) of our UK operations. We exited our private banking and asset management operations in our UK segment, but retain our UK high net worth mortgage lending business. The OWD was largely completed by the end of

4

TABLE OF CONTENTS

2016 with the change in the business operations to mortgage lending services and the change of name from UK operations to Butterfield Mortgages Limited. The excess capital in the UK was released early in 2017, which we intend to invest in other areas of our business.

In April 2016, we completed an acquisition of HSBC's Bermuda trust business and private banking investment management operations that added $1.6 billion of deposits to our balance sheet. As part of the transaction, HSBC also entered into an agreement to refer its existing private banking clients to Butterfield.
In September 2016, we successfully completed a $288 million initial public offering and listing on the New York Stock Exchange, through which we raised approximately $126 million in net primary proceeds.
In December 2016, we redeemed and canceled all of our issued and outstanding preference shares, which had a book value of $183 million, removing approximately $16 million of annual preference dividend and guarantee fees. We also repurchased for cancellation the outstanding warrant from the Government of Bermuda, removing a potentially dilutive instrument.

Our Markets

Our two largest segments are Bermuda and the Cayman Islands. As of December 31, 2016, 59% of our total assets were held by our Bermuda segment and 29% by our Cayman Islands segment. Bermuda is our largest segment by number of employees, and we are the country's largest independent bank. As of December 31, 2016, our Bermuda segment had $6.8 billion of assets, $50.1 billion of trust AUA and $3.4 billion of AUM, and our Cayman Islands segment had $3.4 billion of assets, $4.0 billion of trust AUA and $0.8 billion of AUM.

The charts below provide the geographic distribution of our Net Revenue for the year ended December 31, 2016.


Bermuda is a leading international financial center and a global hub for reinsurers, captive insurers, and other multi-national corporations. Foreign currency assets held by local banks totaled $18 billion in 2015, more than three times gross domestic product (“GDP”) for the same period. According to a 2015 report from the Federal Insurance Office of the US Department of the Treasury, Bermuda is the domicile for 15 of the world's 40 largest reinsurance groups and accounts for 11% of global reinsurance premiums written and 15% of global property & casualty reinsurance premiums written. Bermuda's captive insurance market includes approximately 750 captive insurers according to a 2015 report by the Bermuda

5

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Monetary Authority. Home to a population of approximately 66,000, the country had the second highest GDP per capita income in the world in 2015 at approximately $92,500 and a nominal GDP of $5.7 billion according to The Economist.

The Cayman Islands is also a leading international financial center, serving as the leading domicile for hedge funds globally and the second largest domicile (after Bermuda) for captive insurers globally. Total deposits held by banks equaled $12 billion as of 2015, or more than three times GDP for 2015. As of December 31, 2016, there were 10,586 regulated mutual funds registered in the Cayman Islands with 106 mutual fund administrators according to CIMA. We hold business relationships with approximately 650 funds, fund administrators, and related entities. Home to a population of approximately 60,000, the country had a 2015 GDP per capita of approximately $56,100 and a nominal GDP of $9.2 billion according to the Cayman Islands' Annual Economic Report.

The table below highlights the relative position of Bermuda and the Cayman Islands compared to the US and UK based on several macroeconomic factors:

Comparison of Selected 2015 Macroeconomic Indicators(1)

 
Bermuda
Cayman Islands
USA
UK
GDP per Capita (in thousands of $)
$
92.5
 
$
56.1
 
$
55.9
 
$
44.2
 
Unemployment
 
7.0
%
 
4.2
%
 
5.3
%
 
5.4
%
Consumer Price Inflation
 
1.4
%
 
(2.3
)%
 
0.1
%
 
0.1
%

___________________

(1)Source: The Economist, 2015 Bermuda Labour Force Survey Executive Report, and The Cayman Islands' Labour Force Survey Report Fall 2015

The international trust market is primarily concentrated in select jurisdictions, including Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, Guernsey, Hong Kong, Jersey, Singapore, and Switzerland. The leading international trust law firms serve as key introducers of clients to Butterfield and are the primary source of new business. Trust clients often hold assets that are international in nature, and as a result, performance of trust businesses is not generally linked to performance of the domestic economies where clients are served.

The private banking market in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, and Guernsey is composed largely of resident high net worth individuals meeting minimum deposit and/or loan thresholds. Clients are introduced to the private bank through Butterfield's retail banking operation upon reaching the appropriate deposit or loan threshold, Butterfield's trust and asset management arms, as well as through external introducers. Although locally based, private banking clients often hold international assets, and as a result, business performance is not necessarily correlated to the domestic economies where clients are served.

Our asset management business line operates in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, and Guernsey. As of December 31, 2016, 73% of our AUM was in Bermuda, 18% was in the Cayman Islands and 8% was in Guernsey. In Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, a majority of our institutional and private clients are domestic from a domicile perspective while a majority of our clients in Guernsey are tied to our trust business and are international in nature.

Our Competitive Strengths

Leading Bank in Attractive Markets

We are a leading bank in Bermuda with a 39% market share in BMD deposits and a 36% market share in BMD loans, respectively, as of December 31, 2015 (Source: BMA). In the Cayman Islands, we have a 35% market share in local deposits and a 25% market share in local mortgages as of December 31, 2015 (Source: CIMA). The Bermuda and Cayman Islands banking markets have historically been characterized by a limited number of participants and significant barriers to entry. In addition, these markets provide us with access to several attractive customer bases: in retail banking, we serve local residents and businesses; in corporate banking, we serve captive insurers, hedge funds, middle-market reinsurers, and other corporates; and in wealth management, we serve private trust clients

6

TABLE OF CONTENTS

and ultra-high net worth and high net worth individuals and families. Our market share, scale, history, and brand in our Bermuda and Cayman Islands segments have enabled us to achieve our strategic objectives, including lending at attractive margins, attracting low cost, sticky deposits, and growing our wealth management business, all of which have driven our earnings and capital generation.

Strong Capital Generation and Return

Since our recapitalization, we have streamlined our business by exiting non-core markets, executing on various operating efficiency initiatives, shifting the risk profile of our loan and securities portfolios, running off our legacy loan and securities portfolios, and deploying our excess capital in the form of dividends and share repurchases. Our return on equity for 2016 of approximately 9% and our Core ROATCE for 2016 of approximately 21% were driven by a number of factors, including: significant fee income with historically low capital requirements, low cost deposits, a high yielding loan portfolio, a conservative capital efficient securities portfolio, and operations in corporate income tax neutral jurisdictions. As a result, our business generated core net income in 2016 well in excess of that needed to execute our organic balance sheet growth strategy.


(1)Core ROATCE is a non-GAAP financial measure that is calculated by dividing core earnings to common shareholders by average tangible common equity. Average tangible common equity does not include the preference shareholders' equity or goodwill and intangible assets. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.

7

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Growth Opportunities

We expect that, all else being equal, a rising rate environment would increase our net interest income before provision for credit losses because an increase in our cost of deposits would lag an increase in yield of our securities and loans. In addition, a significant portion of our deposits are non-interest bearing (24% as of December 31, 2016), and as a result, a portion of our funding is insensitive to rising rates. Our non-interest bearing deposit balances have historically exhibited low correlation with interest rates, a behavior that we attribute in part to a sizeable client base that utilizes our bank for cash management purposes. Potential changes to our net interest income in hypothetical rising and declining rate scenarios, measured over a 12-month period, are presented in the chart below (these projections assume parallel shifts of the yield curves occurring immediately and no changes in other potential variables):


A down 100 basis points interest rate shock shows a reduction in projected 12-month net interest income of 8.9% from the flat scenario. The loss of income is driven by lower loan and investment yields, which more than offset reduced rates paid on deposits. Mitigating against the loss of income is the potential to charge negative interest rates on deposits (which we currently do in some instances) and certain loans that have rate floors.

In addition, we are well-positioned as an acquirer of certain businesses, primarily in wealth management. Our acquisition strategy seeks to capitalize on opportunities created by international financial institutions that have faced operating issues requiring them to simplify their businesses. We consider a wide range of potential acquisition opportunities, and we have a well-defined, disciplined approach to identifying potential acquisition targets across numerous criteria including: geography, business alignment, size, timing, quality, buyer universe and financial hurdles. Our recent focus has been primarily on the private trust business where we have expertise, scale and a strong brand.

In 2014, we completed two acquisitions that allowed us to both expand and complement our existing businesses. In April 2014, we completed the acquisition of Legis Group’s Guernsey-based trust and corporate services business. The transaction enhanced the scale of our international trust capabilities and fortified our position as a leading player in Guernsey. In November 2014, we acquired select deposits and loans in the Cayman Islands from HSBC. At close, the transaction added approximately $0.5 billion of customer deposits with an average cost of 0.12%, and $144 million of loans.

In April 2016, we acquired HSBC’s Bermuda trust business and private banking investment management operations. HSBC also entered into an agreement to refer its existing private banking clients to Butterfield. This acquisition added over $18.9 billion of trust AUA, $1.3 billion of AUM, and $1.6 billion of deposits.

8

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Efficient Balance Sheet and Visible Earnings

Our relationship-driven business model and international corporate clientele have allowed us to develop a sticky deposit base with historically low funding costs. We believe our customers’ deposit activity has historically been inelastic to deposit pricing given the nature of corporate activity and competition in retail deposit taking in our segments. From 2012 to 2016, customer deposits have grown at a compound annual growth rate (“CAGR”) of approximately 14% in Bermuda and 12% in the Cayman Islands, taking into account the HSBC Cayman acquisition in November 2014 that added $0.5 billion of new deposits, and the April 2016 acquisition of HSBC’s Bermuda trust business and private banking investment management operations that added $1.6 billion of new deposits. As of December 31, 2016, we had $10.0 billion in deposits at a cost of 0.12%, of which 24% were non-interest bearing demand deposits, 58% were interest bearing demand deposits with a weighted-average cost of 0.07%, and 18% were term deposits with a weighted-average cost of 0.47% and an average maturity of 80 days. We believe the market conditions in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands will allow us to continue to benefit from favorable deposit pricing.

The following chart shows deposit trends for 2012 to 2016:


Historically, the markets in which we operate generate fewer loans than deposits, which has led us to take a conservative approach to managing our balance sheet. We accomplish this by maintaining a large cash balance and investing in high quality and liquid securities. The following chart illustrates our asset composition as of December 31, 2016:

9

TABLE OF CONTENTS


As of December 31, 2016, 19% of our balance sheet was cash and cash equivalents, which included cash and demand deposits with banks, unrestricted term deposits, certificates of deposits, and treasury bills with a maturity less than three months.

In addition to maintaining a large cash balance, we also have a large securities investment portfolio. We have a disciplined investment portfolio selection process and invest in highly rated securities. We also seek to ensure that our portfolio remains liquid across market cycles: 79% of our portfolio was invested in US government treasuries and mortgage-backed securities issued by US governmental agencies. Our investment strategy aims to align the interest rate risk profile of our assets and liabilities — as of December 31, 2016, the average duration of our AFS investment portfolio was 2.5 years, the average duration of our HTM investment portfolio was 6.3 years, and the average duration of our total investment portfolio was 3.4 years.

10

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following charts show the composition of our investment portfolio by rating and asset type as of December 31, 2016:


The combination of our significant cash and securities portfolios helps drive our capital efficient balance sheet, with risk-weighted assets equal to 39% of our total assets and a Basel III total capital ratio of 17.6%, each as of December 31, 2016.

Our loan underwriting process requires that we complete a full credit assessment of every customer prior to committing to a loan, which we believe has resulted in a high quality loan portfolio. Our lending markets do not have secondary markets for loans and as such we hold all of our originated loans on our balance sheet. In 2015 and 2016, net charge-offs represented 0.2% and 0.3%, respectively, of average loans. As of December 31, 2016, our non-accrual loan balance was $48.5 million, or 1.3% of total loans, and 84% of our loans past due were full recourse residential mortgages. As of December 31, 2016, our loan portfolio consisted of 94% floating-rate loans and 6% fixed-rate loans.

11

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following chart shows the segment composition of our loan portfolio as of December 31, 2016:


Our loan portfolio has exhibited stability over time. The following chart shows loan portfolio trends for 2012 to 2016:


12

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The domestic lending markets in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands have a limited number of participants and significant barriers to entry. 65.2% of our loan balances were residential mortgages as of December 31, 2016. These loans are attractive for a number of reasons. The average yield on new residential mortgage originations in our Bermuda and Cayman segment in the fourth quarter of 2016 was 4.47%, which we believe is consistent with other firms that compete in our markets. In addition, our mortgages have exhibited predictable cash flows, with historically negligible refinancing activity due to high costs to refinance in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands. Finally, our mortgages have historically benefited from a manual underwriting process, low LTVs (67% of residential loans below 70% LTV as of December 31, 2016), and a full recourse system in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands.

We have also generated balanced sources of non-interest income from a well-diversified customer base. For the five year period ended December 31, 2016, our non-interest income is evenly split between banking which consists of banking and foreign exchange revenue, and wealth management, which consists of trust, asset management, and custody and other administration services. The wealth management non-interest income stream is not directly correlated with the performance of our banking business. For example, the typical trust we manage generates a relatively constant fee stream on an annual basis throughout its life. In addition, because fee revenue in our wealth management business lines is primarily driven by the size of our clients’ assets and holdings, which are generally diversified across multiple geographies, the performance of these businesses is not typically linked to the economies of our local markets. Non-interest income represented 36% of our total Net Revenue in 2016, and contributed materially to the Company’s high Core ROATCE and excess capital generation as limited capital is required for our fee income business.

The following chart shows our various sources of non-interest income for the year ended December 31, 2016:


(1)Foreign exchange revenue represents income generated from client-driven transactions in the normal course of business. We do not engage in proprietary trading.

13

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Strong Leadership with Deep Knowledge of Our Domestic and International Markets

Our management team has extensive and varied experience managing banking and financial services firms. We believe that our management team’s reputation and performance track record gives us an advantage in executing our organic growth and acquisition strategies.

Name
Title
Joined
Butterfield
Prior Experience
Years of
Experience
Michael Collins
Chief Executive Officer
2009
COO of HSBC Bermuda
31
Michael Schrum
Chief Financial Officer
2015
CFO of HSBC Bermuda
21
Daniel Frumkin
Chief Risk Officer
2010
CRO of Retail Banking at RBS
30
Robert Moore
Group Head of Trust
1997
Senior Manager of International Private
Banking with Lloyds
38
Michael Neff
Group Head of Wealth Management
2011
Global Head of
Wealth Management
at RiskMetrics
29

In addition to his role as CEO, Michael Collins serves as a member of our Board. Barclay Simmons, our Non-Executive Chairman since 2015, joined our Board in 2011 and was named Vice Chairman in 2012. We have seven additional non-executive directors, who bring to the Bank a diverse array of experiences in the financial services industry from across the globe.

Our Strategy

Butterfield is both a leading banking business in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands and a growing, award-winning, and international wealth management business with operations in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, Guernsey, The Bahamas, and Switzerland. Our strategy focuses on maintaining our leading banking position in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands while continuing to grow scale in our wealth management business across our core geographies. The key components of our strategic plan are:

Banking

Leverage Our Leading Market Position

We seek to remain a leading bank in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands in terms of local deposit and lending market share by continuing to provide excellent service, employ a high-quality work force, and offer a competitive product suite to our customers.

Improve Operating Efficiency

Our banking business operates in geographies with high operational costs. We carefully manage our cost structure to improve efficiency through the deployment of technology and continuous process improvement. We expect continued investments in core banking systems and expansion of electronic channels in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, as well as upgrades in Guernsey, to result in improved operational efficiency.

Wealth Management

Leverage Relationships with Key Introducers

We have over 70 years of experience providing sophisticated trust services and an award-winning brand that was named 2015 “Trust Company of the Year” by STEP. We believe that our reputation and expertise are well-recognized by industry insiders, including the leading international trust law firms. These firms act as a key source of new business for trust services. We plan to leverage our relationships with key introducers to continue to grow our company and build our brand, as well as invest in the further development of our technical expertise and multi-jurisdictional offering. Our recent trust acquisitions have grown the size and reach of our business. As we continue to grow through organic and inorganic means, we believe that our business will increasingly benefit from referrals by key introducers.

14

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Utilize Multi-Jurisdictional Offerings to Attract Client Base

We seek to take advantage of our presence, seasoned trust officers, and product offerings in key international financial centers in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, Guernsey, The Bahamas, and Switzerland to attract our target client base. International trust law varies across different jurisdictions, and our multi-jurisdictional presence enables us to cater to a variety of client preferences from a geographical perspective. In recent years, we have experienced increased demand for trust services from our European, Asian, Latin American, and Middle Eastern clients. We view our trust business line as an opportunity for further growth.

Emphasize Strong Client Relationships

Our primary focus is to build strong client relationships using our knowledge of the local market and combining our banking and wealth management services to meet the financial needs of our customers. We believe our experience in building strong, long-term client relationships in our wealth management business will enable us to retain our existing clients and attract additional trust, private banking, and asset management business from them, as well as receive referrals to potential new clients. In addition, our wealth management business sources customers and benefits from the strong relationships we have in our banking business.

Expand Revenues from Client Relationships Across Our Wealth Management Services

We believe that there is an opportunity to increase the revenues generated from client relationships across our wealth management business lines. For example, we seek to create personal banking and wealth management relationships with the professionals for whom we provide corporate banking services. In addition, trust relationships, which are very long lived, can present opportunities for use of other Butterfield services at different stages of a trust's lifecycle or to meet needs of family members outside the trust itself.

Client relationships from our recent acquisitions represent another area of opportunity to expand Butterfield services and products for high net worth customers and certain corporate and institutional clients. Through the acquisition of HSBC's Bermuda trust business and private banking investment management operations, we migrated 285 new relationships and $1.6 billion of deposits onto our platform.

Improve Operating Efficiency

We continue to identify areas where we can improve cost efficiency without impacting our quality of client service. Past initiatives have included implementation of one global Trust Administration system across segments, implementation of a new custody system, consolidation of our trading operations, and reduction in our fund administration expenses through consolidation.

Pursue Prudent Acquisitions to Increase Scale

We intend to continue pursuing acquisitions aligned with existing business operations, in particular to increase the scale of our trust business line. The fragmented nature of the market, with approximately 500 trust companies operating in key international financial centers, and recent sales of subsidiaries by several international financial institutions have created a favorable environment for companies with the resources and expertise to act as effective consolidators. We believe that our management team has developed a rigorous approach for conducting due diligence and efficiently integrating acquired businesses to meet our internal financial hurdles. In addition, we may pursue acquisitions of other wealth management businesses, including private banking businesses, and we plan to continue to opportunistically analyze potential acquisitions as a means of capital deployment.

Corporate Information

Our principal executive offices are located at 65 Front Street, Hamilton, Bermuda and our telephone number is (441) 295-1111. We maintain a website at www.butterfieldgroup.com. Neither this website nor the information on or accessible through this website is included or incorporated in, or is a part of, this prospectus.

15

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Summary Risk Factors

An investment in the common shares involves a high degree of risk. Any of the factors set forth under “Risk Factors” may limit our ability to successfully execute our business strategy. You should carefully consider all of the information set forth in this prospectus and, in particular, should evaluate the specific factors set forth under “Risk Factors” in deciding whether to invest in the common shares. Among these important risks are the following:

Adverse economic and market conditions, in particular in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, have in the past resulted in and could in the future result in lower revenue, lower asset quality, increased provisions and lower earnings.
Unlike geographically more diversified banks, our business is concentrated primarily in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, and we may be more affected by a downturn in these markets than more diversified competitors.
A decline in the residential real estate market, in particular in Bermuda, could increase the risk of loans being impaired and could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
The value of the securities in our investment portfolio may decline in the future.
Fluctuations in interest rates and inflation may negatively impact our net interest margin and our profitability.
We depend primarily on deposits to fund our liquidity needs; if we are unable to effectively manage our liquidity across the jurisdictions in which we operate, our business, financial condition or results of operations could be adversely affected.
We face competition in all aspects of our business, and may not be able to attract and retain wealth management, trust and banking clients at current levels.
We could fail to attract, retain or motivate highly skilled and qualified personnel, including our senior management, other key employees or members of the Board, which could adversely affect our business.
Our controls and procedures may fail or be circumvented, which could have an adverse impact on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Volatility levels and fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates may affect our business, financial position and results of operations.
Our international business model exposes us to different and possibly conflicting regulatory schemes across multiple jurisdictions.
US withholding tax and information reporting requirements imposed under the Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act may apply.
Fulfilling public company financial reporting and other regulatory obligations in the United States is expensive, time-consuming and may strain our resources.
The uncertainty resulting from the recent vote by the UK electorate in favor of a UK exit from the European Union (“EU”), as well as changes in US legislation, regulation and government policy as a result of the 2016 US presidential and congressional elections, could adversely impact our business, financial condition and results of operations.
We operate in a complex regulatory environment and legal and regulatory changes could have a negative impact on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Changes in US tax laws could cause the insurance and reinsurance industry to relocate from Bermuda, which could have an adverse effect on our buisness, financial condition and results of operations.
Provisions of Bermuda law and our bye-laws could adversely affect your rights as a holder of the common shares or prevent or delay a change in control.
Bermuda law differs from the laws in effect in the United States and might afford less protection to shareholders.

16

TABLE OF CONTENTS

THE OFFERING

Common shares offered by the selling shareholders
          common shares.
Option to purchase additional shares from the selling shareholders
The selling shareholders have granted the underwriters an option for a period of 30 days after the date of this prospectus to purchase up to an additional           common shares.
Common shares outstanding
53,300,372 common shares as of the date of this prospectus.
Voting rights
The common shares have one voting right per share. See “Description of Share Capital”.
Use of proceeds
We will not receive any of the proceeds from the sale of the common shares by the selling shareholders. All of the common shares in this offering are being sold by the selling shareholders.
Dividend policy
On February 12, 2017, our Board declared a cash dividend of $0.32 per share to owners of record as of March 13, 2017.

Subject to the discretion of our Board of Directors and receipt of any required approval from the Bermuda Monetary Authority, we intend to pay cash dividends on the common shares on a quarterly basis. Initially, we expect the quarterly dividends for 2017 to continue to be $0.32 per share, which, if paid in all three remaining quarters, would equal $1.28 per share on an annualized basis. See “Dividend Policy”.

Although we expect to pay dividends according to our dividend policy, we may elect not to pay dividends. Any declarations of dividends will be at the discretion of the Board, subject to regulatory approval, and such dividends may be declared and paid by the Board only as permitted under applicable law. In determining the amount of any future dividends, the Board may take into account: (1) our financial results; (2) our available cash, as well as anticipated cash requirements (including debt servicing); (3) our capital requirements, including the capital requirements of our subsidiaries; (4) contractual, legal, tax and regulatory restrictions on, and implications of, the payment of dividends by us to the Bank's shareholders; (5) general economic and business conditions; (6) restrictions applicable to the Bank and its subsidiaries under Bermuda and other applicable laws, regulations and policies, including the requirement to obtain the BMA's prior approval for the payment of dividends on our common shares; and (7) any other factors that the Board may deem relevant. Therefore, there can be no assurance that we will declare or pay any dividends

17

TABLE OF CONTENTS

to holders of the common shares, or as to the amount of any such dividends. See “Risk Factors — Risks Relating to the Common Shares — Holders of our common shares may not receive dividends”.

Pre-emptive Rights
Holders of the common shares, including prospective purchasers in this offering, do not and, upon completion of this offering, will not have any pre-emptive rights.
Listing
The common shares trade on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “NTB”. The closing price of the common shares on the NYSE on February 10, 2017 was $32.59.

The common shares also trade on the Bermuda Stock Exchange under the symbol “NTB.BH”. The closing price of the common shares on the BSX on February 10, 2017 was $32.00.

Lock-up
The Bank and the selling shareholders have agreed with the underwriters not to offer, pledge, sell or otherwise dispose of or hedge any of the Bank's common shares, subject to certain exceptions, for the 75-day period following the date of this prospectus, without the prior consent of certain of the underwriters. The members of the Board and senior management have entered into similar lock-up agreements with the underwriters. The representatives of the underwriters may, at any time, release the Bank, such shareholders or any of the members of the Board and senior management from these lock-up restrictions. For more information, see “Underwriting”.
Risk Factors
Investing in our common shares involves significant risks. You should read the “Risk Factors” section of this prospectus, beginning on page 26, for a discussion of factors to consider carefully before deciding to invest in the common shares.

18

TABLE OF CONTENTS

SUMMARY CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL AND OTHER DATA

Consolidated Financial Information

The following tables present our selected consolidated financial information as of and for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015, 2014, 2013, and 2012.

Our historical results for any prior period do not necessarily indicate our results to be expected for any future period. The following data should be read in conjunction with “Selected Consolidated Financial Data” and “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations”.

The summary consolidated financial information presented as of December 31, 2016 and 2015 and for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 have been derived from the audited consolidated financial statements of The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited included elsewhere in this prospectus. The summary consolidated financial information presented as of December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 and for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 have been derived from the audited consolidated financial statements of The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited, which are not included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 
For the year ended
December 31,
(in millions of $, unless indicated otherwise)
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
Total interest income
 
274.9
 
 
262.6
 
 
265.1
 
 
253.2
 
 
244.8
 
Total interest expense
 
16.4
 
 
23.3
 
 
26.6
 
 
29.4
 
 
33.1
 
Net interest income before provisions for credit losses
 
258.5
 
 
239.3
 
 
238.5
 
 
223.8
 
 
211.7
 
Provisions for credit losses
 
(4.4
)
 
(5.7
)
 
(8.0
)
 
(14.8
)
 
(14.2
)
Net interest income after provisions for credit losses
 
254.1
 
 
233.5
 
 
230.4
 
 
209.0
 
 
197.5
 
Total non-interest income
 
147.5
 
 
140.2
 
 
134.8
 
 
126.0
 
 
128.5
 
Total other gains (losses)
 
1.0
 
 
(9.4
)
 
15.7
 
 
(8.8
)
 
(26.4
)
Total net revenue
 
402.6
 
 
364.3
 
 
381.0
 
 
326.2
 
 
299.7
 
Total non-interest expense
 
285.9
 
 
285.2
 
 
273.0
 
 
262.6
 
 
274.9
 
Net income before income taxes from continuing operations
 
116.7
 
 
79.0
 
 
108.0
 
 
63.5
 
 
24.8
 
Income tax (expense) benefit
 
(0.7
)
 
(1.3
)
 
0.2
 
 
(0.9
)
 
(5.9
)
Net income from continuing operations
 
115.9
 
 
77.7
 
 
108.2
 
 
62.6
 
 
18.9
 
Net income(1)
 
115.9
 
 
77.7
 
 
108.2
 
 
62.6
 
 
26.5
 
Net income to common shareholders
 
58.4
 
 
61.2
 
 
91.6
 
 
42.8
 
 
7.5
 
Earnings per common share from continuing operations (in US$)(2)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
 
1.20
 
 
1.25
 
 
1.67
 
 
0.78
 
 
0.14
 
Diluted(3)
 
1.18
 
 
1.23
 
 
1.65
 
 
0.77
 
 
0.14
 
Cash Dividends per common share (in BM$)(2)
 
0.40
 
 
0.50
 
 
0.50
 
 
0.70
 
 
 
Dividends per preference share (in US$)
 
80.00
 
 
80.00
 
 
80.00
 
 
80.00
 
 
80.00
 
(1)Net income (loss) attributable to our Barbados operations that were reported as discontinued operations in 2012 amounted to $7.6 million in 2012.
(2)Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.
(3)Reflects only “in the money” options and warrants to purchase the common shares as well as certain unvested share awards, which have a dilutive effect. The warrant issued to the Government of Bermuda in exchange for the Government's guarantee of the preference shares are not included in the computation of earnings per share because the exercise price was greater than the average market price of the common shares for the relevant periods. In December 2016, in connection with the preference share redemption, the warrant issued to the Government of Bermuda was repurchased for cancellation by the Bank. Only share awards and options for which the sum of (1) the expense that will be recognized in the future (i.e., the unrecognized expense) and (2) its exercise price, if any, was lower than the average market price of the common shares were considered dilutive, and therefore, included in the computation of diluted earnings per share.

19

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Balance Sheet Data

 
As of December 31,
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks
 
2,101.7
 
 
2,288.9
 
 
2,063.3
 
 
1,730.5
 
 
1,542.5
 
Of which cash and demand deposits with banks — non-interest bearing
 
110.7
 
 
110.9
 
 
343.1
 
 
247.0
 
 
216.6
 
Of which demand deposits with banks — interest bearing
 
326.4
 
 
378.6
 
 
139.2
 
 
164.2
 
 
150.4
 
Of which cash equivalents — interest bearing
 
1,664.5
 
 
1,799.4
 
 
1,581.0
 
 
1,319.3
 
 
1,175.5
 
Securities purchased under agreement to resell
 
148.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Short-term investments
 
519.8
 
 
409.5
 
 
394.8
 
 
55.0
 
 
76.2
 
Investment in securities
 
4,400.2
 
 
3,223.9
 
 
2,989.1
 
 
2,613.6
 
 
2,881.7
 
Of which trading
 
6.3
 
 
321.3
 
 
417.4
 
 
552.3
 
 
771.1
 
Of which available-for-sale
 
3,332.7
 
 
2,201.3
 
 
2,233.5
 
 
1,728.0
 
 
1,871.2
 
Of which held-to-maturity(1)
 
1,061.1
 
 
701.3
 
 
338.2
 
 
333.4
 
 
239.3
 
Loans, net of allowance for credit losses
 
3,570.5
 
 
4,000.2
 
 
4,019.1
 
 
4,088.2
 
 
3,956.0
 
Premises, equipment and computer software
 
167.8
 
 
183.4
 
 
215.1
 
 
240.6
 
 
243.3
 
Accrued interest
 
22.8
 
 
17.5
 
 
19.2
 
 
19.6
 
 
19.0
 
Goodwill
 
19.6
 
 
23.5
 
 
24.8
 
 
7.1
 
 
6.9
 
Intangible assets
 
42.3
 
 
27.7
 
 
33.0
 
 
12.0
 
 
15.3
 
Equity method investments
 
13.5
 
 
12.8
 
 
12.8
 
 
12.5
 
 
18.6
 
Other real estate owned
 
14.2
 
 
11.2
 
 
19.3
 
 
27.4
 
 
34.4
 
Other assets
 
82.5
 
 
77.1
 
 
67.8
 
 
64.2
 
 
39.0
 
Total assets
 
11,103.5
 
 
10,275.6
 
 
9,858.4
 
 
8,870.8
 
 
8,833.0
 
Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total customer and bank deposits
 
10,033.6
 
 
9,182.1
 
 
8,671.6
 
 
7,638.0
 
 
7,393.2
 
Of which customer deposits — Bermuda — non-interest bearing
 
1,733.7
 
 
1,348.9
 
 
1,021.4
 
 
713.3
 
 
664.1
 
Of which customer deposits — Bermuda — interest bearing
 
4,213.4
 
 
2,922.8
 
 
2,848.7
 
 
2,837.7
 
 
2,591.2
 
Of which customer deposits — non-Bermuda — non-interest bearing
 
651.3
 
 
532.9
 
 
536.7
 
 
299.5
 
 
254.7
 
Of which customer deposits — non-Bermuda — interest bearing
 
3,411.4
 
 
4,363.1
 
 
4,224.8
 
 
3,747.1
 
 
3,756.8
 
Of which bank deposits — Bermuda
 
0.3
 
 
0.4
 
 
9.5
 
 
0.5
 
 
88.2
 
Of which bank deposits — non-Bermuda
 
23.5
 
 
14.1
 
 
30.4
 
 
39.7
 
 
38.3
 
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
25.5
 
 
109.0
 
Employee future benefits
 
140.0
 
 
122.1
 
 
117.9
 
 
89.1
 
 
103.1
 
Accrued interest
 
2.1
 
 
2.7
 
 
4.8
 
 
3.8
 
 
2.8
 
Preference share dividends payable
 
 
 
0.7
 
 
0.7
 
 
0.6
 
 
0.7
 
Payable for investments purchased
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
 
100.0
 
 
100.5
 
 
97.2
 
 
104.2
 
 
107.0
 
Liabilities of discontinued operations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Long-term debt
 
117.0
 
 
117.0
 
 
117.0
 
 
207.0
 
 
260.0
 
Total liabilities
 
10,392.8
 
 
9,525.2
 
 
9,009.1
 
 
8,068.3
 
 
7,975.8
 
Total shareholders' equity(2)
 
710.7
 
 
750.4
 
 
849.4
 
 
802.6
 
 
857.2
 
Of which common share capital(6)
 
0.5
 
 
0.5
(5)
 
0.6
 
 
0.6
 
 
0.6
 
Of which preference share capital(3)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Of which contingent value convertible preference (CVCP) share capital(4)(6)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
 
11,103.5
 
 
10,275.6
 
 
9,858.4
 
 
8,870.8
 
 
8,833.0
 
(1)Fair value of held to maturity debt securities was $1,046.8 million as of December 31, 2016, $701.5 million as of December 31, 2015, $344.0 million as of December 31, 2014, $315.5 million as of December 31, 2013 and $244.8 million as of December 31, 2012.
(2)As of December 31, 2016, the number of outstanding awards of unvested common shares was 0.8 million (December 31, 2015: 0.8 million, December 31, 2014: 1.0 million, December 31, 2013: 0.9 million and December 31, 2012: 0.7 million). Only awards for which the sum of (1) the expense that will be recognized in the future (i.e., the unrecognized expense) and (2) the exercise price, if any, was lower than the average market price of $34.72. A warrant, outstanding until the Bank repurchased it in December 2016, to purchase 0.43 million shares (December 31, 2015: 0.43 million, December 31, 2014: 0.43 million,

20

TABLE OF CONTENTS

December 31, 2013: 0.43 million and December 31, 2012: 0.42 million) was excluded from the computation of earnings per share because the exercise price was greater than the average market price of the common shares. Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.

(3)Preference share capital in all periods presented is nil, $182,863, $183,046, $183,606 and $195,578 as of December 31, 2016, 2015, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, representing $0.01 par value per preference share issued and outstanding as of the respective dates. In December 2016, the Bank redeemed and cancelled all outstanding preference shares.
(4)All CVCP shares were converted to common shares at a 1:1 ratio on March 31, 2015. See “Description of Share Capital — Preference Shares — Contingent Value Convertible Preference Shares”.
(5)Reflects the repurchase for cancellation of 8,000,000 common shares previously held by CIBC effected on April 30, 2015. See “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Contingent Value Convertible Preference Shares — Share Buy-Back Program”. Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.
(6)Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.

21

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Financial Ratios and Other Performance Indicators

We use a number of financial measures to track the performance of our business and guide our management. Some of these measures are defined by, and calculated in compliance with, applicable banking regulations, but such regulations often provide for certain discretion in defining and calculating the measures. These measures allow management to review our core activities, enabling us and our investors to evaluate relevant trends meaningfully when considered in conjunction with (but not in lieu of) measures that are calculated in accordance with US GAAP. Non-GAAP measures used in this prospectus are not a substitute for US GAAP measures and readers should consider the US GAAP measures as well.

The following table shows certain of our key financial measures for the periods indicated. Because of the discretion that we and other banks and companies have in defining and calculating these measures, care should be taken in comparing such measures used by us with similarly titled measures of other banks and companies, as such measures may not be directly comparable.

Many of these measures are non-GAAP financial measures. We believe that each of these measures is useful to investors in understanding trends in our business that may not otherwise be apparent when relying solely on our GAAP-calculated results. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures presented below, including a reconciliation to the most directly comparable GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.

 
For the year ended
December 31,
(in %, unless otherwise indicated)
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
Return on common shareholders' equity(1)
 
8.9
 
 
10.1
 
 
13.7
 
 
6.8
 
 
1.1
 
Core return on average tangible common equity(2)
 
20.5
 
 
17.6
 
 
14.4
 
 
9.7
 
 
5.8
 
Return on assets(3)
 
1.1
 
 
0.8
 
 
1.2
 
 
0.7
 
 
0.3
 
Core return on average tangible assets(4)
 
1.3
 
 
1.1
 
 
1.2
 
 
0.9
 
 
0.6
 
Net interest margin(5)
 
2.45
 
 
2.48
 
 
2.74
 
 
2.64
 
 
2.63
 
Efficiency margin(6)
 
69.3
 
 
74.0
 
 
72.0
 
 
74.1
 
 
79.3
 
Core efficiency ratio(7)
 
63.8
 
 
66.0
 
 
67.7
 
 
71.6
 
 
78.4
 
Fee income ratio(8)
 
36.7
 
 
37.5
 
 
36.9
 
 
37.6
 
 
39.5
 
Common equity Tier 1 capital ratio(9)(10)
 
15.3
 
 
10.7
 
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
Tier 1 common ratio(9)
 
N/A
 
 
12.0
 
 
14.6
 
 
15.2
 
 
14.0
 
Tier 1 capital ratio(9)
 
15.3
 
 
16.2
 
 
19.0
 
 
19.6
 
 
18.5
 
Total capital ratio(9)
 
17.6
 
 
19.0
 
 
22.2
 
 
23.7
 
 
24.2
 
Leverage ratio(9)(10)
 
5.8
 
 
6.4
 
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
Tangible common equity/tangible assets(11)
 
5.9
 
 
5.1
 
 
6.2
 
 
6.8
 
 
7.3
 
Tangible total equity/tangible assets(12)
 
5.9
 
 
6.8
 
 
8.1
 
 
8.9
 
 
9.5
 
Non-performing assets ratio(13)
 
0.5
 
 
0.7
 
 
1.0
 
 
1.4
 
 
1.7
 
Non-accrual ratio(14)
 
1.3
 
 
1.6
 
 
1.8
 
 
2.5
 
 
2.8
 
Non-performing loan ratio(15)
 
1.6
 
 
2.0
 
 
2.4
 
 
2.8
 
 
3.5
 
Net charge-off ratio(16)
 
0.3
 
 
0.2
 
 
0.4
 
 
0.6
 
 
0.4
 
Core earnings attributable to common shareholders(17)(18) (in BM$ million)
 
123.0
 
 
97.4
 
 
89.9
 
 
59.6
 
 
36.9
 
Core earnings per common share fully diluted(19)(21) (in BM$)
 
2.48
 
 
1.95
 
 
1.61
 
 
1.08
 
 
0.66
 
Common equity per share(20)(21) (in BM$)
 
13.34
 
 
12.24
 
 
12.25
 
 
11.28
 
 
12.03
 
(1)Return on common shareholders' equity (“ROE”) measures profitability revealing how much profit is generated with the money invested by common shareholders. ROE represents the amount of net income to common shareholders as a percentage of average common equity and calculated as net income to common shareholders / average common equity. Net income to common shareholders is net income for the full fiscal year, before dividends paid to common shareholders but after dividends to preference shareholders. Average common equity does not include the preference shareholders' equity.
(2)Core return on average tangible common equity (“Core ROATCE”) is a non-GAAP financial measure. Core ROATCE measures core profitability as a percentage of average tangible common equity. Core ROATCE is the amount of core income to common shareholders as a percentage of average tangible common equity and is calculated as core earnings to common shareholders / average tangible common equity. Core earnings to common shareholders is net earnings to common shareholders for the full fiscal year (before dividends paid to common shareholders but after dividends to preference shareholders) adjusted to exclude certain items that are included in the financial results presented in accordance with GAAP. Average tangible common equity does not include the preference shareholders' equity or goodwill and intangible assets. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.

22

TABLE OF CONTENTS

(3)Return on assets (“ROA”) is an indicator of profitability relative to total assets and is intended to demonstrate how efficient management is at using the assets to generate earnings. The ROA ratio is calculated as net income / average total assets.
(4)Core return on average tangible assets (“Core ROATA”) is a non-GAAP financial measure. Core ROATA is an indicator used to assess the core profitability of average tangible assets and is intended to demonstrate how efficiently management is utilizing its tangible assets to generate core net income. Core ROATA is calculated by taking the core income as a percentage of average tangible assets and is calculated as core net income / average tangible assets. Core net income is the net income adjusted to exclude certain items that are included in the financial results presented in accordance with GAAP. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “— Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(5)Net interest margin (“NIM”) is a performance metric that examines how successful the Bank's investment decisions are compared to its cost of funding assets and is expressed as net interest income as a percentage of average interest-earning assets. NIM is calculated as net interest income before provision for credit losses / average interest-earning assets. Net interest income is the interest earned on cash due from banks, investments, loans and other interest earning assets minus the interest paid for deposits, short-term borrowings and long-term debt. The average interest-earning assets is calculated using daily average balances of interest-earning assets.
(6)Efficiency margin is a non-GAAP financial measure. Efficiency margin is an indicator used to assess operating efficiencies and is intended to demonstrate how efficiently management is controlling expenses relative to generating revenues. The efficiency margin is calculated by taking the non-interest expenses as a percentage of total net revenue before total other gains (losses) and provisions for credit losses and is calculated as (non-interest expense — amortization of intangible assets) / (total non-interest income + net interest income before provision for credit losses). For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(7)The core efficiency ratio is a non-GAAP financial measure. The core efficiency ratio is an indicator used to assess operating efficiencies and is intended to demonstrate how efficiently management is controlling expenses relative to generating revenues. The core efficiency ratio is calculated by taking the core non-interest expenses as a percentage of total net revenue before provision for credit losses and other gains and losses and is calculated as (core non-interest expenses — amortization of intangible assets) / (core non-interest income + core net interest income before provision for credit losses). Core non-interest expenses exclude certain items that are included in the financial results presented in accordance with GAAP including income taxes and amortization of intangible assets. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(8)The fee income ratio is a measure used to determine the proportion of revenues derived from non-interest income sources. The ratio is calculated as non-interest income / (non-interest income + net interest income after provision for credit losses).
(9)The total capital ratio measures the amount of the Bank's capital in relation to the amount of risk it is taking. All banks must ensure that a reasonable proportion of their risk is covered by permanent capital. Prior to January 1, 2015, the Bank's regulatory capital was determined in accordance with Basel II guidelines issued by the BMA. Under Basel II, Pillar I, banks must maintain a minimum total capital ratio of 14.46%, inclusive of all capital buffers. In effect, this means that 14.46% of the risk-weighted assets must be covered by permanent or near permanent capital. The risk weighting process takes into account the relative risk of various types of lending. The higher the capital adequacy ratio a bank has, the greater the level of unexpected losses it can absorb before becoming insolvent. The tier 1 capital ratio is the ratio of the Bank's core equity capital, as measured under Basel II, to its total RWA. RWA are the total of all assets held by the Bank weighted by credit risk according to a formula determined by the regulator. The Bank follows BCBS guidelines in setting formulas for asset risk weights. The tier 1 common ratio is equivalent to the tier 1 capital ratio except that it only includes common equity in the numerator and deducts the preference shareholders' equity. Note that the tier 1 common ratio is calculated in the same manner as the common equity tier 1 (“CET1”) ratio discussed below, but differs in its inputs based upon RWA calculations under Basel II versus Basel III.
(10)Effective January 1, 2015, the Bank's regulatory capital is determined in accordance with current Basel III guidelines issued by the BMA. However, the Bank was not required to publish its capital ratios under Basel III until January 1, 2016 as per guidance from the BMA and continued to publish certain ratios under Basel II during 2015. Basel III adopts CET1 as the predominant form of regulatory capital with the CET1 ratio as a new metric. Under Basel III, banks must maintain a minimum CET1 ratio of 8.1%. Basel III also adopts the new Leverage Ratio regime, which is calculated by dividing tier 1 capital by an exposure measure. Under Basel III, banks must maintain a minimum Leverage Ratio of 5.0%. The exposure measure consists of total assets (excluding items deducted from tier 1 capital) and certain off balance sheet items converted into credit exposure equivalents as well as adjustments for derivatives to reflect credit and other risks.
(11)The tangible common equity/tangible assets (“TCE/TA”) ratio is a non-GAAP financial measure. The TCE/TA ratio is a measure used to determine how significant of an unexpected loss can be incurred by the Bank before other forms of capital, other than common equity, are impacted. The TCE/TA ratio is calculated as (common equity — intangible assets — goodwill) / tangible assets. Tangible common equity does not include the preference shareholders' equity or goodwill and intangible assets. Tangible assets are the Bank's total assets from continuing operations less goodwill and intangibles. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(12)The tangible total equity/tangible assets (“TE/TA”) ratio is a non-GAAP financial measure. The TE/TA ratio is a measure used to determine how much loss the Bank can absorb before subordinated debt capital is impacted. The TE/TA ratio is calculated as (total shareholders' equity — intangible assets — goodwill) / tangible assets. Tangible assets are the Bank's total assets from continuing operations less intangible assets and goodwill. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(13)The non-performing assets (“NPA”) ratio is an indicator of the credit quality of the Bank's total assets by expressing the non-performing assets as a percentage of total assets. The NPA ratio is calculated as (gross non-accrual loans — specific allowance for credit losses on non-accrual loans + accruing loans past due 90 days + other real estate owned) / total assets.
(14)The non-accrual (“NACL”) ratio is an indicator used to assess the credit performance of the Bank's loan portfolio by calculating the non-accrual loans as a percentage of loans. The NACL ratio is calculated as gross non-accrual loans / gross total loans. Note the reference to gross implies the amounts prior to loan allowances for credit losses.

23

TABLE OF CONTENTS

(15)The non-performing loan (“NPL”) ratio is an indicator used to assess the credit performance of the Bank's loan portfolio by calculating the non-performing loans as a percentage of loans. The NPL ratio is calculated as total gross non-performing loans / total gross loans.
(16)The net charge-off (“NCO”) ratio is an indicator used to assess the net credit loss of the Bank's loan portfolio by calculating the net charge-offs as a percentage of average total loans. The NCO ratio is calculated as net charge-off expense / average total loans. Average total loans is calculated as the average of the month-end asset balances during the relevant period.
(17)Core net income is a non-GAAP financial measure. Core net income measures net income on a core basis. Core net income is calculated by adjusting net income for income or expense items which are not representative of the ongoing operations of our business. For a reconciliation of core net income to net income, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(18)Core earnings attributable to common shareholders (“CEACS”) is a non-GAAP financial measure. CEACS measures profitability attributable to common shareholders on a core basis. For a reconciliation of CEACS to net income, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(19)Core net income per common share — fully diluted is a non-GAAP financial measure. Core net income per common share - fully diluted measures core profitability attributable to common shareholders on a per share basis. For a reconciliation to net income per share, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(20)Common equity per share is calculated as total common equity / number of common shares issued and outstanding at period end.
(21)Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.

Net Interest Income

Net interest income is the amount of interest earned on our interest-earning assets less interest paid on our interest-bearing liabilities. The following table shows our net-interest income before provision for credit losses for the periods indicated.

 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2016
2015
(in millions of $)
Average
balance
($)
Interest
($)
Average
rate
(%)
Average
balance
($)
Interest
($)
Average
rate
(%)
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks and short-term investments
 
2,655.3
 
 
9.8
 
 
0.37
%
 
2,407.9
 
 
6.5
 
 
0.27
%
Investment in securities
 
3,940.6
 
 
77.2
 
 
1.95
%
 
3,217.0
 
 
69.6
 
 
2.16
%
Loans
 
3,921.1
 
 
188.0
 
 
4.78
%
 
4,026.7
 
 
186.5
 
 
4.63
%
Interest earning assets
 
10,517.0
 
 
275.0
 
 
2.61
%
 
9,651.6
 
 
262.6
 
 
2.72
%
Other assets
 
343.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
371.5
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
 
10,860.4
 
 
275.0
 
 
2.53
%
 
10,023.1
 
 
262.6
 
 
2.62
%
Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
 
7,733.8
 
 
(11.8
)
 
(0.15
)%
 
7,156.7
 
 
(18.4
)
 
(0.26
)%
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase
 
16.0
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.73
)%
 
2.1
 
 
 
 
%
Long-term debt
 
117.0
 
 
(4.5
)
 
(3.84
)%
 
117.0
 
 
(4.9
)
 
(4.15
)%
Interest bearing liabilities
 
7,866.8
 
 
(16.4
)
 
(0.21
)%
 
7,275.8
 
 
(23.3
)
 
(0.32
)%
Non-interest bearing current accounts
 
2,042.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,720.7
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
 
123.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
196.8
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities
 
10,033.0
 
 
(16.4
)
 
(0.16
)%
 
9,193.3
 
 
(23.3
)
 
(0.25
)%
Shareholders’ equity
 
827.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
829.8
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 
10,860.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
10,023.1
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest-bearing funds net of non-interest earning assets (free balance)
 
2,650.2
 
 
 
 
 
 
2,375.8
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest margin
 
 
 
 
258.6
 
 
2.45
%
 
 
 
 
239.3
 
 
2.48
%

24

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2014
2013
2012
(in millions of $)
Average
balance
($)
Interest
($)
Average
rate
(%)
Average
balance
($)
Interest
($)
Average
rate
(%)
Average
balance
($)
Interest
($)
Average
rate
(%)
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks and short-term investments
 
1,752.9
 
 
5.4
 
 
0.31
%
 
1,794.7
 
 
5.4
 
 
0.30
%
 
1,494.4
 
 
5.1
 
 
0.34
%
Investment in securities
 
2,877.8
 
 
67.7
 
 
2.35
%
 
2,655.3
 
 
60.9
 
 
2.29
%
 
2,455.9
 
 
48.6
 
 
1.98
%
Loans
 
4,075.0
 
 
192.0
 
 
4.71
%
 
4,022.9
 
 
187.0
 
 
4.65
%
 
4,022.6
 
 
190.6
 
 
4.74
%
Interest earning assets
 
8,705.7
 
 
265.1
 
 
3.05
%
 
8,472.9
 
 
253.3
 
 
2.99
%
 
7,972.9
 
 
244.3
 
 
3.06
%
Other assets
 
410.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
413.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
474.2
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
 
9,116.5
 
 
265.1
 
 
2.91
%
 
8,886.6
 
 
253.3
 
 
2.85
%
 
8,447.1
 
 
244.3
 
 
2.89
%
Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
 
6,741.6
 
 
(20.9
)
 
(0.31
)%
 
6,559.5
 
 
(20.0
)
 
(0.30
)%
 
6,205.7
 
 
(21.4
)
 
(0.34
)%
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase
 
22.0
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.38
)%
 
63.8
 
 
(0.2
)
 
(0.38
)%
 
1.3
 
 
 
 
(1.38
)%
Long-term debt
 
117.2
 
 
(5.6
)
 
(4.80
)%
 
228.7
 
 
(9.2
)
 
(4.02
)%
 
261.3
 
 
(12.6
)
 
(4.81
)%
Interest bearing liabilities
 
6,880.8
 
 
(26.6
)
 
(0.39
)%
 
6,852.0
 
 
(29.4
)
 
(0.43
)%
 
6,468.4
 
 
(34.0
)
 
(0.53
)%
Non-interest bearing current accounts
 
1,211.0
 
 
 
 
 
 
990.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
974.3
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
 
187.2
 
 
 
 
 
 
198.0
 
 
 
 
 
 
205.6
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities
 
8,279.0
 
 
(26.6
)
 
(0.32
)%
 
8,040.7
 
 
(29.4
)
 
(0.37
)%
 
7,648.3
 
 
(34.0
)
 
(0.44
)%
Shareholders’ equity
 
837.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
845.9
 
 
 
 
 
 
798.8
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 
9,116.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
8,886.6
 
 
 
 
 
 
8,447.1
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest-bearing funds net of non-interest earning assets (free balance)
 
1,824.9
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,620.9
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,504.6
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest margin
 
 
 
 
238.5
 
 
2.74
%
 
 
 
 
223.9
 
 
2.64
%
 
 
 
 
210.4
 
 
2.63
%

25

TABLE OF CONTENTS

RISK FACTORS

Investing in the common shares involves a significant degree of risk. The material risks and uncertainties that management believes affect us are described below. Before investing in the common shares, you should carefully consider the risks and uncertainties described below in addition to the other information contained in this prospectus. Any of the following risks, as well as risks that we do not know or currently deem immaterial, could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations. As a result, the trading price of the common shares could decline, and you could lose some or all of your investment. Further, the risk factors below include cautionary statements identifying important factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed in any forward-looking statements made by us or on our behalf. See “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements”.

Risks Relating to Financial Conditions, Market Environment and General Economic Trends

Adverse economic and market conditions, in particular in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, have in the past resulted in and could in the future result in lower revenue, lower asset quality, increased provisions and lower earnings.

Our financial performance generally, and in particular the ability of our borrowers to pay interest on and repay principal on outstanding loans and the value for the collateral securing those loans, as well as demand for loans and other products and services we offer and whose success we rely on to drive our future growth, is highly dependent upon the business environment in the markets in which we operate. Unlike larger banks that are more diversified, we provide banking and wealth management services mainly to customers in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands. A downturn in the markets in which we operate, in particular in Bermuda or the Cayman Islands, can have a profound impact on our business performance. Some elements of the business environment that affect our financial performance include short-term and long-term interest rates, any downgrade in sovereign credit ratings (such as the recent downgrade in Bermuda's sovereign rating), the prevailing yield curve, inflation and price levels, monetary policy, regulatory changes or changes in enforcement thereof, unemployment, investor or business confidence, natural or man-made disasters, the strength of the local economy in the markets in which we operate or a combination of these or other factors. Unfavorable market conditions can result in a deterioration in the credit quality of our borrowers and the demand for our products and services, an increase in the number of loan delinquencies, defaults and charge-offs, additional provisions for loan losses, decreases in asset values, deterioration in investment performance and an overall material adverse effect on the quality of our loan portfolio.

Unlike geographically more diversified banks, our business is concentrated primarily in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, and we may be more affected by a downturn in these markets than more diversified competitors.

Our banking operations are concentrated in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, and serve local customers in these markets. In the year ended December 31, 2016, 57% of our total net revenue before provision for credit losses and other gains/losses was derived from our Bermuda segment and 30% of our total net revenue was derived from our Cayman Islands segment. In addition, in the year ended December 31, 2016, approximately $2 billion, or 59%, of our loans originated in Bermuda and approximately $1 billion, or 20%, of our loans originated in the Cayman Islands. Accordingly, a downturn in these markets may have a profound effect on our banking business. Because Bermuda and the Cayman Islands do not have well-diversified economies, a downturn in their key industries could affect their economies as a whole and have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations. In addition, we have sought to expand our existing trust business line, including through recent acquisitions. Any reduction in demand for trust services in our Bermuda and Cayman Islands segments, due to perceived reputational risks, increasing regulatory scrutiny over activities in these jurisdictions or otherwise, may adversely impact our business and results of operations, including the ongoing success of any of our acquired trust business.

In particular, Bermuda and the Cayman Islands are international business centers in part due to their favorable tax treatment of entities and their political and economic stability. Bermuda is among the largest reinsurance markets, and the Cayman Islands is a leader in fund domiciliation for global asset managers,

26

TABLE OF CONTENTS

with 10,586 regulated mutual funds as of December 31, 2016 according to CIMA. These industries are key contributors to the Bermuda and the Cayman Islands economies. As a result, a downturn in these sectors or a shift of business away from Bermuda or the Cayman Islands could result in job losses and harm the economies in these markets. Many of our commercial customers are reinsurance or regulated fund service providers. Accordingly, any downturn or further concentration in the reinsurance market could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. See “— Regulatory and Tax-Related Risks — Changes in US tax laws could cause the insurance and reinsurance industry to relocate from Bermuda, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations”.

In addition, changes in legislation and regulation or an attempt by Bermuda to declare independence from the United Kingdom (“UK”) or to implement changes in its constitution, including its fiscal and monetary policies, could have a negative effect on Bermuda's position as an international business center and Bermuda-based companies could move from Bermuda. This could have a significant negative effect on the local economy and in turn negatively affect our business.

Tourism is another major contributor to the economies of both Bermuda and the Cayman Islands. In 2015, travel and tourism contributed 14.2% of GDP in Bermuda and 28.9% of GDP in the Cayman Islands. The deterioration of the tourism industry could decrease the value of hotels and other commercial properties, which could adversely affect our commercial loan portfolio. A decline in tourism could similarly result in an increase in unemployment, which could affect the ability of our residential borrowers to make payments on their loans. Accordingly, a decline in tourism in either Bermuda or the Cayman Islands could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

A decline in the residential real estate market, in particular in Bermuda, could increase the risk of loans being impaired and could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

We are exposed to the risk that our borrowers may not repay their loans according to their contractual terms and that the collateral securing the payment of these loans may be insufficient. As of December 31, 2016, approximately 62.1% of our Bermuda loan portfolio, net of allowance for credit losses, was comprised of residential mortgages in Bermuda and approximately 67.9% of our loan portfolio in our remaining jurisdictions was comprised of residential mortgages. A decline in the real estate market, in particular in Bermuda, would mean that the collateral for our loans would hold less value. As a result, our ability to recover on defaulted loans by selling the underlying real estate would be diminished, and we would be more likely to suffer losses on the defaulted loans. Declines in the real estate market could also adversely affect demand for new loans, further decreasing the interest revenue generated by our loan portfolio. This may lead to impairment charges on loans and other assets, higher costs and incurred loan-loss provisions. In addition, if our estimate for our allowance for credit losses proves to be incorrect and our allowance is inadequate, we will have to increase the allowance accordingly.

These risks may be compounded due to the fact that there is no available economic and statistical data regarding the Bermuda, The Bahamas and the Cayman Islands real estate markets. Although reliable and comprehensive economic and statistical data is available for certain real estate markets, such as the Case-Schiller Home Price Index in the United States, there is no comparable statistical data or mechanism to value the overall real estate market in Bermuda, The Bahamas or the Cayman Islands. This lack of information makes it difficult to assess the market value of real estate in these markets, and requires us to rely on observations of the valuation of our own real estate originations in order to assess whether the value of mortgaged real estate has declined.

Any of the above factors could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

In addition, following the 2008 financial crisis, the Bermuda economy experienced consecutive years of negative GDP growth. International business activity declined from 2009 to 2011, with modest annual growth from 2012 onwards. In 2015, the Bermuda economy's GDP was nominally positive and various local economic measures appeared to have stabilized. The impact of the 2008 financial crisis and the

27

TABLE OF CONTENTS

resulting decline in international business on employment, population levels and real estate values was negative for several years, with recent apparent stability observed in terms of economic activity and stabilized real estate values. The Bermuda economy's ability to sustain or improve on this recent apparent economic stability is uncertain.

The value of the securities in our investment portfolio may decline in the future.

As of December 31, 2016, we owned $4.4 billion of investment securities consisting primarily of securities issued by the US government and US governmental agencies. In 2016, our investment portfolio had an average yield of 1.95%.

The fair value of our investment securities may be adversely affected by market conditions, including changes in interest rates, and the occurrence of any events adversely affecting the issuer of particular securities in our investment portfolio. We perform periodic reviews to determine if an other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) has occurred. Our Asset and Liability Policy Committee reviews the results of impairment analyses and advises whether an OTTI exists. The process for determining whether an impairment is other-than-temporary usually requires complex, subjective judgments about the future financial performance of the issuer of the relevant security in order to assess the probability of receiving all contractual principal and interest payments on the security.

We did not record any OTTI losses on investments in the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015. However, in prior periods we have experienced higher OTTI on investments, in particular as a result of investments in structured securities. See “— We depend primarily on deposits to fund our liquidity needs; if we are unable to effectively manage our liquidity across the jurisdictions in which we operate, our business, financial condition or results of operations could be adversely affected”.

We may be required to recognize OTTI in future periods, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

Fluctuations in interest rates and inflation may negatively impact our net interest margin and our profitability.

Net interest income is a significant component of our revenues and changes in prevailing interest rates may adversely affect our business, including the level of net interest income we earn, and for our banking business, the levels of deposits and the demand for loans. The low interest rate environment following the global financial crisis has led to changes in savings rates and continues to shift the interest of savers away from low-rate retail bank deposits.

If interest rates increase, our net interest income would narrow if our cost of funding increased without a correlative increase in the interest we earn from loans and investments. Because we rely extensively on deposits to fund our operations, our cost of funding would increase if there is an increase in the interest rate we are required to pay our customers to retain their deposits. This could occur, for instance, if we are faced with competitive or regulatory pressures to increase rates on deposits. In addition, if the interest rates we are required to pay for other sources of funding increases, our cost of funding would increase. Moreover, increases in interest rates may decrease customer demand for loans as the higher cost of obtaining credit may deter customers from seeking new loans. Further, higher interest rates might also lead to an increased number of delinquent loans and defaults, which would affect the value of our loans.

Changes in interest rates may negatively affect the value of our assets and our ability to realize gains or avoid losses from the sale of those assets, all of which also ultimately affect earnings and capital, as well as our regulatory solvency position. A sustained increase in the inflation rate in our principal markets may also have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations. For example, a sustained increase in the inflation rate may result in an increase in nominal market interest rates. A failure to accurately anticipate higher inflation and factor it into our product-pricing assumptions may result in mispricing of our products, which could adversely affect our business, financial position or results of operations. On the other hand, recent concerns regarding negative interest rates and the low level of interest rates generally may negatively impact our net interest income, which may have an adverse impact on our profitability.

28

TABLE OF CONTENTS

We depend primarily on deposits to fund our liquidity needs; if we are unable to effectively manage our liquidity across the jurisdictions in which we operate, our business, financial condition or results of operations could be adversely affected.

We need liquidity to pay our operating expenses, interest on our debt and dividends on our capital stock, and to replace certain maturing liabilities. Without sufficient liquidity, we will be forced to curtail our operations and our business will suffer.

Our main source of funding is customer deposits. As of December 31, 2016, we had $10.0 billion in customer deposits (67% USD deposits, 18% USD-pegged deposits), with 58% of our deposits derived from our Bermuda segment and 29% of our deposits derived from the Cayman Islands segment, with the balance derived from Guernsey and The Bahamas. In addition, we source our funding from shareholders' equity, and to a lesser extent from other sources including the sale of securities to institutional counterparties under repurchase agreements and the sale of trading and AFS securities. Our deposit base includes both demand and term liabilities, but the significant majority of such deposits are demand deposits or are due within six months. Because we rely primarily on short-term deposits for funding, a sudden or unexpected shortage of funds in the banking systems in which we operate may prevent us from obtaining necessary funding without incurring higher costs. Our deposit base includes deposits from commercial and institutional clients which may be more sensitive to financial strength rating changes. A significant withdrawal of deposits in either of these markets could significantly affect our liquidity and our ability to meet our funding needs.

In addition, as a bank with subsidiaries located outside of Bermuda, access to inter-company funds can be restricted because our regulated banking subsidiaries are required to maintain certain liquidity ratios or minimum levels of capital in accordance with the laws of the jurisdictions in which they operate or otherwise. The necessity of maintaining these ratios or levels of capital or other liquidity considerations could restrict the ability of these subsidiaries to transfer funds to us, in the form of cash dividends, loans or advances. Recently, our subsidiaries' ability to upstream funds from certain jurisdictions has been increasingly restricted due to changes in the business and regulatory environments in such jurisdictions.

In the event that our current resources do not satisfy our needs, we may need to seek additional financing. The availability of additional financing will depend on a variety of factors, such as market conditions, the general availability of credit, the volume of trading activities, the overall availability of credit to the financial services industry, our credit ratings and credit capacity, as well as the possibility that customers or lenders could develop a negative perception of our long- or short-term financial prospects. For example, in the course of the global financial crisis, we realized significant losses attributable to write-downs on investments in structured assets made prior to mid-2007 and required a significant amount of new capital to ensure sufficient liquidity and restore our capital structure. In 2009, the Government of Bermuda provided assistance to us in raising private sector capital by issuing a full and unconditional guarantee to support our $200 million issuance of preference shares. See “Supervision and Regulation — Bermuda — Supervision and Monitoring by the BMA”. In addition, we raised an additional $550 million of new capital from a group of investors that included The Carlyle Group and CIBC and undertook a $130 million rights offering. See “Description of Share Capital”.

Although the Government of Bermuda supported us in 2009, there is no central bank or similar governmental agency in Bermuda from which we may borrow US or Bermuda Dollars if we experience liquidity shortages. In addition, a number of the other jurisdictions in which we operate, including the Cayman Islands and Guernsey, do not have a central bank either. Accordingly, we may not have a lender of last resort in case of future liquidity shortages. See “— Banks domiciled in Bermuda, including us, are not supported by a central bank from which to borrow funds, so if we are unable to maintain sufficient liquidity by continuously attracting deposits and other short-term funding, our financial condition, including our capital ratios, funding costs or results of operations could be adversely affected”.

Banks domiciled in Bermuda, including us, are not supported by a central bank from which to borrow funds, so if we are unable to maintain sufficient liquidity by continuously attracting deposits and other short-term funding, our financial condition, including our capital ratios, funding costs or results of operations could be adversely affected.

Unlike many other jurisdictions, there is no central bank or similar governmental agency in Bermuda from which we may borrow US or Bermuda Dollars if we experience liquidity shortages, which may leave

29

TABLE OF CONTENTS

us without a lender of last resort in the event that Bermuda suffers a severe economic downturn at the same time as a liquidity shortage. Similarly, there is no central bank in the Cayman Islands or Guernsey to act as a lender of last resort. We may therefore be unable to sufficiently fund our liquidity needs. While there is no central bank or similar governmental agency in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands or Guernsey that insures bank deposits, such as the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation in the United States, the Government of Bermuda has implemented a Deposit Insurance Scheme. See “Supervision and Regulation” and “— The Government of Bermuda has implemented a Deposit Insurance Scheme and we will incur additional costs”. Without a central bank from which we could borrow funds, liquidity management will be critical to the management of our consolidated balance sheet, and an inability to obtain sufficient liquidity could adversely affect our financial condition.

The Government of Bermuda has implemented a Deposit Insurance Scheme and we will incur additional costs.

Pursuant to the Deposit Insurance Act 2011 and the Deposit Insurance Rules 2016 of Bermuda, a Deposit Insurance Scheme (“DIS”) has come into effect in Bermuda. The DIS is administered by the Bermuda Deposit Insurance Corporation. The DIS is designed to protect the deposits of individuals, charities, unincorporated associations, partnerships, sole proprietors and small businesses by guaranteeing up to $25,000 of their aggregate Bermuda Dollar deposits in the event of a Bermuda deposit taking institution’s failure. The DIS is backed by a Deposit Insurance Fund which is in turn funded from premium contributions that are payable by all banks and credit unions licensed by the BMA. As a bank licensed by the BMA, we are required to be a member of the DIS and pay contributions to the Deposit Insurance Fund. Currently, our premium contribution is calculated by the Bermuda Deposit Insurance Corporation as 0.25% per annum of the average total amount of our Bermuda Dollar deposits that are covered by the DIS guarantee over a rolling three month period, with our initial contribution backdated to July 1, 2016. Each contribution to the Deposit Insurance Fund (including the initial contribution) is payable every three months in arrears. The amount of the contribution we are liable to pay may change from time to time as the total level of our insured Bermuda Dollar deposits changes; in addition there is no guarantee that the current rate of premium contributions charged by the Bermuda Deposit Insurance Corporation will stay the same and not increase or that the Bermuda Deposit Insurance Corporation will not require additional contributions in the event that the Deposit Insurance Fund is insufficient to pay compensation due to insured depositors. We may also not be able to recover our contributions to the Deposit Insurance Fund from any failed institution whose insured depositors receive payments from the Deposit Insurance Fund. Any contributions we are required to make as part of the DIS (and any associated costs) are a cost to our business, and such costs, including any future increases, may have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

We could be negatively affected if the soundness of other financial institutions and counterparties deteriorates or if such counterparties, including clearing houses, are unwilling to do business with us, in particular in respect of US Dollar transactions.

Given the high level of interdependence between financial institutions, we are and will continue to be subject to the risk of actual or perceived deterioration in the commercial and financial soundness of other financial services institutions. Within the financial services industry, the default by any one institution could lead to defaults by other institutions. Concerns about, or a default by, one institution could lead to significant liquidity problems, losses or defaults by other institutions, because the commercial and financial soundness of many financial institutions may be closely related as a result of their credit, trading, clearing or other relationships. Even the perceived lack of creditworthiness of, or questions about, a financial institution may lead to market-wide liquidity problems and losses or defaults by us or by other institutions. This risk is sometimes referred to as “systemic risk” or “contagion” and may adversely affect financial intermediaries, such as clearing agencies, clearing houses and banks with whom we interact on a daily basis. In particular, Bank of New York Mellon (“BNYM”) and Wells Fargo act as clearing houses for all our US Dollar transactions. If BNYM's or Wells Fargo's ability to act as our clearing houses becomes impaired or BNYM or Wells Fargo cease to act as our clearing houses for any other reason and other financial institutions are not willing to provide the services currently provided to us by BNYM and Wells Fargo, we could lose our ability to engage in US Dollar transactions, which could lead to severe disruptions in our operations and adversely impact our business, financial condition or results of operations.

30

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Our operations are reliant on effective implementation and use of technology and require us to adapt to new technologies, and a breach, interruption or failure of our technology services or the inability to effectively integrate new technologies could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

We rely heavily on communications and information systems to conduct business in the banking industry. In particular, we rely on technology to provide key components of our information system infrastructure, including loan, deposit and general ledger processing, risk management information collection and processing for internal control purposes, Internet connections and network access. Any disruption in service of these key components, due to a natural catastrophe, or the termination of any third-party software licenses upon which any of these systems is based, could adversely affect our ability to effectively deliver products and services to clients, to detect, assess and manage risk and otherwise to conduct operations. See “— We rely on third parties to provide services that are integral to our ordinary course operations, and their failure to perform in a satisfactory manner could negatively affect us”. Furthermore, any security breach, due to computer viruses, programming or human errors or other events or developments, of information systems or data, whether managed by us or third parties, could interrupt our business, harm our reputation or cause a decrease in the number of clients using our services. The financial services industry is continually undergoing rapid technological change with frequent introductions of new, technology-driven products and services. The effective use of technology increases efficiency and enables financial institutions to better serve customers and to reduce costs. We have continually invested in upgrades to our core banking systems in our two largest markets (Bermuda and the Cayman Islands), made upgrades in Guernsey and the UK, and introduced mobile banking in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands. However, we face the risk of having to establish and maintain further improved technological capabilities, and our future success depends, in part, on an ability to recognize and implement new technologies to address our operational and internal control needs and to meet the demands of our clients. See “— Cyber-attacks, distributed denial of service attacks and other cyber-security matters, if successful, could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations”.

Many of our competitors have substantially greater resources to invest in technological improvements than we do. We may not be able to effectively implement new, technology-driven products and services or be successful in marketing these products and services to our customers. In addition, the implementation of technological changes and upgrades to maintain current systems and integrate new ones may also cause service interruptions, transaction processing errors and system conversion delays and may cause us to fail to comply with applicable laws. Failure to successfully keep pace with technological change affecting the financial services industry and avoid interruptions, errors and delays could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

We face competition in all aspects of our business, and may not be able to attract and retain wealth management, trust and banking clients at current levels.

We compete, both domestically and internationally, with a broad range of financial institutions. Many of our competitors are larger and have broader ranges of product and service offerings, increased access to capital, greater efficiency and pricing power. We face competition from other domestic and foreign lending institutions and from numerous other providers of financial services, including the following:

Non-banking financial institutions. The ability of these institutions to offer services previously limited to commercial banks has intensified competition. Because non-banking financial institutions are not subject to the same regulatory restrictions as banks, they can often operate with greater flexibility and lower cost structures; and
Competitors that have greater financial resources. Some of our larger competitors, including certain international banks that have a significant presence in our market area, may have greater capital and resources, higher lending limits and may offer products, services and technology that we do not. We cannot predict the reaction of our customers and other third parties with respect to our financial or commercial strength relative to our competition, including our larger competitors.

In our banking business, we face competition mainly from other local banks, such as Bermuda Commercial Bank and Clarien Bank in Bermuda and from Cayman National in the Cayman Islands, as

31

TABLE OF CONTENTS

well as from subsidiaries of international banks, RBC in the Cayman Islands and HSBC in Bermuda, whom we view as our most significant competitors. In our wealth management business line, we face competition from local competitors as well as much larger financial institutions including financial institutions that are not based in the markets in which we operate. Revenues from the trust and wealth management business depend in large part on the level of assets under management, and larger international banks may have higher levels of assets under management.

In our trust business line, we face competition primarily from other specialized trust service providers. There are approximately 500 trust companies in the main international financial centers, and many of our competitors in this sector offer fund administration and corporate services work alongside private client fiduciary services.

Our ability to successfully attract and retain trust, wealth management and banking clients is dependent upon our ability to compete with competitors' investment products, retail products and services, level of investment performance, client services and marketing and distribution capabilities. If we are not successful, our business, financial condition or results of operations may be adversely affected.

We may expand our business through acquisitions of, or investments in, other companies or new products and services, but we may not be able to achieve regulatory approval for such transactions or be able to achieve the anticipated cost savings, growth opportunities and other benefits anticipated from such transactions.

We completed two acquisitions in 2014: the acquisition of the Legis trust business in Guernsey and the acquisition of parts of HSBC Cayman in the Cayman Islands. Additionally, in April 2016, we completed the acquisition of Bermuda Trust Company Limited, and the investment management operations of HSBC Bank Bermuda Limited, as well as transactions in connection with a referral agreement with HSBC Bank Bermuda Limited for HSBC Bank Bermuda Limited to refer its existing private banking clients to us. Our long-term growth strategy includes identifying and effecting selective acquisitions in our core geographies, but we cannot be sure that we will be able to identify suitable acquisition candidates or investment opportunities. Even if we identify suitable targets, we cannot be sure that we will be able to obtain the necessary funding on acceptable terms, if at all, to finance any of those potential acquisitions or investments.

We may also be required to obtain the BMA’s approval prior to any potential acquisition or investment and, depending on the transaction, may require other regulatory approval. Regulators consider a number of factors when determining whether to approve a proposed transaction, and we may have difficulty obtaining the necessary regulatory approvals, government permits or licenses required for such acquisitions. We may fail to pursue, evaluate or complete strategic and competitively significant business opportunities as a result of our inability, or our perceived inability, to obtain any required regulatory approvals in a timely manner or at all.

Even where we are able to complete an acquisition or an investment, we cannot be sure that such acquired entity, business or asset or such investment will perform in line with our assumptions or expectations or otherwise complement our business or strategy.

Furthermore, future acquisitions could divert management's time and focus from operating the existing business, and there are no guarantees that our strategic growth initiatives will yield the expected returns. In addition, integrating an acquired company, business or technology is risky and could result in unforeseen operating difficulties and expenditures including, among other things:

the incorporation of new technologies into our existing business infrastructure;
the maintenance of standards, controls, procedures and policies throughout the organization (including effective internal controls over financial reporting and disclosure controls and procedures);
the consolidation of our corporate or administrative functions;
the coordination of our sales and marketing functions to incorporate the new business or technology;
the potential for liabilities and claims arising out of the acquired businesses;

32

TABLE OF CONTENTS

the maintenance of morale, retention and integration of key employees to support the new business or technology and management of our expansion in capacity; and
compliance with the regulatory schemes of newly entered jurisdictions.

In addition, a significant portion of the purchase price of companies that we may acquire may be allocated to goodwill and other intangible assets. Intangible assets are tested for impairment annually or when there is a triggering event requiring such testing; an intangible asset that is subject to amortization is periodically reviewed for impairment. Goodwill is tested for impairment on an annual basis. As of December 31, 2016, we had $61.9 million of goodwill and intangible assets. In the future, if our acquisitions do not yield expected returns or there are changes in discount rates, we may be required to take additional charges to our earnings based on the impairment assessment process, which could harm our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects.

We rely on our reputation and the appeal of our brand to our customers. Any damage to our reputation and appeal could harm us and our business prospects.

The success of our strategy relies significantly on our reputation and the reputation of our senior management, and on our customers and key introducers associating our brand with meeting customer needs and delivering value to those customers.

As a bank operating offshore, including in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, we are subject to increasing scrutiny with respect to potential or alleged legal and regulatory breaches and unethical behavior and associated reputational risks. Any circumstance that causes real or perceived damage to our brand or reputation, or offshore banking or wealth management generally, may negatively affect our relationships with our customers and key introducers, which would have an adverse effect on our business, financial conditions or results of operations.

Potential reputational issues include, but are not limited to:

breaching or facing allegations of having breached legal and regulatory requirements (including, but not limited to, conduct requirements, money laundering, anti-terrorism financing requirements, laws against assisting in tax evasion and data protection laws);
acting or facing allegations of having acted unethically (including having adopted inappropriate sales and trading practices);
failing or facing allegations of having failed to maintain appropriate standards of customer privacy, customer service and record-keeping;
failing to appropriately address potential conflicts of interest;
experiencing technology failures that impact customer services and accounts;
failing to properly identify legal, reputational, credit, liquidity and market risks inherent in products offered; and
changing the terms of our product offerings and pricing that may result in outcomes for customers that are unfair or perceived to be unfair.

A failure to address the above or any other relevant issues appropriately could make customers unwilling to do business with us, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations and could damage our relationships with our employees and regulators.

The appraisals and other valuation techniques we use in evaluating and monitoring loans secured by real property may not accurately describe the net value of the collateral that we can realize.

In considering whether to make a loan secured by real property, we generally require an appraisal of the property. However, an appraisal is only an estimate of the value of the property at the time the appraisal is made, and, as real estate values may change significantly in relatively short periods of time (especially in periods of heightened economic uncertainty), this estimate may not accurately describe the net value of the real property collateral after the loan is made. As a result, we may not be able to realize the full amount of any remaining indebtedness when we foreclose on and sell the relevant property. In

33

TABLE OF CONTENTS

addition, we rely on appraisals and other valuation techniques to establish the value of our other-real-estate-owned portfolio (“OREO”) and to determine certain loan impairments. If any of these valuations is inaccurate, our consolidated financial statements may not reflect the correct value of our OREO, and our allowance for credit losses may not reflect accurate loan impairments. This could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

The Bank's credit ratings have a direct effect on its competitive position, and declines in the Bank's ratings would increase the cost of borrowing funds and make our ability to raise new funds, attract and retain deposits or renew maturing debt more difficult, which may negatively affect long-term and short-term funding.

The Bank's financial strength ratings are an important component of its liquidity profile and competitive position. On an ongoing basis, nationally recognized statistical rating organizations (“NRSROs”) review the financial performance and condition of banks and may downgrade or change the outlook on a bank's ratings due to, for example: a change in a bank's regulatory capital ratios; a change in an NRSRO's determination of the amount of capital cushion required to maintain a particular rating; an increase in the perceived risk of a bank's investment portfolio; reduced confidence in management; or other considerations that may or may not be under our control. The Bank has credit ratings from Standard & Poor's (“S&P”), Moody's Investor Service (“Moody's”) and Fitch Ratings (“Fitch”). Each of the rating agencies reviews its ratings and rating methodologies on a recurring basis and may decide on a downgrade at any time. The Bank's ratings as of December 31, 2016 are shown in the table below:

 
Ratings
 
Fitch
Moody's
S&P
Long-term issuer
BBB
A3
BBB
Short-term issuer
F2
P-2
A-2
Subordinated debt
BB+
Baa1
 
Long-term counterparty risk assessment
 
A3
 
Short-term counterparty risk assessment
 
P-2
 

A downgrade in our credit ratings could adversely affect clients' perception of us and our ability to compete successfully in the marketplace for deposits (or result in the withdrawal of deposits). A downgrade in our short-term debt ratings will affect our short-term funding capabilities. The Bank does not currently access debt markets on an active basis and has only limited historical subordinated debt which is not expected to be affected by rating changes. As a result, the impact of a one-notch downgrade in credit ratings is currently not likely to have a direct impact on funding programs, activities, borrowing capacity or borrowing costs. In addition, there has been no measurable correlation or effect on deposit levels during previous downgrades and, as a result, historically, no material impacts on the Bank's operations or results.

Negative changes in the Bank's long-term deposit ratings would also likely increase the cost of raising long-term funding in the capital markets or of borrowing funds. Even where we can access the capital markets, negative changes in our ratings could affect our share price and make any equity offerings more difficult and dilutive to current shareholders, further driving down the Bank's share price. Our ability to replace maturing or existing debt may be more difficult and expensive. In addition, our lenders and counterparties in derivative transactions are sensitive to the risk of a ratings downgrade.

On June 7, 2016, Moody's downgraded our then-existing government-backed preferred stock rating from A1 (hyb) to A2 (hyb), and our long-term and short-term counterparty risk rating from A2 to A3 and Prime-1 to Prime-2, respectively. Moody's stated that the downgrade of our government-backed preferred stock rating was the result of the downgrade of the government bond rating of the Government of Bermuda, the guarantor of our preferred shares. Our counterparty risk assessments were also downgraded as a result of the Government of Bermuda's weaker creditworthiness. While to date the impact of these downgrades has not materially affected our ability to meet future cash or debt needs, the exact effect of these downgrades on our funding capabilities in the future cannot be determined with certainty, as downgrades in other ratings, as described above, could materially impact our funding ability and costs.

34

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Management cannot predict what actions rating agencies may take, or what actions we may take in response to the actions of rating agencies that could adversely affect our business. As with other companies in the financial services industry, our ratings could be downgraded at any time and without any notice by any NRSRO, which could adversely affect our business, financial conditions or results of operations.

We could fail to attract, retain or motivate highly skilled and qualified personnel, including our senior management, other key employees or members of the Board, which could adversely affect our business.

Our ability to implement our strategic plan and our future success depends on our ability to continue to attract, retain and motivate highly skilled and qualified personnel, including our senior management and other key employees and directors, competitively with our peers. The marketplace for skilled personnel is becoming more competitive, which means the cost of hiring, incentivizing and retaining skilled personnel may continue to increase. The failure to attract or retain, including as a result of an untimely death or illness of key personnel, or replace a sufficient number of appropriately skilled and key personnel could place us at a significant competitive disadvantage and prevent us from successfully implementing our strategy, which could impair our ability to implement our strategic plan successfully, achieve our performance targets and otherwise have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

We may also be unable to attract and retain staff due to our locations. Many of our employees are employed in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, which are small markets. To the extent we have needs for employees in these locations, this may be an impediment to attracting and retaining experienced personnel. Further, immigration laws in small markets may impose limitations on attracting experienced personnel.

In addition, governmental scrutiny with respect to matters relating to compensation and other business practices in the financial services industry has increased dramatically in the past several years and has resulted in more aggressive and intense regulatory supervision in certain markets in which we operate. Future legislation or regulation or government views on compensation may result in us altering compensation practices in ways that could adversely affect our ability to attract and retain talented employees.

We rely on third parties to provide services that are integral to our ordinary course operations, and their failure to perform in a satisfactory manner could negatively affect us.

We rely on third parties to provide services that are integral to our ordinary course operations, including providers of information technology, administrative or investment advisory services. For example, we have a contract with Alumina Investment Management LLC (“Alumina”) pursuant to which it provides investment advisory services to us and a contract with Hewlett Packard (“HP”) to supply technology infrastructure and application development management, information security and technical support for our locations in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands. We rely on Alumina to provide investment advisory services in respect of our US treasury and agency portfolio and to provide investment advice. Poor performance on the part of providers of investment advisory services could adversely affect our financial performance. A material breach of customer data, including by HP, may negatively impact our business reputation and cause a loss of customer business; result in increased expense to contain the event and/or require that we provide credit monitoring services for affected customers; result in regulatory fines and sanctions; and/or may result in litigation. We rely on our outsourced service providers to implement and maintain prudent cyber security controls. We have procedures in place to assess a vendor's cyber security controls prior to establishing a contractual relationship and to periodically review assessments of those control systems; however, these procedures are not infallible and a vendor's system can be breached despite the procedures we employ.

In addition, BNYM and Wells Fargo act as clearing houses for all our US Dollar transactions and, if our relationships with BNYM and Wells Fargo are terminated, we could lose our ability to engage in US Dollar transactions. For more information see “— We could be negatively affected if the soundness of other financial institutions and counterparties deteriorates or if such counterparties, including clearing houses, are unwilling to do business with us in particular in respect of US Dollar transactions”.

35

TABLE OF CONTENTS

We may be alleged to have infringed upon intellectual property rights owned by others or may be unable to protect our own intellectual property.

Competitors or other third parties may allege that we, or consultants or other third parties retained or indemnified by us, infringe on their intellectual property rights. Even in instances where we believe that claims and allegations of intellectual property infringement against us are without merit, defending against such claims is time consuming and expensive and could result in the diversion of time and attention of our management and employees. In addition, although in some cases a third party may have agreed to indemnify us for such costs, such indemnifying party may refuse, or be unable, to uphold its contractual obligations.

Moreover, we rely on a variety of measures to protect our intellectual property and proprietary information, including copyrights, trademarks, and controls on access and distribution. These measures may not prevent misappropriation or infringement of our intellectual property or proprietary information and a resulting loss of competitive advantage. In any event, we may be required to litigate to protect our intellectual property and proprietary information from misappropriation or infringement by others, which is expensive and could cause a diversion of resources and may not be successful.

Our insurance coverage may not be adequate to cover all possible losses that we could suffer, and our insurance costs could increase in the future.

Our insurance policies do not cover all types of potential losses and liabilities and are subject to limits and excesses. There can be no assurance that our insurance will be sufficient to cover the full extent of all losses or liabilities for which we are ultimately responsible, which could result in losses being incurred by the Bank. Additionally, we cannot guarantee that we will be able to renew our current insurance policies on favorable terms, or at all.

Cyber-attacks, distributed denial of service attacks and other cyber-security matters, if successful, could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

We are under continuous threat of loss due to cyber-attacks, especially as we continue to expand customer capabilities to utilize the internet and other remote channels to transact business. Two of the most significant cyber-attack risks that we face are e-fraud and loss of sensitive customer data. Loss from e-fraud occurs when cyber-criminals extract funds directly from customers' or our accounts using fraudulent schemes that may include Internet-based funds transfers. Such attacks are infrequent, but could present significant reputational, legal and regulatory costs to us if successful.

We also face risks related to cyber-attacks and other security breaches in connection with credit card transactions that typically involve the transmission of sensitive information regarding our customers through various third parties, including merchant acquiring banks, payment processors, payment card networks (e.g., Visa or MasterCard), our processors, and BNYM and Wells Fargo as clearing banks. Some of these parties have in the past been the target of security breaches and cyber-attacks, and because the transactions involve third parties and environments such as the point of sale that we do not control or secure, future security breaches or cyber-attacks affecting any of these third parties could impact us through no fault of our own, and in some cases we may have exposure and suffer losses for breaches or attacks relating to them. We also rely on numerous other third-party service providers to conduct other aspects of our business operations and face similar risks relating to them.

Recently, there has been a series of distributed denial of service attacks on financial services companies. Distributed denial of service attacks are designed to saturate the targeted online network with excessive amounts of network traffic, resulting in slow response times, or in some cases, causing the site to be temporarily unavailable. Generally, these attacks are conducted to interrupt or suspend a company's access to Internet service. The attacks can adversely affect the performance of a company's website and in some instances prevent customers from accessing a company's website. Potential cyber threats that include hacking and other attempts to breach information technology security controls are rapidly evolving and we may not be able to anticipate or prevent all such attacks. In the event that a cyber-attack is successful, our business, financial condition or results of operations may be adversely affected.

In addition, in April 2016, the Society for Worldwide Interbank Financial Telecommunication (“SWIFT”) announced that one of its member banks was a target of a cyber-attack in February 2016. In

36

TABLE OF CONTENTS

May 2016, SWIFT announced that a second bank was the target of a cyber-attack in May 2016. The SWIFT platform is used by more than 10,000 financial institutions around the world, including us, to effect fund transfers. A cyber-attack on the SWIFT network can result in theft of funds and other adverse consequences, and our business, financial condition or results of operations may be adversely affected in the event that such a cyber-attack is successful.

Severe weather, natural disasters and other external events could disrupt our businesses and adversely affect our financial condition or results of operations.

Our business is concentrated primarily in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands and is therefore subject to the risks associated with severe tropical storms, hurricanes and tornadoes, including downed telephone lines, flooded facilities, power outages, fuel shortages, damaged or destroyed property and equipment, and work interruptions. Such severe weather conditions and natural disasters may negatively impact us and our clients and their ability to meet their financial obligations to us, including the repayment of loans. Such events may also result in an impairment of the value of property or other collateral used to secure the loans that we extend.

In addition, we cannot predict whether we will continue to be able to obtain insurance for hazard-related damages to our premises or, if obtainable and carried, whether this insurance will be adequate to cover our losses. Moreover, we expect any insurance of this nature to be subject to substantial deductibles and to provide for premium adjustments based on claims, and we do not carry insurance against all types of losses. For all these reasons, any future hazard-related costs and work interruptions could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

In addition, we are exposed to risks arising out of geopolitical events, such as trade barriers, exchange controls and other measures taken by sovereign governments, including by the US, that can hinder economic or financial activity levels. Furthermore, unfavorable political, military or diplomatic events, armed conflict, pandemics and terrorist acts and threats, and the responses to them by governments, could also negatively affect economic activity and have an adverse effect upon our business, financial condition or results of operations.

Our controls and procedures may fail or be circumvented, which could have an adverse impact on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

We face the risk that the design of our controls and procedures that govern operations, financial reporting and compliance across jurisdictions, including those to mitigate the risk of human error or fraud by employees or outsiders, or to monitor financial reporting, may be inadequate, circumvented or exposed to variations in compliance at the local level, thereby causing inaccuracies in data and information or delays in the detection of errors. At present, we do not have a uniform core banking platform in place across the jurisdictions in which we operate and, therefore, we need to use manual processes to compile certain financial information from certain subsidiaries. Moreover, in the past, our information technology capabilities in Bermuda and other jurisdictions have experienced difficulties with certain identified weaknesses, including internal control deficiencies in our facilities and operations (including wire transfer and foreign exchange and interest rate calculation functions). To address these weaknesses we resorted to using manual processing, data spreadsheets or a combination thereof. Use of such manual procedures and data spreadsheets presents financial reporting and operational risks and increases the importance of staff compliance with internal operating and security procedures. In addition, we may incur operational losses due to non-compliance by our staff with internal operating and control procedures and arising from human error. Any failure or circumvention of our controls and procedures or failure to comply with any current or future regulations related to controls and procedures could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

Our risk management framework, systems and process, and related guidelines and policies, may prove inadequate to manage our risks, and any failure to properly assess or manage such risks could harm us.

Our approach to risk management requires senior management to make complex judgments, including decisions (based on assumptions about economic factors) about the level and types of risk that we are willing to accept in order to achieve our business objectives. These also include the maximum

37

TABLE OF CONTENTS

level of risks we can assume before breaching constraints determined by regulatory capital and liquidity needs and our regulatory and legal obligations including, among others, from a conduct and prudential perspective. Given these complexities, and the dynamic environment in which we operate, the decisions made by senior management may not be appropriate or yield the results expected. In addition, senior management may be unable to recognize emerging risks for us quickly enough to take appropriate action in a timely manner.

We depend on the accuracy and completeness of information about clients and counterparties.

In deciding whether to extend credit or enter into other transactions with clients and counterparties, we rely on information furnished by or on behalf of clients and counterparties, including financial statements and other financial information. We also may rely on representations of clients and counterparties as to the accuracy and completeness of that information and, with respect to financial statements, on reports of independent auditors. Such information could turn out to be inaccurate, including as a result of fraud or misrepresentation on behalf of our clients, counterparties or other third parties, which would increase our credit risk and expose us to possible write-downs and losses.

We cannot be certain that our underwriting and operational controls will prevent or detect such fraud or that we will not experience fraud losses or incur costs or other losses related to such fraud. Our clients and counterparties may also experience fraud in their businesses which could adversely affect their ability to repay their loans or make use of our services.

During the periods reported in this prospectus, we have not experienced any material losses, or had to write down collateral, as a result of fraud or misrepresentation, but we cannot be certain that the Bank will not experience any such losses or have to write down any such collateral in the future.

Volatility levels and fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates may affect our business, financial position and results of operations.

We are exposed to foreign currency risk as a result of our holdings of foreign currency denominated assets and liabilities, investment in foreign subsidiaries, and future foreign currency denominated revenue and expense. Fluctuations in exchange rates may raise the potential for losses resulting from foreign-currency trading positions, where aggregate obligations to purchase and sell a foreign currency do not offset each other or offset each other in different time periods. In addition, the recent Brexit vote has introduced volatility for the Pound Sterling which may continue in the future. Such volatility may adversely affect our operations that employ the Pound Sterling as the functional currency and materially affect our results of operations. In addition, the outcome of the US presidential election has caused significant volatility for the US dollar, which may continue in the future. Such volatility may have negative impacts on our business, financial position and results of operations.

We also provide foreign exchange services to our clients, including trading on behalf of clients in all major currencies and providing hedging solutions to manage foreign exchange risk. Foreign currency volatility influences the level of client activity. Changes in client activity may result in reduced foreign exchange trading income.

In addition, as a result of an order issued under the Bermuda Monetary Authority Act 1969, since 1981, one Bermuda Dollar is equivalent to one US Dollar. However, we cannot make assurances that this parity will continue. In the event that the Government of Bermuda, pursuant to the Bermuda Monetary Authority Act 1969, issues an order that materially affects the Bermuda Dollar Parity Order 1981, the value of our common shares could be adversely affected. Moreover, our US Dollar deposits are used to fund mortgages in Bermuda Dollars. As the Bermuda Dollar is pegged to the US Dollar at a one-to-one ratio, we do not engage in hedging activities to counteract this currency risk. If the Bermuda Dollar ceased to be pegged to the US Dollar at this ratio, however, we could be exposed to significant currency risks.

Changes in accounting policies and practices, as may be adopted by applicable regulatory agencies or other authoritative bodies, could materially impact our financial statements.

Our accounting policies and methods are fundamental to how we record and report our financial condition and results of operations. From time to time, applicable regulatory agencies and other

38

TABLE OF CONTENTS

authoritative bodies change the financial accounting and reporting standards that govern the preparation of our financial statements. These changes can be difficult to predict and can materially impact how we record and report our financial condition and results of operations.

We are subject to certain litigation, and our expenses related to this litigation could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

We are, from time to time, involved in various legal proceedings arising from our normal business activities. These claims and legal actions, including supervisory actions by our regulators, could involve large monetary claims and significant defense costs. The outcome of these cases is uncertain. Substantial legal liability or significant regulatory action against us could have material financial effects or cause significant reputational harm to us, which in turn could seriously harm our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects. We may be exposed to substantial uninsured liabilities, which could materially affect our results of operations and financial condition.

As previously publicly announced, in November 2013, the US Attorney's Office for the Southern District of New York (the “USAO”) applied for and secured the issuance of so-called John Doe Summonses to six US financial institutions with which the Bank had correspondent bank relationships. The purpose of these Summonses was to identify US persons who may have been using our banking, trust, or other services to evade their own tax obligations in the United States. Although the Bank has been cooperating with the US authorities in their ongoing investigation, we are unable at this point to predict the timing or outcome of the investigation and it is possible that the ultimate resolution of this matter may be material to our financial results. Although we are unable to determine the amount of financial consequences, fines and/or penalties resulting from this tax compliance review, we have recorded as of December 31, 2016, a provision of $5.5 million (December 31, 2015: $4.8 million). As the investigation remains ongoing at this time, the timing and terms of the final resolution, including any fines or penalties, remain uncertain and the financial impact to the Bank could exceed the amount of the provision. In this regard, we note that the US authorities have not approved or commented on the adequacy or reasonableness of the provision.

39

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Regulatory and Tax-Related Risks

We operate in a complex and changing regulatory environment and our legal and regulatory changes could have a negative impact on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

Our business is subject to ongoing changes in laws, regulations, policies, voluntary codes of practice and interpretations in the markets in which we operate. We currently face an increasingly extensive and complex stricter set of laws, regulations and standards as a result of the concerns enveloping the global financial sector. We are exposed to potential changes in governmental or regulatory policies, price controls, capital controls, exchange controls, other restrictive actions, unfavorable political and diplomatic developments and changes in legislation.

Some areas of potential regulatory change involve multiple jurisdictions seeking to adopt a coordinated approach. This may result in conflicts with specific requirements of the jurisdictions in which we operate and, in addition, such changes may be inconsistently introduced across jurisdictions.

Changes may also occur in the oversight approach of regulators. It is possible that governments in jurisdictions in which we operate or obtain funding might revise their application of existing regulatory policies that apply to, or impact, the Bank's business, including for reasons relating to national interest and/or systemic stability. The powers exercisable by our regulators may also be expanded in the future.

Regulatory changes and the timing of their introduction continue to evolve and we manage our businesses in the context of regulatory uncertainty. The nature and impact of future changes are not predictable and are beyond our control. Regulatory compliance and the management of regulatory change are an important part of our planning processes. We expect that we will be required to continue to invest significantly in compliance and the management and implementation of regulatory change and, at the same time, significant management attention and resources will be required to update existing, or implement new, processes to comply with new regulations.

Changes and restrictions imposed by our principal regulator, the BMA, and other regulators may also impact our operations by requiring us to have increased levels of liquidity and higher levels of, and better quality, capital and funding as well as place restrictions on the businesses we conduct (including limiting our ability to provide products and services to certain customers), require us to amend our corporate structure or require us to alter our product or service offerings. If regulatory change has any such effect, it could adversely affect one or more of our businesses, restrict our flexibility, require us to incur substantial costs and impact the profitability of one or more of our business lines. Any such costs or restrictions could adversely affect our business, prospects, financial performance or financial condition.

Effective as of January 1, 2015, the BMA adopted capital and liquidity regulatory requirements consistent with Basel III, a framework released by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision. The finalization of the implementation is subject to ongoing consultation with the BMA regarding the implementation and interpretation of these new rules. Because the Basel III framework is relatively new and the BMA retains certain limited discretions, we cannot guarantee that we will be able to fully comply with any changing requirements. We also cannot predict what effect Bermuda's adoption of Basel III will have on our operations in other jurisdictions, some of which have not yet adopted Basel III and still operate under the Basel II framework. Furthermore, because Basel III can require capital to be held sometimes far in excess of capital required under Basel II, if other jurisdictions in which we operate move to a Basel III framework, we may not be able to meet our total capital adequacy requirements in those jurisdictions, which may lead us to move more capital into a given jurisdiction. We may be subject to heightened regulatory oversight by the BMA or other regulatory bodies in the future. For more information, see “Supervision and Regulation — Bermuda — Supervision and Monitoring by the BMA”.

Our failure or inability to comply fully with the stricter set of laws and regulations could lead to fines, public reprimands, damage to reputation, civil liability, enforced suspension of operations or, in extreme cases, withdrawal of authorization to operate, adversely affecting our business, financial condition or results of operations. We could also be required to incur significant expenses to comply with new or revised regulations. Future developments or changes in laws, regulations, policies, voluntary codes of practice and their effects are expected to require greater capital resources and significant management attention, and may require us to modify our business strategies and plans.

40

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Failure to comply with any applicable anti-corruption legislation could result in fines, criminal penalties and an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

We must comply with all applicable laws and regulations, which include anti-corruption, anti-money laundering and anti-terrorist financing laws and regulations. Recently, there has been a substantial increase in the global enforcement of these laws and regulations, in particular in respect of the financial services industry. The measures and procedures we have in place may not be entirely effective in preventing third parties from using us (and our correspondent banks) as a conduit for money laundering (including illegal cash operations) or terrorist financing without our (and our correspondent banks') knowledge or consent. Although, as of the date of this prospectus, we have not been subject to any fines or penalties, and we believe we have not suffered any material business or reputational harm, as a result of violations of anti-money laundering laws and regulations, there can be no assurances that we will not be subject to such fines, penalties or losses or harm in the future. If we were to be associated with money laundering (including illegal cash operations) or terrorist financing, our reputation could be harmed and we could become subject to fines, sanctions or legal enforcement (including being added to any “blacklists” that would prohibit certain parties, potentially including US Dollar clearing banks, from engaging in transactions with us), which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

Our international business model exposes us to different and possibly conflicting regulatory schemes across multiple jurisdictions.

Our international business model exposes us to different regulatory schemes across multiple jurisdictions. Although our central management and a large part of our business are located in Bermuda, our operations are spread throughout six international jurisdictions. In addition to the logistical and communications challenges this creates, the financial services industry is heavily regulated in many jurisdictions, and each line of the business is exposed to different, constantly evolving and possibly conflicting regulatory schemes. Our management has enacted internal controls and procedures that are designed to result in compliance with these regulatory schemes, which are periodically reviewed and updated, but in the future we might have difficulty meeting and remaining in compliance with existing or new regulatory requirements imposed by a particular jurisdiction, particularly in light of the increasing regulatory scrutiny of financial institutions and their subsidiaries. Our current internal controls for one jurisdiction may not sufficiently comply with the demands of increased oversight in another jurisdiction.

To the extent we are unable to comply with the regulatory scheme of a particular jurisdiction, we might not be able to operate in that jurisdiction, or we may incur fines or penalties for compliance failures or incur costs in order to remediate compliance failures, any or all of which could adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations.

Changes in US tax laws could cause the insurance and reinsurance industry to relocate from Bermuda, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

For several years now, some members of the US Congress have expressed concern about US corporations that move their place of incorporation to low-tax jurisdictions and the competitive advantage that foreign-controlled insurers and reinsurers may have over US-controlled insurers. Recently, various discussion drafts, outlines and legislative proposals that would reform US corporate income tax laws have been proposed by members of the US Congress as well as members of President Trump’s administration, including proposals that would significantly impact how US multinational businesses are taxed on international earnings. We cannot determine whether some or all of these or other proposals will be enacted into law, or what, if any, changes may be made to such proposals prior to being enacted into law. However, the recent legislative proposals have included changes that, if implemented, could make the US more attractive to insurers and reinsurers, and provide significant incentives for insurance and reinsurance companies to relocate to the US from Bermuda. Since the reinsurance industry is a key contributor to the Bermuda economy, a downturn in this sector could result in job losses and harm the economy in Bermuda. As many of our commercial customers are insurance and reinsurance providers, any downturn in the reinsurance market or movement of this industry away from Bermuda could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. See also “Risks Relating to

41

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Financial Conditions, Market Conditions, Market Environment and General Economic Trends — Unlike geographically more diversified banks, our business is concentrated primarily in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, and we may be more affected by a downturn in these markets than more diversified competitors”.

The OECD's review of harmful tax competition could adversely affect our tax status outside Bermuda.

The Organization for Economic Co-operation and Development (the “OECD”) has published reports and launched a global dialogue among member and non-member countries on measures to limit harmful tax competition. These measures are largely directed at counteracting the effects of low or zero tax jurisdictions and preferential tax regimes in countries around the world. According to the OECD, Bermuda is a jurisdiction that has substantially implemented the internationally agreed tax standard and, as such is listed on the OECD “white list.” However, we are not able to predict whether any changes will be made to this classification or whether any such changes will subject us to additional taxes.

We are required to obtain approval from our regulators before engaging in certain activities.

The laws, regulations, policies, voluntary codes of practice and interpretations applicable to us govern a variety of matters, including the permissible activities that we may engage in. As our principal regulator, the BMA requires that we obtain its prior approval before engaging in certain activities, including paying interim dividends on our common shares, entering into material acquisitions or issuing or repurchasing our common shares, and there can be no assurance that any regulatory approvals we may require will be obtained, either in a timely manner or at all. Our regulators have the ability to compel us to, or restrict us from, taking certain actions entirely, such as actions that our regulators deem to constitute an unsafe or unsound banking practice.

Our ability to pay dividends to non-residents of Bermuda and the transfer of our common shares to non-residents of Bermuda could be impaired by Bermuda regulations.

The present policy of Bermuda’s Controller of Foreign Exchange is:

to permit the conversion of Bermuda Dollars for payment of dividends in foreign currency to shareholders who are non-residents of Bermuda for exchange control purposes, provided that all payments are processed through an authorized dealer, including, for this purpose, us; and
to permit the free transferability of equity securities of a Bermuda company for so long as such equity securities of such company are listed on an “appointed stock exchange” appointed by the Minister of Finance under section 2(9) of the Companies Act 1981.

However, if the Controller of Foreign Exchange were to change the foregoing policies, our ability to pay dividends in US Dollars to non-residents of Bermuda for exchange control purposes could be impaired and each transfer of our common shares to or from non-residents of Bermuda for exchange control purposes could require specific approval by the Controller of Foreign Exchange, and the value of your common shares could be adversely affected.

If we are considered to be a passive foreign investment company, such characterization could result in adverse US federal income tax consequences to shareholders that are US investors.

Special adverse US federal income tax rules apply if a US shareholder holds shares of a company that is treated as a passive foreign investment company (“PFIC”), for any taxable year during which the US shareholder held such shares. A foreign corporation will be considered a PFIC for any taxable year in which (1) 75% or more of its gross income is passive income (the “income test”), or (2) 50% or more of the average fair market value of its assets is attributable to assets that produce or are held for the production of passive income (the “asset test”). Passive income for this purpose generally includes dividends, interest, royalties, rents, annuities and gains from assets that produce passive income. If a foreign corporation owns at least 25% (by value) of the stock of another corporation, the foreign corporation is treated, for purposes of the PFIC tests, as owning a proportionate share of the other corporation's assets and receiving its proportionate share of the other corporation's income.

42

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Banks generally derive a substantial part of their income from assets that are interest-bearing or that otherwise could be considered passive under the PFIC rules. The US Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”), has issued a notice, and has proposed regulations, that exclude from passive income any income derived in the active conduct of a banking business by a qualifying foreign bank.

Based upon the proportion of our income derived from activities that are “bona fide” banking activities for US federal income tax purposes, we believe that we were not a PFIC for the taxable year ending December 31, 2016 (the latest period for which the determination can be made) and, based further on our present regulatory status under local laws, the present nature of our activities, and the present composition of our assets and sources of income, we do not expect to be a PFIC for the current year or for any future years. However, because PFIC status is a factual determination and because there are uncertainties in the application of the relevant rules, there can be no assurances that we will not be a PFIC for any particular year. If we were a PFIC in any taxable year during which a US shareholder owns our common shares and the US shareholder does not make a “mark-to-market” election, as discussed under the heading “Certain Taxation Considerations — Material US Federal Income Tax Consequences — US shareholders — Passive Foreign Investment Company Considerations”, or a special “purging election,” we generally would continue to be treated as a PFIC with respect to such US shareholders in all succeeding years, regardless of whether we continue to meet the income or asset test discussed above. US shareholders are urged to consult their own tax advisers with respect to the tax consequences to them if we were to become a PFIC for any taxable year in which they own our common shares.

US withholding tax and information reporting requirements imposed under the Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act may apply.

As discussed below under the heading “Certain Taxation Considerations — Material US Federal Income Tax Consequences — Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act Withholding”, pursuant to the Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act (“FATCA”) enacted in 2010, a 30% withholding tax will be imposed on certain payments to certain non-US financial institutions that fail to comply with certain information-reporting, account identification, withholding, certification and other FATCA-related requirements in respect of their direct and indirect US shareholders and/or US accountholders. To avoid becoming subject to FATCA withholding, we and other financial institutions may be required to report information to the IRS regarding the holders of our common shares and to withhold on a portion of payments under our common shares to certain holders that fail to comply with the relevant information reporting requirements (or that hold our common shares directly or indirectly through certain non-compliant intermediaries). Such withholding would not apply to payments made with respect to common shares before January 1, 2019.

Many countries, including Bermuda, have entered into agreements with the United States (“intergovernmental agreements” or “IGAs”) to facilitate the implementation of FATCA. These IGAs modify the FATCA withholding regime described above. In December 2013, Bermuda entered into a Model 2 IGA with the United States (the “Bermuda IGA”) pursuant to which Bermudian financial institutions are directed by the Bermudian authorities to register with the IRS and to enter into an agreement (an “FFI Agreement”) with the IRS to perform specified due diligence, reporting and withholding functions.

We have registered with the IRS and have entered into an FFI Agreement as required by the Bermuda IGA. However, because the rules for the implementation of FATCA, including IGAs, have not yet been fully finalized, it remains uncertain at this time what impact, if any, this legislation will have on holders of the common shares.

Fulfilling public company financial reporting and other regulatory obligations in the United States is expensive, time-consuming and may strain our resources.

As a public company registered in the United States, we are subject to the reporting requirements of the Exchange Act, and are required to implement specific corporate governance practices and adhere to a variety of reporting requirements under the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (“Sarbanes-Oxley”) and the related rules and regulations of the SEC, as well as the rules of the NYSE. The Exchange Act requires us to file, among other things, annual reports with respect to our business and financial condition. These

43

TABLE OF CONTENTS

additional efforts may strain our resources and divert management's attention from other business concerns, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

The uncertainty resulting from the recent vote by the UK electorate in favor of a UK exit from the EU, as well as the new US presidential administration's policies, could adversely impact our business, financial condition and results of operations.

The United Kingdom’s June 2016 vote to leave the EU (“Brexit”) and the new US presidential administration's present and future policies may generate greater uncertainty and instability in the global financial markets, which could lead to weaker macroeconomic conditions that continue for the foreseeable future. Such economic weakness and uncertainty may adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Brexit could impair our ability to transact business in EU countries, as well as the territories and dependencies of the United Kingdom. We expect that Brexit could lead to legal uncertainty and potentially divergent national laws and regulations as the United Kingdom determines which EU laws to replicate or replace. If the United Kingdom were to significantly alter its regulations affecting the banking industry, we could face significant new costs, particularly as it relates to our banking operations in certain UK territories and dependencies, namely Bermuda, the Cayman Islands and Guernsey. It may also be time-consuming and expensive for us to alter our internal operations in order to comply with new regulations. The long-term financial and legal effects of Brexit will depend in part on any agreements the United Kingdom makes to retain access to EU markets following the United Kingdom's withdrawal from the EU. Although the timetable for UK withdrawal is not at all clear at this stage, it is likely that the process of the withdrawal of the United Kingdom from the EU will take at least two years to be negotiated and concluded.

The new US presidential administration's present and future policies could also lead to increased regulatory uncertainty for our industry and for us. It is unknown at this time to what extent new legislation will be passed into law or pending or new regulatory proposals will be adopted, or the effect that such passage or adoption would have, either positively or negatively, on our industry or on us. If any new legislation and/or regulations are implemented, it may be time-consuming and expensive for us to alter our internal operations in order to comply with such legislation and/or regulations.

44

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Risks Relating to the Common Shares

The value of the common shares may fluctuate significantly.

The value of our common shares may fluctuate significantly as a result of a large number of factors, including, in part, changes in our actual or forecasted operating results and the inability to fulfill the profit expectations of securities analysts, as well as the high volatility in the securities markets generally and more particularly in shares of financial institutions. Prior to our IPO, there had been no public market for our common shares. An active public market for our common shares may not be sustained. If an active public market is not sustained, it may be difficult for you to sell your shares of our common shares at a price that is attractive to you, or at all. The price of our common shares in any such market may be higher or lower than the price that you pay in this offering.

Other factors, beside our financial results, that may impact the price of our common shares include, but are not limited to:

market expectations of the performance and capital adequacy of financial institutions in general;
investor perception of the success and impact of our strategies;
investor perception of our positions and risks;
a downgrade or review of our credit ratings;
potential litigation or regulatory action involving us;
announcements concerning financial problems or any investigations into the accounting practices of other financial institutions; and
general market circumstances.

The market price of the common shares could also be negatively affected by sales of substantial amounts of our common shares in the public markets, including following the expiration of the lock-up restrictions applicable to certain of our shareholders, the members of the Board and senior management, or the perception that these sales could occur.

Holders of our common shares may not receive dividends.

The dividend policy described under “Dividend Policy” should not be construed as a dividend forecast. Our results of operations and financial condition are dependent on our performance. There can be no assurance that we will declare and pay dividends in the future. Any decision to declare and pay dividends in the future will be subject to the prior approval of the BMA and be made at the discretion of the Board. Such dividends shall be declared and paid by the Board only as permitted under applicable law. In determining the amount of any future dividends, factors the Board may take into account include: (1) our financial results; (2) our available cash, as well as anticipated cash requirements (including debt servicing); (3) our capital requirements, including the capital requirements of our subsidiaries; (4) contractual, legal, tax and regulatory restrictions on, and implications of, the declaration and payment of dividends by us to our shareholders; (5) general economic and business conditions; (6) restrictions applicable to the Bank and its subsidiaries under Bermuda and other applicable laws, regulations and policies, including the requirement to obtain the BMA's prior approval for the payment of dividends on our common shares; and (7) any other factors that the Board may deem relevant. Therefore, there can be no assurance that we will declare or pay any dividends to holders of the common shares, or as to the amount of any such dividends.

Our ability to declare and pay dividends may also depend on the level of distributions, if any, received from our operating subsidiaries. Our operating subsidiaries may be precluded from declaring and paying dividends by various factors, such as their own financial condition, or restrictions applicable to us and our subsidiaries under Bermuda and other applicable laws, regulations and policies. The ability of certain of our subsidiaries to upstream funds has been increasingly restricted due to changes in the business and regulatory environments in the jurisdictions in which those subsidiaries operate. In addition, any change in tax treatment of dividends or interest received by us may reduce the level of yield received by our shareholders.

45

TABLE OF CONTENTS

If securities or industry analysts do not actively follow our business, or if they publish unfavorable research about our business, the price and trading volume of our common shares could decline.

The trading market for our common shares depends, in part, on the research and reports that securities or industry analysts publish about us or our business. If analysts do not cover us, the trading price for our common shares may be negatively impacted. If one or more of the analysts who covers us downgrades our common shares or publishes unfavorable research about our business, the price of our common shares would likely decline. If one or more of these analysts ceases coverage of us or fails to publish reports on us regularly, demand for our common shares could decrease, which could cause the price and trading volume of our common shares to decline.

We are an “emerging growth company,” and the reduced reporting requirements applicable to emerging growth companies may make our common shares less attractive to investors.

We are an “emerging growth company,” as defined in the JOBS Act. For so long as we continue to be an emerging growth company, we may take advantage of exemptions from various reporting requirements that are applicable to other public companies that are not emerging growth companies, including, but not limited to, not being required to comply with the auditor attestation requirements of Section 404 of Sarbanes-Oxley, reduced disclosure obligations regarding executive compensation in our periodic reports and proxy statements and exemptions from the requirements of holding a nonbinding advisory vote on executive compensation and shareholder approval of any golden parachute payments not previously approved. We could be an emerging growth company for up to five years from the date of our IPO, although we could lose that status sooner if our gross revenues exceed $1.0 billion, if we issue more than $1.0 billion in nonconvertible debt in a three-year period or if the fair value of our common shares held by nonaffiliates exceeds $700 million as of any June 30 before that time, in which case we would no longer be an emerging growth company as of the following December 31. See “Implications of Being an Emerging Growth Company and a Foreign Private Issuer”. We cannot predict if investors will find our common shares less attractive because we may rely on these exemptions, or if we choose to rely on additional exemptions in the future. If some investors find our common shares less attractive as a result, there may be a less active trading market for our common shares and our share price may be more volatile.

We are a “foreign private issuer” under US securities law. Therefore, we are exempt from certain requirements applicable to US domestic registrants.

Although we are subject to the periodic reporting requirements of the Exchange Act, the periodic disclosure required of foreign private issuers, including us, under the Exchange Act is different from periodic disclosure required of US domestic registrants. Therefore, there may be less publicly available information about us than is regularly published by or about US domestic registrants. We are exempt from certain other sections of the Exchange Act to which US domestic registrants are subject, including the requirement to provide our shareholders with information statements or proxy statements that comply with the Exchange Act. In addition, our insiders and large shareholders are not obligated to file reports under Section 16 of the Exchange Act, and we are not required to comply with certain corporate governance rules imposed by the NYSE applicable to US domestic registrants. See “Implications of Being an Emerging Growth Company and a Foreign Private Issuer”.

Future sales of our shares in the public market could lower the price of our common shares, and any additional capital raised by us through the sale of equity or convertible securities may dilute your ownership.

The market price of our common shares could decline as a result of sales of a large number of our shares available for sale or from the perception that such sales could occur. These sales, or the possibility that these sales may occur, also may make it more difficult for us to raise additional capital by selling equity securities in the future, at a time and price that we deem appropriate.

We had 53,284,872 common shares outstanding as of December 31, 2016. Of these shares, the 12,234,042 common shares sold in our IPO are freely tradable, except for any shares purchased by our “affiliates”, as defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”).

46

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Certain holders of our remaining common shares have agreed with the underwriters in our IPO, subject to certain exceptions, not to dispose of or hedge any of their common shares or securities convertible into or exchangeable for common shares during the 180-day period beginning on September 15, 2016, except with the prior written consent of the representatives of the underwriters in our IPO (and this offering is being made pursuant to such a consent). We, our officers and directors and the selling shareholders will also enter into new lock-up agreements in connection with this offering that will restrict transfers for a period of 75 days following the date of this prospectus, subject to certain exceptions. See “Underwriting”. Upon expiration of the lock-up agreements described above, all of the shares subject to these lock-up agreements will be eligible for resale in a public market, subject, in the case of shares held by our affiliates, to volume, manner of sale and other limitations under Rule 144.

As restrictions on resale end, the market price of our common shares could drop significantly. The timing and manner of the sale of our shareholders' remaining ownership of our common shares remains uncertain, and we have no control over the manner in which our shareholders may seek to divest such remaining common shares. The shareholders could elect to sell their common shares in a number of different ways, including in a number of tranches via future registrations or, alternatively, by the sale of all or a significant tranche of such remaining common shares to a single third-party purchaser. Any such sale would impact the price of the common shares and there can be no guarantee that the price at which the shareholders are willing to sell their remaining common shares will be at a level that the Board would be prepared to recommend to holders of our common shares or that you determine adequately values our common shares.

We cannot predict the size of future issuances or sales of our shares or the effect, if any, that future issuances or sales of our shares may have on the market price of the common shares. Sales or distributions of substantial amounts of our common shares (including shares issued in connection with an acquisition), or the perception that such sales could occur, may cause the market price of the common shares to decline.

Provisions of Bermuda law and our bye-laws could adversely affect your rights as a holder of the common shares or prevent or delay a change in control.

Under the provisions of the Banks and Deposit Companies Act 1999 (“BDCA”), your rights as a holder of common shares could be impaired if you become a shareholder controller, which is defined as a person who, among other things, acquires control of 10% or more of the voting power of our common shares. The BDCA prohibits a person from becoming a shareholder controller of any company licensed under the BDCA unless the person provides written notice to the BMA of his intent to do so and the BMA does not object. The definition of shareholder controller is set out in the BDCA but generally refers to a person who, among other things, either alone or with any associate or associates (within the meaning of the BDCA) (i) holds 10% or more of the shares in the licensed institution or another company of which it is a subsidiary company; or (ii) is entitled to exercise, or control the exercise of, 10% or more of the voting power at any general meeting of the licensed institution or another company of which it is such a subsidiary.

The BDCA distinguishes between shareholder controllers of the following threshold descriptions: “10% shareholder controllers,” “20% shareholder controllers,” “30% shareholder controllers,” “40% shareholder controllers,” “50% shareholder controllers,” “60% shareholder controllers” and “principal shareholder controllers” who have a 75% or greater interest. A person who intends to become a shareholder controller, or a shareholder controller who intends to increase his shareholding/control, meaning generally, ownership of shares or the ability to exercise or control the exercise of voting rights attached to shares, beyond his present threshold, must provide written notice to the BMA that he intends to do so. It is an offense not to give this notice.

The BMA may object to a person's notice of intent to become a shareholder controller of any description or to an existing shareholder controller where it appears to the BMA that, among other things, such person is not or is no longer a fit and proper person to be such a controller of the Bank. Prior to serving a notice of objection, the BMA will serve the person seeking to become a shareholder controller or will serve an existing shareholder controller with a preliminary written notice stating that the BMA is considering service on that person of a notice of objection, stating, among other things, the reasons for the BMA's proposed objection. The statement of the BMA's reasons for their proposed objection will

47

TABLE OF CONTENTS

however, be subject to the BMA's determination that such statement would involve the disclosure of confidential information, the disclosure of which would be prejudicial to a third party. A person served with a preliminary written notice may, within a period of 28 days beginning with the day on which the notice is served, make written representations to the BMA and the BMA shall take any such representations into account in deciding whether to serve a notice of objection.

If three months pass from the date of notifying the BMA of a new shareholder controller or an increased shareholding/control beyond a shareholder controller's then current threshold, without the BMA serving a notice of objection, then the person may become a shareholder controller as requested in the notice. In practice, the BMA's procedure is generally to respond to a person's shareholder controller notification.

If a person becomes a shareholder controller or increases his shareholding/control in spite of the BMA's objection thereto, if a shareholder controller fails to comply with the foregoing notice requirements or if a shareholder controller continues as such after being given notice of objection to his or her being a shareholder controller, the BMA may take the actions specified in the BDCA, including, among other things, revoking the relevant license of the Bank under the BDCA. For more information, see the summaries of relevant provisions of the BDCA regulations under “Supervision and Regulation”.

Further, under the BDCA, any person who becomes a significant shareholder of a deposit-taking institution, which is defined as a person who is not a shareholder controller but who, either individually or with any associate or associates (within the meaning of the BDCA) (i) holds 5% or more of the shares in the licensed institution or another company of which it is a subsidiary company; or (ii) is entitled to exercise, or control the exercise of 5% or more of the voting power of any general meeting of the licensed institution or another company of which it is such a subsidiary, must notify the BMA in writing of that fact within seven days. Failure to provide the BMA with prompt and appropriate notice would make the person guilty of an offense that could result in a fine.

In addition to these restrictions, the provisions of our bye-laws provide that a person who is not “Bermudian” (as such term is defined in the Companies Act) who is “interested” (as such term is defined in the bye-laws) in our shares which constitute more than 40% of all shares then issued and outstanding is not entitled to vote the shares which are in excess of such 40% interest at any general meeting without the prior written approval of the Minister of Finance. See also “Supervision and Regulation”.

Provisions of our bye-laws may also discourage, delay or prevent acquisition of our shares by certain persons or a merger, amalgamation, change of management or other change of control that a shareholder may consider favorable. In addition, these provisions could limit the price that investors might be willing to pay in the future for our common shares. See “— Certain provisions of our bye-laws may have an anti-takeover effect”.

Certain provisions of our bye-laws may have an anti-takeover effect.

There are provisions in our bye-laws that may be used to delay or block a takeover attempt. For example, proposals for an amalgamation, merger, consolidation or sale and other such transactions would require an affirmative vote of not less than two-thirds of all voting rights attached to all issued and outstanding shares unless the proposal received the prior approval of the Board. For a detailed summary of the anti-takeover provisions in our bye-laws, see “Description of Share Capital”. These provisions could discourage, delay or prevent a change in control of the Bank and could adversely impact the value of our common shares.

The issuance of additional shares in connection with future acquisitions, any share incentive or share option plan or otherwise may dilute all other shareholdings.

We may seek to raise capital to fund future acquisitions and other growth opportunities. We may, for these and other purposes, such as in connection with share incentive and share option plans, issue additional equity or convertible securities. Any issuance of additional shares, however, is subject to prior BMA approval, and we cannot guarantee that their approval will be obtained, either in a timely manner or at all. In the event that we are able to and do issue additional shares, existing shareholders could suffer dilution in their percentage ownership.

48

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Our common shares trade on more than one market and this may result in price variations; in addition, investors may not be able to easily move shares for trading between such markets.

Our common shares have traded on the BSX since 1971 and began trading on the NYSE in September 2016. Trading in our common shares on these markets take place in different currencies (US Dollars on the NYSE and Bermuda Dollars on the BSX), and at different times (resulting from different time zones, different trading days and different public holidays in the United States and Bermuda). The trading prices of our common shares on these two markets may differ due to these and other factors. Any decrease in the price of our common shares on the BSX could cause a decrease in the trading price of our common shares on the NYSE. Investors could seek to sell or buy our common shares to take advantage of any price differences between the markets through a practice referred to as arbitrage. Any arbitrage activity could create unexpected volatility in both our share prices on one exchange, and the shares available for trading on the other exchange.

We are a Bermuda company. It may be difficult for you to enforce judgments against us or against our directors and executive officers.

We are incorporated under the laws of Bermuda. As a result, the rights of holders of our shares will be governed by Bermuda law, including the Companies Act 1981, the Butterfield Act and our bye-laws. Our business is based outside of the United States, a majority of our directors and officers reside outside of the United States and a majority of our assets and some or all of the assets of such persons are located outside of the United States. As a result, it may be difficult or impossible to effect service of process on us or our directors and officers in the United States or to enforce in the United States judgments obtained in the United States courts against us or those persons based on the civil liability provisions of the United States securities laws. In addition, it is doubtful whether courts in Bermuda will enforce judgments obtained in other jurisdictions, including the United States, against us or our directors or officers under the securities laws of those jurisdictions or entertain actions in Bermuda against us or our directors or officers under the securities laws of other jurisdictions.

Bermuda law differs from the laws in effect in the United States and might afford less protection to shareholders.

We are a Bermuda-based company. As a result, the rights of holders of our common shares will be governed by Bermuda law, including the Companies Act, the Butterfield Act and our bye-laws. The rights of shareholders under Bermuda law may differ from the rights of shareholders of companies incorporated in other jurisdictions. In particular, under Bermuda law, the duties of directors and officers of a company are generally owed to the company only, and shareholders do not generally have rights to take action against directors or officers of the company. In addition, class actions and derivative actions are generally not available to shareholders under Bermuda law. See “Description of Share Capital — Shareholder Suits”.

Not only are the laws in Bermuda different from, and sometimes incompatible with, laws in the United States, but the processes by which they are established are also different. If you are not familiar with the Bermudian legislative process and the factors and individuals influencing the political environment, you should not make assumptions about the status of various legal and political issues. The status of laws currently in place, and areas not currently governed, are subject to change. Your interests could be adversely affected if significant regulations are added or deleted from Bermuda’s existing statutory framework.

49

TABLE OF CONTENTS

CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This prospectus contains forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements are neither historical facts nor assurances of future performance. Instead, they are based on our current beliefs, expectations or assumptions regarding the future of our business, future plans and strategies, our operational results and other future conditions. Forward-looking statements can be identified by words such as “anticipate,” “believe,” “estimate,” “expect,” “intend,” “may,” “plan,” “predict,” “project,” “seek,” “target,” “potential,” “will,” “would,” “could,” “should,” “continue,” “contemplate” and other similar expressions, although not all forward-looking statements contain these identifying words. These forward-looking statements include all matters that are not historical facts. They appear in a number of places throughout this prospectus and include statements regarding our intentions, beliefs or current expectation concerning, among other things, our results of operations, financial condition, capital and liquidity requirements, prospects, growth, strategies and the industry in which we operate.

There are important factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those contemplated by such forward-looking statements. By their nature, forward-looking statements involve risks and uncertainties because they relate to events and depend on circumstances that may or may not occur in the future. We believe that these risks and uncertainties include, but are not limited to, those described in the “Risk Factors” section of this prospectus, which include, but are not limited to, the following:

changes in economic and market conditions;
changes in market interest rates;
our access to sources of liquidity and capital to address our liquidity needs;
our ability to attract and retain customer deposits;
our ability to effectively compete with other financial services companies and the effects of competition in the financial services industry on our business;
our ability to successfully execute our business plan and implement our growth strategy;
our ability to successfully manage our credit risk and the sufficiency of our allowance for credit loss;
our ability to successfully develop and commercialize new or enhanced products and services;
our ability to transact business in EU countries in the aftermath of Brexit;
damage to our reputation from any of the factors described in this section, in “Risk Factors” and in “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations”;
our reliance on appraisals and valuation techniques;
our ability to attract and maintain qualified employees and key executives;
our reliance on third-party vendors;
our reliance on the effective implementation and use of technology;
our ability to identify and address cyber-security risks;
the failure or interruption of our information and communications systems;
the effectiveness of our risk management and internal disclosure controls and procedures;
our ability to maintain effective internal control over financial reporting;
the likelihood of success in, and the impact of, litigation or regulatory actions;

50

TABLE OF CONTENTS

the complex and changing regulatory environment in which we operate, including any changing regulatory requirements and restrictions placed on us by our principal regulator, the BMA, and other regulators, as well as our ability to comply with regulatory schemes in multiple jurisdictions; and
the incremental costs of operating as a public company.

These factors should not be construed as exhaustive and should be read with the other cautionary statements in this prospectus.

Although we base these forward-looking statements on assumptions that we believe are reasonable when made, we caution you that forward-looking statements are not guarantees of future performance and that our actual results of operations, financial condition and liquidity, and the development of the industry in which we operate may differ materially from those made in or suggested by the forward-looking statements contained in this prospectus. In addition, even if our results of operations, financial condition and liquidity, and the development of the industry in which we operate, are consistent with the forward-looking statements contained in this prospectus, those results or developments may not be indicative of results or developments in subsequent periods.

Given these risks and uncertainties, you are cautioned not to place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements. Any forward-looking statement that we make in this prospectus speaks only as of the date of such statement. Except to the extent required by applicable law, we undertake no obligation to update any forward-looking statements or to publicly announce the results of any revisions to any of those statements to reflect future events or developments. Comparisons of results for current and any prior periods are not intended to express any future trends or indications of future performance, unless specifically expressed as such, and should only be viewed as historical data.

51

TABLE OF CONTENTS

MARKET INFORMATION

The Bank's common shares trade on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “NTB” and on the Bermuda Stock Exchange under the symbol “NTB.BH”.

The following table sets forth for the periods indicated the reported high and low closing sale prices per common share and the average daily trading volume on each of the NYSE and the BSX. The Bank's common shares began trading on the NYSE on September 16, 2016:

Period
NYSE
High
(US$)
NYSE
Low
(US$)
NYSE Average Daily
Trading Volume
(Shares)
BSX
High
(BM$)
BSX
Low
(BM$)
BSX Average Daily
Trading Volume
(Shares)
Annual
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2012
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
13.30
 
 
9.90
 
 
6,187
 
2013
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
15.00
 
 
12.60
 
 
4,114
 
2014
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
20.50
 
 
14.90
 
 
5,756
 
2015
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
21.00
 
 
16.00
 
 
2,426
 
2016
 
32.90
 
 
23.75
 
 
244,611
 
 
32.00
 
 
16.00
 
 
6,619
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Quarterly
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
First Quarter 2015
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
21.00
 
 
19.70
 
 
4,421
 
Second Quarter 2015
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
19.90
 
 
16.00
 
 
1,921
 
Third Quarter 2015
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
18.00
 
 
16.50
 
 
1,528
 
Fourth Quarter 2015
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
20.00
 
 
17.50
 
 
1,672
 
First Quarter 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
19.50
 
 
16.00
 
 
6,737
 
Second Quarter 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
16.60
 
 
16.00
 
 
2,354
 
Third Quarter 2016
 
25.38
 
 
23.75
 
 
723,036
 
 
24.50
 
 
16.20
 
 
12,266
 
Fourth Quarter 2016
 
32.90
 
 
24.70
 
 
161,076
 
 
32.00
 
 
24.50
 
 
4,864
 
First Quarter 2017 (through February 10, 2017)
 
34.59
 
 
30.50
 
 
150,702
 
 
33.50
 
 
31.00
 
 
3,441
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Monthly
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
August 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
20.50
 
 
16.80
 
 
2,602
 
September 2016
 
25.38
 
 
23.75
 
 
723,036
 
 
24.50
 
 
17.60
 
 
27,540
 
October 2016
 
25.85
 
 
24.70
 
 
142,369
 
 
25.40
 
 
24.50
 
 
9,439
 
November 2016
 
29.94
 
 
25.24
 
 
98,600
 
 
29.00
 
 
24.75
 
 
3,222
 
December 2016
 
32.90
 
 
28.37
 
 
242,259
 
 
32.00
 
 
28.00
 
 
2,788
 
January 2017
 
34.59
 
 
31.31
 
 
121,058
 
 
32.00
 
 
31.10
 
 
4,051
 

52

TABLE OF CONTENTS

USE OF PROCEEDS

We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of the common shares being sold by the selling shareholders in this offering. See “Principal Shareholders and Selling Shareholders”. All proceeds from the sale of these shares, net of the underwriters’ discounts, will be received by the selling shareholders.

53

TABLE OF CONTENTS

DIVIDEND POLICY

Dividend Policy

On February 12, 2017, our Board declared a cash dividend of $0.32 per common share payable on March 27, 2017 to shareholders of record as of March 13, 2017.

We intend to pay cash dividends on a quarterly basis at $0.32 per quarter, subject to the prior approval of the BMA. There can be no assurance, however, that we will pay such dividend amount for any given period, and the declaration of dividends remains subject to the approval of our Board and the BMA.

Although we currently expect to pay dividends according to our dividend policy, we may elect not to pay dividends. Any declarations of dividends will be at the discretion of the Board, and will be subject to the prior approval of the BMA. Such dividends may be declared and paid by the Board only as permitted under applicable law. In determining the amount of any future dividends, the Board may take into account: (1) our financial results; (2) our available cash, as well as anticipated cash requirements (including debt servicing); (3) our capital requirements, including the capital requirements of our subsidiaries; (4) contractual, legal, tax and regulatory restrictions on, and implications of, the payment of dividends by us to our shareholders; (5) general economic and business conditions; (6) restrictions applicable to us and our subsidiaries under Bermuda and other applicable laws, regulations and policies, including the requirement to obtain the BMA's prior approval for the payment of dividends on our common shares; and (7) any other factors that the Board may deem relevant. Therefore, there can be no assurance that we will declare or pay any dividends to holders of the common shares, or as to the amount of any such dividends.

See “Risk Factors — Risks Relating to the Common Shares — Holders of our common shares may not receive dividends”.

Our Historical Dividends

Since 2013 we have declared and paid dividends on a quarterly basis. For the quarter ended December 31, 2016, we declared a quarterly dividend of $0.32 per share, payable on March 27, 2017 to shareholders of record on March 13, 2017. For the quarter ended September 30, 2016, we declared a quarterly dividend of $0.10 per common share, payable on December 15, 2016 to shareholders of record on December 1, 2016. For the quarter ended June 30, 2016, we declared a quarterly dividend of $0.10 per common share, payable on August 29, 2016 to shareholders of record on August 15, 2016. For the quarter ended March 31, 2016, we declared a quarterly dividend of $0.10 per common share, paid on March 24, 2016 to shareholders of record on March 11, 2016. For the year ended December 31, 2016, we declared four quarterly dividends totaling $0.62 for each common share held on record as of the applicable record dates.

During the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015, 2014 and 2013, we declared the full 8.00% cash dividends on our issued and outstanding preference shares. Preference share dividends declared and paid were $14.6 million during 2016, $14.6 million during 2015 and $14.7 million during 2014. Guarantee fees paid to the Government of Bermuda pursuant to an agreement whereby the Government of Bermuda guaranteed payments as to dividends on certain preference shares were $1.7 million during the nine months ended September 30, 2016, $1.8 million during 2015 and $1.8 million during 2014. On December 15, 2016, we completed the mandatory redemption of our preference shares and all shareholders of record of the preference shares as of December 1, 2016 were issued a make whole payment on December 15, 2016 of $1,180 per preference share, comprising the sum of the most recent dividend per preference share, the net present value of future dividend payments that would have been paid through June 22, 2019 and the $1,000 liquidation preference on each preference share, discounted for present value. For more information regarding the payment of dividends on preference shares and guarantee fees, see “Description of Share Capital — Preference Shares”.

54

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following table sets forth dividends per share paid during the periods indicated.

 
Year ended
December 31,
(in $, unless otherwise indicated)(1)
2016
2015
2014
Period
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
First Quarter
 
0.10
 
 
0.20
 
 
0.20
 
Second Quarter
 
0.10
 
 
0.10
 
 
0.10
 
Third Quarter
 
0.10
 
 
0.10
 
 
0.10
 
Fourth Quarter
 
0.10
 
 
0.10
 
 
0.10
 
Total dividends per common share
 
0.40
 
 
0.50
 
 
0.50
 
Total dividends per common share as a percentage of earnings per share (in %)
 
33.9
%
 
40.8
%
 
30.4
%
(1)Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.

On February 12, 2017, our Board declared a cash dividend of $0.32 per share to be paid in respect of our earnings in the fourth quarter of 2016 payable on March 27, 2017 to the holders of record of our common shares as of March 13, 2017.

55

TABLE OF CONTENTS

CAPITALIZATION

The table below sets forth our capitalization as of December 31, 2016 on an actual basis. You should read this table in conjunction with “Selected Consolidated Financial Data”, “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” as well as our consolidated financial statements, the related notes and the other financial information included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 
As of
December 31, 2016
(in millions of $, (1) unless otherwise indicated)
Actual
Liabilities
 
 
 
Customer deposits
 
10,033.6
 
of which non-interest bearing
 
2,385.0
 
of which interest bearing
 
7,648.6
 
Bank deposits
 
23.8
 
Other liabilities
 
242.2
 
Long-term debt
 
117.0
 
Total liabilities
 
10,392.8
 
   
 
 
 
Shareholders' equity:
 
 
 
Common share capital
 
0.5
 
Preference share capital(2)
 
 
Additional paid-in capital
 
1,142.6
 
Accumulated deficit
 
(287.7
)
Less: treasury shares
 
 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
 
(144.7
)
Total shareholders' equity
 
710.7
 
Total capitalization
 
11,103.5
 
   
 
 
 
Regulatory Capital and Capital Ratios(3):
 
 
 
Tier 1 capital(4)
 
666.8
 
Tier 2 capital(5)
 
102.7
 
Total risk-weighted assets (RWA)(6)
 
4,365.4
 
TCE/TA (in %)(7)
 
5.9
%
Common equity tier 1 ratio (in %)
 
15.3
%
Tier 1 total ratio (in %)
 
15.3
%
Total capital ratio (in %)
 
17.6
%
(1)Amounts denominated in USD are translated to BMD at an exchange rate of $1.0 = BM$1.0.
(2)All preference shares were redeemed and cancelled in December 2016.
(3)Calculated in accordance with the Basel II framework as adopted by the BMA. For more information on our capital ratios, see “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Capital Resources”.
(4)Tier 1 capital is comprised of share capital, the share premium account, retained earnings and other reserves.
(5)Tier 2 capital is comprised of the Bank's qualifying subordinated notes and the general allowance for credit losses.
(6)Risk-weighted assets are calculated by assigning a risk weight to each asset and exposure.
(7)The TCE/TA ratio is a non-GAAP financial measure. TCE/TA is a measure to determine how significant of an unexpected loss can be incurred by the Bank before other forms of capital, other than common equity, are impacted. The TCE/TA ratio is calculated as (common equity — intangible assets — goodwill) / tangible assets. Tangible common equity does not include the preference shareholders' equity or goodwill and intangible assets. Tangible assets are the Bank's total assets from continuing operations less goodwill and intangibles. For more information on non-GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of non-GAAP Financial Measures”.

56

TABLE OF CONTENTS

SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL AND OTHER DATA

Consolidated Financial Information

The following tables present our selected consolidated financial information as of and for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015, 2014, 2013, and 2012.

Our historical results for any prior period do not necessarily indicate our results to be expected for any future period. The following data should be read in conjunction with “Summary Consolidated Financial and Other Data” and “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations”.

The selected consolidated financial information presented as of December 31, 2016 and 2015 and for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 have been derived from the audited consolidated financial statements of The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited included elsewhere in this prospectus. The selected consolidated financial information presented as of December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 and for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 have been derived from the audited consolidated financial statements of The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited, which are not included elsewhere in this prospectus.

Statement of Operations Data

 
For the year ended
December 31,
(in millions of $, unless indicated otherwise)
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
Total interest income
 
274.9
 
 
262.6
 
 
265.1
 
 
253.2
 
 
244.8
 
Total interest expense
 
16.4
 
 
23.3
 
 
26.6
 
 
29.4
 
 
33.1
 
Net interest income before provisions for credit losses
 
258.5
 
 
239.3
 
 
238.5
 
 
223.8
 
 
211.7
 
Provisions for credit losses
 
(4.4
)
 
(5.7
)
 
(8.0
)
 
(14.8
)
 
(14.2
)
Net interest income after provisions for credit losses
 
254.1
 
 
233.5
 
 
230.4
 
 
209.0
 
 
197.5
 
Total non-interest income
 
147.5
 
 
140.2
 
 
134.8
 
 
126.0
 
 
128.5
 
Total other gains (losses)
 
1.0
 
 
(9.4
)
 
15.7
 
 
(8.8
)
 
(26.4
)
Total net revenue
 
402.6
 
 
364.3
 
 
381.0
 
 
326.2
 
 
299.7
 
Total non-interest expense
 
285.9
 
 
285.2
 
 
273.0
 
 
262.6
 
 
274.9
 
Net income before income taxes from continuing operations
 
116.7
 
 
79.0
 
 
108.0
 
 
63.5
 
 
24.8
 
Income tax (expense) benefit
 
(0.7
)
 
(1.3
)
 
0.2
 
 
(0.9
)
 
(5.9
)
Net income from continuing operations
 
115.9
 
 
77.7
 
 
108.2
 
 
62.6
 
 
18.9
 
Net income(1)
 
115.9
 
 
77.7
 
 
108.2
 
 
62.6
 
 
26.5
 
Net income to common shareholders
 
58.4
 
 
61.2
 
 
91.6
 
 
42.8
 
 
7.5
 
Earnings per common share from continuing operations (in US$)(2)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
 
1.20
 
 
1.25
 
 
1.67
 
 
0.78
 
 
0.14
 
Diluted(3)
 
1.18
 
 
1.23
 
 
1.65
 
 
0.77
 
 
0.14
 
Cash Dividends per common share (in BM$)(2)
 
0.40
 
 
0.50
 
 
0.50
 
 
0.70
 
 
 
Dividends per preference share (in US$)
 
80.00
 
 
80.00
 
 
80.00
 
 
80.00
 
 
80.00
 
(1)Net income (loss) attributable to our Barbados operations that were reported as discontinued operations in 2012 amounted to $7.6 million in 2012.
(2)Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.
(3)Reflects only “in the money” options and warrants to purchase the common shares as well as certain unvested share awards, which have a dilutive effect. Warrants issued to the Government of Bermuda in exchange for the Government's guarantee of the preference shares are not included in the computation of earnings per share because the exercise price was greater than the average market price of the common shares for the relevant periods. In December 2016, in connection with the preference share redemption, the warrant issued to the Government of Bermuda was repurchased for cancellation by the Bank. Only share awards and options for which the sum of (1) the expense that will be recognized in the future (i.e., the unrecognized expense) and (2) its exercise price, if any, was lower than the average market price of the common shares were considered dilutive, and therefore, included in the computation of diluted earnings per share.

57

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Balance Sheet Data

 
As of December 31,
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks
 
2,101.7
 
 
2,288.9
 
 
2,063.3
 
 
1,730.5
 
 
1,542.5
 
Of which cash and demand deposits with banks — non-interest bearing
 
110.7
 
 
110.9
 
 
343.1
 
 
247.0
 
 
216.6
 
Of which demand deposits with banks — interest bearing
 
326.4
 
 
378.6
 
 
139.2
 
 
164.2
 
 
150.4
 
Of which cash equivalents — interest bearing
 
1,664.5
 
 
1,799.4
 
 
1,581.0
 
 
1,319.3
 
 
1,175.5
 
Securities purchased under agreement to resell
 
148.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Short-term investments
 
519.8
 
 
409.5
 
 
394.8
 
 
55.0
 
 
76.2
 
Investment in securities
 
4,400.2
 
 
3,223.9
 
 
2,989.1
 
 
2,613.6
 
 
2,881.7
 
Of which trading
 
6.3
 
 
321.3
 
 
417.4
 
 
552.3
 
 
771.1
 
Of which available-for-sale
 
3,332.7
 
 
2,201.3
 
 
2,233.5
 
 
1,728.0
 
 
1,871.2
 
Of which held-to-maturity(1)
 
1,061.1
 
 
701.3
 
 
338.2
 
 
333.4
 
 
239.3
 
Loans, net of allowance for credit losses
 
3,570.5
 
 
4,000.2
 
 
4,019.1
 
 
4,088.2
 
 
3,956.0
 
Premises, equipment and computer software
 
167.8
 
 
183.4
 
 
215.1
 
 
240.6
 
 
243.3
 
Accrued interest
 
22.8
 
 
17.5
 
 
19.2
 
 
19.6
 
 
19.0
 
Goodwill
 
19.6
 
 
23.5
 
 
24.8
 
 
7.1
 
 
6.9
 
Intangible assets
 
42.3
 
 
27.7
 
 
33.0
 
 
12.0
 
 
15.3
 
Equity method investments
 
13.5
 
 
12.8
 
 
12.8
 
 
12.5
 
 
18.6
 
Other real estate owned
 
14.2
 
 
11.2
 
 
19.3
 
 
27.4
 
 
34.4
 
Other assets
 
82.5
 
 
77.1
 
 
67.8
 
 
64.2
 
 
39.0
 
Total assets
 
11,103.5
 
 
10,275.6
 
 
9,858.4
 
 
8,870.8
 
 
8,833.0
 
Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total customer and bank deposits
 
10,033.6
 
 
9,182.1
 
 
8,671.6
 
 
7,638.0
 
 
7,393.2
 
Of which customer deposits — Bermuda — non-interest bearing
 
1,733.7
 
 
1,348.9
 
 
1,021.4
 
 
713.3
 
 
664.1
 
Of which customer deposits — Bermuda — interest bearing
 
4,213.4
 
 
2,922.8
 
 
2,848.7
 
 
2,837.7
 
 
2,591.2
 
Of which customer deposits — non-Bermuda — non-interest bearing
 
651.3
 
 
532.9
 
 
536.7
 
 
299.5
 
 
254.7
 
Of which customer deposits — non-Bermuda — interest bearing
 
3,411.4
 
 
4,363.1
 
 
4,224.8
 
 
3,747.1
 
 
3,756.8
 
Of which bank deposits — Bermuda
 
0.3
 
 
0.4
 
 
9.5
 
 
0.5
 
 
88.2
 
Of which bank deposits — non-Bermuda
 
23.5
 
 
14.1
 
 
30.4
 
 
39.7
 
 
38.3
 
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
25.5
 
 
109.0
 
Employee future benefits
 
140.0
 
 
122.1
 
 
117.9
 
 
89.1
 
 
103.1
 
Accrued interest
 
2.1
 
 
2.7
 
 
4.8
 
 
3.8
 
 
2.8
 
Preference share dividends payable
 
 
 
0.7
 
 
0.7
 
 
0.6
 
 
0.7
 
Payable for investments purchased
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
 
100.0
 
 
100.5
 
 
97.2
 
 
104.2
 
 
107.0
 
Liabilities of discontinued operations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Long-term debt
 
117.0
 
 
117.0
 
 
117.0
 
 
207.0
 
 
260.0
 
Total liabilities
 
10,392.8
 
 
9,525.2
 
 
9,009.1
 
 
8,068.3
 
 
7,975.8
 
Total shareholders' equity(2)
 
710.7
 
 
750.4
 
 
849.4
 
 
802.6
 
 
857.2
 
Of which common share capital(6)
 
0.5
 
 
0.5
(5)
 
0.6
 
 
0.6
 
 
0.6
 
Of which preference share capital(3)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Of which contingent value convertible preference (CVCP) share capital(4)(6)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
 
11,103.5
 
 
10,275.6
 
 
9,858.4
 
 
8,870.8
 
 
8,833.0
 
(1)Fair value of held to maturity debt securities was $1,046.8 million as of December 31, 2016, $701.5 million as of December 31, 2015, $344.0 million as of December 31, 2014, $315.5 million as of December 31, 2013 and $244.8 million as of December 31, 2012.
(2)As of December 31, 2016, the number of outstanding awards of unvested common shares was 0.8 million (December 31, 2015: 0.8 million, December 31, 2014: 1.0 million, December 31, 2013: 0.9 million and December 31, 2012: 0.7 million). Only awards for which the sum of (1) the expense that will be recognized in the future (i.e., the unrecognized expense) and (2) the exercise price, if any, was lower than the average market price of $34.72. A warrant, outstanding until the Bank repurchased it

58

TABLE OF CONTENTS

in December 2016, to purchase 0.43 million shares (December 31, 2015: 0.43 million, December 31, 2014: 0.43 million, December 31, 2013: 0.43 million and December 31, 2012: 0.42 million) was excluded from the computation of earnings per share because the exercise price was greater than the average market price of the common shares. Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.

(3)Preference share capital in all periods presented was nil, $182,863, $183,046, $183,606 and $195,578 as of December 31, 2016, 2015, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, representing $0.01 par value per preference share issued and outstanding as of the respective dates. In December 2016, the Bank redeemed and cancelled all outstanding preference shares.
(4)All CVCP shares were converted to common shares at a 1:1 ratio on March 31, 2015. See “Description of Share Capital — Preference Shares — Contingent Value Convertible Preference Shares”.
(5)Reflects the repurchase for cancellation of 8,000,000 common shares previously held by CIBC effected on April 30, 2015. See “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Contingent Value Convertible Preference Shares — Share Buy-Back Program”. Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.
(6)Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.

59

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Financial Ratios and Other Performance Indicators

We use a number of financial measures to track the performance of our business and guide our management. Some of these measures are defined by, and calculated in compliance with, applicable banking regulations, but such regulations often provide for certain discretion in defining and calculating the measures. These measures allow management to review our core activities, enabling us and our investors to evaluate relevant trends meaningfully when considered in conjunction with (but not in lieu of) measures that are calculated in accordance with US GAAP. Non-GAAP measures used in this prospectus are not a substitute for US GAAP measures and readers should consider the US GAAP measures as well.

The following table shows certain of our key financial measures for the periods indicated. Because of the discretion that we and other banks and companies have in defining and calculating these measures, care should be taken in comparing such measures used by us with similarly titled measures of other banks and companies, as such measures may not be directly comparable.

Many of these measures are non-GAAP financial measures. We believe that each of these measures is useful to investors in understanding trends in our business that may not otherwise be apparent when relying solely on our GAAP-calculated results. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures presented below, including a reconciliation to the most directly comparable GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.

 
For the year ended
December 31,
(in %, unless otherwise indicated)
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
Return on common shareholders' equity(1)
 
8.9
 
 
10.1
 
 
13.7
 
 
6.8
 
 
1.1
 
Core return on average tangible common equity(2)
 
20.5
 
 
17.6
 
 
14.4
 
 
9.7
 
 
5.8
 
Return on assets(3)
 
1.1
 
 
0.8
 
 
1.2
 
 
0.7
 
 
0.3
 
Core return on average tangible assets(4)
 
1.3
 
 
1.1
 
 
1.2
 
 
0.9
 
 
0.6
 
Net interest margin(5)
 
2.45
 
 
2.48
 
 
2.74
 
 
2.64
 
 
2.63
 
Efficiency margin(6)
 
69.3
 
 
74.0
 
 
72.0
 
 
74.1
 
 
79.3
 
Core efficiency ratio(7)
 
63.8
 
 
66.0
 
 
67.7
 
 
71.6
 
 
78.4
 
Fee income ratio(8)
 
36.7
 
 
37.5
 
 
36.9
 
 
37.6
 
 
39.5
 
Common equity Tier 1 capital ratio(9)(10)
 
15.3
 
 
10.7
 
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
Tier 1 common ratio(9)
 
N/A
 
 
12.0
 
 
14.6
 
 
15.2
 
 
14.0
 
Tier 1 capital ratio(9)
 
15.3
 
 
16.2
 
 
19.0
 
 
19.6
 
 
18.5
 
Total capital ratio(9)
 
17.6
 
 
19.0
 
 
22.2
 
 
23.7
 
 
24.2
 
Leverage ratio(9)(10)
 
5.8
 
 
6.4
 
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
Tangible common equity/tangible assets(11)
 
5.9
 
 
5.1
 
 
6.2
 
 
6.8
 
 
7.3
 
Tangible total equity/tangible assets(12)
 
5.9
 
 
6.8
 
 
8.1
 
 
8.9
 
 
9.5
 
Non-performing assets ratio(13)
 
0.5
 
 
0.7
 
 
1.0
 
 
1.4
 
 
1.7
 
Non-accrual ratio(14)
 
1.3
 
 
1.6
 
 
1.8
 
 
2.5
 
 
2.8
 
Non-performing loan ratio(15)
 
1.6
 
 
2.0
 
 
2.4
 
 
2.8
 
 
3.5
 
Net charge-off ratio(16)
 
0.3
 
 
0.2
 
 
0.4
 
 
0.6
 
 
0.4
 
Core earnings attributable to common shareholders(17)(18) (in BM$ million)
 
123.0
 
 
97.4
 
 
89.9
 
 
59.6
 
 
36.9
 
Core earnings per common share fully diluted(19)(21) (in BM$)
 
2.48
 
 
1.95
 
 
1.61
 
 
1.08
 
 
0.66
 
Common equity per share(20)(21) (in BM$)
 
13.34
 
 
12.24
 
 
12.25
 
 
11.28
 
 
12.03
 
(1)Return on common shareholders' equity (“ROE”) measures profitability revealing how much profit is generated with the money invested by common shareholders. ROE represents the amount of net income to common shareholders as a percentage of average common equity and calculated as net income to common shareholders / average common equity. Net income to common shareholders is net income for the full fiscal year, before dividends paid to common shareholders but after dividends to preference shareholders. Average common equity does not include the preference shareholders' equity.
(2)Core return on average tangible common equity (“Core ROATCE”) is a non-GAAP financial measure. Core ROATCE measures core profitability as a percentage of average tangible common equity. Core ROATCE is the amount of core income to common shareholders as a percentage of average tangible common equity and is calculated as core earnings to common shareholders / average tangible common equity. Core earnings to common shareholders is net earnings to common shareholders for the full fiscal year (before dividends paid to common shareholders but after dividends to preference shareholders) adjusted to exclude certain items that are included in the financial results presented in accordance with GAAP.

60

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Average tangible common equity does not include the preference shareholders' equity or goodwill and intangible assets. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.

(3)Return on assets (“ROA”) is an indicator of profitability relative to total assets and is intended to demonstrate how efficient management is at using the assets to generate earnings. The ROA ratio is calculated as net income / average total assets.
(4)Core return on average tangible assets (“Core ROATA”) is a non-GAAP financial measure. Core ROATA is an indicator used to assess the core profitability of average tangible assets and is intended to demonstrate how efficiently management is utilizing its tangible assets to generate core net income. Core ROATA is calculated by taking the core income as a percentage of average tangible assets and is calculated as core net income / average tangible assets. Core net income is the net income adjusted to exclude certain items that are included in the financial results presented in accordance with GAAP. Core ROATA is a non-GAAP financial measure. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “— Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(5)Net interest margin (“NIM”) is a performance metric that examines how successful the Bank's investment decisions are compared to its cost of funding assets and is expressed as net interest income as a percentage of average interest-earning assets. NIM is calculated as net interest income before provision for credit losses / average interest-earning assets. Net interest income is the interest earned on cash due from banks, investments, loans and other interest earning assets minus the interest paid for deposits, short-term borrowings and long-term debt. The average interest-earning assets is calculated using daily average balances of interest-earning assets.
(6)Efficiency margin is a non-GAAP financial measure. Efficiency margin is an indicator used to assess operating efficiencies and is intended to demonstrate how efficiently management is controlling expenses relative to generating revenues. The efficiency margin is calculated by taking the non-interest expenses as a percentage of total net revenue before total other gains (losses) and provisions for credit losses and is calculated as (non-interest expense — amortization of intangible assets) / (total non-interest income + net interest income before provision for credit losses). For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(7)The core efficiency ratio is a non-GAAP financial measure. The core efficiency ratio is an indicator used to assess operating efficiencies and is intended to demonstrate how efficiently management is controlling expenses relative to generating revenues. The core efficiency ratio is calculated by taking the core non-interest expenses as a percentage of total net revenue before provision for credit losses and other gains and losses and is calculated as (core non-interest expenses — amortization of intangible assets) / (core non-interest income + core net interest income before provision for credit losses). Core non-interest expenses excludes certain items that are included in the financial results presented in accordance with GAAP including income taxes and amortization of intangible assets. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(8)The fee income ratio is a measure used to determine the proportion of revenues derived from non-interest income sources. The ratio is calculated as non-interest income / (non-interest income + net interest income after provision for credit losses).
(9)The total capital ratio measures the amount of the Bank's capital in relation to the amount of risk it is taking. All banks must ensure that a reasonable proportion of their risk is covered by permanent capital. Prior to January 1, 2015, the Bank's regulatory capital was determined in accordance with Basel II guidelines issued by the BMA. Under Basel II, Pillar I, banks must maintain a minimum total capital ratio of 14.46%, inclusive of all capital buffers. In effect, this means that 14.46% of the risk-weighted assets must be covered by permanent or near permanent capital. The risk weighting process takes into account the relative risk of various types of lending. The higher the capital adequacy ratio a bank has, the greater the level of unexpected losses it can absorb before becoming insolvent. The tier 1 capital ratio is the ratio of the Bank's core equity capital, as measured under Basel II, to its total RWA. RWA are the total of all assets held by the Bank weighted by credit risk according to a formula determined by the regulator. The Bank follows BCBS guidelines in setting formulas for asset risk weights. The tier 1 common ratio is equivalent to the tier 1 capital ratio except that it only includes common equity in the numerator and deducts the preference shareholders' equity. Note that the tier 1 common ratio is calculated in the same manner as the common equity tier 1 (“CET1”) ratio discussed below, but differs in its inputs based upon RWA calculations under Basel II versus Basel III.
(10)Effective January 1, 2015, the Bank's regulatory capital is determined in accordance with current Basel III guidelines issued by the BMA. However, the Bank was not required to publish its capital ratios under Basel III until January 1, 2016 as per guidance from the BMA and continued to publish certain ratios under Basel II during 2015. Basel III adopts CET1 as the predominant form of regulatory capital with the CET1 ratio as a new metric. Under Basel III, banks must maintain a minimum CET1 ratio of 8.1%. Basel III also adopts the new Leverage Ratio regime, which is calculated by dividing tier 1 capital by an exposure measure. Under Basel III, banks must maintain a minimum Leverage Ratio of 5.0%. The exposure measure consists of total assets (excluding items deducted from tier 1 capital) and certain off balance sheet items converted into credit exposure equivalents as well as adjustments for derivatives to reflect credit and other risks.
(11)The tangible common equity/tangible assets (“TCE/TA”) ratio is a non-GAAP financial measure. The TCE/TA ratio is a measure used to determine how significant of an unexpected loss can be incurred by the Bank before other forms of capital, other than common equity, are impacted. The TCE/TA ratio is calculated as (common equity — intangible assets — goodwill) / tangible assets. Tangible common equity does not include the preference shareholders' equity or goodwill and intangible assets. Tangible assets are the Bank's total assets from continuing operations less goodwill and intangibles. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(12)The tangible total equity/tangible assets (“TE/TA”) ratio is a non-GAAP financial measure. The TE/TA ratio is a measure used to determine how much loss the Bank can absorb before subordinated debt capital is impacted. The TE/TA ratio is calculated as (total shareholders' equity — intangible assets — goodwill) / tangible assets. Tangible assets are the Bank's total assets from continuing operations less intangible assets and goodwill. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(13)The non-performing assets (“NPA”) ratio is an indicator of the credit quality of the Bank's total assets by expressing the non-performing assets as a percentage of total assets. The NPA ratio is calculated as (gross non-accrual loans — specific allowance for credit losses on non-accrual loans + accruing loans past due 90 days + other real estate owned) / total assets.

61

TABLE OF CONTENTS

(14)The non-accrual (“NACL”) ratio is an indicator used to assess the credit performance of the Bank's loan portfolio by calculating the non-accrual loans as a percentage of loans. The NACL ratio is calculated as gross non-accrual loans / gross total loans. Note the reference to gross implies the amounts prior to loan allowances for credit losses.
(15)The non-performing loan (“NPL”) ratio is an indicator used to assess the credit performance of the Bank's loan portfolio by calculating the non-performing loans as a percentage of loans. The NPL ratio is calculated as total gross non-performing loans / total gross loans.
(16)The net charge-off (“NCO”) ratio is an indicator used to assess the net credit loss of the Bank's loan portfolio by calculating the net charge-offs as a percentage of average total loans. The NCO ratio is calculated as net charge-off expense / average total loans. Average total loans is calculated as the average of the month-end asset balances during the relevant period.
(17)Core net income is a non-GAAP financial measure. Core net income measures net income on a core basis. Core net income is calculated by adjusting net income for income or expense items which are not representative of the ongoing operations of our business. For a reconciliation of core net income to net income, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(18)Core earnings attributable to common shareholders (“CEACS”) is a non-GAAP financial measure. CEACS measures profitability attributable to common shareholders on a core basis. For a reconciliation of CEACS to net income, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(19)Core net income per common share — fully diluted is a non-GAAP financial measure. Core net income per common share — fully diluted measures core profitability attributable to common shareholders on a per share basis. For a reconciliation to net income per share, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(20)Common equity per share is calculated as total common equity / number of common shares issued and outstanding at period end.
(21)Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.

Net Interest Income

Net interest income is the amount of interest earned on our interest-earning assets less interest paid on our interest-bearing liabilities. The following table shows our net interest income before provision for credit losses for the periods indicated.

 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2016
2015
(in millions of $)
Average
balance
($)
Interest
($)
Average
rate
(%)
Average
balance
($)
Interest
($)
Average
rate
(%)
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks and short-term investments
 
2,655.3
 
 
9.8
 
 
0.37
%
 
2,407.9
 
 
6.5
 
 
0.27
%
Investment in securities
 
3,940.6
 
 
77.2
 
 
1.95
%
 
3,217.0
 
 
69.6
 
 
2.16
%
Loans
 
3,921.1
 
 
188.0
 
 
4.78
%
 
4,026.7
 
 
186.5
 
 
4.63
%
Interest earning assets
 
10,517.0
 
 
275.0
 
 
2.61
%
 
9,651.6
 
 
262.6
 
 
2.72
%
Other assets
 
343.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
371.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
 
10,860.4
 
 
275.0
 
 
2.53
%
 
10,023.1
 
 
262.6
 
 
2.62
%
Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
 
7,733.8
 
 
(11.8
)
 
(0.15
)%
 
7,156.7
 
 
(18.4
)
 
(0.26
)%
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase
 
16.0
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.73
)%
 
2.1
 
 
 
 
 
Long-term debt
 
117.0
 
 
(4.5
)
 
(3.84
)%
 
117.0
 
 
(4.9
)
 
(4.15
)%
Interest bearing liabilities
 
7,866.8
 
 
(16.4
)
 
(0.21
)%
 
7,275.8
 
 
(23.3
)
 
(0.32
)%
Non-interest bearing current accounts
 
2,042.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,720.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
 
123.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
196.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities
 
10,033.0
 
 
(16.4
)
 
(0.16
)%
 
9,193.3
 
 
(23.3
)
 
(0.25
)%
Shareholders’ equity
 
827.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
829.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 
10,860.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10,023.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest-bearing funds net of non-interest earning assets (free balance)
 
2,650.2
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2,375.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest margin
 
 
 
 
258.6
 
 
2.45
%
 
 
 
 
239.3
 
 
2.48
%

62

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 
For the years ended December 31,
 
2014
2013
2012
(in millions of $)
Average
balance
($)
Interest
($)
Average
rate
(%)
Average
balance
($)
Interest
($)
Average
rate
(%)
Average
balance
($)
Interest
($)
Average
rate
(%)
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks and short-term investments
 
1,752.9
 
 
5.4
 
 
0.31
%
 
1,794.7
 
 
5.4
 
 
0.30
%
 
1,494.4
 
 
5.1
 
 
0.34
%
Investment in securities
 
2,877.8
 
 
67.7
 
 
2.35
%
 
2,655.3
 
 
60.9
 
 
2.29
%
 
2,455.9
 
 
48.6
 
 
1.98
%
Loans
 
4,075.0
 
 
192.0
 
 
4.71
%
 
4,022.9
 
 
187.0
 
 
4.65
%
 
4,022.6
 
 
190.6
 
 
4.74
%
Interest earning assets
 
8,705.7
 
 
265.1
 
 
3.05
%
 
8,472.9
 
 
253.3
 
 
2.99
%
 
7,972.9
 
 
244.3
 
 
3.06
%
Other assets
 
410.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
413.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
474.2
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
 
9,116.5
 
 
265.1
 
 
2.91
%
 
8,886.6
 
 
253.3
 
 
2.85
%
 
8,447.1
 
 
244.3
 
 
2.89
%
Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
 
6,741.6
 
 
(20.9
)
 
(0.31
)%
 
6,559.5
 
 
(20.0
)
 
(0.30
)%
 
6,205.7
 
 
(21.4
)
 
(0.34
)%
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase
 
22.0
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.38
)%
 
63.8
 
 
(0.2
)
 
(0.38
)%
 
1.3
 
 
 
 
(1.38
)%
Long-term debt
 
117.2
 
 
(5.6
)
 
(4.80
)%
 
228.7
 
 
(9.2
)
 
(4.02
)%
 
261.3
 
 
(12.6
)
 
(4.81
)%
Interest bearing liabilities
 
6,880.8
 
 
(26.6
)
 
(0.39
)%
 
6,852.0
 
 
(29.4
)
 
(0.43
)%
 
6,468.4
 
 
(34.0
)
 
(0.53
)%
Non-interest bearing current accounts
 
1,211.0
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
990.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
974.3
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
 
187.2
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
198.0
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
205.6
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities
 
8,279.0
 
 
(26.6
)
 
(0.32
)%
 
8,040.7
 
 
(29.4
)
 
(0.37
)%
 
7,648.3
 
 
(34.0
)
 
(0.44
)%
Shareholders’ equity
 
837.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
845.9
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
798.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 
9,116.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
8,886.6
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
8,447.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest-bearing funds net of non-interest earning assets (free balance)
 
1,824.9
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,620.9
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,504.6
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest margin
 
 
 
 
238.5
 
 
2.74
%
 
 
 
 
223.9
 
 
2.64
%
 
 
 
 
210.4
 
 
2.63
%

Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures

The tables below present computations of earnings and certain other financial measures, which exclude certain significant items that are included in the financial results presented in accordance with GAAP.

We focus on core net income in many of these measures and ratios, which we calculate by adjusting net income for income or expense items which are not representative of the ongoing operations of our business, which results in non-core gains, losses and expense measures. Core net income includes revenue, gains, losses and expense items incurred in the normal course of business. We consider the normal course of business to be the general operations of our business lines of banking and wealth management. We believe that expressing earnings and certain other financial measures excluding these non-core items provides a meaningful base for period-to-period comparisons, which management believes will assist investors in analyzing the operating results of the Bank and predicting future performance. Non-core items are determined by the Chief Financial Officer in conjunction with the Chief Executive Officer, and approved by our Board of Directors. Consideration is given to whether the expense, gain or loss is a result of exceptional circumstances or other decisions made not in the normal course of business. Items which are not in the normal course of business, such as business acquisition costs or impairment losses, or a result of exceptional circumstances, such as business restructuring costs, are considered non-core. These non-GAAP financial measures based on core net income are also used by management to assess the performance of the Bank's business because management does not consider the activities related to the adjustments to be indications of core operations. We believe that

63

TABLE OF CONTENTS

presentation of these non-GAAP financial measures will permit investors to assess the performance of the Bank on the same basis as that applied by management. Management and the Board utilize these non-GAAP financial measures utilizing core net income as follows:

Preparation of the Bank's operating budgets;
Quarterly financial performance reporting; and
Monthly reporting of consolidated results (management reporting only).

We calculate core net income attributable to common shareholders by deducting preference dividend and guarantee fees from core net income. We calculate core net income per common share by dividing the core net income attributable to common shareholders by the average number of common shares issued and outstanding during the relevant period.

The core efficiency ratio (non-GAAP), which is a measure of productivity, is generally calculated as core expenses, which is total expenses excluding non-core expense items, minus amortization of intangible assets divided by core revenue before other gains and losses and provision for credit losses, which excludes non-core revenue items or non-core gains or losses. Management uses this ratio to monitor performance regarding the efficiency of expense management and believes this measure provides meaningful information to investors.

Tangible common shareholders' equity ratios and tangible total asset ratios have become a focus of some investors in analyzing the capital position of the Bank absent the effects of intangible assets and preference shareholders' equity. Traditionally, the BMA and other banking regulatory bodies have assessed a bank's capital adequacy based on Tier 1 capital, and from January 1, 2016 onwards, CET1, the calculation of which is codified in the Basel II and Basel III framework, respectively, implemented by the BMA. Because tangible common shareholders' equity and tangible total assets are not formally defined by GAAP, these measures are considered to be non-GAAP financial measures and other entities may calculate them differently. Since analysts and banking regulators may assess the Bank's capital adequacy using tangible common shareholders' equity or tangible assets, the Bank believes that it is useful to provide investors the ability to assess the Bank's capital adequacy on this same basis. The Bank calculates tangible common equity and tangible total assets on a period end basis. The Bank also measures performance relative to core net income over average tangible common shareholders' equity and average tangible assets to monitor performance and efficiency relative to the Bank's capital adequacy.

We believe the non-GAAP financial measures presented in this prospectus provide useful information to management and investors that is supplementary to our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows computed in accordance with GAAP; however, we acknowledge that our non-GAAP financial measures have a number of limitations. As such, you should not view these disclosures as a substitute for results determined in accordance with GAAP, and they are not necessarily comparable to non-GAAP financial measures that other companies use.

The following tables provide: 1) a reconciliation of net income (GAAP) to core net income and core net income attributable to common shareholders (non-GAAP), 2) a computation of core net income attributable to common shareholders per common share fully diluted (non-GAAP), 3) a reconciliation of average and total shareholders' equity (GAAP) to average and total equity and average tangible common equity (non-GAAP), 4) a computation of core return to average tangible common equity (non-GAAP), 5) a reconciliation of average total assets (GAAP) to average tangible assets (non-GAAP), 6) a computation of core return on average tangible assets (non-GAAP), 7) a computation of tangible common equity to tangible assets (non-GAAP), 8) a computation of tangible total equity to tangible assets (non-GAAP), 9) a reconciliation of non-interest expenses (GAAP) to core non-interest expenses (non-GAAP) and 10) a computation of the core efficiency ratio (non-GAAP).

64

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 
 
For the year ended December 31,
(in millions of $, unless otherwise indicated)
 
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
Net income
A
 
115.9
 
 
77.7
 
 
108.2
 
 
62.6
 
 
26.5
 
Dividends and guarantee fee of preference shares
 
 
(15.7
)
 
(16.5
)
 
(16.5
)
 
(17.0
)
 
(18.0
)
Premium paid on repurchase/redemption of preference shares(1)
B
 
(41.9
)
 
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(2.8
)
 
(1.0
)
Net income to common shareholders
C
 
58.4
 
 
61.2
 
 
91.6
 
 
42.8
 
 
7.5
 
Non-core (gains), losses and expenses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-core (gains) losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gain on disposal of a pass-through note investment (formerly a SIV)(2)
 
 
(0.6
)
 
 
 
(8.7
)
 
 
 
 
Net gain on sale of affiliate(3)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(0.4
)
 
(4.2
)
Additional consideration from previously disposed of entities(4)
 
 
 
 
 
 
(0.3
)
 
(0.8
)
 
 
Impairment of equity method investment(5)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3.8
 
 
 
Realized gain on legal settlement(6)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(13.1
)
 
 
Realized gain on private equity investment(7)
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1.1
)
 
 
 
 
Income tax refund(8)
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1.0
)
 
 
 
 
Impairment of and gain on disposal of fixed assets (including software)(9)
 
 
 
 
5.1
 
 
2.0
 
 
 
 
14.5
 
Impairment of goodwill and intangible assets(10)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
18.6
 
Change in unrealized (gains) losses on certain investments(11)
 
 
 
 
0.7
 
 
(9.9
)
 
15.6
 
 
(0.9
)
Deferred tax valuation allowance and tax adjustments(12)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.0
 
Adjustment to holdback payable for a previous business acquisition(13)
 
 
0.9
 
 
 
 
1.2
 
 
 
 
 
Total net gains from discontinued operations(14)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(8.0
)
Total non-core (gains) losses
D
 
0.3
 
 
5.8
 
 
(17.8
)
 
5.1
 
 
25.0
 
Non-core expenses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Early retirement program, redundancies and other non-core compensation costs(15)
 
 
1.8
 
 
8.2
 
 
2.7
 
 
8.9
 
 
2.2
 
Onerous leases(16)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.8
 
Tax compliance review costs(17)
 
 
1.6
 
 
3.8
 
 
10.2
 
 
 
 
 
Provision in connection with ongoing tax compliance review(18)
 
 
0.7
 
 
4.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Business acquisition costs(19)
 
 
3.2
 
 
1.0
 
 
3.1
 
 
 
 
 
Restructuring charges and related professional service fees(20)
 
 
6.3
 
 
2.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investigation of an international stock exchange listing costs(21)
 
 
 
 
10.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total expenses from discontinued operations(14)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.4
 
Cost of 2010 legacy option plan vesting and related payroll taxes(22)
 
 
8.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total non-core expenses
E
 
22.4
 
 
30.4
 
 
16.0
 
 
8.9
 
 
3.4
 
Total non-core (gains), losses and expenses
F=D+E
 
22.7
 
 
36.2
 
 
(1.8
)
 
14.0
 
 
28.4
 
Core net income
G=A+F
 
138.6
 
 
113.9
 
 
106.4
 
 
76.6
 
 
54.9
 
Core net income attributable to common shareholders(1)
H=C-B+F
 
123.0
 
 
97.4
 
 
89.9
 
 
59.6
 
 
36.9
 
Average shareholders' equity
 
 
826.0
 
 
791.8
 
 
849.4
 
 
821.1
 
 
874.7
 
Less: average preference shareholders' equity
 
 
(168.8
)
 
(182.9
)
 
(183.4
)
 
(189.3
)
 
(199.6
)
Average common equity
I
 
657.2
 
 
608.9
 
 
666.0
 
 
631.8
 
 
675.1
 
Less: average goodwill and intangible assets
 
 
(58.6
)
 
(54.8
)
 
(42.1
)
 
(20.0
)
 
(42.0
)
Average tangible common equity
J
 
598.6
 
 
554.1
 
 
623.9
 
 
611.8
 
 
633.1
 
Return on equity
C/I
 
8.9
%
 
10.1
%
 
13.7
%
 
6.8
%
 
1.1
%
Core return on average tangible common equity
H/J
 
20.5
%
 
17.6
%
 
14.4
%
 
9.7
%
 
5.8
%

65

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 
 
For the year ended December 31,
(in millions of $, unless otherwise indicated)
 
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
Core earnings per common share fully diluted
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Adjusted weighted average number of diluted common shares (in thousands)(23)
K
 
49.6
 
 
50.0
 
 
55.6
 
 
55.4
 
 
55.6
 
Earnings per common share fully diluted
C/K
 
1.18
 
 
1.23
 
 
1.65
 
 
0.77
 
 
0.14
 
Non-core items per share
(F-B)/K
 
1.30
 
 
0.72
 
 
(0.04
)
 
0.31
 
 
0.52
 
Core earnings per common share fully diluted
 
 
2.48
 
 
1.95
 
 
1.61
 
 
1.08
 
 
0.66
 
Core return on average tangible assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total average assets
L
 
10,842.6
 
 
9,967.5
 
 
9,268.9
 
 
9,016.5
 
 
8,658.8
 
Less: average goodwill and intangible assets
 
 
(58.6
)
 
(54.8
)
 
(42.1
)
 
(20.0
)
 
(42.0
)
Average tangible assets
M
 
10,784.0
 
 
9,912.7
 
 
9,226.8
 
 
8,996.5
 
 
8,616.8
 
Return on average assets
A/L
 
1.1
%
 
0.8
%
 
1.2
%
 
0.7
%
 
0.3
%
Core return on average tangible assets
G/M
 
1.3
%
 
1.1
%
 
1.2
%
 
0.9
%
 
0.6
%
Tangible equity to tangible assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Shareholders' equity
 
 
710.7
 
 
750.4
 
 
849.4
 
 
802.6
 
 
857.2
 
Less: goodwill and intangible assets
 
 
(61.9
)
 
(51.1
)
 
(57.9
)
 
(19.1
)
 
(22.3
)
Tangible total equity
N
 
648.8
 
 
699.3
 
 
791.5
 
 
783.5
 
 
834.9
 
Less: preference shareholders' equity
 
 
 
 
(182.9
)
 
(183.0
)
 
(183.6
)
 
(195.6
)
Tangible common equity
O
 
648.8
 
 
516.4
 
 
608.5
 
 
599.9
 
 
639.3
 
Total assets
 
 
11,103.5
 
 
10,275.6
 
 
9,858.4
 
 
8,870.8
 
 
8,833.0
 
Less: goodwill and intangible assets
 
 
(61.9
)
 
(51.1
)
 
(57.9
)
 
(19.1
)
 
(22.3
)
Tangible assets
P
 
11,041.6
 
 
10,224.5
 
 
9,800.5
 
 
8,851.7
 
 
8,810.7
 
Tangible common equity to tangible assets
O/P
 
5.9
%
 
5.1
%
 
6.2
%
 
6.8
%
 
7.3
%
Tangible total equity to tangible assets
N/P
 
5.9
%
 
6.8
%
 
8.1
%
 
8.9
%
 
9.5
%
Efficiency ratio
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest expenses
 
 
285.9
 
 
285.2
 
 
273.0
 
 
262.6
 
 
274.9
 
Less: Amortization of intangibles
 
 
(4.5
)
 
(4.4
)
 
(4.3
)
 
(3.4
)
 
(5.0
)
Non-interest expenses before amortization of intangibles
Q
 
281.4
 
 
280.8
 
 
268.7
 
 
259.2
 
 
269.9
 
Non-interest income
 
 
147.5
 
 
140.2
 
 
134.8
 
 
126.0
 
 
128.5
 
Net interest income before provision for credit losses
 
 
258.5
 
 
239.3
 
 
238.5
 
 
223.8
 
 
211.7
 
Net revenue before provision for credit losses and other gains/losses
R
 
406.0
 
 
379.5
 
 
373.3
 
 
349.8
 
 
340.2
 
Efficiency ratio
Q/R
 
69.3
%
 
74.0
%
 
72.0
%
 
74.1
%
 
79.3
%
Core efficiency ratio
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest expenses
 
 
285.9
 
 
285.2
 
 
273.0
 
 
262.6
 
 
274.9
 
Less: non-core expenses
(E)
 
(22.4
)
 
(30.4
)
 
(16.0
)
 
(8.9
)
 
(3.4
)
Less: amortization of intangibles
 
 
(4.5
)
 
(4.4
)
 
(4.3
)
 
(3.4
)
 
(5.0
)
Core non-interest expenses before amortization of intangibles
S
 
259.0
 
 
250.4
 
 
252.7
 
 
250.3
 
 
266.5
 
Core revenue before other gains and losses and provision for credit losses
T
 
406.0
 
 
379.5
 
 
373.3
 
 
349.8
 
 
340.2
 
Core efficiency ratio
S/T
 
63.8
%
 
66.0
%
 
67.7
%
 
71.6
%
 
78.4
%
(1)Premiums paid on the preference share buy-backs and redemption are removed from core net income available to common shareholders as management views these premium amounts as non-core.
(2)Reflects a gain realized on a liquidation settlement from the Avenir pass-through note, our last remaining structured investment, in 2014. As the Bank no longer holds structured investment products, management determined the gains represented by these liquidation settlements to be non-core. In 2016, the Bank received a further distribution on this liquidation settlement.
(3)In 2013, reflected the sale of our 30% interest in Freisenbruch-Meyer Insurance Ltd., a Bermuda-based insurance company; in 2012, reflected the sale of our 27.8% interest in Island Heritage Holdings Ltd., a Cayman-based insurance company. The Bank does not sell affiliates or equity method investments unless a specific circumstance warrants the sale since acquiring and disposing of businesses is not part of management's core business. Accordingly, management considers the gains resulting from these sales to be non-core.

66

TABLE OF CONTENTS

(4)In 2014 and 2013, reflected the relevant portion of proceeds from the sale of our interest in Island Heritage Holdings Ltd. effected in 2012. As is detailed above, due to the nature of the underlying sale, management considers the additional earn-out proceeds realized from this sale to be non-core.
(5)In 2013, reflected an impairment loss on the adjustment of the carrying value of our investment in Philips Holdings, an equity method investment, to its fair value. While the Bank adjusts the carrying value of equity method investments on a quarterly basis, impairment losses such as this result from market or underlying business specific reasons which are outside of management's control. As a result, management considers this impairment loss to be non-core.
(6)Reflected a legal settlement from a class action lawsuit which we were party to relating to a previously disposed of investment reached by us in the second quarter of 2013. This lawsuit was not in the normal course of business for the Bank, and has no impact on the ongoing operations as the underlying investment had been disposed of. Therefore, management considers gains resulting from it to be non-core.
(7)Reflected a realized gain on the disposal of one of our investments in a private equity holding in the second quarter of 2014. This disposal was very opportunistic in nature as it represented a tender offer for a previously impaired private equity holding. This realization of a sale upon receipt of an opportunistic tender such as this is not in the normal course of business, and therefore management considers gains from it to be non-core.
(8)In 2014, reflected a tax refund granted by the Guernsey tax authorities relating to the ability to claim accelerated tax allowances on a new IT system that was implemented in 2013. While the Bank considers the costs associated with the implementation of the new IT system to be core to our operations, the benefit realized through the accelerated tax allowances was not the intended consequence. Therefore management considers the resulting gain to be non-core.
(9)In 2015, reflected impairment write-downs on the core banking system in the UK related to the orderly wind down of the deposit taking and investment management businesses. In 2014, represented write-downs on certain Bermuda properties, which were being utilized for rental income, adjusting the recorded value to the market value. In 2012, represented write-downs on certain properties, mostly in Bermuda, adjusting the recorded value to the market value resulting from the downturn of the Bermuda real estate values. Also in 2012 was a $8.0 million write-down resulting from the reclassification of certain properties in Bermuda from being used in our own operations to held-for-sale. These gains or losses were each individually a result of either decisions made which are not part of the core business strategy, such as the impairment write-down in the UK in 2015, or a result of isolated decisions made not in the normal course of business. Therefore management considers these gains and losses to be non-core.
(10)In 2012, reflected the full impairment of goodwill and intangible assets attributable to the United Kingdom and The Bahamas. These losses were a result of a continuous period of losses in these subsidiaries which resulted in the estimated future profitability to be unable to sustain the valuations of goodwill and customer intangibles. These were decisions and assessments made not in the normal course of business, and therefore management considers these impairment losses to be non-core.
(11)These gains and losses were a result of the price movements of certain securities which were previously classified as AFS for our operations in Guernsey and the United Kingdom but should have been classified as trading securities in the previously published financial statements since 2011, which have been subsequently revised. This classification introduced unintended asymmetry between core accounting performance measures of the Bank and economic / risk performance of the Bank, and led management to the decision to prospectively dispose of the securities. Management considers this to be an exceptional circumstance, and accordingly has classified these as non-core items.
(12)In 2012, reflected management's estimate of taxable income attributable to our UK operations and their ability to utilize deferred tax assets resulting in the recognition of a deferred tax valuation allowance and a tax adjustment related to the prior year. This deferred tax write-off is associated with the goodwill and identifiable intangible impairment discussed above. Accordingly this impairment loss was as well made outside of the normal course of business, and therefore management considers this impairment loss to be non-core.
(13)In 2016, reflected an adjustment to the holdback payable for the acquisition of Legis due to continued strong revenue from legacy clients. In 2014, reflected an adjustment to the initial estimated holdback payable for the acquisition of Legis due to the change in payment probabilities as estimates were updated for actual results. While management considers the integrated operations of acquired entities to be core to our business operations, due to the limited and isolated nature of acquisitions, management does not consider the costs associated with these acquisitions to a part of the normal course of business. Therefore management considers costs associated with acquisitions, including these contractual adjustments to the holdback payable amount, to be non-core.
(14)In 2012, reflected net income attributable to our Barbados operations that was classified as discontinued operations in 2012. This resulted from the sale of our wholly owned subsidiary, which is not considered part of the continued operations of the Bank. Therefore management considers the net income reflected from this discontinued operation to be non-core.
(15)In 2012 and partially in 2013, reflected the cost of an early retirement program offered to reduce staff costs. This program has not been offered since. In 2013, additional expenses reflected payments to Treasury and Operations staff whose roles were made redundant as a result of the implementation of a new core banking software. In 2014, a strategic cost program led to a review of work being done in several non-management roles in Guernsey resulted in these roles being made redundant, and therefore costs as shown reflect payments to these non-management staff whose roles were affected. In 2015, predominantly reflected the cost of negotiated packages for three executives who stepped down from their positions during the year. In 2016, reflected payments to non-executive management staff whose roles were made redundant resulting from a span of control review. Management does not consider the costs associated with these projects to be core to the strategy of the business.
(16)In 2012, reflected the amount by which the net present value of the Bank's lease obligations exceeded the expected rent receipts which resulted in the recognition of an onerous lease charge. This charge was a result of a specific lease and is therefore an isolated expense which management does not consider as part of the normal course of business. Therefore, management considers this amount to be non-core.
(17)In each of the periods reflected costs associated with a review and account remediation exercise to determine the US tax

67

TABLE OF CONTENTS

compliance status of US person account holders linked to the publically announced so called Jon Doe Summonses in November 2013 issued by the US Attorney's Office for the Southern District of New York to six US financial institutions with which the Bank had correspondent banking relationships. These expenses are a result of exceptional circumstances which arose outside of the normal course of business.

(18)In 2015 and 2016, reflected a provision associated with the aforementioned review and account remediation exercise referenced in the above footnote. Although the Bank is unable to determine the amount of financial consequences, fine and/or penalties resulting from this tax compliance review, this reflects a provision which management believes to be appropriate. These expenses are a result of exceptional circumstances which arose outside of the normal course of business.
(19)In 2015 and 2016, reflected contract negotiation, due diligence and IT implementation costs relating to the acquisition of the Bermuda Trust Company Ltd and the private banking investment management of operations of HSBC Bank Bermuda Limited; in 2014, reflected legal, due diligence and costs for temporary staff assisting with integration relating to the acquisitions of Legis and of select deposits and loans from HSBC Bank Cayman Limited. As above, due to the limited nature of acquisitions, management does not consider the costs associated with these acquisitions to a part of normal course of business. Therefore management considers costs associated with acquisitions, specifically including the costs associated with negotiation and integration of operations, to be non-core.
(20)In 2015 and 2016, reflected costs associated with the orderly wind down of the deposit taking, investment management and custody businesses of Butterfield Bank (UK) Limited which included staff redundancy expenses and professional fees. These expenses are a result of exceptional circumstances which arose outside of the normal course of business.
(21)In 2015, reflected professional and legal fees related to the investigation of an international stock exchange listing for the Bank's common shares. This investigation was undertaken in an effort to provide a means for liquidity for the Bank's shareholders, and was therefore not in the normal course of business. Accordingly, management considers the expenses associated with this investigation to be non-core.
(22)In 2016, reflected the expense for the vesting of the outstanding 2010 Performance Options resulting from the IPO which led to a $8.5 million salaries and other employee benefits expense, and a related payroll tax expense of $0.3 million. Management does not consider these expenses to be core to the strategy of the business.
(23)Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.

68

TABLE OF CONTENTS

INFORMATION ABOUT THE COMPANY

Overview

We are a full service bank and wealth manager headquartered in Hamilton, Bermuda. We operate our business through six geographic segments: Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, and Guernsey, where our principal banking operations are located; and The Bahamas, Switzerland, and the United Kingdom, where we offer specialized financial services. We offer banking services, comprised of retail and corporate banking, and wealth management, which consists of trust, private banking, and asset management. In our Bermuda and Cayman Islands segments, we offer both banking and wealth management. In our Guernsey, Bahamas, and Switzerland segments, we offer wealth management. In our United Kingdom segment, we offer residential property lending.

Our total net revenue by each of our six geographic segments for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 are as follows:

 
For the year ended
December 31,
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
2014
Net Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bermuda segment
$
231.4
 
$
202.5
 
$
201.0
 
Cayman Islands segment
$
121.0
 
$
105.8
 
$
91.9
 
Guernsey segment
$
39.0
 
$
43.1
 
$
46.1
 
United Kingdom segment
$
6.0
 
$
19.3
 
$
26.4
 
Bahamas segment
$
4.7
 
$
5.3
 
$
5.5
 
Switzerland segment
$
3.8
 
$
3.4
 
$
2.5
 

As of December 31, 2016, we had $11.1 billion in total assets, $3.6 billion in net loans, $10.0 billion in customer deposits (67% USD deposits, 18% USD-pegged deposits), $98.0 billion of trust assets under administration (“AUA”), and $4.7 billion of assets under management (“AUM”).

In our Bermuda and Cayman Islands segments, our bank provides a full range of retail and corporate banking services to individuals, local businesses, captive insurers, reinsurance companies, trust companies, and hedge funds. The key products we offer include personal and business deposit services, residential and commercial mortgages, small and medium-sized enterprise and corporate loans, credit and debit card suite, merchant acquiring, mobile / online banking, and cash management. With seven branches and 51 ATMs as of December 31, 2016, we have a 39% Bermudian Dollar (“BMD”) deposit market share in Bermuda and a 35% local deposit market share in the Cayman Islands as of December 31, 2015 based on data from the Bermuda Monetary Authority (“BMA”) and the Cayman Islands Monetary Authority (“CIMA”), respectively. We were named “Bermuda Bank of the Year” and “Cayman Bank of the Year” in 2013, 2014 and 2015, and once again “Bermuda Bank of the Year” in 2016 by The Banker and “Best Developed Market Bank in Bermuda” by Global Finance in 2015 and 2016.

In all of our segments except the United Kingdom, we offer wealth management to high net worth and ultra-high net worth individuals, family offices, and institutional and corporate clients. Our wealth management platform has three lines of business: trust, private banking, and asset management. The wealth management business has received a number of industry awards from Euromoney, the Society of Trust and Estate Practitioners (“STEP”), Citiwealth, PWM/The Banker, and Global Finance, including “Trust Company of the Year” at the STEP Private Client Awards in 2015 and “Best Private Bank 2015, Bermuda” by both PWM/The Banker and Global Finance in 2015.

The trust business line, which utilizes specialists in each of our geographic areas, meets client needs in estate and succession planning, administration of complex asset holdings, and efficient coordination of family affairs. In addition, the business provides pension and employee benefits services for multinational corporations, as well as services that involve administration of and fiduciary responsibility for customized trust structures holding a wide range of asset types including financial assets, property, business assets, and art. As of December 31, 2016, trust AUA totaled $98.0 billion.

Our private banking business line offers access to a suite of services, targeted toward high net worth individuals, trusts, and family offices, that can be customized to each client's needs and preferences and

69

TABLE OF CONTENTS

delivered as part of a coordinated strategy by a dedicated private banker. We provide clients in our Bermuda, Cayman Islands, and Guernsey segments with an integrated model that combines traditional wealth management with banking, lending, cash management, foreign exchange services, custody and access to asset management and trust professionals within Butterfield. We also provide our clients with immediate access to their account information through the use of internet banking. As of December 31, 2016, total deposits and loans in our private banking business were $3.3 billion and $0.9 billion, respectively.

Our asset management business line provides a broad range of portfolio management services to institutional and private clients. Our target client base includes institutions such as pension funds and captive insurance companies with investable assets over $10 million and private clients such as high net worth individuals, families, and trusts with investable assets over $1 million. Our principal services include discretionary investment management, managed portfolio services, money market, and mutual fund offerings. We also offer advisory and self-directed brokerage options. Over 90% of the business's discretionary investment mandates call for balanced growth to conservative allocations. We focus on delivery of reasonable appreciation with an emphasis on capital preservation. The Bank relies on well-recognized and leading third parties to provide research and investment management expertise, while our own services are concentrated on portfolio construction and managing client relationships. We also provide customized reporting to meet specific needs of our major clients. As of December 31, 2016 our asset management AUM were $4.7 billion.

From 2012 to 2016, our GAAP net income to common shareholders and our core net income to common shareholders (“Core Net Income to Common”) had compound annual growth rates (“CAGRs”) of 67% and 35%, respectively(1). These results were achieved despite a low interest rate environment. We attribute this financial performance to the attractive markets in our segments, leading position in those markets, strong operating discipline, conservative balance sheet deployment, and ability to grow our award-winning wealth management business. Our earnings generation has allowed us to build capital to return to shareholders and invest strategically, both organically and through acquisitions, to further enhance the growth prospects of our Company. We aim to continue to build excess capital in the future, which we can redeploy into growing our business and return to shareholders.

70

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following charts show the trajectory of our performance from 2012 to 2016:


(1)Core Net Income to Common is a non-GAAP financial measure that is calculated by adjusting net income for income or expense items which management considers not to be representative of the ongoing operations of our business and preference share dividends, guarantee fees and premiums paid on preference share buybacks and redemptions. For a reconciliation of Core Net Income to Common to GAAP net income to common, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data – Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.
(2)Core Earnings per Common Share Fully Diluted is a non-GAAP financial measure that is calculated by dividing Core Earnings to Common by the weighted average shares outstanding. For a reconciliation of Core Earnings per Common Share Fully Diluted to GAAP earnings per share, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data – Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.

71

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Our History

The origin of The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited traces back to 1758, to the founding of the trading firm of Nathaniel Butterfield. In 1858, our company was established as a bank in Bermuda and has been instrumental to the local economy ever since. The Bank was later incorporated under a special act of the local Parliament in 1904. In the 1960s, as international businesses began contributing substantially to Bermuda's economy, we developed services to meet their needs. In 1967, we opened offices in the Cayman Islands and by the 1980s had expanded our operations to include retail banking, investment management, and fund administration. In 1973, we opened our Guernsey office in order to provide customers with access to the Pound Sterling after Bermuda's departure from the British Sterling zone. In addition to being Bermuda's first bank, we have a long history of innovating financial services on the island: we opened the first ATMs in Bermuda in the 1980s and launched Bermuda's first internet banking service in 2001. In 1998, we listed our common shares on the Bermuda Stock Exchange under the ticker symbol “NTB.BH”. In 2016, we listed our common shares on the New York Stock Exchange under the ticker symbol “NTB”.

In 2008 and 2009, as a result of the global financial crisis, we realized losses attributable primarily to US non-agency mortgage backed securities in our investment portfolio, as well as write-downs on local market hospitality loans. To raise capital to offset these losses, the Bank executed a $200 million preference share offering in June 2009. In 2009 and 2010, we implemented a comprehensive restructuring plan for the Company: we hired a new management team, de-risked our balance sheet, and raised $550 million of common equity from a group of investors that included Carlyle Global Financial Services and related entities (collectively, “The Carlyle Group” or “Carlyle”) and Canadian Imperial Bank of Commerce (“CIBC”), as well as existing shareholders. As part of the transaction, we launched a rights offering of $130 million on April 12, 2010, so as to allow the pre-transaction shareholders to participate in the recapitalization of the Company. The rights offering, which closed on May 12, 2010, was fully subscribed to, and the proceeds were used to repurchase shares from the recapitalization investors. As a result, the recapitalization investors' total investment was reduced to $420 million.

Since our restructuring, we have pursued a strategy to focus on our core strengths in banking and wealth management. We have executed upon our strategy by streamlining the Company's operations through exiting non-core markets, repositioning our balance sheet, investing in efficiency initiatives, and continuing to invest in our core business lines to grow both organically and through acquisitions. By following this strategy, we have significantly improved our financial results including growing Core Earnings to Common every year since 2011 and have been able to initiate a capital return policy for investors. The following items were key steps in executing our strategy:

In 2010, we sold our operations in Hong Kong and Malta, and in 2012, we sold our operations in Barbados as they were no longer consistent with our strategy.
In 2010, we sold $820 million of asset-backed securities to cleanse our investment portfolio.
In 2013, we implemented an annual cash dividend of $0.40 per year plus a $0.10 per year special dividend.
In 2014, we completed two acquisitions, which allowed us to both expand and complement our existing business lines: Legis Group Holdings' Guernsey-based trust and corporate services business as well as a significant portion of HSBC's corporate and retail banking business in the Cayman Islands.
In April 2015, CIBC sold its 19% ownership stake. We repurchased and retired 8 million shares for a total of $120 million, and The Carlyle Group purchased CIBC's remaining 2.3 million shares and subsequently sold them to other existing investors.
In December 2015, we repositioned our balance sheet to better match the duration of our assets and liabilities and to reclassify a portion of our Available for Sale (“AFS”) portfolio as Held to Maturity (“HTM”).
In February 2016, we commenced an orderly wind down (“OWD”) of our UK operations. We exited our private banking and asset management operations in our UK segment, but retain our UK high net worth mortgage lending business. The OWD was largely completed by the end of

72

TABLE OF CONTENTS

2016 with the change in the business operations to mortgage lending services and the change of name from UK operations to Butterfield Mortgages Limited. The excess capital in the UK was released early in 2017, which we intend to invest in other areas of our business.

In April 2016, we completed an acquisition of HSBC's Bermuda trust business and private banking investment management operations that added $1.6 billion of deposits to our balance sheet. As part of the transaction, HSBC also entered into an agreement to refer its existing private banking clients to Butterfield.
In September 2016, we successfully completed a $288 million initial public offering and listing on the New York Stock Exchange, through which we raised approximately $126 million in net primary proceeds.
In December 2016, we redeemed and canceled all of our outstanding preference shares, which had a book value of $183 million, removing approximately $16 million of annual preference dividend and guarantee fees. We also repurchased for cancellation the outstanding warrant from the Government of Bermuda, removing a potentially dilutive instrument.

Our Markets

Our two largest segments are Bermuda and the Cayman Islands. As of December 31, 2016, 59% of our total assets were held by our Bermuda segment and 29% by our Cayman Islands segment. Bermuda is our largest segment by number of employees, and we are the country's largest independent bank. As of December 31, 2016, our Bermuda segment had $6.8 billion of assets, $50.1 billion of trust AUA and $3.4 billion of AUM, and our Cayman Islands segment had $3.4 billion of assets, $4.0 billion of trust AUA and $0.8 billion of AUM.

The charts below provide the geographic distribution of our Net Revenue for the year ended December 31, 2016.


Bermuda is a leading international financial center and a global hub for reinsurers, captive insurers, and other multi-national corporations. Foreign currency assets held by local banks totaled $18 billion in 2015, more than three times gross domestic product (“GDP”) for the same period. According to a 2015 report from the Federal Insurance Office of the US Department of the Treasury, Bermuda is the domicile for 15 of the world's 40 largest reinsurance groups and accounts for 11% of global reinsurance premiums written and 15% of global property & casualty reinsurance premiums written. Bermuda's captive insurance market includes approximately 750 captive insurers according to a 2015 report by the Bermuda

73

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Monetary Authority. Home to a population of approximately 66,000, the country had the second highest GDP per capita income in the world in 2015 at approximately $92,500 and a nominal GDP of $5.7 billion according to The Economist.

The Cayman Islands is also a leading international financial center, serving as the leading domicile for hedge funds globally and the second largest domicile (after Bermuda) for captive insurers globally. Total deposits held by banks equaled $12 billion as of 2015, or more than three times GDP for 2015. As of December 31, 2016, there were 10,586 regulated mutual funds registered in the Cayman Islands with 106 mutual fund administrators according to CIMA. We hold business relationships with approximately 650 funds, fund administrators, and related entities. Home to a population of approximately 60,000, the country had a 2015 GDP per capita of approximately $56,100 and a nominal GDP of $9.2 billion according to the Cayman Islands' Annual Economic Report.

The table below highlights the relative position of Bermuda and the Cayman Islands compared to the US and UK based on several macroeconomic factors:

Comparison of Selected 2015 Macroeconomic Indicators(1)

 
Bermuda
Cayman Islands
USA
UK
GDP per Capita (in thousands of $)
$
92.5
 
$
56.1
 
$
55.9
 
$
44.2
 
Unemployment
 
7.0
%
 
4.2
%
 
5.3
%
 
5.4
%
Consumer Price Inflation
 
1.4
%
 
(2.3
)%
 
0.1
%
 
0.1
%
(1)Source: The Economist, 2015 Bermuda Labour Force Survey Executive Report, and The Cayman Islands' Labour Force Survey Report Fall 2015

The international trust market is primarily concentrated in select jurisdictions, including Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, Guernsey, Hong Kong, Jersey, Singapore, and Switzerland. The leading international trust law firms serve as key introducers of clients to Butterfield and are the primary source of new business. Trust clients often hold assets that are international in nature, and as a result, performance of trust businesses is not generally linked to performance of the domestic economies where clients are served.

The private banking market in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, and Guernsey is composed largely of resident high net worth individuals meeting minimum deposit and/or loan thresholds. Clients are introduced to the private bank through Butterfield's retail banking operation upon reaching the appropriate deposit or loan threshold, Butterfield's trust and asset management arms, as well as through external introducers. Although locally based, private banking clients often hold international assets, and as a result, business performance is not necessarily correlated to the domestic economies where clients are served.

Our asset management business line operates in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, and Guernsey. As of December 31, 2016, 73% of our AUM was in Bermuda, 18% was in the Cayman Islands and 8% was in Guernsey. In Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, a majority of our institutional and private clients are domestic from a domicile perspective while a majority of our clients in Guernsey are tied to our trust business and are international in nature.

Our Competitive Strengths

Leading Bank in Attractive Markets

We are a leading bank in Bermuda with a 39% market share in BMD deposits and a 36% market share in BMD loans, respectively, as of December 31, 2015 (Source: BMA). In the Cayman Islands, we have a 35% market share in local deposits and a 25% market share in local mortgages as of December 31, 2015 (Source: CIMA). The Bermuda and Cayman Islands banking markets have historically been characterized by a limited number of participants and significant barriers to entry. In addition, these markets provide us with access to several attractive customer bases: in retail banking, we serve local residents and businesses; in corporate banking, we serve captive insurers, hedge funds, middle-market reinsurers, and other corporates; and in wealth management, we serve private trust clients

74

TABLE OF CONTENTS

and ultra-high net worth and high net worth individuals and families. Our market share, scale, history, and brand in our Bermuda and Cayman Islands segments have enabled us to achieve our strategic objectives, including lending at attractive margins, attracting low cost, sticky deposits, and growing our wealth management business, all of which have driven our earnings and capital generation.

Strong Capital Generation and Return

Since our recapitalization, we have streamlined our business by exiting non-core markets, executing on various operating efficiency initiatives, shifting the risk profile of our loan and securities portfolios, running off our legacy loan and securities portfolios, and deploying our excess capital in the form of dividends and share repurchases. Our return on equity for 2016 of approximately 9% and our Core ROATCE for 2016 of approximately 21% were driven by a number of factors, including: significant fee income with historically low capital requirements, low cost deposits, a high yielding loan portfolio, a conservative capital efficient securities portfolio, and operations in corporate income tax neutral jurisdictions. As a result, our business generated core net income in 2016 well in excess of that needed to execute our organic balance sheet growth strategy.


(1)Core ROATCE is a non-GAAP financial measure that is calculated by dividing core earnings to common shareholders by average tangible common equity. Average tangible common equity does not include the preference shareholders' equity or goodwill and intangible assets. For more information on the non-GAAP financial measures, see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.

75

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Growth Opportunities

We expect that, all else being equal, a rising rate environment would increase our net interest income before provision for credit losses because an increase in our cost of deposits would lag an increase in yield of our securities and loans. In addition, a significant portion of our deposits are non-interest bearing (24% as of December 31, 2016), and as a result, a portion of our funding is insensitive to rising rates. Our non-interest bearing deposit balances have historically exhibited low correlation with interest rates, a behavior that we attribute in part to a sizeable client base that utilizes our bank for cash management purposes. Potential changes to our net interest income in hypothetical rising and declining rate scenarios, measured over a 12-month period, are presented in the chart below (these projections assume parallel shifts of the yield curves occurring immediately and no changes in other potential variables):


A down 100 basis points interest rate shock shows a reduction in projected 12-month net interest income of 8.9% from the flat scenario. The loss of income is driven by lower loan and investment yields, which more than offset reduced rates paid on deposits. Mitigating against the loss of income is the potential to charge negative interest rates on deposits (which we currently do in some instances) and certain loans that have rate floors.

In addition, we are well-positioned as an acquirer of certain businesses, primarily in wealth management. Our acquisition strategy seeks to capitalize on opportunities created by international financial institutions that have faced operating issues requiring them to simplify their businesses. We consider a wide range of potential acquisition opportunities, and we have a well-defined, disciplined approach to identifying potential acquisition targets across numerous criteria including: geography, business alignment, size, timing, quality, buyer universe and financial hurdles. Our recent focus has been primarily on the private trust business where we have expertise, scale and a strong brand.

In 2014, we completed two acquisitions that allowed us to both expand and complement our existing businesses. In April 2014, we completed the acquisition of Legis Group’s Guernsey-based trust and corporate services business. The transaction enhanced the scale of our international trust capabilities and fortified our position as a leading player in Guernsey. In November 2014, we acquired select deposits and loans in the Cayman Islands from HSBC. At close, the transaction added approximately $0.5 billion of customer deposits with an average cost of 0.12%, and $144 million of loans.

In April 2016, we acquired HSBC’s Bermuda trust business and private banking investment management operations. HSBC also entered into an agreement to refer its existing private banking clients to Butterfield. This acquisition added over $18.9 billion of trust AUA, $1.3 billion of AUM, and $1.6 billion of deposits.

76

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Efficient Balance Sheet and Visible Earnings

Our relationship-driven business model and international corporate clientele have allowed us to develop a sticky deposit base with historically low funding costs. We believe our customers’ deposit activity has historically been inelastic to deposit pricing given the nature of corporate activity and competition in retail deposit taking in our segments. From 2012 to 2016, customer deposits have grown at a CAGR of approximately 14% in Bermuda and 12% in the Cayman Islands, taking into account the HSBC Cayman acquisition in November 2014 that added $0.5 billion of new deposits, and the April 2016 acquisition of HSBC’s Bermuda trust business and private banking investment management operations that added $1.6 billion of new deposits. As of December 31, 2016, we had $10.0 billion in deposits at a cost of 0.12%, of which 24% were non-interest bearing demand deposits, 58% were interest bearing demand deposits with a weighted-average cost of 0.07%, and 18% were term deposits with a weighted-average cost of 0.47% and an average maturity of 80 days. We believe the market conditions in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands will allow us to continue to benefit from favorable deposit pricing.

The following chart shows deposit trends for 2012 to 2016:


77

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Historically, the markets in which we operate generate fewer loans than deposits, which has led us to take a conservative approach to managing our balance sheet. We accomplish this by maintaining a large cash balance and investing in high quality and liquid securities. The following chart illustrates our asset composition as of December 31, 2016:


As of December 31, 2016, 19% of our balance sheet was cash and cash equivalents, which included cash and demand deposits with banks, unrestricted term deposits, certificates of deposits, and treasury bills with a maturity less than three months.

In addition to maintaining a large cash balance, we also have a large securities investment portfolio. We have a disciplined investment portfolio selection process and invest in highly rated securities. We also seek to ensure that our portfolio remains liquid across market cycles: 79% of our portfolio was invested in US government treasuries and mortgage-backed securities issued by US governmental agencies. Our investment strategy aims to align the interest rate risk profile of our assets and liabilities — as of December 31, 2016, the average duration of our AFS investment portfolio was 2.5 years, the average duration of our HTM investment portfolio was 6.3 years, and the average duration of our total investment portfolio was 3.4 years.

78

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following charts show the composition of our investment portfolio by rating and asset type as of December 31, 2016:


The combination of our significant cash and securities portfolios helps drive our capital efficient balance sheet, with risk-weighted assets equal to 39% of our total assets and a Basel III total capital ratio of 17.6%, each as of December 31, 2016.

Our loan underwriting process requires that we complete a full credit assessment of every customer prior to committing to a loan, which we believe has resulted in a high quality loan portfolio. Our lending markets do not have secondary markets for loans and as such we hold all of our originated loans on our balance sheet. In 2015 and 2016, net charge-offs represented 0.2% and 0.3%, respectively, of average loans. As of December 31, 2016, our non-accrual loan balance was $48.5 million, or 1.3% of total loans, and 84% of our loans past due were full recourse residential mortgages. As of December 31, 2016, our loan portfolio consisted of 94% floating-rate loans and 6% fixed-rate loans.

79

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following chart shows the segment composition of our loan portfolio as of December 31, 2016:


Our loan portfolio has exhibited stability over time. The following chart shows loan portfolio trends for 2012 to 2016:


80

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The domestic lending markets in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands have a limited number of participants and significant barriers to entry. 65.2% of our loan balances were residential mortgages as of December 31, 2016. These loans are attractive for a number of reasons. The average yield on new residential mortgage originations in our Bermuda and Cayman segment in the fourth quarter of 2016 was 4.47%, which we believe is consistent with other firms that compete in our markets. In addition, our mortgages have exhibited predictable cash flows, with historically negligible refinancing activity due to high costs to refinance in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands. Finally, our mortgages have historically benefited from a manual underwriting process, low LTVs (67% of residential loans below 70% LTV as of December 31, 2016), and a full recourse system in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands.

We have also generated balanced sources of non-interest income from a well-diversified customer base. For the five year period ended December 31, 2016, our non-interest income is evenly split between banking which consists of banking and foreign exchange revenue, and wealth management, which consists of trust, asset management, and custody and other administration services. The wealth management non-interest income stream is not directly correlated with the performance of our banking business. For example, the typical trust we manage generates a relatively constant fee stream on an annual basis throughout its life. In addition, because fee revenue in our wealth management business lines is primarily driven by the size of our clients’ assets and holdings, which are generally diversified across multiple geographies, the performance of these businesses is not typically linked to the economies of our local markets. Non-interest income represented 36% of our total Net Revenue in 2016, and contributed materially to the Company’s high Core ROATCE and excess capital generation as limited capital is required for our fee income business.

The following chart shows our various sources of non-interest income for the year ended December 31, 2016:


(1)Foreign exchange revenue represents income generated from client-driven transactions in the normal course of business. We do not engage in proprietary trading.

81

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Strong Leadership with Deep Knowledge of Our Domestic and International Markets

Our management team has extensive and varied experience managing banking and financial services firms. We believe that our management team’s reputation and performance track record gives us an advantage in executing our organic growth and acquisition strategies.

Name
Title
Joined
Butterfield
Prior Experience
Years of
Experience
Michael Collins
Chief Executive Officer
2009
COO of HSBC Bermuda
31
Michael Schrum
Chief Financial Officer
2015
CFO of HSBC Bermuda
21
Daniel Frumkin
Chief Risk Officer
2010
CRO of Retail Banking at RBS
30
Robert Moore
Group Head of Trust
1997
Senior Manager of International Private
Banking with Lloyds
38
Michael Neff
Group Head of Wealth Management
2011
Global Head of
Wealth Management
at RiskMetrics
29

In addition to his role as CEO, Michael Collins serves as a member of our Board. Barclay Simmons, our Non-Executive Chairman since 2015, joined our Board in 2011 and was named Vice Chairman in 2012. We have seven additional non-executive directors, who bring to the Bank a diverse array of experiences in the financial services industry from across the globe.

Our Strategy

Butterfield is both a leading banking business in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands and a growing, award-winning, and international wealth management business with operations in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, Guernsey, The Bahamas, and Switzerland. Our strategy focuses on maintaining our leading banking position in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands while continuing to grow scale in our wealth management business across our core geographies. The key components of our strategic plan are:

Banking

Leverage Our Leading Market Position

We seek to remain a leading bank in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands in terms of local deposit and lending market share by continuing to provide excellent service, employ a high-quality work force, and offer a competitive product suite to our customers.

Improve Operating Efficiency

Our banking business operates in geographies with high operational costs. We carefully manage our cost structure to improve efficiency through the deployment of technology and continuous process improvement. We expect continued investments in core banking systems and expansion of electronic channels in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, as well as upgrades in Guernsey, to result in improved operational efficiency.

Wealth Management

Leverage Relationships with Key Introducers

We have over 70 years of experience providing sophisticated trust services and an award-winning brand that was named 2015 “Trust Company of the Year” by STEP. We believe that our reputation and expertise are well-recognized by industry insiders, including the leading international trust law firms. These firms act as a key source of new business for trust services. We plan to leverage our relationships with key introducers to continue to grow our company and build our brand, as well as invest in the further development of our technical expertise and multi-jurisdictional offering. Our recent trust acquisitions have grown the size and reach of our business. As we continue to grow through organic and inorganic means, we believe that our business will increasingly benefit from referrals by key introducers.

82

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Utilize Multi-Jurisdictional Offerings to Attract Client Base

We seek to take advantage of our presence, seasoned trust officers, and product offerings in key international financial centers in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, Guernsey, The Bahamas, and Switzerland to attract our target client base. International trust law varies across different jurisdictions, and our multi-jurisdictional presence enables us to cater to a variety of client preferences from a geographical perspective. In recent years, we have experienced increased demand for trust services from our European, Asian, Latin American, and Middle Eastern clients. We view our trust business line as an opportunity for further growth.

Emphasize Strong Client Relationships

Our primary focus is to build strong client relationships using our knowledge of the local market and combining our banking and wealth management services to meet the financial needs of our customers. We believe our experience in building strong, long-term client relationships in our wealth management business will enable us to retain our existing clients and attract additional trust, private banking, and asset management business from them, as well as receive referrals to potential new clients. In addition, our wealth management business sources customers and benefits from the strong relationships we have in our banking business.

Expand Revenues from Client Relationships Across Our Wealth Management Services

We believe that there is an opportunity to increase the revenues generated from client relationships across our wealth management business lines. For example, we seek to create personal banking and wealth management relationships with the professionals for whom we provide corporate banking services. In addition, trust relationships, which are very long lived, can present opportunities for use of other Butterfield services at different stages of a trust's lifecycle or to meet needs of family members outside the trust itself.

Client relationships from our recent acquisitions represent another area of opportunity to expand Butterfield services and products for high net worth customers and certain corporate and institutional clients. Through the acquisition of HSBC's Bermuda trust business and private banking investment management operations, we migrated 285 new relationships and $1.6 billion of deposits onto our platform.

Improve Operating Efficiency

We continue to identify areas where we can improve cost efficiency without impacting our quality of client service. Past initiatives have included implementation of one global Trust Administration system across segments, implementation of a new custody system, consolidation of our trading operations, and reduction in our fund administration expenses through consolidation.

Pursue Prudent Acquisitions to Increase Scale

We intend to continue pursuing acquisitions aligned with existing business operations, in particular to increase the scale of our trust business line. The fragmented nature of the market, with approximately 500 trust companies operating in key international financial centers, and recent sales of subsidiaries by several international financial institutions have created a favorable environment for companies with the resources and expertise to act as effective consolidators. We believe that our management team has developed a rigorous approach for conducting due diligence and efficiently integrating acquired businesses to meet our internal financial hurdles. In addition, we may pursue acquisitions of other wealth management businesses, including private banking businesses, and we plan to continue to opportunistically analyze potential acquisitions as a means of capital deployment.

83

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Our International Network and Group Structure

The following map presents the several geographic regions in which our business operates:


The following chart presents our corporate structure, indicating our principal subsidiaries as of December 31, 2016:


Bermuda

The Bank itself is licensed in Bermuda to provide banking services and wealth management services. Through its wholly owned Bermuda subsidiary Butterfield Asset Management Limited it provides asset management services and through its wholly owned Bermuda subsidiaries Butterfield Trust (Bermuda) Limited and Butterfield Trust Company Limited it provides corporate trustee, fiduciary and corporate administration services. Bermuda Securities (Bermuda) Limited provides investment advisory and listing sponsor services.

84

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Cayman Islands

Butterfield Bank (Cayman) Limited, a wholly owned subsidiary of the Bank, provides banking services and its subsidiary Butterfield Trust (Cayman) Limited provides trustee, fiduciary and corporate administration services.

Guernsey

Butterfield Bank (Guernsey) Ltd. is a wholly owned subsidiary of the Bank and provides private banking, custody and administered banking services. Butterfield Trust (Guernsey) Ltd. is a subsidiary of Butterfield Bank (Guernsey) Ltd. and provides trustee and fiduciary services.

Bahamas

Butterfield Trust (Bahamas) Limited is a wholly owned subsidiary of the Bank and provides trust and fiduciary services.

Switzerland

Butterfield Holdings (Switzerland) Limited is a wholly owned subsidiary of the Bank and provides investment services and through its subsidiary Butterfield Trust (Switzerland) Limited provides trust and fiduciary services.

United Kingdom

Butterfield Mortgages Limited is a wholly owned subsidiary of the Bank and provides residential property lending services.

Competition

The financial services industry and each of the markets in which we operate are competitive. We face strong competition in gathering deposits, making loans and obtaining client assets for management. We compete, both domestically and internationally, with globally oriented asset managers, retail and commercial banks, investment banking firms, brokerage firms and other investment service firms. Due to the trend toward consolidation in the global financial services industry, our larger competitors tend to have broader ranges of product and service offerings, increased access to capital, and greater efficiency. Larger financial institutions may also have greater ability to leverage increasing regulatory requirements and investment in expensive technology platforms. We also face competition from non-banking financial institutions. These institutions have the ability to offer services previously limited to commercial banks. In addition, non-banking financial institutions are not subject to the same regulatory restrictions as banks, and can often operate with greater flexibility and lower cost structures.

The Bermuda banking segment currently consists of four licensed banks and one licensed deposit-taking institution including one large subsidiary of an international bank, HSBC, and three domestic institutions, including Bermuda Commercial Bank and Clarien Bank. In the Cayman Islands, the Bank is one of six Class 'A' full service retail banks licensed to conduct business with domestic and international clients. There are also five non-retail Class 'A' banks and 148 limited service Class 'B' banks, including Cayman National and subsidiaries of international banks, such as RBC. In certain interest rate environments, additional significant competition for deposits may be expected to arise from corporate and government debt securities and money market mutual funds. We view HSBC in Bermuda and RBC in the Cayman Islands as our most significant competitors.

In our wealth management business line, we face competition from local competitors as well as larger financial institutions including financial institutions that are not based in the markets in which we operate. Revenues from the trust and wealth management business depend in large part on the level of assets under management, and larger international banks may have higher levels of assets under management.

In our trust business line, we face competition primarily from other specialized trust service providers. There are approximately 500 trust companies in the main international financial centers, and many of our competitors in this sector offer fund administration and corporate services work alongside private client fiduciary services.

85

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Competition for deposits is also affected by the ease with which customers can transfer deposits from one institution to another. Our cost of funds fluctuates with market interest rates and may be affected by higher rates being offered by other financial institutions. Our management believes that our most direct competition for deposits comes from international and domestic financial services firms that target the same customers as the Bank.

Deposits

We are a deposit-led institution with leading market share in our primary segments: Bermuda and the Cayman Islands. We strive to maintain deposit growth and to maintain a strong liquidity profile through a significant excess of deposits over loans through market cycles.

Our deposits are generated principally by our banking business line, which offers retail and corporate checking, savings, and term deposits through our segments in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands and Guernsey. In addition, wealth management, through its private banking business line, also provides deposit services to high net worth and ultra-high net worth clients in those same geographic segments. As of December 31, 2016, our Bermuda, Cayman Islands and Guernsey segments contributed $5.9 billion, $3.0 billion and $1.0 billion, respectively, to our total customer deposit base. Deposits from all other segments totaled $0.1 billion as of December 31, 2016.

Total deposits as of December 31, 2016 were $10.0 billion, up 9.3% over total deposits as of December 31, 2015. Customer demand deposits, which include checking, savings and call accounts, totaled $8.2 billion, or 81.9% of customer deposits, as of December 31, 2016, compared to $7.7 billion, or 84%, as of December 31, 2015. Customer term deposits totaled $1.8 billion as of December 31, 2016. The cost of funds on total deposits improved from 21 basis points in 2015 to 12 basis points as of December 31, 2016 as a result of an increase in non-interest bearing deposits and small rate decreases in some jurisdictions, as well as the full repayment of the UK segment deposits, which carried a relatively higher cost than other jurisdictions.

Lending

We offer a broad set of lending offerings including residential mortgage lending, automobile lending, credit cards consumer financing, and overdraft facilities to our retail customers, and commercial real estate lending, commercial and industrial loans, and overdraft facilities to our commercial and corporate customers. These offerings are provided to our retail, commercial, and private banking clients in our key jurisdictions including Bermuda and the Cayman Islands. We also offer residential mortgage lending through our private banking business in Guernsey and to our high net worth and ultra-high net worth clients in the UK. Our loan portfolio, net of allowance for credit losses stood at $3.6 billion as of December 31, 2016. The loan portfolio represented 32.2% of total assets as of December 31, 2016, and loans, net of allowance for credit losses, as a percentage of customer deposits were 35.7%. The effective yield on total loans for the year ended December 31, 2016 was 4.78%, compared to 4.57% for the year ended December 31, 2015.

Residential Mortgage Lending

The residential mortgage portfolio comprises mortgages to clients with whom we are seeking to establish (or already have) a comprehensive financial services relationship. It includes mortgages to individuals and corporate loans secured by way of first ranking charges over the residential property to which each specific loan relates generally on terms which allow for the repossession and sale of the property if the borrower fails to comply with the terms of the loan. As of December 31, 2016, residential mortgages (after specific allowance for credit losses) totaled $2.3 billion (a $197.5 million decrease from December 31, 2015), accounting for approximately 64.6% of the Group's total gross loan portfolio (after specific allowance for credit losses) and approximately 84.3% of total non-accrual loans in the Group's loan portfolio.

Consumer Lending

We provide loans, as part of our normal banking business, in respect of automobile financing, consumer financing, credit cards and overdraft facilities to retail and private banking clients in the

86

TABLE OF CONTENTS

jurisdictions in which we operate. As of December 31, 2016, non-residential loans to consumers (after specific allowance for credit losses) totaled $197.8 million, accounting for approximately 5.5% of the Group's total gross loan portfolio and approximately 2.1% of total non-accrual loans in the Group's loan portfolio.

Commercial Real Estate Lending

Commercial real estate loans are offered to real estate investors, developers and builders domiciled primarily in Bermuda and the United Kingdom. To manage the Group's credit exposure on such loans, the principal collateral is real estate held for commercial purposes and is supported by a registered mortgage. Cash flows from the properties, primarily from rental income, are generally supported by long-term leases.

As of December 31, 2016, our commercial real estate loan portfolio (after specific allowance for credit losses) totaled $609.8 million, accounting for approximately 16.9% of the Group's total gross loan portfolio and approximately 12.4% of total non-accrual loans in the Group's loan portfolio.

Our commercial real estate loan portfolio is broken down into two categories: commercial mortgage and construction. As of December 31, 2016, commercial mortgages totaled $580.9 million (after allowance for credit losses), and construction loans totaled $28.9 million, accounting for approximately 95.3% and 4.7% of our commercial real estate loan portfolio before allowance for credit losses, respectively.

Other Commercial Lending

The commercial and industrial loan portfolio includes loans and overdraft facilities advanced primarily to corporations and small and medium-sized entities, which are generally not collateralized by real estate and where loan repayments are expected to flow from the operation of the underlying businesses. As of December 31, 2016, the Group's other commercial loan portfolio totaled $469.0 million, accounting for approximately 13.0% of the Group's total gross loan portfolio. As of the same date, the Group's loans to governments totaled $112.4 million, accounting for approximately 3.1% of our loan portfolio. As of December 31, 2016, other commercial loans accounted for approximately 1.2% of our total non-accrual loans, and there were no loans to governments classified as non-accrual loans.

Investments

Given the large customer deposit base commanded in our Bermuda and Cayman Islands operations, and the relatively low volume of lending demand from our customer base, our investment strategy is more important than may be the case for most financial institutions. In recognition of this, we maintain what we believe to be a conservative approach to investments, requiring the purchase of mainly fixed-rate investments in order to manage interest rate risk. Our investment portfolio is mainly comprised of securities issued or guaranteed by the US Government or federal agencies. The securities in which we invest are generally limited to securities that are considered investment grade (i.e., “BBB” and higher by S&P's Financial Services LLC or an equivalent credit rating). Effective July 31, 2012, we entered into an agreement with Alumina pursuant to which Alumina provides investment advisory services to us in respect of our US Treasury and agency portfolio.

As of December 31, 2016, the Group held $4.4 billion in investments, representing approximately 39.6% of total assets.

Cash and Liquidity Management

We operate across multiple currency jurisdictions with pervasive multi-currency products. In our deposit taking jurisdictions—Bermuda, the Cayman Islands and Guernsey—there are currently no dedicated central banks, and no deposit insurance scheme infrastructures (such as the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation in the United States), with the exception of Bermuda, where a deposit insurance scheme has recently been implemented. In addition, we do not have access to borrowing or deposit facilities with the US Federal Reserve or the European Central Bank; therefore, we conservatively manage client deposit balances and the liquidity risk profile of our balance sheets. This involves the retention of significant cash or cash equivalent balances, management of intra-bank counterparty

87

TABLE OF CONTENTS

exposure and management of a significant short-dated US Treasury Bill portfolio. As of December 31, 2016, the cash due from banks of $2.1 billion was comprised primarily of $1.7 billion in interest earning cash equivalents, which are investments with a less than 90 day duration. The remaining amounts were comprised of non-interest earning and interest earning deposits of $0.1 billion and $0.3 billion, respectively.

Foreign Exchange Services

We provide foreign exchange services in the normal course of business in all jurisdictions. The major contributors to foreign exchange revenues are Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, accounting for 90% and 87% of our foreign exchange revenue for the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. We do not maintain a proprietary trading book. Foreign exchange income is generated from client-driven transactions and totaled $30.6 million during the year ended December 31, 2016, compared to $31.9 million for the comparative period in 2015. The $1.3 million period-over-period decrease reflects decreasing client activity and related volumes in retail and institutional foreign exchange flows, as well as increased unrealized gains on client service derivatives held over period ends.

Administration Services

Through our wholly owned trust subsidiaries, we provide custody administration and settlement services to a wide range of internal and external investment clients dealing in global markets. Our custody service currently offers custody settlement and safekeeping services in 40 markets globally, including major markets and smaller, less-developed markets, with principal markets covered being the United States, Canada, Europe and Japan.

Our custody service offers safekeeping services for physical and book-entry assets. Custody for listed securities is conducted through BNYM. Hedge funds, mutual funds and Exchange Trust Funds are held by Brown Brothers Harriman (“BBH”). Trading in investment transactions is settled via our global sub-custodians, BNYM and BBH. Custody services are offered from our Bermuda, Cayman Islands and Guernsey segments and complement core wealth management services offered by other parts of the Group, and we currently anticipate this business to grow generally proportionally with our wealth management business. Clients of our custody service include a wide range of investment funds and other investment vehicles, corporations and trusts whose related banking requirements are provided by the Bank. As such, the custody client base, in addition to delivering a fee based income, also provides cash balances and foreign exchange dealing flows.

Custody fees comprise a basis point charge on the value of Assets Under Custody (“AUC”), which are subject to a minimum level for smaller, less complex portfolios and charged on a reducing scale as AUC values increase. In addition to these fees, custody clients are charged banking transactions fees based on account activity.

Employees

As of December 31, 2016, we had 1,240 employees on a full-time equivalency basis, which included 1,061 full-time employees, 5 part-time employees and 51 temporary employees. As of December 31, 2016, we had 668 employees in Bermuda, 304 employees in the Cayman Islands, 209 employees in Guernsey, 23 employees in the United Kingdom, 28 employees in The Bahamas and 9 employees in Switzerland. We have not experienced any material employment-related issues or interruptions of services due to labor disagreements and are not a party to any collective bargaining agreements.

Information Technology

We devote significant resources to maintain stable, reliable, efficient and scalable information technology systems. We work with our third party vendors to monitor and maximize the efficiency of our use of their applications. We use integrated systems to originate and process loans and deposit accounts, which reduces processing time, improves customer experience and reduces costs. Most customer records are maintained digitally. We are also currently executing several initiatives to enhance our online and mobile banking services to further improve the overall client experience.

88

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Since 2011 we have made significant investment to alignments and banking operations, as well as to make further alignment across the whole Group for products, services, licensing and hosting locations. Currently, our information technology is operationally divided into two platforms: (i) Bermuda and Cayman and (ii) Guernsey, the United Kingdom and the Group Trust. In 2011, our Bermuda and Cayman operations transitioned to a single industry standard technology platform utilizing a predominantly outsourced and supported model hosted in Canada. In late 2013, our Guernsey and UK operations were placed under the Group Technology governance structure with a goal to hub core services in a single location (Guernsey). The process to move to a common platform is currently underway.

Protecting our systems to ensure the safety of our customers' information is critical to our business. We use multiple layers of protection to control access and reduce risk, including conducting a variety of vulnerability and penetration tests on our platforms, systems and applications to reduce the risk that any attacks are successful. To protect against disasters, we have a backup offsite core processing system and recovery plans.

Marketing

Through our Marketing & Communications department, we engage select advertising, branding and promotional companies on an as-needed basis and provide business development and sales support for businesses in all jurisdictions. In support of our banking businesses, we broadly market our products and services through print, broadcast, web and social media advertising in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands. Trust and fiduciary services are marketed primarily to intermediaries through representative attendance at and sponsorship of industry conferences and through print advertising in international trade journals.

Intellectual Property

In the highly competitive banking industry in which we operate, intellectual property is important to the success of our business. We own a variety of trademarks, service marks, trade names and logos and spend time and resources maintaining this intellectual property portfolio. We control access to our intellectual property through license agreements, confidentiality procedures, non-disclosure agreements with third parties, employment agreements and other contractual rights to protect our intellectual property.

Properties

Our corporate headquarters is located at 65 Front Street, Hamilton, Bermuda, HM 12. In addition to our corporate headquarters, we also maintain offices in the Cayman Islands, Guernsey, the United Kingdom, The Bahamas and Switzerland. Additionally, we operate four branch locations in Bermuda and three branch locations in the Cayman Islands.

Legal Proceedings

From time to time, we are a party to various litigation matters incidental to the conduct of our business.

As publicly announced, in November 2013, the USAO applied for and secured the issuance of so-called John Doe Summonses to six US financial institutions with which the Bank had correspondent bank relationships. The purpose of these Summonses was to identify US persons who may have been using our banking, trust, or other services to evade their own tax obligations in the United States. The Bank has been cooperating with the US authorities in their ongoing investigation.

Although we are unable to determine the amount of financial consequences, fines and/or penalties resulting from this tax compliance review, we have recorded as of December 31, 2016, a provision of $5.5 million (December 31, 2015: $4.8 million). As the investigation remains ongoing at this time, the timing and terms of the final resolution, including any fines or penalties, remain uncertain and the financial impact to the Bank could exceed the amount of the provision. In this regard, we note that the US authorities have not approved or commented on the adequacy or reasonableness of the provision. The provision is included on the consolidated balance sheets under other liabilities and on the consolidated statements of operations under other expenses.

89

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Corporate Information

Our principal executive offices are located at 65 Front Street, Hamilton, Bermuda and our telephone number is (441) 295-1111. We maintain a website at www.butterfieldgroup.com. Neither this website nor the information on or accessible through this website is included or incorporated in, or is a part of, this prospectus.

90

TABLE OF CONTENTS

MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

This section presents management's perspective on our financial condition and results of operations. The following discussion and analysis is intended to highlight and supplement data and information presented elsewhere in this prospectus, including the consolidated financial statements and related notes and should be read in conjunction with the accompanying tables and our financial statements included in this prospectus. The consolidated financial statements and notes have been prepared in accordance with GAAP. Certain statements in this discussion and analysis may be deemed to include “forward looking statements” and are based on management's current expectations and are subject to uncertainty and changes in circumstances. Forward looking statements are not historical facts but instead represent only management's belief regarding future events, many of which by their nature are inherently uncertain and outside of management's control. Actual results may differ materially from those included in these statements due to a variety of factors, including worldwide and local economic conditions, success in business retention and obtaining new business and other factors. Factors that could cause these differences are discussed in the sections titled “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements” and “Risk Factors”. For management's considerations and determinations of each non-core item discussed, please see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data—Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures”.

Overview

We are a full service bank and wealth manager headquartered in Hamilton, Bermuda. We operate our business through six geographic segments: Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, and Guernsey, where our principal banking operations are located; and The Bahamas, Switzerland, and the United Kingdom, where we offer specialized financial services. We offer banking services, comprised of retail and corporate banking, and wealth management, which consists of trust, private banking, and asset management. In our Bermuda and Cayman Islands segments, we offer both banking and wealth management. In our Guernsey, Bahamas, and Switzerland segments, we offer wealth management. In our United Kingdom segment, we offer residential property lending.

The following table details our Net Revenue in total and by segment, as well as our total assets, total loans, total deposits, total AUA (which includes trust and custody assets under administration) and AUM for the years ended December 31, 2016, December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014.

 
For the year ended
December 31
 
2016
2015
2014
Net Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
% of Net Revenue from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bermuda segment
 
57.0
%
 
53.4
%
 
53.8
%
Cayman Islands segment
 
29.8
%
 
27.9
%
 
24.6
%
Guernsey segment
 
9.6
%
 
11.4
%
 
12.3
%
United Kingdom segment
 
1.5
%
 
5.1
%
 
7.1
%
Bahamas segment
 
1.2
%
 
1.4
%
 
1.5
%
Switzerland segment
 
0.9
%
 
0.9
%
 
0.7
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(in millions of $)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Summary Balance Sheet
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Assets
 
11,103.5
 
 
10,275.6
 
 
 
 
Total Loans
 
3,570.5
 
 
4,000.2
 
 
 
 
Total Deposits
 
10,033.6
 
 
9,182.1
 
 
 
 
Assets under administration
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Custody and other administration services
 
24,675.4
 
 
39,200.9
 
 
 
 
Trust
 
97,964.2
 
 
81,829.1
 
 
 
 
Assets under management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Butterfield Funds
 
1,808.0
 
 
1,870.9
 
 
 
 
Other assets under management
 
2,884.9
 
 
1,740.6
 
 
 
 

91

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations for the Year Ended December 31, 2016

2016 Overview

In 2016, our net income increased to $115.9 million from $77.7 million in 2015, which was driven by a continued focus on prudent expansion within our core businesses and markets, diligent management of capital, expenses and risks and the successful integration of an acquisition completed in April. While net income increased by $38.2 million to $115.9 million, this increase was further augmented by certain items which management believes are not representative of our financial results, or “non-core”. Excluding these items Core Net Income improved by $24.7 million to $138.6 million, building on our strong capital position with Total and Tier 1 capital ratios of 17.6% and 15.3%, respectively. To enhance common shareholder returns, the Board declared a fourth interim dividend of $0.32 per common share on February 12, 2017. The Board will continue to evaluate capital planning options and the payment of future dividends as warranted, subject to regulatory approval. See “Dividend Policy” and “Risk Factors – Risks Relating to the Common Shares — Holders of our common shares may not receive dividends” elsewhere in this prospectus for further details.

In December 2016, we redeemed all of the issued and outstanding preference shares for cancellation. The cancellation of these preference shares will eliminate approximately $16 million of preference share dividends and guarantee fees annually, which is further accretive to common shareholder equity. The premium paid on this redemption resulted in the slight decrease in both return on common shareholders’ equity and diluted earnings per share to 8.9% from 10.1% and to $1.18 per share from $1.23 per share, respectively in 2016 from 2015, despite the increase in net income. After removing the effects of non-core items, including this premium, the core return on average tangible common equity increased to 20.5% and core EPS (diluted) to $2.48, up from 17.6% and $1.95, respectively, in 2015.

Our balance sheet grew, while the quality of our assets remained strong. Total assets increased by $0.8 billion to $11.1 billion, driven by a $0.8 billion increase in customer deposit levels which were primarily a result of the acquisition of HSBC Bank Bermuda's private banking investment management and trust businesses in April 2016. These increased deposits were reinvested in short-term investments, securities purchased under agreement to resell and investments in securities which grew by $0.1 billion, $0.1 billion and $1.2 billion, respectively, slightly offset by a decrease of $0.2 billion in cash due from banks, while still maintaining our overall liquidity. Our shareholders’ equity decreased slightly, down $39.6 million to $710.7 million which was a result of the full redemption and cancellation of all of the outstanding preference shares, partially offset by the net proceeds from the IPO in September as well as organic growth through net income.

We substantially completed the planned wind down of the deposit taking, investment management and custody businesses in the UK jurisdiction by year-end. This wind down resulted in the full repayment of high-cost deposits, which helped to reduce deposit interest expense. We will continue our UK segment in the form of a mortgage lending business in the UK on a going forward basis. The funding for the mortgage lending business will be provided by other jurisdictions with adequate liquidity.

Key contributors to our 2016 results were as follows:

Profitability: Net income increased $38.2 million (49.1%) to $115.9 million, which was largely attributable to increases in non-interest and net interest income. After eliminating items which management believes are not representative of our financial results, or “non-core”, our core net income further increased $24.7 million to $138.6 million. Increases in non-interest income were largely driven by additional fees earned from new business as a result of the recent acquisition. Increases in net interest income were largely a result of an increase in the balance of the investment portfolio and in short-term investments.

The significant non-core items excluded from core net income are as follows: costs associated with the vesting of a 2010 legacy option plan and related payroll taxes; restructuring charges related to the orderly wind down of the deposit taking and investment management business of our UK segment; compensation costs relating to redundancies and early retirement packages; tax compliance review costs and a provision for a settlement amount arising from this review; and business acquisition costs.

92

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Net interest margin: While NIM decreased by 3 basis points to 245 basis points compared to 248 basis points in 2015, the cost of funding declined by 9 basis points to 12 basis points. The primary driver of the decrease in NIM was a decrease in investment portfolio yields by 21 basis points to 195 basis points due to an average decrease in the long-term yield of US Treasury debt over the year, which was reflected in our portfolio due to the high proportion of our portfolio in adjustable-rate securities. This was augmented by an increase in average holdings in cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments, which carry a lower yield.
Expenses: Total non-interest expenses increased $0.7 million to $285.9 million in 2016 largely due to the items discussed above that management does not believe are representative of our ongoing operations. After removing the effect of these items, core non-interest expenses increased by $8.7 million, from $254.8 million in 2015, to $263.5 million in 2016 as a result of an increase in core salaries as a result of a headcount increase from the recent acquisition and an increase in technology and communication expenses due to higher sourcing costs and higher depreciation, slightly offset by decreases in indirect taxation and decreases in core professional service charges. The core efficiency ratio improved from 66.0% in 2015 to 63.8% in 2016, reflecting the rate of revenue increase over the marginal decrease in core expenses.
Deposits: Customer deposits increased by $842.2 million as of December 31, 2016 due to both organic deposit growth and additional take-on from the recent acquisition in April 2016, while interest bearing deposit costs decreased by 11 basis points from 26 basis points in 2015 to 15 basis points in 2016 primarily due to the repayments of more expensive deposits from our UK segment. Taken together with non-interest bearing deposits totaling $2.4 billion on December 31, 2016, the average cost of deposits for the year decreased by nine basis points to 12 basis points.
Loan quality: As of December 31, 2016, we had gross non-accrual loans of $48.5 million representing 1.3% of total gross loans, reflecting an improvement from the $65.3 million, or 1.6%, of total loans at year-end 2015. Net non-accrual loans were $36.7 million, equivalent to 1.0% of net loans, after specific provisions of $11.7 million, reflecting an improved specific provision coverage ratio of 24.2%, up from 29.3% on December 31, 2015.

Market Environment

Our business is affected by national, regional and local economic conditions, as well as the perception of those conditions and future economic prospects. The significant macro-economic factors that impact our business include the US and global economic landscapes, unemployment rates, the housing markets and interest rates. The global economy continued for another year to show signs of recovery alongside indications of continued weakness, creating inconsistency and volatility across geographic regions. In the US, the Federal Reserve once again increased its target rate range from 0.25% to 0.50% to 0.50% to 0.75% in December 2016. Meanwhile, the European Central Bank (“ECB”) announced a further extension of its asset purchase program until the end of 2017 in response to continued low inflation across the European region.

In the US, 2016 began with increased market volatility, but with continued indications of improvement primarily in unemployment measures. Inflationary measures started the year slowly but began to turn the corner by the second half of 2016 after weathering several months of market volatility and a weakening US dollar. Continued strength in the job markets has been an often discussed point of strength for the US economy, with jobless rates continuing to new lows. Forecasts are for inflation to rise to the target levels of 2.0% over the medium term due to these strong labor market indicators as well as increases in household spending and business fixed investments. As a result of this, the US Federal Reserve announced the aforementioned second increase in its target range for the Federal Funds Rate since 2006. The US dollar ended the year up significantly versus lows encountered in the second quarter. While the Bank does not have operations in the US, economic trends in the US, particularly as they pertain to the interest rate environment, do affect the Bank through our investment portfolio and utilization of certain US base rates as reference rates in our lending portfolio.

In Bermuda, we continued to face mixed trading conditions during 2016, with continued signs that the economy is on the road to recovery with growth in retail sales, construction expenditures and ultimately

93

TABLE OF CONTENTS

GDP. The latest economic indicators from the third quarter show a 2015 to 2016 decrease on GDP growth to 2.2% in current price terms, relative to an increase of 4.6% in the prior year. This represented the first quarter of decline after sixth consecutive quarters of GDP growth. Bermuda continued preparations for the 2017 America's Cup, which has driven several new hotels under construction and related infrastructure projects. Tourism continues to be a focus of the Bermudian domestic economy, and signs of strength include four hotels undergoing significant rebuilds or renovations, notably the Ritz Carlton development at Morgan's Point. Further, air visitors increased by 18% in the third quarter of 2016 relative to the same quarter a year ago, and visitor expenditure increased 11.7% in the second quarter of 2016 relative to the same period one year ago. Retail sales continued to show positive signs for Bermuda with retail sales growing for 18 of the last 19 months as of the third quarter of 2016. However, the Bermuda economy continues to face medium term challenges from high unemployment, significant government debt and related debt service charges. See “Risk Factors — Risks Relating to Financial Conditions, Market Environment and General Economic Trends — Adverse economic and market conditions in particular in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, have in the past resulted in and could in the future result in lower revenue, lower asset quality, increased provisions and lower earnings”. Overcoming these challenges, as well as continuing to attract foreign capital, is a key focus of the Bermuda Government and sustainable growth for the Bermudian economy will be driven largely by successful management over these three areas.

Following the 2008 financial crisis, the Bermuda economy experienced consecutive years of negative GDP growth. In 2015, the Bermuda economy’s GDP was nominally positive and the local economy appeared to have stabilized. International business activity declined from 2009 to 2011, with modest annual growth from 2012 onwards. The impact of the above on employment, population levels and real estate values was negative for several years, with recent apparent stability being observed in terms of economic activity and stabilized real estate values. The real estate and international business components represent over 40% of Bermuda’s GDP and therefore provide insight into both the overall health of the Bermuda economy and the longer term recovery. The table below shows the extent to which the real estate market and overall economy has recovered, stabilized, and begun to show growth.

 
2015
2014
2013
2012
2011
Bermuda GDP (in millions)
 
5,928
 
 
5,700
 
 
5,670
 
 
5,585
 
 
5,620
 
% change from prior year
 
4.0
%
 
0.5
%
 
1.5
%
 
(0.6
)%
 
(4
)%
Selected GDP Components:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate and renting GDP (in millions)
 
983
 
 
963
 
 
948
 
 
954
 
 
960
 
% change from prior year
 
2.1
%
 
1.6
%
 
(0.6
)%
 
(0.6
)%
 
0.6
%
International business GDP (in millions)
 
1,659
 
 
1,575
 
 
1,570
 
 
1,455
 
 
1,432
 
% change from prior year
 
5.3
%
 
0.3
%
 
7.9
%
 
1.6
%
 
(6.8
)%

Source: National Economic Report of Bermuda 2016, Department of Statistics, Gross Domestic Product by Industrial Origin, Table 1

94

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bermuda Ministry of Finance interim quarterly figures for 2016 are shown below to provide further insight into current GDP trends. Note that the fourth quarter figures for 2016 are not available as of the date of this prospectus.


The Cayman Islands projected GDP growth in 2016 of 3.0%, up from a GDP of 2% in the previous year. Expansion was noted in construction, utilities, wholesale and retail trade, transport, storage and communication sectors. Tourist arrivals by air and cruise ship continued to record year-over-year improvements, but at a slower pace than in previous years. The opening of the new 265-room Kimpton Seafire Hotel in November 2016 complements the island's tourist offering. The Owen Roberts International Airport redevelopment and expansion project entered Phase II, which, when completed in 2018, will provide a better overall travel experience for tourists, business visitors and residents alike. While several significant infrastructure projects have been deferred, the Cayman Islands Government continues to record growing surpluses and overall external debt reduction. The most recent consumer price index showed a marked increase in 2016 from its lower 2015 levels, with higher costs for restaurants and hotels, recreation and culture, education, housing and utilities, alcohol and tobacco and communication offset by lower costs for transport, driven by lower fuel costs, health and household equipment. Commercial credits reported increased activity led by manufacturing, utilities and construction while credits to households reported increases in domestic property, vehicle, education and technology loans, which plays to our strength in the Cayman Islands and is reflected in the growth of our domestic residential mortgage book.

Meanwhile, the Eurozone has weathered another difficult year with some signs of stabilization. Continued negative deposit rates and large quantitative easing programs by the ECB have been aimed at strengthening the weaker economies while bolstering growth in the stronger economies. The year saw the UK referendum vote to exit the European Union, which triggered a significant decrease in the value of the GBP. The decreased value of the GBP had indirect effects on the value of the Euro. In spite of this, the UK continued their trend of positive GDP growth, with inflation for the third quarter, the first available data following the referendum vote, showing GDP growth of 0.5%. Our operations in Guernsey and the UK use the Pound Sterling as their functional currency, and are closely linked to the economic trends in the UK, as well as to economic trends within the larger Eurozone due to close relationships between the UK and continental Europe.

The mixed economic climate in our two largest operations in 2016 resulted in limited loan demand and continued pressure on customers' ability to service loan payment obligations. Similarly, our private banking business in Europe experienced limited loan growth due to increased competition and pricing pressures.

We continue to maintain a cautious stance with a liquid balance sheet with a conservative investment portfolio and no reliance on wholesale money markets for liquidity. Total liquid cash and investments, excluding held-to-maturity investments, made up 55.0% of our balance sheet at December 31, 2016, which is up slightly from 50.8% at December 31, 2015.

95

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Financial Summary

Summary Balance Sheet
As at
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in millions of $, except per share data)
2016
2015
Cash due from banks
 
2,101.7
 
 
2,288.9
 
 
(187.2
)
 
(8.2
)%
Securities purchased under agreement to resell
 
148.8
 
 
 
 
148.8
 
 
100.0
%
Short-term investments
 
519.8
 
 
409.5
 
 
110.3
 
 
26.9
%
Investment in securities
 
4,400.2
 
 
3,223.9
 
 
1,176.3
 
 
36.5
%
Loans, net of allowance for credit losses
 
3,570.5
 
 
4,000.2
 
 
(429.7
)
 
(10.7
)%
Premises, equipment and computer software
 
167.8
 
 
183.4
 
 
(15.6
)
 
(8.5
)%
Goodwill and intangible assets
 
61.9
 
 
51.1
 
 
10.8
 
 
21.1
%
Total assets
 
11,103.5
 
 
10,275.6
 
 
827.9
 
 
8.1
%
Total deposits
 
10,033.6
 
 
9,182.1
 
 
851.5
 
 
9.3
%
Long-term debt
 
117.0
 
 
117.0
 
 
 
 
%
Shareholders' equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preference shareholders' equity
 
 
 
182.9
 
 
(182.9
)
 
(100.0
)%
Common and contingent value convertible preference shareholders' equity
 
710.7
 
 
567.5
 
 
143.2
 
 
25.2
%
Summary Income Statement
For the year ended
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in millions of $, except per share data)
2016
2015
2014
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
Interest income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans
 
188.0
 
 
186.5
 
 
192.0
 
 
1.5
 
 
(5.5
)
 
0.8
%
 
(2.9
)%
Investments
 
77.2
 
 
69.6
 
 
67.8
 
 
7.6
 
 
1.8
 
 
10.9
%
 
2.7
%
Deposits with banks
 
9.8
 
 
6.5
 
 
5.4
 
 
3.3
 
 
1.1
 
 
50.8
%
 
20.4
%
Interest expense
 
(16.4
)
 
(23.3
)
 
(26.6
)
 
6.9
 
 
3.3
 
 
(29.6
)%
 
(12.4
)%
Net interest income before provision for credit losses
 
258.5
 
 
239.3
 
 
238.5
 
 
19.2
 
 
0.8
 
 
8.0
%
 
0.3
%
Non-interest income
 
147.5
 
 
140.2
 
 
134.8
 
 
7.3
 
 
5.4
 
 
5.2
%
 
4.0
%
Net Revenue
 
406.0
 
 
379.5
 
 
373.3
 
 
26.5
 
 
6.2
 
 
7.0
%
 
1.7
%
Provision for credit losses
 
(4.4
)
 
(5.7
)
 
(8.0
)
 
1.3
 
 
2.3
 
 
(22.8
)%
 
(28.8
)%
Salaries and other employee benefits
 
(140.0
)
 
(134.9
)
 
(129.8
)
 
(5.1
)
 
(5.1
)
 
3.8
%
 
3.9
%
Other non-interest expenses (including income taxes)
 
(146.7
)
 
(151.6
)
 
(143.2
)
 
4.9
 
 
(8.4
)
 
(3.2
)%
 
5.9
%
Net income before other gains (losses)
 
114.9
 
 
87.2
 
 
92.5
 
 
27.7
 
 
(5.3
)
 
31.8
%
 
(5.7
)%
Total other gains (losses)
 
1.0
 
 
(9.4
)
 
15.7
 
 
10.4
 
 
(25.1
)
 
(110.6
)%
 
(159.9
)%
Net income
 
115.9
 
 
77.7
 
 
108.2
 
 
38.2
 
 
(30.5
)
 
49.2
%
 
(28.2
)%
Non-core items
 
22.7
 
 
36.2
 
 
(1.8
)
 
(13.5
)
 
38.0
 
 
(37.3
)%
 
(2,111.1
)%
Core net income (Non-GAAP)
 
138.6
 
 
113.9
 
 
106.4
 
 
24.7
 
 
7.5
 
 
21.7
%
 
7.0
%
Dividends and guarantee fee of preference shares
 
(15.7
)
 
(16.5
)
 
(16.5
)
 
0.8
 
 
 
 
(4.8
)%
 
%
Core earnings to common shareholders (Non-GAAP)
 
122.9
 
 
97.4
 
 
89.9
 
 
25.5
 
 
7.5
 
 
26.2
%
 
8.3
%
Common dividends paid
 
(19.3
)
 
(24.8
)
 
(27.4
)
 
5.5
 
 
2.6
 
 
(22.2
)%
 
(9.5
)%

96

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Consolidated Results of Operations and Discussion for Fiscal Years Ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014

Net Revenue

2016 vs. 2015

Total net revenue before provision for credit losses and other gains and losses for 2016 was $406.0 million, up $26.5 million (7.0%) from 2015. Net interest income before provision for credit losses increased from $239.3 million in 2015 to $258.5 million in 2016, an improvement of $19.2 million (8.0%). The increase in net interest income was driven primarily by higher average investment portfolio balances of $723.6 million, which were funded by an increase in deposits, and a decrease in deposit liability costs of nine basis points, which was driven by the repayment of expensive deposits in our UK jurisdiction. Slightly offsetting these increases was a decrease in related investment yields of 21 basis points and a decrease in average loan balances of $105.6 million. The overall NIM decreased by three basis points from 248 basis points in 2015 to 245 basis points in 2016. In addition, non-interest income was up $7.3 million (5.2%) attributable to increased trust and asset management revenues earned related to the recently acquired HSBC Bank Bermuda private banking investment management and trust businesses, along with organic business growth in asset management, which was slightly offset by lower transaction volume in foreign exchange revenue.

2015 vs. 2014

Total net revenue before provision for credit losses and other gains and losses for 2015 was $379.5 million, up $6.1 million (1.6%) from 2014. Net interest income before provision for credit losses increased from $238.5 million in 2014 to $239.3 million in 2015, an improvement of $0.8 million (0.3%). The increase in net interest income was driven primarily by higher average investment portfolio balances of $339.3 million, which were funded by an increase in deposits and a decrease in liability costs, which resulted from a decrease in interest expense on long-term debt of 7 basis points attributable to a decrease in the average volume of long-term debt outstanding, which was marginally offset by a decrease in related investment yields of 19 basis points and a decrease in average loan balances of $48.3 million. The overall NIM decreased by 26 basis points from 274 basis points in 2014 to 248 basis points in 2015. In addition, non-interest income was up $5.3 million (4.0%) attributable to increased trust revenues earned from the recently acquired Legis Group business, along with new business growth in asset management, and transaction volume increases in foreign exchange revenue.

Net Interest Income Before Provision For Credit Losses

Net interest income is the amount of interest earned on our interest-earning assets less interest paid on our interest bearing liabilities. There are several drivers of the change in net interest income, including changes in the volume and mix of interest-earning assets and interest bearing liabilities, their relative sensitivity to interest rate movements, and the proportion of non-interest bearing sources of funds, such as equity and non-interest bearing current accounts.

97

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following table presents the components of net interest income for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014:

 
For the year ended December 31,
 
2016
2015
2014
(in millions of $)
Average
balance
($)
Interest
($)
Average
rate
(%)
Average
balance
($)
Interest
($)
Average
rate
(%)
Average
balance
($)
Interest
($)
Average
rate
(%)
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks and short-term investments
 
2,655.3
 
 
9.8
 
 
0.37
%
 
2,407.9
 
 
6.5
 
 
0.27
%
 
1,752.9
 
 
5.4
 
 
0.31
%
Investment in securities
 
3,940.6
 
 
77.2
 
 
1.95
%
 
3,217.0
 
 
69.6
 
 
2.16
%
 
2,877.8
 
 
67.7
 
 
2.35
%
Loans
 
3,921.1
 
 
188.0
 
 
4.78
%
 
4,026.7
 
 
186.5
 
 
4.63
%
 
4,075.0
 
 
192.0
 
 
4.71
%
Interest earning assets
 
10,517.0
 
 
275.0
 
 
2.61
%
 
9,651.6
 
 
262.6
 
 
2.72
%
 
8,705.7
 
 
265.1
 
 
3.05
%
Other assets
 
343.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
371.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
410.8
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
 
10,860.4
 
 
275.0
 
 
2.53
%
 
10,023.1
 
 
262.6
 
 
2.62
%
 
9,116.5
 
 
265.1
 
 
2.91
%
Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
 
7,733.8
 
 
(11.8
)
 
(0.15
)%
 
7,156.7
 
 
(18.4
)
 
(0.26
)%
 
6,741.6
 
 
(20.9
)
 
(0.31
)%
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase
 
16.0
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.73
)%
 
2.1
 
 
 
 
%
 
22.0
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.38
)%
Long-term debt
 
117.0
 
 
(4.5
)
 
(3.84
)%
 
117.0
 
 
(4.9
)
 
(4.15
)%
 
117.2
 
 
(5.6
)
 
(4.80
)%
Interest bearing liabilities
 
7,866.8
 
 
(16.4
)
 
(0.21
)%
 
7,275.8
 
 
(23.3
)
 
(0.32
)%
 
6,880.8
 
 
(26.6
)
 
(0.39
)%
Non-interest bearing current accounts
 
2,042.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,720.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,211.0
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
 
123.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
196.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
187.2
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities
 
10,033.0
 
 
(16.4
)
 
(0.16
)%
 
9,193.3
 
 
(23.3
)
 
(0.25
)%
 
8,279.0
 
 
(26.6
)
 
(0.32
)%
Shareholders' equity
 
827.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
829.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
837.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
 
10,860.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10,023.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
9,116.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest bearing funds net of non-interest earning assets (free balance)
 
2,650.2
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2,375.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,824.9
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest margin
 
 
 
 
258.6
 
 
2.45
%
 
 
 
 
239.3
 
 
2.48
%
 
 
 
 
238.5
 
 
2.74
%

2016 vs. 2015

Net interest income before provision for credit losses of $258.6 million in 2016 represented an increase of $19.2 million (or 8.0%) over our net interest income before provision for credit losses in 2015. Net interest income is generated largely by our Bermuda and Cayman segments, which accounted for 92.9% of total net interest income in 2016. Interest income increased by $12.3 million in 2016, which was driven by increased investment portfolio balances and increased income on deposits from higher balances, with a smaller increase in loan interest income driven by higher rates, despite a decrease in average balances. Investment interest income increased by $7.6 million, driven by an increase of $723.6 million in average investment balances, which was slightly offset by a yield decrease of 21 basis points. The yield decrease resulted from a shortening of duration to approximately 3.4 years by year-end attributable to increased investments in shorter term structures and adjustable-rate US agency securities early in the year. During the year, this duration figure was lower than this and increased by year-end due to an increase in longer-duration held-to-maturity investments in the fourth quarter of 2016. The increase in investment balances was funded by an increase in deposits primarily from the recent acquisition of HSBC's private banking investment management and trust businesses in Bermuda.

Loan interest income was higher in 2016 by $1.5 million due primarily to a 15 basis point increase in yield, which was slightly offset by a $105.6 million decrease in average balances. The decrease in balances was largely due to several large prepayments in corporate lending and slower new loan generation than in the prior year, while the increase in yield was due to the Bermuda corporate rate and the Cayman base rate increases in December 2015 in reaction to the US Federal Reserve target rate revision. The majority of the loan portfolio is on a floating rate basis, and utilizes US Federal Reserve

98

TABLE OF CONTENTS

rates as a repricing reference point. Therefore, movements in the US Federal Reserve rates can impact loan interest income if management elects to change base rates. During 2016, there was an increase late in the fourth quarter to the Bermuda and Cayman base rate with no changes in the remaining jurisdictions.

Interest bearing liability costs decreased by 11 basis points, resulting in a decrease in interest expense of $6.9 million, attributable to lower rates on interest bearing deposit rates and the repayment of the more expensive UK deposits, despite an increase of $577.1 million in average interest bearing deposits. Interest bearing deposit rates decreased due to a variety of rate revisions in all jurisdictions.

Average free balances for 2016 were $2.7 billion (2015: $2.4 billion), including non-interest bearing current accounts of $2.0 billion (2015: $1.7 billion), shareholders' equity of $827.4 million (2015: $829.8 million), net of other assets and other liabilities totaling $219.7 million (2015: $174.7 million). See “Risk Management” for more information on how interest rate risk is managed.

2015 vs. 2014

Net interest income before provision for credit losses of $239.3 million in 2015 represented an increase of $0.8 million (or 0.3%) over our net interest income before provision for credit losses in 2014. Net interest income is generated largely by our Bermuda and Cayman segments, which accounted for 88.6% of total net interest income. Interest income decreased by $2.5 million which was driven by lower loan income, offset by improved investment portfolio performance and increased income on deposits. Investment income increased by $1.8 million, driven by an increase of $339.2 million in average balances, which was slightly offset by a yield decrease of 19 basis points. The yield decrease resulted from unfavorable prepayment speeds on US agency securities despite a shortening of duration to approximately 3.5 years attributable to increased investments in adjustable-rate US agency securities. The increase in investment balances was funded by an increase in deposits primarily from an increase in commercial deposits.

Loan interest income in 2015 was lower by $5.5 million due primarily to a $48.3 million decrease in average balances, and an 8 basis point decrease in yield. The decrease in balances was largely due to several large prepayments in corporate lending and slower new loan generation than in the prior year, while the decrease in yield was due to numerous smaller factors. During 2015, there was no change to the base rates charged to loans in any jurisdictions.

Interest bearing liability costs decreased by 7 basis points, driving a decrease in interest expense of $3.3 million, largely from the long-term debt paydown of $90 million in January 2014 and lower rates on interest bearing deposit balances in 2015. Interest bearing deposit rates decreased due to a variety of rate revisions in all jurisdictions.

Average free balances for 2015 were $2.4 billion (2014: $1.8 billion), including non-interest bearing current accounts of $1.7 billion (2014: $1.2 billion), shareholders' equity of $829.8 million (2014: $837.5 million), net of other assets and other liabilities totaling $174.7 million (2014: $223.6 million). See “Risk Management” for more information on how interest rate risk is managed.

Provision for Credit Losses

Our net provision for credit losses in 2016 was $4.4 million compared to $5.7 million in 2015, a decrease of $1.3 million. Incremental provisions of $5.8 million were required principally for general reserves pertaining to commercial real estate, partially offset by recoveries of $1.4 million. In comparison, in 2015, we required incremental provisions relating to specific reserves of $8.6 million that were partially offset by recoveries of $2.9 million. Recoveries on consumer and residential mortgages were 93% of 2016 recoveries and 66% of 2015 recoveries. The 2016 incremental provisions were comprised of $3.0 million against impaired loans and $2.8 million against unimpaired loans, versus $6.5 million and of $2.1 million respectively for 2015. The decline in 2016 impaired charges related primarily to a reduction in Bermuda residential credit losses, demonstrating the stability of our domestic credit markets. This is further evidenced by a reduction in non-accrual loans, which decreased $16.8 million to $48.5 million in 2016.

Our net provision for credit losses in 2015 was $5.7 million compared to $8.0 million in 2014, a decrease of $2.3 million. Incremental provisions of $8.6 million were required principally for specific

99

TABLE OF CONTENTS

reserves discussed above, partially offset by recoveries of $2.9 million. In comparison, in 2014, we required incremental provisions relating to specific reserves of $10.4 million that were partially offset by recoveries of $2.3 million. Recoveries on consumer and residential mortgages were 66% of 2015 recoveries and 97% of 2014 recoveries. The 2015 incremental provisions were comprised of $6.5 million against impaired loans and $2.1 million against unimpaired loans, versus $12.0 million and a release of $1.6 million respectively for 2014. The decline in 2015 impaired charges related primarily to a $4.1 million reduction in Bermuda residential credit losses. The 2015 increase in credit losses for unimpaired loans was spread across all jurisdictions due to increases in deemed country concentration risk.

Other Gains (Losses)

The following table represents the components of other gains (losses) for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014:

 
For the year ended
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in thousands of $)
2016
2015
2014
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
Net trading gains (losses)
 
715
 
 
(562
)
 
10,070
 
 
1,277
 
 
(10,632
)
 
(227.2
)%
 
(105.6
)%
Net realized gains (losses) on available-for-sale investments
 
1,546
 
 
(4,407
)
 
8,680
 
 
5,953
 
 
(13,087
)
 
(135.1
)%
 
(150.8
)%
Net realized / unrealized gains (losses) on other real estate owned
 
(440
)
 
277
 
 
(1,804
)
 
(717
)
 
2,081
 
 
(258.8
)%
 
(115.4
)%
Impairment of fixed assets
 
 
 
(5,083
)
 
(1,986
)
 
5,083
 
 
(3,097
)
 
(100.0
)%
 
155.9
%
Net gain on sale of equity method investments
 
 
 
 
 
277
 
 
 
 
(277
)
 
%
 
(100.0
)%
Net other gains (losses)
 
(807
)
 
338
 
 
451
 
 
(1,145
)
 
(113
)
 
(338.8
)%
 
(25.1
)%
Net gain on sale of equity method investments
 
 
 
 
 
277
 
 
 
 
(277
)
 
%
 
(100.0
)%
Other gains (losses)
 
1,014
 
 
(9,437
)
 
15,965
 
 
10,451
 
 
(25,125
)
 
(110.7
)%
 
(157.4
)%

Net Trading Gains

A $0.7 million gain was recorded with respect to trading securities in 2016 compared to net trading losses of $0.6 million in 2015. These gains were as a result of a determination made in 2015 that certain securities classified as AFS for our operations in Guernsey and the UK should have been classified as trading securities since 2011. These securities were sold by the second quarter of 2016 in both jurisdictions. The net change in unrealized gains (losses) on these securities was $0.1 million of net gains in 2016, and $0.7 million of net losses in 2015 and $9.9 million in 2014 which are classified as non-core. The increase was due primarily to movements in long-term US treasury rates prior to the liquidation date.

Net Realized Gains (Losses) on Available-For-Sale Investments

Net realized gains of $1.5 million were recorded in 2016 as a result of the sale of certain investments from our US government and federal agency portfolio where the proceeds were used to acquire long-term held-to-maturity investments. In 2015, we recorded a $4.4 million net realized loss on the sale of certain lower yielding investments from our US government and federal agency portfolio.

In 2014, we recorded a $8.7 million net realized gain on the receipt of liquidation proceeds from our former investment in the Avenir Pass-through Note, which was formerly a structured investment vehicle. In 2016, we received a further $0.6 million in liquidation proceeds from this same investment Management considers these gains in 2014 and 2016 to be non-core.

Net Realized / Unrealized Gains (Losses) on Other Real Estate Owned

Valuation adjustments and realized gains and losses related to real estate held for sale were losses of $0.4 million in 2016 compared to gains of $0.3 million in 2015, attributable largely to the sale of certain properties in Bermuda and Cayman triggering a small loss relative to gains under similar circumstances booked in 2015 and valuation losses in 2014.

100

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Impairment of Fixed Assets

We conduct annual property impairment assessments on our properties held for sale and rent as well as other fixed assets, which resulted in no write downs in 2016. In 2015, there were $5.1 million in write downs as a result of an impairment in the UK's core banking system due to the planned orderly wind down of the deposit taking, investment management and custody businesses, which impacted the recoverable value of this asset to the UK operations during the wind down period. In 2014, there were $2.0 million in write downs to reflect current market values of properties held for sale and rent.

Net Other Gains (Losses)

Net other losses were $0.8 million in 2016 compared to net other gains of $0.3 million in 2015 and $0.5 million in 2014. Included in the 2016 results is the non-core realized losses relating to a revision to the contingent consideration in the Legis acquisition from 2014 due to positive results during the pre-determined earn-out period which revised the estimated payments, offset by non-core realized gains relating to the contingent consideration in the HSBC Bermuda acquisition due to slightly lower referred business than the initial estimate. Included in the 2014 results is the non-core realized gain relating to the disposal of the Bank's investment in a private equity holding offset by business acquisition costs relating to the Legis acquisition.

Net Gain on Sale of Equity Method Investments

During 2014, we received $0.3 million in additional sale consideration for the 2012 disposal of Island Heritage Holdings Ltd. Management considered this gain in 2014 to be non-core.

Non-Interest Income

Non-interest income is a function of a number of factors including the composition and value of client assets under management and administration, the volume and nature of clients' transaction activities, and the types of products and services our clients use. Our fee structure provides for varied pricing that depends on the value of client assets and the nature of services provided. As a result, it is not always possible to draw a direct relationship between the value of client assets and the level of non-interest income, though the trend of non-interest income generally follows the trend in client asset levels.

Total non-interest income increased from $140.2 million in 2015 to $147.5 million in 2016. Non-interest income as a percentage of total net revenue before provision for credit losses and other gains and losses decreased slightly from 36.9% in 2015 to 36.3% in 2016 due to a higher relative increase in net interest income.

Total non-interest income increased from $134.8 million in 2014 to $140.2 million in 2015. Non-interest income as a percentage of total net revenue before provision for credit losses and other gains and losses increased slightly from 36.1% in 2014 to 36.9% in 2015.

The following table presents the components of non-interest income for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014:

 
For the year ended
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in thousands of $)
2016
2015
2014
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
Asset management
 
21,106
 
 
18,910
 
 
17,728
 
 
2,196
 
 
1,182
 
 
11.6
%
 
6.7
%
Banking
 
39,342
 
 
35,221
 
 
34,280
 
 
4,121
 
 
941
 
 
11.7
%
 
2.7
%
Foreign exchange revenue
 
30,606
 
 
31,896
 
 
29,379
 
 
(1,290
)
 
2,517
 
 
(4.0
)%
 
8.6
%
Trust
 
44,060
 
 
40,264
 
 
38,268
 
 
3,796
 
 
1,996
 
 
9.4
%
 
5.2
%
Custody and other administration services
 
8,883
 
 
9,522
 
 
10,166
 
 
(639
)
 
(644
)
 
(6.7
)%
 
(6.3
)%
Other non-interest income
 
3,476
 
 
4,359
 
 
5,009
 
 
(883
)
 
(650
)
 
(20.3
)%
 
(13.0
)%
Total non-interest income
 
147,473
 
 
140,172
 
 
134,830
 
 
7,301
 
 
5,342
 
 
5.2
%
 
4.0
%

Asset Management

Asset management revenues are generally based on the market value of assets managed and the volume of transactions and fees for other services rendered. We provide asset management services

101

TABLE OF CONTENTS

from our offices in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, Guernsey and the UK. Revenues from asset management were $21.1 million in 2016, compared to $18.9 million in 2015, and $17.7 million in 2014.

The table that follows shows the changes in the year-end values of clients' assets under management, sub-divided between those managed for clients on a discretionary basis and client funds invested in mutual funds that Butterfield manages (“Butterfield Funds”):

 
Year ended
December 31,
Dollar
Change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
2014
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
Butterfield Funds
 
1,808
 
 
1,871
 
 
2,164
 
 
(63
)
 
(293
)
Other assets under management
 
2,885
 
 
1,741
 
 
1,638
 
 
1,144
 
 
103
 
Total assets under management
 
4,693
 
 
3,612
 
 
3,802
 
 
1,081
 
 
(190
)

2016 vs. 2015

Assets under management were $4.7 billion as of December 31, 2016, compared to $3.6 billion as of December 31, 2015. The AUM increase was driven by the acquisition of the HSBC asset management business in Bermuda. This AUM increase was tempered by the loss of $0.2 billion of AUM resulting from the orderly wind down of our asset management practice in the UK. The newly acquired business in Bermuda led to an increase of $5.0 million in asset management fees, slightly offset by $1.8 million of lost revenue from the UK. The Butterfield Funds were relatively stable in terms of AUM, with the money market fund showing signs of recovery after several years of decline due to low interest rates which impacted the returns.

The remaining asset management fees are primarily generated from custody and brokerage fees. Custody fees were relatively unchanged at $0.7 million and brokerage fees decreased by $0.9 million to $2.0 million primarily as a result of the orderly wind down in the UK, and to a lesser extent, a decrease in the volume of brokerage generating transactions.

2015 vs. 2014

Assets under management were $3.6 billion as of December 31, 2015, compared to $3.8 billion as of December 31, 2014. The Butterfield Funds decreased by $0.3 billion as clients continued to withdraw funds from the money market fund. Market appreciation continued to be insignificant due to the majority of the balance being held in zero yielding money market funds. On an average basis, AUM of the Butterfield Funds declined by 8% to $2.1 billion as of December 31, 2015 from $2.3 billion as of December 31, 2014. In spite of this, asset management revenue generated by the Butterfield Funds increased by $1.9 million to $7.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2015, which was primarily driven by placement fees earned upon the launch of a new private equity fund in 2015 and higher average rates earned on money market funds owing to short-term interest rates.

The overall decline in AUM was partly offset by an increase of $0.1 billion in the discretionary portfolios, primarily due to growth in the number of high net worth private clients. However, on an average basis, AUM on the discretionary portfolios remained stable at $1.7 billion. Discretionary portfolios typically returned between 1% to 2% throughout the year, which was was partly offset by unfavorable foreign exchange movements on the European portfolios. Overall, this led to a decrease in asset management revenue generated by the discretionary portfolios of $0.1 million to $8.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2015.

The remaining asset management fees are primarily generated from custody and brokerage fees, each of which decreased by $0.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2015 to $0.7 million and $2.9 million, respectively, due to a decrease in volume of assets under custody and a decrease in volume of transactions generating brokerage commission.

Banking

We provide a full range of community, commercial, and private banking services in select jurisdictions. Banking services are offered to individuals and small to medium-sized businesses through

102

TABLE OF CONTENTS

branch locations, Internet banking, automated teller machines, debit cards, and mobile banking in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, while private banking services are offered in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands and Guernsey. Banking revenues reflect loan, transaction processing, and other fees earned in these jurisdictions. During 2016, we announced the orderly wind down of our private banking and asset management businesses in the UK, which was substantially completed by the 2016 year-end.

Banking fee revenues increased by 11.7% in 2016 to $39.3 million, compared to $35.2 million in 2015, due primarily to higher credit card activity and revised fee schedules in several jurisdictions and increased overdraft fees in 2016.

Banking fee revenues increased by 2.7% in 2015 to $35.2 million, compared to $34.3 million in 2014, due primarily to higher credit card activity and increased wire fees in 2015, which were partially offset by the termination of a tailor-made banking product for one of our major clients in Guernsey in 2015, decreased electronic banking revenues due to the release of a collections reserve in 2014, and a large volume of loan exit fees charged in 2014 on repayment of some significant commercial facilities.

Foreign Exchange

We provide foreign exchange services in the normal course of business in all jurisdictions. The major contributors to foreign exchange revenues are Bermuda and the Cayman Islands, accounting for 90% of our foreign exchange revenue (2015: 87%; 2014: 86%). We do not maintain a proprietary trading book. Foreign exchange income is generated from client-driven transactions and totaled $30.6 million in 2016, compared to $31.9 million in 2015 and $29.4 million in 2014. The $1.3 million decrease from 2015 to 2016 reflects decreased client activity and related volumes in both retail and institutional foreign exchange flows. The $2.5 million increase from 2014 to 2015 reflects increased client activity and related volumes in both retail and institutional foreign exchange flows.

Trust

We provide both personal and institutional fiduciary services from our operations in Bermuda, The Bahamas, the Cayman Islands, Guernsey and Switzerland. Revenues are derived from a combination of fixed fees, fees based on the market values of assets held in trust and fees based on time spent in relation to the range of personal trust and company administration services and pension and employee benefit trust services we provide.

In 2016, trust revenues represented 29.9% of our non-interest income, up from 28.7% in 2015. In 2016, trust revenues totaled $44.1 million, an increase of $3.8 million or 9.4% over 2015, attributable largely to the acquisition of the Bermuda Trust Company Limited, which was acquired from HSBC Bank Bermuda Limited on April 1, 2016.

In 2015, trust revenues represented 28.7% of our non-interest income, up from 28.4% in 2014. In 2015, trust revenues totaled $40.3 million, an increase of $2.0 million or 5.2% over 2014, attributable largely to the acquisition of the Legis Group business, which closed on April 1, 2014. Revenue growth was supported by structured, proactive business development activities.

Trust assets under administration were $82.4 billion at the end of 2016 compared to $81.8 billion at the end of 2015, an increase of $0.6 billion or 0.7%, which is attributable largely from new business from the recent HSBC trust acquisition in Bermuda, partially offset by unfavorable foreign exchange movements. Trust assets under administration decreased $2.6 billion or 3.0% from 2014 to 2015, which was again attributable largely to unfavorable foreign exchange movements.

Custody and Other Administration Services

Custody fees are generally based on market values of assets in custody, the volume of transactions and flat fees for other services rendered. We provide custody services from our offices in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, Guernsey and the UK, and other administration services — primarily administered banking — in Guernsey. In 2016, revenues were $8.9 million, a slight decrease of $0.6 million from 2015 due to lower transaction volumes and expired mandates. From 2014 to 2015, revenues decreased slightly by $0.6 million due to lower transaction volumes and expired mandates.

103

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Total assets under administration for the custody and other administration services business (which includes the administered banking services operations provided by our Guernsey business) were $24.7 billion on December 31, 2016, down from $39.2 billion on December 31, 2015, compared to $42.5 billion on December 31, 2014.

Other Non-Interest Income

The components of our other non-interest income for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 are set forth in the following table:

 
Year ended
December 31,
Dollar
Change
Percent
Change
(in thousands of $)
2016
2015
2014
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
Net share of earnings from equity method investments
 
1,175
 
 
979
 
 
834
 
 
196
 
 
145
 
 
20.0
%
 
17.4
%
Rental income
 
1,104
 
 
1,379
 
 
2,726
 
 
(275
)
 
(1,347
)
 
(19.9
)%
 
(49.4
)%
Other
 
1,197
 
 
2,001
 
 
1,449
 
 
(804
)
 
552
 
 
(40.2
)%
 
38.1
%
Total other non-interest income
 
3,476
 
 
4,359
 
 
5,009
 
 
(883
)
 
(650
)
 
(20.3
)%
 
(13.0
)%

In 2016, we recorded equity pickup income of $1.2 million, an increase of $0.2 million from the prior year due to higher earnings by equity method investments. From 2014 to 2015, equity pickup increased by $0.1 million due to higher earnings by equity method investments. Rental income decreased by $0.3 million to $1.1 million in 2016 due to a further reduction in rented properties, and decreased by $1.3 million from 2014 to 2015 due to an initial reduction in rented properties. Included in the “Other” category are maintenance fees from leased premises, director's fee income, and other miscellaneous income.

Non-Interest Expenses

Expense management continued to be a key focus in 2016 as we continue to adapt to the low interest rate environment. Total non-interest expenses in 2016 were $286.0 million compared to $285.2 million in 2015 and $273.0 million in 2014. These figures include non-core expenses in 2016, 2015 and 2014 of $22.4 million, $30.4 million and $16.0 million, respectively. After adjusting for these non-core items, 2016 core expenses were down $8.7 million (3.4%) with an improvement in core efficiency ratio to 63.8% from 66.0% in 2015. From 2014 to 2015, core expenses were down $2.2 million (0.9%) with an improvement in core efficiency ratio to 66.0% from 67.7% in 2014.

In 2016, salaries and other employee benefits accounted for 49.0% of non-interest expenses, with technology and communications and property making up 27.4% combined.

104

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following table presents the components of non-interest expenses for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014:

 
Year ended
December 31,
Dollar
Change
Percent
Change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
2014
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
Salaries and other employee benefits
 
140.0
 
 
134.9
 
 
129.8
 
 
5.1
 
 
5.1
 
 
3.8
%
 
3.9
%
Technology and communications
 
57.4
 
 
57.1
 
 
57.1
 
 
0.3
 
 
 
 
0.5
%
 
%
Property
 
21.0
 
 
21.5
 
 
24.3
 
 
(0.5
)
 
(2.8
)
 
(2.3
)%
 
(11.5
)%
Professional and outside services
 
18.9
 
 
27.6
 
 
24.0
 
 
(8.7
)
 
3.6
 
 
(31.5
)%
 
15.0
%
Indirect taxes
 
16.4
 
 
13.9
 
 
14.2
 
 
2.5
 
 
(0.3
)
 
18.0
%
 
(2.1
)%
Amortization of intangible assets
 
4.5
 
 
4.4
 
 
4.3
 
 
0.1
 
 
0.1
 
 
2.3
%
 
2.3
%
Marketing
 
4.5
 
 
3.9
 
 
3.8
 
 
0.6
 
 
0.1
 
 
15.4
%
 
2.6
%
Restructuring costs
 
6.3
 
 
2.2
 
 
 
 
4.1
 
 
2.2
 
 
 
 
 
Other non-interest expenses
 
17.0
 
 
19.7
 
 
15.5
 
 
(2.7
)
 
4.2
 
 
(13.7
)%
 
27.1
%
Total non-interest expenses
 
286.0
 
 
285.2
 
 
273.0
 
 
0.8
 
 
12.2
 
 
0.3
%
 
4.5
%
Non-core expenses (Non-GAAP)
 
(22.4
)
 
(30.4
)
 
(16.0
)
 
8.0
 
 
(14.4
)
 
(26.3
)%
 
90.0
%
Core non-interest expenses (Non-GAAP)
 
263.5
 
 
254.8
 
 
257.0
 
 
8.7
 
 
(2.2
)
 
3.4
%
 
(0.9
)%

For a full reconciliation of GAAP net income to core net income, please see “Selected Consolidated Financial Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Measures”.

Salaries and Other Employee Benefits

Total salaries and other employee benefits costs were $140.0 million in 2016, up $5.1 million compared to 2015. Included in 2016 expenses were $11.3 million of severance, early retirement and project-related non-core costs, compared to $8.7 million of severance and project-related non-core costs in 2015 and $5.6 million in 2014. These 2016 amounts are primarily comprised of $8.5 million of costs associated with the vesting of the outstanding 2010 legacy performance options. The remaining amounts in 2016 and prior period amounts are comprised of (i) $1.8 million in 2016, $8.1 million in 2015 and $2.7 million in 2014 in severance and early retirement, with the increase in 2015 largely driven by compensation paid to former senior executives who stepped down from their positions during 2015; (ii) nil in 2016, $0.4 million in 2015 and $2.4 million in 2014 relating to the extensive review and account remediation exercise to determine the US tax compliance status of US person account holders; and (iii) $1.0 million in 2016, $1.0 million in 2015 and $0.5 million in 2014 attributable to business acquisition costs relating to the HSBC Bermuda acquisition completed in 2016 which were incurred in 2015 and 2016 and Legis and HSBC Cayman acquisitions in 2014.

Core salaries, which exclude these amounts, and other employee benefits costs were $128.7 million in 2016, up $2.5 million compared to 2015 due to increased costs associated with financial crime and tax reporting compliance, a slight increase due to headcount increases as a result of the recent acquisition which was slightly offset by favorable foreign exchange fluctuations from foreign-denominated subsidiaries. From 2014 to 2015, core salaries increased $2.1 million due to increased post-retirement medical costs resulting from higher healthcare costs, which were partially offset by a headcount reduction and favorable foreign exchange fluctuations from foreign-denominated subsidiaries.

Headcount on a full-time equivalency basis at the end of 2016 was 1,240, compared to 1,141 in 2015 and 1,164 in 2014. The increase from 2015 to 2016 was a result of staff increases resulting from the HSBC Bermuda acquisition. The decrease from 2014 to 2015 was a result of certain expired mandates in administered banking and trust services, as well as a decrease in temporary staffing (included in full-time equivalent) that were involved in the integration of acquisitions in the prior year, as well as the tax compliance review.

Technology and Communications

Technology and communication costs reflect expenses relating to the support for our IT infrastructure and increased slightly to $57.4 million in 2016 due to increased depreciation. In 2015 and 2014, technology and communications remained constant at $57.1 million.

105

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Property

Property costs, which reflect occupancy expenses, building maintenance, and depreciation of property, plant and equipment, were $21.0 million in 2016, down $0.5 million from $21.5 million recorded in 2015 due primarily to reduced electrical costs from ongoing implemented cost savings initiatives in one our jurisdictions offset by increased file storage costs.

From 2014 to 2015, property costs decreased by $2.8 million due primarily to decreased property management and maintenance costs resulting from the sale of hotel properties in the third quarter of 2015, as well as reduced electrical costs due to ongoing implemented cost savings initiatives.

Professional and Outside Services

Professional and outside services primarily include consulting, legal, audit and other professional services. The 2016 expense of $18.9 million included $1.7 million of non-core project-related costs. In 2015 and 2014, total expenses of $27.6 million and $24.0 million included non-core project expenses of $15.8 million and $9.5 million, respectively. Excluding the non-core project related costs, professional fees from our core business increased by $5.2 million from 2015 to 2016 due to increased financial crime and tax reporting compliance costs and decreased by $0.9 million from 2014 to 2015 due to reduced consulting expenditures. The non-core project-related costs in 2016 consisted of:

$0.9 million relating to the extensive review and account remediation exercise to determine the US tax compliance status of US person account holders resulting from the so-called John Doe Summonses issued by the USAO to six US financial institutions with which we had correspondent bank relationships. Costs associated with this remediation exercise during the year ended December 31, 2016 amounted to $2.2 million (2015 — $3.8 million; 2014 — $10.2 million), comprised largely of professional fees of $1.0 million (2015 — $2.8 million; $2014 — $6.9 million); and
$0.7 million of legal and professional fees relating to the acquisition of the Bermuda Trust Company Ltd. and the private banking and investment management operations of HSBC Bank Bermuda Limited. In 2015, we realized expenses of $1.0 million related to this same acquisition. During 2014, we expensed $2.8 million of legal and professional fees relating to the acquisitions of Legis and HSBC Cayman.

In forthcoming periods, we expect to incur additional expenses associated with the compliance with regulations which are a result of our recent listing in the US, which will largely be comprised of professional and outside services expenses.

Indirect Taxes

These taxes reflect taxes levied in the jurisdictions in which we operate, including employee-related payroll taxes, customs duties, and business licenses. In 2016, the expense was $16.4 million, up $2.5 million mainly due to increased payroll tax and a stamp duty paid upon the HSBC Bermuda acquisition, both in Bermuda. Of the $16.4 million in indirect taxes, $12.0 million was paid to the Bermuda government agencies for payroll tax, business licenses and land taxes, $1.8 million for value-added taxes paid in our UK business and $2.5 million was paid to other governments for business licenses, insurance tax and work permit fees. We incurred new taxes in Bermuda during 2016 as payment for the Bermuda Deposit Insurance Scheme. These amounts are calculated at 0.25% per annum of the average total amount of our Bermuda Dollar deposits, and are payable quarterly. These payments began during the third quarter of 2016, and were not a material amount by year-end. The Bermuda Government has increased payroll tax in each of the past two years, and subsequent increases could increase indirect taxes. From 2014 to 2015, indirect taxes decreased by $0.3 million mainly due to value-added tax recoveries in the UK.

Amortization of Intangible Assets

Intangible assets relate to client relationships acquired from business acquisitions and are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives, not exceeding 15 years. The estimated lives of these acquired intangible assets are re-evaluated annually and tested for impairment. The amortization

106

TABLE OF CONTENTS

expense associated with intangible assets was $4.5 million in 2016 compared to $4.4 million in 2015 and $4.3 million in 2014. The higher amortization levels from 2015 to 2016 were driven by an increase in identifiable, limited life intangible assets acquired in the HSBC Bermuda acquisition, while the increase from 2014 to 2015 was driven by a similar increase in identifiable, limited life intangible assets acquired in the Legis Group and HSBC Cayman acquisitions completed in 2014.

Marketing

Marketing expenses reflect costs incurred in advertising and promoting our products and services. Marketing expenses totaled $4.5 million in 2016, up $0.6 million compared to 2015, but remained consistent as a percentage of total net revenue before provision for credit losses and other gains and losses at 1.1%. From 2014 to 2015, marketing expenses increased by $0.1 million while still maintaining the same percentage of total revenue before provision for credit losses and other gains and losses at 1.0%.

Other Non-Interest Expenses

 
For the year ended
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
2014
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
Stationery & supplies
 
1.6
 
 
1.4
 
 
1.3
 
 
0.2
 
 
0.1
 
 
14.3
%
 
7.7
%
Custodian & handling
 
2.0
 
 
1.6
 
 
1.8
 
 
0.4
 
 
(0.2
)
 
25.0
%
 
(11.1
)%
Charitable donations
 
0.9
 
 
0.8
 
 
0.8
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
12.5
%
 
%
Insurance
 
2.7
 
 
2.1
 
 
2.2
 
 
0.6
 
 
(0.1
)
 
28.6
%
 
(4.5
)%
Other expenses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Agent commission fees
 
0.7
 
 
0.6
 
 
0.4
 
 
0.1
 
 
0.2
 
 
16.7
%
 
50.0
%
Cheque processing
 
1.1
 
 
1.2
 
 
1.3
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.1
)
 
(8.3
)%
 
(7.7
)%
Directors' fees
 
1.8
 
 
1.2
 
 
0.9
 
 
0.6
 
 
0.3
 
 
50.0
%
 
33.3
%
Dues and subscriptions
 
0.2
 
 
0.3
 
 
0.5
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.2
)
 
(33.3
)%
 
(40.0
)%
Foreign bank charges
 
0.8
 
 
0.8
 
 
0.6
 
 
 
 
0.2
 
 
%
 
33.3
%
General expenses
 
0.5
 
 
0.1
 
 
0.7
 
 
0.4
 
 
(0.6
)
 
400.0
%
 
(85.7
)%
Maintenance fees for liquidity facility
 
0.2
 
 
0.2
 
 
0.2
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Registrar and transfer agent fee
 
0.6
 
 
0.5
 
 
0.7
 
 
0.1
 
 
(0.2
)
 
20.0
%
 
(28.6
)%
Provision for settlement amount arising from tax compliance review
 
0.7
 
 
4.8
 
 
 
 
(4.1
)
 
4.8
 
 
(85.4
)%
 
%
Other
 
3.2
 
 
4.1
 
 
4.1
 
 
(0.9
)
 
 
 
(22.0
)%
 
%
Total other non-interest expenses
 
17.0
 
 
19.7
 
 
15.5
 
 
(2.7
)
 
4.2
 
 
(13.7
)%
 
27.1
%

Other non-interest expenses were $17.0 million in 2016, a decrease of $2.7 million compared to 2015. This was driven principally by a $4.8 million provision for a potential settlement arising from the tax compliance review in 2015 compared to an additional $0.7 million provision raised for this review in 2016 and certain expenses related to the recent IPO and NYSE listing including increased insurance costs.

From 2014 to 2015, other non-interest expenses increased $4.2 million, principally driven by the aforementioned $4.8 million provision for a settlement amount arising from the tax compliance review in 2015 compared to lower operational losses experienced in 2014. As the investigation regarding this tax compliance review remains ongoing at this time, the timing and terms of the final resolution, including any fines or penalties, remain uncertain and the financial impact to us could exceed the amount of the provision. In this regard, we note that the US authorities have not approved or commented on the adequacy or reasonableness of the provision. Management views this provision as non-core. See “Business — Legal Proceedings”.

Income Taxes

Each jurisdiction in which we operate is subject to different corporate income tax laws. We are incorporated in Bermuda as a local company and, pursuant to Bermuda law, not obligated to pay any taxes in Bermuda on either income or capital gains there. Our subsidiaries in the Cayman Islands and

107

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bahamas are not subject to any taxes on either income or capital gains under current laws applicable in the respective jurisdictions. In general, entities in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands are not subject to corporate income taxes but are required to pay higher rates of indirect taxes (included above) such as license fees and in Bermuda, payroll taxes.

Our subsidiaries in the UK, Guernsey and Switzerland are subject to the tax laws of those jurisdictions. The corporate tax rate in the UK is 20%, while in Guernsey, banking profits are subject to a 10% flat corporate tax rate. See Note 25 “Income Taxes in the Audited Consolidated Financial Statements” for a reconciliation between the effective income tax rate and the statutory income tax rate.

In 2016, income tax expense netted to $0.7 million compared to $1.4 million in 2015. The change in income tax expense of $0.6 million was primarily due to the impact of exchange rate movements in the translation of the balances from our UK and Guernsey subsidiaries, and the existence of a $0.5 million deferred tax expense in 2015 relating to the write down of a deferred tax asset in that year.

From 2014 to 2015, the change in income tax amounted to $1.4 million principally due to a $1.0 million tax refund that our Guernsey segment was notified of and recognized in 2014 relating to the ability to claim accelerated tax allowances on a computer system implemented in 2013 and a deferred tax expense of $0.5 million in 2015 primarily due to the write-off of a deferred tax asset relating to capital allowance in the UK. The deferred tax asset amount written off related to the orderly wind down of the deposit taking, investment management and custody businesses in the UK jurisdiction, which resulted in an assessment that the benefits related to this deferred tax asset would not be realizable.

Net Income

We reported net income of $115.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2016, compared to $77.7 million in 2015 and $108.2 million in 2014. The increase from 2015 to 2016 of $38.2 million was driven by higher net interest and non-interest income, offset by slightly higher non-interest expenses. The increases in net interest and non-interest income were driven principally by the acquisition of the private banking investment management and trust businesses of HSBC in Bermuda. This acquisition drove increases in trust and asset management fees, and provided additional deposits which funded an increase in average investments balances of $723.6 million, which resulted in an increase in interest income on investments. The decrease from 2014 to 2015 of $30.4 million was largely driven by non-core gains (losses) and expenses, which increased $38.0 million year over year due primarily to higher project related costs compared to 2014.

After deduction of preference dividends and guarantee fees (2016: $15.7 million, 2015: $16.5 million and 2014: $16.5 million) and the premium paid on the preference share buy-backs and redemption (2016: $41.9 million, 2015: nil and 2014: $0.1 million), net income available to common shareholders was $58.4 million ($1.18 per share) in 2016 compared to $61.3 million ($1.23 per share) in 2015 and $91.5 million ($1.65 per share) in 2014. The increased premium in 2016 was due to the redemption and cancellation of all of the outstanding preference shares in December 2016. These per share figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.

108

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Consolidated Balance Sheet and Discussion

The following table shows the balance sheet as reported as of December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 
As of
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks
 
2,102
 
 
2,289
 
 
(187
)
 
(8.2
)%
Securities purchased under agreement to resell
 
149
 
 
 
 
149
 
 
100.0
%
Short-term investments
 
520
 
 
409
 
 
111
 
 
27.1
%
Investment in securities
 
4,400
 
 
3,224
 
 
1,176
 
 
36.5
%
Loans, net of allowance for credit losses
 
3,570
 
 
4,000
 
 
(430
)
 
(10.8
)%
Premises, equipment and computer software
 
168
 
 
183
 
 
(15
)
 
(8.2
)%
Goodwill and intangibles
 
62
 
 
51
 
 
11
 
 
21.6
%
Other assets
 
133
 
 
119
 
 
14
 
 
11.8
%
Total assets
 
11,104
 
 
10,276
 
 
828
 
 
8.1
%
Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total deposits
 
10,034
 
 
9,182
 
 
852
 
 
9.3
%
Total other liabilities
 
242
 
 
226
 
 
16
 
 
7.1
%
Long-term debt
 
117
 
 
117
 
 
 
 
%
Total liabilities
 
10,393
 
 
9,525
 
 
868
 
 
9.1
%
Preference shareholders' equity
 
 
 
183
 
 
(183
)
 
(100.0
)%
Common and contingent value convertible preference shareholders' equity
 
711
 
 
567
 
 
144
 
 
25.4
%
Total shareholders' equity
 
711
 
 
750
 
 
(39
)
 
(5.2
)%
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
 
11,104
 
 
10,276
 
 
828
 
 
8.1
%
 
As of
December 31,
 
2016
2015
Capital Ratios
 
 
 
 
 
 
Risk-weighted assets
 
4,365
 
 
4,304
 
Tangible common equity (TCE)
 
649
 
 
516
 
Tangible assets (TA)
 
11,042
 
 
10,224
 
TCE/TA
 
5.9
%
 
5.1
%
Common Equity Tier 1
 
15.3
%
 
N/A
 
Total Tier 1
 
15.3
%
 
16.2
%
Total Capital
 
17.6
%
 
19.0
%
Leverage ratio
 
5.8
%
 
N/A
 

We maintain a liquid balance sheet and are well capitalized. As of December 31, 2016, total cash due from banks, short-term investments and investment in securities (excluding held-to-maturity investments) represented $6.1 billion, or 55.0% of total assets, up slightly from 50.8% at the end of 2015 due to an increase in available-for-sale securities and short-term investments due to an increase in customer deposits. Shareholders' equity at December 31, 2016 was $710.7 million, down from $750.4 million at the end of 2015 due primarily to the redemption and cancellation of all of the outstanding preference shares, despite our IPO and net income on the year. Of the shareholders' equity at the end of 2016, preference shareholders' equity was nil and common equity was $710.7 million (2015: $182.9 million and $567.5 million, respectively) due to the redemption and cancellation of all of the preference shares in December 2016.

109

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Total assets grew by $0.8 billion to $11.1 billion from 2015 to 2016, primarily reflecting a $0.8 billion increase in customer deposit levels reinvested in short-term investments, securities sold under agreement to repurchase and investment in securities, which grew by $1.4 billion.

As of December 31, 2016, our capital ratios were strong, and were significantly in excess of regulatory requirements. Effective January 1, 2016, the Bank's regulatory capital is determined in accordance with current Basel III guidelines as issued by the BMA. Basel III adopts CET1 as the predominant form of regulatory capital with the CET1 ratio as a new metric. Basel III also adopts the new Leverage Ratio regime, which is calculated by dividing Tier 1 capital by an exposure measure. The exposure measure consists of total assets (excluding items deducted from Tier 1 capital) and certain off-balance sheet items converted into credit exposure equivalents as well as adjustments for derivatives to reflect credit risk and other risks. Prior to January 1, 2016, the Bank's regulatory capital was determined in accordance with Basel II guidelines issued by the BMA.

The TCE/TA ratio at the end of 2016 was 5.9% (2015: 5.1%), while the CET1 and total tier 1 capital ratios at the end of 2016 were 15.3% (2015: 10.7%) and 15.3% (2015: 16.2%), respectively. These ratios continue to remain in excess of regulatory minimums at December 31, 2016.

Cash Due from Banks and Short-Term Investments

We only place deposits with highly-rated institutions and ensure that there is appropriate geographic and sector diversification in our exposures. Limits are set for aggregate geographic exposures and for every counterparty for which we place deposits. Those limits are monitored and reviewed by our Credit Risk Management division and approved by the Financial Institutions Committee. We define cash due from banks to include cash on hand, cash items in the process of collection, amounts due from correspondent banks and liquid investments that are readily convertible to known amounts of cash and which are subject to an insignificant risk of change in fair value. Such investments are those with less than three months maturity from the date of acquisition and include unrestricted term deposits, certificates of deposit and treasury bills. Investments of a similar nature that are either restricted or have a maturity of more than three months but less than one year are classified as short-term investments. As of December 31, 2016, cash due from banks and short-term investments were $2.8 billion, compared to $2.7 billion as of December 31, 2015. The increase from 2015 to 2016 was due to a $0.9 billion increase in average customer and bank deposits in 2016 that were partially placed in investments with the remainder being held in short term investments and securities sold under agreement to repurchase to maintain liquidity.

See “Note 3: Cash Due from Banks” and “Note 4: Short-Term Investments” to our audited consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 2016 for additional tables and information.

Investment in Securities

Our investment policy requires management to maintain a portfolio of securities that provide the liquidity necessary to cover our obligations as they come due, and mitigate our overall exposure to credit and interest rate risk, while achieving a satisfactory return on the funds invested. The securities in which we invest are limited to securities that are considered investment grade. Securities in our investment portfolio are accounted for as either trading, available-for-sale or held-to-maturity. Investment policies are approved by the Board, governed by the Group Asset and Liability Committee and monitored by Group Market Risk, a department of the Group Risk Management division.

Consistent with industry and rating agency designations, we define investment grade as “BBB” or higher. As of December 31, 2016, 99.9% (2015: 99.8%) of our total investments were investment grade. Of these securities, 93.7% (2015: 93.1%) are rated “A” or higher.

110

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following table presents the carrying value of investment securities by balance sheet category as of December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 
As of
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
Trading
 
6
 
 
321
 
 
(315
)
 
(98.1
)%
Available-for-sale
 
3,333
 
 
2,201
 
 
1,132
 
 
51.4
%
Held-to-maturity
 
1,061
 
 
701
 
 
360
 
 
51.4
%
Total Investment in Securities
 
4,400
 
 
3,224
 
 
1,176
 
 
36.5
%

The investment portfolio was $4.4 billion as of December 31, 2016, compared to $3.2 billion as of December 31, 2015. The increased portfolio size was due to purchases of liquid US government and federal agency securities using cash provided by the increased deposit base primarily as a result of the recent acquisition and organic business growth. New investments were placed primarily in US government and federal agency securities that totaled $3.5 billion, based upon carrying value, or 79.3% of the total investment portfolio, as of December 31, 2016. Total net unrealized losses of the investment portfolio were $36.4 million, compared to net unrealized gains of $0.7 million at the end of 2015. The movement in unrealized gains for the year was primarily driven by an increase in longer-term US treasury interest rates. The 10 year treasury rate was 2.45% as of December 31, 2016 compared to 2.27% the year before.

Trading securities totaled $6.3 million at the end of 2016, compared to $321.3 million at the end of 2015. As of December 31, 2016, trading securities consisted of real estate mutual funds and seed capital invested in mutual funds managed by us of 100.0%, or $6.3 million (2015: 1.9%, or $6.2 million). In the prior year, trading securities consisted of 86.9% or $279.3 million of holdings of securities issued by the US government and federal agencies, debt securities issued by non-US governments of 2.3%, or $7.5 million and guaranteed student loan-backed securities of 8.8%, or $28.3 million. The overall decrease in trading securities was in an effort to reduce volatility in earnings. These securities were held by our Guernsey and UK segment and were sold by the second quarter of 2016.

AFS securities totaled $3.3 billion at the end of 2016, compared to $2.2 billion at the end of 2015. As of December 31, 2016, 72.9% or $2.4 billion (2015: 63.8%, or $1.4 billion) of AFS securities consisted of holdings of securities issued by the US government and federal agencies. The US government guarantees 34.8% or $1,159.3 million (2015: 23.4% or $734.3 million) of these securities. Corporate debt securities represented 15.4%, or $514.5 million (2015: 23.0% or $506.1 million) of the AFS portfolio. As of December 31, 2016, the remaining 11.6%, or $387.9 million of AFS securities (2015: 13.3% or $290.7 million) was comprised primarily of commercial mortgage-backed securities of 4.5%, or $150.5 million (2015: 6.8%, or $148.7 million), guaranteed student loan-backed securities of 0.4%, or $12.5 million (2015: 0.6%, or $12.2 million), debt securities issued by non-US governments of 0.8%, or $27.0 million (2015: 1.3%, or $29.6 million) and residential mortgage-backed securities of 5.9%, or $197.8 million (2015: 4.6%, or $100.2 million). The overall increase in US government and federal agency securities was funded by the increase in the overall deposits, with a smaller portion being added to strategically selected residential mortgage-backed securities.

HTM investments were $1.1 billion as of December 31, 2016 (2015: $0.7 billion) and consisted entirely of mortgage-backed securities issued by US federal agencies that management does not intend to sell before maturity. The increase in the HTM portfolio was also related to a repositioning of the investment portfolio intended to increase investment yield and reduce volatility in other comprehensive income.

Investment Valuation — OTTI Considerations

Securities in unrealized loss positions are analyzed as part of management's ongoing assessment of OTTI. When management intends to sell securities, it recognizes an impairment loss equal to the full difference between the amortized cost basis and the fair value of those securities. When management does not intend and is not required to sell equity or debt securities in an unrealized loss position, potential OTTI is considered using a variety of factors, including: the length of time and extent to which the market

111

TABLE OF CONTENTS

value has been less than amortized cost; adverse conditions specifically related to the industry, geographic area or financial condition of the issuer or underlying collateral of a security; payment structure of the security; changes to the rating of the security by a rating agency; the volatility of the fair value changes; and changes in fair value of the security after the balance sheet date.

Management made a strategic repositioning of the investment portfolio during 2015, which resulted in the sale of AFS securities triggering realized losses of $4.4 million. The securities sold were primarily long duration, fixed income securities which were highly sensitive to interest rate risk and were sold in the lead-up to the announcement for a rate rise in December 2015. While management sold additional AFS securities in 2016, these securities were sold for gains of $0.9 million. Management does not have the intention or does not foresee a more likely than not scenario where management will be required to sell any further securities which are in an unrealized loss position, and accordingly, management has concluded that this sale does not result in an OTTI for any remaining securities in a loss position as of December 31, 2016.

See “Note 5: Investments in Securities” to our audited consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2016 for additional tables and information.

Loans

The loan portfolio decreased from $4.0 billion in 2015 to $3.6 billion as of December 31, 2016, due primarily to significant prepayments on the government, commercial and residential mortgage portfolio and unfavorable foreign exchange rate movements, without an adequate amount of new loans written to offset these decreases.

During the year ended 2016, gross loans written totaled $544.5 million, which were offset by paydowns of $854.2 million.

The loan portfolio represented 32.2% of total assets as of December 31, 2016 (2015: 38.9%), while loans as a percentage of customer deposits decreased from 43.6% at the end of 2015 to 35.7% at the end of 2016.

Allowance for credit losses as of December 31, 2016 totaled $44.2 million, a decrease of $5.1 million from the prior year. The movement in the allowance was mainly the result of charge-offs of $10.4 million recorded during the year, partially offset by incremental recoveries of $5.8 million (including recoveries of $1.4 million). Of the total allowance, the general allowance was $32.5 million (2015: $30.2 million) and the specific allowance was $11.7 million (2015: $19.1 million), reflecting a specific coverage ratio of 24.2%, compared to 29.3% as of December 31, 2015. The decrease in the specific coverage ratio reflects a proportionately higher decrease in specific provisions relative to the decrease in gross non-accrual loans. This was as a result of the recovery of a large commercial mortgage with a large provision relative to a decrease in non-accrual residential mortgages which previously carried smaller provisions.

Gross non-accrual loans totaled $48.5 million as of December 31, 2016, down $16.8 million from $65.3 million as of December 31, 2015, and represented 1.3% of the total loan portfolio as of December 31, 2016, compared to 1.6% as of December 31, 2015. During 2016, we held OREO amounting to $14.2 million (2015: $11.2 million), consisting of commercial real estate of $12.1 million (2015: $6.7 million), foreclosed residential properties of $2.1 million (2015: $4.5 million) and nil amount of property held for sale reclassified during 2016 (2015: nil).

Government

Loans to governments were $112.4 million, which was a $112.8 million decrease from 2015, due primarily to paydowns in government lending in Bermuda compared to new government lending in Bermuda in the prior year. This decrease accounts for 26.2% of the overall decrease in net loans year-on-year.

Commercial

The commercial and industrial loan portfolio includes loans and overdraft facilities advanced primarily to corporations and small and medium-sized entities, which are generally not collateralized by real estate and where loan repayments are expected to flow from the operation of the underlying businesses.

112

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Commercial real estate loans are offered to real estate investors, developers and builders domiciled primarily in Bermuda and the UK. To manage our credit exposure on such loans, the principal collateral is real estate held for commercial purposes and is supported by a registered mortgage. Cash flows from the properties, primarily from rental income, are generally supported by long-term leases to high quality international businesses. These cash flows are principally sufficient to service the loan. The portfolio decreased by $66.3 million to $609.8 million at December 31, 2016 due primarily to repayments of loans in our European jurisdictions.

Commercial loans outstanding as of December 31, 2016 were $357.2 million, which represented a decrease of $26.3 million from the previous year, driven by repayments of commercial lending facilities principally in the Cayman Islands and Bermuda.

Residential

The residential mortgage portfolio comprises mortgages to clients with whom we are seeking to establish (or already have) a comprehensive financial services relationship. It includes mortgages to individuals and corporate loans secured by residential property.

All mortgages were underwritten utilizing our stringent credit standards. See “Risk Management — Credit Risk.” Residential loans consist of conventional home mortgages and equity credit lines.

As of December 31, 2016, residential mortgages totaled $2.3 billion (or 64.6% of total gross loans), a $0.2 billion decrease from December 31, 2015. This decrease was mainly attributed to reductions in the residential mortgages portfolio across the Cayman and Guernsey jurisdictions and unfavorable foreign exchange movements within the portfolio, which were partially offset by increases in the UK residential mortgage portfolio. Residential lending in Bermuda was relatively stable year-on-year.

OREO and Non-Accrual Loans

While non-accrual loans decreased during the year by $16.8 million, OREO increased slightly by $3.0 million. The growth in OREO was driven by a commercial property which was foreclosed upon and added to OREO in Bermuda in the fourth quarter of 2016. Excluding the effect of this property, OREO decreased $4.9 million due to sales in the residential mortgage OREO portfolio in Bermuda. This decrease, along with the decrease in non-accrual loans, reflects the Bank's continued focus on improving the quality of our loan portfolio. Non-accrual loans decreased as a result of the Bank continuing to work with holders of non-performing loans, which resulted in several loans returning to a performing status during the year, primarily within residential mortgages.

Other Loan Portfolios

We provide loans, as part of our normal banking business, in respect of automobile financing, consumer financing, credit cards, commercial financing, loans to financial institutions and overdraft facilities to retail, corporate and private banking clients in the jurisdictions in which we operate. As of December 31, 2016, other consumer loans totaled $197.8 million (or 5.5% of total gross loans), a $29.7 million decrease from December 31, 2015. The decrease was due to repayments and expiration of loan facilities without sufficient new loan origination.

See “Note 6: Loans” and “Note 7: Credit Risk Concentrations” to our audited consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2016 for more information on our loan portfolio and contractual obligations and arrangements.

Deposits

Deposits are our principal funding source for use in lending, investments and liquidity. We are a deposit-led bank and do not require the use of wholesale or institutional markets to fund our loan business. See “Risk Management — Liquidity Risk” and “Risk Management — Credit Risk”. Deposit balances at the end of reporting periods, particularly in our Bermuda and Cayman Islands operations, can fluctuate due to significant balances that flow in and out from fund and insurance clients to meet quarter-end cyclical cash flow requirements.

113

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The table below shows the year-end and average customer deposit balances by jurisdiction for the year ended and as of December 31, 2016 and 2015:

 
As of
December 31
Dollar
change
Average
balance
Dollar
change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
2016
2015
Bermuda
 
5,947
 
 
4,272
 
 
1,675
 
 
5,270
 
 
4,013
 
 
1,257
 
Cayman
 
3,024
 
 
3,013
 
 
11
 
 
3,034
 
 
2,804
 
 
230
 
Guernsey
 
967
 
 
1,245
 
 
(278
)
 
1,178
 
 
1,366
 
 
(188
)
The Bahamas
 
72
 
 
40
 
 
32
 
 
56
 
 
66
 
 
(10
)
UK
 
 
 
598
 
 
(598
)
 
179
 
 
611
 
 
(432
)
Total customer deposits
 
10,010
 
 
9,168
 
 
842
 
 
9,717
 
 
8,860
 
 
857
 

Average customer deposits increased by $0.9 billion to $9.7 billion in 2016. On a year-end basis, customer deposits were up $0.8 billion to $10.0 billion from $9.2 billion at the end of 2015. The increase was largely from new clients as a result of the recent acquisition in Bermuda, as well as organic growth in both Bermuda and Cayman within consumer deposits.

Customer demand deposits, which include checking accounts (both interest bearing and non-interest bearing), savings and call accounts, totaled $8.2 billion, or 81.9% of total customer deposits at the end of 2016, compared to $7.7 billion, or 83.5%, at the end of 2015. Customer term deposits increased by $0.3 billion to $1.8 billion compared to the prior year. The cost of funds on deposits improved from 21 basis points in the full year ended 2015 to 12 basis points in 2016 as a result of an increase in average non-interest bearing deposits by $0.3 billion to $2.0 billion, and the payback of deposits from our UK jurisdiction, which in the prior year carried a cost of deposits of 75 basis points on a jurisdictional stand-alone basis.

See “Note 10: Customer Deposits and Deposits from Banks” to our audited consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2016 for additional tables and information.

Borrowings

We have no issuances of certificates of deposit (“CD”), commercial paper (“CP”) or senior notes outstanding and have no CD or CP issuance programs. We use funding from the inter-bank market as part of interest rate and liquidity management. As of December 31, 2016, deposits from banks totaled $23.8 million, an increase of $9.3 million from the prior year.

Employee Future Benefits

We maintain trusteed pension plans including non-contributory defined benefit plans and a number of defined contribution plans, and provide post-retirement healthcare benefits to our qualifying retirees. The defined benefit provisions under the pension plans are generally based upon years of service and average salary during the final years of employment. The defined benefit pension and post-retirement healthcare plans are not open to new participants and are non-contributory and the funding required is provided by us, based upon the advice of an independent actuary.

Effective December 31, 2011, the Bermuda defined benefit pension benefits were amended to freeze credited service and final average earnings for remaining active members. Effective January 2012, all the participants of the Bermuda defined benefit pension plan are inactive and in accordance with GAAP, the net actuarial loss of the Bermuda defined benefit pension plan is amortized over the estimated average remaining life expectancy of the inactive participants of 22.8 years. Prior to all Bermuda participants being inactive, the net actuarial loss of the Bermuda defined benefit pension plan was amortized to net income over the estimated average remaining service period for active members of 4.5 years.

Effective September 30, 2014, the defined benefit pension benefits of our Guernsey operations were amended to freeze credited service and final average earnings for remaining active members. The benefits amendment resulted in a further reduction in the Guernsey defined benefit pension liability of $4.6 million as of September 30, 2014.

114

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Effective October 2014, all of the participants of the Guernsey defined benefit pension plan are inactive and in accordance with GAAP, the net actuarial loss of the Guernsey defined benefit pension plan will be amortized over the estimated average remaining life expectancy of the inactive participants of 39 years. Prior to all Guernsey participants being inactive, the net actuarial loss of the Guernsey defined benefit pension plan was amortized to net income over the estimated average remaining service period for active members of 15 years.

For the year ended December 31, 2014, numerous changes in the plan provisions were made to align the plan provisions with our administrative practices, resulting in a further increase in the Bermuda defined benefit post-retirement healthcare plan liability of $7.9 million. We amortize prior service credit resulting from plan amendments that occurred when plan members were active employees, on a linear basis over the expected average remaining service period (to full eligibility) of active members expected to receive benefits under the plan. Such remaining service periods are as follow: 3.1 years for the 2010 plan amendments and 4.6 years for the 2011 plan amendments. Plan amendments occurring in 2014 resulted in the recognition of new prior service cost on December 31, 2014 on a plan for which substantially all members are now inactive and, in accordance with GAAP, we have elected to amortize this new prior service cost on a linear basis over 21 years, which is the average remaining life expectancy of members eligible for benefits under the plan at the time of the amendments.

As of December 31, 2016, we had a net obligation for employee future benefits in the amount of $140.0 million, up $17.8 million (14.6%) from $122.1 million at the end of 2015. The increase was driven by valuation changes caused by increased healthcare costs, partially offset by discount factor changes relating to interest rate fluctuations.

See “Note 11: Employee Benefits Plans” to our audited consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2016 for additional tables and information.

Long-Term Debt, Interest Payments and Maturities

We had outstanding issuances of long-term debt with a carrying value of $117.0 million as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, all issued in US Dollars. As of December 31, 2016, $70.2 million of our outstanding long-term debt was eligible for inclusion in our Tier 2 regulatory capital base and was limited to 50% of Tier 1 capital, down from $89.0 million at the end of 2015. There were no other significant movements in long-term debt during the period from December 31, 2015 to December 31, 2016.

The following table presents the contractual maturity, interest rates and principal outstanding as of December 31, 2016:

Long-term debt
(in millions of $)
Earliest date
redeemable at
the Bank's
option
Contractual
maturity date
Interest rate
until date
redeemable
Interest rate from
earliest date
redeemable to
contractual maturity
Principal
outstanding
(in millions of $)
2003 issuance — Series B
May 27, 2013
May 27, 2018
 
5.15
%
3 months $ LIBOR + 2.000%
 
47.0
 
2005 issuance — Series B
July 2, 2015
July 2, 2020
 
5.11
%
3 months $ LIBOR + 1.695%
 
45.0
 
2008 issuance — Series B
May 27, 2018
May 27, 2023
 
8.44
%
3 months $ LIBOR + 4.929%
 
25.0
 
Total
 
 
 
 
 
117.0
 

See “Note 19: Long-Term Debt” to our audited consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2016 for additional information.

Other Liabilities

Other liabilities include derivative liabilities, current employee salaries and benefits payable and related payroll tax, as well as sundry liabilities. Other liabilities decreased by $0.5 million to $100.0 million as of December 31, 2016. This decrease was a result of decreased accrued liabilities and deferred revenue, the latter of which is due to the timing of billing for trust revenues relative to the prior year. This was partially offset by a slight increase in derivative positions from the prior year. These derivatives were client service foreign exchange derivatives which are economically hedged and result in no foreign exchange gains or losses.

115

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Contractual Obligations

Credit-Related Arrangements

We enter into standby letters of credit, letters of guarantee and contractual commitments to extend credit in the normal course of business, which are not required to be recorded on the balance sheet. Since many commitments expire unused or only partially used, these totals do not necessarily reflect future cash requirements. Generally, the term of the standby letters of credit does not exceed one year, while the term of the letters of guarantee does not exceed four years. The following table sets forth the outstanding financial guarantees with contractual amounts representing credit risk as of the dates indicated:

 
December 31, 2016
December 31, 2015
(in millions of $)
Gross
Collateral
Net
Gross
Collateral
Net
Standby letters of credit
 
242.4
 
 
242.4
 
 
  —
 
 
258.9
 
 
257.2
 
 
1.7
 
Letters of guarantee
 
4.8
 
 
4.8
 
 
 
 
9.1
 
 
8.4
 
 
0.7
 
Total
 
247.2
 
 
247.2
 
 
 
 
268.0
 
 
265.6
 
 
2.4
 

The Bank enters into contractual commitments to extend credit, normally with fixed expiration dates or termination clauses, at specified rates and for specific purposes. Substantially all of the Bank's commitments to extend credit are contingent upon customers maintaining specific credit standards at the time of loan funding. Management assesses the credit risk associated with certain commitments to extend credit in determining the level of the allowance for possible loan losses. The following table sets forth the outstanding unfunded legally binding commitments to extend credit as of the dates indicated:

(in millions of $)
December 31,
2016
December 31,
2015
Commitments to extend credit
 
412.6
 
 
390.5
 
Documentary and commercial letters of credit
 
1.1
 
 
0.5
 
Total unfunded commitments to extend credit
 
413.6
 
 
391.0
 

The Bank has a facility by one of its custodians, whereby the Bank may offer up to $200 million of standby letters of credit to its customers on a fully secured basis. Under the standard terms of the facility, the custodian has the right to set-off against securities held of 110% of the utilized facility. At December 31, 2016, $110.3 million (December 31, 2015: $123.7 million) of standby letters of credit were issued under this facility.

Contractual Obligations

The following table presents our outstanding contractual obligations as of December 31, 2016:

(in millions)
Total
Less than 1
year
1 to 3
years
3 to 5
years
After 5
years
Long term debt(1)
 
117.0
 
 
 
 
47.0
 
 
45.0
 
 
25.0
 
Operating lease obligations
 
19.3
 
 
4.8
 
 
6.6
 
 
5.5
 
 
2.5
 
Sourcing arrangements(2)
 
69.8
 
 
17.2
 
 
27.6
 
 
25.1
 
 
 
Term deposits
 
1,816.6
 
 
1,750.0
 
 
66.6
 
 
 
 
 
Other obligations
 
9.2
 
 
2.5
 
 
4.8
 
 
1.2
 
 
0.6
 
Total outstanding contractual obligations
 
2,031.9
 
 
1,774.5
 
 
152.6
 
 
76.8
 
 
28.1
 
(1)Long term debt excludes interest.
(2)We also have an outstanding contractual obligation relating to a five-year agreement entered into in November 2016 with HP (previously EDS) to supply technology infrastructure and application development management, information security and technical support for our locations in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands. Under our agreement with HP, server management and maintenance, technology field support, application support and development and help desk functions are managed by HP. Our obligations to HP under this agreement amounted to $69.8 million as of December 31, 2016 (December 31, 2015: $16.3 million).

116

TABLE OF CONTENTS

See “Note 12: Credit related arrangements and commitments” to our audited consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2016 for additional information.

Interest expense on our contractual obligations primarily relates to term deposits and our long-term debt. Interest expense on term deposits was $7.7 million for the year-ended December 31, 2016, compared to $10.6 million and $12.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. Movements in interest expense on term deposits primarily are due to volume or rate movements, with yearly average term deposits of $1.6 billion, $1.5 billion and $1.7 billion for 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. The decrease in the expense is primarily related to rates in Bermuda, which decreased by 16 basis points in 2016 due to certain higher rate deposits being withdrawn during the year.

During the year-ended December 31, 2016, none of the rates on any tranches of our long-term debt reset. Interest expense on commitments decreased by $0.4 million as during July 2015, the rate on the 2005 issuance - Series B moved from fixed to floating, giving 2016 a full year at the lower floating rate versus a partial year in 2015. This also resulted in a decrease in interest expense on long-term debt from $5.6 million to $4.9 million from 2014 to 2015.

Repurchase Agreements

We also obtain funds from time to time from the sale of securities to institutional investors under repurchase agreements. In a repurchase agreement transaction, we will generally pledge investment securities as collateral in a borrowing transaction, agreeing to repurchase the identical security on a specified later date, generally not more than 90 days, at a price greater than the original sales price. The difference between the sale price and repurchase price is the cost of the use of the proceeds, or interest expense. The investment securities underlying these agreements may be delivered to securities dealers who arrange such transactions as collateral for the repurchase obligation. Repurchase agreements represent a cost competitive funding source and also provide liquidity on agency paper for us. However, we are subject to the risk that the borrower of the securities may default at maturity and not return the collateral. In order to minimize this potential risk when entering into such transactions, we generally deal with large, established investment brokerage firms with whom we have master repurchase agreements. Repurchase transactions are accounted for as collateralized financing arrangements rather than as sales of such securities, and the obligation to repurchase such securities is reflected as a liability in our consolidated financial statements. As of December 31, 2016 and 2015, there were no repurchase agreements outstanding.

Shareholders' Equity

Shareholders' equity decreased during the year ended December 31, 2016 by $39.6 million to $710.7 million.

Increases totaling $263.4 million included:

$115.9 million of net income for the year;
$126.2 million from the issuance of common shares;
$14.0 million for share-based settlements; and
$7.3 million of share-based settlement for stock options exercised.

These increases were offset by the following decreases totaling $303.0 million:

$212.1 million from the redemption and cancellation of all of the outstanding preference shares;
$26.4 million from adjustments to employee benefit plans;
$21.2 million from net change in unrealized gains (losses) on AFS investments;
$19.3 million of common share dividends;
$15.7 million of preference share dividends and guarantee fees;
$6.5 million of translation adjustments on foreign operations;

117

TABLE OF CONTENTS

$1.6 million from the purchase of treasury common shares; and
$0.2 million on other smaller adjustments.

On September 21, 2016, the Bank completed its offering of 5,957,447 common shares at $23.50 per share, which raised $126.2 million of capital. On December 16, 2016, the Bank completed the redemption and cancellation of all of its issued and outstanding preference shares for $212.1 million.

Liquidity

We define liquidity as our ability to maintain cash flow that is adequate to fund operations and meet present and future financial obligations through either the sale or maturity of existing assets or by obtaining additional funding through liability management.

Sources and Uses of Cash

Our primary sources of cash are (i) cash obtained from deposits, (ii) long-term debt, and (ii) cash from operations. Our primary uses are (i) the payment of our operating expenses, (ii) payment of dividends on our preference and common shares and guarantee fees, (iii) as repayment of certain maturing liabilities and (iv) extraordinary requirements for cash, such as acquisitions. We had $2.1 billion of cash and cash equivalents as of December 31, 2016 and $2.3 billion as of December 31, 2015, as well as $4.0 billion and $2.9 billion, respectively, of liquid securities, the balance of which could be sold to meet liquidity requirements. In our opinion, the Bank’s working capital is sufficient for the Bank’s present requirements.

Liquidity Risk

Our liquidity risk is managed through a comprehensive framework of policies and limits overseen by our Group Asset and Liability Committee. We consider the effective and prudent management of liquidity to be fundamental to our health and strength. Our objective is to manage our cash flow and liquidity reserves so that they are adequate to fund our obligations and other commitments on a timely basis and at a reasonable cost.

We continuously monitor and make adjustments to our liquidity position by adjusting the balance between sources and uses of funds as we deem appropriate. Our primary measures of liquidity include monthly cash flow analyses under ordinary business activities and conditions and under situations simulating a severe run on the Bank. The Bank strives to use a cautious liquidity risk appetite with internal quantitative liquidity risk tolerances more stringent than regulatory requirements. Specifically the Bank manages liquidity against internal limits established by the market risk management policy and its related liquidity risk standard and quarterly stress testing methodology. The results of these measures and analyses are incorporated into our liquidity contingency plan, which provides the basis for the identification of our liquidity needs. For more information, see “Risk Management — Liquidity Risk”.

Capital Resources

We manage our capital both on a consolidated basis and, where appropriate, on a legal entity basis. The finance department has the responsibility for measuring, monitoring and reporting capital levels within guidelines and limits established by the Risk Policy & Compliance Committee of the Board. The management of capital will also involve regional management to ensure compliance with local regulation. In establishing the guidelines and limits for capital, a variety of factors are taken into consideration, including the overall risk of the business in stressed scenarios, regulatory requirements, capital levels relative to our peers, and the impact on our credit ratings.

Effective January 1, 2015, the BMA implemented the capital reforms proposed by the BCBS and referred to as the Basel III regulatory framework. Basel III aims to raise the quality, consistency and transparency of the capital base, limit the build-up of excess leverage and increase capital requirements for the banking sector. Basel III adopts CET1 capital as the predominant form of regulatory capital with the CET1 ratio as a new metric. Basel III also adopts the new Leverage Ratio and Liquidity Coverage Ratio (“LCR”) regimes.

118

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank was required to report under both Basel II and Basel III guidance during 2015. However only the Basel II results were required to be published under guidance from the BMA. From January 1, 2016 onwards, all published ratios are calculated under Basel III. The Basel III regulatory framework adopts a phased implementation approach for Bermuda banks with full implementation on January 1, 2019, consistent with BCBS recommendations. When fully phased-in, we will be subject to the following requirements:

CET1 ratio of at least 7.0% of RWA, inclusive of a minimum CET1 ratio of 4.5% and the new capital conservation buffer of 2.5%;
Tier 1 capital of at least 8.5% of RWA, inclusive of the 2.5% capital conservation buffer;
Total capital of at least 10.5% of RWA, inclusive of the 2.5% capital conservation buffer;
We are considered to be a Domestic Systemically Important Bank (“D-SIB”) and are subject to a 3% surcharge composed of CET1-eligible capital implemented by the BMA effective September 30, 2015. This is based upon our assessment of the extent to which we (individually and collectively with the other Bermuda banks) pose a degree of material systemic risk to the economy of Bermuda due to our role in deposit taking, corporate lending, payment systems and other core economic functions;
Counter-cyclical buffer of up to 2.5% composed of CET1-eligible capital may be implemented by the BMA when macroeconomic indicators provide an assessment of excessive credit or other pressures building in the banking sector;
Leverage ratio must be at 5.0% or higher; and
LCR with a minimum requirement of 100%, subject to the phase-in rules.

The following table sets forth our capital adequacy as of December 31, 2016 and 2015 in accordance with the Basel III framework:

 
As of
December 31,
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
Capital
 
 
 
 
Tier 1 capital
 
666.8
 
 
699.3
 
Common Equity Tier 1
 
666.8
 
 
N/A
(2)
Tier 2 capital
 
102.7
 
 
119.1
 
Total capital
 
769.6
 
 
818.4
 
Risk Weighted Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks and investments
 
1,069.8
 
 
1,004.6
 
Loans
 
2,152.9
 
 
2,201.7
 
Other assets
 
258.8
 
 
278.5
 
Off-balance sheet items
 
251.8
 
 
215.0
 
Operational risk charge
 
632.1
 
 
604.3
 
Total risk-weighted assets
 
4,365.4
 
 
4,304.1
 
Capital Ratios (%)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common Equity Tier 1
 
15.3
%(1)
 
N/A
(2)
Tier 1 common
 
N/A
(1)
 
12.0
%(2)
Tier 1 total
 
15.3
%(1)
 
16.2
%(2)
Total capital
 
17.6
%(1)
 
19.0
%(2)
Leverage ratio
 
5.8
%(1)
 
N/A
(2)
(1)Effective January 1, 2016, the Bank's regulatory capital is determined in accordance with current Basel III guidelines issued by the BMA. Basel III adopts CET1 as the predominant form of regulatory capital with the CET1 ratio as a new metric. Basel III also adopts the new Leverage Ratio regime, which is calculated by dividing Tier 1 capital by an exposure measure. The exposure measure consists of total assets (excluding items deducted from Tier 1 capital) and certain off balance sheet items converted into credit exposure equivalents as well as adjustments for derivatives to reflect credit and other risks.
(2)Prior to January 1, 2016, the Bank's regulatory capital was determined in accordance with Basel II guidelines issued by the BMA.

119

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Tier 1 capital increased due to the issuance of 6.0 million common shares in the IPO as well as earnings on the year, which was partially offset by an increased deduction for goodwill and intangibles as a result of the HSBC Bermuda Trust business acquisition and a new Basel III deduction for defined pension fund assets. Total capital decreased due to the redemption and cancellation of all of our issued and outstanding preference shares in December 2016 and the impact of Basel III phase-out buyback rules on our non-qualifying long-term debt's eligibility for inclusion as Tier 2 capital. RWA remained flat, despite the significant increase in customer deposits which funded balance sheet growth, due to prudent capital management to accommodate the HSBC Bermuda Trust business acquisition. We are currently in compliance with the minimum LCR of 60% as well as the minimum LCR of 100% which will be applicable to us when the Basel III regulatory framework has been fully phased-in in 2019.

Preference Shares

In June 2009, we offered 200,000 shares of 8.00% non-cumulative perpetual limited voting preference shares of par value $0.01 with a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share for $200,000,000 in the aggregate. The preference shares were fully and unconditionally guaranteed, with the full faith and credit of the Government of Bermuda (the “Guarantor”), as to payment of dividends for up to ten years and as to payment of the liquidation preference on, or in certain circumstances prior to, the ten-year anniversary of the date of issuance (the “Guarantee”). On December 16, 2016, we redeemed and canceled all of the issued and outstanding preference shares for a total of $212.1 million, which comprised the sum of the most recent dividend payment, the net present value of future dividend payments that would have been paid through June 22, 2019 and the $1,000 liquidation preference on each preference share, discounted for present value.

Dividends on the preference shares were payable quarterly on a non-cumulative basis, only when, as and if declared by the Board, on March 15, June 15, September 15 and December 15 of each year at a fixed rate equal to 8.00% per annum on the liquidation preference, commencing on September 15, 2009.

Contingent Value Convertible Preference Shares

In May 2010, we offered up to 9.9 million common shares and 0.8 million contingent value convertible preference shares (“CVCP shares”) in the form of up to 10.74 million Rights Units, each Unit consisting of 0.92038 common shares and 0.07692 CVCP shares, for each common share held at a price of $12.10 per Rights Unit. Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.

On March 31, 2015, all remaining issued and outstanding CVCP shares were converted to common shares at a conversion ratio of 1:1.

Share Buy-Back Program

We initially introduced two share buy-back programs on May 1, 2012 as a means to improve shareholder liquidity and facilitate growth in share value. Each program was approved by the Board for a period of 12 months, in accordance with the regulations of the BSX. The BSX is advised monthly of shares purchased pursuant to each program.

Common Share Buy-Back Program

Effective April 1, 2014, the Board approved the 2014 common share buy-back program authorizing the purchase for treasury of up to 1.5 million common shares.

On February 26, 2015, the Board approved, with effect from April 1, 2015, the 2015 common share buy-back program, authorizing the purchase for treasury of up to 0.8 million common shares.

On February 19, 2016, the Board approved, with effect from April 1, 2016, the 2016 common share buy-back program, authorizing the purchase for treasury of up to 0.8 million common shares. The repurchase of shares pursuant to the buy-back program is subject to the approval of the BMA. However, we do not intend to repurchase any common shares under this program, which expires on March 31, 2017.

120

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Total common share buy-backs for the years ending December 31, 2016, 2015, 2014, and 2013 are as follows:

 
For the year ending December 31,
 
2016
2015
2014
2013
Total
Acquired number of shares (to the nearest share)
 
97,053
 
 
250,371
 
 
856,734
 
 
403,848
 
 
1,608,006
 
Average cost per common share (in $)
 
16.36
 
 
19.42
 
 
19.86
 
 
13.89
 
 
18.08
 
Total cost (in $)
 
1,588,189
 
 
4,862,248
 
 
17,018,412
 
 
5,610,907
 
 
29,079,756
 

On April 30, 2015, we repurchased and canceled 8,000,000 common shares held by CIBC for $15.00 per share, for a total of $120.0 million. The remaining CIBC shareholding in Butterfield (representing 2,343,423 shares) was purchased by Carlyle Global Financial Services, L.P. at $15.00 per share and subsequently sold to other investors.

On August 13, 2015, we repurchased and canceled 400,000 common shares held by two directors for $14.90 per share, for a total of $6.0 million.

The foregoing reflects the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.

Preference Share Buy-Back Program

On April 28, 2014, the Board approved the 2014 preference share buy-back program, authorizing the purchase and cancellation of up to 26,600 preference shares.

On February 26, 2015, the Board approved, with effect from May 5, 2015, the 2015 preference share buy-back program, authorizing the purchase and cancellation of up to 5,000 preference shares.

Total preference share buy-backs for the years ending December 31, 2016, 2015, 2014, and 2013 are as follows:

 
For the year ending December 31,
 
2016
2015
2014
2013
Total
Acquired number of shares (to the nearest share)
 
     —
 
 
183
 
 
560
 
 
11,972
 
 
12,715
 
Average cost per common share (in $)
 
 
 
1,151.55
 
 
1,172.26
 
 
1,230.26
 
 
1,226.57
 
Total cost (in $)
 
 
 
210,734
 
 
656,465
 
 
14,728,624
 
 
15,595,823
 

All of the preference shares were redeemed and canceled in December 2016.

From time to time, our associates, insiders and insiders' associates as defined by the BSX regulations may sell shares which may result in such shares being repurchased pursuant to each program, provided no more than any such person's pro-rata share of the listed securities is repurchased. Pursuant to the BSX regulations, all repurchases made by any issuer pursuant to a securities repurchase program must be made: (1) in the open market and not by private agreement; and (2) for a price not higher than the last independent trade for a round lot of the relevant class of securities.

Warrants

Following the capital raise on March 2, 2010, the terms of the 427,960 warrants with an exercise price of $70.10 previously issued to the Government of Bermuda in conjunction with the issuance of the preference shares in 2009 were adjusted in accordance with the terms of the Guarantee. Subsequently, the Government of Bermuda held 0.43 million (2015: 0.43 million) warrants with an exercise price of $34.72 (2015: $34.72) with an expiration date of June 22, 2019. On December 16, 2016, the Bank announced that it had repurchased for cancellation all of the outstanding warrants for $0.1 million.

Dividends

During the year ended December 31, 2016, we paid cash dividends totaling $19.3 million or $0.40 for each common share on record as of the related record dates (2015: $24.8 million or $0.50 for each

121

TABLE OF CONTENTS

common share and CVCP share on record), and subsequent to year-end, we declared a dividend of $0.32 for each common share on the related record date for the fourth quarter of 2016. The CVCP shares were all converted to common shares on March 31, 2015.

The Board also declared dividends of $0.10 per common share for each of the first three quarters of 2016, and $0.32 per share for the fourth quarter of 2016. These per share amounts reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split” and “Risk Factors – Risks Relating to the Common Shares – Holders of our common shares may not receive dividends”.

During the year ended December 31, 2015, we declared the full 8.00% cash dividends on preference shares in each quarter. During the year ended December 31, 2016, we declared the full 8.00% cash dividends on preference shares in the first three quarters and then redeemed the preference shares in December 2016. Preference share dividends declared and paid were $14.6 million during 2016 (2015: $14.6 million). Guarantee fees paid to the Government of Bermuda were $1.7 million during 2016 (2015: $1.8 million).

Cash Flows

2016 vs. 2015

Cash due from banks was $2.1 billion as of December 31, 2016, compared to $2.3 billion as of December 31, 2015. The increase is described below by category of operating, investing and financing activities.

For the year ended December 31, 2016, net cash provided by operating activities totaled $178.2 million (2015: $155.5 million). Cash flows from operating activities are generally the cash effects of transactions and other events that enter into the determination of net income. Cash provided by operating activities increased by $22.7 million from 2015 to 2016, due primarily to an increase in net income and an increase on cash received on settlement of share-based payments. This was partially offset by a decrease in the net realized gains (losses on AFS investments and a relatively larger increase in accrued interest receivable).

Net cash used in investing activities for the year ending December 31, 2016 totaled $1.2 billion, compared to cash used in investing activities of $325.8 million in 2015. The $873.9 million decrease in cash used in investing activities in 2015 was mainly attributable to an increase in cash disbursed for short-term investments, securities purchased under agreement to resell, as well as increased purchases of AFS and HTM investments, a decrease in sale proceeds from AFS investments and cash disbursed for a business acquisition. This was partially offset by a relatively higher decrease in cash outflow on loan growth.

Net cash provided by financing activities totaled $939.6 million in 2016, compared to net cash provided by financing activities of $426.9 million in 2015. The $512.7 million increase is mainly due to an increase in demand and term deposits and the proceeds from the issuance of common shares, net of underwriting discounts and commissions. This was partially offset by cash disbursed to redeem and cancel all of the outstanding preference shares.

2015 vs. 2014

Cash due from banks was $2.3 billion as of December 31, 2015, compared to $2.1 billion as of December 31, 2014. The increase is described below by category of operating, investing and financing activities.

For the year ended December 31, 2015, net cash provided by operating activities totaled $155.5 million (2014: $143.8 million). Cash flows from operating activities are generally the cash effects of transactions and other events that enter into the determination of net income. Cash provided by operating activities increased from 2014 to 2015, due primarily to an increase in other liabilities and employee benefit plans, and the movement in net realized gains (losses) on AFS investments, offset by a decrease in net income that generated lower cash earnings compared to the prior year, and an increase in other assets.

122

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Our investing activities include capital expenditures, loan activities, investment activities, and divesture and acquisition activities. We do not own, directly or indirectly, any shares of stock or any other equity interest or long-term debt securities of any company, corporation, firm, partnership, joint venture, association or other entity, except pursuant to the ordinary course of investment activities, the strategic investment in an associated company or as a result of the ordinary course of loan origination. Net cash used in investing activities for the year ending December 31, 2015 totaled $325.8 million, compared to cash used in investing activities of $258.7 million in 2014. The $67.1 million increase in cash used in investing activities in 2015 was mainly attributable to a decrease in purchases of short-term investments, and a $0.2 million increase in proceeds from maturities and pay-downs on AFS investments, and an increase in proceeds from sales on AFS investments, which was partially offset by an increase in purchases of AFS investments, a decrease in loans movement and the relative decrease from the deposits acquired in the HSBC acquisition in Cayman in 2014.

Net cash provided by financing activities totaled $426.9 million in 2015, compared to net cash provided by financing activities of $461.7 million in 2014. The $34.8 million decrease is mainly due to a $39.1 million decrease in deposit growth, a $113.8 million increase in common shares repurchased attributable to the share repurchase and cancellation of the majority of CIBC’s shareholding and repurchases from two other shareholders, which was partially offset by decrease in repayment of long-term debt due to the redemption of the $90 million Series A note in 2014 and a decrease in securities sold under agreement to repurchase.

Off Balance Sheet Arrangements

Assets Under Administration and Assets Under Management

In the normal course of business, we hold assets under administration and assets under management in a fiduciary or agency capacity for our clients. In accordance with GAAP, these assets are not our assets and are not included in our consolidated balance sheets.

Credit-Related Arrangements

We enter into standby letters of credit, letters of guarantee and contractual commitments to extend credit in the normal course of business, which are not required to be recorded on the balance sheet. Since many commitments expire unused or only partially used, these arrangements do not necessarily reflect future cash requirements. Management believes there are no material commitments to extend credit that represent risks of an unusual nature.

Standby letters of credit and letters of guarantee are issued at the request of our clients in order to secure a client's payment or performance obligations to a third party. These guarantees represent our irrevocable obligation to pay the third-party beneficiary upon presentation of the guarantee and satisfaction of the documentary requirements stipulated therein, without investigation as to the validity of the beneficiary's claim against the client. Generally, the term of the standby letters of credit does not exceed one year, while the term of the letters of guarantee does not exceed four years.

Credit risk is the principal risk associated with these instruments. The contractual amounts of these instruments represent the credit risk should the instrument be fully drawn upon and the client defaults. To control the credit risk associated with issuing letters of credit and letters of guarantee, we subject such activities to the same credit quality and monitoring controls as our lending activities. The types and amounts of collateral security we hold for these standby letters of credit and letters of guarantee are generally represented by our deposits or a charge over assets held in mutual funds. We are obligated to meet the entire financial obligation of these agreements and in certain cases are able to recover the amounts paid through recourse against the collateral security.

Segment Overview

The Bank manages its segments on a geographic basis which are grouped into the following six business segments based upon the geographic location of the Bank's operations: Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, Guernsey, Switzerland, The Bahamas and the United Kingdom. Transactions between segments are accounted for on an accrual basis and are all eliminated upon consolidation. The Bank generally does

123

TABLE OF CONTENTS

not allocate assets, revenues and expenses among its business segments, with the exception of certain corporate overhead expenses and loan participation revenue and expense. Loan participation revenue and expenses are allocated pro-rata based upon the percentage of the total loan funded by each jurisdiction participating in the loan.

Note that the operations of Switzerland and The Bahamas are not included in the following discussion due to their small scale of operations and their immaterial impact to the Bank's overall results.

Bermuda (Including Head Office)

For more than 150 years, Bermuda has served as home to our headquarters and remains our largest jurisdiction in terms of number of employees, Banking Center locations and business volume. The following table provides certain financial information for our Bermuda segment for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014.

Summary Income Statement
For the year ended
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
2014
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
Net interest income
 
162.1
 
 
145.1
 
 
144.7
 
 
17.0
 
 
0.4
 
 
11.7
%
 
0.3
%
Provision for credit losses
 
(7.3
)
 
(3.6
)
 
(6.4
)
 
(3.7
)
 
2.8
 
 
102.8
%
 
(43.8
)%
Non-interest income
 
71.8
 
 
61.1
 
 
60.7
 
 
10.7
 
 
0.4
 
 
17.5
%
 
0.7
%
Net revenue before other gains (losses)
 
226.6
 
 
202.5
 
 
199.0
 
 
24.1
 
 
3.5
 
 
11.9
%
 
1.8
%
Operating expenses
 
(164.5
)
 
(159.5
)
 
(145.7
)
 
(5.0
)
 
(13.8
)
 
3.1
%
 
9.5
%
Net income before other gains (losses)
 
62.1
 
 
43.0
 
 
53.3
 
 
19.1
 
 
(10.3
)
 
44.4
%
 
(19.3
)%
Total other gains (losses)
 
1.4
 
 
(2.5
)
 
6.9
 
 
3.9
 
 
(9.4
)
 
156.0
%
 
(136.2
)%
Net income
 
63.5
 
 
40.5
 
 
60.2
 
 
23.0
 
 
(19.7
)
 
56.8
%
 
(32.7
)%
Summary Balance Sheet
As of
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
Customer deposits
 
5,947
 
 
4,272
 
 
1,675
 
 
39.2
%
Loans, net of allowance for credit losses
 
1,997
 
 
2,207
 
 
(210
)
 
(9.5
)%
Total assets
 
6,765
 
 
5,114
 
 
1,651
 
 
32.3
%
Assets under administration
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Custody and other administration services
 
17,904
 
 
29,367
 
 
(11,463
)
 
(39.0
)%
Trust
 
50,118
 
 
32,064
 
 
18,054
 
 
56.3
%
Assets under management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Butterfield Funds
 
1,659
 
 
1,644
 
 
15
 
 
0.9
%
Other assets under management
 
1,777
 
 
479
 
 
1,298
 
 
271.0
%
Total assets under management
 
3,436
 
 
2,123
 
 
1,313
 
 
61.8
%
Number of employees
 
668
 
 
529
 
 
139
 
 
26.3
%

2016 vs. 2015

Net income before other gains and losses was $62.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2016, up by $19.1 million from $43.0 million in the prior year, due principally to decreased project-related professional fees, which were down by $9.5 million to $10.8 million, increased loan interest income, which was up by $6.3 million to $122.6 million, increased investment income, which was up $4.8 million to $44.7 million, increased deposit interest income, which was up $4.5 million to $6.1 million, increased trust revenue, which was up by $4.6 million to $16.7 million, increased asset management revenue, which was up $4.4 million to $13.3 million, partially offset by increased salary and other employee benefit costs, which were up by $13.1 million to $80.4 million.

Other gains of $1.4 million during the year were favorable by $3.9 million compared to net losses of $2.5 million in 2015. Other gains in 2016 were due primarily to realized gains upon the sale of certain AFS investments of $0.6 million and a $0.6 million receipt from a liquidation distribution on a pass-through note

124

TABLE OF CONTENTS

which was previously fully impaired in 2010. Net income after gains and losses was $63.5 million in 2016, an increase of $23.0 million from $40.5 million in the prior year.

Net interest income before provision for credit losses increased by $17.0 million to $162.1 million in 2016, driven primarily by increased investment income due to a higher average balance of investments, increased loan interest income, increased deposit income, both from higher average balances, and lower deposit expense due to a lower average volume of interest bearing deposits.

Provision for credit losses was $7.3 million, up $3.7 million from the prior year, which resulted primarily from large provisions for commercial loans and residential mortgages that were taken in 2016, compared to much lower required provisions in 2015. This was partially offset by increased recoveries and unfavorable growth in new loans written and quicker than expected prepayments in 2016.

Non-interest income increased by $10.7 million to $71.8 million in 2016, due primarily to increased trust revenue, which was up $4.6 million from the prior year, and increased asset management revenue, which was up $4.4 million from the prior year, both of which are primarily driven by the acquisition of HSBC’s private banking investment management and trust businesses.

Operating expenses increased by $5.0 million to $164.5 million in 2016 due primarily to a non-core share based compensation expense as a result of the vesting of legacy 2010 performance options, increased salary and other employee benefit costs which were primarily driven by increased headcount from the onboarding of staff from the recent acquisition, partially offset by lower project-related professional fees.

Total assets as of December 31, 2016 were $6.8 billion, up $1.7 billion from December 31, 2015. Customer deposits ended 2016 at $5.9 billion, up $1.7 billion from the end of 2015 from deposits which were a result of the recent acquisition during the year, and loan balances ended 2016 at $2.0 billion, down $0.2 billion from the end of 2015.

Client assets under administration for the trust and custody businesses as of December 31, 2016 were $50.1 billion and $17.9 billion, respectively, while assets under management were $3.4 billion. This compares with $32.1 billion, $29.4 billion and $2.1 billion, respectively, as of December 31, 2015.

2015 vs. 2014

Net income before other gains and losses decreased $10.3 million for the year-ended December 31, 2015 from December 31, 2014 due principally to increased project-related professional fees, which were up by $6.2 million to $14.0 million, increased severance and early retirement costs which were up by $3.9 million to $6.6 million, a $4.8 million provision in connection with the ongoing US investigation relating to the so-called John Doe Summonses, partially offset by lower provisions for credit losses which were down by $2.8 million to $3.6 million. See “Business — Legal Proceedings”.

Other losses of $2.5 million during the prior year were unfavorable by $9.4 million compared to net gains of $6.9 million in 2014. Other losses in 2015 were due primarily to realized losses upon the sale of certain AFS investments of $2.8 million due to the strategic repositioning of the investment portfolio partially offset by decreased valuation allowances taken on foreclosed properties. In 2014, a $8.7 million gain was recorded on liquidation proceeds from our last remaining pass-through note. Net income after gains and losses was $40.5 million, a decrease of $19.7 million from $60.2 million in the prior year.

Net interest income before provision for credit losses increased by $0.4 million to $145.1 million in 2015. The increase was driven primarily by increased investment income due to higher average balance of investments, lower deposit expense and long term debt interest expense, partially offset by lower loan interest income due to lower average loan balances.

Provision for credit losses was down $2.8 million from 2014 to 2015 due to large provisions for commercial loans and residential mortgages that were taken in 2014, combined with increased recoveries in 2015.

Non-interest income increased by $0.4 million to $61.1 million in 2015, due primarily to increased asset management revenue from increased money market fund rates and other one-time fees, increased banking revenues resulting primarily from increased electronic banking revenues, which was partially

125

TABLE OF CONTENTS

offset by decreased rental income from the sale of hotel properties in 2014 and decreased foreign exchange and trust revenues due to decreased volumes.

Operating expenses increased by $13.8 million to $159.5 million in 2015 due to higher project-related professional fees, increased salaries and other benefits expense relating to increased severance and post-retirement medical expense, partially offset by reduced headcount and incentive compensation, a provision in connection with the ongoing US investigation relating to the John Doe Summonses, and increased non-income taxes from higher payroll taxes, partially offset by decreased property management and maintenance costs resulting from the sale of hotel properties in 2014 as well as cost savings initiatives resulting in lower electrical costs.

Cayman Islands

We are a leading financial services provider in the Cayman Islands, offering a comprehensive range of personal and corporate financial services. In addition to our strong retail presence, we are focused on the provision of wealth management services including private banking, asset management and trust services.

We have continued to enhance our client delivery channels including online and mobile banking, and introduced Chip & PIN enabled and American Airlines affinity credit card products in the market. With three Banking Centers in desirable locations and 14 ATMs strategically located in Grand Cayman, we continue to be a leading provider of financial services locally. The following table provides certain financial information for our Cayman Islands segment for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014.

Summary Income Statement
For the year ended
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
2014
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
Net interest income
 
80.0
 
 
66.9
 
 
59.4
 
 
13.1
 
 
7.5
 
 
19.6
%
 
12.6
%
Provision for credit losses
 
2.1
 
 
(0.5
)
 
(0.6
)
 
2.6
 
 
0.1
 
 
(520.0
)%
 
(16.7
)%
Non-interest income
 
41.4
 
 
39.5
 
 
33.5
 
 
1.9
 
 
6.0
 
 
4.8
%
 
17.9
%
Net revenue before other gains (losses)
 
123.5
 
 
106.0
 
 
92.3
 
 
17.5
 
 
13.7
 
 
16.5
%
 
14.8
%
Operating expenses
 
(60.6
)
 
(58.1
)
 
(58.8
)
 
(2.5
)
 
0.7
 
 
4.3
%
 
(1.2
)%
Net income before other gains (losses)
 
62.9
 
 
47.9
 
 
33.5
 
 
15.0
 
 
14.4
 
 
31.3
%
 
43.0
%
Total other gains (losses)
 
(0.5
)
 
(0.8
)
 
 
 
0.3
 
 
(0.8
)
 
37.5
%
 
(100.0
)%
Net income
 
62.4
 
 
47.1
 
 
33.5
 
 
15.3
 
 
13.6
 
 
32.5
%
 
40.6
%
Summary Balance Sheet
As of
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
Customer deposits
 
3,024
 
 
3,013
 
 
11
 
 
0.4
%
Loans, net of allowance for credit losses
 
1,182
 
 
1,105
 
 
77
 
 
7.0
%
Total assets
 
3,393
 
 
3,282
 
 
111
 
 
3.4
%
Assets under administration
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Custody and other administration services
 
2,323
 
 
2,008
 
 
315
 
 
15.7
%
Trust
 
4,018
 
 
3,463
 
 
555
 
 
16.0
%
Assets under management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Butterfield Funds
 
76
 
 
83
 
 
(7
)
 
(8.4
)%
Other assets under management
 
770
 
 
768
 
 
2
 
 
0.3
%
Total assets under management
 
846
 
 
851
 
 
(5
)
 
(0.6
)%
Number of employees
 
304
 
 
293
 
 
11
 
 
3.8
%

126

TABLE OF CONTENTS

2016 vs. 2015

Net income before other gains and losses for the year ended December 31, 2016 was $62.9 million, up by $15.0 million from $47.9 million in 2015. The increase was due primarily to increases in interest income on investments and loans and non-interest income led by volume-driven banking, and foreign exchange income, partially offset by increased costs in technology and communications, professional services and loan servicing fees.

Net interest income before provision for credit losses was $80.0 million in 2016, an improvement of $13.1 million compared to 2015. The increase from 2015 to 2016 was driven primarily by an improvement in loan income of $5.8 million from a $100 million increase in average loans attributable largely to increased inter-group loan participation levels and investment income which was up by $7.0 million from 2015 to 2016 as a result of an increase in average AFS and HTM investment balances. Deposit liability costs decreased from $2.1 million in 2015 to $2.0 million in 2016 following the balance run-off on a high interest notice deposit product and impact of low to negative rates on currency demand deposits.

Provision for credit losses was a recovery of $2.1 million in 2016, representing a decrease of $2.6 million compared to credit losses in 2015. This decrease was primarily a result of a revision to the country risk factor applied in 2016.

Non-interest income was $41.4 million, up $1.9 million from 2015 due primarily to volume driven increases in banking fees led by account service charges, wire transfer and card volumes, and foreign exchange income.

Other losses for the year ended December 31, 2016 were $0.5 million, a decrease of $0.3 million from the prior year, which resulted primarily from investment sales as a part of the strategic repositioning of the investment portfolio and a write-down on other real estate owned.

Operating expenses increased by $2.5 million from 2015 to 2016, to $60.6 million, driven primarily by increased costs in technology and communication, professional services and loan servicing fees.

Total assets as of December 31, 2016 were $3.4 billion, up $0.1 billion from the end of 2015, reflecting higher total deposit levels. Net loans increased $0.1 billion from year-end 2015 to year-end 2016 at $1.2 billion. The AFS investments, at $1.2 billion at the end of 2016, were up $0.2 billion, year over year. The HTM investments, at $0.6 billion at the end of 2016, were up $0.3 billion, year over year.

Client assets under administration for the trust and custody businesses were $4.0 billion and $2.3 billion, respectively, while assets under management were $0.8 billion at the end of 2016. This compares with $3.5 billion, $2.0 billion and $0.9 billion, respectively, on December 31, 2015.

2015 vs. 2014

Net income before other gains and losses for the year ended December 31, 2015 was up by $14.4 million from $33.5 million in 2014. The increase was due primarily to increases in interest income on investments and loans and non-interest income led by volume-driven banking, foreign exchange income, trust and asset management fees, partially offset by increased costs in technology and communications, professional services and loan servicing fees.

Net interest income before provision for credit losses was an improvement of $7.5 million compared to 2014. The increase was primarily driven from an improvement in loan income of $4.3 million from a $104.0 million increase in average loans attributable largely to the acquisition of loans and deposits from HSBC Bank (Cayman) Limited in the fourth quarter of 2014. Investment income was up by $3.5 million from 2014 to 2015, resulting from an increase in average AFS and HTM investment balances. Deposit liability costs increased from $1.9 million in 2014 to $2.1 million in 2015 on growth in average interest bearing customer deposits.

Provision for credit losses of $0.5 million was $0.1 million lower than provision for credit losses in 2014.

127

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Non-interest income was $39.5 million in 2015, up $6.0 million over 2014. The increase was due primarily to volume driven increases in foreign exchange and banking fees led by wire transfer, account service charges and card volumes, along with asset management and trust fees partially offset by lower rental income.

Other losses for the year ended December 31, 2015, was $0.8 million, an increase of $0.8 million from 2014 primarily from investment sales as a part of the strategic repositioning of the investment portfolio, partially offset by the gain on the sale of Butterfield House, a building we formerly occupied.

Operating expenses decreased $0.7 million from 2014 to 2015 to $58.1 million, driven primarily by acquisition integration and other project costs in 2014 along with lower technology and communication costs in the current year, which were partially offset by increased salary and employee benefit costs and amortization of intangible assets following the acquisition of loans and deposits from HSBC Bank (Cayman) Limited in the fourth quarter of 2014.

Guernsey

In Guernsey, we offer private banking, lending, asset management, custody, administered banking and fiduciary services. The following table provides certain financial information for our Guernsey segment for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014.

Summary Income Statement
For the year ended
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
2014
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
Net interest income
 
14.1
 
 
16.6
 
 
18.1
 
 
(2.5
)
 
(1.5
)
 
(15.1
)%
 
(8.3
)%
Provision for credit losses
 
(0.4
)
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.2
)
 
(0.3
)
 
0.1
 
 
300.0
%
 
(50.0
)%
Non-interest income
 
24.6
 
 
26.2
 
 
26.8
 
 
(1.6
)
 
(0.6
)
 
(6.1
)%
 
(2.2
)%
Net revenue before other gains (losses)
 
38.3
 
 
42.7
 
 
44.7
 
 
(4.4
)
 
(2.0
)
 
(10.3
)%
 
(4.5
)%
Operating expenses
 
(35.5
)
 
(39.9
)
 
(39.6
)
 
4.4
 
 
(0.3
)
 
(11.0
)%
 
0.8
%
Net income before other gains (losses)
 
2.8
 
 
2.8
 
 
5.1
 
 
 
 
(2.3
)
 
%
 
(45.1
)%
Total other gains (losses)
 
(1.0
)
 
(1.1
)
 
4.4
 
 
0.1
 
 
(5.5
)
 
9.1
%
 
(125.0
)%
Net income
 
1.8
 
 
1.7
 
 
9.6
 
 
0.1
 
 
(7.9
)
 
5.9
%
 
(82.3
)%
Summary Balance Sheet
As of
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
Customer deposits
 
967
 
 
1,245
 
 
(278
)
 
(22.3
)%
Loans, net of allowance for credit losses
 
519
 
 
433
 
 
86
 
 
19.9
%
Total assets
 
1,133
 
 
1,391
 
 
(258
)
 
(18.5
)%
Assets under administration
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Custody and other administration services
 
4,449
 
 
6,253
 
 
(1,804
)
 
(28.9
)%
Trust
 
28,262
 
 
31,339
 
 
(3,077
)
 
(9.8
)%
Assets under management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Butterfield Funds
 
56
 
 
55
 
 
1
 
 
1.8
%
Other assets under management
 
338
 
 
355
 
 
(17
)
 
(4.8
)%
Total assets under management
 
394
 
 
410
 
 
(16
)
 
(3.9
)%
Number of employees
 
209
 
 
203
 
 
6
 
 
3.0
%

2016 vs. 2015

Our Guernsey segment posted net income before gains and losses of $2.8 million in 2016, flat when compared to 2015. This was due to the offsetting effects of lower non-interest expenses due to lower salaries and benefits costs due to exit costs incurred in the prior year, which was offset by lower revenues which were generally a result of adverse exchange rate movements. In GBP equivalent, net income before gains and losses was up £0.3 million.

Other losses for 2016 were $1.0 million, down by $0.1 million compared to net losses of $1.1 million in 2015, due primarily to valuation changes on certain US government and federal agency securities in

128

TABLE OF CONTENTS

2015 compared a revision to the purchase price allocation of the Legis transaction in 2016 due to positive results during a previously established earn-out period. Net income after gains and losses was $1.8 million in 2016, an increase of $0.1 million from $1.7 million in 2015.

Net interest income before provision for credit losses decreased by $2.5 million to $14.1 million in 2016, compared to $16.6 million in 2015, primarily due to lower interest income earned on investments from the sale of the investment book in June 2016, as well as adverse exchange rate movements.

Provision for credit losses was $0.4 million, compared to $0.1 million in 2015 due to increased general provisioning rates on United Kingdom exposures together with the impact of increased participation in United Kingdom loans driving higher average loan balances.

Non-interest income decreased by $1.6 million to $24.6 million in 2016, attributable to adverse exchange rate movements which more than offset increases in trust revenues principally from higher time spent and special fees.

Operating expenses of $35.5 million in 2016 were $4.4 million lower than 2015 due to favorable exchange rate movements. In local currency, salaries and other staff benefits were lower than the prior year resulting from a slightly lower average headcount. Offsetting this was higher technology expenses from increased infrastructure investment and higher professional fees.

Total assets of $1.1 billion as of December 31, 2016 were down from $1.4 billion as of December 31, 2015 primarily from adverse exchange rates.

At the end of 2016, client assets under administration for the trust and custody businesses were $28.3 billion and $4.4 billion, respectively, while assets under management were $0.4 billion as of December 31, 2016. This compares with $31.3 billion, $6.3 billion and $0.4 billion, respectively, as of December 31, 2015.

2015 vs. 2014

Net income before gains and losses decreased $2.3 million from 2014 to 2015. The year-over-year decrease is due mainly to increased expenses, primarily salaries and benefits, as a result of the full year of increased full-time headcounts from the Legis transaction, as well as adverse exchange rate movements affecting revenues. In GBP equivalent, net revenues before gains and losses were up £0.8 million, largely resulting from a full year of revenue from the Legis transaction.

Other gains (losses) decreased $5.5 million from 2014 to 2015 due primarily to valuation changes on certain US government and federal agency securities. Net income after gains and losses was $7.9 million lower than the prior year.

Net interest income before provision for credit losses decreased by $1.5 million from 2014 to 2015 primarily due to lower interest income earned on investments from lower yields, as well as adverse exchange rate movements.

Provision for credit losses was $0.1 million in 2015 and $0.2 million in 2014.

Non-interest income decreased $0.6 million from 2014 to 2015 attributable to lower banking revenue from the termination of a tailor-made banking product for one of our major clients in 2015, and adverse exchange rate movements offset by increased trust revenues as a result of new business growth and the impact of the Legis transaction in the prior year.

From 2014 to 2015, operating expenses increased $0.3 million due to higher staff expenses from headcount increases, offset by favorable exchange rate movements and lower amortization as intangibles from a previous acquisition were fully amortized by the end of 2014.

129

TABLE OF CONTENTS

United Kingdom

In the United Kingdom in 2016, we provided a range of traditional private banking, lending, treasury and investment management services, inclusive of the provision of family office services to high net worth international clients through the expertise within the Butterfield Group. In early 2016, we announced the orderly wind down of the deposit-taking and investment management and custody businesses in the United Kingdom. The following table provides certain financial information for our United Kingdom segment for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014.

Summary Income Statement
For the year ended
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
2014
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
2015 to
2016
2014 to
2015
Net interest income
 
2.1
 
 
10.5
 
 
16.2
 
 
(8.4
)
 
(5.7
)
 
(80.0
)%
 
(35.2
)%
Provision for credit losses
 
1.1
 
 
(1.5
)
 
(0.9
)
 
2.6
 
 
(0.6
)
 
(173.3
)%
 
66.7
%
Non-interest income
 
3.9
 
 
6.3
 
 
7.7
 
 
(2.4
)
 
(1.4
)
 
(38.1
)%
 
(18.2
)%
Net revenue before other gains (losses)
 
7.1
 
 
15.3
 
 
23.0
 
 
(8.2
)
 
(7.7
)
 
(53.6
)%
 
(33.5
)%
Operating expenses
 
(20.3
)
 
(22.3
)
 
(22.2
)
 
2.0
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(9.0
)%
 
0.5
%
Net income before other gains (losses)
 
(13.2
)
 
(7.0
)
 
0.9
 
 
(6.2
)
 
(7.9
)
 
88.6
%
 
(877.8
)%
Total other gains (losses)
 
1.2
 
 
(5.1
)
 
4.3
 
 
6.3
 
 
(9.4
)
 
(123.5
)%
 
(218.6
)%
Net income
 
(12.0
)
 
(12.0
)
 
5.2
 
 
 
 
(17.2
)
 
%
 
(330.8
)%
Summary Balance Sheet
As at
December 31,
Dollar
change
Percent
change
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
Customer deposits
 
 
 
598
 
 
(598
)
 
(100.0
)%
Loans, net of allowance for credit losses
 
 
 
404
 
 
(404
)
 
(100.0
)%
Total assets
 
152
 
 
788
 
 
(636
)
 
(80.7
)%
Assets under administration - Custody
 
 
 
1,573
 
 
(1,573
)
 
(100.0
)%
Assets under management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Butterfield Funds
 
 
 
70
 
 
(70
)
 
(100.0
)%
Other assets under management
 
 
 
139
 
 
(139
)
 
(100.0
)%
Total assets under management
 
 
 
209
 
 
(209
)
 
(100.0
)%
Number of employees
 
23
 
 
80
 
 
(57
)
 
(71.3
)%

2016 vs. 2015

The United Kingdom segment recorded a net loss of $12.0 million in 2016, flat when compared to 2015. Costs associated with the orderly wind down of the United Kingdom's operations inclusive of restructuring charges, as well as lower net interest income primarily attributable to lower loan balances accounts were offset by decreases in provision for credit losses and increases in other gains.

Other gains in 2016 were $1.2 million, up $6.3 million from losses in 2015 of $5.1 million due primarily to the impairment of the core banking system as a result of the orderly wind down of the United Kingdom's operations recorded in the prior year, compared to a change in unrealized gains recorded in 2016 pertaining to certain US government and federal agency securities.

Net interest income before provision for credit losses of $2.1 million was down $8.4 million from $10.5 million in 2015. The decrease was due primarily to reduced loan interest income, which resulted from the participation of existing loans to other group jurisdictions throughout 2016.

Provision for credit losses was a recovery of $1.1 million in 2016 compared to a loss of $1.5 million in 2015. The recovery in 2016 is due to two factors: the recovery of certain specific provisions on commercial properties, and the sub-participation of the entire loan book to other group jurisdictions, thereby transferring the risks associated with those loans.

Operating expenses of $20.3 million in 2016 were $2.0 million lower than in 2015, due primarily to lower salaries, technology and communications and professional and outside services charges, all due to the smaller continuing operations, which was partially offset by restructuring charges of $6.1 million

130

TABLE OF CONTENTS

recorded in 2016, compared to $2.2 million recorded in 2015. The increased restructuring charges were primarily a result of increased staff redundancy costs and related professional fees incurred in 2016, and have been included as non-core expenses.

Total assets at the end of 2016 were down from total assets at the end of 2015, decreasing by $0.6 billion to $0.2 billion. Loan balances and customer deposit balances both decreased to nil as loans were all participated by other group jurisdictions and all depositors were repaid, compared to year-end 2015 position at $0.4 billion and $0.6 billion, respectively.

Custody client assets under administration at the end of 2016 amounted to nil, down from $1.6 billion as of December 31, 2015. Assets under management were nil as of December 31, 2016, down from $0.2 billion as of December 31, 2015. The decreases are a result of the orderly wind down of the asset management business in the United Kingdom.

2015 vs. 2014

From 2014 to 2015, net income decreased by $17.2 million due to costs associated with the orderly wind down of the United Kingdom's operations inclusive of impairment charges and other restructuring charges, as well as lower net interest income primarily attributable to lower loan balances.

Other gains decreased $9.4 million from 2014 to 2015, due primarily to the impairment of the core banking system as a result of the orderly wind down of the United Kingdom's operations recorded in 2015.

Net interest income before provision for credit losses decreased $5.7 million from 2014 to 2015, due primarily to reduced loan interest income, which resulted from the combination of a reduction in commercial loan balances with a corresponding decrease in average interest rates earned on loans, as well as adverse exchange rate movements.

Provision for credit losses was a loss of $1.5 million in 2015 and $0.9 million in 2014. In 2015, additional provisions of $1.7 million were raised on two commercial loan facilities and were offset by a $0.2 million recovery on a commercial facility that was written off in 2014.

Operating expenses increased $0.1 million from 2014 to 2015 due primarily to restructuring charges of $2.2 million recorded in 2015, as well as a $0.2 million increase in professional and outside services fees, which were slightly offset by reductions in salaries and other employee benefits from a drop in headcount, a decrease in non-income taxes from a value-added tax recovery, a decrease in rental expense, as well as favorable foreign exchange movements.

Quarterly Financial Highlights

The selected quarterly financial information presented below contains financial measures that are not presented in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles and which have not been audited. For more information on these non-GAAP financial measures, and a reconciliation to the most directly comparable GAAP financial measures, see the Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures at the end of this section.

131

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following table provides certain key income statement information and key financial ratios:

 
For the quarter ended
Income Statement
(in millions of $ other than per share date)
December 31,
2016
September 30,
2016
December 31,
2015
Net income
$
35.4
 
$
24.0
 
$
(2.3
)
Core net income(1)(2)
 
37.1
 
 
33.4
 
 
27.8
 
Fully diluted net income per share
 
(0.19
)
 
0.41
 
 
(0.14
)
Core net income per share – fully diluted(1)
 
0.62
 
 
0.60
 
 
0.50
 
Net interest income
 
66.8
 
 
65.0
 
 
61.2
 
Provision for credit losses
 
0.9
 
 
(0.3
)
 
(2.6
)
Non-interest income
 
38.8
 
 
36.3
 
 
37.3
 
Non-interest expenses
 
(71.9
)
 
(77.4
)
 
(87.2
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Key financial ratios
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Return on average assets
 
1.3
 
 
0.9
 
 
(0.1
)
Core return on average tangible assets(1)
 
1.3
 
 
1.2
 
 
1.1
 
Return on common equity
 
(5.2
)
 
11.7
 
 
(4.4
)
Core return on average tangible common equity(1)
 
19.3
 
 
19.0
 
 
17.7
 
Net interest margin
 
2.5
 
 
2.4
 
 
2.5
 
Core efficiency ratio(1)
 
65.6
 
 
65.3
 
 
63.7
 
(1)Core net income, core net income per share – fully diluted, core return on average tangible assets, core return on average tangible common equity and core efficiency ratio are non-GAAP financial measures. For more information on these non-GAAP financial measures, see “—Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures” below.
(2)Our core net income excludes non-core expenses and gains and losses outside the course of normal business of $1.7 million in the quarter ended December 31, 2016, $9.4 million in the quarter ended September 30, 2016 and $30.1 million in the quarter ended December 31, 2015.

The following table provides certain key balance sheet information and balance sheet ratios:

 
As at
Balance Sheet
(in millions of $)
December 31,
2016
September 30,
2016
December 31,
2015
Loans, net of allowance for credit losses
 
3,570
 
 
3,836
 
 
4,000
 
Total deposits
 
10,034
 
 
9,667
 
 
9,182
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Key balance sheet ratios
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common equity tier 1 (CETI) capital ratio(1)
 
15.3
%
 
16.1
%
 
N/A
 
Tier 1 capital ratio(1)
 
15.3
%
 
20.5
%
 
16.2
%
Total capital ratio(1)
 
17.6
%
 
22.9
%
 
19.0
%
Non-accrual loans/gross loans
 
1.3
%
 
1.7
%
 
1.6
%
Net charge-off ratio
 
0.46
%
 
0.14
%
 
0.21
%
(1)Effective on January 1, 2016, the Bank’s regulatory capital is determined in accordance with current Basel III guidelines issued by the BMA. Basel III adopts CET1 as the predominant form of regulatory capital with the CET1 ratio as a new metric. Basel III also adopts the new Leverage Ratio regime, which is calculated by dividing Tier 1 capital by an exposure measure. The exposure measure consists of total assets (excluding items deducted from Tier 1 capital) and certain off balance sheet items converted into credit exposure equivalents as well as adjustments for derivatives to reflect credit and other risks. Prior to January 1, 2016, the Bank’s regulatory capital was determined in accordance with Basel II guidelines issued by the BMA.

132

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures

 
For the quarters ended
(in millions of $ except per share amounts)
December 31,
2016
September 30,
2016
December 31,
2015
Net income
 
35.4
 
 
24.0
 
 
(2.3
)
Dividends and guarantee fee of preference shares
 
(3.4
)
 
(4.1
)
 
(4.2
)
Premium paid on preference shares bought back(1)
 
(41.9
)
 
 
 
 
Net income to common shareholder
 
(9.9
)
 
19.9
 
 
(6.5
)
Non-core items
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-core (gains) losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gain on disposal of a pass-through note investment (formerly a SIV)(1)
 
(0.6
)
 
 
 
 
Impairment of and gain on disposal of fixed assets (including software)(1)
 
 
 
 
 
5.1
 
Change in unrealized (gains) losses on certain investments(1)
 
 
 
 
 
1.7
 
Adjustment to holdback payable for a previous business acquisition(1)
 
0.7
 
 
(0.7
)
 
 
Total non-core (gains) losses
 
0.1
 
 
(0.7
)
 
6.8
 
Non-core expenses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Early retirement program, redundancies and other non-core compensation costs(1)
 
 
 
0.3
 
 
6.6
 
Tax compliance review costs(1)
 
 
 
0.2
 
 
0.4
 
Provision in connection with ongoing tax compliance review(1)
 
 
 
 
 
4.8
 
Business acquisition costs(1)
 
1.1
 
 
0.2
 
 
0.2
 
Restructuring charges and related professional service fees(1)
 
0.5
 
 
0.6
 
 
2.5
 
Investigation of an international stock exchange listing costs(1)
 
 
 
 
 
8.9
 
Cost of 2010 legacy option plan vesting and related payroll taxes(1)
 
 
 
8.8
 
 
 
Total non-core expenses
 
1.6
 
 
10.1
 
 
23.3
 
Total non-core items
 
1.7
 
 
9.4
 
 
30.1
 
Core net income
 
37.1
 
 
33.4
 
 
27.8
 
Core net income attributable to common shareholders(1)
 
33.7
 
 
29.3
 
 
23.6
 
(in millions of $)
December 31,
2016
September 30,
2016
December 31,
2015
Core return on average tangible common equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Average shareholders' equity
 
895.0
 
 
859.4
 
 
764.5
 
Less: average preference shareholders' equity
 
(137.1
)
 
(182.9
)
 
(182.9
)
Average common equity
 
757.9
 
 
676.5
 
 
581.6
 
Less: average goodwill and intangible assets
 
(62.9
)
 
(65.6
)
 
(52.6
)
Average tangible common equity.
 
695.0
 
 
611.0
 
 
529.0
 
Core net income per share — fully diluted
 
0.62
 
 
0.60
 
 
0.50
 
Return on common equity
 
(5.2
)%
 
11.7
%
 
(4.4
)%
Core return on average tangible common equity
 
19.3
%
 
19.0
%
 
17.7
%

133

TABLE OF CONTENTS

(in millions of $)
December 31,
2016
September 30,
2016
December 31,
2015
Core efficiency ratio
Non-interest expenses
 
71.9
 
 
77.4
 
 
87.2
 
Less: non-core expenses
 
(1.6
)
 
(10.1
)
 
(23.3
)
Less: amortization of intangibles
 
(1.0
)
 
(1.2
)
 
(1.1
)
Core non-interest expenses before amortization of intangibles
 
69.3
 
 
66.0
 
 
62.8
 
Core revenue before other gains and losses and provision for credit losses
 
105.6
 
 
101.3
 
 
98.5
 
Core efficiency ratio
 
65.6
%
 
65.3
%
 
63.7
%
(in millions of $)
December 31,
2016
September 30,
2016
December 31,
2015
Core return on average tangible assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total average assets
 
11,106.3
 
 
11,207.4
 
 
10,083.5
 
Less: average goodwill and intangible assets
 
(62.9
)
 
(65.6
)
 
(52.6
)
Average tangible assets
 
11,043.4
 
 
11,141.8
 
 
10,030.8
 
Return on assets
 
1.3
%
 
0.9
%
 
(0.1
)%
Core return on average tangible assets
 
1.3
%
 
1.2
%
 
1.1
%
(1)For additional information on these adjustments, see the discussion under the heading “Selected Consolidated Financial and Other Data — Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures” beginning on page 63.

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

The Bank's significant accounting policies conform to US GAAP and are described in Note 2 of our audited consolidated financial statements. Various elements of our accounting policies, by their nature, are inherently subject to estimation techniques, valuation assumptions and other subjective assessments. Given the sensitivity of our consolidated financial statements to these critical accounting policies, the use of other judgments, estimates and assumptions could result in material differences in our results of operations or financial condition. Details of certain critical policies and estimates that affect our business results are summarized below:

Allowance for Credit Losses

We maintain an allowance for credit losses, which in management's opinion is adequate to absorb all estimated credit-related losses in our lending and off-balance sheet credit-related arrangements at the balance sheet date.

The allowance for credit losses could be affected by a variety of internal and external factors. Internal factors include portfolio performance such as delinquency levels, assigned risk ratings, the mix and level of loan balances, differing economic risks associated with each loan category and the financial condition of specific borrowers. External factors include fluctuations in the general economy, unemployment rates, bankruptcy filings, developments within a particular industry, changes in collateral values and factors particular to a specific commercial credit such as competition, business and management performance. The allowance for credit losses may be adjusted to reflect our current assessment of various qualitative risks, factors and events that may not be measured in our statistical procedures. There is no certainty that the allowance for credit losses will be appropriate over time to cover losses because of unanticipated adverse changes in any of these internal, external or qualitative factors.

For non-accrual loans and loans modified in a TDR, we conduct specific analysis on a loan level basis to determine the probable amount of credit loss. If appropriate, a specific allowance is established for the loan through a charge to the provision for credit losses. For all classes of impaired loans, if the expected realizable value of the impaired loan is less than the recorded investment in the loan,

134

TABLE OF CONTENTS

impairment is recognized through an allowance estimate. If we determine that part of the allowance is uncollectible, in such cases, the provision for credit losses is not affected when a specific reserve for at least that amount already exists. Techniques utilized include comparing the loan's carrying amount to the estimated present value of its future cash flows or the fair value of its underlying collateral, or the loan's observable market price.

Even minor changes in the level of estimated losses can significantly affect management's determination of the appropriate allowance because those changes must be applied across a large portfolio. To illustrate, an increase in estimated losses equal to one percent of our residential mortgage loan portfolio would result in a $23.3 million increase in the allowance, and a corresponding decrease to net income, or a $0.48 decrease in basic earnings per common share. The same increase in estimated losses for the commercial loan and commercial mortgage portfolio would result in a $9.7 million increase in the allowance and a corresponding decrease to net income, or a $0.20 decrease in basic earnings per common share. Such adjustments to the allowance for credit losses can materially affect financial results.

Determination of the allowance for credit losses is inherently subjective. It requires significant estimates including the amounts and timing of expected future cash flows on impaired loans, appraisal values of underlying collateral for collateralized loans, and the amount of estimated losses on pools of homogeneous loans which is based on historical loss experience and consideration of current economic trends, all of which may be susceptible to significant change.

Recognition of Other-Than-Temporary Impairments on Investments

For debt securities, we consider a decline in fair value to be other-than-temporary when it does not expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis of the security. Investments in debt securities in unrealized loss positions are analyzed as part of our ongoing assessment of OTTI. When we intend to sell such securities or it is more likely than not that we will be required to sell the securities before recovering the amortized cost, we recognize an impairment loss equal to the full difference between the amortized cost basis and the fair value of those securities. When we do not intend to sell or it is not more likely than not that we will be required to sell such securities before recovering the amortized cost, we determine whether any credit losses exist to identify any OTTI.

In situations where there is a credit loss, only the amount of impairment relating to credit losses on AFS and HTM investments is recognized in net income. The degree of judgment involved in determining the recoverable value of an investment security is dependent upon the availability of observable market prices or observable market parameters. When observable market prices and parameters do not exist, judgment is necessary to estimate recoverable value which gives rise to added uncertainty in the assessment. The assessment takes into consideration factors such as interest rate changes, movements in credit spreads. We believe that the amount that has been recognized in net income has been a historically accurate estimate of the amount of impairment relating to credit losses on these investments.

Our valuations may include inputs and assumptions that are less observable or require greater estimation, thereby resulting in values which may be greater or lower than the actual value at which the investments may be ultimately sold or the ultimate cash flows that may be recovered. If the assumptions on which we base our valuations change, we may experience additional OTTI or realized losses or gains, and the period-to-period changes in value could vary significantly.

Fair Values

We define fair value as the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. We determine the fair values of assets and liabilities based on the fair value hierarchy which requires an entity to maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs when measuring fair value. The relevant accounting standard describes three levels of inputs that may be used to measure fair value. Investments classified as trading and AFS, and derivative assets and liabilities are recognized in the consolidated balance sheet at fair value.

Fair value inputs are considered Level 1 when based on unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets.

135

TABLE OF CONTENTS

We determine fair value based on quoted market prices, where available. If quoted prices are not available, fair value is estimated based upon other observable inputs, and may include valuation techniques such as present value cash flow models or other conventional valuation methods. In addition, when estimating the fair value of assets, we may use the quoted price of similar assets, if available.

We use unobservable inputs when observable inputs are not available. These inputs are based upon our judgments and assumptions, which represent our assessment of the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability, which may include assumptions about risk, counterparty credit quality and liquidity and are developed based on the best information available. The use of different assumptions could produce significantly different results, which could have material positive or negative effects on the Bank's results of operations.

Significant assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis include our US government and federal agencies investments, corporate debt securities, and commercial mortgage-backed securities. The fair values of these instruments are generally sourced from an external pricing service and are classified as Level 2 within the fair value hierarchy. The service's pricing models use predominantly observable valuation inputs to measure the fair value of these securities under both the market and income approaches.

Fair value is also used on a nonrecurring basis to evaluate certain assets for impairment or for disclosure purposes. Examples of nonrecurring uses of fair value include other real estate owned, loan impairments for certain loans and goodwill.

We review and update the fair value hierarchy classifications on a quarterly basis. We also verify the accuracy of the pricing provided by our primary external pricing service on a quarterly basis.

There were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 during the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015.

Refer to Note 17 “Fair value measurement” of the audited consolidated financial statements for further detail on the judgments made in classifying instruments in the fair value hierarchy.

Goodwill

We account for acquisitions using the acquisition method of accounting, under which the acquired company's net assets are recorded at fair value at the date of the acquisition and the difference between the fair value of consideration and fair value of the net assets acquired is recorded as goodwill, if positive, and as bargain purchase gain, if negative.

Goodwill is tested annually in the third quarter for impairment at the reporting unit level, or more frequently if events or circumstances indicate there may be impairment. The goodwill impairment analysis is a two-step test. The first step, used to identify potential impairment, involves comparing each reporting unit's fair value to its carrying value including goodwill. If the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying value, applicable goodwill is deemed to be not impaired. If the carrying value exceeds fair value, there is an indication of impairment and the second step is performed to measure the amount of impairment.

The second step involves calculating an implied fair value of goodwill for each reporting unit for which the first step indicated impairment. The implied fair value of goodwill is determined in the same manner as the amount of goodwill recognized in a business combination, which is the excess of the fair value of the reporting unit, as determined in the first step, over the aggregate fair values of the individual assets, liabilities and identifiable intangible assets as if the reporting unit were being acquired in a business combination. If the implied fair value of goodwill exceeds the carrying value of goodwill assigned to the reporting unit, there is no impairment. If the carrying value of goodwill assigned to a reporting unit exceeds the implied fair value of the goodwill, an impairment charge is recorded for the excess. An impairment loss recognized cannot exceed the amount of goodwill assigned to a reporting unit, and the loss establishes a new basis in the goodwill. Subsequent reversal of goodwill impairment losses is not permitted.

We rely on several assumptions when estimating the fair value of our reporting units using the discounted cash flow method. These assumptions include the estimated future cash flows from

136

TABLE OF CONTENTS

operations, current discount rate, as well as projected loan losses, an estimate of terminal value and other inputs. Our estimated future cash flows are largely based on our historical actual cash flows and industry and economic trends, among other considerations. Although management has used the estimates and assumptions it believes to be most appropriate in the circumstances, it should be noted that even relatively minor changes in certain valuation assumptions used in management's calculation would result in significant differences in the results of the impairment test.

The valuation of goodwill is dependent on forward-looking expectations related to nationwide and local economic conditions and our associated financial performance. In the future, if our acquisitions do not yield expected returns or there are changes in discount rates, we may be required to take additional charges to our earnings based on the impairment assessment process, which could harm our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects. We had $19.6 million as of December 31, 2016 and $23.5 million as of December 31, 2015 of goodwill, and the results of the impairment analysis for both annual periods resulted in no impairment being required.

Employee Future Benefits

We maintain trusteed pension plans for substantially all employees as either non-contributory defined benefit plans or defined contribution plans. Benefits under the defined benefit plans are primarily based on the employee's years of credited service and average annual salary during the final years of employment as defined in the plans. We also provide post-retirement medical benefits for certain qualifying active and retired Bermuda-based employees.

The calculations of the amounts recorded require the use of various actuarial assumptions, such as discount rates, assumed rates of return on plan assets, compensation increases, and turnover rates. We review our actuarial assumptions on an annual basis and make modifications to the assumptions based on current rates and trends when appropriate. We believe that the assumptions used in recording our defined benefit plan obligations are reasonable based on our experience and advice from our actuaries.

The post-retirement medical benefits obligation is determined using our assumptions regarding health care cost trend rates. The health care trend rates are developed based on historical cost data, the near-term outlook on health care trends and the likely long-term trends.

In accordance with US GAAP, actual results that differ from the assumptions are accumulated and amortized over future periods and, therefore, generally affect recognized expense and the recorded obligation of future periods. While management believes that the assumptions used are appropriate, differences in actual experience or changes in assumptions may affect the defined benefit obligations and future expense.

See Note 11 “Employee benefit plans” to our audited consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2016 for more information on our pension plans and post-retirement medical benefit plan, along with the key actuarial assumptions.

137

TABLE OF CONTENTS

SELECTED STATISTICAL DATA

Distribution of Assets, Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity; Interest Rates and Interest Differential

Average Balance Sheet and Interest Rates

The following table presents average consolidated balance sheets and net interest income for the years indicated:

 
For the year ended December 31,
 
2016
2015
2014
(in millions of $)
Average
balance
Interest
income/
expense
Average
yield/
rate
Average
balance
Interest
income/
expense
Average
yield/
rate
Average
balance
Interest
income/
expense
Average
yield/
rate
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks — Interest bearing
 
933.3
 
 
4.3
 
 
0.46
%
 
759.9
 
 
1.6
 
 
0.21
%
 
601.7
 
 
1.4
 
 
0.23
%
Securities purchased under agreement to resell
 
26.7
 
 
0.4
 
 
1.56
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Short-term investments
 
405.9
 
 
1.4
 
 
0.34
%
 
14.6
 
 
 
 
0.24
%
 
11.5
 
 
 
 
0.09
%
Held for trading
 
0.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale
 
1,808.0
 
 
32.5
 
 
1.80
%
 
1,447.5
 
 
33.5
 
 
2.32
%
 
1,379.1
 
 
33.4
 
 
2.42
%
Held-to-maturity
 
430.0
 
 
12.2
 
 
2.85
%
 
210.6
 
 
6.4
 
 
3.07
%
 
160.2
 
 
5.1
 
 
3.18
%
Investment in securities(1)
 
2,238.7
 
 
44.7
 
 
1.99
%
 
1,658.5
 
 
40.0
 
 
2.41
%
 
1,539.5
 
 
38.5
 
 
2.50
%
Commercial
 
815.1
 
 
40.9
 
 
5.00
%
 
700.8
 
 
33.5
 
 
4.78
%
 
694.6
 
 
32.4
 
 
4.67
%
Consumer
 
1,343.9
 
 
79.1
 
 
5.88
%
 
1,323.3
 
 
79.0
 
 
5.97
%
 
1,368.1
 
 
82.9
 
 
6.06
%
Total loans, net of allowance for credit losses(2)
 
2,159.0
 
 
120.0
 
 
5.55
%
 
2,024.1
 
 
112.5
 
 
5.56
%
 
2,062.7
 
 
115.3
 
 
5.59
%
Interest-earning assets
 
5,763.6
 
 
170.9
 
 
2.96
%
 
4,457.2
 
 
154.1
 
 
3.46
%
 
4,215.4
 
 
155.2
 
 
3.68
%
Other assets
 
199.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
187.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
227.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
 
5,963.4
 
 
170.9
 
 
2.86
%
 
4,644.7
 
 
154.1
 
 
3.32
%
 
4,442.9
 
 
155.2
 
 
3.49
%
Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customer deposits
 
3,784.9
 
 
(5.6
)
 
(0.15
)%
 
2,820.8
 
 
(6.7
)
 
(0.24
)%
 
2,875.3
 
 
(7.9
)
 
(0.27
)%
Bank deposits
 
22.8
 
 
(0.2
)
 
(1.01
)%
 
1.8
 
 
 
 
(1.52
)%
 
2.4
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.38
)%
Interest-bearing deposits
 
3,807.6
 
 
(5.8
)
 
(0.15
)%
 
2,822.6
 
 
(6.7
)
 
(0.24
)%
 
2,877.7
 
 
(7.9
)
 
(0.28
)%
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase
 
16.0
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.72
)%
 
2.1
 
 
 
 
(0.39
)%
 
22.0
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.38
)%
Long-term debt
 
117.0
 
 
(4.5
)
 
(3.84
)%
 
117.0
 
 
(4.9
)
 
(4.15
)%
 
117.2
 
 
(5.6
)
 
(4.80
)%
Interest-bearing liabilities
 
3,940.7
 
 
(10.4
)
 
(0.26
)%
 
2,941.7
 
 
(11.5
)
 
(0.39
)%
 
3,019.9
 
 
(13.7
)
 
(0.45
)%
Non-interest-bearing current accounts
 
1,486.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,192.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
883.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
 
175.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
154.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
129.3
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities
 
5,602.5
 
 
(10.4
)
 
(0.19
)%
 
4,288.2
 
 
(11.5
)
 
(0.27
)%
 
4,029.3
 
 
(13.7
)
 
(0.34
)%
Shareholders’ equity
 
360.9
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
356.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
413.6
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 
5,963.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4,644.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4,442.9
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest-bearing funds net of non-interest-earning assets (free balance)
 
1,822.9
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,515.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,198.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest margin
 
 
 
 
160.5
 
 
2.78
%
 
 
 
 
142.5
 
 
3.20
%
 
 
 
 
141.6
 
 
3.36
%
Net interest spread
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2.68
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3.05
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3.15
%
Ratio of average interest earning asset/ interest bearing liabilities
 
146.3
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
151.5
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
139.7
%
 
 
 
 
 
 

138

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 
For the year ended December 31,
 
2016
2015
2014
(in millions of $)
Average
balance
Interest
income/
expense
Average
yield/
rate
Average
balance
Interest
income/
expense
Average
yield/
rate
Average
balance
Interest
income/
expense
Average
yield/
rate
Non-Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks — Interest bearing
 
1,146.6
 
 
3.0
 
 
0.26
%
 
1,311.6
 
 
3.2
 
 
0.24
%
 
1,040.6
 
 
3.5
 
 
0.34
%
Short-term investments
 
142.8
 
 
0.7
 
 
0.47
%
 
321.8
 
 
1.7
 
 
0.54
%
 
99.1
 
 
0.5
 
 
0.47
%
Held for trading
 
132.7
 
 
1.7
 
 
1.30
%
 
347.0
 
 
5.9
 
 
1.70
%
 
598.7
 
 
9.1
 
 
1.52
%
Available-for-sale
 
1,326.8
 
 
20.7
 
 
1.55
%
 
1,025.3
 
 
17.5
 
 
1.71
%
 
570.1
 
 
14.6
 
 
2.57
%
Held-to-maturity
 
242.4
 
 
10.0
 
 
4.11
%
 
186.3
 
 
6.2
 
 
3.32
%
 
169.5
 
 
5.5
 
 
3.27
%
Investment in securities(1)
 
1,701.9
 
 
32.4
 
 
1.90
%
 
1,558.5
 
 
29.6
 
 
1.90
%
 
1,338.2
 
 
29.2
 
 
2.19
%
Commercial
 
615.5
 
 
30.7
 
 
4.98
%
 
657.7
 
 
28.7
 
 
4.37
%
 
886.4
 
 
33.4
 
 
3.77
%
Consumer
 
1,146.6
 
 
37.2
 
 
3.24
%
 
1,344.9
 
 
45.3
 
 
3.37
%
 
1,125.8
 
 
43.3
 
 
3.84
%
Total loans, net of allowance for credit losses(2)
 
1,762.1
 
 
68.0
 
 
3.86
%
 
2,002.5
 
 
74.0
 
 
3.70
%
 
2,012.2
 
 
76.7
 
 
3.81
%
Interest-earning assets
 
4,753.4
 
 
104.0
 
 
2.18
%
 
5,194.4
 
 
108.5
 
 
2.09
%
 
4,490.2
 
 
109.9
 
 
2.45
%
Other assets
 
143.6
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
184.0
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
183.3
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
 
4,897.0
 
 
104.0
 
 
2.12
%
 
5,378.5
 
 
108.5
 
 
2.02
%
 
4,673.5
 
 
109.9
 
 
2.35
%
Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customer deposits
 
3,890.7
 
 
(6.0
)
 
(0.15
)%
 
4,318.2
 
 
(11.7
)
 
(0.27
)%
 
3,828.1
 
 
(12.8
)
 
(0.33
)%
Bank deposits
 
35.5
 
 
 
 
(0.08
)%
 
15.9
 
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.54
)%
 
35.8
 
 
(0.2
)
 
(0.46
)%
Interest-bearing deposits
 
3,926.2
 
 
(6.0
)
 
(0.15
)%
 
4,334.1
 
 
(11.7
)
 
(0.27
)%
 
3,863.9
 
 
(12.9
)
 
(0.33
)%
Interest-bearing liabilities
 
3,926.2
 
 
(6.0
)
 
(0.15
)%
 
4,334.1
 
 
(11.7
)
 
(0.27
)%
 
3,864.0
 
 
(12.9
)
 
(0.33
)%
Non-interest-bearing current accounts
 
504.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
528.2
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
327.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
42.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
58.0
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities
 
4,430.6
 
 
(6.0
)
 
(0.15
)%
 
4,905.1
 
 
(11.7
)
 
(0.24
)%
 
4,249.8
 
 
(12.9
)
 
(0.30
)%
Shareholders’ equity
 
466.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
473.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
423.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 
4,897.0
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5,378.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4,673.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest-bearing funds net of non-interest-earning assets (free balance)
 
827.3
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
860.3
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
626.2
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest margin
 
 
 
 
98.0
 
 
2.06
%
 
 
 
 
96.8
 
 
1.86
%
 
 
 
 
97.0
 
 
2.16
%
Net interest spread
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1.99
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1.78
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2.05
%
Ratio of average interest earning asset/ interest bearing liabilities
 
121.1
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
119.9
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
116.2
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)Yields are based on average historical costs and yields on securities held in income tax exempt jurisdictions are not computed on a tax-equivalent yield basis.
(2)Interest income and rates on loans include loan fees. Additionally, average non-accrual loans were included in the average loan balances used to determine the average yield on loans in all of the periods presented.

139

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Analysis of Changes in Volume and Rate on Interest Income and Interest Expense

The following table presents the amount of changes in interest income and interest expense from December 31, 2015 to December 31, 2016 and from December 31, 2014 to December 31, 2015, due to changes in both average volume and average rate. Changes not solely due to volume or rate have been allocated to volume.

 
2016 compared to 2015
2015 compared to 2014
(in millions of $)
Increase/
(Decrease)
due to
Changes in
Net
Increase/
(Decrease)
Increase/
(Decrease)
due to
Changes in
Net
Increase/
(Decrease)
 
Volume
Rate
 
Volume
Rate
 
Interest income related to:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks — Interest bearing
 
0.81
 
 
1.94
 
 
2.75
 
 
0.33
 
 
(0.15
)
 
0.18
 
Securities purchased under agreement to resell
 
0.42
 
 
 
 
0.42
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Short-term investments
 
1.32
 
 
0.01
 
 
1.33
 
 
0.01
 
 
0.02
 
 
0.03
 
Held-for-trading
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale
 
6.55
 
 
(7.59
)
 
(1.04
)
 
1.58
 
 
(1.45
)
 
0.13
 
Held-to-maturity
 
6.14
 
 
(0.34
)
 
5.80
 
 
1.52
 
 
(0.17
)
 
1.35
 
Total investment in securities(1)
 
12.69
 
 
(7.93
)
 
4.76
 
 
3.10
 
 
(1.62
)
 
1.48
 
Commercial
 
5.83
 
 
1.52
 
 
7.35
 
 
0.30
 
 
0.78
 
 
1.08
 
Consumer
 
1.42
 
 
(1.19
)
 
0.23
 
 
(2.68
)
 
(1.24
)
 
(3.92
)
Total loans, net of allowance for credit losses(2)
 
7.25
 
 
0.33
 
 
7.58
 
 
(2.38
)
 
(0.46
)
 
(2.84
)
Total interest-earning assets
 
22.49
 
 
(5.65
)
 
16.84
 
 
1.06
 
 
(2.21
)
 
(1.15
)
Interest expenses related to:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customer deposits
 
(1.43
)
 
2.52
 
 
1.09
 
 
0.13
 
 
1.08
 
 
1.20
 
Bank deposits
 
(0.21
)
 
0.01
 
 
(0.20
)
 
0.01
 
 
(0.01
)
 
 
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase
 
(0.10
)
 
(0.01
)
 
(0.11
)
 
0.08
 
 
 
 
0.07
 
Long-term debt
 
 
 
0.37
 
 
0.37
 
 
0.01
 
 
0.75
 
 
0.78
 
Total interest-bearing liabilities
 
(1.74
)
 
2.89
 
 
1.15
 
 
0.23
 
 
1.82
 
 
2.05
 
Change in net interest income
 
20.75
 
 
(2.76
)
 
17.99
 
 
1.29
 
 
(0.39
)
 
0.90
 
Non-Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks — Interest bearing
 
(0.42
)
 
0.23
 
 
(0.19
)
 
0.66
 
 
(0.96
)
 
(0.30
)
Short-term investments
 
(0.83
)
 
(0.23
)
 
(1.06
)
 
1.20
 
 
0.06
 
 
1.26
 
Held-for-trading
 
(2.77
)
 
(1.39
)
 
(4.16
)
 
(4.28
)
 
1.09
 
 
(3.18
)
Available-for-sale
 
4.74
 
 
(1.60
)
 
3.14
 
 
7.78
 
 
(4.88
)
 
2.90
 
Held-to-maturity
 
2.38
 
 
1.48
 
 
3.86
 
 
0.54
 
 
0.09
 
 
0.63
 
Total investment in securities(1)
 
4.35
 
 
(1.51
)
 
2.84
 
 
4.05
 
 
(3.70
)
 
0.34
 
Commercial
 
(2.01
)
 
4.01
 
 
2.00
 
 
(9.99
)
 
5.32
 
 
(4.67
)
Consumer
 
(6.33
)
 
(1.74
)
 
(8.07
)
 
7.37
 
 
(5.37
)
 
2.01
 
Total loans, net of allowance for credit losses(2)
 
(8.34
)
 
2.27
 
 
(6.07
)
 
(2.62
)
 
(0.05
)
 
(2.66
)
Interest rate swaps
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total interest-earning assets
 
(5.24
)
 
0.76
 
 
(4.48
)
 
3.29
 
 
(4.65
)
 
(1.36
)
Interest expenses related to:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customer deposits
 
0.64
 
 
5.03
 
 
5.67
 
 
(1.33
)
 
2.43
 
 
1.10
 
Bank deposits
 
(0.02
)
 
0.07
 
 
0.05
 
 
0.11
 
 
(0.03
)
 
0.08
 
Total interest-bearing liabilities
 
0.62
 
 
5.10
 
 
5.72
 
 
(1.22
)
 
2.40
 
 
1.18
 
Change in net interest income
 
(4.62
)
 
5.86
 
 
1.24
 
 
2.07
 
 
(2.25
)
 
(0.18
)
(1)Yields are based on average historical costs and yields on securities held in income tax exempt jurisdictions are not computed on a tax-equivalent yield basis.
(2)Interest income and rates on loans include loan fees. Additionally, average non-accrual loans were included in the average loan balances used to determine the average yield on loans in all of the periods presented.

140

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Investment Portfolio

The following table sets forth the composition of our debt and equity securities as of the dates indicated measured at amortized cost of fair value. See Note 5 “Investment in Securities” to our audited consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, included elsewhere in this prospectus for further discussion.

 
As of
December 31,
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
Trading
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
 
 
279.3
 
Non-US governments debt securities
 
 
 
7.5
 
Asset-backed securities — Student loans
 
 
 
28.3
 
Mutual funds
 
6.3
 
 
6.2
 
Total trading
 
6.3
 
 
321.3
 
Available-for-sale
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
2,430.4
 
 
1,404.5
 
Non-US governments debt securities
 
27.0
 
 
29.6
 
Corporate debt securities
 
514.5
 
 
506.1
 
Asset-backed securities — Student loans
 
12.5
 
 
12.2
 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
 
150.5
 
 
148.7
 
Residential mortgage-backed securities
 
197.8
 
 
100.2
 
Total available-for-sale
 
3,332.7
 
 
2,201.3
 
Held-to-maturity
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
1,061.1
 
 
701.3
 
Total held-to-maturity
 
1,061.1
 
 
701.3
 
Total investment in securities
 
4,400.2
 
 
3,223.9
 

141

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following table presents an analysis of remaining contractual maturities and weighted average yields for interest bearing securities as of December 31, 2016. Yields on tax-exempt obligations have been computed on a tax-equivalent basis.

 
Remaining term to maturity
(in millions of $)
Within
1 year
1 to 5
years
5 to 10
years
Over 10
years
No specific
maturity
Trading
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mutual funds
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.3
 
Total trading
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.3
 
Available-for-sale
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
6.4
 
 
87.3
 
 
653.6
 
 
1,683.2
 
 
 
Non-US governments debt securities
 
1.4
 
 
4.0
 
 
21.7
 
 
 
 
 
Corporate debt securities
 
110.2
 
 
404.3
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset-backed securities — Student loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
12.5
 
 
 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
 
 
 
38.4
 
 
112.1
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage-backed securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
197.8
 
 
 
Total available-for-sale
 
117.9
 
 
533.9
 
 
787.4
 
 
1,893.5
 
 
 
 
Held-to-maturity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
 
 
10.7
 
 
31.2
 
 
1,019.3
 
 
 
Total held-to-maturity
 
 
 
10.7
 
 
31.2
 
 
1,019.3
 
 
 
Total investment in securities
 
117.9
 
 
544.6
 
 
818.6
 
 
2,912.7
 
 
6.3
 
Weighted average yield(1)
 
3.51
%
 
2.36
%
 
2.11
%
 
2.10
%
 
 
(1)Yields are based on average historical costs and yields on securities held in income tax exempt jurisdictions are not computed on a tax-equivalent yield basis.

As of December 31, 2016, no investment other than securities of the US Government and US Government agencies exceeded 10% of shareholders’ equity.

142

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Loan Portfolio

Composition of the Loan Portfolio

The following table shows the composition of the Group’s loan portfolio by type of loan and geographic location as of the dates indicated. See Note 6 “Loans” to our audited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus for further discussion of our loan portfolio inclusive of the Bank’s policies for placing loans on a non-accrual status.

 
As of December 31,
 
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
(in millions of $)
Bermuda
Non-
Bermuda
Bermuda
Non-
Bermuda
Bermuda
Non-
Bermuda
Bermuda
Non-
Bermuda
Bermuda
Non-
Bermuda
Government
 
94.5
 
 
17.9
 
 
202.8
 
 
22.4
 
 
66.7
 
 
46.8
 
 
65.7
 
 
15.0
 
 
64.5
 
 
4.1
 
Commercial and industrial
 
130.2
 
 
201.7
 
 
121.5
 
 
221.2
 
 
137.1
 
 
251.4
 
 
129.9
 
 
270.8
 
 
121.9
 
 
190.0
 
Commercial overdrafts
 
22.6
 
 
2.8
 
 
35.0
 
 
5.7
 
 
48.1
 
 
11.2
 
 
57.8
 
 
8.1
 
 
59.0
 
 
22.9
 
Total commercial loans
 
247.3
 
 
222.3
 
 
359.2
 
 
249.4
 
 
251.9
 
 
309.4
 
 
253.4
 
 
293.9
 
 
245.5
 
 
217.0
 
Specific allowance for credit losses on commercial loans
 
(0.6
)
 
 
 
(0.6
)
 
 
 
(0.4
)
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.2
)
 
(0.2
)
 
(0.2
)
 
(1.3
)
Total commercial loans after specific allowance for credit loss
 
246.7
 
 
222.3
 
 
358.6
 
 
249.4
 
 
251.5
 
 
309.3
 
 
253.2
 
 
293.7
 
 
245.3
 
 
215.7
 
Commercial mortgage
 
364.0
 
 
217.6
 
 
415.7
 
 
249.6
 
 
415.3
 
 
281.7
 
 
417.1
 
 
332.5
 
 
495.5
 
 
281.5
 
Construction
 
24.5
 
 
4.4
 
 
5.4
 
 
8.2
 
 
 
 
20.6
 
 
 
 
13.5
 
 
0.1
 
 
2.1
 
Total commercial real estate loans
 
388.5
 
 
222.0
 
 
421.1
 
 
257.8
 
 
415.3
 
 
302.3
 
 
417.1
 
 
346.0
 
 
495.6
 
 
283.6
 
Specific allowance for credit losses on commercial real estate loans
 
(0.8
)
 
 
 
(0.7
)
 
(2.2
)
 
(0.8
)
 
(1.1
)
 
(5.1
)
 
 
 
(8.8
)
 
(4.7
)
Total commercial real estate loans after specific allowance for credit losses
 
387.7
 
 
222.0
 
 
420.4
 
 
255.6
 
 
414.5
 
 
301.2
 
 
412.0
 
 
346.0
 
 
486.8
 
 
278.9
 
Automobile financing
 
13.1
 
 
6.9
 
 
12.3
 
 
7.6
 
 
12.6
 
 
7.7
 
 
15.6
 
 
6.7
 
 
19.7
 
 
6.1
 
Credit card
 
57.7
 
 
20.8
 
 
59.1
 
 
19.8
 
 
58.5
 
 
20.7
 
 
60.8
 
 
16.1
 
 
58.5
 
 
15.4
 
Overdrafts
 
2.4
 
 
3.2
 
 
4.8
 
 
8.2
 
 
12.9
 
 
8.2
 
 
10.1
 
 
6.3
 
 
8.5
 
 
3.9
 
Other consumer
 
30.8
 
 
63.2
 
 
32.0
 
 
84.1
 
 
43.7
 
 
113.9
 
 
47.4
 
 
118.0
 
 
66.0
 
 
94.8
 
Total consumer loans
 
104.0
 
 
94.1
 
 
108.2
 
 
119.7
 
 
127.8
 
 
150.5
 
 
133.9
 
 
147.1
 
 
152.7
 
 
120.2
 
Specific allowance for credit losses on consumer loans
 
(0.3
)
 
 
 
(0.3
)
 
 
 
(0.4
)
 
 
 
(0.2
)
 
 
 
(0.2
)
 
 
Total consumer loans after specific allowance for credit losses
 
103.7
 
 
94.1
 
 
107.9
 
 
119.6
 
 
127.4
 
 
150.5
 
 
133.7
 
 
147.1
 
 
152.5
 
 
120.2
 
Residential mortgage loans
 
1,205.5
 
 
1,131.1
 
 
1,243.2
 
 
1,290.8
 
 
1,270.9
 
 
1,238.6
 
 
1,309.6
 
 
1,239.9
 
 
1,351.7
 
 
1,145.7
 
Specific allowance for credit losses on residential mortgage loans
 
(9.6
)
 
(0.6
)
 
(13.4
)
 
(1.9
)
 
(14.8
)
 
(1.4
)
 
(13.2
)
 
(3.1
)
 
(7.7
)
 
(3.9
)
Total residential mortgage loans after specific allowance for credit losses
 
1,195.9
 
 
1,130.5
 
 
1,229.8
 
 
1,288.9
 
 
1,256.1
 
 
1,237.2
 
 
1,296.4
 
 
1,236.9
 
 
1,343.9
 
 
1,141.8
 
Total gross loans
 
1,945.2
 
 
1,669.5
 
 
2,131.8
 
 
1,917.7
 
 
2,065.8
 
 
2,000.8
 
 
2,114.1
 
 
2,026.9
 
 
2,245.4
 
 
1,766.5
 
Specific allowance for credit losses
 
(11.2
)
 
(0.6
)
 
(15.0
)
 
(4.1
)
 
(16.2
)
 
(2.6
)
 
(18.7
)
 
(3.3
)
 
(16.8
)
 
(9.9
)
General allowance for credit losses
 
(25.0
)
 
(7.6
)
 
(20.2
)
 
(10.0
)
 
(19.0
)
 
(9.7
)
 
(20.4
)
 
(10.3
)
 
(20.8
)
 
(8.4
)
Net loans
 
1,909.1
 
 
1,661.4
 
 
2,096.6
 
 
1,903.5
 
 
2,030.6
 
 
1,988.6
 
 
2,074.9
 
 
2,013.3
 
 
2,207.7
 
 
1,748.2
 

143

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Maturity Profile of the Loan Portfolio

The following table presents certain items in our loan portfolio by contractual maturity as of December 31, 2016.

 
As at December 31, 2016
Remaining term to average
contractual maturity
(in millions of $) (audited)
Within
1 year
1 to 5
years
Over 5
years
Total
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial loans
 
74.4
 
 
138.3
 
 
34.6
 
 
247.3
 
Commercial real estate
 
15.5
 
 
216.9
 
 
156.1
 
 
388.5
 
Consumer loans
 
65.4
 
 
27.1
 
 
11.5
 
 
104.0
 
Residential mortgages
 
38.0
 
 
46.0
 
 
1,121.5
 
 
1,205.5
 
Total Bermuda
 
193.2
 
 
428.3
 
 
1,323.6
 
 
1,945.1
 
Non-Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial loans
 
46.7
 
 
153.2
 
 
22.5
 
 
222.3
 
Commercial real estate
 
34.1
 
 
59.2
 
 
128.8
 
 
222.0
 
Consumer loans
 
44.3
 
 
34.4
 
 
15.4
 
 
94.1
 
Residential mortgages
 
114.7
 
 
462.0
 
 
554.3
 
 
1,131.0
 
Total Non-Bermuda
 
239.7
 
 
708.8
 
 
720.9
 
 
1,669.5
 
Total
 
433.0
 
 
1,137.2
 
 
2,044.6
 
 
3,614.7
 

The following table presents our loan portfolio by maturity and type of interest as of December 31, 2016.

 
As at December 31, 2016
Remaining term to average
contractual maturity
(in millions of $) (audited)
Within
1 year
1 to 5
years
Over 5
years
Total
Loans with fixed interest rates
 
37.0
 
 
57.2
 
 
53.0
 
 
147.2
 
Loans with floating or adjustable interest rates
 
396.0
 
 
1,080.0
 
 
1,991.5
 
 
3,467.5
 
Total
 
433.0
 
 
1,137.2
 
 
2,044.6
 
 
3,614.7
 

Loan and Lease Concentrations

As of December 31, 2016, we did not identify any concentration of loans and leases that exceeded 10% of total loans and leases. See Note 7 “Credit Risk Concentrations” to our audited consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 2016 included elsewhere in this prospectus for further discussion of how we manage concentration exposures.

Risk Elements

For details on our policy for placing loans on non-accrual status, see Note 2 “Significant Accounting Policies” to our audited consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 2016 included elsewhere in this prospectus.

144

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following table shows a five-year history of non-accrual loans, loans past due 90 days or more and other potential problem loans. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates” for our policies for determining non-performing and potential problem loans.

 
As of December 31,
 
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
(in millions of $)
Bermuda
Non-
Bermuda
Bermuda
Non-
Bermuda
Bermuda
Non-
Bermuda
Bermuda
Non-
Bermuda
Bermuda
Non-
Bermuda
Non-accrual loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
0.6
 
 
 
 
0.6
 
 
 
 
0.6
 
 
0.1
 
 
0.3
 
 
0.2
 
 
1.5
 
 
2.1
 
Commercial overdrafts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
 
0.1
 
 
0.3
 
 
0.2
 
 
0.3
 
 
 
Total commercial loans
 
0.6
 
 
 
 
0.6
 
 
 
 
0.7
 
 
0.2
 
 
0.6
 
 
0.4
 
 
1.8
 
 
2.1
 
Commercial real estate loans
 
5.5
 
 
0.5
 
 
5.4
 
 
4.9
 
 
8.3
 
 
4.0
 
 
38.9
 
 
2.3
 
 
46.0
 
 
9.1
 
Consumer loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Automobile financing
 
0.3
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
0.4
 
 
0.1
 
 
0.5
 
 
 
Credit card
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Overdrafts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.2
 
 
 
 
0.2
 
 
 
Other consumer
 
0.6
 
 
0.1
 
 
0.9
 
 
0.4
 
 
1.6
 
 
0.2
 
 
1.7
 
 
0.2
 
 
1.7
 
 
0.3
 
Total consumer loans
 
0.9
 
 
0.1
 
 
1.0
 
 
0.4
 
 
1.7
 
 
0.2
 
 
2.4
 
 
0.3
 
 
2.4
 
 
0.4
 
Residential mortgages
 
34.0
 
 
6.9
 
 
40.4
 
 
12.6
 
 
45.0
 
 
11.7
 
 
47.1
 
 
12.0
 
 
37.3
 
 
14.3
 
Total non-accrual loans
 
40.9
 
 
7.5
 
 
47.4
 
 
17.9
 
 
55.7
 
 
16.1
 
 
89.0
 
 
15.0
 
 
87.5
 
 
25.9
 
Accruing loans past due 90 days and more
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial overdrafts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total commercial loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1.1
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial real estate loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.7
 
 
 
 
0.8
 
 
1.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.4
 
Consumer loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Automobile financing
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
Credit card
 
0.4
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
0.2
 
 
 
 
0.4
 
 
 
 
0.6
 
 
 
Overdrafts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other consumer
 
 
 
0.3
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.3
 
 
 
 
0.3
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
Total consumer loans
 
0.4
 
 
0.3
 
 
0.2
 
 
0.5
 
 
0.2
 
 
0.3
 
 
0.5
 
 
0.3
 
 
0.6
 
 
0.2
 
Residential mortgages
 
6.2
 
 
2.3
 
 
4.5
 
 
8.2
 
 
8.5
 
 
14.9
 
 
7.2
 
 
2.7
 
 
8.6
 
 
18.6
 
Total accruing loans past 90 days and more
 
6.6
 
 
2.6
 
 
4.7
 
 
9.4
 
 
8.7
 
 
17.1
 
 
9.5
 
 
3.0
 
 
9.2
 
 
19.2
 
Loans modified in a troubled debt restructuring (TDR)(1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial loans
 
 
 
1.0
 
 
 
 
1.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
1.7
 
 
0.1
 
 
2.1
 
 
 
Commercial real estate loans
 
2.8
 
 
0.5
 
 
14.2
 
 
0.4
 
 
17.9
 
 
8.0
 
 
20.9
 
 
8.1
 
 
14.7
 
 
8.2
 
Consumer loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgages
 
43.5
 
 
3.0
 
 
34.0
 
 
1.6
 
 
22.2
 
 
1.2
 
 
9.8
 
 
1.7
 
 
8.0
 
 
2.9
 
Total loans modified in a TDR
 
46.2
 
 
4.5
 
 
48.2
 
 
3.2
 
 
40.1
 
 
9.3
 
 
32.4
 
 
10.0
 
 
24.8
 
 
11.1
 
(1)Total recorded investment.

145

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Impact of Impaired Loans on Interest Income

The following table presents the gross interest income for both nonaccrual and TDR’s that would have been recognized if such loans had been current in accordance with their original contractual terms, and had been outstanding throughout the period or since origination if held for only part of the period. The table also presents the interest income related to these loans that was actually recognized for the year.

 
Year-ended
December 31, 2016
Total
Gross amount of interest income that would have been recorded in accordance with original contractual terms, and had been outstanding throughout the year or since origination, if held for only part of the year(1)
 
2.7
 
Interest income actually recognized
 
2.5
 
Total interest income forgone
 
0.2
 
(1)Based on the contractual rate that was being charged at the time the loan was restructured or placed on non-accrual status.

Potential Problem Loans

This disclosure presents outstanding amounts as well as specific reserves for certain loans and leases where information about possible credit problems of borrowers causes management to have serious doubts as to the ability of such borrowers to comply with the present repayment terms. At December 31, 2016, we did not identify any potential problem loans or leases within the portfolio that were not already included in “Risk Elements” above.

Cross Border Outstandings

The following table presents the aggregate amount of cross-border outstandings from borrowers or counterparties for each foreign country that exceeds 0.75% of consolidated assets for any of the periods reported below. Cross-border outstandings include loans, receivables, interest-bearing deposits with other banks, other interest-bearing investments and monetary assets that are denominated in either dollars or other non-local currency.

The table separately presents the amounts of cross-border outstandings by type of borrower including governments, banks and financial institutions and other, along with an analysis of local country assets net of local country liabilities.

Country of counterparty
United
Kingdom
United
States
Canada
Guernsey
(in millions of $)
For the year ended
December 31, 2016
Governments and official institutions
 
580.1
 
 
398.1
 
 
271.5
 
 
 
Banks and other financial institutions
 
563.4
 
 
846.4
 
 
246.9
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
49.5
 
 
148.8
 
 
 
 
 
Residential
 
312.0
 
 
3,859.7
 
 
 
 
 
Total cross border outstandings
 
1,505.0
 
 
5,253.0
 
 
518.4
 
 
 
Net local country claims
 
102.0
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cross-border commitments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total exposure
 
1,607.0
 
 
5,253.0
 
 
518.4
 
 
 

146

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Country of counterparty
United
Kingdom
United
States
Canada
Guernsey
(in millions of $)
For the year ended
December 31, 2015
Governments and official institutions
 
169.1
 
 
843.9
 
 
 
 
 
Banks and other financial institutions
 
623.8
 
 
810.2
 
 
368.8
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
3.9
 
 
45.8
 
 
 
 
 
Residential
 
101.2
 
 
2,674.8
 
 
 
 
 
Total cross-border outstandings
 
898.0
 
 
4,374.7
 
 
368.8
 
 
 
Net local country claims
 
183.0
 
 
 
 
 
 
433.4
 
Cross-border commitments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total exposure
 
1,081.0
 
 
4,374.7
 
 
368.8
 
 
433.4
 
Country of counterparty
United
Kingdom
United
States
Canada(1)
Guernsey
(in millions of $)
For the year ended
December 31, 2014
Governments and official institutions
 
46.7
 
 
174.9
 
 
 
 
 
Banks and other financial institutions
 
905.9
 
 
1,075.4
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
4.1
 
 
39.0
 
 
 
 
 
Residential
 
94.6
 
 
2,491.5
 
 
 
 
 
Total cross-border outstandings
 
1,051.4
 
 
3,780.8
 
 
 
 
 
Net local country claims
 
216.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
528.4
 
Cross-border commitments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total exposure
 
1,267.9
 
 
3,780.8
 
 
 
 
528.4
 

There were no countries listed above which were experiencing liquidity problems as of any of the period-end dates listed.

(1)For the year ended December 31, 2014, there were no cross border outstanding exposures to Canada in excess of 1% of total assets.

Loan Concentration

As of December 31, 2016, there were no individual loans for which their net carrying value was greater than 10% of the total loans outstanding.

Summary of Loan Loss Experience

The following table presents our loan loss experience for the years indicated.

 
For the year ended December 31,
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
Balance at the beginning of the year
 
49.3
 
 
47.5
 
 
52.8
 
 
56.0
 
 
55.5
 
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charge-offs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial loans
 
(0.1
)
 
(0.2
)
 
 
 
 
 
(1.3
)
Commercial real estate
 
(2.8
)
 
(0.2
)
 
(6.6
)
 
(10.3
)
 
(2.3
)
Consumer loans
 
(1.7
)
 
(3.3
)
 
(2.0
)
 
(2.2
)
 
(4.5
)
Residential mortgages
 
(2.9
)
 
(1.6
)
 
(3.7
)
 
(1.7
)
 
(0.8
)
Recoveries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial loans
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial real estate
 
 
 
0.2
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer loans
 
1.1
 
 
0.3
 
 
1.9
 
 
3.0
 
 
2.9
 
Residential mortgages
 
 
 
1.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

147

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 
For the year ended December 31,
(in millions of $)
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
Non-Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charge-offs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial loans
 
 
 
(0.3
)
 
(0.8
)
 
(1.7
)
 
(0.1
)
Commercial real estate
 
(1.7
)
 
(0.1
)
 
 
 
(5.3
)
 
(4.4
)
Consumer loans
 
(0.2
)
 
(0.4
)
 
0.1
 
 
(0.5
)
 
(0.2
)
Residential mortgages
 
(1.0
)
 
(0.4
)
 
(2.5
)
 
(2.0
)
 
(4.1
)
Recoveries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial loans
 
 
 
0.2
 
 
0.1
 
 
2.7
 
 
0.5
 
Commercial real estate
 
 
 
0.6
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer loans
 
0.2
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
0.1
 
 
0.1
 
Residential mortgages
 
0.1
 
 
0.3
 
 
0.3
 
 
 
 
0.3
 
Charge-offs, net of recoveries
 
(9.0
)
 
(3.7
)
 
(13.2
)
 
(17.9
)
 
(13.9
)
Additional charge to operations
 
3.9
 
 
5.5
 
 
7.9
 
 
14.7
 
 
14.4
 
Balance at the end of the year
 
44.2
 
 
49.3
 
 
47.5
 
 
52.8
 
 
56.0
 
Average loans
 
3,921.1
 
 
4,026.7
 
 
4,075.0
 
 
4,022.9
 
 
4,022.6
 
Ratio of net charge-offs during the period to average loans outstanding during the year
 
(0.23
)%
 
(0.09
)%
 
(0.32
)%
 
(0.44
)%
 
(0.35
)%

See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” located elsewhere in this prospectus for further details on additional charges to operations.

The following table presents allocation of allowances for credit losses for the periods indicated.

 
For the year ended December 31,
 
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
(in millions of $)
$
%(1)
$
%(1)
$
%(1)
$
%(1)
$
%(1)
Balance at the end of the year
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial loans
 
1.7
 
 
0.7
 
 
4.3
 
 
1.2
 
 
3.1
 
 
1.2
 
 
3.3
 
 
1.3
 
 
2.8
 
 
1.1
 
Commercial real estate
 
13.2
 
 
3.4
 
 
3.7
 
 
0.9
 
 
4.2
 
 
1.0
 
 
9.2
 
 
2.2
 
 
12.7
 
 
2.6
 
Consumer loans
 
0.7
 
 
0.7
 
 
1.3
 
 
1.2
 
 
1.4
 
 
1.1
 
 
1.8
 
 
1.4
 
 
3.8
 
 
2.5
 
Residential mortgages
 
20.5
 
 
1.7
 
 
25.9
 
 
2.1
 
 
26.5
 
 
2.1
 
 
24.9
 
 
1.9
 
 
18.3
 
 
1.4
 
Non-Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial loans
 
1.7
 
 
0.8
 
 
4.4
 
 
1.8
 
 
4.7
 
 
1.5
 
 
5.0
 
 
1.7
 
 
3.8
 
 
1.8
 
Commercial real estate
 
3.0
 
 
1.3
 
 
2.8
 
 
1.1
 
 
1.7
 
 
0.6
 
 
0.7
 
 
0.2
 
 
5.7
 
 
2.0
 
Consumer loans
 
0.3
 
 
0.3
 
 
1.5
 
 
1.2
 
 
1.4
 
 
0.9
 
 
1.6
 
 
1.1
 
 
1.0
 
 
0.8
 
Residential mortgages
 
3.2
 
 
0.3
 
 
5.4
 
 
0.4
 
 
4.5
 
 
0.4
 
 
6.3
 
 
0.5
 
 
7.9
 
 
0.7
 
Total
 
44.2
 
 
1.2
 
 
49.3
 
 
1.6
 
 
47.5
 
 
1.6
 
 
52.8
 
 
1.7
 
 
56.0
 
 
1.7
 
(1)Percent of loans in each category to total loans.

148

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Deposits

The following table presents our interest-bearing deposits for the years indicated.

 
For the year ended December 31,
 
2016
2015
2014
(in millions of $, unless otherwise indicated)
Average
balance
Average
rate
Average
balance
Average
rate
Average
balance
Average
rate
Interest bearing deposits
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand
 
2,881.0
 
 
0.05
%
 
2,130.6
 
 
0.12
%
 
1,905.6
 
 
0.14
%
Term
 
903.9
 
 
0.45
%
 
690.2
 
 
0.61
%
 
969.7
 
 
0.54
%
Total Bermuda(1)
 
3,784.9
 
 
 
 
 
2,820.8
 
 
 
 
 
2,875.3
 
 
 
 
Non-Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand
 
3,205.6
 
 
0.08
%
 
3,479.7
 
 
0.15
%
 
3,052.6
 
 
0.19
%
Term
 
685.1
 
 
0.50
%
 
838.5
 
 
0.75
%
 
775.6
 
 
0.88
%
Total Non-Bermuda
 
3,890.7
 
 
 
 
 
4,318.2
 
 
 
 
 
3,828.2
 
 
 
 
Total interest-bearing deposits
 
7,675.6
 
 
 
 
 
7,139.0
 
 
 
 
 
6,703.4
 
 
 
 
Non-interest bearing demand deposits
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bermuda(1)
 
1,486.1
 
 
 
 
 
1,192.5
 
 
 
 
 
883.1
 
 
 
 
Non-Bermuda
 
556.5
 
 
 
 
 
528.2
 
 
 
 
 
327.9
 
 
 
 
Total non-interest bearing deposits
 
2,042.6
 
 
 
 
 
1,720.7
 
 
 
 
 
1,211.0
 
 
 
 
(1)The aggregate amount of deposits by foreign depositors in Bermuda was approximately $1,028.2 million, $688.9 million, and $668.2 million as of December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 respectively.

Term Deposits of $100,000 or More

The following table presents the amount of term deposits of $100,000 or more by time remaining until maturity as of December 31, 2016:

 
Remaining term to maturity
(in millions of $)
3 months
or less
3 to 6
months
6 to 12
months
Over
12 months
Total
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customer
 
1,013.2
 
 
37.5
 
 
61.0
 
 
44.5
 
 
1,156.2
 
Bank
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Bermuda
 
1,013.2
 
 
37.5
 
 
61.0
 
 
44.5
 
 
1,156.2
 
Non-Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customer
 
440.7
 
 
119.5
 
 
17.6
 
 
9.5
 
 
587.3
 
Bank
 
3.7
 
 
0.1
 
 
 
 
 
 
3.8
 
Total Non-Bermuda
 
444.4
 
 
119.6
 
 
17.6
 
 
9.5
 
 
591.1
 
Total Term Deposits of $100,000 or More
 
1,457.6
 
 
157.1
 
 
78.6
 
 
54.0
 
 
1,747.3
 

149

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Return on Equity and Assets

The following table presents our return on equity and assets for the years indicated.

 
For the year ended
December 31,
 
2016
2015
2014
Return on assets(1)
 
1.1
%
 
0.8
%
 
1.2
%
Return on equity(2)
 
8.9
%
 
10.1
%
 
13.7
%
Dividend payout ratio(3)
 
33.9
%
 
40.8
%
 
30.4
%
Equity to assets ratio(4)
 
7.6
%
 
8.3
%
 
9.2
%
(1)Net income divided by average total assets.
(2)Net income divided by average equity.
(3)Dividends declared per share divided by net income per share. Figures reflect a ten-to-one reverse share split of common shares that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.
(4)Average equity divided by average total assets.

Short-Term Borrowings

There were no short-term borrowings in excess of 30% of shareholders’ equity as of December 31, 2016 and 2015.

150

TABLE OF CONTENTS

RISK MANAGEMENT

Risk Oversight and Management

General

The principal types of risk inherent in our business are market, liquidity, credit and operational risks.

Organizational structure

The Board has overall responsibility for determining the strategy for risk management, setting the Bank's risk appetite and ensuring that risk is monitored and controlled effectively. It accomplishes its mandate through the activities of two dedicated committees:

The Risk Policy and Compliance Committee (“RPC”): This committee of the Board assists the Board in fulfilling its responsibilities by overseeing the Group's risk profile and its performance against approved risk appetites and tolerance thresholds. Specifically, the committee considers the sufficiency of the Group's policies, procedures and limits related to the identification, measurement, monitoring and control of activities that give rise to credit, market, liquidity, interest rate, operational and reputational risks, as well as overseeing its compliance with laws, regulations and codes of conduct.

The Audit Committee: This committee reviews the overall adequacy and effectiveness of the Group's system of internal controls and the control environment, including in respect of the risk management process. It reviews recommendations arising from internal and independent audit review activities and management's response to any findings raised.

Both the RPC and Audit Committees are supported in the execution of their respective mandates by the dedicated Audit, Compliance and Risk Policy Committees for our UK, Guernsey and Caribbean operations, which oversee the sufficiency of local risk management policies and procedures and the effectiveness of the system of internal controls that are in place. These committees are chaired by non-executive directors drawn from the board of directors for each segment.

The Group executive management team is led by the Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”) and includes the members of executive management reporting directly to the CEO. The executive management team is responsible for setting business strategy and for monitoring, evaluating and managing risks across the Group. It is supported by the following management committees:

The Group Risk Committee (“GRC”): This committee is comprised of executive and senior management team members and is chaired by the Chief Risk Officer. It provides a forum for the strategic assessment of risks assumed across the Group as a whole based on an integrated view of credit, market, liquidity, legal and regulatory compliance, operational, interest rate, investment, capital and reputational risks, ensuring that these exposures are consistent with the risk appetites and tolerance thresholds promulgated by the Board. It is responsible for reviewing, evaluating and recommending the Group's Risk Appetite Framework, the results of the Capital Assessment and Risk Profile (“CARP”) process (including all associated stress testing performed) and the Group's key risk policies to the Board for approval, for reviewing and evaluating current and proposed business strategies in the context of our risk appetites and for identifying, reviewing and advising on current and emerging risk issues and associated mitigation plans.

The Group Asset and Liability Committee (“GALCO”): This committee is comprised of executive and senior management team members and is chaired by the Chief Financial Officer. The committee is responsible for liquidity, interest rate and exchange rate risk management and other balance sheet issues. It also oversees the execution of the Group's investment and capital management strategies and monitors the associated risks assumed. It is supported in the execution of its mandate by the work undertaken by the dedicated Asset & Liability Committees in each of the Bank's jurisdictional business units.

The Group Credit Committee (“GCC”): This committee is comprised of executive and senior management and is chaired by the Chief Risk Officer. The committee is responsible for a broad range of activities relating to the monitoring, evaluation and management of credit risks assumed across the Group at both transaction and portfolio levels. It is supported in the execution of its mandate by the Financial

151

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Institutions Committee (“FIC”), a dedicated sub-committee that is responsible for the evaluation and approval of recommended inter-bank and counterparty exposures assumed in the Group's treasury and investment portfolios, and by the activities of the European Credit Committee, which reviews and approves transactions within delegated authorities and recommends specific transactions outside of these limits to the GCC for approval.

The Provisions and Impairments Committee: This committee is comprised of executive and senior management team members and is chaired by the Chief Risk Officer. The committee is responsible for approving significant provisions and other impairment charges. It also oversees the overall credit risk profile of the Group in regards to non-accrual loans and assets. It is supported in the execution of its mandate by local credit committees and the GCC, which make recommendations to this committee.

The Policy Development Committee: This committee is comprised of senior management team members across the Group and is chaired by the Group Head of Operational Risk. The committee is responsible for overseeing the design, development and maintenance of the Group's framework of operational policies. It develops recommendations regarding policy requirements, engages with nominated members of executive management to ensure that policies are drafted or updated on a timely basis and provides a forum through which they are debated Group-wide prior to their adoption, thereby ensuring a consistency of application and interpretation. It also ensures that all policies and policy exception requests are reviewed and recommended prior to presentation to the GRC and if necessary, the RPC for approval.

Risk Management

We manage our exposure to risk through a three “lines of defense” model.

The first “line of defense” is provided by our jurisdictional business units, which retain ultimate responsibility for the risks they assume and for bearing the cost of risk associated with these exposures.

The second “line of defense” is provided by our Risk Management group, which works in collaboration with our business units to identify, assess, mitigate and monitor the risks associated with our business activities and strategies. It does this by:

Making recommendations to the GRC regarding the constitution of the Risk Appetite Framework;
Setting risk strategies that are designed to manage risk exposures assumed in the course of pursuing our business strategies and aligning them with agreed appetites;
Establishing and communicating policies, procedures and limits to control risks in alignment with these risk strategies;
Measuring, monitoring and reporting on risk levels;
Opining on specific transactions that fall outside delegated risk limits; and
Identifying and assessing emerging risks.

The four functions within the Risk Management group that support our risk management activities are outlined below. To ensure a formal separation of duties, each reports directly to our Chief Risk Officer.

Group Market Risk — This unit provides independent oversight of the measurement, monitoring and control of liquidity and funding risks, interest rate and foreign exchange risks as well as the market risks associated with our investment portfolios. It also monitors compliance with both regulatory requirements and our internal policies and procedures relating to the management of these risks.

Group Credit Risk Management — This unit is responsible for the adjudication and oversight of credit risks associated with our retail and commercial lending activities and the management of risks associated with our investment portfolios and counterparty exposures. It also establishes the parameters and delegated limits within which credit risks may be assumed and promulgates guidelines on how exposures should be managed and monitored.

Group Compliance — This unit provides independent analysis and assurance of our compliance with applicable laws, regulations, codes of conduct and recommended best practices, including those

152

TABLE OF CONTENTS

associated with the prevention of money laundering and terrorist financing. It is also responsible for assessing our potential exposure to upstream risks and for providing guidance on the preparations that should be made in advance of these changes coming into effect.

Group Operational Risk — This unit assesses the effectiveness of our procedures and internal controls in managing our exposure to various forms of operational risk, including those associated with new business activities and processes and the deployment of new technologies. It also oversees our incident management processes and reviews the effectiveness of our loss data collection activities.

The third “line of defense” is provided by our Group Internal Audit function, which performs oversight and ongoing review, and challenges the effectiveness of the internal controls that are executed by both the business and Risk Management.

Regulatory Review Process

Our banking, trust and investment business activities are monitored by the BMA. One of the principal objectives of the BMA is to supervise, regulate and inspect Bermudian financial institutions to ensure their financial stability and soundness.

In addition to conducting on-site reviews, the BMA utilizes a comprehensive quarterly statistical return system that enables off-site monitoring. The statistical system is consistent with Basel Committee Standards, which provides the BMA with a detailed breakdown of a bank's balance sheet and profit-and-loss accounts on both a consolidated and unconsolidated basis. This information enables the BMA to monitor the soundness of a bank's financial position and ensure that it meets certain capital requirements. For more information, see “Supervision and Regulation — Bermuda — Supervision and Monitoring by the BMA”.

The Risk Appetite Framework

The Risk Appetite Framework is the cornerstone of our approach to risk management. Developed by executive management and approved formally by the Board, it communicates a willingness to take on certain risks in the pursuit of our strategic objectives and defines those that should be avoided. It also provides management with a clear mandate regarding the amount and type of risk that it may accept and establishes minimum expectations regarding the practices and behaviors that should be brought to bear in managing the exposures assumed. It is aligned with the interests of our stakeholders, feeds into our business planning processes, and shapes our discussions on risk matters generally.

Our framework comprises the following elements:

(1)   Nine broad categories of risk: credit; market; liquidity; legal and regulatory; governance; process and technology; people; country and political; and reputational. These represent the various risks that the Group assumes across the entirety of its operations in the pursuit of its strategic goals.

(2)   For each risk category, there is a declared risk appetite. To ensure consistency in our risk conversations, these have been distilled into the three options set out in the following table, with each appetite designed to convey a clear strategic direction in terms of the risk/reward profile assumed:

Appetite
Definition
Profile
Averse
The Group will work to avoid exposure to this risk given its potential for financial loss, reputational damage, and/or the loss of customer and/or investor confidence.
Our processes and controls are defensive and focus on detection and prevention.
Cautious
Given the potential for financial loss, reputational damage, and the loss of customer and/or investor confidence, the Group will be very selective in the exposures assumed to this risk and will monitor it closely.
Security is favored over reward. Exposures are only assumed when the risk can be quantified accurately and is assessed as being acceptable.

153

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Appetite
Definition
Profile
Open
The Group will consider opportunities to accept this risk and will accept those that fall within clearly defined parameters. The risk of loss or reputational damage is accepted but the exposure can be estimated reliably and can be managed to a tolerable level.
Reward is commensurate with the risk assumed. Exposures can be estimated reliably and structures, systems and processes are in place to manage them.

(3)   A statement of our governing principles relating to each risk category. This establishes the characteristics of the risks that the Bank is willing to assume and the management behaviors that we should exhibit when doing so.

Specific performance measures and tolerance thresholds in respect of each risk category, combining quantitative and qualitative targets (which are designed to reflect both forward looking as well as historical perspectives), are designed to provide executive management and the Board with an indication of the “direction” of our exposure relative to our declared risk appetite and an early warning of material adverse developments requiring remedial action. The measures are monitored independently by the Group Risk function and are measured against actual results. The results of these analyses are reported to management at all levels of the organization and are reviewed regularly by Group Risk, executive management, and the Board in the performance of their oversight activities.

Application of the Risk Appetite Framework

The limits, targets and thresholds used to measure performance continue to be refined by the Group Risk Management function in an effort to express as complete a “picture” as possible of our exposure to a given risk, relative to the stated appetite. All changes proposed pass through a formal review and approval process at both the executive management and Board levels prior to their adoption. Through this approach, the risk appetite framework sets the tone for our risk culture across the Group as a whole, influencing behaviors at all levels of the organization and reinforcing accountability for decisions taken. Many of our jurisdictional offices have developed subsidiary risk appetite frameworks in conjunction with their local risk management functions. This ensures appropriate coverage of local risk factors and the establishment of proportional tolerance thresholds. Group risk has reviewed these frameworks prior to their adoption and has modified any appetites proposed that are considered to be inconsistent with the overall Group approach.

Market Risks

Interest Rate Risk Management

Our primary market risk is interest rate risk, which is defined as the risk of loss of net interest income or changes in net interest margin because of changes in interest rates.

We seek to measure and manage the potential impact of interest rate risk. Interest rate risk occurs when interest earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities mature or re-price at different times, on a different basis or in unequal amounts. Interest rate risk also arises when our assets, liabilities and off-balance sheet contracts each respond differently to changes in interest rates, including as a result of explicit and implicit provisions in agreements related to such assets and liabilities and in off-balance sheet contracts that alter the applicable interest rate and cash flow characteristics as interest rates change. The two primary examples of such provisions that we are exposed to are the duration and rate sensitivity associated with indeterminate-maturity deposits (e.g., non-interest-bearing checking accounts) and the rate of prepayment associated with fixed-rate lending and mortgage-backed securities. Interest rates may also affect loan demand, credit losses, mortgage origination volume and other items affecting earnings.

Our management of interest rate risk is overseen by the RPC, which outlines reporting and measurement requirements. In particular, this infrastructure sets limits and management targets, calculated for various metrics, including our economic value sensitivity, our economic value of equity and net interest income simulations involving parallel shifts in interest rate curves, steepening and flattening

154

TABLE OF CONTENTS

yield curves, and various prepayment and deposit duration assumptions. Our risk management infrastructure also requires a periodic review of all key assumptions used, such as identifying appropriate interest rate scenarios, setting loan prepayment rates based on historical analysis, non-interest-bearing and interest-bearing demand deposit durations based on historical analysis, and the targeted investment term of capital.

The principal objective of our interest rate risk management is to maximize profit potential while minimizing exposure to changes in interest rates. Our actions in this regard are taken under the guidance of GALCO. The committee is actively involved in formulating the economic assumptions that we use in our financial planning and budgeting processes and establishes policies which control and monitor the sources, uses and pricing of funds. From time to time, we utilize hedging techniques to reduce interest rate risk. GALCO uses interest income simulation and economic value of equity analysis to measure inherent risk in our balance sheet at specific points in time.

Appetite for interest rate risk is documented in the Group's policies on market risk and investments. This includes the completion of stress testing on at least a quarterly basis of the impact of an immediate and sustained shift in interest rates of +/– 200 basis points on net interest income, economic value of equity and the ratio of tangible total equity to average assets. If any of the parameters established by policy are exceeded, GALCO will provide a plan to executive management to bring the exposure back within tolerance under advice to the Board. The plan does not have to bring the exposure back within limit immediately, but must adjust the exposure within Board and management approved timeframes.

We also use derivatives in the asset and liability management of positions to minimize significant unplanned fluctuations in earnings that are caused by interest rate volatility. Our derivative contracts principally involve over-the-counter transactions that are privately negotiated between the Group and the counterparty to the contract. Derivative instruments that are used as part of our interest rate risk management strategy include interest rate swaps. Interest rate swaps generally involve the exchange of fixed and variable rate interest payments between two parties, based on a common notional principal amount and maturity date.

Interest Rate Risk

The following table sets out the assets, liabilities and shareholders' equity and off-balance sheet instruments on the date of the earlier of contractual maturity, expected maturity and repricing date. Use of these tables to derive information about our interest rate risk position is limited by the fact that customers may choose to terminate their financial instruments at a date earlier than the contractual maturity or repricing date. Examples of this include fixed-rate mortgages, which are shown at contractual maturity but which may pre-pay earlier, and certain term deposits, which are shown at contractual maturity but which may be withdrawn before their contractual maturity subject to prepayment penalties. Investments are shown based on remaining contractual maturities. The remaining contractual principal maturities for mortgage-backed securities (primarily US Government agencies) do not consider prepayments. Remaining expected maturities differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to prepay obligations before the underlying mortgages mature.

155

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 
Earlier of contractual maturity or repricing date
December 31, 2016
(in millions of $)
Within
3 months
3 to 6
months
6 to 12
months
1 to 5
years
After
5 years
Non-interest
bearing
Total
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and deposits with banks
 
1,991
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
111
 
 
2,102
 
Securities purchased under agreement to resell
 
149
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
149
 
Short-term investments
 
135
 
 
385
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
520
 
Investments
 
1,343
 
 
15
 
 
81
 
 
704
 
 
2,251
 
 
6
 
 
4,400
 
Loans
 
3,339
 
 
53
 
 
57
 
 
81
 
 
38
 
 
2
 
 
3,570
 
Other assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
363
 
 
363
 
Total assets
 
6,957
 
 
453
 
 
138
 
 
785
 
 
2,289
 
 
482
 
 
11,104
 
Liabilities and shareholders' equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand deposits
 
5,828
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2,385
 
 
8,213
 
Term deposits
 
1,492
 
 
166
 
 
92
 
 
71
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,821
 
Other liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
242
 
 
242
 
Subordinated capital
 
92
 
 
 
 
 
 
25
 
 
 
 
 
 
117
 
Shareholders' equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
711
 
 
711
 
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
 
7,412
 
 
166
 
 
92
 
 
96
 
 
 
 
3,338
 
 
11,104
 
Interest rate sensitivity gap
 
(455
)
 
287
 
 
46
 
 
689
 
 
2,289
 
 
(2,856
)
 
 
Cumulative interest rate sensitivity gap
 
(455
)
 
(168
)
 
(122
)
 
567
 
 
2,856
 
 
 
 
 

Asset/Liability Management and Interest Rate Risk

The principal objective of our asset and liability management function is to evaluate the interest rate risk within the balance sheet and pursue a controlled assumption of interest rate risk while maximizing net income and preserving adequate levels of liquidity and capital.

As a financial institution, our primary component of market risk is interest rate volatility. Fluctuations in interest rates will ultimately impact both the level of income and expense recorded on most of our assets and liabilities, and the fair value of all interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, other than those which have a short term to maturity. Interest rate risk is the potential of economic losses due to future interest rate changes. These economic losses can be reflected as a loss of future net interest income and/or a loss of current fair values. The objective is to measure the effect on net interest income and to adjust the balance sheet to minimize the inherent risk while at the same time maximizing income.

We manage our exposure to interest rates primarily by structuring our balance sheet in the ordinary course of business. We do not typically enter into derivative contracts for the purpose of managing interest rate risk, but we may elect to do so in the future. Based upon the nature of our operations, we are not subject to foreign exchange or commodity price risk. Our exposure to holdings categorized as “trading positions” falls below the de minimis threshold established of 5% (ratio of total trading book open position compared to the sum of on and off-balance sheet assets that are not part of the trading book).

We use an interest rate risk simulation model to test the interest rate sensitivity of net interest income and the balance sheet. Instantaneous parallel rate shift scenarios are modeled and utilized to evaluate risk and establish exposure limits for acceptable changes in net interest margin. These scenarios, known as rate shocks, simulate an instantaneous change in interest rates and use various assumptions, including, but not limited to, prepayments on securities, deposit decay rates, pricing decisions on loans and deposits, reinvestment and replacement of asset and liability cash flows. We also analyze the economic value of equity as a secondary measure of interest rate risk. This is a complementary measure to net interest income where the calculated value is the result of the fair value of assets less the fair value of liabilities. The economic value of equity is a longer term view of interest rate risk because it measures

156

TABLE OF CONTENTS

the present value of all future cash flows. The impact of changes in interest rates on this calculation is analyzed for the risk to our future earnings and is used in conjunction with the analysis on net interest income. The following table summarizes simulated change in net interest income versus unchanged rates as of December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015:

 
For the year ended
 
December 31, 2016
December 31, 2015
 
Following
12 Months
Months
13 - 24
Following
12 Months
Months
13 - 24
+300 basis points
 
17.70
%
 
25.00
%
 
13.80
%
 
17.30
%
+200 basis points
 
11.60
%
 
16.80
%
 
9.10
%
 
11.70
%
+100 basis points
 
5.60
%
 
8.50
%
 
4.50
%
 
6.10
%
Flat rates
 
0.00
%
 
0.00
%
 
0.00
%
 
0.00
%
−100 basis points
 
(8.90
)%
 
(13.00
)%
 
(6.40
)%
 
(8.70
)%

The following table presents the change in our economic value of equity as of December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, assuming immediate parallel shifts in interest rates:

 
For the year ended
 
December 31,
2016
December 31,
2015
+300 basis points
 
(0.10
)%
 
(2.60
)%
+200 basis points
 
(0.70
)%
 
(2.00
)%
+100 basis points
 
(0.60
)%
 
(1.00
)%
Flat rates
 
0.00
%
 
0.00
%
−100 basis points
 
(1.80
)%
 
(0.90
)%

The differences between the change in our economic value of equity assuming immediate parallel shifts in interests rates from December 31, 2015 to December 31, 2016 is driven by an increase in non-interest bearing deposits and an increase in fixed rate investments, which impacted both the duration and convexity of interest bearing assets and liabilities on the balance sheet.

Many assumptions are used to calculate the impact of interest rate fluctuations. Actual results may be significantly different than our projections due to several factors, including the timing and frequency of rate changes, market conditions and the shape of the yield curve. The computations of interest rate risk shown above do not include the full suite of actions that our management may undertake to manage the risks in response to anticipated changes in interest rates, and actual results may also differ materially.

Foreign Exchange Risk

The Group holds various non-USD denominated assets and liabilities and maintains investments in subsidiaries whose domestic currency is either not USD or whose domestic currency is not pegged to USD. Assets and liabilities denominated in currencies other than USD are translated to USD at the rates of exchange prevailing at the balance sheet date. The resulting gains or losses are included in foreign exchange revenue in the consolidated statement of operations. Assets and liabilities of subsidiaries outside of Bermuda are translated at the rate of exchange prevailing on the balance sheet date while associated revenues and expenses are translated to USD at the average rate of exchange prevailing through the accounting period. Unrealized translation gains or losses on investments in foreign currency based subsidiaries are recorded as a separate component of shareholders' equity within accumulated other comprehensive loss. Such gains or losses are recorded in the consolidated statement of operations only when realized. Our foreign currency subsidiaries, located in Guernsey and the United Kingdom, may give rise to significant foreign currency translation movements against the USD. We also provide foreign exchange services to our clients, principally in connection with our banking and wealth management businesses, and effect other transactions in non-USD currencies. Foreign currency volatility and fluctuations in exchange rates may impact the value of non-USD denominated assets and liabilities and raise the potential for losses resulting from foreign currency trading positions where aggregate obligations to purchase and sell a currency other than USD do not offset one another, or offset each other in different time periods. If the policies and procedures we have in place to assess and mitigate potential impacts of

157

TABLE OF CONTENTS

foreign exchange volatility are not followed, or are not effective to mitigate such risks, our results and earnings may be negatively affected. The Group maintains a clearly articulated foreign exchange risk exposure tolerance framework which limits exposures to select currencies.

Liquidity Risk

The objectives of liquidity risk management are to ensure that the Group can meet its cash flow requirements and capitalize on business opportunities on a timely and cost effective basis. Liquidity is defined as the ability to hold and/or generate cash adequate to meet our needs for day-to-day operations and material long and short-term commitments. Liquidity risk is the risk of potential loss if the Group were unable to meet its funding requirements at a reasonable cost.

We monitor and manage our liquidity on a group-wide basis. The treasury functions in the Group's banking operations, located in Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, Guernsey, and the United Kingdom, manage day-to-day liquidity. The group market risk function has the responsibility for measuring and reporting to senior management on liquidity risk positions. We manage our liquidity based on demand, commitments, specific events and uncertainties to meet current and future financial obligations of a short-term nature. Our objective in managing liquidity is to respond to the needs of depositors and borrowers as well as to earnings enhancement opportunities in a changing marketplace. Management is responsible for establishing and monitoring liquidity targets as well as strategies to meet these targets. The Group adopts a cautious liquidity risk appetite with internal quantitative liquidity risk tolerances more stringent than regulatory requirements. Specifically the Group manages liquidity against internal limits established by the market risk management policy and its related liquidity risk standard and quarterly stress testing methodology.

We maintained a balance sheet with loans representing 32.2% of total assets as of December 31, 2016. Further, at that date there were significant sources of liquidity within our balance sheet in the form of cash and cash equivalents, short-term investments securities purchased under agreement to resell and investments (excluding held-to-maturity investments) amounting to $6.1 billion, or 55.0%, of total assets.

An important element of our liquidity management is our liquidity contingency plan which can be employed in the event of a liquidity crisis. The objective of the liquidity contingency plan is to ensure that we maintain our liquidity during periods of stress. This plan takes into consideration a variety of scenarios that could challenge our liquidity. These scenarios include specific and systemic events that can impact our on-and off-balance sheet sources and uses of liquidity. This plan is reviewed and updated at least annually.

Credit Risk

Credit risk is defined as the risk that unexpected losses arise as a result of the Group's borrowers or market counterparties failing to meet their obligations to repay. Credit risk is managed through the Group credit risk management department (“GCRM”). GCRM provides a system of checks and balances for our diverse credit related activities by establishing and monitoring all credit related policies and practices throughout the Group and assuring their uniform application. These activities are designed to diversify credit exposure on an industry and client basis, thus lessening overall credit risk. These credit management activities also apply to our use of derivative financial instruments, including foreign exchange contracts and interest rate risk management instruments, which are primarily used to facilitate client transactions.

Individual credit authority for commercial and other loans is limited to specified amounts and maturities. Credit decisions involving commitment exposure in excess of the specified individual limits are submitted to GCRM and then to the GCC, which provides a forum for ongoing executive review of loan activity, establishing our credit guidelines and policies and approving selected credit transactions in accordance with our business objectives. The committee reviews large credit exposures, establishes and reviews credit strategy and policy and approves selected credit transactions. The FIC manages counterparty risk in respect of (third party) bank counterparties which do not have commercial credit relationships within the Group and also approves country exposure limits.

As part of our ongoing credit granting process, internal ratings are assigned to commercial clients before credit is extended, based on an assessment of creditworthiness. At least annually, a review of all

158

TABLE OF CONTENTS

significant credit exposures is undertaken to identify, at an early stage, clients who might be facing financial difficulties. Internal borrower risk ratings are also reviewed during this process, allowing identification of adverse individual borrower and sector trends.

An integral part of the GCRM function is to formally review past due and potential problem loans to determine which credits, if any, need to be placed on non-accrual status or charged off. The allowance for loan losses is reviewed monthly to determine the amount necessary to maintain an adequate provision for credit losses.

Another way credit risk is managed is by requiring collateral. Management's assessment of the borrower's creditworthiness determines whether collateral is obtained. The amount and type of collateral held varies but may include deposits held in financial institutions, mutual funds, US Treasury securities, other marketable securities, income-producing commercial properties, accounts receivable, residential real estate, property, plant and equipment, and inventory. Values of variable collateral are monitored on a regular basis to ensure that they are maintained at an appropriate level.

Credit Risk — Retail and Private Banking

Retail and private lending activity is split between residential mortgages, personal loans, credit cards and authorized overdrafts. Retail credit risks are managed in accordance with limits and processes set out in the credit risk policies and guidelines approved by GCC and GRC (and ratified by the Board). The policies set out where specialist underwriting may be needed.

For residential mortgages, a combination of lending policy criteria, lending guidelines and underwriting are used to make a decision on applications for credit. The primary factors considered are affordability, residential status, residential history, credit history, employment history, nature of income and loan-to-value of the residential property. In addition, confirmation of a borrower's identity is obtained and an assessment of the value of the collateral carried out prior to granting a credit facility. When considering applications the primary focus is placed on the willingness and ability to repay.

Loan-to-value (“LTV”) ratios are derived based on third-party valuations as part of the original underwriting or when increased borrowing has been requested. Updated valuations are not otherwise obtained unless the loan reaches non-accrual status. Non-accrual loans which are collateral-dependent on real estate must be supported by a third-party valuation no older than 12 months. Specific provisions are calculated as the amount by which non-accrual loan principal exceeds the value of the supporting real estate, after application of a haircut for the estimated costs of sale. Costs of sale for commercial properties are calculated based on individual circumstances, whereas the haircuts for residential real estate are prescribed in lending guidelines by geographic location and are never less than 20% of the valuation amount.

As valuations are conducted throughout the year, the rolling average age of the valuations is closer to 6 months than 12 months. In addition, on at least a quarterly basis, impairment levels are adjusted for any changes in non-accrual principal.

To further ensure that valuations within the twelve-month revaluation period remain appropriate measures for impairment, we: (1) compare renewal valuations to the prior valuation to track market movement; (2) back-test all sales to compare net carrying value versus any additional gain/loss at the time of sale; (3) segregate the tests described in (1) and (2) by Bermuda geographic area and, where required, amend provision factors accordingly; and (4) perform a review of new valuations to ascertain such valuations' reasonableness and determine if any change in value may impact similar properties or locations where valuations are more stale-dated and require an adjustment to the impairment level. Valuations for properties in less central locations have been further discounted to compensate for the steeper discounts required to sell such properties.

The Bank performs an annual assessment of group residential LTV ranges as part of its stress-testing exercise for regulatory and capital-adequacy purposes. Real estate indices are not available in the Bank's primary markets and LTV values are based on standard reductions in value over time, based on observed market activity.

159

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Maximum LTV for new residential and commercial loans follow:

 
Bermuda
Cayman
UK—London
Residential:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Owner-occupied freehold
 
80
%
 
85
%
 
65
%
Owner-occupied leasehold condominium
 
80
%
 
85
%
 
65
%
Investment (not owner-occupied)
 
65
%
 
75
%
 
65
%
Raw land
 
50
%
 
80
%
 
n/a
 
Commercial Real Estate
 
65
%
 
65
%
 
n/a
 

For other retail lending products, similar lending policy criteria are used, and each of these products has its own policy and underwriting guidelines to enable decisions on applications for credit and to manage accounts. The factors used are attuned to the lending product in question, although affordability and credit history are considered in all cases. Ongoing monitoring of all retail and private banking credit is undertaken by the business unit concerned as well as by GCRM. In addition, the GCC reviews reports on a weekly basis. In the event that particular exposures show adverse features such as arrears, the Bank's specialist recovery teams generally work with borrowers to resolve the situation.

Unlike the United States where the Fair Credit Reporting Act (“FCRA”) is designed to help ensure that credit bureaus furnish correct and complete information when evaluating loan applications, the markets in which we operate do not have systemic credit bureau reports such as those provided by Experian, Equifax, or TransUnion. These firms collect comprehensive data on individuals' credit history, payment history, debt, history of bankruptcy, credit score trends, income, FICO scores and other background information that provide a broad indication of a loan applicant's credit worthiness. Due to the lack of such systemically collected information with respect to loan applicants in the markets in which we operate, we cannot use sophisticated software analytics tools, such as Fair Isaac type applications, that would enable us to automate our credit underwriting process. As a result, our experienced underwriters must manually review each loan on a credit by credit basis and we use a formally governed tiered credit approval process that is administered through and governed by our risk management framework.

Credit Risk — Commercial Banking

Commercial credit risks are managed in accordance with limits and asset quality measures set out in the credit risk policies and guidelines approved by GCC (and ratified by the Board).

In respect of commercial banking, there is a level of delegated sanctioning authority to underwrite certain credit risks based upon an evaluation of the borrower's experience, track record, financial strength, ability to repay, transaction structure and security characteristics. Lending decisions for large or high risk exposures are based upon a thorough credit risk analysis and the assignment of an internal borrower risk rating, and are subject to further approval by the assigned officers in GCRM or the GCC.

Consideration is also given to risk mitigation measures which will provide the Group with protection, such as third-party guarantees, supporting collateral and security, legal documentation and financial covenants. Commercial portfolio asset quality monitoring is based upon a number of measures, including the monitoring of financial covenants, cash flows, pricing movements and variable collateral. In the event that particular exposures begin to show adverse features such as payment arrears, covenant breaches or business trading losses, a full risk reassessment is undertaken. Where appropriate, a specialist recovery team will work with the borrower to resolve the situation. If this proves unsuccessful, the case will be subject to intensive monitoring and management procedures designed to maximize debt recovery.

Credit Risk — Treasury

Treasury credit risks are managed in accordance with limits, asset quality measures and criteria set out within the policy approved by the GCC and ratified by the Board. The policy also sets out powers which require higher levels of authorization according to the size of the transaction or the nature of the associated risk. The financial institutions committee identifies, assesses, prioritizes and manages our risks associated with counterparty exposure to other financial institutions, as well as country-specific exposures.

160

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Exposures to financial institutions arise within the Group's investment portfolio and treasury operations. The Group has treasury operations in all of its banking locations. Treasury exposures primarily take the form of deposits with banks and foreign exchange positions. Exposures to financial institutions in the investment portfolio can take the form of bonds, floating rate notes and or certificates of deposit.

Diversification and avoidance of concentration is emphasized. The Group establishes limits for countries and each financial institution where there is an expected exposure. Ongoing asset quality monitoring is undertaken by Treasury and GCRM. reports are sent to the FIC, GCC and the GRC on a monthly basis. Exception reporting takes place against a range of asset quality triggers. Treasury uses a number of risk mitigation techniques including netting and collateralization agreements. Other methods (such as margining and derivatives) are used periodically to mitigate the risk associated with particular transactions or group of transactions.

For its exposure to treasury credit risk, the Group uses Standard and Poor's (“S&P”), Fitch and Moody's as external credit assessment institutions as permitted under Basel II for sovereign, financial institutions, asset-backed securities, covered bonds and corporate risks. With regard to financial institutions and corporates, the Group's preference for a long-term rating is the senior unsecured rating. However, counterparty ratings and/or short-term deposit or commercial paper ratings are used if this is unavailable. For asset-backed securities, the issue or tranche rating is used.

Exposures

The following tables analyze the Group's regulatory credit risk exposures as of December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015. Exposures are allocated to specific standardized exposure portfolios determined by the BMA's Revised Framework for Regulatory Capital Assessment and it is these portfolios that determine the risk weights used. These exposures include both on and off-balance sheet exposures, with the latter shown separately after credit conversion factors have been applied.

Analysis of exposures class
(in millions of $)
Average
Exposure
2016
Position as of
December 31,
2016
Average
Exposure
2015
Position as of
December 31,
2015
Cash
 
50.5
 
 
63.7
 
 
41.8
 
 
45.1
 
Claims on Sovereigns
 
1,531.0
 
 
1,350.7
 
 
716.0
 
 
1,367.8
 
Claims on Public Sector Entities
 
100.5
 
 
105.0
 
 
88.0
 
 
89.0
 
Claims on Corporates
 
444.8
 
 
516.7
 
 
388.0
 
 
401.1
 
Claims on Banks and Securities Firms
 
1,718.4
 
 
1,760.2
 
 
2,255.3
 
 
1,955.3
 
Securitizations
 
3,306.7
 
 
3,859.7
 
 
2,695.9
 
 
2,655.6
 
Retail Loans
 
235.7
 
 
216.1
 
 
325.2
 
 
260.6
 
Residential Mortgages
 
2,380.9
 
 
2,291.7
 
 
2,453.4
 
 
2,474.5
 
Commercial Mortgages
 
612.0
 
 
572.0
 
 
673.5
 
 
652.4
 
Past Due Loans
 
57.1
 
 
48.3
 
 
68.9
 
 
59.1
 
Other Balance Sheet Exposures
 
271.2
 
 
257.7
 
 
298.2
 
 
277.0
 
Non-Market Related Off Balance Sheet Credit Exposures
 
353.7
 
 
377.2
 
 
363.6
 
 
395.0
 
Market-Related Off-Balance Sheet Credit Exposures
 
59.7
 
 
65.8
 
 
48.6
 
 
51.2
 
Total
 
11,122.2
 
 
11,484.8
 
 
10,416.4
 
 
10,683.7
 

161

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Geographic distribution of
exposures class as of
December 31, 2016
(in millions of $)
Bermuda
UK
Guernsey
Caribbean
Switzerland
Total
Cash
 
28.0
 
 
 
 
 
 
35.7
 
 
 
 
63.7
 
Claims on Sovereigns
 
911.6
 
 
66.5
 
 
284.8
 
 
87.8
 
 
 
 
1,350.7
 
Claims on Public Sector Entities
 
94.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
10.5
 
 
 
 
105.0
 
Claims on Corporates
 
326.1
 
 
 
 
50.8
 
 
139.8
 
 
 
 
516.7
 
Claims on Banks and Securities firms
 
987.3
 
 
76.7
 
 
226.2
 
 
468.2
 
 
1.8
 
 
1,760.2
 
Securitizations
 
2,299.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,560.0
 
 
 
 
3,859.7
 
Retail loan
 
99.7
 
 
(1.1
)
 
35.6
 
 
81.9
 
 
 
 
216.1
 
Residential Mortgages
 
1,170.4
 
 
 
 
416.6
 
 
704.7
 
 
 
 
2,291.7
 
Commercial Mortgages
 
359.0
 
 
 
 
17.8
 
 
195.2
 
 
 
 
572.0
 
Past Due Loans
 
35.6
 
 
 
 
 
 
12.7
 
 
 
 
48.3
 
Other Balance Sheet Exposures
 
163.4
 
 
9.4
 
 
20.8
 
 
63.7
 
 
0.4
 
 
257.7
 
Non-Market Related Off Balance Sheet Credit exposures
 
202.6
 
 
 
 
32.1
 
 
142.5
 
 
 
 
377.2
 
Market Related Off Balance Sheet Credit Exposures
 
52.4
 
 
 
 
0.5
 
 
12.9
 
 
 
 
65.8
 
Total
 
6,730.3
 
 
151.5
 
 
1,085.2
 
 
3,515.6
 
 
2.2
 
 
11,484.8
 
Residual maturity breakdown of
exposures class as of
December 31, 2016
(in millions of $)
Up to
12 months
1 - 5
years
More than
5 years
No specific
maturity
Total
Cash
 
63.7
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
63.7
 
Claims on Sovereigns
 
1,317.5
 
 
11.5
 
 
21.7
 
 
 
 
1,350.7
 
Claims on Public Sector Entities
 
 
 
81.1
 
 
23.9
 
 
 
 
105.0
 
Claims on Corporates
 
267.3
 
 
210.5
 
 
38.9
 
 
 
 
516.7
 
Claims on Banks and Securities firms
 
1,352.8
 
 
407.4
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,760.2
 
Securitizations
 
 
 
14.2
 
 
3,845.5
 
 
 
 
3,859.7
 
Retail loan
 
111.9
 
 
79.5
 
 
24.7
 
 
 
 
216.1
 
Residential Mortgages
 
150.9
 
 
506.7
 
 
1,634.1
 
 
 
 
2,291.7
 
Commercial Mortgages
 
43.6
 
 
251.0
 
 
277.4
 
 
 
 
572.0
 
Past Due Loans
 
4.7
 
 
2.6
 
 
41.0
 
 
 
 
48.3
 
Other Balance Sheet Exposures
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
257.7
 
 
257.7
 
Non-Market Related Off Balance Sheet Credit exposures
 
377.2
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
377.2
 
Market Related Off Balance Sheet Credit Exposures
 
65.8
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
65.8
 
 
 
3,755.4
 
 
1,564.5
 
 
5,907.2
 
 
257.7
 
 
11,484.8
 

The table below details the mappings between the main Fitch and Moody's external credit assessment institutions used by the Group and the credit quality steps used to determine the risk weightings applied to rated counterparties. Where no external rating is used in the risk weighted assets calculation, the unrated credit quality step applies.

Credit quality step
Fitch's
assessment
Moody's
assessment
S&P's
assessment
Step 1
AAA to AA–
Aaa to Aa3
AAA to AA–
Step 2
A+ to A–
A1 to A3
A+ to A–
Step 3
BBB+ to BBB–
Baa1 to Ba3
BBB+ to BBB–
Step 4
BB+ to BB–
Ba1 to Ba3
BB+ to BB–
Step 5
B+ to B–
B1 to B3
B+ to B–
Step 6
CCC+ and below
Caa1 and below
CCC+ and below

162

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Impairment Provisions

Credit Risk Concentrations

Concentration risk is defined as: any single exposure or group of exposures with the potential to produce losses large enough (relative to the Group's capital, total assets or overall risk level) to threaten the Group's health or ability to maintain core operations. The management of concentration risk is addressed in the first instance by the Group's large exposure policy and related credit guidelines, which require that credit facilities to entities that are affiliated through common ownership or management are aggregated for adjudication and reporting purposes. The policy also defines what constitutes a large exposure and the related reporting requirements. The GCRM function also undertakes monitoring and assessment of our exposure to concentration risk, reporting the results of these analyses to the GCC, the GRC and RPC.

The factors taken into consideration when assessing concentration risk are as follows:

single or linked counterparty;
industry or economic sector (e.g. hospitality, property development, commercial office building investment);
geographic region;
product type;
collateral type;
maturity date (whether of the facility or of interest rate fixes).

Counterparty Concentrations

Counterparty concentrations is the risk associated with assuming a high level of exposure to a single counterparty, the failure of which could have an adverse impact on the Group.

Large exposures are reviewed quarterly by the GRC and RPC for the loan portfolio and the treasury / investment portfolios. GCRM and Treasury work closely together on daily treasury positions and exceptions.

All large exposures and concentrations in the portfolio are reviewed and agreed by the FIC on a quarterly basis and are reported to the Board as a part of this process. The review of large exposures considers:

facility total;
any link with other facilities;
total linked facility being within guidelines;
borrower risk rating;
security value on the facility;
loan-to-value percentage against minimum security covenants.

Industry Concentration

Industry concentration encompasses the scenario that a risk factor inherent within an industry is tied to an entire portfolio of accounts or investments; e.g., a portfolio made up of a large number of small individual loans where all the counterparties are steel producers. We believe that due to the nature of the Group's client base our exposure to the property, insurance and fund sectors could be classified as industry concentration, although geographic and product concentration are the more appropriate risks to measure.

Geographic Concentration

Geographic concentration of the book is monitored as follows. Reports are generated which provide details of all the property loan exposure of the Group. Through this, loans are subdivided into regional

163

TABLE OF CONTENTS

exposure. From this, the percentage breakdown per region of the Group's property exposure is analyzed and reported to the GRC and RPC. Assessment of the exposure allows the committees to decide whether the Group should decline further lending in any area in which it is becoming over-weighted.

Product Concentration

Product concentration is defined in the context of credit risk, as an over-weighting in the portfolio to a given product type, making the Group vulnerable to the impact of a variety of external factors that could either reduce demand for the product itself or lead to an increase in the level of default rates experienced. We operate as a full service bank in Bermuda and Cayman and aim to satisfy the requirements of our customers in these communities through the range of products and services we offer. Accordingly, there is no dependence or concentration on a single product in these markets outside of the residential mortgage portfolios, which comprised 64.6% of the Group's loan book as of December 31, 2016 (compared to 63.0% as of December 31, 2015); in Bermuda, residential mortgage lending made up 62.0% of the Bermuda loan book as of December 31, 2016 (compared to 58.7% as of December 31, 2015), and loans for many purposes (education, business support, family requirements) were made in the form of residential mortgages. Product category analysis confirms that the total lending portfolio is concentrated in the property market; this has been addressed in stress testing performed.

Collateral Concentration

Collateral concentration considers whether the Group's loan book is secured by a limited number of collateral types. An example of this would be when a large value of loans to a diversified group of borrowers is all secured by shares in the same company or by the shares of various companies within the same industry sector. Any decline in the value of these shares or in the performance of the sector as a whole could have an adverse impact on the Group's security position across all affected borrowers. The most obvious and relevant example of collateral concentration is the Group's exposure to real estate property values. Ignoring cash-backed facilities, the largest collateral concentrations within the portfolio are to residential and commercial property. The greatest risk with collateral concentration is that the value of the security could be severely reduced. To simulate this, the Group's stress testing process incorporates a scenario in which all real estate collateral is devalued by factors as high as 30%.

Credit Risk Mitigation

The Group uses a wide range of techniques to reduce credit risk of its lending. The most basic of these is performing an assessment of the ability of a borrower to service the proposed level of borrowing without distress. However, the risk can be further mitigated by obtaining security for the funds advanced.

Residential Mortgages

Residential property is the Group's main source of collateral and means of mitigating credit risk inherent in the residential mortgage portfolio. All mortgage lending activities are supported by underlying assumptions and estimated values received by independent third parties. All residential property must be insured to cover property risks through a third party.

Commercial

Commercial property is one of the Group's primary sources of collateral and means of mitigating credit risk inherent in its commercial portfolios. Collateral for the majority of commercial loans comprises first legal charges over freehold or long leasehold property but the following may also be taken as security: life insurance policies, credit balances assignments, share guarantees, equitable charges, debentures, chattel mortgages and charges over residential property.

For property-based lending, supporting information such as professional valuations are an important tool to help determine the suitability of the property offered as security and, in the case of investment lending, generating the cash to cover interest and principal payments. All standard documentation is subject to in-house legal review and sign-off in order to ensure that the Group's legal documentation is

164

TABLE OF CONTENTS

robust and enforceable. Documentation for large advances may be specifically prepared by independent solicitors. Insurance requirements are always fully considered as part of the application process and the Group ensures that appropriate insurance is taken out to protect the property against an insurable event.

Treasury

Collateral held as security for treasury assets, including investments, is determined by the nature of the instrument. Loans, debt securities, treasury and other eligible bills are generally unsecured with the exception of asset-backed securities and similar instruments, which are secured by pools of financial assets. The International Swaps and Derivatives Association (“ISDA”) Master Agreement is the Group's preferred method of documenting derivative activity. It is common in such cases for a Credit Support Annex to be executed in conjunction with the ISDA Master Agreement in order to mitigate credit risk on the derivatives portfolio. Valuations are performed, agreed with the relevant counterparties, and collateral is exchanged to bring the credit exposure within agreed tolerances. The exposure value to the counterparty is measured under the counterparty credit risk mark-to-market method. The exposure value is derived by adding the gross positive fair value of the contract (replacement cost) to the contracts potential future credit exposure, which is derived by applying a multiple base on the contracts residual maturity to the notional value of the contract.

The following table shows the exposures to counterparty credit risk for derivative contracts as of December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015:

(in millions of $)
Gross
Positive
Fair Value of
Contracts
as of
December 31,
2016
Potential
Future
Credit
Exposure
as of
December 31,
2016
Total
Derivatives
Credit
Exposure
as of
December 31,
2016
Gross
Positive
Fair Value of
Contracts
as of
December 31,
2015
Potential
Future
Credit
Exposure
as of
December 31,
2015
Total
Derivatives
Credit
Exposure
as of
December 31,
2015
Spot and forward foreign exchange and currency swap contracts
 
37.1
 
 
28.7
 
 
65.8
 
 
20.8
 
 
30.4
 
 
51.2
 
Other market related contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total
 
37.1
 
 
28.7
 
 
65.8
 
 
20.8
 
 
30.4
 
 
51.2
 

Securitizations

The Bank has not, to date, securitized assets that it has originated. The Bank's total exposure to purchased securitization positions as of December 31, 2016 was $3.9 billion by market value, with US Government and federal agencies accounting for the majority of this exposure.

The following table provides an analysis of the Bank's investments in securitization positions by exposure type as of December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015:

Underlying asset type
(in millions of $)
Exposure Value
as of
December 31,
2016
Exposure Value
as of
December 31,
2015
US government and federal agencies
 
3,498.0
 
 
2,365.5
 
Mortgage backed securities — Commercial
 
151.0
 
 
149.1
 
Mortgage backed securities — Retail
 
198.3
 
 
100.5
 
Asset-backed securities — Student loans
 
12.5
 
 
40.5
 
Total
 
3,859.8
 
 
2,655.6
 

A combination of ratings published by Fitch, Moody's and S&P are used to derive the external rating to be used under the standardized approach for securitization exposures. In line with the BMA's revised framework for regulatory capital assessment, where two credit assessments by Fitch and Moody's as external credit assessment institutions are available, the less favorable of the two credit assessments is applied. Where more than two credit assessments are available, the two most favorable credit assessments are used and where the two most favorable assessments are different, the less favorable of the two is applied.

165

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The following table shows the aggregate amount of the Bank's purchased securitizations as of December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015 broken down by risk weighting:

Risk Weight %
(in millions of $)
Exposure
Value
as of
December 31,
2016
Exposure
Value after
Credit Risk
Mitigation
as of
December 31,
2016
Exposure
Value
as of
December 31,
2015
Exposure
Value after
Credit Risk
Mitigation
as of
December 31,
2015
20%
 
3,859.0
 
 
2,669.9
 
 
2,654.9
 
 
1,953.1
 
50%
 
0.7
 
 
0.7
 
 
0.7
 
 
0.7
 
100%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
350%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Look through to underlying assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total
 
3,859.7
 
 
2,670.6
 
 
2,655.6
 
 
1,953.8
 

Operational Risk

In providing our services, we are exposed to operational risk. This is the risk of loss from inadequate or failed internal processes and systems, actions or inactions of people, or from external events. Operational risk is mitigated through internal controls embedded in our business activities and our risk management practices, which are designed to continuously reassess the effectiveness of these controls in order to keep the risk we assume at levels appropriate to our risk appetite as approved by the Board. Data on operational losses and any significant control failures incurred are captured through an incident reporting process. These events are reported to both the GRC and RPC, which assess the sufficiency of the corrective actions taken by management to prevent recurrence. Both committees also receive regular reporting on actual performance against established risk tolerance metrics.

Capital Adequacy Management

Effective January 1, 2015, the BMA adopted capital and liquidity requirements consistent with Basel III. The finalization of the implementation is subject to ongoing consultation with the BMA regarding the implementation and interpretation of these new rules.

One of management's primary objectives is to maintain the confidence of our clients, bank regulators and shareholders. A strong capital position helps the Group to take advantage of profitable investment opportunities and withstand unforeseen adverse developments. The Group manages its capital both on a total Group basis and, where appropriate, on a legal entity basis. The finance department has the responsibility for measuring, monitoring and reporting capital levels within guidelines and limits established by the RPC. The management of capital will also involve regional management to ensure compliance with local regulation. In establishing the guidelines and limits for capital, a variety of factors are taken into consideration, including the overall risk of the business in stressed scenarios, regulatory requirements, capital levels relative to our peers, and the impact on our credit ratings.

Capital Assessment and Risk Profiling

Under the requirements of Basel II as implemented by the BMA, the Group undertakes a CARP process, which is an internal assessment of all material risks to determine our capital needs. This internal assessment takes account of the minimum capital requirement and other risks not covered by the minimum capital requirement (Pillar II). Where capital is deemed as not being able to mitigate a particular risk, alternative management actions are identified and described within the CARP. The CARP is presented to the RPC before being presented to the Board for challenge and approval and then submission to the BMA. The CARP process is performed annually or more frequently should the need arise.

A supervisory assessment process (“SAP”) is then undertaken annually by the BMA, which is designed to assess the Group's risk profile as documented in the CARP. This assessment is used to determine and set the Individual Capital Guidance which is the minimum level of capital the Group will be required to hold until the next SAP review is conducted.

166

TABLE OF CONTENTS

SUPERVISION AND REGULATION

Bermuda

The Bank is subject to regulation and supervision by the Bermuda Monetary Authority under:

the Bermuda Monetary Authority Act 1969;
the Banks and Deposit Companies Act 1999;
the Trusts (Regulation of Trust Business) Act 2001;
the Investment Business Act 2003;
the Exchange Control Regulations 1973;
the Bermuda Corporate Services Provider Business Act 2012; and
the Deposit Insurance Act 2011 and the Deposit Insurance Rules 2016.

The Bank is also subject to regulation by the Minister of Finance and the Minister of Economic Development in Bermuda under the Companies Act 1981.

Supervision and Monitoring by the BMA

Our activities are regulated by the BMA and our ability to engage in certain activities are subject to prior approval by the BMA. One of the principal objectives of the BMA is to supervise, regulate and inspect financial institutions which operate in or from within Bermuda and further to promote the financial stability and soundness of such financial institutions. The supervision is primarily for the benefit and protection of the Bank's clients and not for the benefit of our investors. The BMA is also responsible for managing and regulating transactions in foreign currency or gold.

In addition to conducting on-site reviews, the BMA utilizes a comprehensive quarterly statistical return system that enables off-site monitoring of institutions licensed under the BDCA. The statistical system, which follows the standards imposed on banks in the United Kingdom by the Financial Conduct Authority and is consistent with Basel Committee Standards, provides the BMA with a detailed breakdown of a bank's balance sheet and profit-and-loss accounts on both a consolidated and unconsolidated basis. This information enables the BMA to monitor the soundness of a bank's financial position and ensure that it meets certain capital requirements.

As the Bank's supervisory authority in Bermuda, the BMA is responsible for the consolidated supervision of our worldwide operations. There are also host regulatory bodies performing a similar function to that of the BMA in all major locations in which the Bank operates. Many of these local authorities require detailed reporting on the activities of the Bank's subsidiaries located in their jurisdictions. As part of its oversight process, the BMA receives copies of each of these reports on a regular basis and liaises with the regulatory authorities in the respective locations.

From time to time, in the ordinary course of business, the Bank enters into agreements with the BMA under which the Bank agrees to achieve or maintain certain levels of capital and to obtain the BMA's prior approval to take certain corporate actions. Certain actions that may not be taken without prior BMA approval include: (1) paying any dividends on the common shares, (2) creating or increasing the authorized amount of, or issuance of, common shares, (3) repurchasing common shares and (4) entering into a material acquisition.

Under the market disclosure requirements (referred to as Pillar III disclosures) applicable under both Basel II and the Basel II Accord (“Basel III”), the Bank is required to publish information about the risks to which it is exposed. Effective as of January 1, 2015, the BMA adopted capital and liquidity regulatory requirements consistent with Basel III, a framework released by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision. Basel III aims to raise the quality, consistency and transparency of the capital base, limit the build-up of excess leverage and increase capital requirements for the banking sector. Basel III adopts CET1 capital as the predominant form of regulatory capital with the CET1 ratio as a new metric. Basel III also adopts the new LCR regimes.

167

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Basel III regulatory framework adopts a phased implementation approach for Bermuda banks with full implementation on January 1, 2019, consistent with BCBS recommendations. When fully phased-in, the Bank will be subject to the following requirements:

adopted CET1 as the primary and predominant form of regulatory capital, with a requirement of CET1 of at least 7.0% of RWA, inclusive of a minimum CET1 ratio of 4.5% and the new capital conservation buffer of 2.5%. The BMA has allowed Bermuda banks to make the one-time irrevocable election to exclude Other Comprehensive Income on its Available-for-sale portfolio from CET1;
adopted a Tier 1 capital requirement of at least 8.5% of RWA, inclusive of the 2.5% capital conservation buffer and Total capital requirement of at least 10.5% of RWA, inclusive of the 2.5% capital conservation buffer;
the Bank is considered to be a D-SIB and will be subject to a 3% surcharge composed of CET1-eligible capital implemented by the BMA effective 30 September 2015. This is based upon its assessment of the extent to which the Bank (individually and collectively with the other Bermuda banks) poses a degree of material systemic risk to the economy of Bermuda due to its role in deposit taking, corporate lending, payment systems and other core economic functions;
provided for the inclusion of a countercyclical buffer to be introduced when macro-economic indicators provide an assessment of excessive credit or other pressures building in the banking sector;
provided that it will assess the extent to which Bermuda's banks pose a degree of material systemic risk to Bermuda's economy, applying a capital surcharge buffer (as a percentage of RWA and composed of CET1 eligible capital) between 0.5% and 3.0% on those banks designated to be a domestic systemically important bank, depending on the extent of systemic risk posed by such bank;
adopted the introduction of a 5% leverage ratio as calculated in Basel III; and
adopted the liquidity coverage ratio implementation timetable consistent with that published by Basel III, with a minimum requirement of 60%, rising in equal annual steps to 100% by January 1, 2019.

Bermuda Monetary Authority Act 1969

The Bermuda Monetary Authority Act 1969 established the Bermuda Monetary Authority as a statutory corporate body responsible for, among other things, supervising, regulating and inspecting any financial institution which operates in or from within Bermuda (which includes the Bank). Specific areas of financial regulation, such as the banking industry, are also the subject of separate, specific legislation (some of which is discussed below), but this specific legislation is nevertheless administered by the BMA in its supervisory capacity. In addition to its supervisory functions, both under the Bermuda Monetary Authority Act 1969 and the specific legislation discussed below, the BMA is empowered to assist foreign regulatory bodies by requiring entities supervised and regulated by the BMA to furnish information on demand to the BMA in connection with foreign regulatory requests.

Banks and Deposit Companies Act 1999

The BDCA prohibits any person from carrying on a deposit-taking business in or from within Bermuda unless that person is a company incorporated in Bermuda and licensed by the BMA under the BDCA. The BDCA provides for two classes of licenses: banking licenses and deposit company licenses. The Bank holds a banking license and a deposit company license. Unless otherwise permitted by the BMA, a company that holds a banking license must provide a range of minimum services to the public in Bermuda, including (without limitation) current accounts in Bermuda dollars, other deposit accounts, loan facilities in Bermuda Dollars, foreign exchange services and credit card or debit card facilities. A company holding a deposit company license typically offers a small range of services but, unless otherwise permitted by the BMA, must also provide some specified services to the public in Bermuda, including (without limitation) savings, deposit or other similar accounts in Bermuda Dollars and loans in Bermuda Dollars secured on mortgages of real property in Bermuda.

168

TABLE OF CONTENTS

As the agency responsible for administering the BDCA, regulating deposit-taking businesses and protecting depositors, the BMA has broad authority to compel companies licensed under the BDCA to take or cease specific actions and comply with informational or access requests. Under the BDCA, the BMA can, or can compel these companies, including us to, among other things, do any or all of the following:

provide such information as the BMA may reasonably require;
submit a report prepared by the Bank's auditors or by an accountant or other person with professional skills on any matter about which the BMA could require us to provide information;
produce documentation or other information as the BMA may reasonably require; and
permit any officer, servant or agent of the BMA, on producing evidence of his authority, to enter the Bank's premises to obtain information and documents.

In addition, the BMA has the power to do any or all of the following:

examine, copy or retain any documents relating to the Bank's deposit-taking business;
require the Bank to take certain steps or to refrain from adopting or pursuing a particular course of action or to restrict the scope of the Bank's business in a particular way;
appoint competent persons to investigate and report to the BMA on the Bank's business or the Bank's ownership and control;
restrict the scope of a license or revoke a license; and
vary, suspend or revoke the Bank's banking license and to give directions if it feels these are necessary to protect the Bank's depositors.

The Bank's failure to comply with any of the statutory requirements set forth in the BDCA could result in civil or criminal penalties.

The Bank is required to report certain transactions to the BMA. These include any transaction or transactions relating to any one person as a result of which the Bank would be exposed to a risk of incurring losses in excess of 10% of the Bank's available capital resources, or where the Bank proposes to enter into a transaction or transactions relating to any one person, which, either alone or together with previous transactions entered into by the Bank in relation to the same person, would result in the Bank being exposed to the risk of incurring losses in excess of 25% of its available capital resources. This also applies where the transaction relates to different persons if they are connected in such a way that the financial soundness of any of them may affect the financial soundness of the others or the same factors may affect the financial soundness of both or all of them. The BMA may extend the scope of this requirement to the Bank's subsidiaries even if these subsidiaries are not licensed under the BDCA as if the transactions and available capital resources of the Bank's subsidiaries were included in the Bank's available capital resources. For the purpose of the foregoing, the transactions which must be reported by the Bank to the BMA are those between the Bank and a person where:

(a)that person incurs an obligation to the Bank or as a result of which such person may incur such an obligation;
(b)the Bank will incur, or as a result of which it may incur, an obligation in the event of that person defaulting on an obligation to a third party; or
(c)the Bank acquires or incurs any obligation to acquire, or as a result of which it may incur an obligation to acquire, an asset the value of which depends wholly or mainly on that person performing their obligations or otherwise on his financial soundness

and the risk of loss attributable to a transaction is, in a case within paragraph (a) or (b), the risk of the person concerned defaulting on the obligation there mentioned and, in a case within paragraph (c), the

169

TABLE OF CONTENTS

risk of the person concerned defaulting on the obligations there mentioned or of a deterioration in such person's financial soundness. The Bank's available capital resources may be determined by the BMA after consultation with it and in accordance with principles published by the BMA. It is an offense for the Bank to fail to make the required reports.

Under the BDCA, any person who becomes a significant shareholder of a deposit-taking institution, which is defined to include persons, either individually or with associates, who (i) hold 5% or more of the shares in the institution or another company of which it is a subsidiary company; or (ii) is entitled to exercise, or control the exercise of 5% or more of the voting power at any general meeting of the institution or of another company of which it is such a subsidiary, must notify the BMA in writing of that fact within seven days. Failure to provide the BMA with prompt and appropriate notice would constitute an offense that could result in a fine.

The BDCA prohibits a person from becoming a shareholder controller of any company licensed under the BDCA unless the person provides written notice to the BMA of his intent to do so and the BMA does not object. The definition of shareholder controller is set out in the BDCA but generally refers to a person who, among other things, either alone or with any associate or associates (within the meaning of the BDCA) (i) holds 10% or more of the shares in the licensed institution or another company of which it is a subsidiary company; or (ii) is entitled to exercise, or control the exercise of 10% or more of the voting power at any general meeting of the licensed institution or another company of which it is such a subsidiary. The BDCA distinguishes between shareholder controllers of the following threshold descriptions: “10% shareholder controllers,” “20% shareholder controllers,” “30% shareholder controllers,” “40% shareholder controllers,” “50% shareholder controllers,” “60% shareholder controllers” and “principal shareholder controllers” who have a 75% or greater interest. A person who intends to become a shareholder controller, or a shareholder controller who intends to increase his shareholding/control, meaning generally, ownership of shares or the ability to exercise or control the exercise of voting rights attached to shares, beyond his present threshold, must provide written notice to the BMA that he intends to do so. It is an offense not to give this notice. The BMA may object to a person's notice of intent to become a shareholder controller of any description or to an existing shareholder controller where it appears to the BMA that, among other things, such person is not or is no longer a fit and proper person to be such controller of the institution. If the BMA objects, the BMA will provide such person with written notice of its objection.

Prior to serving a notice of objection, the BMA serves the person seeking to become a shareholder of any description or serves an existing shareholder controller with a preliminary written notice stating that the BMA is considering service on that person of a notice of objection, stating, among other things, the reasons for the BMA's proposed objection. The statement of the BMA's reasons for their proposed objection will, however, be subject to the BMA's determination that such statement would involve the disclosure of confidential information, the disclosure of which would be prejudicial to a third party. A person served with a preliminary written notice may, within a period of 28 days beginning with the day on which the notice is served, make written representations to the BMA and the BMA shall take any such representations into account in deciding whether to serve a notice of objection.

If three months pass from the date of giving the notice to the BMA without the BMA serving a notice of objection, then the person may become a shareholder controller as requested in the notice. In practice, the BMA's procedure is generally to respond to a person's shareholder controller notification.

If a person becomes a shareholder controller or increases his shareholding/control in spite of the BMA's objection thereto, if a shareholder controller fails to comply with the foregoing notice requirements or if a shareholder controller continues as such after being given notice of objection to his or her being a shareholder controller, the BMA may take the actions specified in the BDCA, including revoking the relevant license where a 50%, 60% or principal shareholder controller is involved, or mandating that any specified shares become subject to one or more of the following restrictions:

any transfer of or agreement to transfer those shares or, in the case of unissued shares, any transfer of or any agreement to transfer the right to be issued with them, will be void;
no voting rights may be exercisable in respect of the shares;

170

TABLE OF CONTENTS

no further shares may be issued in right of them or pursuant to any offer made to their holder; or
except in liquidation, no payment may be made of any sums due from the deposit-taking institution on the shares, whether in respect of capital or otherwise.

A court in Bermuda may, on the application of the BMA, order the sale of any such shares. Any person may appeal to a tribunal constituted under the BDCA for a review of a notice of objection given by the BMA as described above. However, this right of appeal does not apply to a person in any case in which such person has failed to give a notice or become or continued to be a controller in contravention of the BDCA. In addition, if a person has had its license revoked or has been subject to any of the restrictions set forth above, the tribunal may confirm or reverse the decision which is the subject of the appeal but shall not have power to vary it except:

where the decision was made to impose or vary any restriction, the tribunal may direct the BMA to impose different restrictions or to vary them in a different way; or
where the decision was to revoke a license, the tribunal may direct the BMA to restrict it instead.

In the event that the BMA imposes any of the restrictions listed above, the restrictions may apply to:

all shares of the deposit-taking institution where the person in question is a shareholder controller that (i) are held by him or any associate of his, and (ii) were not so held immediately before he became such shareholder controller of the institution; and
all shares in another company where the person in question became a shareholder controller (i) as a result of the acquisition by him or any associate of his of shares in such other company, and (ii) the shares were not so held before he became a shareholder controller of such institution.

A company licensed under the BDCA must give written notice to the BMA in the event that any person has either become or ceased to be a director, controller or senior executive of such licensed company. The written notice is required to be given to the BMA within 14 days beginning with the day on which the licensed company becomes aware of the relevant change in director, controller or senior executive. The definition of “controller” is set out in the BDCA but generally refers to (i) a shareholder controller, a managing director or chief executive officer of the deposit-taking institution or of another company of which it is a subsidiary, or (ii) a person whose duties include directing the actions of the board of directors of the licensed company or of another company of which it is a subsidiary, or (iii) a person whose duties include directing the actions of any shareholder controller of the deposit-taking institution.

Trusts (Regulation of Trust Business) Act 2001

The principal purpose of the Trusts (Regulation of Trust Business) Act 2001 (the “Trusts Business Act”), which came into effect on January 25, 2002, is to regulate “trust business,” which is generally defined as providing the services of a trustee as a business, trade, profession or vocation. Under the Trusts Business Act, a license is required to conduct trust business in or from within Bermuda. Licenses are designated either “unlimited” or “limited.” Only bodies corporate are entitled to obtain unlimited licenses, which allow them to conduct trust business and solicit business from the public generally. At present, the Bank and certain of its subsidiaries hold unlimited licenses issued by the BMA pursuant to the Trusts Business Act. Pursuant to Section 6 of the Trusts Business Act, the BMA has published a Statement of Principles, in accordance with which it is acting or purporting to act with respect to the exercise of its powers under the Trusts Business Act, including (without limitation) the BMA's minimum licensing criteria, the grounds for revocation of licenses, the power to grant, revoke or restrict a license and the power to obtain information or require the production of documents. In addition, pursuant to Section 7 of the legislation, the BMA published a Code of Practice that provides guidance as to the duties, requirements, procedures, standards and principles to be observed by persons carrying on trust business under the Trusts Business Act.

The BMA's powers under the Trusts Business Act include (without limitation) the power to:

impose conditions on a license with respect to scope and type of business, to protect a client or potential client of a licensee;

171

TABLE OF CONTENTS

revoke a license in certain circumstances including if the licensee has not complied with the licensing criteria; and
request and obtain information from a licensee to ensure compliance with the Trusts Business Act, and to safeguard the interests of the licensee's clients.

The Trusts Business Act prohibits a person from becoming a 10% shareholder controller or a majority shareholder controller of a licensed company, unless such person provides written notice to the BMA of his intent to do so and the BMA does not object. It is an offense not to provide this notice. The definition of shareholder controller is set out in the Trusts Business Act, but generally refers to a person who, among other things, either alone or with any associate or associates (within the meaning of the Trusts Business Act) (i) holds 10% or more of the shares in the licensed company or another company of which it is a subsidiary company; or (ii) is entitled to exercise, or control the exercise of 10% or more of the voting power at any general meeting of the licensed company or another company of which it is such a subsidiary. A “majority shareholder controller” is defined under the Trusts Business Act as a shareholder controller which, among other things, (i) holds 50% or more of the issued and outstanding shares in the licensed company; (ii) is entitled to exercise, or control the exercise of 50% or more of the voting power at any general meeting of the licensed company.The BMA may object to a person's notice of intent to become a 10% shareholder controller or majority shareholder controller or may object to an existing shareholder controller of any description where it appears to the BMA that, among other things, such person is not or is no longer a fit and proper person to be such a controller of the licensed company. If the BMA objects, the BMA will provide such person with a written notice of objection. Prior to serving any such notice of objection, the BMA serves the person seeking to become a shareholder controller or serves an existing shareholder controller with a preliminary written notice stating that the BMA is considering service on that person of a notice of objection, stating, among other things, the reasons for the BMA's proposed objection. The statement of the BMA's reasons for their proposed objection will, however, be subject to the BMA's determination that such statement would involve the disclosure of confidential information, the disclosure of which would be prejudicial to a third party. A person served with a preliminary written notice may, within a period of 28 days beginning with the day on which the notice is served, make written representations to the BMA and the BMA shall take any such representations into account in deciding whether to serve a notice of objection.

If three months pass from the date of notifying the BMA of a new shareholder controller or an increased shareholder/controller beyond a shareholder controller's then current threshold, without the BMA serving a notice of objection, then the person may become a shareholder controller as requested in the notice. In practice, the BMA's procedure is generally to respond to a person's shareholder controller notification.

If a person becomes a shareholder controller in spite of the BMA's objection thereto, if a shareholder controller fails to comply with the foregoing notice requirements or if a shareholder controller continues as such after being given notice of objection to his or her being a shareholder controller, the BMA may take certain actions, including mandating that any specified shares become subject to one or more of the following restrictions:

any transfer of or agreement to transfer those shares or, in the case of unissued shares, any transfer of or any agreement to transfer the right to be issued with them, will be void;
no voting rights may be exercisable in respect of the shares;
no further shares may be issued in right of them or pursuant to any offer made to their holder; or
except in liquidation, no payment may be made of any sums due from the licensed company on the shares, whether in respect of capital or otherwise.

A court in Bermuda may, on the application of the BMA, order the sale of any such shares. Any person may appeal to a tribunal constituted under the Trusts Business Act for a review of a notice of objection given by the BMA as described above. However, this right of appeal does not apply to a person in any case in which such person has failed to give a notice or become or continued to be a controller in

172

TABLE OF CONTENTS

contravention of the Trusts Business Act. In addition, if a person has had its license revoked or has been subject to any of the restrictions set forth above, the tribunal may confirm or reverse the decision which is the subject of the appeal but shall not have power to vary it except:

where the decision was made to impose or vary any restriction, the tribunal may direct the BMA to impose different restrictions; or
where the decision was to revoke a license, the tribunal may direct the BMA to restrict it instead.

In the event that the BMA imposes any of the restrictions listed above, the restrictions may apply to:

all shares of the licensed company of which the person in question is a shareholder controller that (i) are held by him or any associate of his, and (ii) were not so held immediately before he became such shareholder controller of the licensed company; and
all shares in another company where the person in question became a shareholder controller (i) as a result of the acquisition by him or any associate of his of shares in such other company, and (ii) the shares were not so held before he became a shareholder controller of such licensed company.

A company licensed under the Trusts Business Act must give written notice to the BMA in the event that any person has either become or ceased to be a controller or officer of such licensed company. The written notice is required to be given to the BMA within 14 days beginning with the day on which the licensed company becomes aware of the change in controller or officer. The definition of “controller” is set out in the Trusts Business Act but generally refers to (i) a shareholder controller, a managing director or chief executive officer of the licensed company or of another company of which it is a subsidiary, or (ii) a person whose duties include directing the actions of the board of directors of the licensed company or of another company of which it is a subsidiary, or (iii) a person whose duties include directing the actions of any shareholder controller of the licensed company. The definition of “officer” under the Trusts Business Act includes a director, secretary or any senior executive.

Investment Business Act 2003

The Investment Business Act 2003 (the “Investment Business Act”) prohibits any person from carrying on, or purporting to carry on, an investment business in or from within Bermuda unless that person holds a license granted under the Investment Business Act, or is exempted from holding a license. The Investment Business Act defines “investment business” broadly as the business of dealing in investments, arranging deals in investments, managing or offering investments and giving advice on investments.

Under the Investment Business Act, the BMA is given the authority to grant licenses and to supervise license holders. The BMA will only grant a license if it is satisfied that the applicant complies with licensing criteria set out in the Investment Business Act, which include (without limitation) that controllers and senior executives of the applicant are fit and proper persons to carry on such business, the applicant company's business is effectively directed by at least two individuals (unless the BMA otherwise approves), the Board of the applicant has a number of independent directors considered appropriate by the BMA, the applicant's business is conducted in a prudent manner, the position of the applicant in the group does not obstruct effective consolidated supervision and the applicant will carry on the investment business with integrity and professional skill appropriate to the nature and scale of its activities.

At the present time, the Bank's wholly owned subsidiaries Butterfield Trust (Bermuda) Limited, Butterfield Securities (Bermuda) Limited and Butterfield Asset Management Limited hold licenses under the Investment Business Act.

Under the Investment Business Act, the BMA may require an accountant's report on a license holder, to appoint an inspector to carry out an investigation into the affairs of a license holder and to demand the production of documents or information relating to the investment business of a license holder. The Investment Business Act also grants the BMA broad powers to enforce the provisions of the Investment Business Act, including (without limitation) powers to issue directions, to vary, suspend or cancel a license, to appoint a custodian manager of an offending investment business, to levy fines and to seek from the court injunctions and restitution orders. If the BMA considers that an investment provider

173

TABLE OF CONTENTS

knowingly and willfully has breached any condition imposed on its license, the licensing criteria or any other duty or obligation under the Investment Business Act, or has been carrying on investment business in a manner detrimental to the interest of its clients and creditors, or contrary to the public's interests, the BMA may issue a direction of compliance, vary, suspend or cancel the license of the investment provider, appoint a custodian manager to manage the investment business, impose civil penalties, or publicly censure an investment provider.

The Investment Business Act prohibits a person from becoming a 10% shareholder controller or a majority shareholder controller of an investment provider, unless such person provides written notice to the BMA of his intent to do so and the BMA does not object. It is an offense not to provide this notice. The definition of 10% shareholder controller is set out in the Investment Business Act, but generally refers to a person who, among other things, either alone or with any associate or associates (within the meaning of the Investment Business Act) (i) holds 10% or more of the shares in the investment provider or its parent undertaking; or (ii) is entitled to exercise, or control the exercise of 10% or more of the voting power in the investment provider or in the parent undertaking. A “majority shareholder controller” is defined under the Investment Business Act as a shareholder controller which (i) holds 50% or more of the issued and outstanding shares in the investment provider or its parent undertaking; or (ii) is entitled to exercise, or control the exercise of 50% or more of the voting power in the investment provider or in the parent undertaking.

The BMA may object to a person's notice of intent to become a 10% shareholder controller or majority shareholder controller or to an existing shareholder controller of any description where it appears to the BMA that, among other things, such person is not or is no longer a fit and proper person to be such controller of the licensed company. If the BMA objects, the BMA will provide such person with a written notice of objection. Prior to serving any such notice of objection, the BMA serves the person seeking to become a shareholder controller or will serve an existing shareholder controller with a preliminary written notice stating that the BMA is considering service on that person of a notice of objection, stating, among other things, the reasons for the BMA's proposed objection. The statement of the BMA's reasons for their proposed objection will, however, be subject to the BMA's determination that such statement would involve the disclosure of confidential information, the disclosure of which would be prejudicial to a third party. A person served with a preliminary written notice may, within a period of 28 days beginning with the day on which the notice is served, make written representations to the BMA and the BMA shall take any such representations into account in deciding whether to serve a notice of objection.

If three months pass from the date of notifying the BMA of a new shareholder controller or an increased shareholding/control beyond a shareholder controller's then current threshold, without the BMA serving a notice of objection, then the person may become a shareholder controller as requested in the notice. In practice, the BMA's procedure is generally to respond to a person's shareholder controller notification.

If a person becomes a shareholder controller in spite of the BMA's objection to his or her becoming a shareholder controller or if a shareholder controller fails to comply with the foregoing notice requirements or if a shareholder controller continues as such after being given notice of objection to his or her being a shareholder controller, the BMA may take certain actions, including mandating that any specified shares become subject to one or more of the following restrictions:

any transfer of or agreement to transfer those shares or, in the case of unissued shares, any transfer of or any agreement to transfer the right to be issued with them, will be void;
no voting rights may be exercisable in respect of the shares;
no further shares may be issued in right of them or pursuant to any offer made to their holder; or
except in liquidation, no payment may be made of any sums due from the investment provider on the shares, whether in respect of capital or otherwise.

A court in Bermuda may, on the application of the BMA, order the sale of any such shares. Any person may appeal to a tribunal constituted under the Investment Business Act for a review of a notice of objection given by the BMA as described above. However, this right of appeal does not apply to a person in any case in which such person has failed to give a notice or become or continued to be a controller in

174

TABLE OF CONTENTS

contravention of the Investment Business Act. In addition, if a person has had its license revoked or has been subject to any of the restrictions set forth above, the tribunal may confirm or reverse the decision which is the subject of the appeal but shall not have power to vary it except:

where the decision was made to impose or vary any restriction, the tribunal may direct the BMA to impose different restrictions or to vary them in a different way; or
where the decision was to revoke a license, the tribunal may direct the BMA to restrict it instead.

In the event that the BMA imposes any of the restrictions listed above, the restrictions may apply to:

all shares of the investment provider of which the person in question is a shareholder controller that (i) are held by him or any associate of his, and (ii) were not so held immediately before he became such shareholder controller of the investment provider; and
all shares in another company where the person in question became a shareholder controller (i) as a result of the acquisition by him or any associate of his of shares in such other company, and (ii) the shares were not so held before he became a shareholder controller of such investment provider.

A company licensed under the Investment Business Act must give written notice to the BMA in the event that any person has either become or ceased to be a controller or officer of such investment provider. The written notice is required to be given to the BMA within 14 days beginning with the day on which the investment provider becomes aware of the change in controller or officer. The definition of “controller” is set out in the Investment Business Act but generally refers to a shareholder controller, a managing director or chief executive officer of the investment provider or of another company of which it is a subsidiary, or a person whose duties include directing the actions of any shareholder controller of the investment provider. The definition of “officer” under the Investment Business Act includes a director, secretary or any senior executive.

Bermuda Corporate Service Provider Business Act 2012

The Bermuda Corporate Service Provider Business Act 2012 (“BCSPB”) regulates persons carrying on a corporate service provider business in Bermuda. “Corporate service provider business” in this context means the provision of any of the following services for a profit: (i) acting as a company formation agent; (b) providing nominee services, including (against other things) providing nominee shareholders; (c) providing administrative and secretarial services to companies or partnerships (including, among other things, providing a registered office and maintaining the books and records of a company or partnership); (d) performing functions in the capacity as a resident representative under various Bermuda statutes ; and (e) providing any other corporate or administrative services as may be specified in regulations made under the BCSPB. Under the BCSPB, the Bank or any of its subsidiaries are required to hold a corporate service provider license to lawfully provide corporate services to our customers in Bermuda, although a transitional period is currently in effect pending the determination of the initial round of corporate service provider license applications. Licensing under the BCSPB is administered by the BMA.

Pursuant to the provisions of the BCSPB any person who, together with their associates (within the meaning of the BCSPB), intends to become either a shareholder controller or a majority shareholder controller of a BCSPB licensed entity, must first serve notice of their intent to do so on the BMA and either receive a notice of non-objection from the BMA, or wait for the expiration of a three month period starting from the date of the notice to the BMA without the BMA having served a written notice of objection. A “shareholder controller” under the BCSPB is any person who, either alone or with any associate or associates, (i) holds 10% or more of shares of the licensed entity (if it is a company) or 10 % or more of another company of which the licensed entity is a subsidiary; (ii) is entitled to control or control the exercise of 10% or more of the voting power at any general meeting of the licensed entity (if it is a company) or of another company of which the licensed entity is a subsidiary; or (iii) is able to exercise a significant influence over the management of a licensed entity or of another company of which the licensed entity is a subsidiary by virtue of holding shares in or an entitlement to exercise or control the

175

TABLE OF CONTENTS

exercise of the voting power at any general meeting of either the licensed entity (if it is a company) or its holding company. A “majority shareholder controller” under the BCSPB has the same meaning as limbs (i) and (ii) in the preceding sentence, save that the relevant percentage threshold for ownership is 50% or more.

In addition to the requirement to notify and obtain BMA non-objection (whether express or deemed) of any change in shareholder controller or majority shareholder controller of a BCSPB licensed entity, if at any time it appears to the BMA that a person who is a “controller” of any description of a BCSPB licensed entity is not a fit and proper person for such role, the BMA may serve a written notice of objection to that controller; provided that, before serving such a notice, the BMA must serve that person with a preliminary written notice stating that the BMA is considering service on that person of a notice of objection, specifying the reasons for which it appears to the BMA why that person is not or is no longer a fit and proper person and advising as to the rights of that person to make written representations to the Authority within 28 days beginning on the day on which such notice is served, and that such written representations shall be taken into account by the Authority in deciding whether to serve a notice of objection. For these purposes a “controller” includes (i) a managing director of a licensed entity or the licensed entity’s holding company; (ii) the CEO of the licensed entity or the licensed entity’s holding company; and (iii) a person in accordance with whose directions or instruction the directors of the licensed entity (or its holding company) are accustomed to act. Upon determining that any individual is not a fit and proper person, the BMA may pass a prohibition order, thereby preventing that individual from exercising any functions in connection with any business requiring licensing under the BCSPB. Furthermore, under the BCSPB, a licensed entity is required to give written notice to the BMA of any person becoming or ceasing to be a controller or an “officer” (director, company secretary or senior executive) of the licensed entity.

Breaches of the BCSPB are punishable by a range of criminal and civil penalties including fines, imprisonment and public censure; breaches can result in the licensed entity losing its license and therefore its ability to conduct corporate service provider business. The BMA is also empowered to restrict a controller’s ability to sell any shares (and exercise any rights in respect of such shares) held by the controller in a BCSPB licensed entity if they continue to be or become a controller following a confirmed notice of objection from the BMA.

Companies Act 1981

As a local company incorporated in Bermuda, the Bank is subject to the Companies Act 1981 (the “Companies Act”). Under section 114 of the Companies Act, no local company may carry on business of any sort in Bermuda unless, among other things, (i) it complies with the control and ownership requirements set out in Part I of the Third Schedule of the Companies Act; (ii) it is licensed under section 114B of the Companies Act and is carrying on such business in accordance with the terms and conditions imposed in such license; or (iii) its shares are listed on a designated stock exchange and the company is engaged as a business in a material way in a prescribed industry pursuant to section 114(1)(e) of the Companies Act.

In December 2000, the Minister of Finance issued to the Bank a license pursuant to section 114B of the Companies Act allowing the Bank to carry on business in Bermuda without complying with certain provisions of the Third Schedule to the Companies Act. Effective June 10, 2016, the Bank relinquished its section 114B license and carries on business in Bermuda without complying with the provisions of the Third Schedule in reliance upon the exemption in section 114(1)(e) of the Companies Act. The Bank qualifies for this statutory exemption by virtue of (i) the listing of the Bank's shares on the BSX, which is a “designated stock exchange” for the purposes of the Companies Act and (ii) the Bank's material business of banking, which is a “prescribed industry” for the purposes of the Companies Act.

Exchange Control

The Bank is designated as resident in Bermuda for exchange control purposes.

The BMA has given its consent for the issue and free transferability of all of the common shares that are the subject of this offering to and between non-residents of Bermuda for exchange control purposes, provided the Bank's shares remain listed on an appointed stock exchange, which includes the NYSE. Approvals or permissions given by the BMA do not constitute a guarantee by the BMA as to our

176

TABLE OF CONTENTS

performance or our creditworthiness. Accordingly, in giving such consent or permissions, the BMA shall not be liable for the financial soundness, performance or default of our business or for the correctness of any opinions or statements expressed in this prospectus. Certain issues and transfers of common shares involving persons deemed resident in Bermuda for exchange control purposes require the specific consent of the BMA.

Stamp Duty

Stamp duty is a tax in Bermuda imposed on written documents. The governing legislation is the Stamp Duties Act 1976, as amended (the “Stamp Duties Act”). The Stamp Duties Act sets out the instruments that are subject to stamp duty, which generally include certain instruments or documents as specified in the Stamp Duties Act that are executed in Bermuda or, if executed outside of Bermuda, are then brought into Bermuda.

There are certain limited stamp duty exemptions under the Bermuda Stock Exchange Company Act 1992 (the “BSX Act”), which extend to local companies, the securities of which are listed on the BSX. The Bank’s common shares are currently listed on the NYSE and BSX. Pursuant to the BSX Act, the provisions of the Stamp Duties Act will not apply to any instrument which relates to (i) a conveyance or transfer on sale, (ii) a conveyance or transfer to effect or having the effect of a voluntary disposition inter vivos, or (iii) any agreement for the lending and borrowing, of any securities which are listed on the BSX. Accordingly, for so long as the common shares of the Bank remain listed on the BSX, the stamp duty exemptions under the BSX Act would apply. However, dealings in the Bank’s common shares beyond the limited exemptions under the BSX Act may attract stamp duty under various heads of the Schedule to the Stamp Duties Act. For example, ad valorem stamp duty may be payable (i) where security is granted over shares of the Bank, (ii) where shares of the Bank form part of a deceased’s estate and probate is sought, and (iii) on a share certificate where the share is issued by the Bank for the first time at a premium in excess of the par value thereof.

The Stamp Duties Act prescribes the persons liable to pay the stamp duty, whether the amount of duty is a fixed or ad valorem amount and the time period in which the duty must be paid, depending on the nature of the instrument. The Stamp Duties Act also sets out the consequences for failure to stamp instruments which are subject to duty.

Generally, if a stampable document has been executed in Bermuda or has been executed outside of Bermuda and then brought into Bermuda and stamp duty is not paid, the document is not valid for any purpose (including registration) in Bermuda, until such time as it is stamped. In addition, a stampable document which is not stamped (i) is not admissible in court proceedings in Bermuda, except in criminal proceedings or stamp duty violation prosecutions; and (ii) may not be acted upon, filed, or registered by any public official or by any company. Anyone trying to evade payment of stamp duty commits an offence and is liable to prosecution and penalty.

Limits on Shareholding

Generally, limits are imposed by the Companies Act on the percentage of shares in a local company carrying on business in Bermuda which may be held by persons who are non-Bermudian as that term is defined in the Companies Act. As described above, although the Bank relies on an exemption under section 114(1)(e) of the Companies Act to these ownership requirements and related control requirements, the bye-laws of the Bank currently restrict the voting rights of any person who is not “Bermudian” (as such term is defined in the Companies Act) who is “interested” (as such term is defined in the bye-laws) in the Bank's shares which constitutes more than 40% of all shares then issued and outstanding is not entitled to vote the shares which are in excess of such 40% interest at any general meeting without the prior written approval of the Minister of Finance.

In addition, there are certain prior approval requirements pursuant to the BDCA, the Trusts Business Act and the Investment Business Act with respect to any person who seeks to become a “shareholder controller” (as defined under each of those Acts) of the Bank.

Deposit Insurance Scheme

Pursuant to the Deposit Insurance Act 2011 and the Deposit Insurance Rules 2016 of Bermuda, a Deposit Insurance Scheme (“DIS”) has come into effect in Bermuda. The DIS is administered by the

177

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Bermuda Deposit Insurance Corporation. The DIS is designed to protect the deposits of individuals, charities, unincorporated associations, partnerships, sole proprietors and small businesses by guaranteeing up to $25,000 of their aggregate Bermuda Dollar deposits in the event of a Bermuda deposit taking institution’s failure. The DIS is backed by a Deposit Insurance Fund which is in turn funded from premium contributions that are payable by all banks and credit unions licensed by the BMA . As a bank licensed by the BMA, we are required to be a member of the DIS and pay contributions to the Deposit Insurance Fund. Currently, our premium contribution is calculated by the Bermuda Deposit Insurance Corporation as 0.25% per annum of the average total amount of our Bermuda Dollar deposits that are covered by the DIS guarantee over a rolling three month period based on information disclosed by us to the Bermuda Deposit Insurance Corporation, with our initial contribution backdated to July 1, 2016. Each contribution to the Deposit Insurance Fund (including the initial contribution) is payable every three months in arrears.

The Cayman Islands

The Cayman Islands Monetary Authority

Our activities in the Cayman Islands are monitored by CIMA. CIMA is responsible for currency management, regulation and supervision of the Cayman Islands financial services sector (which includes securities and investments business, banking, insurance and fiduciary services), advice to the Cayman Islands government and cooperation with overseas regulatory authorities. CIMA's principal focus is to promote and maintain a sound financial system in the Cayman Islands and to promote and enhance market confidence, consumer protection and the reputation of the Cayman Islands as a financial center.

CIMA has broad statutory powers of enforcement. These powers are intended to permit CIMA to have access to information held or maintained by a licensee as necessary and to enable CIMA to take appropriate remedial action if a licensee is in default of its obligations under applicable laws.

Relevant Legislation/Regulations

Banks & Trust Companies Laws (2013 Revision)

The Banks and Trust Companies Law (2013 Revision) (the “BTCL”) provides that it is an offense to conduct banking business or trust business without the appropriate license. Bank of Butterfield (Cayman) Limited holds a category “A” banking license and a trust license, both issued by CIMA.

The BTCL is supplemented by certain regulations which, among other things, prescribe the fees that are payable by licensees and certain information that must be submitted to CIMA in connection with any license application.

Licensees must adhere to certain capital adequacy requirements and must file audited financial statements with CIMA within three months of their financial year-end. Prior written approval of CIMA is required in a number of circumstances including, but are not limited to, the issue, transfer or disposal of any shares, the appointment of a new director or senior officer or where the licensee wishes to conduct business that deviates from its business plan submitted at the time of its license application.

Securities Investment Business Law (2015 Revision), as amended

The Securities Investment Business Law (2015 Revision), as amended (the “SIBL”) provides that a person shall not carry on, or purport to carry on, securities investment business in or from the Cayman Islands unless that person is for the time being licensed under SIBL or is exempted from the requirement to hold a license pursuant to SIBL. Butterfield Bank (Cayman) Limited holds a securities investment business license, issued by CIMA, to conduct its business.

SIBL is essentially designed to achieve the licensing and regulation of securities investment providers and applies to (i) any company, foreign company or partnership incorporated or registered in the Cayman Islands and carrying on “securities investment business” anywhere in the world, or (ii) any entity which has a “place of business” in the Cayman Islands through which “securities investment business” is carried on. The entity need not have a physical presence in the Cayman Islands in order for such entity to fall within the ambit of SIBL.

178

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Certain activities are explicitly excluded that would otherwise fall within the definition of securities investment business. In addition, SIBL exempts certain persons who are engaged in securities investment business with, among other things, sophisticated or high net worth persons (as such terms are defined in SIBL) from the full licensing requirements of SIBL, provided that they file an annual declaration with CIMA and pay an annual fee.

Insurance Law, 2010 (as amended)

CIMA regulates the insurance industry in the Cayman Islands pursuant to the Insurance Law, 2010 (as amended) (the “IL”). Such regulation includes licensing, ongoing supervision, and enforcement.

Pursuant to the IL, a company is required to hold a license in order to carry on insurance or reinsurance business or business as an insurance agent, insurance broker or insurance manager in or from the Cayman Islands. Bank of Butterfield (Cayman) Limited (which is not itself an insurer) holds an insurance agent license, issued by CIMA, permitting it to solicit domestic business on behalf of not more than one general insurer and one long term insurer.

Companies Laws (2016 Revision) as amended

Butterfield Bank (Cayman) Limited is an ordinary resident company incorporated in the Cayman Islands, meaning that, subject to it being licensed under the BTCL, it can carry on business within the Cayman Islands. Butterfield Bank (Cayman) Limited is required to comply with the requirements of the Companies Law (2016 Revision), as amended, this being the principal statute governing the incorporation and ongoing operations of the Cayman Islands companies.

Money Laundering Regulations (2015 Revision); Proceeds of Crime Law (2016 Revision); and Terrorism Law (2015 Revision), each as amended

Butterfield Bank (Cayman) Limited is subject to the Money Laundering Regulations (2015 Revision) (the “Regulations”) made pursuant to the Proceeds of the Crime Law (2016 Revision) (the “PCL”), each as amended. The Regulations apply to anyone conducting “relevant financial business” in or from the Cayman Islands intending to form a business relationship or carry out a one-off transaction. The Regulations require a financial service provider to maintain certain anti-money laundering procedures including those for the purposes of verifying the identity and source of funds of an “applicant for business” except in certain circumstances, including where an entity is regulated by a recognized overseas regulatory authority and/or listed on a recognized stock exchange in an approved jurisdiction. In addition, if any person resident in the Cayman Islands knows or suspects, or has reasonable grounds for knowing or suspecting that another person is engaged in criminal conduct, or is involved with terrorism or terrorist property, and the information for that knowledge or suspicion came to their attention in the course of business in the regulated sector, or other trade, profession, business or employment, the person will be required to report such knowledge or suspicion to (i) the Financial Reporting Authority of the Cayman Islands (the “FRA”), pursuant to the PCL, if the disclosure relates to criminal conduct or money laundering, or (ii) a police officer of the rank of constable or higher, or the FRA, pursuant to the Terrorism Law (2015 Revision), if the disclosure relates to involvement with terrorism or terrorist financing and property.

Guernsey

Guernsey Financial Services Commission

Our activities in Guernsey are monitored by the Guernsey Financial Services Commission (the “GFSC”) through its Probability and Risk Impact System. The primary objective of the GFSC is to regulate and supervise finance businesses in the Bailiwick of Guernsey (“Guernsey”, or the “Bailiwick”). Almost all financial service activities in Guernsey are required to be licensed by the GFSC. Once licensed, the businesses are subject to the regulation, oversight, investigatory, information gathering and enforcement powers of the GFSC.

The various divisions of the GFSC perform regular visits with the purpose of understanding the business and reviewing the risk management and internal control environment (including monitoring and any outsourced functions). Such visits also monitor compliance with applicable law and regulation.

179

TABLE OF CONTENTS

In addition to conducing on-site reviews, the GFSC has a continuing duty to determine whether entities it regulates and the persons who own or run them remain fit and proper. Licensees therefore have a statutory obligation to notify the GFSC of various changes, which are set out in comprehensive rules and regulations. The GFSC also requires financial services businesses to submit periodic returns for statistical analysis and inclusion in thematic studies.

The GFSC has wide powers of enforcement to address shortcomings and breaches by financial services businesses. These range from private warnings and reprimands to revocation and suspension of applicable licenses and consents and criminal prosecution, among others.

The Banking Supervision (Bailiwick of Guernsey) Law, 1994

The Banking Supervision (Bailiwick of Guernsey) Law, 1994 (the “BSL”) provides that no person shall in the Bailiwick accept a deposit in the course of carrying on, whether in the Guernsey or elsewhere, a deposit-taking business under the authority of and in accordance with the condition of a license granted by the GFSC. Butterfield Bank (Guernsey) Limited holds a license under the BSL. In order to be granted a license, a company's business must be carried on with prudence, integrity, professional skills and in a manner which will not tend to bring the Bailiwick into disrepute. The business must also be directed by at least two individuals who are resident in the Bailiwick of Guernsey with appropriate standing and experience and sufficiently independent of each other. Businesses must also adhere to codes, principles, rules and instructions issued from time to time.

Regulation of Fiduciaries, Administration Businesses and Company Directors (Bailiwick of Guernsey) Law 2000

The Regulation of Fiduciaries, Administration Businesses and Company Directors (Bailiwick of Guernsey) Law 2000 (the “Guernsey Fiduciaries Law”) provides that only a person licensed by the GFSC under the Guernsey Fiduciaries Law can operate fiduciary businesses, which includes:

formation, management and administration or trusts;
company or corporate administration;
provision of executorship services; and
the formation and management of foundations.

The GFSC can grant two different categories of license, including a full fiduciary license, which can only be granted to a company or a partnership, and a personal fiduciary license. The full fiduciary license covers any director, manager, partner or employee acting in the course of their employment.

The Protection of Investors (Bailiwick of Guernsey) Law, 1987

Under the Protection of Investors (Bailiwick of Guernsey) Law, 1987, as amended (the “POI Law”), a person shall not (subject to certain exemptions) carry on, or hold himself out as carrying on, any controlled investment business in or from within the Bailiwick, except under and in accordance with the terms of a license. For the purposes of the POI Law, a controlled investment includes collective investment schemes and general securities and derivatives. All Guernsey domiciled funds have to be authorized by or registered with the GFSC and be administered by a Guernsey licensed administrator. In addition, open-ended funds must also have a Guernsey licensed custodian.

The Financial Services Commission (Bailiwick of Guernsey) Law, 1987

The Financial Services Commission (Bailiwick of Guernsey) Law, 1987 provides that the general functions of the GFSC are to supervise the finance business in the Bailiwick, to counter financial crime and the financing of terrorism and to maintain confidence in the Bailiwick's reputation as an international finance center.

The Criminal Justice (Proceeds of Crime) (Bailiwick of Guernsey) Law, 1999

The Criminal Justice (Proceeds of Crime) (Bailiwick of Guernsey) Law, 1999 established certain offenses in connection with the proceeds of criminal conduct including concealing of transferring the proceeds of crime, assisting another person to retain the proceeds of criminal conduct, acquisition, possession or use of proceeds of criminal conduct and tipping-off.

180

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Terrorism and Crime (Bailiwick of Guernsey) Regulations, 2007

The Terrorism and Crime (Bailiwick of Guernsey) Regulations, 2007 provides for a positive obligation on businesses to report internally any suspicions of money laundering. A money laundering reporting officer must be appointed to fulfill this function and to make disclosure to the relevant division of Guernsey's police unit.

United Kingdom

Regulatory Regime

Prior to January 2017, our activities in the UK took place through Butterfield Bank (UK) Limited (“BBUK”) and consisted of various banking and investment services businesses, including lending, administering and advising on regulated mortgage contracts (including consumer buy to let business), and arranging deals in, and managing investments. Throughout 2016, we wound down the private banking business, deposit-taking and investment management services of BBUK. We continue to provide UK residential property lending services and family office services through an entity now known as Butterfield Mortgages Limited (“Butterfield UK”).

The primary legislation governing the provision of Butterfield UK's services is the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 and its secondary regulations (“FSMA”). FSMA requires that in order to carry on mortgage and investment services in the UK, a firm must be authorized (or exempt) and have the necessary permissions. Butterfield UK is authorized and has permissions to enter into, advise on and administer regulated mortgage contracts and to provide certain investment services.

Because its permissions are limited to mortgage and investment activities, Butterfield UK is, as of January 2017, only regulated by the Financial Conduct Authority (“FCA”) and not by the Prudential Regulation Authority (“PRA”), which regulates banks and insurers. The FCA has responsibility for regulating the conduct of the business of Butterfield UK. On December 21, 2016, Butterfield UK ceased to be authorized as a bank and therefore ceased to be regulated by the PRA.

Butterfield UK must comply with the FCA handbook which contains detailed rules and guidance in respect of governance and conduct matters. The FCA's Principles for Business require, among other things, that Butterfield UK conducts its business with integrity and due skill, care and diligence and deal with its regulators in an open and co-operative way. In addition, certain directors and approved persons of Butterfield UK are subject to statements of principle and a code of practice that describes behaviors expected of persons operating in the regulated sector.

Control

FSMA requires any person seeking to obtain (and in certain circumstances increase) control over Butterfield UK to first get approval from the FCA. A person will become a controller if it holds (itself or with another where they are acting together) (i) 10% or more in the shares of Butterfield UK or in any parent undertaking; or (ii) 10% or more of the voting power in Butterfield UK or any parent.

The Companies Act 2006 requires that UK incorporated companies maintain a register of persons who have significant control over them. A person will be considered to have significant control if it holds (itself or with another where they are acting together) 25% or more of the company's shares or voting rights or has the ability to appoint a majority of the board of directors.

Capital

Butterfield UK is subject to capital rules under the FCA's Prudential sourcebook for Mortgage and Home Finance Firms and Insurance Intermediaries handbook (MIPRU). The MIPRU capital rules stipulate the minimum level and quality of capital that must be maintained to support the activities carried on.

AML and Financial Crime

Butterfield UK is subject to a range of legislation at a UK and European level requiring it to take steps to detect and prevent potential money laundering, financial crime or terrorist financing. The FCA and HM Treasury have investigatory powers in relation to suspected breaches.

181

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Relevant legislation at the EU level is the Third Money Laundering Directive (2005/60) and, in the future, the Fourth Money Laundering Directive (2015/849) due to be implemented in the UK before June 26, 2017. From July 3, 2016, Butterfield UK has been subject to the Market Abuse Regulation (596/2014) and the Directive on criminal sanctions for market abuse (2014/57/EU) (“CSMAD”) which have introduced a strengthened EU market abuse regime, incorporating a wide range of tougher sanctions which include criminal sanctions (under CSMAD) for the most serious market abuse cases.

At the UK level, Butterfield UK must comply with its obligations under the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002, the Terrorism Act 2000 and the Anti-terrorism, Crime and Security Act 2001, Counter-Terrorism Act 2008 (Schedule 7), the Transfer of Funds (Information on the Payer) Regulations 2007, the Money Laundering Regulations 2007 and certain specific obligations in FSMA (in particular with respect to market abuse and insider dealing) and the FCA Handbook. Together, this legislation requires regulated firms to create appropriate and risk-sensitive policies and procedures in relation to customer due diligence procedures and monitoring of transactions, to avoid financing terrorism or money laundering or facilitating either of these, to avoid dealing with certain persons specified by HM Treasury, and to disclose suspicious activity to the relevant regulatory authorities.

Butterfield UK must also comply with legislation of third countries to the extent that such legislation has extra-territorial effect and is applicable to it. Examples of this are the US PATRIOT Act of 2001 and The Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act (“FATCA”) of 2010.

The Bahamas

The Central Bank of The Bahamas

Butterfield Trust (Bahamas) Limited has been granted a license from the Central Bank of The Bahamas to conduct banking and trust business from within The Bahamas. As the primary regulator of Butterfield Trust (Bahamas) Limited, the Central Bank of The Bahamas is responsible for the regulation and supervision of Butterfield Trust (Bahamas) Limited with respect to all of its operations, corporate governance issues, and compliance with applicable laws and regulations. The Central Bank of The Bahamas' regulations on capital adequacy and the regulatory framework within The Bahamas take into account the recommendations of the BCBS.

Relevant Legislation/Regulations

The Banks and Trust Companies Regulation Act and Regulations

The Banks and Trust Companies Regulation Act and Regulations set forth the basic provisions relating to the licensing and operations of banks and trust companies in The Bahamas, as well as the powers of the Central Bank of The Bahamas to supervise and audit the activities of such entities.

The Central Bank of The Bahamas Act

The Central Bank of The Bahamas Act provides general provisions relating to the structure and operation of the Central Bank of The Bahamas, the regulatory reporting required to be submitted to the Central Bank of The Bahamas by the licensees and the penalties that may be imposed for failure to comply with the orders of the Central Bank of The Bahamas.

Financial Intelligence and Reporting

The Financial Intelligence Unit Act provides for the establishment of the financial intelligence unit organization in The Bahamas that is responsible for receiving, analyzing, obtaining and disseminating information which relates to or may relate to the proceeds of offenses under the Proceeds of Crime Act or the Anti-Terrorism Act.

The Financial Transactions Reporting Act and Regulations provides the basic requirements applicable to financial institutions in The Bahamas with respect to verifying the identities of facility holders and bank customers, the obligation to report suspicious transactions to the financial intelligence unit, and minimum record retention policies and procedures.

182

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Other Relevant Regulations

Butterfield Trust (Bahamas) Limited is also subject to various other regulations, including the Proceeds of Crime Act, which sets forth that it is a crime in The Bahamas for a person to conceal, transfer or deal with the proceeds of criminal conduct (such as money laundering) and the Anti-Terrorism Act, which sets forth that it is a crime in The Bahamas for a person to provide or collect funds or provide financial services or make such services available to persons with the intention that such funds or services are to be used in full or in part to carry out a terrorist act. In addition to the laws and regulations set forth above, Butterfield Trust (Bahamas) Limited is also obligated to comply with the guidelines released by the Central Bank of The Bahamas from time to time.

United States

Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act (FATCA)

Under FATCA, US federal tax legislation passed in 2010, a 30% withholding tax will be imposed on “withholdable payments” made to non-US financial institutions (including non-US investment funds and certain other non-US financial entities) that fail (or, in some cases, that have 50% affiliates which are also non-US financial institutions that fail) to provide certain information regarding their US accountholders and/or certain US investors (such US accountholders and US investors, “US accountholders”) to the IRS. For non-US financial institutions that fail to comply, this withholding will generally apply without regard to whether the beneficial owner of a withholdable payment is a US person or would otherwise be entitled to an exemption from US federal withholding tax. “Withholdable payments” generally include, among other items, payments of US-source interest and dividends and the gross proceeds from the sale or other disposition of property that may produce US-source interest and dividends. Furthermore, FATCA may also impose withholding on non-US source payments by non-US financial institutions that comply with FATCA to non-US financial institutions that fail to comply with FATCA. Withholding pursuant to FATCA will start no earlier than January 2019 with respect to non-US source payments by non-US financial institutions. In general, non-publicly traded debt and equity interests in investment vehicles will be treated as “accounts” and subject to these reporting requirements. In addition, certain insurance policies and annuities are considered accounts for these purposes.

Some countries, including the Cayman Islands, Guernsey, the United Kingdom and The Bahamas, have entered into, and other countries are expected to enter into, Intergovernmental Agreements (“IGAs”) with the United States to facilitate the type of information reporting required under FATCA. While the existence of IGAs will not eliminate the risk of the withholding described above, these agreements are expected to reduce that risk for financial institutions and investors in countries that have entered into IGAs. IGAs will often require financial institutions in those countries to report some information on their US accountholders to the taxing authorities of those countries, which will then pass the information to the IRS.

The Group closely monitors all present and new legislation that is or will be applicable for its organization, and is currently investigating all implications of FATCA and legislation of countries that have entered into IGAs. While investigating these implications, the Group is and will be in close contact with all of its stakeholders, including its peers and financial industry representative organizations.

The Group intends to take all necessary steps to comply with FATCA (including entering into agreements with the US tax authorities as may be required), in accordance with the time frame set by the US tax authorities. However, if the Group cannot enter into such agreements or satisfy the requirements thereunder (including as a result of local laws in non-IGA countries prohibiting information-sharing with the IRS, as a result of contracts or local laws prohibiting withholding on certain payments to accountholders, policyholders, annuitants or other investors, or as a result of the failure of accountholders, policyholders, annuitants or other investors to provide requested information), certain payments to the Group may be subject to withholding under FATCA. The possibility of such withholding and the need for accountholders, policyholders, annuitants and investors to provide certain information may adversely affect the sales of certain of the Group's products. In addition, entering into agreements with the IRS and compliance with the terms of such agreements and with FATCA and any regulations or other guidance promulgated

183

TABLE OF CONTENTS

thereunder or any legislation promulgated under an IGA may substantially increase the Group's compliance costs. Because the rules for the implementations of FATCA, including IGAs, have not yet been fully finalized, it remains uncertain at this time what impact, if any, this legislation will have on holders of the common shares.

Office of Foreign Assets Control Regulation

The US Treasury Department's Office of Foreign Assets Control, or OFAC, administers and enforces economic and trade sanctions against targeted foreign countries and regimes, under authority of various laws, including designated foreign countries, nationals and others. OFAC publishes lists of specially designated targets and countries. OFAC sanctions apply to all transactions that take place in the United States. Transactions that take place outside the United States may become subject to the jurisdiction of the United States and subject to compliance with OFAC sanctions if they involve US persons or payment in US dollars. Such payments typically are cleared through the US dollar settlement system located in the United States and involve the intermediation of US financial institutions. Although we currently do not have any operations in the United States, our operations may involve transactions with US persons or in US dollars and as a result, in order to comply with OFAC sanctions, we are responsible for, among other things, blocking any such transactions with designated targets and countries and reporting blocked transactions after their occurrence. Failure to comply with these sanctions could have serious legal and reputational consequences, including causing applicable bank regulatory authorities not to approve merger or acquisition transactions when regulatory approval is required or to prohibit such transactions even if approval is not required.

Anti-Money Laundering and the USA PATRIOT Act

A major focus of worldwide governmental policy on financial institutions in recent years has been aimed at combating money laundering and terrorist financing. In particular, the USA PATRIOT Act of 2001, or the USA Patriot Act, substantially broadened the scope of United States anti-money laundering laws and regulations applicable to US banks and non-US banks with operations in the United States, including banks that engage in transactions outside the United States with US persons or in US dollars, by imposing significant new compliance and due diligence obligations, creating new crimes and penalties and expanding the extra-territorial jurisdiction of the United States. Financial institutions are also prohibited from entering into specified financial transactions and account relationships and must use enhanced due diligence procedures in their dealings with certain types of high-risk customers and implement a written customer identification program. Financial institutions must take certain steps to assist government agencies in detecting and preventing money laundering and report certain types of suspicious transactions. Regulatory authorities routinely examine financial institutions for compliance with these obligations, and failure of a financial institution to maintain and implement adequate programs to combat money laundering and terrorist financing, or to comply with all of the relevant laws or regulations, could have serious legal and reputational consequences for the institution, including causing applicable bank regulatory authorities not to approve merger or acquisition transactions when regulatory approval is required or to prohibit such transactions even if approval is not required. Regulatory authorities have imposed cease and desist orders and civil money penalties against institutions found to be violating these obligations.

Future Legislation and Regulation

The governments of Bermuda and the other jurisdictions in which we operate may enact legislation from time to time that affects the regulation of the financial services industry or that affect the regulation of financial institutions chartered by or operating in those jurisdictions. These governments and their regulatory agencies also periodically propose and adopt changes to their regulations or change the manner in which existing regulations are applied. The substance or impact of pending or future legislation or regulation, or the application thereof, cannot be predicted, although enactment of the proposed legislation could impact the regulatory structure under which we operate and may significantly increase our costs, impede the efficiency of our internal business processes, require us to increase our regulatory capital and modify our business strategy, and limit our ability to pursue business opportunities in an efficient manner. Our business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects may be adversely affected, perhaps materially, as a result.

184

TABLE OF CONTENTS

MANAGEMENT

Board

Our Board oversees the affairs of the Bank. The current Board is composed of nine members, consisting of our Non-Executive Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and seven non-executive directors. The Bank's bye-laws provide that the Board shall consist of not less than six and not more than twelve directors. The Board holds regular meetings five times per year and special meetings when necessary.

Persons may be proposed for election or appointed as directors at a general meeting either by the Board or by one or more shareholders holding shares which in the aggregate carry not less than 5% of the voting rights in respect of the election of directors. There is only a single class of director and each director holds office until the next annual general meeting.

Prior to this offering, Carlyle owned approximately 14% of the Bank's common shares. Carlyle has the right to nominate two persons for election by the shareholders as director until the common shares it owns represent less than 10% of our common shares outstanding. If the common shares it owns represent less than 10% but at least 5% of our common shares outstanding, Carlyle will be entitled to nominate one person for election by the shareholders as director. Mr. James F. Burr and Mr. David Zwiener were appointed as directors on our Board upon Carlyle's designation pursuant to the Investment Agreement. For more information, see “Our Relationship with The Carlyle Group and Related Party Transactions”.

As a foreign private issuer we are allowed to follow our “home country” corporate governance practices in lieu of the NYSE governance requirements for NYSE-listed US companies. Notwithstanding this, our Board has determined that, under current NYSE listing standards regarding independence (which we are not currently subject to), and taking into account any applicable committee standards, Messrs. Barbour, Burr, Foulger, Schoellkopf, Wright, and Zwiener, representing a majority of our Board, are independent directors. In addition, although the chairman of our Board, E. Barclay Simmons, is not independent under NYSE standards due to a familial relationship with a member of our senior management, the Board has deemed Mr. Simmons independent under our corporate governance guidelines, which are consistent with home-country rules.

As the regulatory environment in which we operate becomes more complex, our governance practices and the structures and methodology we use to run the Bank continue to be of key strategic significance. With the exception of the Chief Executive Officer, our Board is comprised entirely of directors who are not employees of the Bank. It is the Board that ensures our governance keeps abreast of best practices. The following table lists the names, positions and date of birth of the Directors of the Bank:

Name
Date of Birth
Position
E. Barclay Simmons
September 17, 1972
Non-Executive Chairman
Michael Collins
March 29, 1963
Chief Executive Officer
Alastair Barbour
February 10, 1953
Non-Executive Director
James F. Burr
January 11, 1966
Non-Executive Director
Caroline Foulger
January 9, 1961
Non-Executive Director
Conor O'Dea
March 23, 1959
Non-Executive Director
Wolfgang Schoellkopf
July 22, 1932
Non-Executive Director
John R. Wright
September 10, 1941
Non-Executive Director
David Zwiener
August 2, 1954
Non-Executive Director

Each of our directors may be reached by postal mail at the address of our headquarters in Bermuda: 65 Front Street, Hamilton, HM 12, Bermuda.

E. Barclay Simmons joined the Board in 2011. Currently, he is one of the founding Partners and the Chief Executive Officer of ASW Law Limited, a local commercial law firm. Previously, Mr. Simmons was an investment banker with Goldman, Sachs & Co. in New York. Mr. Simmons is a former Director/Chairman of the Investment Committee of the Bermuda Monetary Authority, the Argus Group Holdings Limited, and the Public Funds Investment Committee, responsible for the investment of pension funds for the Government of Bermuda. Mr. Simmons received a Master's in Business Administration from

185

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Harvard Business School, a Bachelor of Laws (Honors) from the University of Kent at Canterbury and was called to the Bar of England and Wales. Mr. Simmons was previously a serving Infantry Officer in the Bermuda Regiment, having completed the Territorial Army Commissioning Course at the Royal Military Academy Sandhurst.

Michael Collins joined the Board in September of 2015 when he was named Chief Executive Officer of the Bank. Prior to this appointment, Mr. Collins was Senior Executive Vice President with responsibility for all of the Bank's client businesses in Bermuda, including Corporate, Private and Retail Banking, as well as the Operations, Custody and Marketing functions in Bermuda and the Cayman Islands. Mr. Collins has 31 years' experience in financial services, having held progressively senior positions, at Morgan Guaranty Trust Company in New York and later at Bank of Bermuda and HSBC in Bermuda. Before joining the Bank in 2009, Mr. Collins was Chief Operating Officer at HSBC Bank Bermuda. Mr. Collins holds a BA in Economics from Brown University.

Alastair Barbour joined the Board in 2012. He is a Chartered Accountant with more than 25 years of experience providing auditing and advisory services to publicly traded companies, primarily in the financial services industry. Mr. Barbour was employed with KPMG from 1978 until his retirement in 2011. During his time there, he held various positions both locally and overseas. In 1985, he was named Partner at KPMG (Bermuda). Mr. Barbour's most recent position was head of KPMG's Financial Services Group in Scotland. Currently, Mr. Barbour sits on the board of directors of several listed and unlisted companies, including RSA Insurance Group plc and Phoenix Group Holdings Limited. Mr. Barbour trained with Peat, Marwick, Mitchell & Co. in London and holds a Bachelor of Science from the University of Edinburgh. He is a Fellow of the Institute of Chartered Accountants in England & Wales.

James F. Burr joined the Board in 2016. Mr. Burr was appointed as a director on our Board upon Carlyle's designation pursuant to the Investment Agreement. Presently, Mr. Burr is a Managing Director in the Global Financial Services Group of The Carlyle Group, where he focuses on investing in management buyouts, growth capital opportunities and strategic minority investments in financial services. Prior to joining Carlyle, Mr. Burr served as Corporate Treasurer of Wachovia Bank, where he was responsible for activities relating to funding, investing, risk transference, balance sheet management, liquidity and capital usage. He has served in various other roles at Wachovia Bank, including as Assistant Treasurer, Controller of the Corporate and Investment Bank and Management Analyst since 1992. Mr. Burr began his career at Ernst & Young, where he was a certified public accountant focused on banking and computer audit issues. Mr. Burr formerly served on the board of directors of Central Pacific Financial Corp.

Caroline Foulger joined the Board in 2013. Prior to her retirement in 2012, Ms. Foulger was a Partner with PricewaterhouseCoopers Bermuda, where she led the firm's insurance and public sector groups. She holds directorship positions with several listed and private companies. Ms. Foulger graduated with honors, from University College, University of London. Currently, she is either a Fellow or Member of several professional bodies, namely, the Institute of Chartered Accountants in England and Wales, Institute of Chartered Professional Accountants of Bermuda, and the Institute of Directors.

Conor O'Dea joined the Board in 2016 following his retirement as the Group's President & Chief Operating Officer and Managing Director of Butterfield Bank (Cayman) Limited. He joined Butterfield in 1989 and was named Managing Director, Butterfield Bank (Cayman) Limited in 1997. In 2010, he was named Senior Executive Vice President, Caribbean, and in 2011 Senior Executive Vice President, International Banking. Mr. O'Dea is a Chartered Accountant who has worked in the financial services industry in the Cayman Islands and internationally for over 25 years. He is a past President of the Cayman Islands Chamber of Commerce and past President of the Cayman Islands Bankers Association. Mr. O'Dea holds a Bachelor of Commerce degree from the University College Dublin and has been a Fellow of Chartered Accountants in Ireland since 1995.

Wolfgang Schoellkopf joined the Board in 2010. Mr. Schoellkopf currently manages a private investment company PMW Capital Management. He is a former Executive Vice President and Treasurer of Chase Manhattan Bank. He also served as Vice Chairman and Chief Financial Officer of First Fidelity Bank, and Chief Executive Officer of Bank Austria Group's US operations. In addition to serving as a director of the Bank, since 2009, Mr. Schoellkopf has served on the boards of Santander Bank, Santander

186

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Holdings USA, and Santander Consumer Finance. His previous board memberships include BPW Acquisition Corporation, Sallie Mae Corporation (1997-2014), Bank Austria Cayman Islands (2001-2008), Great Lakes Insurance Company (1994-1998), and First Fidelity Bank (1990-1997). Mr. Schoellkopf was educated at the University of California at Berkeley, the University of Munich, and Cornell University.

John Wright joined the Board in 2002. Mr. Wright served as a non-executive director of Butterfield UK from 2001 through 2014. Mr. Wright retired as chief executive of Clydesdale & Yorkshire Banks in 2001. He is a visiting Professor at Heriot-Watt University Business School. He serves as non-executive chairman and board member of several UK and overseas companies. He is also a past President of the Irish Institute of Bankers and a past Vice President of the Chartered Institute of Bankers in Scotland. Mr. Wright was educated at Daniel Stewarts College Edinburgh.

David Zwiener joined the Board in 2016. Mr. Zwiener is an Operating Executive of The Carlyle Group. From January 25, 2015 to March 18, 2016, Mr. Zwiener was Interim CEO at PartnerRe Ltd. Since 2010, Mr. Zwiener has been a Principal in Dowling Capital Partners. Prior to joining Dowling Capital Partners, Mr. Zwiener was Chief Financial Officer of Wachovia Corporation. From 1995 to 2007, Mr. Zwiener served in increasingly responsible positions at The Hartford, rising to President and Chief Operating Officer—Property & Casualty. He previously served as a director of CNO Financial Group, The Hartford and Sheridan Healthcare, Inc. Mr. Zwiener received an A.B. degree from Duke University and an M.B.A. from the Kellogg School of Management at Northwestern University.

Executive Management Team

The Group's current executive management is as follows:

Name
Date of Birth
Position
Michael Collins
March 29, 1963
Chief Executive Officer
Michael Schrum
August 30, 1968
Chief Financial Officer
Daniel Frumkin
June 3, 1964
Chief Risk Officer
Shaun Morris
March 3, 1960
General Counsel, Group Chief Legal Officer
Elizabeth Bauman
April 25, 1960
Group Head of Human Resources

Each member of our executive management team may be reached by postal mail at the address of our headquarters in Bermuda: 65 Front Street, Hamilton, HM 12, Bermuda.

Michael Schrum was appointed Chief Financial Officer of the Group effective September 21, 2015. Mr. Schrum joined the Group from HSBC Bank Bermuda Limited, where he was CFO. He has more than 20 years of financial services experience in London, New York and Bermuda, mainly in banking, insurance and tax. He joined HSBC in Bermuda in 2001 and held progressively more senior positions within the HSBC's Commercial Banking, Strategy, and Finance divisions. He is a Chartered Financial Analyst and a Fellow of the Institute of Chartered Accountants in England and Wales. Mr. Schrum holds Master's (University of London) and Bachelor's (Southern Denmark Business School) degrees in Economics. Mr. Schrum is a director of Ascendant Group Limited, Treasurer of the Bermuda Community Foundation and Director of Pathways Bermuda.

Daniel Frumkin currently serves as Chief Risk Officer of the Group. Mr. Frumkin joined the Group in 2010 and was appointed Chief Risk Officer in 2010. Mr. Frumkin is responsible for the Group's enterprise risk management framework and functions that identify, quantify, monitor and control the Group's credit, operational, compliance and market risks. Mr. Frumkin is a career banker with a depth of experience in risk management, credit and retail banking. He joined the Group in 2010 after 21 years with member companies of the Royal Bank of Scotland Group in the US and UK During his tenure with RBS, he held the positions of Managing Director of the UK Retail Products Group, with responsibility for the profitability of 2,200 branches and more than 14 million customers, and Chief Risk Officer, Retail Banking, responsible for a team of 1,250 risk professionals covering credit, regulatory/compliance and operational risk for the UK's largest retail Financial Services business. Mr. Frumkin's previous experience also includes the post of Head of Transition Risk at Northern Rock in the UK, overseeing the restructuring of

187

TABLE OF CONTENTS

that bank under public ownership, and JSC Parex Banka, where he was Chief Restructuring Officer, responsible for the reorganization of the nationalized Latvian bank. Mr. Frumkin holds a Bachelor of Arts degree in Finance and Economics from Syracuse University and a Masters of Business Administration from Boston University.

Shaun Morris currently serves as General Counsel and Group Chief Legal Officer of the Group. Mr. Morris joined the Group and was appointed General Counsel and Group Chief Legal Officer in 2012. From 2005 to 2012, Mr. Morris was the Managing Partner of Appleby's Bermuda Office. Appleby is the largest offshore law and fiduciary group operating in Bermuda. Prior to joining the Group, Mr. Morris spent his entire professional career at Appleby and was a Partner in the Banking and Asset Finance team in Bermuda. In that role, he practiced corporate and commercial law, specializing in shipping, capital markets, mergers & acquisitions and project finance. Mr. Morris holds an MA (Economics) from Dalhousie University in Canada and a Bachelor of Laws from the London School of Economics & Political Science. He is currently a member of the Bermuda Bar Association.

Elizabeth Bauman currently serves as Group Head of Human Resources with responsibility for the overall management and development of the Human Resources function. Mrs. Bauman joined the Group in September 2015. She has more than 25 years of progressive leadership experience in financial services with a focus on human resources management. She was previously President of Crestview Business Consulting, providing strategic planning and change management advisory services to clients in several industries. Prior to founding Crestview, Mrs. Bauman held the positions of Chief Administrative Officer and SVP, Human Resources at First Niagara Financial Group and Business Chief Financial Officer (Personal Financial Services), SVP Strategy & Development and SVP Human Resources at HSBC Bank USA. Mrs. Bauman holds a Bachelor of Science degree in Economics from Allegheny College and a Master of Business Administration from State University of New York at Buffalo New York.

Committees of the Board

The Bank's bye-laws authorize the Board to delegate certain of its duties to committees of directors. The principal board committees are: (1) Audit Committee, (2) Risk Policy and Compliance Committee, (3) Corporate Governance Committee, (4) Compensation and Human Resources Committee, and (5) Executive Committee. Members of committees are appointed by, from and among the non-executive members of the Board (other than the Executive Committee which includes our Chief Executive Officer). The responsibilities and compositions of these committees are described below.

Audit Committee

Our Audit Committee, on behalf of the Board, monitors (1) the integrity of the financial reports and other financial information provided by the Group to any governmental body or the public, (2) the independent auditor's qualifications and independence, (3) the performance of the Group's internal audit function and the independent auditors, (4) compliance with legal and regulatory requirements, (5) the Group's system of internal controls and (6) the Group's auditing, accounting and financial reporting processes generally. Subject to shareholder approval, the Audit Committee has responsibility for the appointment or replacement of the independent auditor and for the compensation and oversight of the work of the independent auditor. In addition, the Audit Committee is responsible for approving all audit services, internal control related services and permitted non-audit services. With respect to internal controls, the Audit Committee reviews and evaluates any major issues as to the adequacy of the Bank's internal controls, and any major control deficiencies or changes in internal controls over financial reporting are discussed with the Bank's management and the independent auditor. With respect to financial reporting, the Audit Committee consults with management, the independent auditor and the internal auditors about the integrity of the financial reporting process, reviews significant financial reporting risk exposure and management's responses, reviews significant auditor findings and establishes, reviews procedures for the receipt, retention and treatment of complaints about accounting and auditing matters, and reviews and recommends for the Board's approval the Group's financial reports. The Audit Committee also reviews and approves related party transactions.

Our Audit Committee consists of four directors independent under the NYSE requirements. Each member of the Audit Committee also meets the additional criteria for independence of Audit Committee members set forth in Rule 10A-3(b)(1) under the Exchange Act.

188

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The members of the Audit Committee are appointed by the Board upon the recommendation of the Corporate Governance Committee. The Audit Committee's membership is as follows:

Name
Position
Alastair Barbour
Chairman
James F. Burr
Member
Caroline Foulger
Member
David Zwiener
Member

Alastair Barbour serves as the Audit Committee financial expert.

Risk Policy and Compliance Committee

The RPC, on behalf of the Board, acts as the oversight function in respect to those activities throughout the Group that give rise to credit, market, liquidity, interest rate, operational and reputational risks and reviews compliance with laws and regulations. Specifically, the RPC assists the Board in fulfilling its responsibilities by overseeing the Group's risk profile and its performance against approved risk appetites and tolerance thresholds. It approves and ensures compliance with the capital allocation model and approves overall insurance coverage for the Group. The RPC also reviews the credit risk of the Group with respect to country and financial institution risk, large exposures, reserves and provisioning, off-balance sheet risk and related capital needs, as well as market, interest rate and liquidity risks. The RPC monitors operational risks, material breaches of agreed risk limits, appropriate product risk profiles and senior management policies for identification and management of risk. In doing so, the RPC seeks to ensure compliance with all applicable policies and establishes the Group's risk appetite and tolerance.

The RPC's membership is as follows:

Name
Position
Conor O'Dea
Chairman
James F. Burr
Member
E. Barclay Simmons
Member
Wolfgang Schoellkopf
Member
John Wright
Member

Corporate Governance Committee

The Corporate Governance Committee, on behalf of the Board, provides oversight of the effectiveness of the Board and other Board committees in accordance with the prevailing standards of corporate governance and acts as the nomination committee for the Board. The principal duties of the Corporate Governance Committee include recommending director nominees to the full Board who possess the independence and expertise necessary for recommending to the shareholders, recommending to the Board the Board size to recommend to shareholders, recommending to the Board changes in the terms of reference of Board committees and recommending director compensation. The Corporate Governance Committee also reviews the Board's performance, the performance and effectiveness of the committees of the Board and the committees of the Bank's subsidiary boards, conflicts of interest as they are identified, induction and ongoing training for directors and various governance policies of the Bank, including the Group Code of Conduct and Ethics, and the Whistleblower Policy annually.

189

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Corporate Governance Committee's membership is as follows:

Name
Position
Caroline Foulger
Chairperson
Alastair Barbour
Member
E. Barclay Simmons
Member
John Wright
Member

Compensation and Human Resources Committee

The Compensation and Human Resources Committee, on behalf of the Board, determines executive compensation, employee salary ranges, levels and degrees of participation in incentive compensation programs (including bonuses and share option plans) and oversees employee development, relations and succession. Specifically, the Compensation and Human Resources Committee ensures that fair and effective compensation practices are implemented by the Group, approves overall compensation packages for each executive employee, prepares an annual report on executive compensation for the Board, approves changes in employee salary ranges for employees, approves the criteria and design of the Group's incentive bonus plans and approves changes to the other employee benefit plans. The Compensation and Human Resources Committee also recommends to the Board changes in the Group's share option and restricted share plans, reviews the administration of our pension plans, reviews the annual management report on our compensation and benefits, as well as other matters bearing on the relationship between management and employees, while making recommendations to the Board concerning our senior level organization structure and staffing, training and employee development programs.

The Compensation and Human Resources Committee's membership is as follows:

Name
Position
Wolfgang Schoellkopf
Chairman
James F. Burr
Member
E. Barclay Simmons
Member

Executive Committee

The Executive Committee, on behalf of the Board, acts as a forum to provide for ongoing oversight of matters in the intervals between regularly scheduled Board meetings. The other principal duties of the Executive Committee are to monitor progress and provide guidance on important Group initiatives, plan for upcoming Board meetings and consider and, if thought fit, approve matters requiring approval at short notice in the intervals between Board meetings when it is not possible to convene a meeting of the full Board. The Executive Committee was constituted in October 2009 and its membership is comprised of the Chief Executive Officer, the chairman of the Board, the chair of the Corporate Governance Committee, the chair of the Audit Committee, the chair of the RPC and the chair of the Compensation and Human Resources Committee. The Chairman of the Board serves as the chairman of the Executive Committee.

The Executive Committee's membership is as follows:

Name
Position
E. Barclay Simmons
Chairman
Alastair Barbour
Member
Michael Collins
Member
Caroline Foulger
Member
Wolfgang Schoellkopf
Member
Conor O'Dea
Member

Governance of Geographical Segments

Our banking business operates in six geographical segments — Bermuda, the Cayman Islands, Guernsey, The Bahamas, Switzerland and the United Kingdom — and each geographical segment

190

TABLE OF CONTENTS

utilizes operating subsidiary companies of the Bank within these jurisdictions. See “Business — Our International Network and Group Structure”, which presents the corporate structure chart of our principal subsidiaries as of December 31, 2016. Our principal operating subsidiaries are each regulated by their respective geographical regulator and are fully capitalized as stand-alone operating companies, each with its own board of directors consisting of both executive and non-executive independent directors. Guidance on general corporate governance, board sub-committee structuring, and the various governance policies and procedures of the operating subsidiaries is determined at the Group level.

Current Executive Compensation Arrangements

Senior Management and Director Compensation

In 2016, senior management included the following executives: Michael Collins, Elizabeth Bauman, Daniel Frumkin, Shaun Morris and Michael Schrum. Our compensation program is designed to reward and retain senior management and includes base salary, annual short-term cash incentive compensation, long-term equity incentive compensation and miscellaneous employee benefits and fringe benefits (including, among others, executive medical benefits). In 2016, our compensation program for directors was comprised of an annual cash retainer and an equity grant. None of our directors has entered into service contracts with the Group that provide for benefits upon the termination of their service as a director.

On December 12, 2016, the Board approved a new CEO Stock Ownership Guideline (the “Guideline”), which requires the CEO to own a minimum aggregate value of our common shares equal to five times base salary. Eligible stock includes vested shares, unvested restricted shares, and other stock held by the CEO. The intrinsic value of vested or unvested stock options is not considered eligible stock under the Guideline. The CEO complied with the Guideline at its inception on December 12, 2016 and as of December 31, 2016. If the market value of the CEO’s common stock falls below the Guideline, the CEO must retain 50% of the shares he receives as compensation until he achieves the specified ownership level.

The aggregate amount of compensation, including the value of in-kind benefits, paid to our directors and senior management during fiscal year 2016 was $6,019,739. During 2016, the Group did not sponsor any deferred compensation plans (other than the equity compensation programs described below) and no amounts were set aside or accrued to provide pension, retirement or similar benefits to directors or senior management, other than employer matching contributions to retirement accounts on terms applicable to employees generally.

Short-Term Incentive Compensation

Senior management participates in our annual discretionary bonus program. Our compensation committee establishes an annual bonus pool based on overall company-wide performance during the applicable fiscal year. Once the compensation committee has approved the pool, the pool is allocated to eligible employees, including senior management, based on the employee's achievement of pre-established performance goals during the applicable fiscal year. Annual bonuses for executives are paid 50% in cash and 50% in the form of restricted share awards that vest in three equal installments on the first three anniversaries of the date of grant.

Equity Compensation

The Group sponsors two equity incentive plans, the 1997 Stock Option Plan for Employees (the “1997 Plan”) and the 2010 Omnibus Share Incentive Plan (the “2010 Plan”), in which our senior management and directors have been or are eligible to participate. The Group no longer grants equity awards under the 1997 Plan, although there are unvested stock options under the 1997 Plan that will remain outstanding through 2019. The Group previously granted options under the 2010 Plan and currently grants performance-vesting restricted share awards under the 2010 Plan. As of December 31, 2016, in the aggregate, our members of senior management held 500,000 options and 434,258 restricted shares (assuming that performance with respect to performance-vesting restricted share awards is satisfied at target levels). The outstanding options held by our members of senior management will expire by April 26, 2020 at the latest and have exercise prices ranging from $11.50 to $12.40.

191

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Senior management participates in our long-term equity incentive compensation program. Our compensation committee grants annual restricted share awards under our 2010 Plan. Restricted share awards granted in 2013, 2014, 2015 and 2016 were granted in the form of performance shares, generally vesting upon the achievement of certain performance targets in the three-year period from the effective grant date. Certain members of senior management also participate in our 2010 Executive Stock Purchase Plan, which allows participants to borrow against their common shares and vested options held in a restricted account to purchase common shares.

During calendar year 2016, in the aggregate, our compensation committee granted senior management 286,544 restricted shares (which includes restricted share awards granted under both the annual bonus program and long-term equity incentive compensation, and assumes that performance with respect to performance-vesting restricted share awards is satisfied at target levels).

The Group may from time to time in the future establish or sponsor new equity incentive plans, including to replace any existing plan.

Board Leadership Structure and Qualifications

The Bank must comply with the Bermuda Monetary Authority Corporate Governance Policy, which requires the Bank to appoint board members who have appropriate experience, competencies and personal qualities, including professionalism and personal integrity.

It is the Bank's policy to ensure that all companies within the Group have board members who are fit and proper persons to direct the Bank's business with prudence, integrity and professional skills. The boards of the Bank and the Bank's subsidiaries are comprised of individuals who possess diverse skills, experience and knowledge that are key to understanding the Bank's business and the execution of the Bank's strategies.

The Bank has established guidelines which address the size and composition of its own board and those of its subsidiaries, and for identifying and selecting suitable candidates for appointment to these boards. The Corporate Governance Committee makes appointment recommendations to the Board and the appointment procedure is formal, rigorous and transparent. Each of the Bank and the Bank's subsidiary boards are reviewed at least every two years or earlier whenever circumstances dictate in order to assess whether the board composition is commensurate with the Bank's strategic objective and diversity principles.

In assessing continuity of service on the Board there is a general presumption that individuals should serve for a maximum of 15 years in order that the Board tenure be refreshed. Non-executive directors who have served for a period of more than 15 years are subject to an independent assessment in accordance with applicable legal requirements and regulatory and listing standards.

Board Oversight of Risk Management

The Board believes that effective risk management and control processes are critical to our safety and soundness, our ability to predict and manage the challenges that we face and, ultimately, our long-term corporate success. The Board, both directly and through its committees, is responsible for overseeing our risk management processes, with each of the committees of the Board assuming a different and important role in overseeing the management of the risks we face.

The RPC oversees our enterprise-wide risk management framework, which establishes our overall risk appetite and risk management strategy and enables our management to understand, manage and report on the risks we face. Our RPC also reviews and oversees policies and practices established by management to identify, assess, measure and manage key risks we face, including the risk appetite metrics developed by management and approved by the Board. The Audit Committee of the Board is responsible for overseeing risks associated with financial, accounting and legal matters (particularly financial reporting, accounting practices and policies, disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting), reviewing and discussing generally the identification, assessment, management and control of our risk exposures on an enterprise-wide basis and engaging as appropriate with the RPC to assess our enterprise-wide risk framework. The compensation committee of the Board has primary responsibility for risks and exposures associated with our compensation policies, plans and

192

TABLE OF CONTENTS

practices, regarding both executive compensation and the compensation structure generally. In particular, our Compensation Committee, in conjunction with our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Risk Officer and other members of our management as appropriate, reviews our incentive compensation arrangements to ensure these programs are consistent with applicable laws and regulations, including safety and soundness requirements, and do not encourage imprudent or excessive risk-taking by our employees. The Corporate Governance Committee of the Board oversees risks associated with the independence of the Board and potential conflicts of interest.

Our senior management is responsible for implementing and reporting to the Board regarding our risk management processes, including by assessing and managing the risks we face, including strategic, operational, regulatory, investment and execution risks, on a day-to-day basis. Our senior management is also responsible for creating and recommending to the Board for approval appropriate risk appetite metrics reflecting the aggregate levels and types of risk we are willing to accept in connection with the operation of our business and pursuit of our business objectives.

The role of the Board in our risk oversight is consistent with our leadership structure, with our Chief Executive Officer and the other members of senior management having responsibility for assessing and managing our risk exposure, and the Board and its committees providing oversight in connection with those efforts. We believe this division of risk management responsibilities presents a consistent, systemic and effective approach for identifying, managing and mitigating risks throughout our operations.

Code of Conduct and Ethics and Whistleblower Policy

The Board has adopted a Group Code of Conduct and Ethics (the “Code”) based upon recommended principles of corporate governance. The Code sets out the guidelines and procedures for establishing a high standard of ethical conduct, accountability and transparency to which all of our employees are expected to comply and which are consistent with our high standards of ethics and core values. The Board, in conjunction with the Corporate Governance Committee, is responsible for administering the Code. Copies of the Code can be accessed on www.butterfieldgroup.com.

The Board has adopted a Whistleblower Policy which augments the Code. The policy is designed to serve as a tool to assist employees who believe they have or may have discovered illegal, unethical, or questionable practices to communicate their concerns confidentially and without fear of reprisals. It is also designed to protect the integrity of the Bank's financial reporting and its business dealings.

Foreign Private Issuer Status

The listing rules of the NYSE include certain accommodations in the corporate governance requirements that allow foreign private issuers, such as us, to follow “home country” corporate governance practices in lieu of the otherwise applicable corporate governance standards of the NYSE applicable to listed US companies and we intend to continue to follow Bermuda corporate governance practices. We are required to disclose the significant ways in which our corporate governance practices differ from NYSE listing standards applicable to listed US companies. Set forth below are two NYSE listing standards applicable to listed US companies which are not applicable to us, and which we have not adopted:

Nominating/Corporate Governance Committee. The NYSE requires a listed US company to have a nominating/corporate governance committee of independent directors and a committee charter specifying the purpose, duties and evaluation procedures of the committee. We currently have a Corporate Governance Committee and a Compensation and Human Resources Committee, but the composition of those committees, particularly in respect of the independence of their members, is determined pursuant to our corporate governance guidelines, not NYSE standards for a listed US company.
Executive Sessions. The NYSE requires that non-management directors meet regularly in executive sessions without management. The NYSE also requires that all independent directors meet in an executive session at least once a year. Our non-management directors meet regularly in executive session without management present, but in 2016, we did not have an executive session with only our independent directors present.

193

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Set forth below are other requirements of the NYSE standards applicable to listed US companies, which are not applicable to us, but which we have nonetheless adopted:

A Majority of Independent Directors. The NYSE requires the board of directors of a listed US company to be composed of a majority of independent directors pursuant to current NYSE standards. Six of the nine members of our Board (Messrs. Barbour, Burr, Foulger, Schoellkopf, Wright, and Zwiener) are independent according to the NYSE's standards for independence applicable to a foreign private issuer.
An Audit Committee. The NYSE requires a listed US company to have, among other things, an audit committee with a minimum of three members, all of whom are independent. As permitted by Rule 10A-3 under the Exchange Act, our audit committee consists of four directors who are all independent members of our Board (Messrs. Barbour, Burr, Foulger and Zwiener).
Corporate Governance Guidelines. The NYSE requires a listed US company to adopt and disclose corporate governance guidelines that address, among other things, director qualification standards, director responsibilities, director access to management and independent advisers, director compensation, director orientation and continuing education, management succession and an annual performance evaluation. We have adopted and disclosed our corporate governance guidelines and our Group Code of Conduct and Ethics.

We believe that our established corporate governance practice satisfies the NYSE listing standards applicable to foreign private issuers. If at any time we cease to be a “foreign private issuer” under the rules of the NYSE, and no other exemptions apply, or if we otherwise so elect, the Board will take all action necessary to comply with NYSE corporate governance rules applicable to listed US companies, including establishing certain committees composed entirely of independent directors, subject to a permitted “phase-in” period.

194

TABLE OF CONTENTS

PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS AND SELLING SHAREHOLDERS

The following table sets forth information with respect to the beneficial ownership of our common shares as of the most recent practicable date and following this offering, in each case by: each person or entity known by us to beneficially own 5% or more of our issued and outstanding common shares; each selling shareholder; each of our directors and executive officers individually; and all of our directors and executive officers as a group. As of the date of this prospectus, we have 53,300,372 common shares issued and outstanding, of which Carlyle, our principal shareholder, owns approximately 14%.

Under the rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission, a person is deemed to be a “beneficial owner” of a security if that person has or shares “voting power,” which includes the power to vote or to direct the voting of such security, or “investment power,” which includes the power to dispose of or to direct the disposition of such security. A person is also deemed to be a beneficial owner of any securities of which that person has a right to acquire beneficial ownership within 60 days. Under these rules, more than one person may be deemed to be a beneficial owner of such securities as to which such person has voting or investment power. Except as described in the footnotes below, to our knowledge, each of the persons named in the table below has sole voting and investment power with respect to the common shares beneficially owned, subject to community property laws where applicable.

Unless otherwise noted, the address for each shareholder listed on the table below is: c/o The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited, 65 Front Street, Hamilton, HM 12, Bermuda.

Name of beneficial owner
Number of
common
shares
beneficially
owned prior
to the
offering
Beneficial
ownership
percentage
Number of
common
shares being
sold in the
offering by
such selling
shareholder
Number of
common
shares
beneficially
owned after
this offering
assuming no
exercise of
the option to
purchase
additional
shares from
the selling
shareholders
Beneficial
ownership
percentage
Number of
common
shares
beneficially
owned after
this offering
assuming
exercise of
the option to
purchase
additional
shares from
the selling
shareholders
Beneficial
ownership
percentage
Principal and Selling Shareholders:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Entities affiliated with The Carlyle Group L.P.(1)
 
7,632,569
 
 
14.3
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The Wellcome Trust Limited as trustee of The Wellcome Trust(2)
 
1,856,594
 
 
3.5
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Wellington Management Group LLP (3)
 
5,082,470
 
 
9.5
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Rosebowl Western Ltd(4)
 
2,623,624
 
 
4.9
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Directors and Executive Officers:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Alastair Barbour
 
9,356
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
9,356
 
 
 
*
 
9,356
 
 
 
*
Elizabeth Bauman(5)
 
640
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
640
 
 
 
*
 
640
 
 
 
*
James F. Burr
 
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
 
*
Michael Collins(6)
 
572,466
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
572,466
 
 
 
*
 
572,466
 
 
 
*
Caroline Foulger
 
6,529
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
6,529
 
 
 
*
 
6,529
 
 
 
*
Daniel Frumkin(7)
 
155,915
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
155,915
 
 
 
*
 
155,915
 
 
 
*
Shaun Morris(8)
 
47,941
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
47,941
 
 
 
*
 
47,941
 
 
 
*
Conor O'Dea(9)
 
443,772
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Wolfgang Schoellkopf
 
22,878
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
22,878
 
 
 
*
 
22,878
 
 
 
*
Michael Schrum(10)
 
33,030
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
33,030
 
 
 
*
 
33,030
 
 
 
*
E. Barclay Simmons
 
16,520
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
16,520
 
 
 
*
 
16,520
 
 
 
*
John R. Wright
 
18,500
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
18,500
 
 
 
*
 
18,500
 
 
 
*
David Zwiener
 
1,055
 
 
 
*
 
 
 
1,055
 
 
 
*
 
1,055
 
 
 
*
All directors and executive officers as a group (13 persons)
 
1,328,602
 
 
2.5
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
*Indicates less than 1%
(1)Consists of (i) 7,130,063 common shares held by Carlyle Global Financial Services Partners, L.P., and (ii) 502,506 common shares held by CGFSP Coinvestment, L.P. Carlyle Group Management L.L.C. is the general partner of The Carlyle Group L.P., which is a publicly traded entity listed on NASDAQ. The Carlyle Group L.P. is the managing member of Carlyle Holdings II GP L.L.C., which is the general partner of Carlyle Holdings II L.P., which is the general partner of TC Group Cayman Investment Holdings, L.P., which is the general partner of TC Group Cayman Investment Holdings Sub L.P., which is the sole shareholder

195

TABLE OF CONTENTS

of Carlyle Financial Services, Ltd., which is the general partner of TCG Financial Services, L.P., which is the general partner of each of Carlyle Global Financial Services Partners, L.P. and CGFSP Coinvestment, L.P. The address for each of Carlyle Group Management L.L.C., The Carlyle Group L.P., Carlyle Holdings II GP L.L.C., and Carlyle Holdings II L.P. is c/o The Carlyle Group, 1001 Pennsylvania Ave. NW, Suite 220 South, Washington, D.C. 20004 2505. The address for each of the other reporting persons listed in this footnote is c/o Walkers, Cayman Corporate Center, 27 Hospital Road, George Town, Grand Cayman KY1 9008, Cayman Islands. Voting and investment determinations with respect to the common shares held by each of Carlyle Global Financial Services Partners, L.P. and CGFSP Coinvestment, L.P. are made by an investment committee of TCG Financial Services L.P. comprised of Daniel A. DiAniello, William E. Conway, David M. Rubenstein, Kewsong Lee, James Hance, Glenn A. Youngkin, Eliot Merrill, Thomas Mayrhofer. Each member of the investment committees disclaims beneficial ownership of such common shares.

(2)Responsibility for the activities of The Wellcome Trust, which includes voting and dispositive control over the common shares lies with the Board of Governors of The Wellcome Trust Limited, which is comprised of Eliza Manningham Buller, Kay Davies, Tobias Bonhoeffer, Alan Brown, Damon Buffini, William Burns, Michael Ferguson, Bryan Grenfell and Anne Johnson. The Board of Governors share all voting and dispositive control with respect to the common shares held by The Wellcome Trust Limited as trustee of the Wellcome Trust. The address of each of the persons and entities affiliated with The Wellcome Trust Limited as trustee of the Wellcome Trust is 215 Euston Road, London NW12BE, United Kingdom.
(3)Based on the Schedule 13G, filed on February 9, 2017 by Wellington Management Group LLP and certain of its investment adviser subsidiaries (Wellington Group Holdings LLP, Wellington Investment Advisors Holdings LLP and Wellington Management Company LLP), which reported that, as of December 31, 2016, the group beneficially owned 5,082,470 shares with shared voting power over 5,041,878 common shares and shared dispositive power over 5,082,470 common shares. The address of Wellington Management Group LLP is 280 Congress Street, Boston, MA 02210 USA.
(4)Based on our prospectus filed with the SEC on September 16, 2016. Prior to the completion of our IPO and the exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional shares from the selling shareholders in our IPO, (i) 2,643,773 common shares were held by Rosebowl Western Ltd, and (ii) 1,079,851 common shares were held by Rosebowl Western LLC. The address of Rosebowl Western Ltd is c/o Codan Trust Co (BVI) Ltd., Commerce House Wickhams Cay 1, P.O. Box 3140 Road Town Tortola VG 1110 British Virgin Islands. Christopher T. Snyder is the president of Rosebowl Western Ltd. and Rosebowl Western LLC and may be deemed to have voting and dispositive control over the common shares held by Rosebowl Western Ltd. and Rosebowl Western LLC.
(5)Consists of 640 common shares underlying restricted share awards granted under our annual discretionary bonus program, which will vest on February 24, 2017.
(6)Consists of (i) 64,207 common shares held by Mr. Collins directly, (ii) 400,000 shares underlying vested but unexercised options, exercisable at strike prices between $11.50 to $12.40, (iii) 17,350 common shares underlying restricted share awards granted under our annual discretionary bonus program, which will vest on February 24, 2017, (iv) 20,217 common shares underlying performance-based equity awards granted under our long-term equity incentive compensation program, which are expected to vest on February 27, 2017, pending our Board's confirmation that previously established performance goals have been achieved, and (v) 90,909 common shares beneficially owned by Mr. Collins through D&O Lockup 201 Account. See “Management's — Current Executive Compensation Arrangements — Equity Compensation”.
(7)Consists of (i) 49,094 common shares held by Mr. Frumkin directly, (ii) 100,000 shares underlying vested but unexercised options, exercisable at strike prices between $11.50 to $12.40, (iii) 6,821 common shares underlying restricted share awards granted under our annual discretionary bonus program, which will vest on February 24, 2017, (iv) 11,197 common shares underlying performance-based equity awards granted under our long-term equity incentive compensation program, which are expected to vest on February 27, 2017, pending our Board's confirmation that previously established performance goals have been achieved. See “Management's — Current Executive Compensation Arrangements — Equity Compensation”.
(8)Consists of (i) 40,368 common shares held by Mr. Morris directly, (ii) 7,573 common shares underlying restricted share awards granted under our annual discretionary bonus program, which will vest on February 24, 2017, and (iii) 12,442 common shares underlying performance-based equity awards granted under our long-term equity incentive compensation program, which are expected to vest on February 27, 2017, pending our Board's confirmation that previously established performance goals have been achieved. See “Management's — Current Executive Compensation Arrangements — Equity Compensation”.
(9)Consists of 43,772 common shares held by Mr. O'Dea directly and 400,000 shares underlying vested but unexercised options, exercisable at strike prices between $11.50 to $12.40. Goldman, Sachs & Co., Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and Sandler O’Neill & Partners, L.P., the book-running managers in our IPO, will be releasing a lock-up restriction with respect to           common shares held by Mr. O’Dea. The release will take effect on or about February 21, 2017, and the shares may be sold on or after such date.
(10)Consists of (i) 12,764 common shares held by Mr. Schrum together with his spouse, Vanessa Schrum, (ii) 14,266 common shares underlying restricted share awards granted under our annual discretionary bonus program, which will vest on February 24, 2017. and (iii) 6,000 common shares held by Mr. Schrum through Pershing Account. Mr. Schrum exercises voting and dispositive control over the common shares held by Pershing. Mr. Schrum disclaims beneficial ownership of such common shares, except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein.

The shareholders listed above do not have voting rights that are different from those held by any other holder of common shares of the Bank. See also “Our Relationship with The Carlyle Group and Related Party Transactions — Amended Investment Agreement”.

As of January 31, 2017, 35.94% of our common shares were held of record by holders located in the United States and there were approximately 200 holders of record of our common shares located in the United States. As of January 31, 2017, 55.22% of our common shares were held of record by holders located in Bermuda, and there were approximately 5,000 holders of record of our common shares located in Bermuda.

196

TABLE OF CONTENTS

OUR RELATIONSHIP WITH THE CARLYLE GROUP AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

Our Relationship with The Carlyle Group

Carlyle currently holds approximately 14% of our equity voting power along with the right to designate two persons for nomination for election by the shareholders as members of the Board.

Investment Agreement

In connection with the subscription by Carlyle and certain other investors for newly issued common shares and preference shares that have since been converted to our common shares, we entered into an Investment Agreement, dated as of March 2, 2010 (the “Investment Agreement”) with Carlyle. The Investment Agreement provides for, among other items, subject to the terms set forth in the Investment Agreement, certain transfer restrictions and Carlyle's right to designate two persons for nomination for election by the shareholders as members of the Board. The Investment Agreement also contained certain standstill and other provisions which have generally expired.

Amended Investment Agreement

Prior to our IPO, we entered into an Amended and Restated Investment Agreement with Carlyle (the “Amended Investment Agreement”).

The Amended Investment Agreement provides that, subject to certain exceptions for ordinary public market trades, Carlyle may not transfer our common shares it holds to any person or group if, to its knowledge, such transferee (directly or together with its affiliates) would own 10% or more of the outstanding voting power in the Bank.

In addition, the Amended Investment Agreement provides that (a) until our common shares held by Carlyle represent less than 10% of our issued and outstanding common shares, Carlyle will be entitled to nominate two persons for election as members of the Board and (b) if our common shares held by Carlyle represent less than 10% but at least 5% of our issued and outstanding common shares, Carlyle will be entitled to nominate one person for election as a member of the Board (such nominees, “Carlyle Directors”), in each case subject to the Carlyle Directors' satisfaction of legal requirements regarding services as a director. The Amended Investment Agreement provides that we will use our reasonable best efforts to cause the Carlyle Directors to be elected to the Board and will solicit proxies for the Carlyle Directors to the same extent that we do for our other nominees to the Board, and that if requested by Carlyle, one Carlyle Director chosen by Carlyle would be appointed to certain committees and subcommittees of the Board.

Under the terms set forth in the Amended Investment Agreement, until our common shares held by Carlyle represent less than 5% of our issued and outstanding common shares, we have also agreed to share certain financial and other information with Carlyle and Carlyle is generally obliged to treat information provided to it as confidential, and to comply with all applicable rules and regulations in relation to the use and disclosure of such information.

This summary does not purport to be a comprehensive description of the Amended Investment Agreement, and is qualified in its entirety by the full text of the Amended Investment Agreement filed as an exhibit to the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part.

Financing Transactions

On June 27, 2013, the Group executed a $95 million loan agreement with an investment fund managed by The Carlyle Group which provided for maturity on June 30, 2017. This loan was made in the ordinary course of business on normal commercial terms and was repaid in full according to its terms on August 11, 2015. In 2016, nil (2015: $1.0 million) of interest income was recognized in the consolidated statements of operations.

Transactions with Related Parties and with Directors and Executive Officers

Financing Transactions

As of May 17, 2005, we established a program to offer loans with preferential rates to eligible Group employees, subject to certain conditions set by the Group and provided that such employees meet certain credit criteria. Loan payments are serviced by automatically debiting the employee's checking or savings

197

TABLE OF CONTENTS

account with the Bank. Applications for loans are handled according to the same policies as those for our regular retail banking clients. Our ability to offer preferential rates on loans depends upon a number of factors, including market conditions, regulations and the Group's overall profitability. The Group has the right to change its employee loan policy at any time after notifying participants. The non-executive employee loans outstanding at December 31, 2016 amount to $123.2 million (December, 31 2015: $204.3 million) resulting in an interest rate benefit to non-executive employees of $3.7 million (December, 31 2015: $5.3 million, December, 31 2014: $6.2 million).

Certain directors and executives of the Bank, companies in which they are principal owners, and trusts in which they are involved, have loans with the Bank. Loans to directors were made in the ordinary course of business, on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with other persons, and did not involve more than the normal risk of collectibility or present other unfavorable features. Loans to executives may be eligible to preferential rates as described in the preceding paragraph. As at December 31, 2016, related party director and executive loan balances were $12.1 million (December, 31, 2015: $63.9 million). During the year ended December, 31 2016, new issuance of loans and change in directorships to directors and executives were $27.6 million and repayments and change in directorships were $25.1 million (year ended December 31, 2015: $17.5 and $17.4 million respectively, year ended December 31, 2014: $18.4 and $25.2 million respectively). Also, during the year ended December 31, 2016, a director resigned from the Board resulting in $54.3 million in loans being reclassified out of related party loans. All of these loans were considered performing loans at as December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015.

Butterfield Asset Management

Butterfield Asset Management Limited (“BAM”), a Bermuda-based asset manager that is part of the Group, entered into an agreement in May 2015 to solicit investments from BAM's high net worth clients to invest in a fund of funds vehicle for certain Carlyle funds. BAM is the general partner of the fund of funds vehicle which has invested in multiple entities affiliated with Carlyle. Pursuant to the agreement, Carlyle pays BAM a placement fee of 2% of the amount of capital committed by the BAM fund of funds vehicle to the Carlyle funds. The agreement was negotiated on an arm's-length basis and provides for customary terms consistent with those contained in similar arrangements entered into by each of BAM and Carlyle. The aggregate amount of revenue received by BAM in 2016 pursuant to the arrangement was $nil (year-ended December 31, 2015 - $0.9 million; year ended December 31, 2014 - nil). As of December 31, 2015 the assets under management for this fund of funds vehicle was $27.1 million.

Equity Repurchases

On August 13, 2015, we repurchased and canceled 400,000 common shares held by two directors for $14.90 per share, for a total of $6.0 million. Figures reflect the reverse share split that the Bank effected on September 6, 2016. For more information, see “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares — Reverse Share Split”.

Employment Agreements

The Group has entered into employment agreements with senior management. The compensation paid in 2016 to senior management under the employment agreements is described above under “Management — Current Executive Compensation Arrangements”. The senior management employment agreements generally provide for terms and conditions of employment, including the payment of a base salary, participation in the Group’s short- and long-term incentive compensation programs, notice provisions, severance benefits, change in control equity award vesting and participation in the Group’s health, welfare and retirement programs available to all senior executives. For certain members of senior management, the employment agreements also provide for executive life insurance and participation in the Group’s share purchase programs.

Related Party Transaction Policy

The Board has adopted a written policy governing the review, approval or ratification of transactions between the Bank or any of its subsidiaries and any “related party,” which is a person or entity: (1) that controls, is controlled by, or is under common control with the Bank; (2) that is an associate of the Bank;

198

TABLE OF CONTENTS

(3) that is a shareholder of the Bank that has significant influence by virtue of its ownership of the Bank; (4) that is a director, executive officer or other key management person at the Bank; or (5) in which a substantial interest in its voting power is held by the persons described in (3) or (4) above. The policy calls for the related person transactions to be reviewed and, if deemed appropriate, approved or ratified by our Audit Committee. In determining whether or not to approve or ratify a related person transaction, our Audit Committee takes into account, among other factors it deems important, whether the related person transaction is in our best interests and whether the transaction is on terms no less favorable than terms generally available to an unaffiliated third party under the same or similar circumstances. In the event that a member of our Audit Committee is not disinterested with respect to the related person transaction under review, that member may not participate in the review, approval or ratification of that related person transaction.

199

TABLE OF CONTENTS

DESCRIPTION OF SHARE CAPITAL

The following description of the Bank's share capital summarizes the material provisions of the Butterfield Act and of the bye-laws of the Bank. Such summaries are subject to, and are qualified in their entirety by reference to, all of the provisions of these documents, copies of which have been filed as exhibits to the registration statement of which this prospectus forms a part, and applicable law.

General

The Bank is a local company incorporated under the laws of Bermuda. The Bank is registered with the Registrar of Companies in Bermuda under registration number 2106. The Bank was incorporated on October 22, 1904, pursuant to the Butterfield Act. The Bank's registered office is located at 65 Front Street, Hamilton, HM 12, Bermuda. The Bank's agent for service of process in the United States in connection with this offering is C T Corporation System, 111 Eighth Avenue, New York, New York 10011. The objects of our business are set out in clause 5 of the Butterfield Act and include carrying on banking business.

On August 30, 2016, the Bank's shareholders approved certain amendments to the Bank's bye-laws, which included the following amendments: (i) removal of sections of the bye-laws that were not applicable for a NYSE listed company with respect to financial assistance and forfeiture of shares, (ii) the transfer and transmission of Company shares that are listed or admitted for trading on a stock exchange (including the NYSE) be governed by the rules and regulations of such stock exchange (iii) certain requirements in which shareholders must comply in order to propose business at general meetings, (iv) in the absence of fraud or dishonesty shareholders waive any claim or right of action such shareholder may have, including derivative actions, against any director or officer on account of any action such director or officer undertook in the performance of their duties, and (v) the auditor of the Company must satisfy the independence requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act 2002 and the listing standards and regulations of the NYSE and BSX.

Since December 31, 2013, other than (i) the common share buy-back program and preference share buy-back program described in “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Contingent Value Convertible Preference Shares — Share Buy-Back Program”, (ii) the conversion of our contingent value convertible preference shares to common shares at a conversion ratio of 1:1 on March 31, 2015, (iii) our repurchase and cancellation of 8,000,000 common shares held by CIBC for $15.00 per share on April 30, 2015, (iv) our repurchase and cancellation of 400,000 common shares held by two directors for $14.90 per share on August 13, 2015, (v) our mandatory redemption of the preference shares on December 15, 2016 and (vi) the repurchase and cancellation of the warrant issued to the Government of Bermuda in connection with the preference share redemption, there have been no material changes to the Bank's share capital, no mergers or amalgamations of the Bank or any of its subsidiaries, and no name changes. Since that date, there have also been no insolvency, receivership or similar proceedings with respect to the Bank or its subsidiaries.

Share Capital

As a result of the ten-to-one reverse share split, the authorized share capital of the Bank is divided into four classes of shares (1) 2 billion common shares, par value BMD $0.01 each, (2) 6 billion non-voting ordinary shares, par value BMD $0.01 each, (3) 110,200,001 preference shares, par value $0.01 each (“Dollar Preference Shares”) and (4) 50 million preference shares, par value £0.01 each (the “Sterling preference shares” and, together with the Dollar Preference Shares, the “preference shares”).

As of the date of this prospectus, there are 53,284,872 common shares issued and outstanding. None of the preference shares or non-voting ordinary shares are issued and outstanding. All of the Bank's issued and outstanding common shares are fully paid.

Pursuant to the Bank's bye-laws, subject to any resolution of the shareholders to the contrary and to compliance with NYSE listing rules, the Board is authorized to issue any of the Bank's authorized but unissued shares. There are certain notification and prior approval requirements pursuant to the BMA authority and the BDCA with respect to any person who seeks to become a significant shareholder or shareholder controller of the Bank.

200

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Under the BDCA, any person who becomes a significant shareholder of a deposit-taking institution, which is defined to include persons, either individually or with associates, who (i) hold 5% or more of the shares in the institution or another company of which it is a subsidiary company; or (ii) is entitled to exercise, or control the exercise of, 5% or more of the voting power at any general meeting of the institution or of another company of which it is such a subsidiary, must notify the BMA in writing of that fact within seven days. Failure to provide the BMA with prompt and appropriate notice would constitute an offense that could result in a fine.

The BDCA prohibits a person from becoming a shareholder controller of any company licensed under the BDCA unless the person provides written notice to the BMA of his intent to do so and the BMA does not object. The definition of shareholder controller is set out in the BDCA but generally refers to a person who, among other things, either alone or with any associate or associates (within the meaning of the BDCA) (i) holds 10% or more of the shares in the licensed institution or another company of which it is a subsidiary company; or (ii) is entitled to exercise, or control the exercise of 10% or more of the voting power at any general meeting of the licensed institution or another company of which it is such a subsidiary.

A person who intends to become a shareholder controller, or a shareholder controller who intends to increase his shareholding/control, meaning generally, ownership of shares or the ability to exercise or control the exercise of voting rights attached to shares, beyond his present threshold, must provide written notice to the BMA that he intends to do so. The BMA may object to a shareholder controller's request to acquire additional shares/control. If a person acts in spite of the BMA's objection, the BMA may take certain actions specified in the BDCA, including revoking the relevant license under the BDCA. For more information, see the summaries of relevant provisions of the BDCA regulations under “Supervision and Regulation — Bermuda — Banks and Deposit Companies Act 1999”.

In addition to these restrictions, pursuant to the Bank's bye-laws, any person who is not “Bermudian” (as such term is defined in the Companies Act) who is “interested” (as such term is defined in the bye-laws) in shares of the Bank which constitute more than 40% of all of the shares of the Bank then issued and outstanding shall not be entitled to vote the shares which are in excess of such 40% interest at any general meeting of the Bank without the prior written approval of the Minister of Finance.

As of December 31, 2016, options to purchase 2.1 million (December 31, 2015: 2.8 million) common shares were outstanding. As of December 31, 2016, the number of outstanding awards of unvested, restricted common shares was 0.9 million (December 31, 2015: 0.8 million). Only awards for which the sum of (1) the expense that will be recognized in the future (i.e., the unrecognized expense) and (2) its exercise price, if any, was lower than the average market price of the common shares were considered dilutive and, therefore, included in the computation of diluted earnings per share. An award's unrecognized expense is also considered to be the proceeds the employees would need to pay to purchase accelerated vesting of the awards. For purposes of calculating dilution, such proceeds are assumed to be used by the Bank to buy back common shares at the average market price. The weighted-average number of outstanding awards, net of the assumed weighted-average number of common shares bought back, is included in the number of diluted participating shares.

Common Shares

Rights of Holders of the Bank's Common Shares

Holders of common shares have no pre-emptive, redemption, conversion or sinking fund rights. Holders of common shares are entitled to one vote per share on all matters submitted to a vote of holders of common shares. Unless a different majority is required by law or by the Bank's bye-laws, resolutions to be approved by holders of common shares require approval by the affirmative votes of a majority of votes cast at a general meeting at which a quorum is present.

In the event of our dissolution or winding up, the holders of common shares are entitled to the surplus assets of the Bank, subject to any liquidation preference on any issued and outstanding preference shares.

Pursuant to the Bank's bye-laws, the following actions (each, a “Super-Majority Action”) require approval by the affirmative vote of not less than two-thirds of all voting rights attached to all issued and

201

TABLE OF CONTENTS

outstanding shares, unless such Super-Majority Action has received prior approval by the Board: (i) removal of a director other than for cause; (ii) approval of an amalgamation, merger or consolidation with or into any other person, arrangement, reconstruction or sale, lease, conveyance, exchange or other transfer of all or substantially all the Bank's assets, or in each case, an equivalent transaction; and (iii) commencement of proceedings seeking winding-up, liquidation or reorganization of the Bank.

Pursuant to the Bank's bye-laws, certain bye-laws including those relating to approval of a Super-Majority Action may only be amended pursuant to an affirmative vote of not less than 66% of all directors then in office and by a resolution of shareholders including the affirmative vote of not less than 66% of the votes attaching to all shares in issue. For more information see “— Amendment of Butterfield Act and Bye-laws”.

Reverse Share Split

On September 6, 2016, the Bank effected a 10:1 reverse share split of the common shares such that: every 10 common shares at par value BM $0.01 consolidated into one common share par value BM $0.10, and the Bank’s authorized share capital was immediately reduced such that the par value of each of the consolidated common shares was reduced to BM $0.01. No fractional common shares were issued in connection with the reverse share split, and all such fractional interests were rounded down to the nearest whole number of common shares. Shareholders who would have otherwise held a fractional share of the Bank's common shares as a result of the reverse share split received a cash payment in lieu of such fractional common share. Issued and outstanding share options and warrants were adjusted on the same basis and exercise prices will be adjusted accordingly.

Preference Shares

Pursuant to the Bank's bye-laws, the Board by resolution may provide for the issuance of preference shares in one or more series and to establish from time to time the number of preference shares to be included in each such series and to fix the terms, including the designation, powers, preferences, rights qualifications, limitations and restrictions of the preference shares of each series such that the authority of the Board with respect to each series shall include, but not be limited to, determination of, dividend rates, voting rights, conversion or exchange rights, redemption rights, liquidation rights and other relative participation, optional or other special rights, qualifications, limitations or restrictions as may be fixed by the board of directors without any further shareholder approval. Such rights, preferences, powers and limitations as may be established could have the effect of discouraging an attempt to obtain control of the Bank.

The following table presents the number and principal amount of the Bank's issued and outstanding preference shares as of period-end and dividends and guarantee fees of preference shares for the periods indicated.

 
For the year ended
December 31,
(in millions of $, unless otherwise indicated)
2016
2015
 
(audited)
Number (in millions)
 
 
 
0.2
 
Aggregate principal amount
 
 
 
182.9
 
Dividends and guarantee fee
 
16.3
 
 
16.5
 

Dollar Preference Shares

In June 2009, the Bank offered 200,000 Dollar Preference Shares of par value $0.01 with a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share and $200,000,000 in the aggregate with such designations, powers, preferences, rights, qualifications, limitations and restrictions as set out in the Certificate of Designation of the Dollar Preference Shares (the “DPS Certificate of Designation”). The Dollar Preference Shares were fully and unconditionally guaranteed, with the full faith and credit of the Government of Bermuda, as to payment of dividends for up to 10 years and as to payment of the liquidation preference on, or in certain circumstances prior to, the ten-year anniversary of the date of the

202

TABLE OF CONTENTS

first issuance of the Dollar Preference Shares pursuant to that certain Preference Shares Guarantee Agreement dated as of June 22, 2009 by and among the Government of Bermuda, the Bank and The Bank of New York Mellon as Guarantee Trustee (as such term is defined in the Guarantee).

On December 15, 2016, with the approval of the BMA, the Bank exercised its option to redeem all the Dollar Preference Shares out of funds legally available therefor, at a redemption price equal to the make-whole redemption price of $1,180.00 per Dollar Preference Share to holders of record of the Dollar Preference Shares as at December 1, 2016. The make-whole redemption price comprised the sum of the dividend per Dollar Preference Share for the current quarter, the $1,000 liquidation preference per Dollar Preference Share, discounted for present value, and the present value of future dividend payments through June 22, 2019. Accordingly, as of the date hereof, there are no Dollar Preference Shares in issue.

Sterling Preference Shares

To date, no Sterling preference shares have been issued and, therefore, the Sterling preference shares have not been designated nor have the rights, preferences, powers or limitations thereof been established.

Contingent Value Convertible Preference Shares

In May 2010, the Bank issued approximately 0.8 million CVCP shares. A holder of CVCP shares had the option to convert any such shares to common shares at any time.

On March 31, 2015, all remaining CVCP shares were converted to common shares at a ratio of one-to-one. Accordingly, as of the date hereof, there are no authorized CVCP shares in existence.

Dividend Rights

Under Bermuda law, a company may not declare or pay dividends if there are reasonable grounds for believing that: (i) the company is, or would after the payment be, unable to pay its liabilities as they become due; or (ii) that the realizable value of its assets would thereby be less than its liabilities. Under the Bank's bye-laws, each common share is entitled to such dividends that the Board may from time to time declare.

Any cash dividends payable to holders of the common shares listed on the NYSE will be paid to Computershare Inc., our transfer agent in the United States for disbursement to those holders.

Although we expect to pay dividends according to our dividend policy, we may elect not to pay dividends. Any declarations of dividends will be at the discretion of the Board, subject to BMA approval, and such dividends may be declared and paid by the Board only as permitted under applicable law. In determining the amount of any future dividends, the Board may take into account: (1) our financial results; (2) our available cash, as well as anticipated cash requirements (including debt servicing); (3) our capital requirements, including the capital requirements of our subsidiaries; (4) contractual, legal, tax and regulatory restrictions on, and implications of, the payment of dividends by us to our shareholders; (5) general economic and business conditions; (6) restrictions applicable to us and our subsidiaries under Bermuda and other applicable laws, regulations and policies, including the requirement to obtain the BMA's prior approval for the payment of dividends on our common shares; and (7) any other factors that the Board may deem relevant. Therefore, there can be no assurance that we will declare or pay any dividends to holders of the common shares, or as to the amount of any such dividends.

Variation of Rights

If at any time the Bank has more than one class of shares, the rights attaching to any class, unless otherwise provided for by the terms of issue of the relevant class, may be varied either: (i) with the consent in writing of the holders of three-fourths of the issued shares of that class; or (ii) with the sanction of a resolution passed by a majority of the votes cast at a separate general meeting of the relevant class of shareholders at which a quorum consisting of at least two persons holding or representing in proxy one-third of the issued shares of the relevant class is present. The Bank's bye-laws specify that the creation or issue of shares ranking equally with existing shares will not, unless expressly provided by the terms of issue of the shares of that class, vary the rights attached to existing shares. In addition, the

203

TABLE OF CONTENTS

creation or issue of preference shares whether or not ranking prior to common shares will not be deemed to vary the rights attached to common shares or, subject to the terms of any other series of preference shares, to vary the rights attached to any other series of preference shares.

Transfer of Shares

Shares that are listed or admitted to trading on the NYSE or BSX shall be transferred in accordance with the rules and regulations of the applicable exchange. See “Supervision and Regulation”. Subject to these restrictions, a holder of common shares may transfer the title to all or any of his common shares by completing a form of transfer in the form set out in the Bank's bye-laws (or as near thereto as circumstances admit) or in such other form as the Board may accept. The instrument of transfer must be signed by the transferor and transferee, although in the case of a fully paid share the Board may accept the instrument signed only by the transferor.

Differences in Corporate Law

We are incorporated under the laws of Bermuda. The laws applicable to Bermuda companies may differ in certain respects from the laws applicable to corporations incorporated in the United States. Within our discussions below of the Companies Act and the rights and obligations as set forth in the Butterfield Act and our bye-laws, we have summarized the significant differences between the rights of holders of our common shares and the rights of holders of common stock of a typical corporation incorporated under the laws of Delaware. This discussion does not purport to be a complete statement of the rights of holders of our common shares under the Companies Act and the Butterfield Act and our bye-laws or the rights of holders of common stock of a typical corporation under applicable Delaware law and a typical certificate of incorporation and bylaws.

Meetings of Shareholders

Under Bermuda law, a company is required to convene at least one general meeting of shareholders each calendar year (the “annual general meeting”). However, the shareholders may by resolution waive this requirement, either for a specific year or a specified number of years, or indefinitely. When the requirement has been so waived, any member may, on notice to the company, terminate the waiver, in which case an annual general meeting must be called.

Bermuda law provides that a special general meeting of shareholders may be called by the board of directors of a company and must be called upon the request of shareholders holding not less than one-tenth of the paid-up capital of the company carrying the right to vote at general meetings. Bermuda law also requires that shareholders be given at least five days' advance notice of a general meeting, but the accidental omission to give notice to any person does not invalidate the proceedings at a meeting. The Bank's bye-laws provide that the chairman or the Board may convene an annual general meeting or a special general meeting. Under the Bank's bye-laws, at least 21 days' notice of an annual general meeting or a special general meeting must be given to each shareholder entitled to attend and vote at such meeting. This notice requirement is subject to the ability to hold such meetings on shorter notice if such notice is agreed: (i) in the case of an annual general meeting by all of the shareholders entitled to attend and vote at such meeting; or (ii) in the case of a special general meeting by a majority in number of the shareholders entitled to attend and vote at the meeting holding not less than 95% in nominal value of the shares entitled to vote at such meeting. The quorum required for a general meeting of shareholders is two or more persons present in person at the start of the meeting and representing in person or by proxy in excess of 25% of the total issued voting shares. In addition, the Bank's bye-laws provide that shareholders must adhere to certain advance notice requirements with respect to business to be proposed at general meetings.

Pursuant to the Bank's bye-laws, Super-Majority Actions require approval by the affirmative vote of not less than two-thirds of all voting rights attached to all issued and outstanding shares, unless such Super-Majority Action has been approved by the Board. In addition, shareholders may not act by written consent under our bye-laws.

Variance from Delaware: In contrast to our bye-laws, which do not allow shareholders to act by written consent, stockholders of a Delaware corporation may act by written consent to elect directors unless the certificate of incorporation provides otherwise.

204

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Access to Books and Records and Dissemination of Information

Members of the general public have a right to inspect the public documents of a company available at the office of the Registrar of Companies in Bermuda. These documents include the company's memorandum of association (or, in our case, the Butterfield Act), including its objects and powers, and certain alterations thereto, and the company's register of directors. The shareholders have the additional right to inspect the bye-laws of the company, minutes of general meetings and the company's audited financial statements, which must be presented to the annual general meeting. The register of members of a company is also open to inspection by shareholders and by members of the general public without charge. The register of members is required to be open for inspection for not less than two hours in any business day (subject to the ability of a company to close the register of members for not more than 30 days in a year). A company is required to maintain its share register in Bermuda but may, subject to the provisions of the Companies Act, establish a branch register outside of Bermuda. A company is required to keep at its registered office a register of directors and officers that is open for inspection for not less than two hours in any business day by members of the public without charge. Bermuda law does not, however, provide a general right for shareholders to inspect or obtain copies of any other corporate records.

Election and Removal of Directors

The Bank's bye-laws provide that the Board shall consist of not less than six directors and not more than such maximum number of directors, not exceeding 12, as the Board may determine. The Board currently consists of nine directors. The Board consists of a single class of directors.

In addition to the Board, only one or more shareholders holding in the aggregate at least 5% of the voting rights in relation to the election of directors may propose a person for election as a director. Such shareholder(s) must give notice of the intention to propose the person for election. Where a director is to be elected at an annual general meeting, the notice of such election must be given not less than 90 days nor more than 120 days before the anniversary of the last annual general meeting prior to the giving of the notice or, in the event the annual general meeting is called for a date that is not 30 days before or after such anniversary the notice must be given not later than 10 days following the earlier of the date on which notice of the annual general meeting was posted to shareholders or the date on which public disclosure of the date of the annual general meeting was made. Where a director is to be elected at a special general meeting, that notice must be given not later than 10 days following the earlier of the date on which notice of the special general meeting was posted to shareholders or the date on which public disclosure of the date of the special general meeting was made.

A director may be removed by the shareholders, provided notice of the shareholders meeting convened to remove the director is given to the director. The notice must contain a statement of the intention to remove the director and must be served on the director not less than 14 days before the meeting. The director is entitled to attend the meeting and be heard on the motion for his removal. Where a director is to be removed for cause (as such term is defined in the Bank's bye-laws), the resolution shall require the affirmative votes of a majority of the votes cast. Where a director is to be removed without cause and without prior approval of the Board, the resolution shall require the affirmative votes of not less than two-thirds of all voting rights attached to all issued and outstanding shares.

Variance from Delaware: In contrast to our bye-law requirement of at least six directors, a corporation incorporated in Delaware must have at least one director. In addition, any or all of the directors on a non-classified board of a Delaware corporation may be removed, with or without cause, by the holders of a majority of the shares entitled to vote at an election of directors and, in the case of a classified board, the stockholders may effect removal of any or all directors only for cause unless the certificate of incorporation otherwise provides.

Proceedings of the Board of Directors

The Bank's bye-laws provide that our business is to be managed and conducted by the Board. There is no requirement in the Bank's bye-laws or Bermuda law that directors hold any of the Bank's shares. There is also no requirement in the Bank's bye-laws or Bermuda law that the directors must retire at a certain age.

205

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The quorum for meetings of the Board is five directors, a majority of whom must be independent non-executive directors.

The remuneration of our directors is determined by the Board. Our directors may also be paid all travel, hotel and other expenses properly incurred by them in connection with our business or their duties as directors.

Provided a director discloses a direct or indirect interest in any material contract or proposed material contract or arrangement with us as required by Bermuda law, such director is entitled to vote in respect of any such contract or arrangement in which he or she is interested unless he or she is disqualified from voting by the chairman of the relevant board of directors meeting.

Indemnification of Directors and Officers

Section 98 of the Companies Act provides generally that a Bermuda company may indemnify its directors, officers and auditors against any liability which by virtue of any rule of law would otherwise be imposed on them in respect of any negligence, default, breach of duty or breach of trust, except in cases where such liability arises from fraud or dishonesty of which such director, officer or auditor may be guilty in relation to the company. Section 98 further provides that a Bermuda company may indemnify its directors, officers and auditors against any liability incurred by them in defending any proceedings, whether civil or criminal, in which judgment is awarded in their favor or in which they are acquitted or granted relief by the Supreme Court of Bermuda pursuant to section 281 of the Companies Act.

We have adopted provisions in our bye-laws that provide that we shall indemnify our officers and directors in respect of their actions and omissions, except in respect of their fraud or dishonesty. In addition, under our bye-laws, each shareholder agrees to waive any claim or right of action such shareholder might have, whether individually, or by or in the right of the Bank, against any director of officer, on account of any action taken by such director or officer or the failure of such director or officer to take any action in the performance of his duties with or for the Bank or any subsidiary thereof, provided that such waiver shall not extend to any matter in respect of any fraud or dishonesty in relation to the Bank which may attach to such director or officer. Section 98A of the Companies Act permits us to purchase and maintain insurance for the benefit of any officer or director in respect of any loss or liability attaching to him in respect of any negligence, default, breach of duty or breach of trust, whether or not we may otherwise indemnify such officer or director. We have purchased and maintain a directors' and officers' liability policy for such a purpose.

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable.

Amendment of Butterfield Act and Bye-laws

The Butterfield Act may be amended by a resolution passed at a general meeting of shareholders, provided that consent for the proposed amendment has been obtained from the minister responsible for administering the Companies Act, prior to the notice of the shareholders meeting being given to the shareholders. Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the case of certain bye-laws, such as the bye-laws relating to: (i) restrictions on the voting rights of any person who is not Bermudian, (ii) the election of directors, (iii) the class of directors, (iv) the term of directors, (v) the removal of directors, (vi) the Super-Majority Actions and (vii) the approval requirements in respect of amendments to the bye-laws, the required resolutions must include the affirmative vote of not less than 66% of our directors then in office and by a resolution of the shareholders including the affirmative vote of not less than 66% of the votes attaching to all shares in issue. See “Description of Share Capital — Common Shares”.

Under Bermuda law, the holders of an aggregate of not less than 20% in par value of the company's issued share capital or any class thereof have the right to apply to the Supreme Court of Bermuda for an annulment of any amendment of the Butterfield Act adopted by shareholders at any general meeting, other than an amendment which alters or reduces a company's share capital as provided in the

206

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Companies Act. Where such an application is made, the amendment becomes effective only to the extent that it is confirmed by the Bermuda court. An application for an annulment of an amendment of the Butterfield Act must be made within 21 days after the date on which the resolution altering the Butterfield Act is passed and may be made on behalf of persons entitled to make the application by one or more of their number as they may appoint in writing for the purpose. No application may be made by shareholders voting in favor of the amendment.

Amalgamations and Business Combinations

The amalgamation or merger of a Bermuda company with another company or corporation (other than certain affiliated companies) requires the amalgamation or merger agreement to be approved by the company's board of directors and by its shareholders. Unless the company's bye-laws provide otherwise, the approval of 75% of the shares voting at such meeting is required to approve the amalgamation or merger agreement, and the quorum for such meeting must be two persons holding or representing more than one-third of the issued shares of the company.

The Bank's bye-laws provide that a merger or an amalgamation that has not been approved by the Board must only be approved by not less than two-thirds of all voting rights attached to all issued and outstanding shares.

Under Bermuda law, in the event of an amalgamation or merger of a Bermuda company with another company or corporation, a shareholder of the Bermuda company who did not vote in favor of the amalgamation and who is not satisfied that fair value has been offered for such shareholder's shares may, within one month of notice of the shareholders meeting, apply to the Supreme Court of Bermuda to appraise the fair value of those shares.

Variance from Delaware: In contrast, any two or more corporations existing under the laws of the state of Delaware may merge into a single corporation pursuant to a board resolution and upon the approval by stockholders of each constituent corporation by a majority of the outstanding shares entitled to vote, except in certain circumstances, where a vote by stockholders is not required.

Shareholder Suits

Class actions and derivative actions are generally not available to shareholders under Bermuda law. The Bermuda courts, however, would ordinarily be expected to permit a shareholder to commence an action in the name of a company to remedy a wrong to the company where the act complained of is alleged to be beyond the corporate power of the company or illegal, or would result in the violation of the company's memorandum of association (or, in our case, the Butterfield Act) or bye-laws. Furthermore, consideration would be given by a Bermuda court to acts that are alleged to constitute a fraud against the minority shareholders or, for instance, where an act requires the approval of a greater percentage of the company's shareholders than that which actually approved it.

When the affairs of a company are being conducted in a manner which is oppressive or prejudicial to the interests of some part of the shareholders, one or more shareholders may apply to the Supreme Court of Bermuda, which may make such order as it sees fit, including an order regulating the conduct of the company's affairs in the future or ordering the purchase of the shares of any shareholders by other shareholders or by the company.

Variance from Delaware: In contrast, class actions and derivative actions generally are available to stockholders under Delaware law for, among other things, breach of fiduciary duty, corporate waste and actions not taken in accordance with applicable law. In any derivative suit instituted by a stockholder of the corporation, it shall be averred in the complaint that the plaintiff was a stockholder of the corporation at the time of the transaction of which he complains or that such stockholder’s stock thereafter devolved upon such stockholder by operation of law.

Capitalization of Profits and Reserves

Pursuant to the Bank's bye-laws, the Board may: (i) capitalize any part of the amount of the Bank's share premium or other reserve accounts or to the credit of our profit and loss account or otherwise available for distribution by applying such amount in paying up unissued shares to be allotted as fully paid

207

TABLE OF CONTENTS

bonus shares pro-rata (except in connection with the conversion of shares from one class to shares of another class) to the shareholders; or (ii) capitalize any amount standing to the credit of a reserve account or amounts otherwise available for dividend or distribution by applying such amounts in paying up in full, partly paid or nil paid shares of those shareholders who would have been entitled to such sums if they were distributed by way of dividend or distribution.

Registrar or Transfer Agent

Mitsubishi UFG Funds Services serves as the Bank's Registrar and Transfer Agent in Bermuda pursuant to an agreement entered into in July 2014. Under the terms of this agreement, Mitsubishi is responsible for, among other things, maintaining and updating the Bank's share register, facilitating the payment of dividends and coordinating the convening of shareholders meetings. Computershare Inc. is the Bank's Registrar and Transfer Agent in the US.

Untraced Shareholders

The Bank's bye-laws provide that the Board may forfeit any dividend or other monies payable in respect of any shares of the Bank which remain unclaimed for seven years from the date when such monies became due for payment, provided that at least three dividends have become payable during such seven-year period in respect of the shares in question, after such period the Bank has given notice in accordance with the Bank's bye-laws and provided that the NYSE or BSX has been informed of the intention to forfeit such dividend, as the case may be. In addition, we are entitled to cease sending dividend drafts and checks by post or otherwise to a shareholder if such instruments have been returned undelivered to, or left uncashed by, such shareholder on at least two consecutive occasions or, following one such occasion, reasonable inquiries have failed to establish the shareholder's new address. This entitlement ceases if the shareholder claims a dividend or cashes a dividend check or a draft.

Certain Provisions of Bermuda Law

The Bank is designated as resident in Bermuda for exchange control purposes.

The BMA has given its consent for the issue and free transferability of all of the common shares that are the subject of this offering to and between non-residents of Bermuda for exchange control purposes, provided the Bank's shares remain listed on an appointed stock exchange, which includes the BSX and NYSE. Approvals or permissions given by the BMA do not constitute a guarantee by the BMA as to our performance or our creditworthiness. Accordingly, in giving such consent or permissions, the BMA shall not be liable for the financial soundness, performance or default of our business or for the correctness of any opinions or statements expressed in this prospectus. Certain issues and transfers of common shares involving persons deemed resident in Bermuda for exchange control purposes require the specific consent of the BMA.

In accordance with Bermuda law, share certificates are only issued in the names of companies, partnerships or individuals. In the case of a shareholder acting in a special capacity (for example as a trustee), certificates may, at the request of the shareholder, record the capacity in which the shareholder is acting. Notwithstanding such recording of any special capacity, we are not bound to investigate or see to the execution of any such trust. Pursuant to our bye-laws, the Bank will be entitled to treat the registered holder of any share of the Bank as the absolute owner thereof and accordingly shall not be bound to recognize any equitable claim or other claim to, or interest in, such share on the part of any other person.

Anti-Takeover Effects of Provisions of Applicable Law and the Bank's Bye-laws

Two-thirds supermajority shareholder voting requirement: The Bank's bye-laws provide that, except to the extent that a proposal has received the prior approval of the Board, (i) the removal of a director other than for cause; (ii) the approval of an amalgamation, merger or consolidation with or into any other person, arrangement, reconstruction or sale, lease, conveyance, exchange or other transfer of all or substantially all of the Bank's assets, or in each case, an equivalent transaction; and (iii) the commencement of proceedings seeking winding-up, liquidation or reorganization of the Bank, shall require the affirmative vote of not less than two-thirds of all voting rights attached to all issued and outstanding shares.

208

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Amendments to the Bank's bye-laws: The Bank's bye-laws provide that no bye-law may be rescinded, altered or amended and no new bye-law may be made until the same has been approved by a resolution of the Board and by a resolution of the shareholders. In addition, certain of the Bank's bye-laws, including (without limitation) the bye-law concerning the Super-Majority Actions, may not be rescinded, altered or amended and no new bye-law may be made which would have the effect of rescinding, altering or amending the provisions of such bye-law, until the same has been approved by a resolution of the Board including the affirmative vote of not less than 66% of the directors then in office and by a resolution of the shareholders including the affirmative vote of not less than 66% of the votes attaching to all shares in issue.

Limitation relevant to non-Bermudian shareholders: The Bank's bye-laws provide that any person who is not “Bermudian” as defined in the Companies Act who is “interested” (as defined in the bye-laws) in shares of the Bank which constitute more than 40% of all shares then issued and outstanding is not entitled to vote the shares in excess of this 40% interest at any general meeting of the Bank without prior written approval of the Minister of Finance. For purposes of this provision, “interest” means (1) any interest in shares comprised in property held on trust; (2) any contractual right to purchase shares whether for cash or other consideration; (3) any interest by virtue of any right or obligation (whether subject to conditions or not) to exercise any right conferred by the holding of shares including but not limited to voting rights or any entitlement to control the exercise of any such right; (4) any right to call for delivery of shares; (5) the right to acquire an interest in the shares or an obligation to take an interest in shares; or (6) the power to dispose of shares.

Variance from Delaware: In contrast, Delaware law does not have a similar provision requiring prior approval of a governing body for an interested shareholder to vote in the shares of a Delaware-incorporated company.

Additionally, for purposes of this provision: (1) persons having a joint interest shall each be taken to have that interest; (2) a person shall be taken to be interested in any shares in which an associate (within the meaning of the BDCA) of that person is interested; and (3) a person shall be interested in shares if a body corporate is interested in them and that body corporate or its directors are accustomed to act in accordance with the directions or instructions of that person, or that person is entitled by virtue of any right or obligation (whether subject to conditions or not) to exercise or control the exercise of one-third or more of the voting power at general meetings of that body corporate, and where such body corporate is entitled to control the exercise of any of the voting power at general meetings of another body corporate such voting power shall be taken to be exercisable by that person.

The following interests will not be included in this limitation if the person in question is under any obligation to exercise or control the exercise of the voting rights of the shares at the instance of any other person: (1) any interest of a custodian trustee or a bare trustee; (2) any interest of a licensed bank or other financial institution held by way of security for the purposes of a transaction entered into in the ordinary course of banking business; (3) an interest of a personal representative of any estate; (4) any interest of a person arising by reason only that such person has been appointed a proxy to vote at a specified meeting of shareholders and at any adjournment of that meeting or has been appointed by a body corporate to act as its representative at any meeting of shareholders; (5) any interest of any underwriter or sub-underwriter in any offer of shares provided the agreement or interest is confined to that purpose and any matters incidental to it; (6) any interest of any market maker in the shares which has been approved by the Board provided the interest is confined to that purpose and any matters incidental to it; (7) any interest as a beneficiary under a pension or retirement benefits scheme; or (8) the interests of any subsidiary of the Bank.

In addition, the BDCA prohibits a person from becoming a shareholder controller of any company licensed under the BDCA unless the person provides written notice to the BMA of his intent to do so and the BMA does not object. The definition of shareholder controller is set out in the BDCA but generally refers to a person who, among other things, (i) holds 10% or more of the shares in the licensed institution or another company of which it is a subsidiary company; or (ii) is entitled to exercise, or control the exercise of 10% or more of the voting power at any general meeting of the licensed institution or another company of which it is such a subsidiary. See “Supervision and Regulation — Bermuda — Banks and Deposit Companies Act 1999.”

209

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Limitations on the election of directors: The Bank's bye-laws provide that a person may be proposed for election or appointment as a director at a general meeting either by the Board or by one or more shareholders holding shares of the Bank which in the aggregate carry not less than 5% of the voting rights in respect of the election of directors. In addition, unless a person is proposed for election or appointment as a director by the Board, when a person proposed for appointment or election as a director written notice of the proposal must be given to the Bank, and of his willingness to serve as a director, as follows. Where a director is to be appointed or elected: (1) at an annual general meeting, such notice must be given not less than 90 days nor more than 120 days before the anniversary of the last annual general meeting prior to the giving of the notice or, in the event the annual general meeting is called for a date that is not 30 days before or after such anniversary the notice must be given not later than 10 days following the earlier of the date on which notice of the annual general meeting was posted to shareholders or the date on which public disclosure of the date of the annual general meeting was made; and (2) at a special general meeting, such notice must be given not later than 10 days following the earlier of the date on which notice of the special general meeting was posted to shareholders or the date on which public disclosure of the date of the special general meeting was made.

Listing

The Bank's common shares are listed on the NYSE under the symbol “NTB” and on the BSX under the symbol “NTB.BH”. The Bank’s common shares have been listed on the NYSE since September 16, 2016 and on the BSX since 1998.

210

TABLE OF CONTENTS

SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

We had 53,284,872 common shares outstanding as of December 31, 2016. Of these shares, the 12,234,042 common shares sold in our IPO are freely tradable, except for any shares purchased by our “affiliates” as defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act. Certain holders of our remaining common shares have agreed with the underwriters in our IPO, subject to certain exceptions, not to dispose of or hedge any of their common shares or securities convertible into or exchangeable for common shares during the 180-day period beginning on September 15, 2016, except with the prior written consent of the representatives of the underwriters in our IPO (and this offering is being made pursuant to such a consent). We, our officers and directors and the selling shareholders will also enter into new lock-up agreements in connection with this offering that will restrict transfers for a period of 75 days following the date of this prospectus, subject to certain exceptions. See “Underwriting”. Upon expiration of the lock-up agreements described above, all of the shares subject to these lock-up agreements will be eligible for resale in a public market, subject, in the case of shares held by our affiliates, to volume, manner of sale and other limitations under Rule 144.

All of the common shares sold in this offering will be freely transferable by persons other than by our “affiliates” (as defined under Rule 144) without restriction or further registration under the Securities Act. Sales of substantial amounts of the common shares in the public market could adversely affect prevailing market prices of the common shares. Since no shares will be available for sale from certain of our shareholders shortly after this offering because of the contractual and legal restrictions on resale described below (including the lockup agreements), sales of substantial numbers of common shares in the public market after these restrictions lapse could adversely affect the prevailing market price and our ability to raise equity capital in the future.

Lock-Up Agreements

In connection with the IPO, the Bank, its officers and directors and certain shareholders entered into lock-up agreements that expire on March 14, 2017 (the “IPO Lock-Ups”). In connection with this offering, the Bank and its officers, directors, and the selling shareholders have agreed with the underwriters, subject to certain exceptions, not to dispose of or hedge any of the common shares, or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for any of the common shares, during the period from the date of this prospectus continuing through the date 75 days after the date of this prospectus, except with the prior written consent of the representatives of the underwriters. The representatives have advised us that they have no current intent or understanding to release any of the common shares subject to the IPO Lock-Ups or the lock-up agreements prior to their expiration (except releases solely for the purpose of effecting this offering). There are no contractually specified conditions for the waiver of lock-up restrictions and any waiver is at the sole discretion of the representatives.

These lock-up agreements will be subject to certain exceptions, including, but not limited to: (1) we may issue common shares issuable upon the conversion of securities or the exercise of outstanding options or warrants; and (2) our common shares may be (a) transferred to satisfy tax withholding obligations or the option exercise price upon the exercise or vesting of equity awards outstanding, or granted pursuant to an equity incentive plan, (b) transferred or distributed to immediate family members or shareholders, members or affiliates of a party subject to the lock-up (the “lock-up party”) or a trust, partnership, limited partnership or other entity for the direct or indirect benefit of the lock-up party and/or a family member of the lock-up party, (c) to a nominee or custodian of a person or entity to whom a transfer would be permissible under the preceding clauses (a) and (b), (d) upon the death of the lock-up party, transferred by the estate of the lock-up party, or transferred as a bona fide gift, (e) transferred to any business entity, investment fund or entity that controls, is controlled by, or is under common control with the lock-up party, (f) in the case of an executive officer, transferred to the Bank upon death, disability or termination of employment, (g) in the case of a corporation, transferred to any affiliate of such corporation, (h) transferred with the prior written consent of the representatives, (i) pledged in a bona fide transaction to a lender of the lock-up party and (j) with prior notice to the representatives, sold or disposed of pursuant to an order of a court or regulatory agency that requires such a sale or disposition. In the case of clauses (b) through (g) and (i) and (j) above, the transferee, donee or distributee, as the case may be, is to be bound by the same lock-up restrictions as the original lock-up party, and no public disclosure or filings (including under the Exchange Act) shall be required, or made voluntarily, reporting a reduction in

211

TABLE OF CONTENTS

beneficial ownership in connection with any such transfer, prior to the expiration of the lock-up period. In the case of clauses (b) through (g) above, any such transfer or distribution shall not be for value. For more information, see “Underwriting”.

Rule 144

Under Rule 144 under the Securities Act, a person (or persons whose shares are aggregated) (1) who is not considered to have been one of our affiliates at any time during the 90 days preceding a sale and (2) who has beneficially owned the shares proposed to be sold for at least six months, including, in certain cases, the holding period of any prior owner other than an affiliate is entitled to sell his shares without restriction, subject to the Bank's compliance with the reporting obligations under the Exchange Act.

In general, under Rule 144, beginning 90 days after the date of the IPO, a person who is our affiliate and has beneficially owned common shares for at least six months was entitled to sell within any three-month period a number of shares that does not exceed the greater of (1) 1.0% of the number of common shares then issued and outstanding and (2) the average weekly trading volume of the common shares on the NYSE during the four calendar weeks preceding the filing of a notice on Form 144 in connection with the sale.

Any such sales by an affiliate are also subject to manner of sale provisions, notice requirements and our compliance with Exchange Act reporting obligations.

Regulation S

Regulation S under the Securities Act provides that shares owned by any person may be sold without registration in the United States, provided that the sale is effected in an offshore transaction and no directed selling efforts are made in the United States (as these terms are defined in Regulation S), subject to certain other conditions. In general, this means that the Bank's shares may be sold in some other manner outside the United States without requiring registration in the United States.

Rule 701

Beginning 90 days after the date of the IPO, persons other than affiliates who purchased common shares from us in connection with a compensatory share plan or other written agreement were entitled to sell such shares in the United States in reliance on Rule 701 under the Securities Act. Rule 701 permits affiliates of an issuer, defined as a person that directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, controls, or is controlled by, or is under common control with, such issuer, to sell their Rule 701 shares under Rule 144 without complying with the holding period requirements of Rule 144. Rule 701 further provides that non-affiliates may sell these shares in reliance on Rule 144 without complying with the current information or six-month holding period requirements.

212

TABLE OF CONTENTS

CERTAIN TAXATION CONSIDERATIONS

Bermuda Tax Considerations

Under Bermuda law, there is no stamp or documentary taxes, duties or similar taxes in connection with a conveyance or transfer on sale, or a conveyance or transfer to effect or having the effect of a voluntary disposition inter vivos or any agreement for the lending and borrowing of the Bank's shares which are listed on the BSX and NYSE. We are not required by any Bermuda law or regulation to make any deductions or withholdings in Bermuda from any payment we may make in respect of the Bank's shares. Furthermore, Bermuda currently has no corporate or capital gains tax.

Material US Federal Income Tax Consequences

This section describes the material US federal income tax consequences of owning and disposing of common shares of the Bank. It applies solely to US shareholders (as defined below) that hold shares as capital assets for US federal income tax purposes. This section does not describe all of the tax consequences that may apply to members of a special class of holders subject to special rules, including:

a dealer in securities or foreign currencies,
a regulated investment company,
a trader in securities that elects to use a mark-to-market method of accounting for securities holdings,
a tax-exempt organization,
a bank, an insurance company, or any other financial institution,
a person liable for alternative minimum tax,
a person that actually or constructively owns 10% or more, by vote or value, of the Bank,
a person that holds the Bank's common shares as part of a straddle or a hedging, conversion, or other risk reduction transaction for US federal income tax purposes,
a person that purchases or sells common shares as part of a wash sale for tax purposes,
an entity classified as a partnership for US federal income tax purposes, or
a person whose functional currency is not the US Dollar.

This section is based on the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “IRC”), its legislative history, existing and proposed Treasury regulations, published rulings and court decisions, all as of the date hereof. These laws are subject to change, possibly on a retroactive basis.

If an entity treated as a partnership for US federal income tax purposes holds common shares, the US federal income tax treatment of a partner will generally depend on the status of the partner and the tax treatment of the partnership. A partner in an entity treated as a partnership for US federal income tax purposes holding common shares should consult its tax advisers with regard to the US federal income tax treatment of the ownership and disposition of the Bank's common shares.

Shareholders should consult their own tax advisers regarding the US federal, state and local and foreign and other tax consequences of owning and disposing of the Bank's common shares in their particular circumstances.

Special adverse US federal income tax rules apply if a US shareholder owns shares of a company that is or was treated as a PFIC for US federal income tax purposes for any taxable year during which the US shareholder held such shares. US shareholders should consult their own tax advisers as to the potential application of the PFIC rules to their ownership and disposition of the Bank's common shares.

213

TABLE OF CONTENTS

US shareholders

For the purposes of this discussion, a “US shareholder” is a beneficial owner of common shares that is:

an individual that is a citizen or resident of the United States,
a corporation, or other entity taxable as a corporation, created or organized under the laws of the United States, any state therein or the District of Columbia,
an estate whose income is subject to US federal income tax regardless of its source, or
a trust if a US court can exercise primary supervision over the trust's administration and one or more US persons are authorized to control all substantial decisions of the trust.

Taxation of Dividends

Subject to the discussion below under the heading “— Passive Foreign Investment Company Considerations”, a US shareholder must include in its gross income as dividends the gross amount of any distribution paid by the Bank to the extent that they are paid out of the Bank's current or accumulated earnings and profits as determined for US federal income tax purposes. Distributions in excess of current and accumulated earnings and profits, as determined for US federal income tax purposes, will be treated as a non-taxable return of capital to the extent of the US shareholder's basis in the common shares of the Bank, causing a reduction in the US shareholder's adjusted basis in such common shares, and thereafter as capital gain. Because the Bank does not maintain calculations of its earnings and profits under US federal income tax principles, it is expected that distributions generally will be reported to US shareholders as dividends.

Dividends paid to certain non-corporate US shareholders by a “qualified foreign corporation” that constitute qualified dividend income are taxable to the shareholder at the preferential rates applicable to long-term capital gains provided that the shareholder holds the shares for more than 60 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the ex-dividend date and meets other holding period requirements. For this purpose, common shares of the Bank will be treated as stock of a “qualified foreign corporation” if the Bank was not a PFIC for the taxable year in which the dividend was paid, or the preceding taxable year and if such common shares are listed on an established securities market in the United States, such as the NYSE. The common shares of the Bank are listed on the NYSE. Accordingly, subject to the discussion below under the heading “— Passive Foreign Investment Company Considerations”, dividends the Bank pays with respect to the common shares will constitute qualified dividend income, assuming the holding period requirements are met.

The dividend will not be eligible for the dividends-received deduction allowed to US corporations in respect of dividends received from other US corporations.

Dividends generally will be treated as foreign source income for US foreign tax credit purposes. Under Section 904(h) of the IRC, however, dividends paid by a foreign corporation that is treated as 50% or more owned, by vote or value, by US persons for US federal income tax purposes may be treated as US source income (rather than foreign source income) for foreign tax credit purposes, to the extent the foreign corporation earns US source income. In certain circumstances, US shareholders may be able to choose the benefits of Section 904(h)(10) of the IRC and elect to treat dividends that would otherwise be US source dividends as foreign source dividends, but in such a case the foreign tax credit limitations would be separately determined with respect to such “resourced” income. In general, therefore, the application of Section 904(h) of the IRC may adversely affect a US shareholder's ability to use foreign tax credits. As a result of the listing of the common shares of the Bank on the NYSE, the Bank may be treated as 50% or more owned by US persons for purposes of Section 904(h) of the IRC. US shareholders are strongly urged to consult their own tax advisers regarding the possible impact if Section 904(h) of the IRC should apply.

Taxation of Capital Gains

Subject to the discussion below under the heading “— Passive Foreign Investment Company Considerations”, a US shareholder that sells or otherwise disposes of common shares of the Bank will recognize capital gain or loss for US federal income tax purposes equal to the difference between the

214

TABLE OF CONTENTS

amount that the US shareholder realizes and the US shareholder's tax basis in those common shares. Capital gain of a non-corporate US shareholder is generally taxed at preferential rates where the property is held for more than one year. The gain or loss will be US source income or loss for foreign tax credit limitation purposes. The deduction of capital losses is subject to limitations.

Passive Foreign Investment Company Considerations

Special adverse US federal income tax rules apply if a US shareholder holds shares of a company that is treated as a Passive Foreign Investment Company (“PFIC”) for any taxable year during which the US shareholder held such shares. This conclusion is a factual determination that is made annually and thus may be subject to change. A foreign corporation will be considered a PFIC with respect to a US Shareholder for any taxable year if (i) at least 75% of its gross income for the taxable year is passive income (the “income test”), or (ii) at least 50% of the value, determined on the basis of a quarterly average, of its assets is attributable to assets that produce or are held for the production of passive income (the “asset test”). Passive income for this purpose generally includes dividends, interest, royalties, rents (other than certain rents and royalties derived in the active conduct of a trade or business), annuities and gains from assets that produce passive income. If a foreign corporation owns at least 25% (by value) of the shares or stock of another corporation, the foreign corporation is treated, for purposes of the PFIC tests, as owning a proportionate share of the other corporation's assets and receiving its proportionate share of the other corporation's income.

Banks generally derive a substantial part of their income from assets that are interest bearing or that otherwise could be considered passive under the PFIC rules. The IRS has issued a notice, and has proposed regulations, that exclude from passive income any income derived in the active conduct of a banking business by a qualifying foreign bank.

Based upon the proportion of our income derived from activities that are “bona fide” banking activities for US federal income tax purposes, we believe that we were not a PFIC for the taxable year ending December 31, 2016 (the latest period for which the determination can be made) and, based further on our present regulatory status under local laws, the present nature of our activities, and the present composition of our assets and sources of income, we do not expect to be a PFIC for the current year or any future years. However, because PFIC status is a factual determination and because there are uncertainties in the application of the relevant rules, there can be no assurances that we will not be a PFIC for any particular year.

If the Bank were a PFIC in any taxable year during which a US shareholder owns the Bank's common shares and the US shareholder does not make a “mark-to-market” election, as discussed below, or a special “purging” election, the Bank generally would continue to be treated as a PFIC with respect to such US shareholder in all succeeding taxable years, regardless of whether the Bank continues to meet the income or asset test discussed above. US shareholders are urged to consult their own tax advisers with respect to the tax consequences to them if the Bank were to become a PFIC for any taxable year in which they own the common shares.

If the Bank is a PFIC for any taxable year during which a US shareholder holds the common shares and the US shareholder does not make a mark-to-market election, as described below, the US shareholder will be subject to special rules with respect to:

any gain realized on the sale or other disposition of its common shares; and
any “excess distribution” that the Bank makes to the US shareholder (generally, any distributions to the US shareholder during a single taxable year that are greater than 125% of the average annual distributions received by the US shareholder in respect of its common shares during the three preceding taxable years or, if shorter, the portion of the US shareholder's holding period for the common shares).

Under these rules:

the gain or excess distribution will be allocated ratably over the US shareholder's holding period for the common shares;

215

TABLE OF CONTENTS

the amount allocated to the taxable year in which the US shareholder realized the gain or excess distribution and to years before the Bank became a PFIC will be taxed as ordinary income; and
the amount allocated to each other taxable year, with certain exceptions, will be subject to additional tax calculated by multiplying the amount allocated to such other taxable year by the highest tax rate in effect for that taxable year for individuals or corporations, as appropriate, and the interest charge generally applicable to underpayments of tax will be imposed in respect of the tax attributable to each such year.

Alternatively, if a US shareholder owns shares in a PFIC that are treated as “marketable stock,” the US shareholder may make a mark-to-market election. The common shares will be treated as marketable stock if they are regularly traded on a “qualified exchange.” For these purposes, the common shares will be considered regularly traded during any calendar year during which it is traded, other than in negligible quantities, on a qualified exchange, which includes the NYSE, on at least 15 days during each calendar quarter. Any trades that have as their principal purpose meeting this requirement will be disregarded.

A US shareholder that makes a mark-to-market election will not be subject to the PFIC rules described above. Instead, the US shareholder will include as ordinary income each year that the Bank is a PFIC the excess, if any, of the fair market value of its common shares at the end of the taxable year over its adjusted basis in the common shares. These amounts of ordinary income will not be eligible for the favorable tax rates applicable to qualified dividend income or long-term capital gains discussed above. The US shareholder will also be allowed to take an ordinary loss in respect of the excess, if any, of the adjusted basis of its common shares over their fair market value at the end of the taxable year that the Bank is a PFIC (but only to the extent of the net amount of income previously included as a result of the mark-to-market election). The US shareholder's basis in its common shares will be adjusted to reflect any such income or loss amounts recognized. Any gain recognized on the sale or other disposition of the common shares in a taxable year when the Bank is a PFIC will be treated as ordinary income and any loss will be treated as an ordinary loss (but only to the extent of the net amount of income previously included as a result of the mark-to-market election). Distributions paid on the common shares will be treated as discussed above under “— Taxation of Dividends”.

A mark-to-market election will continue to be in effect for all taxable years in which the Bank is a PFIC and the common shares are treated as marketable stock, and may not be revoked without the consent of the IRS. If the US shareholder makes a mark-to-market election with respect to its common shares, it will be treated as having a new holding period in its common shares beginning on the first day of the first taxable year beginning after the last taxable year for which the mark-to-market election applies. The application of the mark-to-market rules to an investment in a PFIC with a subsidiary that is also a PFIC is not entirely clear; however, there is a significant risk that some or all of such an investment will be subject to the special rules described above that apply if a mark-to-market election is not made, even if a mark-to-market election is made with respect to the parent PFIC. In the event that the Bank is a PFIC, US shareholders are urged to consult their tax advisers regarding the availability of the mark-to-market election, and whether the election would be advisable in the holder's particular circumstances.

The PFIC rules outlined above would also not apply to a US shareholder if such holder were to elect to treat us as a qualified electing fund (“QEF”). An election to treat us as a QEF will not be available, however, if the Bank does not provide the information necessary to make such an election. The Bank will not provide US shareholders with the information necessary to make a QEF election, and thus, the QEF election will not be available with respect to the common shares.

Notwithstanding any election made with respect to the common shares, dividends received with respect to the common shares will not constitute “qualified dividend income” if we are a PFIC (or are treated as a PFIC with respect to the relevant US shareholder) in either the taxable year of the distribution or the preceding taxable year. Dividends that do not constitute qualified dividend income are not eligible for taxation at the reduced tax rate available to certain non-corporate holders described above in “— Taxation of Dividends”. Instead, such dividends would be subject to tax at ordinary income rates.

If a US shareholder owns common shares during any taxable year in which we are a PFIC, the US shareholder generally must file annual tax returns (including on Form 8621), for each taxable year that the US shareholder owns the common shares, unless its ownership satisfies a de minimis test.

216

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Medicare Tax on Net Investment Income

A US person that is an individual or estate, or a trust that does not fall into a special class of trusts that is exempt from such tax, is subject to a 3.8% tax (the “Medicare tax”) on the lesser of (i) the US person's “net investment income” (or “undistributed net investment income” in the case of an estate or trust) for the relevant taxable year and (ii) the excess of the US person's modified adjusted gross income for the taxable year over a certain threshold (which in the case of individuals is between $125,000 and $250,000, depending on the individual's circumstances). A shareholder's net investment income generally includes its dividend income and its net gains from the disposition of shares, unless such dividends or net gains are derived in the ordinary course of the conduct of a trade or business (other than a trade or business that consists of certain passive or trading activities). If a shareholder is a US person that is an individual, estate or trust, the shareholder is urged to consult the shareholder's tax advisers regarding the applicability of the Medicare tax to the shareholder's income and gains in respect of the shareholder's investment in the Bank's common shares.

Information with Respect to Foreign Financial Assets

Owners of “specified foreign financial assets” with an aggregate value in excess of $50,000 (and in some cases, a higher threshold) may be required to file an information report with respect to such assets with their tax returns. “Specified foreign financial assets” include any financial accounts maintained by foreign financial institutions, as well as any of the following, if they are held for investment and not held in accounts maintained by financial institutions: (i) stocks and securities issued by non-US persons, (ii) financial instruments and contracts that have non-US issuers or counterparties and (iii) interests in foreign entities. US shareholders are urged to consult their tax advisers regarding the application of this legislation to their ownership of the Bank's common shares.

Backup Withholding and Information Reporting

Information reporting requirements for a non-corporate US shareholder, on IRS Form 1099, will apply to (i) dividend payments or other taxable distributions made to such US shareholder within the United States, and (ii) the payment of proceeds to such US shareholder from the sale of the Bank's common shares effected at a US office of a broker.

Additionally, backup withholding (currently at a 28% rate) may apply to such payments to a non-corporate US shareholder that (i) fails to provide an accurate taxpayer identification number, (ii) is notified by the IRS that such US shareholder has failed to report all interest and dividends required to be shown on such US shareholder's federal income tax returns, or (iii) in certain circumstances, fails to comply with applicable certification requirements.

A US shareholder may obtain a refund of any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules that exceed the shareholder's income tax liability by properly filing a refund claim with the IRS.

Payment of proceeds from the sale of shares effected at a foreign office of a broker generally will not be subject to information reporting or backup withholding. However, a sale effected at a foreign office of a broker could be subject to information reporting in the same manner as a sale within the United States, (and in certain cases may be subject to backup withholding as well) if (i) the broker has certain connections to the United States, or (ii) the sale has certain other specified connections with the United States.

Foreign Account Tax Compliance Withholding

Pursuant to the FATCA enacted in 2010, a 30% withholding tax will be imposed on certain payments to certain non-US financial institutions that fail to comply with certain information-reporting, account identification, withholding, certification and other FATCA-related requirements in respect of their direct and indirect United States shareholders and/or United States accountholders. To avoid becoming subject to FATCA withholding, we and other non-US financial institutions may be required to report information to the IRS regarding the holders of the common shares and to withhold on a portion of payments under the common shares to certain holders that fail to comply with the relevant information reporting requirements (or the holders of the common shares directly or indirectly through certain non-compliant intermediaries). Such withholding would not apply to payments made with respect to the Bank's common shares before January 1, 2019.

217

TABLE OF CONTENTS

UNDERWRITING

The Bank, the selling shareholders and the underwriters named below have entered into an underwriting agreement with respect to the common shares being offered. Subject to certain conditions, the selling shareholders have agreed to sell to the underwriters, and each underwriter has severally agreed to purchase from the selling shareholders, the number of common shares indicated in the following table. Goldman, Sachs & Co., Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Sandler O'Neill & Partners, L.P. and Keefe, Bruyette & Woods, Inc. are acting as the representatives of the underwriters named below.

Underwriters
Number of
Common Shares
Goldman, Sachs & Co.
 
 
 
Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
 
 
 
Sandler O'Neill & Partners, L.P.
 
 
 
Keefe, Bruyette & Woods, Inc.
 
                        
 
Total
 
                        
 

The addresses of the underwriters are as follows: Goldman, Sachs & Co., 200 West Street, New York, New York 10282; Citigroup Global Markets Inc., 388 Greenwich Street, New York, New York 10013; Sandler O'Neill & Partners, L.P., 1251 Avenue of the Americas, New York, New York 10020; and Keefe, Bruyette & Woods, Inc., 787 Seventh Avenue, 4th Floor, New York, New York 10019.

The underwriters are committed to take and pay for all of the common shares being offered, if any are taken, other than the common shares covered by the option described below unless and until this option is exercised.

The underwriters have an option to buy up to an additional           common shares from the selling shareholders to cover sales by the underwriters of a greater number of common shares than the total number set forth in the table above. They may exercise that option for 30 days from the date of this prospectus. If any common shares are purchased pursuant to this option, the underwriters will severally purchase common shares in approximately the same proportion as set forth in the table above.

The following table shows the per common share and total underwriting discounts and commissions to be paid to the underwriters by the selling shareholders. Such amounts are shown assuming both no exercise and full exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional common shares from the selling shareholders.

 
No Exercise
Full Exercise
Per common share
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total
 
 
 
 
 
 

Common shares sold by the underwriters to the public will be offered at the public offering price set forth on the cover of this prospectus. Any common shares sold by the underwriters to securities dealers may be sold at a discount of up to $             per common share from the public offering price.

The public offering price will be determined by the market price of our common shares at the time of the offering and through negotiations among us, the selling shareholders and the representatives of the underwriters.

We, the selling shareholders, and our officers and directors have agreed with the underwriters, subject to certain exceptions, not to dispose of or hedge any of the common shares, or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for any of the common shares, during the period from the date of this prospectus continuing through the date 75 days after the date of this prospectus, except with the prior written consent of the representatives of the underwriters. The representatives have advised us that they have no current intent or understanding to release any of the common shares subject to the lock-up agreements prior to the expiration of the 75-day period. There are no contractually specified conditions for the waiver of lock-up restrictions and any waiver is at the sole discretion of the representatives. When

218

TABLE OF CONTENTS

determining whether or not to release common shares or other securities from such lock-up agreements, the representatives may consider, among other factors, the holder's reasons for requesting the release, the number of common shares or other securities for which the release is being requested and market conditions at the time.

These lock-up restrictions will be subject to certain exceptions, including, but not limited to: (1) we may issue common shares issuable upon the conversion of securities or the exercise of outstanding options or warrants; in each case outstanding as of the date of this prospectus, (2) we may issue common shares or securities convertible into, exercisable or exchangeable for or that represent the right to receive common shares, (3) we may issue common shares or securities convertible into, exercisable or exchangeable for or that represent the right to receive common shares in connection with (x) the acquisition by the Bank or any of its subsidiaries of the securities, business, technology, property or other assets of another person or entity or pursuant to an employee benefit plan assumed by the Bank in connection with such acquisition, and the issuance of any such securities pursuant to any such agreement, or (y) the Bank’s other strategic transactions or (4) we may file any registration statement on Form S-8 relating to securities granted or to be granted pursuant to the Bank’s equity incentive plans that are described in this prospectus or any assumed employee benefit plan contemplated by (3); provided that the aggregate number of common shares that the Bank may sell or issue or agree to sell or issue pursuant to clauses (3) and (4) shall not exceed 5% of the total number of common shares issued and outstanding following this offering; and provided, further, that any recipient of such common shares is to be bound by the same lock-up restrictions, the Bank will enter stop transfer instructions with the transfer agent and registrar for such securities and no public disclosure or filings (including under the Exchange Act) by any party shall be required, or made voluntarily, reporting a change in beneficial ownership in connection with any such transfer, prior to the expiration of the 75-day period, and (5) our common shares may be (a) transferred to satisfy tax withholding obligations or the option exercise price upon the exercise or vesting of equity awards outstanding, or granted pursuant to an equity incentive plan, (b) transferred or distributed to immediate family members or shareholders, members or affiliates of the lock-up party or a trust, partnership, limited partnership or other entity for the direct or indirect benefit of the lock-up party and/or a family member of the lock-up party, (c) to a nominee or custodian of a person or entity to whom a transfer would be permissible under the preceding clauses (a) and (b), (d) upon the death of the lock-up party, transferred by the estate of the lock-up party, or transferred as a bona fide gift, (e) transferred to any business entity, investment fund or entity that controls, is controlled by, or is under common control with the lock-up party, (f) in the case of an executive officer, transferred to the Bank upon death, disability or termination of employment, (g) in the case of a corporation, transferred to any affiliate of such corporation, (h) transferred with the prior written consent of the representatives, (i) pledged in a bona fide transaction to a lender of the lock-up party and (j) with prior notice to the representatives, sold or disposed of pursuant to an order of a court or regulatory agency that requires such a sale or disposition, and in the case of clauses (b) through (g) and (i) and (j) above, the transferee, donee or distributee, as the case may be, is to be bound by the same lock-up restrictions as the original lock-up party and no public disclosure or filings (including under the Exchange Act) shall be required, or made voluntarily, reporting a reduction in beneficial ownership in connection with any such transfer, prior to the expiration of the 75-day period, and in the case of clauses (b) through (g) above, any such transfer or distribution shall not be for value.

In connection with the offering, the underwriters may purchase and sell common shares in the open market. These transactions may include short sales, stabilizing transactions and purchases to cover positions created by short sales. Short sales involve the sale by the underwriters of a greater number of such securities than they are required to purchase in the offering, and a short position represents the amount of such sales that have not been covered by subsequent purchases. A “covered short position” is a short position that is not greater than the amount of additional common shares for which the underwriters' option described above may be exercised. The underwriters may cover any covered short position by either exercising their option to purchase additional common shares or purchasing common shares in the open market. In determining the source of common shares to cover the covered short position, the underwriters will consider, among other things, the price of the common shares available for purchase in the open market as compared to the price at which they may purchase additional common shares pursuant to the option described above. “Naked” short sales are any short sales that create a short position greater than the amount of additional common shares for which the option described above

219

TABLE OF CONTENTS

may be exercised. The underwriters must cover any such naked short position by purchasing common shares in the open market. A naked short position is more likely to be created if the underwriters are concerned that there may be downward pressure on the price of the common shares in the open market after pricing that could adversely affect investors who purchase in the offering. Stabilizing transactions consist of various bids for or purchases of common shares made by the underwriters in the open market prior to the completion of the offering.

The underwriters may also impose a penalty bid. This occurs when a particular underwriter repays to the underwriters a portion of the underwriting discount received by it because the representatives have repurchased common shares sold by or for the account of such underwriter in stabilizing or short covering transactions.

Purchases to cover a short position and stabilizing transactions, as well as other purchases by the underwriters for their own accounts, may have the effect of preventing or retarding a decline in the market price of the common shares, and together with the imposition of the penalty bid, may stabilize, maintain or otherwise affect the market price of the common shares. As a result, the price of the common shares may be higher than the price that otherwise might exist in the open market. The underwriters are not required to engage in these activities and may end any of these activities at any time. These transactions may be effected on the NYSE, the Bermuda Stock Exchange, in the over-the-counter market or otherwise.

We and the selling shareholders estimate that our and their share of the total expenses of the offering, excluding underwriting discounts and commissions, will be approximately $             , approximately $             of which has been or will be paid or reimbursed to us by the selling shareholders. We have agreed to pay the expenses in connection with the qualification of the offering with the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. in an amount not to exceed $             .

We and the selling shareholders have agreed to indemnify the several underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act.

The underwriters and their respective affiliates are full service financial institutions engaged in various activities, which may include sales and trading, commercial and investment banking, advisory, investment management, investment research, principal investment, hedging, market making, brokerage and other financial and non-financial activities and services. Certain of the underwriters and their respective affiliates have provided, and may in the future provide, a variety of these services to us and to persons and entities with relationships with us, for which they received or will receive customary fees and expenses.

In the ordinary course of their various business activities, the underwriters and their respective affiliates, officers, directors and employees may purchase, sell or hold a broad array of investments and actively traded securities, derivatives, loans, commodities, currencies, credit default swaps and other financial instruments for their own account and for the accounts of their customers, and such investment and trading activities may involve or relate to our assets, securities and/or instruments (directly, as collateral securing other obligations or otherwise) and/or persons and entities with relationships with us. The underwriters and their respective affiliates may also communicate independent investment recommendations, market color or trading ideas and/or publish or express independent research views in respect of such assets, securities or instruments and may at any time hold, or recommend to clients that they should acquire, long and/or short positions in such assets, securities and instruments.

Selling Restrictions

Canada

The common shares may be sold only to purchasers purchasing, or deemed to be purchasing, as principal that are accredited investors, as defined in National Instrument 45-106 Prospectus Exemptions or subsection 73.3(1) of the Securities Act (Ontario), and are permitted clients, as defined in National Instrument 31-103 Registration Requirements, Exemptions and Ongoing Registrant Obligations. Any resale of the shares must be made in accordance with an exemption from, or in a transaction not subject to, the prospectus requirements of applicable securities laws.

Securities legislation in certain provinces or territories of Canada may provide a purchaser with remedies for rescission or damages if this prospectus (including any amendment thereto) contains a

220

TABLE OF CONTENTS

misrepresentation, provided that the remedies for rescission or damages are exercised by the purchaser within the time limit prescribed by the securities legislation of the purchaser's province or territory. The purchaser should refer to any applicable provisions of the securities legislation of the purchaser's province or territory for particulars of these rights or consult with a legal advisor.

Pursuant to section 3A.3 of National Instrument 33-105 Underwriting Conflicts (NI 33-105), the underwriters are not required to comply with the disclosure requirements of NI 33-105 regarding underwriter conflicts of interest in connection with this offering.

European Economic Area

This document has been prepared on the basis that any offer of common shares in any Member State of the European Economic Area which has implemented the Prospectus Directive (each, a “Relevant Member State”) will be made pursuant to an exemption under the Prospectus Directive, as implemented in that Relevant Member State, from the requirement to publish a prospectus for offers of common shares. Accordingly, any person making or intending to make an offer in that Relevant Member State of common shares which are the subject of an offering contemplated in this document may only do so in circumstances in which no obligation arises for us or any underwriter to publish a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Directive in relation to such offer. Neither we nor any underwriter has authorized, nor do we or they authorize, (i) the making of any offer of common shares through any financial intermediary (as that term is used in Article 3(2) of the Prospectus Directive), other than offers made by the underwriters which constitute the final placement of common shares contemplated by this document; or (ii) the making of any offer of common shares in circumstances in which an obligation arises for us or any underwriter to publish a prospectus for such offer.

In relation to each Relevant Member State, an offer of common shares to the public may not be made in that Relevant Member State, except that an offer of common shares to the public may be made at any time under the following exemptions under the Prospectus Directive, if they have been implemented in that Relevant Member State:

(a)to any legal entity which is a “qualified investor” as defined in Article 2(1)(e) of the Prospectus Directive (“Qualified Investor”);
(b)to fewer than 150 natural or legal persons (other than Qualified Investors) subject to obtaining the prior consent of the representatives for any such offer; or
(c)in any other circumstances falling within Article 3(2) of the Prospectus Directive, provided that no such offer of common shares shall result in a requirement for the publication of a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Directive or any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in a Relevant Member State and each person in a Relevant Member State who initially acquires any common shares or to whom an offer is made will be deemed to have represented, warranted and agreed to and with the underwriters that it is a Qualified Investor within the meaning of the law in that Relevant Member State implementing Article 2(1)(e) of the Prospectus Directive.

For the purpose of this provision, the expression an “offer of common shares to the public” in relation to any common shares in any Relevant Member State means the communication in any form and by any means of sufficient information on the terms of the offer and the common shares to be offered so as to enable an investor to decide to purchase or subscribe the common shares, as the same may be varied in that Relevant Member State by any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in that Relevant Member State, the expression Prospectus Directive means Directive 2003/71/EC (as amended, including by Directive 2010/73/EU), and includes any relevant implementing measure in each Relevant Member State.

In the case of any common shares being offered to a financial intermediary (as that term is used in Article 3(2) of the Prospectus Directive), such financial intermediary will also be deemed to have represented, acknowledged and agreed that the common shares acquired by it in the offer have not been acquired on a non-discretionary basis on behalf of, nor have they been acquired with a view to their offer

221

TABLE OF CONTENTS

or resale to, persons in circumstances which may give rise to an offer of shares to the public other than their offer or resale in a Relevant Member State to Qualified Investors as so defined or in circumstances in which the prior consent of the underwriters has been obtained to each such proposed offer or resale.

United Kingdom

This prospectus may only be communicated or caused to be communicated to persons in the United Kingdom in circumstances where section 21(1) of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 does not apply. In the United Kingdom, this prospectus is only addressed to and directed to Qualified Investors (i) who have professional experience in matters relating to investments falling within the definition of “investment professional” in Article 19(5) of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (Financial Promotion) Order 2005 (the “Order”); or (ii) who are high net worth entities and other persons to whom it may lawfully be communicated falling within Article 49(2)(a) to (d) of the Order (all such persons together being referred to as “relevant persons”). Any investment or investment activity to which this prospectus relates is available only to relevant persons and will only be engaged with relevant persons. Any person who is not a relevant person should not act or rely on this prospectus or any of its contents.

Hong Kong

The common shares may not be offered or sold in Hong Kong by means of any document other than (i) in circumstances which do not constitute an offer to the public within the meaning of the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance (Cap. 32 of the Laws of Hong Kong) (“Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance”) or which do not constitute an invitation to the public within the meaning of the Securities and Futures Ordinance (Cap. 571 of the Laws of Hong Kong) (“Securities and Futures Ordinance”), or (ii) to “professional investors” as defined in the Securities and Futures Ordinance and any rules made thereunder, or (iii) in other circumstances which do not result in the document being a “prospectus” as defined in the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance, and no advertisement, invitation or document relating to the common shares may be issued or may be in the possession of any person for the purpose of issue (in each case whether in Hong Kong or elsewhere), which is directed at, or the contents of which are likely to be accessed or read by, the public in Hong Kong (except if permitted to do so under the securities laws of Hong Kong) other than with respect to common shares which are or are intended to be disposed of only to persons outside Hong Kong or only to “professional investors” in Hong Kong as defined in the Securities and Futures Ordinance and any rules made thereunder.

Singapore

This prospectus has not been registered as a prospectus with the Monetary Authority of Singapore. Accordingly, this prospectus and any other document or material in connection with the offer or sale, or invitation for subscription or purchase, of the common shares may not be circulated or distributed, nor may the common shares be offered or sold, or be made the subject of an invitation for subscription or purchase, whether directly or indirectly, to persons in Singapore other than (i) to an institutional investor (as defined under Section 4A of the Securities and Futures Act, Chapter 289 of Singapore (the “SFA”)) under Section 274 of the SFA, (ii) to a relevant person (as defined in Section 275(2) of the SFA) pursuant to Section 275(1) of the SFA, or any person pursuant to Section 275(1A) of the SFA, and in accordance with the conditions specified in Section 275 of the SFA or (iii) otherwise pursuant to, and in accordance with the conditions of, any other applicable provision of the SFA, in each case subject to conditions set forth in the SFA.

Where the common shares are subscribed or purchased under Section 275 of the SFA by a relevant person which is a corporation (which is not an accredited investor (as defined in Section 4A of the SFA)) the sole business of which is to hold investments and the entire share capital of which is owned by one or more individuals, each of whom is an accredited investor, the securities (as defined in Section 239(1) of the SFA) of that corporation shall not be transferable for 6 months after that corporation has acquired the common shares under Section 275 of the SFA except: (1) to an institutional investor under Section 274 of the SFA or to a relevant person (as defined in Section 275(2) of the SFA), (2) where such transfer arises from an offer in that corporation's securities pursuant to Section 275(1A) of the SFA, (3) where no

222

TABLE OF CONTENTS

consideration is or will be given for the transfer, (4) where the transfer is by operation of law, (5) as specified in Section 276(7) of the SFA, or (6) as specified in Regulation 32 of the Securities and Futures (Offers of Investments) (Shares and Debentures) Regulations 2005 of Singapore (“Regulation 32”).

Where the common shares are subscribed or purchased under Section 275 of the SFA by a relevant person which is a trust (where the trustee is not an accredited investor (as defined in Section 4A of the SFA)) whose sole purpose is to hold investments and each beneficiary of the trust is an accredited investor, the beneficiaries' rights and interest (howsoever described) in that trust shall not be transferable for 6 months after that trust has acquired the common shares under Section 275 of the SFA except: (1) to an institutional investor under Section 274 of the SFA or to a relevant person (as defined in Section 275(2) of the SFA), (2) where such transfer arises from an offer that is made on terms that such rights or interest are acquired at a consideration of not less than 200,000 Singapore dollars (or its equivalent in a foreign currency) for each transaction (whether such amount is to be paid for in cash or by exchange of securities or other assets), (3) where no consideration is or will be given for the transfer, (4) where the transfer is by operation of law, (5) as specified in Section 276(7) of the SFA, or (6) as specified in Regulation 32.

Japan

The common shares have not been and will not be registered under the Financial Instruments and Exchange Act of Japan (Act No. 25 of 1948, as amended), or the FIEA. The common shares may not be offered or sold, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to or for the benefit of any resident of Japan (including any person resident in Japan or any corporation or other entity organized under the laws of Japan) or to others for reoffering or resale, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to or for the benefit of any resident of Japan, except pursuant to an exemption from the registration requirements of the FIEA and otherwise in compliance with any relevant laws and regulations of Japan.

Bermuda

This registration statement is not subject to and has not received approval from either the BMA or the Registrar of Companies in Bermuda and no statement to the contrary, explicit or implicit, is authorized to be made in this regard. No shares may be offered or sold in Bermuda unless in compliance with the provisions of the Investment Business Act 2003 of Bermuda (as amended). Additionally, non-Bermudian persons may not carry on or engage in any trade or business in Bermuda unless such persons are authorized to do so under applicable Bermuda legislation. Engaging in the activity of offering or marketing the securities being offered to persons in Bermuda may be deemed to be carrying on business in Bermuda.

We, the selling shareholders, the underwriters and their affiliates and others will rely upon the truth and accuracy of the foregoing representations, acknowledgements and agreements.

223

TABLE OF CONTENTS

VALIDITY OF THE COMMON SHARES

The validity of the common shares offered hereby has been passed upon by Conyers Dill & Pearman Limited, Hamilton, Bermuda, special Bermuda legal counsel. We are also being represented as to US matters by Sullivan & Cromwell LLP, New York, New York. The underwriters are being advised as to certain legal matters by Davis Polk & Wardwell LLP, New York, New York.

224

TABLE OF CONTENTS

EXPERTS

The consolidated financial statements of the Company as of December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 have been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers Ltd. (offices at Dorchester House, 7 Church Street, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda), an independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in their report thereon, appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon such report given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

In the second half of 2015, in connection with the Company’s decision to pursue a public offering in the US, the Audit Committee undertook a substantive review of PwC’s independence with respect to the Company under applicable SEC independence rules and identified certain relationships that were inconsistent with the Regulation S-X auditor independence rules, specifically (i) a non-audit service, as described below, provided by PwC that included a contingent fee arrangement and (ii) certain individuals’ ordinary course retail banking relationships.

In January 2015, the Company entered into an arrangement (the “Arrangement”) with PricewaterhouseCoopers Human Capital Consulting Ltd. (“PwC HCC”), an affiliated entity of PwC. PwC HCC’s responsibilities under the Arrangement were to identify potential candidates for the Chief Accountant position at the Company; PwC HCC provided the Company with the resumes of two potential candidates. Thereafter, PwC HCC had no further involvement in the recruitment process. One of the candidates identified by PwC was ultimately hired by the Company for the position on April 1, 2015, following a further process conducted solely internally by Company management and the Audit Committee. PwC HCC’s fee was $39,690, subject to a contractual provision contemplating 50% of the fee paid to PwC HCC being returned should the person not remain in the position for six months and if no suitable replacement could be found by PwC HCC.

In connection with the Audit Committee’s evaluation of PwC’s independence under applicable SEC independence rules under Regulation S-X, in June 2015 the Company and PwC HCC agreed that PwC HCC would amend its engagement letter to remove the fee contingency and refund the fees it had received from the Company. As part of its review, the Audit Committee considered whether the Arrangement impaired PwC’s objectivity and integrity with respect to any “mutual interest” that PwC would have with the Company relating to the matters covered by the Arrangement (including the potential appearance thereof), as well as the amount and nature of the fee. The Audit Committee determined that, in light of the limited nature of PwC’s involvement in the hiring process and lack of visibility into the Company’s ultimate actions and decisions with respect to hiring and retention decisions, as well as the immateriality of the amount of the fee to both the Company and PwC, the Arrangement, including the contingent fee payment aspect thereof, did not impair the ability of PwC to exercise objective and impartial judgement in the audit of the Company’s financial statements. PwC also separately arrived at the same determination.

The Audit Committee also reviewed the covered person relationships requirements pursuant to Regulation S-X, which prohibit deposit relationships with certain covered persons when there is no deposit insurance (as was the case in Bermuda for the first two quarters of 2016). The review identified that the Company had provided certain basic financial services (relating to savings, checking and brokerage accounts as well as one mortgage) to certain “covered persons” at PwC. The individuals at PwC and the Company promptly took action to ensure that the covered persons arranged for alternative banking relationships, and that their respective accounts with the Company were terminated. Due to the ordinary course nature of these services, and on the basis that the relationships were terminated prior to the commencement of the 2015 financial year audit, the Audit Committee and PwC each separately determined that these prior financial relationships would not impair the ability of the covered persons to exercise objective and impartial judgement in the audit of the Company’s financial statements. The Audit Committee also noted the limited number of banking alternatives available for the covered persons in Bermuda.

The Audit Committee (assisted by legal counsel) and PwC thoroughly considered the impact that the Arrangement, including potential “mutuality of interest” considerations and the contingent fee payment, and the personal financial account relationships with certain covered persons, may have had on PwC’s independence with respect to the Company. PwC and the Audit Committee considered these matters in light of all available facts and circumstances and determined that no reasonable investor with knowledge

225

TABLE OF CONTENTS

of all relevant facts and circumstances would conclude that PwC has not been capable of exercising objective and impartial judgment in connection with the audit engagement.

In making this determination, both the Audit Committee and PwC considered, among other things, the facts and circumstances described above and the following:

the amount of funds involved and the fees paid to PwC HCC were de minimis;
potential “mutuality of interest” and appearance considerations arising from the Arrangement, which were determined not to raise concerns with PwC’s ability to exercise objective and impartial judgment, given the limited nature of PwC’s involvement in the hiring process and lack of visibility into the Company’s ultimate actions and decisions with respect to hiring and retention decisions;
the Audit Committee’s determination that the arrangements with PwC were permissible under the independence standards in effect for the prior audits of the Company under the International Ethics Standards Board for Accountants; and
upon the Company’s decision to consider a public offering in the US, the Company and PwC took prompt corrective action upon learning of the impact of these matters under applicable SEC independence rules and the financial interests and fee structure were resolved prior to the commencement of the engagement to audit the Company’s 2015 financial statements.

We are not aware, based on our own review, of any additional non-audit services that may bear on PwC’s independence in performing audit services for us.

226

TABLE OF CONTENTS

ENFORCEMENT OF CIVIL LIABILITIES

The Bank is incorporated under the laws of Bermuda. As a result, the rights of holders of the Bank’s common shares will be governed by Bermuda law and the Butterfield Act and the Bank’s bye-laws. The rights of shareholders under Bermuda law may differ from the rights of shareholders of companies incorporated in other jurisdictions. Some of our directors and some of the named experts referred to in this registration statement are not residents of the United States, and a substantial portion of our assets are located outside the United States. As a result, it may be difficult for investors to effect service of process on those persons in the United States or to enforce in the United States judgments obtained in US courts against us or those persons based on the civil liability provisions of the US federal securities laws. However, we may be served with process in the United States with respect to actions against us arising out of or in connection with violations of US federal securities laws relating to offers and sales of common shares made hereby by serving C T Corporation System, 111 Eighth Avenue, New York, New York 10011, our US agent irrevocably appointed for that purpose.

It is doubtful whether courts in Bermuda will enforce judgments obtained in other jurisdictions, including the United States, against us or our directors or officers under the securities laws of those jurisdictions, or entertain actions in Bermuda against us or our directors or officers under the securities laws of other jurisdictions.

227

TABLE OF CONTENTS

EXPENSES OF THE OFFERING

The following table sets forth all expenses, other than the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions, payable by us in connection with this offering. All the amounts shown are estimates except for the SEC registration fee and the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (“FINRA”) filing fee.

Item
Amount
to be paid
SEC registration fee
$
      
(1)
FINRA filing fee
$
 
(1)
Printing and engraving expenses
$
 
(1)
Legal fees and expenses
$
 
(1)
Accounting fees and expenses
$
 
(1)
Transfer Agent fees and expenses
$
 
(1)
Other advisory fees and expenses
$
 
(1)
Miscellaneous fees and expenses
$
 
(1)
Total
$
 
(1)
(1)To be filed by amendment.

These expenses will be borne by us, except for underwriting discounts and commissions, which will be borne by the selling shareholders in proportion to the numbers of common shares sold in the offering by the selling shareholders.

228

TABLE OF CONTENTS

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

The Bank has filed with the SEC a registration statement (including amendments and exhibits to the registration statement) on Form F-1 under the Securities Act covering the common shares to be sold in this offering. This prospectus, which is part of the registration statement, does not contain all of the information set forth in the registration statement and the exhibits and schedules to the registration statement. For further information, we refer you to the registration statement and the exhibits and schedules filed as part of the registration statement. If a document has been filed as an exhibit to the registration statement, we refer you to the copy of the document that has been filed. Each statement in this prospectus relating to a document filed as an exhibit is qualified in all respects by the filed exhibit.

Upon completion of our IPO, we became subject to periodic reporting and other informational requirements of the Exchange Act as applicable to foreign private issuers. Accordingly, we are required to file reports, including annual reports on Form 20-F, and other information with the SEC. However, we are allowed four months to file our annual report with the SEC instead of approximately three, and we are not required to disclose certain detailed information regarding executive compensation that is required from United States domestic issuers. In addition, we are not required under the Exchange Act to file periodic reports and financial statements with the SEC as frequently as companies that are not foreign private issuers whose securities are registered under the Exchange Act. However, press releases related to financial results and material events have been and will continue to be furnished to the SEC on Form 6-Ks. Also, as a foreign private issuer, we are exempt from the rules of the Exchange Act prescribing the furnishing of proxy statements to shareholders, and our senior management, directors and principal shareholders are exempt from the reporting and “short-swing” profit recovery provisions contained in Section 16 of the Exchange Act.

As a foreign private issuer, we are also exempt from the requirements of Regulation FD (Fair Disclosure) which, generally, are meant to ensure that select groups of investors are not privy to specific information about an issuer before other investors. We are, however, still subject to the anti-fraud and anti-manipulation rules of the SEC, such as Rule 10b-5 under the Securities Act. Since many of the disclosure obligations required of us as a foreign private issuer are different than those required by other United States domestic reporting companies, the Bank’s shareholders, potential shareholders and the investing public in general should not expect to receive information about us in the same amount, and at the same time, as information is received from, or provided by, other United States domestic reporting companies. We are liable for violations of the rules and regulations of the SEC which do apply to us as a foreign private issuer, see “Implications of Being an Emerging Growth Company and a Foreign Private Issuer”.

You may review and copy the registration statement, reports and other information we file at the SEC’s Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, DC 20549. You may also request copies of these documents upon payment of a duplicating fee by writing to the SEC.

For further information on the Public Reference Room, please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. Our SEC filings, including the registration statement, are also available to you on the SEC’s website at http://www.sec.gov. This site contains reports, proxy and information statements and other information regarding issuers that file electronically with the SEC. The information on that website is not part of this prospectus.

229

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of
The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited

In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of operations, of comprehensive income, of changes in shareholders’ equity and of cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited and its subsidiaries as of December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2016 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits of these financial statements in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers Ltd.
Hamilton, Bermuda
February 13, 2017

F-2

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Consolidated Balance Sheets
(In thousands of US dollars, except share and per share data)

 
As at
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and demand deposits with banks - Non-interest bearing
 
110,741
 
 
110,895
 
Demand deposits with banks - Interest bearing
 
326,437
 
 
378,629
 
Cash equivalents - Interest bearing
 
1,664,473
 
 
1,799,366
 
Cash due from banks
 
2,101,651
 
 
2,288,890
 
Securities purchased under agreement to resell
 
148,813
 
 
 
Short-term investments
 
519,755
 
 
409,482
 
Investment in securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading
 
6,313
 
 
321,299
 
Available-for-sale
 
3,332,738
 
 
2,201,349
 
Held-to-maturity (fair value: $1,046,828 (2015: $701,495))
 
1,061,103
 
 
701,282
 
Total investment in securities
 
4,400,154
 
 
3,223,930
 
Loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans
 
3,614,725
 
 
4,049,457
 
Allowance for credit losses
 
(44,247
)
 
(49,302
)
Loans, net of allowance for credit losses
 
3,570,478
 
 
4,000,155
 
Premises, equipment and computer software
 
167,773
 
 
183,378
 
Accrued interest
 
22,780
 
 
17,460
 
Goodwill
 
19,622
 
 
23,462
 
Intangible assets
 
42,289
 
 
27,669
 
Equity method investments
 
13,482
 
 
12,786
 
Other real estate owned
 
14,199
 
 
11,206
 
Other assets
 
82,549
 
 
77,145
 
Total assets
 
11,103,545
 
 
10,275,563
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customer deposits
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest bearing
 
1,733,684
 
 
1,348,878
 
Interest bearing
 
4,213,417
 
 
2,922,830
 
Non-Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest bearing
 
651,329
 
 
532,867
 
Interest bearing
 
3,411,423
 
 
4,363,093
 
Total customer deposits
 
10,009,853
 
 
9,167,668
 
Bank deposits
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bermuda
 
344
 
 
403
 
Non-Bermuda
 
23,452
 
 
14,075
 
Total deposits
 
10,033,649
 
 
9,182,146
 
Employee benefit plans
 
139,967
 
 
122,135
 
Accrued interest
 
2,143
 
 
2,744
 
Preference share dividends payable
 
 
 
654
 
Other liabilities
 
100,044
 
 
100,530
 
Total other liabilities
 
242,154
 
 
226,063
 
Long-term debt
 
117,000
 
 
117,000
 
Total liabilities
 
10,392,803
 
 
9,525,209
 
Commitments, contingencies and guarantees (Note 12)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Shareholders’ equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preference share capital (USD 0.01 par; USD 1,000 liquidation preference) issued and outstanding: nil (2015: 182,863)
 
 
 
2
 
Common share capital (BMD 0.01 par; authorised voting ordinary shares 2,000,000,000 and non-voting ordinary shares 6,000,000,000) issued and outstanding: 53,284,872 (2015: 47,293,253)
 
533
 
 
473
 
Additional paid-in capital
 
1,142,608
 
 
1,225,344
 
Accumulated deficit
 
(287,677
)
 
(368,618
)
Less: treasury common shares, at cost: 2,066 (2015: 924,031)
 
(42
)
 
(16,350
)
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
 
(144,680
)
 
(90,497
)
Total shareholders’ equity
 
710,742
 
 
750,354
 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 
11,103,545
 
 
10,275,563
 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

F-3

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Consolidated Statements of Operations
(In thousands of US dollars, except per share data)

 
Year ended
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Non-interest income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset management
 
21,106
 
 
18,910
 
 
17,728
 
Banking
 
39,342
 
 
35,221
 
 
34,280
 
Foreign exchange revenue
 
30,606
 
 
31,896
 
 
29,379
 
Trust
 
44,060
 
 
40,264
 
 
38,268
 
Custody and other administration services
 
8,883
 
 
9,522
 
 
10,166
 
Other non-interest income
 
3,476
 
 
4,359
 
 
5,009
 
Total non-interest income
 
147,473
 
 
140,172
 
 
134,830
 
Interest income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest and fees on loans
 
188,000
 
 
186,486
 
 
191,986
 
Investments (none of the investment securities are intrinsically tax-exempt)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading
 
1,725
 
 
5,894
 
 
9,078
 
Available-for-sale
 
53,184
 
 
51,077
 
 
48,044
 
Held-to-maturity
 
22,261
 
 
12,607
 
 
10,635
 
Deposits with banks
 
9,759
 
 
6,517
 
 
5,358
 
Total interest income
 
274,929
 
 
262,581
 
 
265,101
 
Interest expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
 
11,831
 
 
18,446
 
 
20,903
 
Long-term debt
 
4,500
 
 
4,861
 
 
5,628
 
Securities sold under repurchase agreements
 
118
 
 
8
 
 
83
 
Total interest expense
 
16,449
 
 
23,315
 
 
26,614
 
Net interest income before provision for credit losses
 
258,480
 
 
239,266
 
 
238,487
 
Provision for credit losses
 
(4,399
)
 
(5,741
)
 
(8,048
)
Net interest income after provision for credit losses
 
254,081
 
 
233,525
 
 
230,439
 
Net trading gains (losses)
 
715
 
 
(562
)
 
10,070
 
Net realised gains (losses) on available-for-sale investments
 
1,546
 
 
(4,407
)
 
8,680
 
Net gains (losses) on other real estate owned
 
(440
)
 
277
 
 
(1,804
)
Impairment of fixed assets
 
 
 
(5,083
)
 
(1,986
)
Net gain on sale of equity method investments
 
 
 
 
 
277
 
Net other gains (losses)
 
(807
)
 
338
 
 
451
 
Total other gains (losses)
 
1,014
 
 
(9,437
)
 
15,688
 
Total net revenue
 
402,568
 
 
364,260
 
 
380,957
 
Non-interest expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Salaries and other employee benefits
 
139,967
 
 
134,917
 
 
129,761
 
Technology and communications
 
57,441
 
 
57,069
 
 
57,119
 
Property
 
21,043
 
 
21,539
 
 
24,312
 
Professional and outside services
 
18,851
 
 
27,638
 
 
24,022
 
Indirect taxes
 
16,352
 
 
13,882
 
 
14,175
 
Amortisation of intangible assets
 
4,514
 
 
4,424
 
 
4,281
 
Marketing
 
4,513
 
 
3,919
 
 
3,802
 
Restructuring costs
 
6,266
 
 
2,183
 
 
 
Other expenses
 
16,952
 
 
19,674
 
 
15,495
 
Total non-interest expense
 
285,899
 
 
285,245
 
 
272,967
 
Net income before income taxes
 
116,669
 
 
79,015
 
 
107,990
 
Income tax expense
 
(727
)
 
(1,276
)
 
169
 
Net income
 
115,942
 
 
77,739
 
 
108,159
 
Cash dividends declared on preference shares
 
(13,979
)
 
(14,631
)
 
(14,712
)
Preference shares guarantee fee
 
(1,676
)
 
(1,824
)
 
(1,834
)
Premium paid on repurchase of preference shares
 
(41,913
)
 
(28
)
 
(96
)
Net income attributable to common shareholders
 
58,374
 
 
61,256
 
 
91,517
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Earnings per common share
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic earnings per share
 
1.20
 
 
1.25
 
 
1.67
 
Diluted earnings per share
 
1.18
 
 
1.23
 
 
1.65
 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

F-4

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income
(In thousands of US dollars)

 
Year ended
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Net income
 
115,942
 
 
77,739
 
 
108,159
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of taxes
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in unrealised gains and losses on translation of net investment in foreign operations
 
(6,507
)
 
(3,139
)
 
(2,874
)
Accretion of net unrealised (gains) losses on held-to-maturity investments transferred from available-for-sale investments
 
(71
)
 
365
 
 
 
Net change in unrealised gains and losses on available-for-sale investments
 
(21,181
)
 
(11,793
)
 
40,085
 
Employee benefit plans adjustments
 
(26,424
)
 
1,590
 
 
(47,143
)
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of taxes
 
(54,183
)
 
(12,977
)
 
(9,932
)
Total comprehensive income
 
61,759
 
 
64,762
 
 
98,227
 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

F-5

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity

 
Year ended
 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
31 December 2014
 
Number of
shares
In thousands of
US dollars
Number of
shares
In thousands of
US dollars
Number of
shares
In thousands of
US dollars
Common share capital issued and outstanding
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of year
 
47,293,253
 
 
473
 
 
55,002,314
 
 
550
 
 
54,980,346
 
 
550
 
Conversion of contingent value preference shares
 
 
 
 
 
690,939
 
 
7
 
 
21,968
 
 
 
Retirement of shares
 
(2,393
)
 
 
 
(8,400,000
)
 
(84
)
 
 
 
 
Issuance of common shares
 
5,994,012
 
 
60
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at end of year
 
53,284,872
 
 
533
 
 
47,293,253
 
 
473
 
 
55,002,314
 
 
550
 
Preference shares
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of year
 
182,863
 
 
2
 
 
183,046
 
 
2
 
 
183,606
 
 
2
 
Repurchase and cancellation of preference shares
 
 
 
 
 
(183
)
 
 
 
(560
)
 
 
Redemption of preference shares
 
(182,863
)
 
(2
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at end of year
 
 
 
 
 
182,863
 
 
2
 
 
183,046
 
 
2
 
Contingent value convertible preference shares
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of year
 
 
 
 
 
690,939
 
 
7
 
 
712,907
 
 
7
 
Conversion to common shares
 
 
 
 
 
(690,939
)
 
(7
)
 
(21,968
)
 
 
Balance at end of year
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
690,939
 
 
7
 
Additional paid-in capital
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of year
 
 
 
 
1,225,344
 
 
 
 
 
1,353,477
 
 
 
 
 
1,349,767
 
Share-based compensation
 
 
 
 
14,072
 
 
 
 
 
7,703
 
 
 
 
 
8,869
 
Share-based settlements
 
 
 
 
(10,626
)
 
 
 
 
(9,749
)
 
 
 
 
(4,503
)
Reduction of carrying value on repurchase of preference shares
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(183
)
 
 
 
 
(560
)
Premium paid on repurchase of preference shares
 
 
 
 
(41,913
)
 
 
 
 
(28
)
 
 
 
 
(96
)
Redemption of preference shares
 
 
 
 
(170,206
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Retirement of common shares
 
 
 
 
(45
)
 
 
 
 
(125,876
)
 
 
 
 
 
Repurchase of warrant
 
 
 
 
(100
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cost of issuance of common shares
 
 
 
 
(5,458
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Issuance of common shares, net of underwriting discounts and commissions
 
 
 
 
131,540
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at end of year
 
 
 
 
1,142,608
 
 
 
 
 
1,225,344
 
 
 
 
 
1,353,477
 
Accumulated deficit
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of year
 
 
 
 
(368,618
)
 
 
 
 
(405,056
)
 
 
 
 
(469,229
)
Net income for year
 
 
 
 
115,942
 
 
 
 
 
77,739
 
 
 
 
 
108,159
 
Common share cash dividends declared and paid, $0.40 per share (2015: $0.50 per share; 2014: $0.50 per share)
 
 
 
 
(19,346
)
 
 
 
 
(24,846
)
 
 
 
 
(27,440
)
Cash dividends declared on preference shares, $80.00 per share (2015: $80.00 per share; 2014: $80.00 per share)
 
 
 
 
(13,979
)
 
 
 
 
(14,631
)
 
 
 
 
(14,712
)
Preference shares guarantee fee
 
 
 
 
(1,676
)
 
 
 
 
(1,824
)
 
 
 
 
(1,834
)
Balance at end of year
 
 
 
 
(287,677
)
 
 
 
 
(368,618
)
 
 
 
 
(405,056
)
Treasury common shares
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of year
 
924,031
 
 
(16,350
)
 
1,277,060
 
 
(22,086
)
 
831,042
 
 
(10,948
)
Purchase of treasury common shares
 
97,053
 
 
(1,588
)
 
250,370
 
 
(4,862
)
 
856,734
 
 
(17,018
)
Share-based settlements
 
(1,019,016
)
 
17,896
 
 
(603,399
)
 
10,598
 
 
(410,716
)
 
5,880
 
Fractional share payout
 
(2
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at end of year
 
2,066
 
 
(42
)
 
924,031
 
 
(16,350
)
 
1,277,060
 
 
(22,086
)
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of year
 
 
 
 
(90,497
)
 
 
 
 
(77,520
)
 
 
 
 
(67,588
)
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of taxes
 
 
 
 
(54,183
)
 
 
 
 
(12,977
)
 
 
 
 
(9,932
)
Balance at end of year
 
 
 
 
(144,680
)
 
 
 
 
(90,497
)
 
 
 
 
(77,520
)
Total shareholders’ equity
 
 
 
 
710,742
 
 
 
 
 
750,354
 
 
 
 
 
849,374
 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

F-6

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
(In thousands of US dollars)

 
Year ended
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Cash flows from operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
 
115,942
 
 
77,739
 
 
108,159
 
Adjustments to reconcile net income to operating cash flows
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation and amortisation
 
52,261
 
 
50,069
 
 
45,116
 
Provision for credit losses
 
4,399
 
 
5,741
 
 
8,048
 
Share-based payments and settlements
 
14,423
 
 
7,913
 
 
9,049
 
Impairment of fixed assets
 
 
 
5,083
 
 
1,986
 
Net realised (gains) losses on available-for-sale investments
 
(1,546
)
 
4,407
 
 
(8,680
)
Equity pick up on private equity partnership investment
 
(42
)
 
(224
)
 
(458
)
(Gain) loss on sale of premises and equipment
 
(37
)
 
28
 
 
 
Net (gains) losses on other real estate owned
 
440
 
 
(277
)
 
1,804
 
Net (gain) on sales of equity method investments
 
 
 
 
 
(277
)
(Increase) in carrying value of equity method investments
 
(1,137
)
 
(980
)
 
(834
)
Fair value adjustments of a contingent payment
 
895
 
 
(143
)
 
1,070
 
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(Increase) decrease in accrued interest receivable
 
(6,054
)
 
1,417
 
 
594
 
(Increase) in other assets
 
(6,652
)
 
(10,259
)
 
(3,955
)
Increase (decrease) in accrued interest payable
 
(284
)
 
(1,907
)
 
1,040
 
Increase (decrease) in employee benefit plans and other liabilities
 
5,587
 
 
16,932
 
 
(18,885
)
Cash provided by operating activities
 
178,195
 
 
155,539
 
 
143,777
 
Cash flows from investing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(Increase) in securities purchased under agreement to resell
 
(148,813
)
 
 
 
 
Net (increase) in short-term investments
 
(127,708
)
 
(28,358
)
 
(343,773
)
Net change in trading investments
 
314,986
 
 
96,086
 
 
134,905
 
Available-for-sale investments: proceeds from sale
 
60,548
 
 
238,756
 
 
130,453
 
Available-for-sale investments: proceeds from maturities and pay downs
 
576,892
 
 
435,827
 
 
198,311
 
Available-for-sale investments: purchases
 
(1,884,554
)
 
(1,018,759
)
 
(800,865
)
Held-to-maturity investments: proceeds from maturities and pay downs
 
73,725
 
 
26,965
 
 
12,426
 
Held-to-maturity investments: purchases
 
(360,959
)
 
(50,283
)
 
(18,073
)
Net (increase) decrease in loans
 
321,722
 
 
(36,876
)
 
145,023
 
Additions to premises, equipment and computer software
 
(9,804
)
 
(1,477
)
 
(6,128
)
Proceeds from sale of other real estate owned
 
5,528
 
 
11,238
 
 
12,389
 
Dividends received on equity method investments
 
441
 
 
1,032
 
 
806
 
Net amounts received for assuming deposits acquired from another bank
 
 
 
 
 
310,578
 
Cash disbursed for business acquisitions
 
(21,778
)
 
 
 
(34,757
)
Cash used in investing activities
 
(1,199,774
)
 
(325,849
)
 
(258,705
)
Cash flows from financing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net increase in demand and term deposit liabilities
 
1,056,029
 
 
598,578
 
 
637,705
 
Net (decrease) in securities sold under agreement to repurchase
 
 
 
 
 
(25,535
)
Proceeds from issuance of common shares, net of underwriting discounts and commissions
 
131,600
 
 
 
 
 
Cost of issuance of common shares
 
(5,458
)
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from loans sold under agreement to repurchase
 
5,152
 
 
 
 
 
Cost of repurchase of loans under agreement to repurchase
 
(5,152
)
 
 
 
 
Repayment of long-term debt
 
 
 
 
 
(90,000
)
Common shares repurchased
 
(1,633
)
 
(130,822
)
 
(17,018
)
Preference shares repurchased
 
(212,121
)
 
(211
)
 
(656
)
Warrant repurchased
 
(100
)
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from stock option exercises
 
6,919
 
 
640
 
 
1,198
 
Cash dividends paid on common and contingent value convertible preference
shares
 
(19,346
)
 
(24,846
)
 
(27,440
)
Cash dividends paid on preference shares
 
(14,629
)
 
(14,631
)
 
(14,673
)
Preference shares guarantee fee paid
 
(1,676
)
 
(1,824
)
 
(1,834
)
Cash provided by financing activities
 
939,585
 
 
426,884
 
 
461,747
 
Net effect of exchange rates on cash due from banks
 
(105,245
)
 
(30,995
)
 
(13,980
)
Net increase (decrease) in cash due from banks
 
(187,239
)
 
225,579
 
 
332,839
 
Cash due from banks at beginning of year
 
2,288,890
 
 
2,063,311
 
 
1,730,472
 
Cash due from banks at end of year
 
2,101,651
 
 
2,288,890
 
 
2,063,311
 
Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash interest paid
 
16,165
 
 
21,408
 
 
27,654
 
Cash income tax paid
 
391
 
 
596
 
 
985
 
Non-cash items
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Transfer to other real estate owned
 
8,961
 
 
3,400
 
 
6,086
 
Transfer of available-for-sale investments to held-to-maturity investments
 
74,731
 
 
340,969
 
 
 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

F-7

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Note 1: Nature of business

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited (“Butterfield”, the “Bank” or the “Company”) is incorporated under the laws of Bermuda and has a banking licence under the Bank and Deposit Companies Act, 1999 (“the Act”). Butterfield is regulated by the Bermuda Monetary Authority (“BMA”), which operates in accordance with Basel principles.

Butterfield is a full service community bank in Bermuda and Cayman and a provider of specialised wealth management services in all its jurisdictions. Services offered include retail, private and corporate banking, treasury, custody, asset management and personal and institutional trust services. The Bank provides such services from six jurisdictions: Bermuda, Cayman, Guernsey, Switzerland, The Bahamas and the United Kingdom. The Bank holds all applicable licences required in the jurisdictions in which it operates.

On 16 September 2016, the Bank’s common shares began to trade on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “NTB”. On 21 September 2016, the Bank completed its offering of 5,957,447 common shares, at $23.50 per share. The proceeds, net of the underwriting discounts and commissions, were $131.6 million.

Note 2: Significant accounting policies

A. Basis of Presentation and Use of Estimates and Assumptions

The accounting and financial reporting policies of the Bank and its subsidiaries conform to generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America (“GAAP”). The preparation of consolidated financial statements in accordance with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the year, and actual results could differ from those estimates.

Critical accounting estimates are those that require management to make subjective or complex judgments about the effect of matters that are inherently uncertain and may change in subsequent periods. Changes that may be required in the underlying assumptions or estimates in these areas could have a material impact on the future financial condition and results of operations. Management believes that the most critical accounting policies upon which the financial condition depends, and which involve the most complex or subjective decisions or assessments, are as follows:

Allowance for credit losses
Fair value and impairment of financial instruments
Impairment of long-lived assets
Impairment of goodwill
Employee benefit plans
Share-based payments

Beginning on 1 January 2016, the Bank’s financial statements for periods presented are reported in United States (“US”) dollars (previously in Bermuda dollars) to increase comparability of the Bank’s financial position and results with market peers. Assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses denominated in Bermuda dollars are translated to US dollars at par and consequently, no amounts presented in the financial statements have changed as a result of this change in reporting currency.

B. Basis of Consolidation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and its wholly-owned subsidiaries (collectively the “Bank”), and those variable interest entities (“VIEs”) where the Company is the primary beneficiary. Intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated. The Bank

F-8

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

consolidates subsidiaries where it holds, directly or indirectly, more than 50% of the voting rights or where it exercises control. The Bank is deemed to have a controlling financial interest and is the primary beneficiary of a VIE if it has both the power to direct the activities of the VIE that most significantly impact the VIE economic performance and an obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive benefits that could potentially be significant to the VIE. The determination of whether the Bank meets the criteria to be considered the primary beneficiary of a VIE requires a periodic evaluation of all transactions (such as investments, loans and fee arrangements) with the entity. During the periods under review, the Bank had no interests in VIEs where the Bank was considered the primary beneficiary.

Entities where the Bank holds 20% to 50% of the voting rights and/or has the ability to exercise significant influence, other than investments in designated VIEs, are accounted for under the equity method, and the pro rata share of their income (loss) is included in other non-interest income.

C. Foreign Currency Translation

Assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses denominated in Bermuda dollars are translated to United States (“US”) dollars at par. Assets and liabilities of the parent company arising from other foreign currency transactions are translated into US dollars at the rates of exchange prevailing at the balance sheet date. The resulting gains or losses are included in foreign exchange revenue in the consolidated statements of operations.

The assets and liabilities of foreign currency-based subsidiaries are translated at the rate of exchange prevailing on the balance sheet date, while associated revenues and expenses are translated to US dollars at the average rates of exchange prevailing throughout the year. Unrealised translation gains or losses on investments in foreign currency- based subsidiaries are recorded as a separate component of Shareholders’ equity within accumulated other comprehensive loss (“AOCL”). Gains and losses on foreign currency based subsidiaries are recorded in the consolidated statements of operations when the Bank ceases to have a controlling financial interest in a foreign currency-based subsidiary.

D. Assets Held in Trust or Custody

Securities and properties (other than cash and deposits held with the Bank and its subsidiaries) held in trust, custody, agency or fiduciary capacity for customers are not included in the consolidated balance sheets because the Bank is not the beneficiary of these assets.

E. Cash Due from Banks

Cash due from banks include cash on hand, cash items in the process of collection, amounts due from correspondent banks and highly liquid investments that are readily convertible to known amounts of cash and which are subject to an insignificant risk of change in fair value. Such investments are those with less than three months’ maturity from the date of acquisition and include unrestricted term deposits, certificates of deposit and treasury bills.

F. Securities Purchased Under Agreement to Resell

Securities purchased under agreement to resell are treated as collateralised lending transactions. The obligation to resell is recorded at the value of the cash paid on purchase adjusted for the amortisation of the difference between the purchase price and the agreed resell price. The amortisation of this amount is recorded as interest income.

G. Short-Term Investments

Short-term investments have maturities of less than one year from the date of acquisition, are only subject to an insignificant risk of change in fair value and comprise 1) restricted term and demand deposits and 2) unrestricted term deposits, certificate of deposits and treasury bills with a maturity greater than three months from the date of acquisition.

F-9

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

H. Investments

Investments securities are classified as trading, available-for-sale (“AFS”) or held-to-maturity (“HTM”).

Investments are classified as trading when management has the intent to sell these investments either for profit or to invest the cash received by taking customer deposits in foreign currencies. Debt and equity securities classified as trading investments are carried at fair value in the consolidated balance sheets, with unrealised gains and losses included in the consolidated statements of operations as net realised / unrealised gains (losses) on trading investments. Investments are classified primarily as AFS when used to manage the Bank’s exposure to interest rate and liquidity movements, as well as to make strategic longer-term investments. AFS investments are carried at fair value in the consolidated balance sheets with unrealised gains and losses reported as net increase or decrease to AOCL. Investments that the Bank has the positive intent and ability to hold to maturity are classified as HTM and are carried at amortised cost in the consolidated balance sheets. Unrecognised gains and losses on HTM securities are disclosed in the notes to the consolidated financial statements.

The specific identification method is used to determine realised gains and losses on trading, AFS and HTM investments, which are included in net realised gains and losses on AFS and HTM investments, respectively, in the consolidated statements of operations.

Dividend and interest income, including amortisation of premiums and discounts, on securities for which cash flows are not considered uncertain are included in interest income in the consolidated statements of operations. For securities with uncertain cash flows, the investments are accounted for under the cost recovery method, whereby all principal and coupon payments received are applied as a reduction of the amortised cost and carrying amount. Accrual of income is suspended in respect of debt securities that are in default, or from which it is unlikely that future interest payments will be received as scheduled.

Contained within other assets are investments in private equity for which the Bank does not have sufficient rights or ownership interests to follow the equity method of accounting. Unquoted equity investments which are held directly by the Bank and which do not have readily determinable fair values are recorded at cost and reviewed for impairment if indicators of impairment exist.

Equity method investments which include investments whereby the Bank has the ability to influence, but not control, the financial or operating policies of such entities, are accounted for using the equity method of accounting.

Recognition of other-than-temporary impairments

For debt securities, management considers a decline in fair value to be other-than-temporary when it does not expect to recover the entire amortised cost basis of the security. Investments in debt securities in unrealised loss positions are analysed as part of management’s ongoing assessment of other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”). When management intends to sell such securities or it is more likely than not that the Bank will be required to sell the securities before recovering the amortised cost, it recognises an impairment loss equal to the full difference between the amortised cost basis and the fair value of those securities. When management does not intend to sell or it is not more likely than not that the Bank will be required to sell such securities before recovering the amortised cost, management determines whether any credit losses exist to identify any OTTI.

Under certain circumstances, management will perform a qualitative determination and consider a variety of factors, including the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than cost; adverse conditions specifically related to the industry, geographic area or financial condition of the issuer or underlying collateral of a security; payment structure of the security; changes to the rating of the security by a rating agency; the volatility of the fair value changes; and changes in fair value of the security after the balance sheet date. Alternatively, management estimates cash flows over the remaining lives of the underlying security to assess whether credit losses exist.

F-10

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

In situations where there is a credit loss, only the amount of impairment relating to credit losses on AFS and HTM investments is recognised in net income. For AFS investments, the decrease in fair value relating to factors other than credit losses are recognised in AOCL. Cash flow estimates take into account expectations of relevant market and economic data as of the end of the reporting period, including, for example, underlying loan-level data, and structural features of securitisation, such as subordination, excess spread, over collateralisation or other forms of credit enhancement. The degree of judgment involved in determining the recoverable value of an investment security is dependent upon the availability of observable market prices or observable market parameters. When observable market prices and parameters do not exist, judgment is necessary to estimate recoverable value which gives rise to added uncertainty in the assessment. The assessment takes into consideration factors such as interest rate changes, movements in credit spreads, default rate assumptions, prepayment assumptions, type and quality of collateral, and market sentiment.

Management’s fair valuations may include inputs and assumptions that are less observable or require greater estimation, thereby resulting in values which may be greater or lower than the actual value at which the investments may be ultimately sold or the ultimate cash flows that may be recovered. If the assumptions on which management based its fair valuations change, the Bank may experience additional OTTI or realised losses or gains, and the period-to-period changes in value could vary significantly.

I. Loans

Loans are reported as the principal amount outstanding, net of allowance for credit losses, unearned income, fair value adjustments arising from hedge accounting and net deferred loan fees. Interest income is recognised over the term of the loan using the effective interest method, or on a basis approximating a level rate of return over the term of the loan, except for loans classified as non-accrual. Prepayments are treated as a reduction of principal outstanding which is recognized upon receipt of payment. Prepayment penalties, if applicable under the terms of the specific loan agreement, are recognized also upon receipt of payment.

Acquired loans

Acquired loans are recorded at fair value at the date of acquisition. No allowance for credit losses is recorded on the acquisition date as the fair value of the acquired assets incorporates assumptions regarding credit risk. Acquired loans with evidence of credit quality deterioration for which it is probable that the Bank will not receive all contractually required payments receivable are accounted for as purchased credit-impaired loans. Generally, acquired loans that meet the Bank’s definition for non-accrual status are considered to be credit-impaired.

The excess of the cash flows expected to be collected on purchased credit-impaired loans, measured as of the acquisition date, over the estimated fair value is referred to as the accretable yield and is recognized in interest income over the remaining life of the loan using an effective yield methodology. The difference between contractually required payments as of the acquisition date and the cash flows expected to be collected is referred to as the non-accretable difference which is included as a reduction of the carrying amount of the purchased credit-impaired loans.

The Bank evaluates at each balance sheet date the estimated cash flows and corresponding carrying value of purchased credit-impaired loans in the same manner as for the measurement of impaired loans, as is described below. The Bank evaluates at each balance sheet date whether the carrying value of its purchased credit-impaired loans has decreased and if so, recognises an allowance for credit losses in its consolidated statements of operations. For any increases in cash flows expected to be collected, the Bank adjusts any prior recorded allowance for purchased credit-impaired loans first, and then the amount of accretable yield recognized on a prospective basis over the purchased credit-impaired loan’s remaining life. Purchased credit-impaired loans are not considered non-performing and continue to have an accretable yield as long as there is a reasonable expectation about the timing and amount of cash flows expected to be collected.

F-11

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Impaired loans

A loan is considered to be impaired when, based on current information and events, the Bank determines that it will not be able to collect all amounts due according to the original loan contract, including scheduled interest payments. Impaired loans include all non-accruing loans and all loans modified in a troubled debt restructuring (“TDR”) even if full collectability is expected following the restructuring.

When a loan is identified as impaired, the impairment is measured based on the present value of expected future cash flows, discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate, except when the sole (remaining) source of repayment for the loan is the operation or liquidation of the collateral. In these cases the current fair value of the collateral, less selling costs, is used instead of discounted cash flows.

If the Bank determines that the expected realisable value of the impaired loan is less than the recorded investment in the loan (net of previous charge-offs, deferred loan fees or costs and unamortised premium or discount), impairment is recognised through an allowance estimate. If the Bank determines that part of the allowance is uncollectible, that amount is charged off.

Non-accrual

Commercial, commercial real estate and consumer loans (excluding credit card consumer loans) are placed on non-accrual status generally if:

in the opinion of management, full payment of principal or interest is in doubt; or
principal or interest is 90 days past due.

Residential mortgages are placed on non-accrual status immediately if:

in the opinion of management, full payment of principal or interest is in doubt; or
when principal or interest is 90 days past due, unless the loan is well secured and any ongoing collection efforts are reasonably expected to result in repayment of all amounts due under the contractual terms of the loan.

Interest income on non-accrual loans is recognised only to the extent it is received in cash. Cash received on non-accrual loans where there is no doubt regarding full repayment (no impairment recognised in the form of a specific allowance) is first applied as repayment of the past due principal amount of the loan and secondly to past due interest and fees.

Where there is doubt regarding the ultimate full repayment of the non-accrual loan (impairment recognised in the form of a specific allowance), all cash received is applied to reduce the principal amount of the loan. Interest income on these loans is recognised only after the entire balance receivable is recovered and interest is actually received.

Loans are returned to accrual status when:

none of the principal or accrued interest is past due (with certain exceptions as noted below) and the Bank expects repayment of the remaining contractual obligation; or
when the loan becomes well secured and in the process of collection.

Loans modified in a troubled debt restructuring (“TDR”)

A modification of a loan constitutes a TDR when a borrower is experiencing financial difficulty and the modification constitutes a concession from originally agreed terms. If a restructuring is considered a TDR, the Bank is required to make certain disclosures in the notes of the consolidated financial statements and individually evaluate the restructured loan for impairment. The Bank employs various types of concessions when modifying a loan that it would not otherwise consider which may include extension of repayment periods, interest rate reductions, principal or interest forgiveness, forbearance, and other actions intended to minimise economic loss and to avoid foreclosure or repossession of collateral.

F-12

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Commercial and industrial loans modified in a TDR often involve temporary interest-only payments, term extensions, and converting revolving credit lines to term loans. Additional collateral, a co-borrower, or a guarantor is often requested. Commercial mortgage and construction loans modified in a TDR often involve extending the maturity date at an interest rate lower than the current market rate for new debt with similar risk, or substituting or adding a new borrower or guarantor. Construction loans modified in a TDR may also involve extending the interest-only payment period.

Residential mortgage modifications generally involve a short-term forbearance period after which the missed payments are added to the end of the loan term, thereby extending the maturity date. Interest continues to accrue on the missed payments and as a result, the effective yield on the mortgage remains unchanged. As the forbearance period usually involves an insignificant payment delay they typically do not meet the reporting criteria for a TDR.

Automobile loans modified in a TDR are primarily comprised of loans where the Bank has lowered monthly payments by extending the term.

When a loan undergoes a TDR, the determination of the loan’s accrual versus non-accrual status following the modification depends on several factors. As with the risk rating process, the accrual status decision for such a loan is a separate and distinct process from the loan’s TDR analysis and determination. Management considers the following in determining the accrual status of restructured loans:

If the loan was appropriately on accrual status prior to the restructuring, the borrower has demonstrated performance under the previous terms, and the bank’s credit evaluation shows the borrower’s capacity to continue to perform under the restructured terms (both principal and interest payments), it is likely that the appropriate conclusion is for the loan to remain on accrual at the time of the restructuring. This evaluation must include consideration of the borrower’s sustained historical repayment performance for a reasonable period prior to the date on which the loan was restructured. A sustained period of repayment performance generally would be a minimum of six months and would involve payments of cash or cash equivalents; or
If the loan was on non-accrual status before the restructuring, but the bank’s credit evaluation shows the borrower’s capacity to meet the restructured terms, the loan would likely remain as non-accrual until the borrower has demonstrated a reasonable period of sustained repayment performance. As noted above, this period generally would be at least six months (thereby providing reasonable assurance as to the ultimate collection of principal and interest in full under the modified terms). Sustained performance before the restructuring may be taken into account.

Loans that have been modified in a TDR are restored to accrual status only when interest and principal payments are brought current for a continuous period of six months under the modified terms. However, performance prior to the modification, or significant events that coincide with the modification, are included in assessing whether the borrower can meet the new terms and may result in the loan being returned to accrual status at the time of loan modification or after a shorter performance period. If the borrower’s ability to meet the revised payment schedule is uncertain, the loan remains on non-accrual status.

A loan that is modified in a TDR prior to becoming impaired will be left on accrual status if full collectability in accordance with the restructured terms is expected. The Bank works with its customers in these difficult economic times and may enter into a TDR for loans that are in default, or at risk of defaulting, even if the loan is not impaired.

A loan that had previously been modified in a TDR and is subsequently refinanced under current underwriting standards at a market rate with no concessionary terms is accounted for as a new loan and is no longer reported as a TDR.

F-13

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Delinquencies

The entire balance of an account is contractually delinquent if the minimum payment of principal or interest is not received by the specified due date. Delinquency is reported on loans that are more than 30 days past due.

Charge-offs

The Bank recognises charge-offs when it determines that loans are uncollectible, and this generally occurs when all commercially reasonable means of recovering the loan balance have been exhausted.

Commercial and consumer loans are either fully or partially charged-off down to the fair value of collateral securing the loans when:

management judges the loan to be uncollectible;
repayment is expected to be protracted beyond reasonable time frames;
the asset has been classified as a loss by either the Bank’s internal loan review process or third party appraisers; or
the customer has filed bankruptcy and the loss becomes evident owing to a lack of assets or cash flow.

The outstanding balance of commercial and consumer real estate secured loans and residential mortgages that are in excess of the estimated property value, less costs to sell, is charged-off once there is reasonable assurance that such excess outstanding balance is not recoverable.

Credit card consumer loans that are contractually 180 days past due and other consumer loans with an outstanding balance under $100,000 that are contractually 180 days past due are generally written off and reported as charge-offs.

J. Allowance for Credit Losses

The Bank maintains an allowance for credit losses, which in management’s opinion is adequate to absorb all estimated credit-related losses that are incurred in its lending and off-balance sheet credit-related arrangements at the balance sheet date. The allowance for credit losses consists of specific allowances and a general allowance as follows:

Specific allowances

Specific allowances are determined on an exposure-by-exposure basis and reflect the associated estimated credit loss. The specific allowance for credit loss is computed as the difference between the recorded investment in the loan and the present value of expected future cash flows from the loan. The effective rate of return on the loan is used for discounting the cash flows. However, when foreclosure of a collateral-dependent loan is probable, the Bank measures impairment based on the fair value of the collateral. The Bank considers estimated costs to sell, on a discounted basis, in the measurement of impairment if those costs are expected to reduce the cash flows available to repay or otherwise satisfy the loan. If the measurement of an impaired loan is less than the recorded investment in the loan, then the Bank recognises impairment by creating an allowance with a corresponding charge to provision for credit losses.

For all commercial and commercial real estate TDRs, the Bank conducts further analysis to determine the probable amount of loss and establishes a specific allowance for the loan, if appropriate. The Bank estimates the impairment amount by comparing the loan’s carrying amount to the estimated present value of its future cash flows or the fair value of its underlying collateral. For collateral-dependent impaired commercial and commercial real estate loans, the excess of the Company’s recorded investment in the loan over the fair value of the collateral, less cost to sell, is charged off to the specific allowance.

F-14

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

For consumer and residential mortgage TDRs that are not collateral-dependent, allowances are developed using the present value of expected future cash flows, compared to the recorded investment in the loans. Expected re-default factors are considered in this analysis. The fair value of collateral is periodically monitored subsequent to the modification.

General allowances

The allowance for credit losses attributed to the remaining portfolio is established through various analyses that estimate the incurred loss at the balance sheet date inherent in the lending and off-balance sheet credit-related arrangements portfolios. These analyses consider historical default rates, geographic, industry, and other environmental factors. Management also considers overall portfolio indicators including trends in internally risk rated exposures, cash-basis loans, historical and forecasted write-offs, and a review of industry, geographic and portfolio concentrations, including current developments within those segments. In addition, management considers the current business strategy and credit process, including limit setting and compliance, credit approvals, loan underwriting criteria and loan workout procedures.

Each portfolio of smaller balance, homogeneous loans, including consumer instalment, revolving credit, and most other consumer loans, is collectively evaluated for impairment. The allowance for credit losses attributed to these loans is established via a process that estimates the probable losses inherent and incurred in the portfolio, based upon various analyses. Management considers overall portfolio indicators including historical credit losses; delinquent (defined as loans that are more than 30 days past due), non-performing, and classified loans; trends in volumes and terms of loans; an evaluation of overall credit quality; the credit process, including lending policies and procedures; and economic, geographical, product, and other environmental factors.

K. Business Combinations, Goodwill and Intangible Assets

All business combinations are accounted for using the acquisition method. Identifiable intangible assets (mostly customer relationships) are recognised separately from goodwill and are initially valued at fair value using discounted cash flow calculations and other recognised valuation techniques. Goodwill represents the excess of the fair value of the consideration paid for the acquisition of a business over the fair value of the net assets acquired. Contingent purchase consideration was measured at its fair value and recorded on the purchase date. Any subsequent changes in the fair value of a contingent consideration liability will be recorded through the consolidated statements of operations.

Goodwill is tested annually for impairment at the reporting unit level, or more frequently if events or circumstances indicate there may be impairment. If the carrying amount of a reporting unit, including the allocated goodwill, exceeds its fair value, goodwill impairment is measured as the excess of the carrying amount of the reporting unit’s allocated goodwill over the implied fair value of the goodwill. Other acquired intangible assets with finite lives are amortised on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives, not exceeding 15 years. Intangible assets’ estimated lives are re-evaluated annually and an impairment test is carried out if certain indicators of impairment exist.

L. Premises, Equipment and Computer Software

Land is carried at cost. Buildings, equipment and computer software, including leasehold improvements, are carried at cost less accumulated depreciation. The Bank generally computes depreciation using the straight-line method over the estimated useful life of an asset, which is 50 years for buildings, and three to 10 years for other equipment. For leasehold improvements the Bank uses the straight-line method over the lesser of the remaining term of the leased facility or the estimated economic life of the improvement. The Bank capitalises certain costs, including interest cost incurred during the development phase, associated with the acquisition or development of internal use software. Once the software is ready for its intended use, these costs are amortised on a straight-line basis over the software’s expected useful life, which is between five and 10 years.

F-15

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Management reviews the recoverability of the carrying amount of premises, equipment and computer software when indicators of impairment exist and an impairment charge is recorded when the carrying amount of the reviewed asset is deemed not recoverable by future expected cash flows to be derived from the use and disposition of the asset. If there is a disposition out of premises, equipment and computer software, a gain is recorded if the difference of the proceeds on disposition is in excess of the assets carrying value. Otherwise, a loss is recorded. If there is an abandonment out of premises, equipment and computer software, the full carrying value of the asset is recognized as a loss.

M. Other Real Estate Owned

Other real estate owned (“OREO”) is comprised of real estate property held for sale and commercial and residential real estate properties acquired in partial or total satisfaction of loans acquired through foreclosure proceedings, acceptance of a deed-in-lieu of foreclosure or by taking possession of assets that were used as loan collateral. These properties are initially recorded at fair value less estimated costs to sell the property. If the recorded investment in the loan exceeds the property’s fair value at the time of acquisition, a charge-off is recorded against the specific allowance. If the carrying value of the real estate exceeds the property’s fair value at the time of reclassification, an impairment charge is recorded in the consolidated statements of operations. Subsequent decreases in the property’s fair value below the new cost basis are recorded through the use of a valuation allowance. Subsequent increases in the fair value of a property may be used to reduce the allowance but not below zero. Any operating expenses of the property are recognised through charges to non-interest expense.

N. Derivatives

All derivatives are recognised on the consolidated balance sheets at their fair value. On the date that the Bank enters into a derivative contract, it designates the derivative as either: a hedge of the fair value of a recognised asset or liability (a fair value hedge); a hedge of a forecasted transaction or the variability of cash flows that are to be received or paid in connection with a recognised asset or liability (a cash flow hedge); a hedge of an exposure to foreign currency risk of a net investment in a foreign operation (a net investment hedge); or, an instrument that is held for trading or non-hedging purposes (a trading or non-hedging derivative instrument).

All instruments utilised as a hedging instrument in a fair value hedge or cash flow hedge must have one or more underlying notional amounts, no or a minimal net initial investment and a provision for net settlement in the contract to meet the definition of a derivative instrument. Instruments utilised as a hedging instrument in a hedge of a net investment in foreign operations may be derivative instruments or non-derivatives.

The changes in the fair value of a derivative that is designated and qualifies as a fair value hedge, along with changes in the fair value of the hedged asset or liability that are attributable to the hedged risk, are recorded in current year earnings.

The changes in the fair value of a derivative that is designated and qualifies as a cash flow hedge, to the extent that the hedge is effective, are recorded in other comprehensive loss (“OCL”) and the ineffective portion is recorded in current year earnings. That is, ineffectiveness from a derivative that overcompensates for changes in the hedged cash flows is recorded in earnings. However, the ineffectiveness from a derivative that under compensates is not recorded in earnings.

The changes in the fair value of a derivative that is designated and qualifies as a foreign currency hedge is recorded in either current year earnings or OCL, depends on whether the hedging relationship satisfies the criteria for a fair value or cash flow hedge. If, however, a derivative is used as a hedge of a net investment in a foreign operation, the changes in the derivative’s fair value, to the extent that the derivative is effective as a hedge, are recorded in the cumulative translation adjustment (“CTA”) account within OCL.

Changes in the fair value of trading and non-hedging derivative instruments are reported in current year earnings.

F-16

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

The Bank formally documents all relationships between hedging instruments and hedged items, as well as its risk management objectives and strategies for undertaking various hedge transactions. This process includes linking all derivatives that are designated as fair value, cash flow, or foreign currency hedges to specific assets and liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets or specific firm commitments or forecasted transactions.

The Bank also formally assesses whether the derivatives that are used in hedging transactions have been highly effective in offsetting changes in the fair value or cash flows of hedged items and whether those derivatives may be expected to remain highly effective in future periods.

For those hedge relationships that are terminated, hedge designations that are elected to be removed, forecasted transactions that are no longer expected to occur, or the hedge relationship ceases to be highly effective, the hedge accounting treatment described in the paragraphs above is no longer applied and the end-user derivative is terminated or transferred to the trading designation. For fair value hedges, any changes to the carrying value of the hedged item prior to the discontinuance remain as part of the basis of the asset or liability. When a cash flow hedge is discontinued, the net derivative gain (loss) remains in AOCL unless it is probable that the forecasted transaction will not occur in the originally specified time period.

O. Securities Sold Under Agreements to Repurchase

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase (securities financing agreements) are treated as collateralised financing transactions. The obligation to repurchase is recorded at the value of the cash received on sale adjusted for the amortisation of the difference between the sale price and the agreed repurchase price. The amortisation of this amount is recorded as an interest expense.

P. Collateral

The Bank pledges assets as collateral as required for various transactions involving security repurchase agreements, deposit products and derivative financial instruments. Assets that have been pledged as collateral, including those that can be sold or repledged by the secured party, continue to be reported on the Bank’s consolidated balance sheets under the same line items as non-pledged assets of the same type.

Q. Employee Benefit Plans

The Bank maintains trusteed pension plans for substantially all employees as either non-contributory defined benefit plans or defined contribution plans. Benefits under the defined benefit plans are primarily based on the employee’s years of credited service and average annual salary during the final years of employment as defined in the plans. The Bank also provides post-retirement medical benefits for certain qualifying active and retired Bermuda-based employees.

Expense for the defined benefit pension plans and the post-retirement medical benefits plan is comprised of (a) the actuarially determined benefits for the current year’s service, (b) imputed interest on the actuarially determined liability of the plan, (c) in the case of the defined benefit pension plans, the expected investment return on the fair value of plan assets and (d) amortisation of certain items over the expected average remaining service life of employees in the case of the active defined benefit pension plans, estimated average remaining life expectancy of the inactive participants in the case of the inactive defined benefit pension plans and the expected average remaining service life to full eligibility age of employees covered by the plan in the case of the post-retirement medical benefits plan. The items amortised are amounts arising as a result of experience gains and losses, changes in assumptions, plan amendments and the change in the net pension asset or post-retirement medical benefits liability arising on adoption of revised accounting standards.

For each of the defined benefit pension plans and for the post-retirement medical benefits plan, the asset and liability recognised for accounting purposes are reported in other assets and employee benefit

F-17

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

plans respectively. The actuarial gains and losses, transition obligation and prior service costs of the defined pension plans and post-retirement medical benefits plan are recognised in OCL net of tax and amortised to net income over the average service period for the active defined benefit pension plans and post-retirement medical benefits plan and average remaining life expectancy for the inactive defined benefit pension plans.

For the defined contribution pension plans, the Bank and participating employees provide an annual contribution based on each participating employee’s pensionable earnings. Amounts paid are expensed in the period.

R. Share-Based Compensation

The Bank engages in equity settled share-based payment transactions in respect of services received from eligible employees. The fair value of the services received is measured by reference to the fair value of the shares or share options granted on the date of the grant. The cost of the employee services received in respect of the shares or share options granted is recognised in the consolidated statements of operations over the shorter of the vesting or service period.

The fair value of the options granted is determined using option pricing models, which take into account the exercise price of the option, the current share price, the risk-free interest rate, expected dividend rate, the expected volatility of the share price over the life of the option and other relevant factors. Time vesting conditions are taken into account by adjusting the number of shares or share options included in the measurement of the cost of employee services so that ultimately, the amount recognised in the consolidated statements of operations reflects the number of vested shares or share options. The Bank recognises compensation cost for awards with performance conditions if and when the Bank concludes that it is probable that the performance condition will be achieved, net of an estimate of pre-vesting forfeitures (e.g., due to termination of employment prior to vesting).

S. Revenue Recognition

Trust, custody and other administration services fees include fees for private and institutional trust, executorship, and custody services. Asset management fees include fees for investment management, investment advice and brokerage services. Fees are recognised as revenue over the period of the relationship or when the Bank has rendered all services to the clients and is entitled to collect the fee from the client, as long as there are no contingencies associated with the fees.

Banking services fees primarily include fees for letters of credit and other financial guarantees, compensating balances, overdraft facilities and other financial services-related products as well as credit card fees. Letters of credit and other financial guarantees fees are recognised as revenue over the period in which the related guarantee is outstanding. Credit card fees are comprised of merchant discounts, late fees and membership fees, net of interchange and rewards costs. Credit card fees are recognised in the period in which the service is provided. All other fees are recognised as revenue in the period in which the service is provided.

Foreign exchange revenue includes fees earned on currency exchange transactions which are recognised when such transactions occur, as well as gains and losses recognised when translating financial instruments held or due in currencies other than the local functional currency at the rates of exchange prevailing at the balance sheet date.

Loan interest income includes the amortisation of deferred non-refundable loan origination and commitment fees. These fees are recognised as an adjustment of yield over the life of the related loan. Loan origination and commitment fees are offset by their related direct costs and only the net amounts are deferred and amortised into interest income.

Dividend and interest income, including amortisation of premiums and discounts, on securities for which cash flows are not considered uncertain are included in interest income in the consolidated

F-18

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

statements of operations. Loans placed on non-accrual status and investments with uncertain cash flows are accounted for under the cost recovery method, whereby all principal, dividends, interest and coupon payments received are applied as a reduction of the amortised cost and carrying amount.

T. Fair Values

Fair value is defined as the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. The Bank determines the fair values of assets and liabilities based on the fair value hierarchy which requires an entity to maximise the use of observable inputs and minimise the use of unobservable inputs when measuring fair value. The relevant accounting standard describes three levels of inputs that may be used to measure fair value. Investments classified as trading and AFS, and derivative assets and liabilities are recognised in the consolidated balance sheets at fair value.

Level 1, 2 and 3 valuation inputs

Management classifies items that are recognised at fair value on a recurring basis based on the level of inputs used in their respective fair value determination as described below.

Fair value inputs are considered Level 1 when based on unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets.

Fair value inputs are considered Level 2 when based on inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the asset or liability either directly or indirectly, including inputs in markets that are not considered to be active.

Fair value inputs are considered Level 3 when based on internally developed models using significant unobservable assumptions involving management’s estimations or non-binding bid quotes from brokers.

The following methods and assumptions were used in the determination of the fair value of financial instruments:

Cash due from banks

The carrying amount of cash and demand deposits with banks, being short-term in nature, is deemed to approximate fair value.

Cash equivalents include unrestricted term deposits, certificates of deposits and Treasury bills with a maturity of less than three months from the date of acquisition and the carrying value at cost is considered to approximate fair value because they are short term in nature, bear interest rates that approximate market rates, and generally have negligible credit risk.

Short-term investments

Short-term investments comprise restricted term and demand deposits and unrestricted term deposits, certificates of deposit and treasury bills with less than one year but greater than three months’ maturity from the date of acquisition. The carrying value at cost is considered to approximate fair value because they are short term in nature, bear interest rates that approximate market rates, and generally have negligible credit risk.

Trading investments and defined benefit pension plan equity securities and mutual funds

Trading investments include equities, mutual funds and debt securities issued by both US and non-US governments. The fair value of listed equity securities is based upon quoted market values. Investments in actively traded mutual funds are based on their published net asset values. See “AFS and HTM investments and defined benefit pension plan fixed income securities” below for valuation techniques and inputs of fixed income securities.

F-19

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

AFS and HTM investments and defined benefit pension plan fixed income securities

The fair values for AFS investments are generally sourced from third parties. The fair value of fixed income securities is based upon quoted market values where available, “evaluated bid” prices provided by third party pricing services (“pricing services”) where quoted market values are not available, or by reference to broker or underwriter bid indications where pricing services do not provide coverage for a particular security. To the extent the Bank believes current trading conditions represent distressed transactions, the Bank may elect to utilise internally generated models. The pricing services typically use market approaches for valuations using primarily Level 2 inputs (in the vast majority of valuations), or some form of discounted cash flow analysis.

Pricing services indicate that they will only produce an estimate of fair value if there is objectively verifiable information available to produce a valuation. Standard inputs to the valuations provided by the pricing services listed in approximate order of priority for use when available include: reported trades, benchmark yields, broker/dealer quotes, issuer spreads, two-sided markets, benchmark securities, bids, offers, and reference data. The pricing services may prioritise inputs differently on any given day for any security, and not all inputs listed are available for use in the evaluation process on any given day for each security evaluation. However, the pricing services also monitor market indicators and industry and economic events. When these inputs are not available, pricing services identify “buckets” of similar securities (allocated by asset class types, sectors, sub-sectors, contractual cash flows/structure, and credit rating characteristics) and apply some form of matrix or other modelled pricing to determine an appropriate security value which represents their best estimate as to what a buyer in the marketplace would pay for a security in a current sale.

It is common industry practice to utilise pricing services as a source for determining the fair values of investments where the pricing services are able to obtain sufficient market corroborating information to allow them to produce a valuation at a reporting date. In addition, in the majority of cases, although a value may be obtained from a particular pricing service for a security or class of similar securities, these values are corroborated against values provided by other pricing services. While the Bank receives values for the majority of the investment securities it holds from pricing services, it is ultimately management’s responsibility to determine whether the values received and recorded in the financial statements are representative of appropriate fair value measurements.

Broker/dealer quotations are used to value investments with fixed maturities where prices are unavailable from pricing services due to factors specific to the security such as limited liquidity, lack of current transactions, or trades only taking place in privately negotiated transactions. These are considered Level 3 valuations, as significant inputs utilised by brokers may be difficult to corroborate with observable market data, or sufficient information regarding the specific inputs utilised by the broker was not available to support a Level 2 classification.

For disclosure purposes, investments held-to-maturity are fair valued using the same methods described above.

Loans

The majority of loans are variable rate and re-price in response to changes in market rates and hence management estimates that the fair value of loans is not significantly different than their carrying amount. For significant fixed-rate loan exposures, fair value is estimated by discounting the future cash flows, using the current rates at which similar loans would be made to borrowers with similar credit ratings and for the same remaining maturities, of such loans. Management includes the effects of specific provisions raised against individual loans, which factors in a loan’s credit quality, as well as accrued interest in determining the fair value of loans.

Accrued interest

The carrying amounts of accrued interest receivable and payable are assumed to approximate their fair values given their short-term nature.

F-20

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

OREO

OREO assets are carried at the lower of cost or fair value less estimated costs to sell. The determination of fair value, which aims at estimating the realisable value of the properties, is based either on third party appraisals, when available, or on internal valuation models. Appraisals of OREO properties are updated on an annual basis.

Deposits

The fair value of fixed-rate deposits has been estimated by discounting the contractual cash flows, using market interest rates offered at the balance sheet date for deposits of similar terms. The carrying amount of deposits with no stated maturity date is deemed to equate to the fair value.

Long-term debt

The fair value of the long-term debt has been estimated by discounting the contractual cash flows, using current market interest rates.

Derivatives

Derivative contracts can be exchange traded or over-the-counter (“OTC”) derivative contracts and may include forward, swap and option contracts relating to interest rates or foreign currencies. Exchange-traded derivatives typically fall within Level 1 of the fair value hierarchy depending on whether they are deemed to be actively traded or not. OTC derivatives are valued using market transactions and other market evidence whenever possible, including market-based inputs to models, model calibration to market clearing transactions, broker or dealer quotations or alternative pricing sources where an understanding of the inputs utilised in arriving at the valuations is obtained.

Where models are used, the selection of a particular model to value an OTC derivative depends upon the contractual terms and specific risks inherent in the instrument as well as the availability of pricing information in the market. The Bank generally uses similar models to value similar instruments. Valuation models require a variety of inputs, including contractual terms, market prices, yield curves, credit curves, measures of volatility, prepayment rates and correlations of such inputs. For OTC derivatives that trade in liquid markets, such as generic forwards, interest rate swaps and options, model inputs can generally be verified and model selection does not involve significant management judgment.

Goodwill

The fair value of reporting units for which goodwill is recognised is determined when an impairment assessment is performed by discounting estimated future cash flows using discount rates reflecting valuation-date market conditions and risks specific to the reporting unit.

U. Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets

Impairment losses are recognised when the carrying amount of a long-lived asset exceeds the sum of the undiscounted cash flows expected from its use and disposal. The impairment recognised is measured as the amount by which the carrying amount of the asset exceeds its fair value. Long-lived assets that are to be disposed of other than by sale are classified and accounted for as held for use until the date of disposal or abandonment. Assets that meet certain criteria are classified as held for sale and are measured at the lower of their carrying amounts or fair value less estimated costs to sell.

F-21

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

V. Credit-Related Arrangements

In the normal course of business, the Bank enters into various commitments to meet the credit requirements of its customers. Such commitments, which are not included in the consolidated balance sheet, include:

commitments to extend credit, which represent undertakings to make credit available in the form of loans or other financing for specific amounts and maturities, subject to certain conditions;
standby letters of credit, which represent irrevocable obligations to make payments to third parties in the event that the customer is unable to meet its financial obligations; and
documentary and commercial letters of credit, related primarily to the import of goods by customers, which represent agreements to honour drafts presented by third parties upon completion of specific activities.

These credit arrangements are subject to the Bank’s normal credit standards and collateral is obtained where appropriate. The contractual amounts for these commitments set out in the table in Note 12 represent the maximum payments the Bank would have to make should the contracts be fully drawn, the counterparty default, and any collateral held prove to be of no value. As many of these arrangements will expire or terminate without being drawn upon or are fully collateralised, the contractual amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. The Bank does not carry any liability for these obligations.

W. Income Taxes

The Bank uses the asset and liability method of accounting for income taxes. Under this method, deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effect of temporary differences between the consolidated financial statements’ carrying amounts of assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. Accordingly, a deferred income tax asset or liability is determined for each temporary difference based on the enacted tax rates to be in effect on the expected reversal date of the temporary difference. The effect of a change in tax rates on deferred tax assets and liabilities is recognised in income in the period that includes the enactment date.

The Bank records net deferred tax assets to the extent the Bank believes these assets will more likely than not be realised. Net deferred income tax assets or liabilities accumulated as a result of temporary differences are included in other assets or other liabilities, respectively. A valuation allowance is established to reduce deferred income tax assets to the amount more likely than not to be realised. In making such a determination, the Bank considers all available positive and negative evidence, including future reversals of existing taxable temporary differences, projected future taxable income, tax-planning strategies, and results of recent operations. In the event the Bank were to determine that it would be able to realise the deferred income tax assets in the future in excess of their net recorded amount, the Bank would make an adjustment to the deferred tax asset valuation allowance, which would reduce the provision for income taxes.

The Bank records uncertain tax positions on the basis of a two-step process whereby (1) the Bank determines whether it is more likely than not that the tax positions will be sustained based on the technical merits of the position and (2) where those tax positions that meet the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold, the Bank recognises the largest amount of tax benefit that is greater than 50 percent likely to be realised upon ultimate settlement with the related tax authority.

Income taxes on the consolidated statements of operations include the current and deferred portions of the income taxes. The Bank recognises accrued interest and penalties related to income taxes in operating expenses. Income taxes applicable to items charged or credited directly to shareholders’ equity are included in such items.

F-22

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

X. Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

For the purposes of the consolidated statements of cash flows, cash due from banks include cash on hand, cash items in the process of collection, amounts due from correspondent banks and highly liquid investments that are readily convertible to known amounts of cash and which are subject to an insignificant risk of change in fair value.

Y. Earnings Per Share

Earnings per share have been calculated using the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the year (see also Note 20). Dividends declared on preference shares and related guarantee fees are deducted from net income to obtain net income available to common shareholders. In periods when basic earnings per share is positive, the dilutive effect of share-based compensation plans is calculated using the treasury stock method, whereby the proceeds received from the exercise of share-based awards are assumed to be used to repurchase outstanding common shares, using the quarterly average market price of the Bank’s shares for the period.

Z. New Accounting Pronouncements

The following accounting developments were issued during the year ended 31 December 2016:

In January 2016, the FASB published Accounting Standards Update No. 2016-01 Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10) which: 1) requires that equity securities be measured at fair value with changes in the fair value recognised through net income; 2) allow certain equity investments to be re-measured at fair value either upon the occurrence of an observable price change or upon identification of an impairment (qualitative assessment being allowed); 3) requires public business entities that are required to disclose fair value of financial instruments on the balance sheet to measure that fair value using the exit price notion consistent with Topic 820, Fair Value Measurement; 4) requires an entity to present separately in other comprehensive income the portion of the total change in the fair value of a liability resulting from a change in the instrument-specific credit risk when the entity has elected to measure the liability at fair value in accordance with the fair value option; and, 5) requires enhanced disclosures about certain financial assets and financial liabilities. This update is effective for public business entities for fiscal years, and interim periods with in those fiscal years, beginning after 15 December 2017. Except for the early application guidance in the update, early adoption of the amendments is not permitted. The Bank is assessing the impact of the adoption of this guidance.

In February 2016, FASB published Accounting Standards Update No. 2016-02 Leases (Topic 842) which requires the recognition of lease assets and lease liabilities by lessees for those leases classified as operating leases under previous GAAP. This update is effective for public business entities for fiscal years, and interim periods with in those fiscal years, beginning after 15 December 2018. Early application is permitted. The Bank has determined that this standard will have an effect due to the recognition of lease assets and lease liabilities currently classified as operating leases, which will result in the recognition of assets and corresponding lease liabilities.

In March 2016, FASB published Accounting Standards Update No. 2016-08 Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606). The amendments in this update are intended to improve the operability and understandability of the implementation guidance on principal versus agent considerations. The amendments in this update affect the guidance in Accounting Standards Update No. 2014-09 Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606) (“ASU 2014-09”) which is not yet effective. The effective date for this update is the same as for Accounting Standards Update No. 2015-14 Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606), Deferral of the Effective Date (“ASU 2015-14”) which defers the effective date of ASU 2014-09 by one year resulting in the effective date being fiscal years, and interim periods with in those fiscal years, beginning after 15 December 2017. Earlier application is permitted only as of annual reporting periods beginning after 15 December 2016, including interim reporting periods within that reporting period. The Bank has determined that this standard will affect non-interest income items that are fee generating but does not expect the impact to have a significant effect.

F-23

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

In March 2016, FASB published Accounting Standards Update No. 2016-09 Compensation – Stock Compensation (Topic 718): Improvements to Employee Share-Based Payment Accounting. The amendments in this update are intended to simplify various aspects of the accounting for share-based payments including accounting for the income tax effects of share-based payments, minimum statutory tax withholding requirements and forfeitures. This update is effective for public business entities for fiscal years, and interim periods with in those fiscal years after 15 December 2016, and early adoption is permitted. The Bank has assessed the impact of the adoption of this guidance, and does not expect this to have an impact.

In June 2016, FASB published Accounting Standards Update No. 2016-13 Financial Instruments – Credit Losses. The amendments in this update provide a new impairment model, known as the current expected credit loss model that is based on expected losses rather than incurred losses. The amendments in this update are also intended to reduce the complexity and reduce the number of impairment models entities use to account for debt instruments. For public business entities that meet the GAAP definition of an SEC filer, the effective date for this update for fiscal years beginning after 15 December 2019, including interim periods within those fiscal years. The Bank is assessing the impact of the adoption of this guidance.

In August 2016, FASB published Accounting Standards Update No. 2016-15 Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230). The amendments in this update provide guidance on eight specific cash flow issues regarding their presentation and classification on the Statement of Cash Flows. The eight specific areas are: debt prepayment or debt extinguishment costs, settlement of zero-coupon debt instruments of other debt instruments with coupon interest rates that are insignificant in relation to the effective interest rate of the borrowing, contingent consideration payments made after a business combination, proceeds from the settlement of insurance claims, proceeds from the settlement of corporate-owned life insurance policies (including bank-owned life insurance policies), distributions received from equity method investees, beneficial interest in securitization transactions, and separately identifiable cash flows and application of the predominance principle. This update is effective for public business entities for fiscal years, and interim periods within those fiscal years, after 15 December 2017, and early adoption is permitted. The Bank is assessing the impact of the adoption of this guidance.

In October 2016, FASB published Accounting Standards Update No. 2016-17 Consolidation (Topic 810) (“ASU 2016-17”). This Update was issued to amend the consolidation guidance presented in Accounting Standards Update No. 2015-02 Consolidation (Topic 810) (“ASU 2015-02) on how a reporting entity that is the single decision maker of a VIE should treat indirect interests in the entity held through related parties that are under common control with the reporting entity when determining whether it is the primary beneficiary of that VIE. The amendments in this Update do not change the characteristics of a primary beneficiary in GAAP, but under the amendments, a single decision maker is not required to consider indirect interests held through related parties that are under common control with the single decision maker to be the equivalent of direct interests in their entirety. Instead, a single decision maker is required to include those interests on a proportionate basis consistent with indirect interests held through other related parties. The Bank has early adopted ASU 2015-02 and has concluded that ASU 2016-17 does not have an impact on the Bank.

In November 2016, FASB published Accounting Standards Update No. 2016-18 Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230). This Update requires that a statement of cash flows explain the change during the period in the total of cash, cash equivalents, and amounts generally described as restricted cash or restricted cash equivalents. Amounts generally described as restricted cash and restricted cash equivalents should be included with cash and cash equivalents when reconciling the beginning-of-period and end-of-period total amounts shown on the statement of cash flows. This update is effective for public business entities for fiscal years, and interim periods with in those fiscal years, beginning after 15 December 2017. Early adoption is permitted. The Bank has determined that this standard will have an effect on the presentation of the statements of cash flows as the Bank often owns cash balances affected by drawing restrictions related to minimum reserve and derivative margin requirements.

F-24

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Note 3: Cash due from banks

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Bermuda
Non-Bermuda
Total
Bermuda
Non-Bermuda
Total
Non-interest bearing
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and demand deposits with banks
 
28,690
 
 
82,051
 
 
110,741
 
 
31,199
 
 
79,696
 
 
110,895
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest bearing(1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand deposits with banks
 
138,123
 
 
188,314
 
 
326,437
 
 
130,589
 
 
248,040
 
 
378,629
 
Cash equivalents
 
976,557
 
 
687,916
 
 
1,664,473
 
 
691,439
 
 
1,107,927
 
 
1,799,366
 
Sub-total - Interest bearing
 
1,114,680
 
 
876,230
 
 
1,990,910
 
 
822,028
 
 
1,355,967
 
 
2,177,995
 
Total cash due from banks
 
1,143,370
 
 
958,281
 
 
2,101,651
 
 
853,227
 
 
1,435,663
 
 
2,288,890
 
(1)Interest bearing cash due from banks includes certain demand deposits with banks as at 31 December 2016 in the amount of $305.3 million (31 December 2015: $306.9 million) that are earning interest at a negligible rate.

Note 4: Short-term investments

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Bermuda
Non-Bermuda
Total
Bermuda
Non-Bermuda
Total
Unrestricted
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Maturing within three months
 
36,953
 
 
80,360
 
 
117,313
 
 
 
 
104,249
 
 
104,249
 
Maturing between three to six months
 
343,723
 
 
40,825
 
 
384,548
 
 
99,810
 
 
192,118
 
 
291,928
 
Maturing between six to twelve months
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
796
 
 
796
 
Total unrestricted short-term investments
 
380,676
 
 
121,185
 
 
501,861
 
 
99,810
 
 
297,163
 
 
396,973
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Affected by drawing restrictions related to minimum reserve and derivative margin requirements
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest earning demand deposits
 
17,894
 
 
 
 
17,894
 
 
12,509
 
 
 
 
12,509
 
Total short-term investments
 
398,570
 
 
121,185
 
 
519,755
 
 
112,319
 
 
297,163
 
 
409,482
 

Note 5: Investment in securities

Amortised Cost, Carrying Amount and Fair Value

On the consolidated balance sheets, trading and available-for-sale (“AFS”) investments are carried at fair value and held-to-maturity (“HTM”) investments are carried at amortised cost.

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Amortised
cost
Gross
unrealised
gains
Gross
unrealised
losses
Fair
value
Amortised
cost
Gross
unrealised
gains
Gross
unrealised
losses
Fair
value
Trading
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
278,500
 
 
2,347
 
 
(1,504
)
 
279,343
 
Non-US governments debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7,483
 
 
6
 
 
 
 
7,489
 
Asset-backed securities - Student loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
28,845
 
 
 
 
(560
)
 
28,285
 
Mutual funds
 
5,724
 
 
1,091
 
 
(502
)
 
6,313
 
 
5,739
 
 
903
 
 
(460
)
 
6,182
 
Total trading
 
5,724
 
 
1,091
 
 
(502
)
 
6,313
 
 
320,567
 
 
3,256
 
 
(2,524
)
 
321,299
 

F-25

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Amortised
cost
Gross
unrealised
gains
Gross
unrealised
losses
Fair
value
Amortised
cost
Gross
unrealised
gains
Gross
unrealised
losses
Fair
value
Available-for-sale
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
2,448,207
 
 
6,773
 
 
(24,578
)
 
2,430,402
 
 
1,399,456
 
 
8,812
 
 
(3,769
)
 
1,404,499
 
Non-US governments debt securities
 
27,895
 
 
178
 
 
(1,053
)
 
27,020
 
 
29,275
 
 
300
 
 
 
 
29,575
 
Corporate debt securities
 
513,881
 
 
2,139
 
 
(1,545
)
 
514,475
 
 
505,139
 
 
3,779
 
 
(2,774
)
 
506,144
 
Asset-backed securities - Student loans
 
13,290
 
 
 
 
(797
)
 
12,493
 
 
13,291
 
 
 
 
(1,130
)
 
12,161
 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
 
151,855
 
 
43
 
 
(1,352
)
 
150,546
 
 
153,046
 
 
9
 
 
(4,329
)
 
148,726
 
Residential mortgage-backed securities
 
200,288
 
 
56
 
 
(2,542
)
 
197,802
 
 
101,382
 
 
 
 
(1,138
)
 
100,244
 
Total available-for-sale
 
3,355,416
 
 
9,189
 
 
(31,867
)
 
3,332,738
 
 
2,201,589
 
 
12,900
 
 
(13,140
)
 
2,201,349
 
Held-to-maturity(1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
1,061,103
 
 
2,528
 
 
(16,803
)
 
1,046,828
 
 
701,282
 
 
5,365
 
 
(5,152
)
 
701,495
 
Total held-to-maturity
 
1,061,103
 
 
2,528
 
 
(16,803
)
 
1,046,828
 
 
701,282
 
 
5,365
 
 
(5,152
)
 
701,495
 
(1)For the years ended 31 December 2016, 2015 and 2014, non-credit impairments recognised in accumulated other comprehensive loss (“AOCL”) for HTM investments were nil.

Investments with Unrealised Loss Positions

The Bank does not believe that the AFS and HTM investment securities that were in an unrealised loss position as of 31 December 2016 (and 31 December 2015), which were comprised of 170 securities representing 76% of the AFS and HTM portfolios’ fair value, (31 December 2015: 99 and 54%, respectively), represent an OTTI. Total gross unrealised losses were 1.5% of the fair value of affected securities (31 December 2015: 1.1%) and were attributable primarily to changes in market interest rates, relative to when the investment securities were purchased, and not due to the credit quality of the investment securities. Due to a strategic change in the investment portfolio composition during the year ended 31 December 2015, several AFS securities were sold while being in an unrealised loss position. The Bank considers this to be a one-time event, and has determined that it is more likely than not that the Bank will not be required to sell, nor does the Bank have the intent to sell any of the remaining investment securities before recovery of the amortised cost basis. The following describes the processes for identifying credit impairment in security types with the most significant unrealised losses as shown in the preceding tables.

Management believes that all the US government and federal agencies securities do not have any credit losses, given the explicit and implicit guarantees provided by the US federal government.

Management believes that all the Non-US governments debt securities securities do not have any credit losses, given the explicit guarantee provided by the issuing government.

The unrealised losses in Corporate debt securities relate primarily to 12 debt securities that are all of investment grade with ratings ranging from BBB+ to A . Management believes that the value of these securities will recover and the current unrealised loss positions are a result of interest rate movements.

Investments in Asset-backed securities - Student loans are composed primarily of securities collateralised by Federal Family Education Loan Program loans (“FFELP loans”). FFELP loans benefit from a US federal government guarantee of at least 97% of defaulted principal and accrued interest, with additional credit support provided in the form of over-collateralisation, subordination and excess spread, which collectively total in excess of 100%. Accordingly, the vast majority of FFELP loan-backed securities are not exposed to traditional consumer credit risk.

F-26

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Investments in Commercial mortgage-backed securities relate to 10 senior securities rated AAA and one senior security rated A that possess significant subordination, a form of credit enhancement expressed hereafter as the percentage of pool losses that can occur before the senior securities held by the Bank will incur its first dollar of principal loss. No credit losses were recognised on these securities as the credit support and the weighted average loan-to-value ratios (“LTV”) range from 5% - 36% and 25% - 60%, respectively. Current credit support is significantly greater than any delinquencies experienced on the underlying mortgages.

Investments in Residential mortgage-backed securities relate to 13 securities which are rated AAA or AA+ and possess significant credit enhancement as described above. No credit losses were recognised on these securities as there are no delinquencies over 60 days on the underlying mortgages and the weighted average credit support and LTV ratios range from 5% - 18% and 56% - 68%, respectively.

In the following tables, debt securities with unrealised losses that are not deemed to be OTTI are categorised as being in a loss position for “less than 12 months” or “12 months or more” based on the point in time that the fair value most recently declined below the amortised cost basis. During 2016, Management revised the methodology for considering the time period during which an investment has been in an unrealized loss by looking at monthly positions rather than annually. The 2015 comparative have been restated using the new methodology.

 
Less than 12 months
12 months or more
 
 
31 December 2016
Fair
value
Gross
unrealised
losses
Fair
value
Gross
unrealised
losses
Total
fair value
Total gross
unrealised
losses
Available-for-sale securities with unrealised losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
1,558,636
 
 
(21,932
)
 
266,094
 
 
(2,646
)
 
1,824,730
 
 
(24,578
)
Non-US governments debt securities
 
21,681
 
 
(1,053
)
 
 
 
 
 
21,681
 
 
(1,053
)
Corporate debt securities
 
214,506
 
 
(1,545
)
 
 
 
 
 
214,506
 
 
(1,545
)
Asset-backed securities - Student loans
 
 
 
 
 
12,493
 
 
(797
)
 
12,493
 
 
(797
)
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
 
134,195
 
 
(1,352
)
 
 
 
 
 
134,195
 
 
(1,352
)
Residential mortgage-backed securities
 
181,556
 
 
(2,542
)
 
 
 
 
 
181,556
 
 
(2,542
)
Total available-for-sale securities with unrealised losses
 
2,110,574
 
 
(28,424
)
 
278,587
 
 
(3,443
)
 
2,389,161
 
 
(31,867
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Held-to-maturity securities with unrealised losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
937,080
 
 
(16,803
)
 
 
 
 
 
937,080
 
 
(16,803
)

F-27

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
Less than 12 months
12 months or more
 
 
31 December 2015
Fair
value
Gross
unrealised
losses
Fair
value
Gross
unrealised
losses
Total
fair value
Total gross
unrealised
losses
Available-for-sale securities with unrealised losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
449,609
 
 
(2,258
)
 
92,554
 
 
(1,511
)
 
542,163
 
 
(3,769
)
Corporate debt securities
 
253,991
 
 
(1,480
)
 
38,706
 
 
(1,294
)
 
292,697
 
 
(2,774
)
Asset-backed securities - Student loans
 
 
 
 
 
12,160
 
 
(1,130
)
 
12,160
 
 
(1,130
)
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
 
138,217
 
 
(4,007
)
 
9,605
 
 
(322
)
 
147,822
 
 
(4,329
)
Residential mortgage-backed securities
 
90,220
 
 
(660
)
 
10,024
 
 
(478
)
 
100,244
 
 
(1,138
)
Total available-for-sale securities with unrealised losses
 
932,037
 
 
(8,405
)
 
163,049
 
 
(4,735
)
 
1,095,086
 
 
(13,140
)
Held-to-maturity securities with unrealised losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
459,623
 
 
(5,152
)
 
 
 
 
 
459,623
 
 
(5,152
)

Investment Maturities

The following table presents the remaining maturities of the Bank’s securities. The maturities are contractual for securities other than mortgage-backed securities. For mortgage-backed securities (primarily US government agencies), management presents the maturity date as the mid-point between the reporting and expected contractual maturity date which is determined assuming no future prepayments. By using the aforementioned mid-point, this date represents management’s best estimate of the date by which the remaining principal balance will be repaid given future principal repayments of such securities. The actual maturities may differ due to the uncertainty of the timing when borrowers make prepayments on the underlying mortgages.

 
Remaining term to maturity
 
 
31 December 2016
Within
3 months
3 to 12
months
1 to 5
years
5 to 10
years
Over
10 years
No specific
maturity
Carrying
amount
Trading
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mutual funds
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6,313
 
 
6,313
 
Total trading
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6,313
 
 
6,313
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
 
 
6,364
 
 
87,257
 
 
653,603
 
 
1,683,178
 
 
 
 
2,430,402
 
Non-US governments debt securities
 
 
 
1,371
 
 
3,967
 
 
21,682
 
 
 
 
 
 
27,020
 
Corporate debt securities
 
22,009
 
 
88,169
 
 
404,297
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
514,475
 
Asset-backed securities - Student loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
12,493
 
 
 
 
12,493
 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
 
 
 
 
 
38,418
 
 
112,128
 
 
 
 
 
 
150,546
 
Residential mortgage-backed securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
197,802
 
 
 
 
197,802
 
Total available-for-sale
 
22,009
 
 
95,904
 
 
533,939
 
 
787,413
 
 
1,893,473
 
 
 
 
3,332,738
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Held-to-maturity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
 
 
 
 
10,688
 
 
31,154
 
 
1,019,261
 
 
 
 
1,061,103
 
Total investments
 
22,009
 
 
95,904
 
 
544,627
 
 
818,567
 
 
2,912,734
 
 
6,313
 
 
4,400,154
 
Total by currency
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US dollars
 
22,009
 
 
95,904
 
 
544,627
 
 
818,567
 
 
2,912,734
 
 
6,091
 
 
4,399,932
 
Other
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
222
 
 
222
 
Total investments
 
22,009
 
 
95,904
 
 
544,627
 
 
818,567
 
 
2,912,734
 
 
6,313
 
 
4,400,154
 

F-28

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
Remaining term to maturity
 
 
31 December 2015
Within
3 months
3 to 12
months
1 to 5
years
5 to 10
years
Over
10 years
No specific
maturity
Carrying
amount
Trading
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
 
 
24,874
 
 
8,497
 
 
53,248
 
 
192,724
 
 
 
 
279,343
 
Non-US governments debt securities
 
7,489
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7,489
 
Asset-backed securities - Student loans
 
 
 
 
 
28,285
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
28,285
 
Mutual funds
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6,182
 
 
6,182
 
Total trading
 
7,489
 
 
24,874
 
 
36,782
 
 
53,248
 
 
192,724
 
 
6,182
 
 
321,299
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
 
 
 
 
126,163
 
 
202,385
 
 
1,075,951
 
 
 
 
1,404,499
 
Non-US governments debt securities
 
 
 
1,360
 
 
5,399
 
 
22,816
 
 
 
 
 
 
29,575
 
Corporate debt securities
 
60,493
 
 
55,649
 
 
351,296
 
 
38,706
 
 
 
 
 
 
506,144
 
Asset-backed securities - Student loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
12,161
 
 
 
 
12,161
 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
42,532
 
 
106,194
 
 
 
 
148,726
 
Residential mortgage-backed securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
100,244
 
 
 
 
100,244
 
Total available-for-sale
 
60,493
 
 
57,009
 
 
482,858
 
 
306,439
 
 
1,294,550
 
 
 
 
2,201,349
 
Held-to-maturity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
45,664
 
 
655,618
 
 
 
 
701,282
 
Total investments
 
67,982
 
 
81,883
 
 
519,640
 
 
405,351
 
 
2,142,892
 
 
6,182
 
 
3,223,930
 
Total by currency
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US dollars
 
67,982
 
 
81,883
 
 
519,640
 
 
405,351
 
 
2,142,892
 
 
5,903
 
 
3,223,651
 
Other
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
279
 
 
279
 
Total investments
 
67,982
 
 
81,883
 
 
519,640
 
 
405,351
 
 
2,142,892
 
 
6,182
 
 
3,223,930
 

Pledged Investments

The Bank pledges certain US government and federal agencies investment securities to further secure the Bank’s issued customer deposit products. The secured party does not have the right to sell or repledge the collateral.

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
Pledged Investments
Amortised
cost
Fair
value
Amortised
cost
Fair
value
Available-for-sale
 
211,342
 
 
212,995
 
 
304,493
 
 
307,513
 
Held-to-maturity
 
320,942
 
 
315,635
 
 
372,546
 
 
372,868
 

F-29

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Sale Proceeds and Realised Gains and Losses of AFS Securities

 
Year ended
31 December 2016
 
Sale
proceeds
Gross
realised
gains
Gross
realised
(losses)
US government and federal agencies
 
59,939
 
 
1,013
 
 
(76
)
Residential mortgage-backed securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pass-through note
 
609
 
 
609
 
 
 
Net realised gains (losses) recognised in net income
 
60,548
 
 
1,622
 
 
(76
)
 
Year ended
31 December 2015
 
Sale
proceeds
Gross
realised
gains
Gross
realised
(losses)
US government and federal agencies
 
232,372
 
 
 
 
(4,465
)
Residential mortgage-backed securities
 
6,056
 
 
 
 
(270
)
Pass-through note
 
328
 
 
328
 
 
 
Net realised gains (losses) recognised in net income
 
238,756
 
 
328
 
 
(4,735
)
 
Year ended
31 December 2014
 
Sale
proceeds
Gross
realised
gains
Gross
realised
(losses)
US government and federal agencies
 
96,031
 
 
 
 
(52
)
Pass-through note
 
34,422
 
 
8,732
 
 
 
Net realised gains (losses) recognised in net income
 
130,453
 
 
8,732
 
 
(52
)

Taxability of Interest Income

None of the investments’ interest income have received a specific preferential income tax treatment in any of the jurisdictions in which the Bank owns investments.

Note 6: Loans

The “Bermuda” and “Non-Bermuda” classifications purpose is to reflect management segment reporting as described in Note 15: Segmented information.

The principal means of securing residential mortgages, personal, credit card and business loans are entitlements over assets and guarantees. Mortgage loans are generally repayable over periods of up to thirty years and personal, business and government loans are generally repayable over terms not exceeding five years. Amounts owing on credit cards are revolving and typically a minimum amount is due within 30 days from billing. The effective yield on total loans as at 31 December 2016 is 4.78% (31 December 2015: 4.57%).

F-30

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Bermuda
Non-Bermuda
Total
Bermuda
Non-Bermuda
Total
Commercial loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government
 
94,504
 
 
17,908
 
 
112,412
 
 
202,776
 
 
22,402
 
 
225,178
 
Commercial and industrial
 
130,171
 
 
201,652
 
 
331,823
 
 
121,466
 
 
221,243
 
 
342,709
 
Commercial overdrafts
 
22,594
 
 
2,767
 
 
25,361
 
 
34,997
 
 
5,736
 
 
40,733
 
Total gross commercial loans
 
247,269
 
 
222,327
 
 
469,596
 
 
359,239
 
 
249,381
 
 
608,620
 
Less specific allowance for credit losses
 
(577
)
 
 
 
(577
)
 
(590
)
 
 
 
(590
)
Net commercial loans
 
246,692
 
 
222,327
 
 
469,019
 
 
358,649
 
 
249,381
 
 
608,030
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial real estate loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial mortgage
 
363,982
 
 
217,640
 
 
581,622
 
 
415,747
 
 
249,622
 
 
665,369
 
Construction
 
24,500
 
 
4,385
 
 
28,885
 
 
5,396
 
 
8,211
 
 
13,607
 
Total gross commercial real estate loans
 
388,482
 
 
222,025
 
 
610,507
 
 
421,143
 
 
257,833
 
 
678,976
 
Less specific allowance for credit losses
 
(750
)
 
 
 
(750
)
 
(727
)
 
(2,224
)
 
(2,951
)
Net commercial real estate loans
 
387,732
 
 
222,025
 
 
609,757
 
 
420,416
 
 
255,609
 
 
676,025
 
Consumer loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Automobile financing
 
13,077
 
 
6,905
 
 
19,982
 
 
12,308
 
 
7,556
 
 
19,864
 
Credit card
 
57,730
 
 
20,811
 
 
78,541
 
 
59,119
 
 
19,839
 
 
78,958
 
Overdrafts
 
2,380
 
 
3,202
 
 
5,582
 
 
4,750
 
 
8,165
 
 
12,915
 
Other consumer
 
30,798
 
 
63,186
 
 
93,984
 
 
32,022
 
 
84,062
 
 
116,084
 
Total gross consumer loans
 
103,985
 
 
94,104
 
 
198,089
 
 
108,199
 
 
119,622
 
 
227,821
 
Less specific allowance for credit losses
 
(275
)
 
(3
)
 
(278
)
 
(274
)
 
 
 
(274
)
Net consumer loans
 
103,710
 
 
94,101
 
 
197,811
 
 
107,925
 
 
119,622
 
 
227,547
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loans
 
1,205,468
 
 
1,131,065
 
 
2,336,533
 
 
1,243,221
 
 
1,290,819
 
 
2,534,040
 
Less specific allowance for credit losses
 
(9,559
)
 
(574
)
 
(10,133
)
 
(13,411
)
 
(1,879
)
 
(15,290
)
Net residential mortgage loans
 
1,195,909
 
 
1,130,491
 
 
2,326,400
 
 
1,229,810
 
 
1,288,940
 
 
2,518,750
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total gross loans
 
1,945,204
 
 
1,669,521
 
 
3,614,725
 
 
2,131,802
 
 
1,917,655
 
 
4,049,457
 
Less specific allowance for credit losses
 
(11,161
)
 
(577
)
 
(11,738
)
 
(15,002
)
 
(4,103
)
 
(19,105
)
Less general allowance for credit losses
 
(24,950
)
 
(7,559
)
 
(32,509
)
 
(20,176
)
 
(10,021
)
 
(30,197
)
Net loans
 
1,909,093
 
 
1,661,385
 
 
3,570,478
 
 
2,096,624
 
 
1,903,531
 
 
4,000,155
 

Age Analysis of Past Due Loans (Including Non-Accrual Loans)

The following tables summarise the past due status of the loans as at 31 December 2016 and 31 December 2015. The aging of past due amounts are determined based on the contractual delinquency status of payments under the loan and this aging may be affected by the timing of the last business day at period end. Loans less than 30 days past due are included in current loans.

F-31

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

31 December 2016
30 - 59
days
60 - 89
days
More than
90 days
Total past
due loans
Total
current
Total
loans
Commercial loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
112,412
 
 
112,412
 
Commercial and industrial
 
2,712
 
 
 
 
584
 
 
3,296
 
 
328,527
 
 
331,823
 
Commercial overdrafts
 
 
 
 
 
2
 
 
2
 
 
25,359
 
 
25,361
 
Total commercial loans
 
2,712
 
 
 
 
586
 
 
3,298
 
 
466,298
 
 
469,596
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial real estate loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial mortgage
 
377
 
 
 
 
5,964
 
 
6,341
 
 
575,281
 
 
581,622
 
Construction
 
175
 
 
 
 
 
 
175
 
 
28,710
 
 
28,885
 
Total commercial real estate loans
 
552
 
 
 
 
5,964
 
 
6,516
 
 
603,991
 
 
610,507
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Automobile financing
 
86
 
 
23
 
 
225
 
 
334
 
 
19,648
 
 
19,982
 
Credit card
 
366
 
 
177
 
 
392
 
 
935
 
 
77,606
 
 
78,541
 
Overdrafts
 
 
 
 
 
17
 
 
17
 
 
5,565
 
 
5,582
 
Other consumer
 
720
 
 
564
 
 
999
 
 
2,283
 
 
91,701
 
 
93,984
 
Total consumer loans
 
1,172
 
 
764
 
 
1,633
 
 
3,569
 
 
194,520
 
 
198,089
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loans
 
26,122
 
 
4,345
 
 
50,262
 
 
80,729
 
 
2,255,804
 
 
2,336,533
 
Total gross loans
 
30,558
 
 
5,109
 
 
58,445
 
 
94,112
 
 
3,520,613
 
 
3,614,725
 
31 December 2015
30 - 59
days
60 - 89
days
More than
90 days
Total past
due loans
Total
current
Total
loans
Commercial loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
225,178
 
 
225,178
 
Commercial and industrial
 
11
 
 
14
 
 
608
 
 
633
 
 
342,076
 
 
342,709
 
Commercial overdrafts
 
 
 
 
 
25
 
 
25
 
 
40,708
 
 
40,733
 
Total commercial loans
 
11
 
 
14
 
 
633
 
 
658
 
 
607,962
 
 
608,620
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial real estate loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial mortgage
 
1,133
 
 
 
 
6,658
 
 
7,791
 
 
657,578
 
 
665,369
 
Construction
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
13,607
 
 
13,607
 
Total commercial real estate loans
 
1,133
 
 
 
 
6,658
 
 
7,791
 
 
671,185
 
 
678,976
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Automobile financing
 
194
 
 
81
 
 
78
 
 
353
 
 
19,511
 
 
19,864
 
Credit card
 
1,459
 
 
337
 
 
132
 
 
1,928
 
 
77,030
 
 
78,958
 
Overdrafts
 
 
 
 
 
538
 
 
538
 
 
12,377
 
 
12,915
 
Other consumer
 
832
 
 
979
 
 
1,231
 
 
3,042
 
 
113,042
 
 
116,084
 
Total consumer loans
 
2,485
 
 
1,397
 
 
1,979
 
 
5,861
 
 
221,960
 
 
227,821
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loans
 
40,793
 
 
8,911
 
 
65,343
 
 
115,047
 
 
2,418,993
 
 
2,534,040
 
Total gross loans
 
44,422
 
 
10,322
 
 
74,613
 
 
129,357
 
 
3,920,100
 
 
4,049,457
 

F-32

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Loans’ Credit Quality

The four credit quality classifications set out in the following tables (which excludes purchased credit-impaired loans) are defined below and describe the credit quality of the Bank’s lending portfolio. These classifications each encompass a range of more granular, internal credit rating grades assigned.

A pass loan shall mean a loan that is expected to be repaid as agreed. A loan is classified as pass where the Bank is not expected to face repayment difficulties because the present and projected cash flows are sufficient to repay the debt and the repayment schedule as established by the agreement is being followed.

A special mention loan shall mean a loan under close monitoring by the Bank’s management. Loans in this category are currently protected and still performing (current with respect to interest and principal payments), but are potentially weak and present an undue credit risk exposure, but not to the point of justifying a classification of substandard.

A substandard loan shall mean a loan whose evident unreliability makes repayment doubtful and there is a threat of loss to the Bank unless the unreliability is averted.

A non-accrual loan shall mean either management is of the opinion full payment of principal or interest is in doubt or when principal or interest is 90 days past due and for residential mortgage loans which are not well secured and in the process of collection.

31 December 2016
Pass
Special
mention
Substandard
Non-accrual
Total gross
recorded
investments
Commercial loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government
 
104,611
 
 
301
 
 
7,500
 
 
 
 
112,412
 
Commercial and industrial
 
325,924
 
 
4,122
 
 
1,194
 
 
583
 
 
331,823
 
Commercial overdrafts
 
22,976
 
 
2,145
 
 
238
 
 
2
 
 
25,361
 
Total commercial loans
 
453,511
 
 
6,568
 
 
8,932
 
 
585
 
 
469,596
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial real estate loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial mortgage
 
502,918
 
 
71,038
 
 
1,702
 
 
5,964
 
 
581,622
 
Construction
 
28,885
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
28,885
 
Total commercial real estate loans
 
531,803
 
 
71,038
 
 
1,702
 
 
5,964
 
 
610,507
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Automobile financing
 
19,309
 
 
360
 
 
28
 
 
285
 
 
19,982
 
Credit card
 
78,149
 
 
 
 
392
 
 
 
 
78,541
 
Overdrafts
 
5,533
 
 
32
 
 
 
 
17
 
 
5,582
 
Other consumer
 
91,348
 
 
1,564
 
 
360
 
 
712
 
 
93,984
 
Total consumer loans
 
194,339
 
 
1,956
 
 
780
 
 
1,014
 
 
198,089
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loans
 
2,200,807
 
 
36,739
 
 
58,087
 
 
40,900
 
 
2,336,533
 
Total gross recorded loans
 
3,380,460
 
 
116,301
 
 
69,501
 
 
48,463
 
 
3,614,725
 

F-33

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

31 December 2015
Pass
Special
mention
Substandard
Non-accrual
Total gross
recorded
investments
Commercial loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government
 
213,928
 
 
11,250
 
 
 
 
 
 
225,178
 
Commercial and industrial
 
333,853
 
 
4,133
 
 
4,106
 
 
617
 
 
342,709
 
Commercial overdrafts
 
36,017
 
 
4,493
 
 
197
 
 
26
 
 
40,733
 
Total commercial loans
 
583,798
 
 
19,876
 
 
4,303
 
 
643
 
 
608,620
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial real estate loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial mortgage
 
542,195
 
 
86,285
 
 
26,629
 
 
10,260
 
 
665,369
 
Construction
 
13,607
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
13,607
 
Total commercial real estate loans
 
555,802
 
 
86,285
 
 
26,629
 
 
10,260
 
 
678,976
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Automobile financing
 
19,378
 
 
388
 
 
 
 
98
 
 
19,864
 
Credit card
 
78,826
 
 
 
 
132
 
 
 
 
78,958
 
Overdrafts
 
11,618
 
 
54
 
 
1,232
 
 
11
 
 
12,915
 
Other consumer
 
112,426
 
 
1,308
 
 
1,056
 
 
1,294
 
 
116,084
 
Total consumer loans
 
222,248
 
 
1,750
 
 
2,420
 
 
1,403
 
 
227,821
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loans
 
2,391,723
 
 
42,578
 
 
46,793
 
 
52,946
 
 
2,534,040
 
Total gross recorded loans
 
3,753,571
 
 
150,489
 
 
80,145
 
 
65,252
 
 
4,049,457
 

Evaluation of Loans For Impairment

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Individually
evaluated
Collectively
evaluated
Individually
evaluated
Collectively
evaluated
Commercial
 
9,686
 
 
459,910
 
 
13,607
 
 
595,013
 
Commercial real estate
 
21,893
 
 
588,614
 
 
38,019
 
 
640,957
 
Consumer
 
1,746
 
 
196,343
 
 
1,882
 
 
225,939
 
Residential mortgage
 
113,065
 
 
2,223,468
 
 
116,176
 
 
2,417,864
 
Total gross loans
 
146,390
 
 
3,468,335
 
 
169,684
 
 
3,879,773
 

Changes in General and Specific Allowances For Credit Losses

 
Year ended
31 December 2016
 
Commercial
Commercial
real estate
Consumer
Residential
mortgage
Total
Allowances at beginning of year
 
8,723
 
 
6,512
 
 
2,763
 
 
31,304
 
 
49,302
 
Provision taken (released)
 
(5,265
)
 
14,459
 
 
(1,076
)
 
(3,719
)
 
4,399
 
Recoveries
 
97
 
 
12
 
 
1,264
 
 
70
 
 
1,443
 
Charge-offs
 
(138
)
 
(4,520
)
 
(1,916
)
 
(3,837
)
 
(10,411
)
Other
 
(40
)
 
(239
)
 
(70
)
 
(137
)
 
(486
)
Allowances at end of year
 
3,377
 
 
16,224
 
 
965
 
 
23,681
 
 
44,247
 
Allowances at end of year: individually evaluated for impairment
 
577
 
 
750
 
 
278
 
 
10,133
 
 
11,738
 
Allowances at end of year: collectively evaluated for impairment
 
2,800
 
 
15,474
 
 
687
 
 
13,548
 
 
32,509
 

F-34

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
Year ended
31 December 2015
 
Commercial
Commercial
real estate
Consumer
Residential
mortgage
Total
Allowances at beginning of year
 
7,831
 
 
5,920
 
 
2,797
 
 
30,934
 
 
47,482
 
Provision taken
 
440
 
 
1,027
 
 
586
 
 
3,688
 
 
5,741
 
Recoveries
 
788
 
 
182
 
 
1,455
 
 
427
 
 
2,852
 
Charge-offs
 
(318
)
 
(513
)
 
(2,031
)
 
(3,701
)
 
(6,563
)
Other
 
(18
)
 
(104
)
 
(44
)
 
(44
)
 
(210
)
Allowances at end of year
 
8,723
 
 
6,512
 
 
2,763
 
 
31,304
 
 
49,302
 
Allowances at end of year: individually evaluated for impairment
 
590
 
 
2,951
 
 
274
 
 
15,290
 
 
19,105
 
Allowances at end of year: collectively evaluated for impairment
 
8,133
 
 
3,561
 
 
2,489
 
 
16,014
 
 
30,197
 
 
Year ended
31 December 2014
 
Commercial
Commercial
real estate
Consumer
Residential
mortgage
Total
Allowances at beginning of year
 
8,340
 
 
9,816
 
 
3,442
 
 
31,157
 
 
52,755
 
Provision taken
 
282
 
 
2,789
 
 
(686
)
 
5,663
 
 
8,048
 
Recoveries
 
67
 
 
 
 
1,983
 
 
274
 
 
2,324
 
Charge-offs
 
(838
)
 
(6,621
)
 
(1,895
)
 
(6,113
)
 
(15,467
)
Other
 
(20
)
 
(64
)
 
(47
)
 
(47
)
 
(178
)
Allowances at end of year
 
7,831
 
 
5,920
 
 
2,797
 
 
30,934
 
 
47,482
 
Allowances at end of year: individually evaluated for impairment
 
417
 
 
1,822
 
 
355
 
 
16,217
 
 
18,811
 
Allowances at end of year: collectively evaluated for impairment
 
7,414
 
 
4,098
 
 
2,442
 
 
14,717
 
 
28,671
 

Non-Performing Loans (excluding purchased credit-impaired loans)

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Non-accrual
Past
due more
than 90 days
and accruing
Total non-
performing
loans
Non-accrual
Past
due more
than 90 days
and accruing
Total non-
performing
loans
Commercial loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
583
 
 
 
 
583
 
 
617
 
 
 
 
617
 
Commercial overdrafts
 
2
 
 
 
 
2
 
 
26
 
 
10
 
 
36
 
Total commercial loans
 
585
 
 
 
 
585
 
 
643
 
 
10
 
 
653
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial real estate loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial mortgage
 
5,964
 
 
 
 
5,964
 
 
10,260
 
 
737
 
 
10,997
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Automobile financing
 
285
 
 
2
 
 
287
 
 
98
 
 
 
 
98
 
Credit card
 
 
 
392
 
 
392
 
 
 
 
132
 
 
132
 
Overdrafts
 
17
 
 
 
 
17
 
 
11
 
 
527
 
 
538
 
Other consumer
 
712
 
 
300
 
 
1,012
 
 
1,294
 
 
85
 
 
1,379
 
Total consumer loans
 
1,014
 
 
694
 
 
1,708
 
 
1,403
 
 
744
 
 
2,147
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loans
 
40,900
 
 
8,476
 
 
49,376
 
 
52,946
 
 
12,760
 
 
65,706
 
Total non-performing loans
 
48,463
 
 
9,170
 
 
57,633
 
 
65,252
 
 
14,251
 
 
79,503
 

F-35

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Impaired Loans (excluding purchased credit-impaired loans)

A loan is considered to be impaired when, based on current information and events, the Bank determines that it will not be able to collect all amounts due according to the original loan contract, including scheduled interest payments. Impaired loans include all non-accrual loans and all loans modified in a troubled debt restructuring (“TDR”) even if full collectability is expected following the restructuring. During the year ended 31 December 2016, the amount of gross interest income that would have been recorded had impaired loans been current was $2.7 million (31 December 2015: $3.1 million; 31 December 2014: $5.2 million).

 
Impaired loans with an allowance
Gross
recorded
investment of
impaired loans
without an
allowance
Total impaired loans
31 December 2016
Gross
recorded
investment
Specific
allowance
Net loans
Gross
recorded
investment
Specific
allowance
Net loans
Commercial loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
579
 
 
(577
)
 
2
 
 
1,048
 
 
1,627
 
 
(577
)
 
1,050
 
Commercial overdrafts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2
 
 
2
 
 
 
 
2
 
Total commercial loans
 
579
 
 
(577
)
 
2
 
 
1,050
 
 
1,629
 
 
(577
)
 
1,052
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial real estate loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial mortgage
 
1,722
 
 
(750
)
 
972
 
 
5,944
 
 
7,666
 
 
(750
)
 
6,916
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Automobile financing
 
155
 
 
(75
)
 
80
 
 
130
 
 
285
 
 
(75
)
 
210
 
Overdrafts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
17
 
 
17
 
 
 
 
17
 
Other consumer
 
253
 
 
(203
)
 
50
 
 
459
 
 
712
 
 
(203
)
 
509
 
Total consumer loans
 
408
 
 
(278
)
 
130
 
 
606
 
 
1,014
 
 
(278
)
 
736
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loans
 
30,330
 
 
(9,961
)
 
20,369
 
 
52,043
 
 
82,373
 
 
(9,961
)
 
72,412
 
Total impaired loans
 
33,039
 
 
(11,566
)
 
21,473
 
 
59,643
 
 
92,682
 
 
(11,566
)
 
81,116
 

Specific allowance excludes $0.2 million recognized relating to purchased credit-impaired loans.

 
Impaired loans with an allowance
Gross
recorded
investment of
impaired loans
without an
allowance
Total impaired loans
31 December 2015
Gross
recorded
investment
Specific
allowance
Net loans
Gross
recorded
investment
Specific
allowance
Net loans
Commercial loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
599
 
 
(590
)
 
9
 
 
1,096
 
 
1,695
 
 
(590
)
 
1,105
 
Commercial overdrafts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
26
 
 
26
 
 
 
 
26
 
Total commercial loans
 
599
 
 
(590
)
 
9
 
 
1,122
 
 
1,721
 
 
(590
)
 
1,131
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial real estate loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial mortgage
 
6,127
 
 
(2,951
)
 
3,176
 
 
17,198
 
 
23,325
 
 
(2,951
)
 
20,374
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Automobile financing
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
98
 
 
98
 
 
 
 
98
 
Overdrafts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
11
 
 
11
 
 
 
 
11
 
Other consumer
 
366
 
 
(274
)
 
92
 
 
1,008
 
 
1,374
 
 
(274
)
 
1,100
 
Total consumer loans
 
366
 
 
(274
)
 
92
 
 
1,117
 
 
1,483
 
 
(274
)
 
1,209
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loans
 
42,145
 
 
(15,290
)
 
26,855
 
 
39,283
 
 
81,428
 
 
(15,290
)
 
66,138
 
Total impaired loans
 
49,237
 
 
(19,105
)
 
30,132
 
 
58,720
 
 
107,957
 
 
(19,105
)
 
88,852
 

F-36

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Average Impaired Loan Balances and Related Recognised Interest Income

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
31 December 2014
 
Average gross
recorded
investment
Interest
income
recognised(1)
Average gross
recorded
investment
Interest
income
recognised(1)
Average gross
recorded
investment
Interest
income
recognised(1)
Commercial loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
1,661
 
 
64
 
 
1,214
 
 
 
 
1,452
 
 
 
Commercial overdrafts
 
14
 
 
 
 
66
 
 
 
 
289
 
 
 
Total commercial loans
 
1,675
 
 
64
 
 
1,280
 
 
 
 
1,741
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial real estate loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial mortgage
 
15,496
 
 
237
 
 
28,612
 
 
311
 
 
48,581
 
 
675
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Automobile financing
 
192
 
 
 
 
137
 
 
 
 
307
 
 
 
Credit card
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
35
 
 
 
Overdrafts
 
14
 
 
 
 
27
 
 
 
 
132
 
 
 
Other consumer
 
1,043
 
 
 
 
1,617
 
 
2
 
 
1,963
 
 
5
 
Total consumer loans
 
1,249
 
 
 
 
1,781
 
 
2
 
 
2,437
 
 
5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loans
 
81,901
 
 
2,201
 
 
78,433
 
 
1,442
 
 
70,923
 
 
1,021
 
Total impaired loans
 
100,321
 
 
2,502
 
 
110,106
 
 
1,755
 
 
123,682
 
 
1,701
 
(1)All interest income recognised on impaired loans relate to loans previously modified in a TDR.

Loans Modified in a TDR

As at 31 December 2016, the Bank had one loan which was formerly a residential mortgage that was modified in a TDR during the preceding 12 months that subsequently defaulted (i.e. 90 days or more past due following a modification) with a recorded investment of $0.9 million. As at 31 December 2015, one loan which was formerly a residential mortgage was modified in a TDR during the preceding 12 months that subsequently defaulted with a recorded investment of $0.8 million. As at 31 December 2014, four loans which were all formerly residential mortgages were modified in a TDR during the preceding 12 months that subsequently defaulted with a recorded investment of $2.4 million.

TDRs entered into during the year

 
Year ended
31 December 2016
 
Number of
contracts
Pre-
modification
recorded
investment
Modification:
interest
capitalisation
Post-
modification
recorded
investment
Residential mortgage loans
 
21
 
 
12,543
 
 
81
 
 
12,624
 
Total loans modified in a TDR
 
21
 
 
12,543
 
 
81
 
 
12,624
 

F-37

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
Year ended
31 December 2015
 
Number of
contracts
Pre-
modification
recorded
investment
Modification:
interest
capitalisation
Post-
modification
recorded
investment
Commercial loans
 
1
 
 
1,000
 
 
87
 
 
1,087
 
Residential mortgage loans
 
20
 
 
13,283
 
 
1,081
 
 
14,364
 
Total loans modified in a TDR
 
21
 
 
14,283
 
 
1,168
 
 
15,451
 
 
Year ended
31 December 2014
 
Number of
contracts
Pre-
modification
recorded
investment
Modification:
interest
capitalisation
Post-
modification
recorded
investment
Residential mortgage loans
 
20
 
 
13,857
 
 
259
 
 
14,116
 
Total loans modified in a TDR
 
20
 
 
13,857
 
 
259
 
 
14,116
 
 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
TDRs outstanding
Accrual
Non-accrual
Accrual
Non-accrual
Commercial loans
 
1,044
 
 
 
 
1,078
 
 
 
Commercial real estate loans
 
1,702
 
 
1,539
 
 
13,065
 
 
1,608
 
Consumer loans
 
 
 
 
 
80
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loans
 
41,473
 
 
5,006
 
 
28,482
 
 
7,175
 
Total TDRs outstanding
 
44,219
 
 
6,545
 
 
42,705
 
 
8,783
 

Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans

The Bank acquired certain credit-impaired loans as part of the 7 November 2014 acquisition of substantially all retail loans of HSBC Bank (Cayman) Limited. The accretable difference (or “accretable yield”) represents the excess of a loan’s cash flows expected to be collected over the loan’s carrying amount.

 
Year ended
31 December 2016
 
Contractual
principal
Non-accretable
difference
Accretable
difference
Carrying
amount
Balance at beginning of year
 
8,709
 
 
(2,248
)
 
(631
)
 
5,830
 
Advances and increases in cash flows expected to be collected
 
166
 
 
408
 
 
(396
)
 
178
 
Reductions resulting from repayments
 
(464
)
 
 
 
216
 
 
(248
)
Reductions resulting from changes in allowances for credit losses
 
 
 
(172
)
 
 
 
(172
)
Reductions resulting from charge-offs
 
(395
)
 
395
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at end of year
 
8,016
 
 
(1,617
)
 
(811
)
 
5,588
 

F-38

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
Year ended
31 December 2015
 
Contractual
principal
Non-accretable
difference
Accretable
difference
Carrying
amount
Balance at beginning of year
 
11,020
 
 
(3,804
)
 
 
 
7,216
 
Advances and increases in cash flows expected to be collected
 
150
 
 
631
 
 
(631
)
 
150
 
Reductions resulting from repayments
 
(1,554
)
 
 
 
107
 
 
(1,447
)
Reductions resulting from charge-offs
 
(907
)
 
818
 
 
 
 
(89
)
Accretion
 
 
 
107
 
 
(107
)
 
 
Balance at end of year
 
8,709
 
 
(2,248
)
 
(631
)
 
5,830
 
 
Year ended
31 December 2014
 
Contractual
principal
Non-accretable
difference
Accretable
difference
Carrying
amount
Balance at beginning of year
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Purchases
 
11,001
 
 
(3,804
)
 
 
 
7,197
 
Advances and increases in cash flows expected to be collected
 
19
 
 
 
 
 
 
19
 
Balance at end of year
 
11,020
 
 
(3,804
)
 
 
 
7,216
 

Note 7: Credit risk concentrations

Concentrations of credit risk in the lending and off-balance sheet credit-related arrangements portfolios arise when a number of customers are engaged in similar business activities, are in the same geographic region, or when they have similar economic features that would cause their ability to meet contractual obligations to be similarly affected by changes in economic conditions. The Bank regularly monitors various segments of its credit risk portfolio to assess potential concentrations of risks and to obtain collateral when deemed necessary. In the Bank’s commercial portfolio, risk concentrations are evaluated primarily by industry and by geographic region of loan origination. In the consumer portfolio, concentrations are evaluated primarily by products. Credit exposures include loans, guarantees and acceptances, letters of credit and commitments for undrawn lines of credit. Unconditionally cancellable credit cards and overdraft lines of credit are excluded from the tables below.

The following tables summarise the credit exposure of the Bank by business sector and by geographic region. The on-balance sheet exposure amounts disclosed are net of specific allowances and the off-balance sheet exposure amounts disclosed are gross of collateral held. During 2016, management revised the methodology for determining the geographic location of cash and cash equivalents from the location of the branch to the location of the head office holding custody.

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Loans
Off-balance
sheet
Total credit
exposure
Loans
Off-balance
sheet
Total credit
exposure
Business sector
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Banks and financial services
 
321,680
 
 
393,148
 
 
714,828
 
 
243,776
 
 
320,934
 
 
564,710
 
Commercial and merchandising
 
266,976
 
 
139,264
 
 
406,240
 
 
230,376
 
 
107,545
 
 
337,921
 
Governments
 
112,857
 
 
709
 
 
113,566
 
 
223,699
 
 
102,782
 
 
326,481
 
Individuals
 
2,299,852
 
 
108,810
 
 
2,408,662
 
 
2,532,209
 
 
95,956
 
 
2,628,165
 
Primary industry and manufacturing
 
34,304
 
 
2,095
 
 
36,399
 
 
36,299
 
 
978
 
 
37,277
 
Real estate
 
418,946
 
 
12,467
 
 
431,413
 
 
632,548
 
 
15,891
 
 
648,439
 
Hospitality industry
 
142,707
 
 
4,353
 
 
147,060
 
 
125,471
 
 
14,854
 
 
140,325
 
Transport and communication
 
5,665
 
 
 
 
5,665
 
 
5,974
 
 
 
 
5,974
 
Sub-total
 
3,602,987
 
 
660,846
 
 
4,263,833
 
 
4,030,352
 
 
658,940
 
 
4,689,292
 
General allowance
 
(32,509
)
 
 
 
(32,509
)
 
(30,197
)
 
 
 
(30,197
)
Total
 
3,570,478
 
 
660,846
 
 
4,231,324
 
 
4,000,155
 
 
658,940
 
 
4,659,095
 

F-39

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Cash due
from banks,
resell agreements
and short-term
investments
Loans
Off-balance
sheet
Total credit
exposure
Cash due
from banks,
resell agreements
and short-term
investments
Loans
Off-balance
sheet
Total credit
exposure
Geographic region
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Australia
 
14,242
 
 
 
 
 
 
14,242
 
 
14,187
 
 
 
 
 
 
14,187
 
Barbados
 
 
 
7,500
 
 
 
 
7,500
 
 
 
 
11,250
 
 
 
 
11,250
 
Belgium
 
1,722
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,722
 
 
3,352
 
 
 
 
 
 
3,352
 
Bermuda
 
23,505
 
 
2,105,195
 
 
322,554
 
 
2,451,254
 
 
22,009
 
 
2,269,635
 
 
371,687
 
 
2,663,331
 
Canada
 
514,861
 
 
 
 
 
 
514,861
 
 
365,037
 
 
 
 
 
 
365,037
 
Cayman
 
40,356
 
 
706,994
 
 
231,211
 
 
978,561
 
 
19,086
 
 
713,468
 
 
207,139
 
 
939,693
 
Guernsey
 
1
 
 
337,037
 
 
107,081
 
 
444,119
 
 
1
 
 
434,531
 
 
53,750
 
 
488,282
 
Japan
 
20,963
 
 
 
 
 
 
20,963
 
 
23,424
 
 
 
 
 
 
23,424
 
New Zealand
 
785
 
 
 
 
 
 
785
 
 
999
 
 
 
 
 
 
999
 
Norway
 
42,477
 
 
 
 
 
 
42,477
 
 
289
 
 
 
 
 
 
289
 
Saint Lucia
 
 
 
65,117
 
 
 
 
65,117
 
 
 
 
65,285
 
 
 
 
65,285
 
Sweden
 
1,550
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,550
 
 
3,659
 
 
 
 
 
 
3,659
 
Switzerland
 
5,833
 
 
 
 
 
 
5,833
 
 
3,905
 
 
 
 
 
 
3,905
 
The Bahamas
 
2,822
 
 
23,860
 
 
 
 
26,682
 
 
3,196
 
 
28,736
 
 
 
 
31,932
 
United Kingdom
 
1,224,263
 
 
357,284
 
 
 
 
1,581,547
 
 
1,078,088
 
 
507,447
 
 
26,364
 
 
1,611,899
 
United States
 
876,642
 
 
 
 
 
 
876,642
 
 
1,161,106
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,161,106
 
Other
 
197
 
 
 
 
 
 
197
 
 
34
 
 
 
 
 
 
34
 
Sub-total
 
2,770,219
 
 
3,602,987
 
 
660,846
 
 
7,034,052
 
 
2,698,372
 
 
4,030,352
 
 
658,940
 
 
7,387,664
 
General allowance
 
 
 
(32,509
)
 
 
 
(32,509
)
 
 
 
(30,197
)
 
 
 
(30,197
)
Total
 
2,770,219
 
 
3,570,478
 
 
660,846
 
 
7,001,543
 
 
2,698,372
 
 
4,000,155
 
 
658,940
 
 
7,357,467
 

Note 8: Premises, equipment and computer software

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Cost
Accumulated
depreciation
Net carrying
value
Cost
Accumulated
depreciation
Net carrying
value
Category
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Land
 
9,008
 
 
 
 
9,008
 
 
9,008
 
 
 
 
9,008
 
Buildings
 
137,110
 
 
(58,606
)
 
78,504
 
 
135,684
 
 
(55,030
)
 
80,654
 
Equipment
 
28,837
 
 
(25,637
)
 
3,200
 
 
31,108
 
 
(27,620
)
 
3,488
 
Computer hardware and software in use
 
170,138
 
 
(98,452
)
 
71,686
 
 
174,162
 
 
(88,582
)
 
85,580
 
Computer software in development
 
5,375
 
 
 
 
5,375
 
 
4,648
 
 
 
 
4,648
 
Total
 
350,468
 
 
(182,695
)
 
167,773
 
 
354,610
 
 
(171,232
)
 
183,378
 
 
Year ended
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Depreciation charged to operating expenses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Buildings (included in Property expense)
 
4,058
 
 
4,183
 
 
4,434
 
Equipment (included in Property expense)
 
1,462
 
 
1,605
 
 
1,728
 
Computer hardware and software (included in Technology and communication expense)
 
18,757
 
 
19,076
 
 
18,588
 
Total depreciation charged to operating expenses
 
24,277
 
 
24,864
 
 
24,750
 
Impairment of buildings’ carrying value (included in Impairment of fixed assets)
 
 
 
 
 
1,986
 

During the year ended 31 December 2014, the Bank’s intended use of three Bermuda properties changed and therefore the properties were assessed for impairment. The carrying amounts of the Bermuda segment’s buildings were impaired by $1.2 million during 2014 because their respective fair values were lower than the carrying amounts.

F-40

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

At the end of 2014, the Bank changed its commitment with respect to a Bermuda property which was being used in its operations but is now contemplated for disposal and therefore the property has been reclassified as held for sale and included in OREO assets in the consolidated balance sheet. The reclassification resulted in an $0.8 million write down during 2014 of the carrying amount to its fair value less cost to sell. The fair value was based on the discounted cash flow of a projected sale.

During the year ended 31 December 2015, the Bank sold four Bermuda properties and one Cayman property which were classified as premises, equipment and computer software as at 31 December 2014. The properties were reclassified to other real estate owned during 2015 upon classification as held for sale. The properties were sold for total proceeds of $11.2 million and a gain of $0.5 million, which is recognized on the consolidated statements of operations under net realised / unrealised gains (losses) on other real estate owned. For the Cayman property, the Bank has entered into a leaseback agreement for two floors with lease payments of $0.4 million per year for three years.

During the year ended 31 December 2015, the Bank recognized an impairment of $5.1 million regarding the core banking system in the UK as described in Note 13: Exit cost obligations.

Note 9: Goodwill and other intangible assets

Goodwill

 
Year ended
Guernsey segment
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Balance at beginning of year
 
23,462
 
 
24,821
 
 
7,086
 
Acquisitions during the year
 
 
 
 
 
19,291
 
Foreign exchange translation adjustment
 
(3,840
)
 
(1,359
)
 
(1,556
)
Balance at end of year
 
19,622
 
 
23,462
 
 
24,821
 

Customer Relationship Intangible Assets

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
Business segment
Cost
Accumulated
amortisation
Net carrying
amount
Cost
Accumulated
amortisation
Net carrying
amount
Bermuda
 
29,785
 
 
(7,762
)
 
22,023
 
 
8,342
 
 
(6,258
)
 
2,084
 
Cayman
 
12,324
 
 
(2,782
)
 
9,542
 
 
12,324
 
 
(1,960
)
 
10,364
 
Guernsey
 
58,420
 
 
(47,696
)
 
10,724
 
 
58,420
 
 
(43,199
)
 
15,221
 
Total
 
100,529
 
 
(58,240
)
 
42,289
 
 
79,086
 
 
(51,417
)
 
27,669
 

Customer relationships are initially valued based on the present value of net cash flows expected to be derived solely from the recurring customer base existing as at the date of acquisition. Customer relationship intangible assets may or may not arise from contracts.

During the year ended 31 December 2016, the Bank acquired new customer intangible assets with a value of $21.4 million (31 December 2015: nil, 31 December 2014: $26.6 million ), the amortisation expense amounted to $4.5 million (31 December 2015: $4.4 million, 31 December 2014: $4.3 million) and the foreign exchange translation adjustment decreased the net carrying amount by $2.3 million (31 December 2015: decreased by $0.9 million, 31 December 2014: decreased by $1.3 million). The estimated aggregate amortisation expense for each of the succeeding five years is $4.2 million.

F-41

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Note 10: Customer deposits and deposits from banks

By Maturity

 
Demand
Total
demand
deposits
Term
Total
term
deposits
Total
deposits
31 December 2016
Non-interest
bearing
Interest
bearing
Within 3
months
3 to 6
months
6 to 12
months
After 12
months
Customers
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand or less than $100k(1)
 
1,733,684
 
 
3,013,401
 
 
4,747,085
 
 
14,091
 
 
4,309
 
 
9,068
 
 
16,380
 
 
43,848
 
 
4,790,933
 
Term - $100k or more
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
 
 
 
1,013,159
 
 
37,550
 
 
60,952
 
 
44,507
 
 
1,156,168
 
 
1,156,168
 
Total Bermuda
 
1,733,684
 
 
3,013,401
 
 
4,747,085
 
 
1,027,250
 
 
41,859
 
 
70,020
 
 
60,887
 
 
1,200,016
 
 
5,947,101
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand or less than $100k
 
651,329
 
 
2,794,799
 
 
3,446,128
 
 
20,295
 
 
4,108
 
 
4,145
 
 
783
 
 
29,331
 
 
3,475,459
 
Term and $100k or more
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
 
 
 
440,674
 
 
119,519
 
 
17,590
 
 
9,510
 
 
587,293
 
 
587,293
 
Total non-Bermuda
 
651,329
 
 
2,794,799
 
 
3,446,128
 
 
460,969
 
 
123,627
 
 
21,735
 
 
10,293
 
 
616,624
 
 
4,062,752
 
Total customer deposits
 
2,385,013
 
 
5,808,200
 
 
8,193,213
 
 
1,488,219
 
 
165,486
 
 
91,755
 
 
71,180
 
 
1,816,640
 
 
10,009,853
 
Banks
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand or less than $100k
 
340
 
 
 
 
340
 
 
4
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4
 
 
344
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand or less than $100k
 
 
 
19,751
 
 
19,751
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
19,751
 
Term and $100k or more
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
 
 
 
3,601
 
 
100
 
 
 
 
 
 
3,701
 
 
3,701
 
Total non-Bermuda
 
 
 
19,751
 
 
19,751
 
 
3,601
 
 
100
 
 
 
 
 
 
3,701
 
 
23,452
 
Total bank deposits
 
340
 
 
19,751
 
 
20,091
 
 
3,605
 
 
100
 
 
 
 
 
 
3,705
 
 
23,796
 
Total deposits
 
2,385,353
 
 
5,827,951
 
 
8,213,304
 
 
1,491,824
 
 
165,586
 
 
91,755
 
 
71,180
 
 
1,820,345
 
 
10,033,649
 
 
Demand
Total
demand
deposits
Term
Total
term
deposits
Total
deposits
31 December 2015
Non-interest
bearing
Interest
bearing
Within 3
months
3 to 6
months
6 to 12
months
After 12
months
Customers
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand or less than $100k(1)
 
1,348,878
 
 
2,390,952
 
 
3,739,830
 
 
15,902
 
 
4,757
 
 
10,035
 
 
15,881
 
 
46,575
 
 
3,786,405
 
Term - $100k or more
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
 
 
 
329,433
 
 
37,925
 
 
64,943
 
 
53,002
 
 
485,303
 
 
485,303
 
Total Bermuda
 
1,348,878
 
 
2,390,952
 
 
3,739,830
 
 
345,335
 
 
42,682
 
 
74,978
 
 
68,883
 
 
531,878
 
 
4,271,708
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand or less than $100k
 
532,867
 
 
3,381,946
 
 
3,914,813
 
 
22,878
 
 
6,714
 
 
4,238
 
 
376
 
 
34,206
 
 
3,949,019
 
Term and $100k or more
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
 
 
 
616,442
 
 
246,989
 
 
74,030
 
 
9,480
 
 
946,941
 
 
946,941
 
Total non-Bermuda
 
532,867
 
 
3,381,946
 
 
3,914,813
 
 
639,320
 
 
253,703
 
 
78,268
 
 
9,856
 
 
981,147
 
 
4,895,960
 
Total customer deposits
 
1,881,745
 
 
5,772,898
 
 
7,654,643
 
 
984,655
 
 
296,385
 
 
153,246
 
 
78,739
 
 
1,513,025
 
 
9,167,668
 
Banks
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand or less than $100k
 
403
 
 
 
 
403
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
403
 
Non-Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand or less than $100k
 
 
 
10,176
 
 
10,176
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10,176
 
Term and $100k or more
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
 
 
 
3,899
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3,899
 
 
3,899
 
Total non-Bermuda
 
 
 
10,176
 
 
10,176
 
 
3,899
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3,899
 
 
14,075
 
Total bank deposits
 
403
 
 
10,176
 
 
10,579
 
 
3,899
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3,899
 
 
14,478
 
Total deposits
 
1,882,148
 
 
5,783,074
 
 
7,665,222
 
 
988,554
 
 
296,385
 
 
153,246
 
 
78,739
 
 
1,516,924
 
 
9,182,146
 

F-42

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

(1)As at 31 December 2016, $150 million (31 December 2015: $175 million) of the Demand deposits - Interest bearing bear a special negligible interest rate. The weighted-average interest rate on interest-bearing demand deposits as at 31 December 2016 is 0.06% (31 December 2015: 0.10%).

By Type and Segment

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Payable
on demand
Payable on a
fixed date
Total
Payable
on demand
Payable on a
fixed date
Total
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customers
 
4,747,086
 
 
1,200,016
 
 
5,947,102
 
 
3,739,829
 
 
531,877
 
 
4,271,706
 
Banks
 
341
 
 
4
 
 
345
 
 
403
 
 
 
 
403
 
Cayman
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customers
 
2,606,305
 
 
417,750
 
 
3,024,055
 
 
2,596,642
 
 
416,489
 
 
3,013,131
 
Banks
 
19,615
 
 
3,701
 
 
23,316
 
 
9,365
 
 
3,899
 
 
13,264
 
Guernsey
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customers
 
781,119
 
 
185,457
 
 
966,576
 
 
996,343
 
 
248,866
 
 
1,245,209
 
Banks
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
669
 
 
 
 
669
 
The Bahamas
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customers
 
58,703
 
 
13,417
 
 
72,120
 
 
36,078
 
 
3,602
 
 
39,680
 
United Kingdom
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customers
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
285,751
 
 
312,191
 
 
597,942
 
Banks
 
135
 
 
 
 
135
 
 
142
 
 
 
 
142
 
Total Customers
 
8,193,213
 
 
1,816,640
 
 
10,009,853
 
 
7,654,643
 
 
1,513,025
 
 
9,167,668
 
Total Banks
 
20,091
 
 
3,705
 
 
23,796
 
 
10,579
 
 
3,899
 
 
14,478
 
Total deposits
 
8,213,304
 
 
1,820,345
 
 
10,033,649
 
 
7,665,222
 
 
1,516,924
 
 
9,182,146
 

Note 11: Employee benefit plans

The Bank maintains trusteed pension plans including non-contributory defined benefit plans and a number of defined contribution plans, and provides post-retirement medical benefits to its qualifying retirees. The expense related to these plans is included in the consolidated statements of operations under Salaries and other employee benefits. The defined benefit provisions under the pension plans are generally based upon years of service and average salary during the relevant years of employment. The defined benefit and post-retirement medical plans are not open to new participants and are non-contributory and the funding required is provided by the Bank, based upon the advice of independent actuaries. The defined benefit pension plans are in the Bermuda, Guernsey and United Kingdom jurisdictions and the defined benefit post-retirement medical plan is in Bermuda.

Bermuda Defined Benefit Post Retirement Healthcare Plan

For the year ended 31 December 2014, numerous changes in the plan provisions were made to align the plan provisions with the administrative practices of the Bank resulting in a further increase in the Bermuda defined benefit post-retirement healthcare plan liability of $7.9 million.

The Bank amortises prior service credit resulting from plan amendments that occurred when plan members were active employees, on a linear basis over the expected average remaining service period (to full eligibility) of active members expected to receive benefits under the plan. Such remaining service periods are as follow: 3.1 years for the 2010 plan amendments and 4.6 years for the 2011 plan amendments. Plan amendments occurring in 2014 resulted in the recognition of new prior service cost on 31 December 2014 on a plan for which substantially all members are now inactive and, in accordance with US GAAP, the Bank has elected to amortise this new prior service cost on a linear basis over 21 years, which is the average remaining life expectancy of members eligible for benefits under the plan at the time of the amendments.

Guernsey Defined Benefit Pension Plan

Effective October 2014, all the participants of the Guernsey defined benefit pension plan are inactive and in accordance with US GAAP, the net actuarial loss of the Guernsey defined benefit pension plan will

F-43

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

be amortised over the then estimated average remaining life expectancy of the inactive participants of 39 years. Prior to all of the Guernsey participants being inactive, the net actuarial loss of the Guernsey defined benefit pension plan was amortised to net income over the estimated average remaining service period for active members of 15 years.

The following table presents the financial position of the Bank’s defined benefit pension plans and the Bank’s post-retirement medical benefits, which is unfunded. The Bank measures the benefit obligations and plan assets annually on each 31 December and therefore, the most recent measurement date is 31 December 2016.

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
31 December 2014
 
Pension
plans
Post-
retirement
medical
benefit plan
Pension
plans
Post-
retirement
medical
benefit plan
Pension
plans
Post-
retirement
medical
benefit plan
Accumulated benefit obligation at end of year
 
178,067
 
 
 
 
166,815
 
 
 
 
188,890
 
 
 
Change in projected benefit obligation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Projected benefit obligation at beginning of year
 
166,815
 
 
119,107
 
 
188,890
 
 
114,640
 
 
167,469
 
 
89,109
 
Service cost
 
 
 
118
 
 
 
 
341
 
 
1,203
 
 
825
 
Employee contributions
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
99
 
 
 
Interest cost
 
5,781
 
 
4,792
 
 
6,958
 
 
4,745
 
 
7,760
 
 
4,503
 
Benefits paid
 
(10,477
)
 
(3,594
)
 
(7,573
)
 
(2,871
)
 
(8,771
)
 
(3,590
)
Plan amendment
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7,901
 
Settlement and curtailment of liability
 
 
 
 
 
(2,509
)
 
 
 
(4,662
)
 
 
Actuarial (gain) loss
 
30,953
 
 
5,911
 
 
(14,157
)
 
2,252
 
 
31,604
 
 
15,892
 
Foreign exchange translation adjustment
 
(15,004
)
 
 
 
(4,794
)
 
 
 
(5,812
)
 
 
Projected benefit obligation at end of year
 
178,068
 
 
126,334
 
 
166,815
 
 
119,107
 
 
188,890
 
 
114,640
 
Change in plan assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of plan assets at beginning of year
 
179,961
 
 
 
 
194,007
 
 
 
 
186,412
 
 
 
Actual return on plan assets
 
18,615
 
 
 
 
687
 
 
 
 
18,451
 
 
 
Employer contribution
 
678
 
 
3,594
 
 
808
 
 
2,871
 
 
4,172
 
 
3,590
 
Employee contributions
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
99
 
 
 
Plan settlement
 
 
 
 
 
(2,424
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Benefits paid
 
(10,477
)
 
(3,594
)
 
(7,573
)
 
(2,871
)
 
(8,771
)
 
(3,590
)
Foreign exchange translation adjustment
 
(16,571
)
 
 
 
(5,544
)
 
 
 
(6,356
)
 
 
Fair value of plan assets at end of year
 
172,206
 
 
 
 
179,961
 
 
 
 
194,007
 
 
 
Amounts recognised in the consolidated balance sheets consist of:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prepaid benefit cost included in other assets
 
7,771
 
 
 
 
16,174
 
 
 
 
8,374
 
 
 
Accrued pension benefit cost included in employee benefit plans liability
 
(13,633
)
 
(126,334
)
 
(3,028
)
 
(119,107
)
 
(3,257
)
 
(114,640
)
Surplus (deficit) of plan assets over projected benefit obligation at measurement date
 
(5,862
)
 
(126,334
)
 
13,146
 
 
(119,107
)
 
5,117
 
 
(114,640
)

As at 31 December 2016, the pension plan of the United Kingdom subsidiary was in a surplus position (i.e. net surplus presented in other assets in the consolidated balance sheets) while the pension plans of the Bermuda and Guernsey operations were in a deficit position with projected benefit obligations of $150.0 million and plan assets of $136.3 million.

F-44

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
Year ended
 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
31 December 2014
 
Pension
plans
Post-
retirement
medical
benefit plan
Pension
plans
Post-
retirement
medical
benefit plan
Pension
plans
Post-
retirement
medical
benefit plan
Amounts recognised in accumulated other comprehensive loss consist of:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net actuarial loss, excluding deferred taxes
 
(64,852
)
 
(31,959
)
 
(46,696
)
 
(28,779
)
 
(53,970
)
 
(29,874
)
Prior service credit, net of prior service cost
 
 
 
(5,678
)
 
 
 
665
 
 
 
 
7,008
 
Deferred income taxes assets
 
1,620
 
 
 
 
365
 
 
 
 
801
 
 
 
Net amount recognised in accumulated other comprehensive loss
 
(63,232
)
 
(37,637
)
 
(46,331
)
 
(28,114
)
 
(53,169
)
 
(22,866
)
Annual Benefit Expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Expense component
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Service cost
 
 
 
118
 
 
 
 
341
 
 
1,203
 
 
825
 
Interest cost
 
5,781
 
 
4,792
 
 
6,958
 
 
4,745
 
 
7,760
 
 
4,503
 
Expected return on plan assets
 
(8,943
)
 
 
 
(9,585
)
 
 
 
(10,653
)
 
 
Amortisation of net actuarial losses
 
1,702
 
 
2,731
 
 
1,607
 
 
3,347
 
 
1,058
 
 
922
 
Amortisation of prior service credit
 
 
 
(6,343
)
 
 
 
(6,343
)
 
 
 
(6,719
)
Loss on settlement
 
 
 
 
 
101
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Defined benefit expense (income)
 
(1,460
)
 
1,298
 
 
(919
)
 
2,090
 
 
(632
)
 
(469
)
Defined contribution expense
 
6,606
 
 
 
 
6,907
 
 
 
 
6,892
 
 
 
Total benefit expense (income)
 
5,146
 
 
1,298
 
 
5,988
 
 
2,090
 
 
6,260
 
 
(469
)
Other Changes Recognised in Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net gain (loss) arising during the year
 
(19,956
)
 
(5,911
)
 
5,096
 
 
(2,252
)
 
(18,947
)
 
(15,892
)
Prior service cost arising during the year
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(7,901
)
Amortisation of net actuarial losses
 
1,702
 
 
2,731
 
 
1,703
 
 
3,347
 
 
1,058
 
 
922
 
Amortisation of prior service credit
 
 
 
(6,343
)
 
 
 
(6,343
)
 
 
 
(6,719
)
Change in deferred taxes
 
1,315
 
 
 
 
(391
)
 
 
 
83
 
 
 
Foreign exchange adjustment
 
38
 
 
 
 
430
 
 
 
 
253
 
 
 
Total changes recognised in other comprehensive income (loss)
 
(16,901
)
 
(9,523
)
 
6,838
 
 
(5,248
)
 
(17,553
)
 
(29,590
)

The estimated portion of the net actuarial loss for the pension plans that will be amortised from AOCL into benefit expense over the 2017 full fiscal year is $2.2 million. The estimated portion of the net actuarial loss and the prior service credit for the post-retirement medical benefit plan that will be amortised from AOCL into benefit expense over the 2017 full fiscal year is $3.5 million for the net actuarial loss and a credit of $0.8 million for the prior service credit.

To develop the expected long-term rate of return on the plan assets assumption for each plan, the Bank considered the historical returns and the future expectations for returns for each asset class, as well as the target asset allocations of the assets. The weighted average discount rate used to determine benefit obligations at the end of the year is derived from interest rates on high quality corporate bonds with maturities that match the expected benefit payments.

F-45

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Actuarial Assumptions

 
Year ended
 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
31 December 2014
 
Pension
plans
Post-
retirement
medical
benefit plan
Pension
plans
Post-
retirement
medical
benefit plan
Pension
plans
Post-
retirement
medical
benefit plan
Actuarial assumptions used to determine annual benefit expense
Weighted average discount rate
3.90%
4.70%
3.80%
4.20%
4.75%
5.10%
Weighted average rate of compensation increases(1)
2.30%
N/A
2.20%
N/A
4.30%
N/A
Weighted average expected long-term rate of return on plan assets
5.30%
N/A
5.10%
N/A
5.80%
N/A
Weighted average annual medical cost increase rate (sensitivity shown below)
N/A
8.0% to
4.5% in
2035
N/A
7.1% to
4.5% in
2027
N/A
7.3% to
4.5% in
2027
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Actuarial assumptions used to determine benefit obligations at end of year
Weighted average discount rate
3.40%
4.37%
4.20%
4.70%
3.80%
4.20%
Weighted average rate of compensation increases
2.50%
N/A
2.30%
N/A
2.80%
N/A
Weighted average annual medical cost increase rate (sensitivity shown below)
N/A
7.8% to
4.5% in
2035
N/A
8.0% to
4.5% in
2035
N/A
7.1% to
4.5% in
2027
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Post-retirement medical benefit plan sensitivity to trend rate assumptions
The effect of a one percentage point increase or decrease in the assumed medical cost increase rate on the aggregate of service and interest costs is as follows:
a. One percent increase in trend rate
 
 
 
 
 
 
i. Effect on total service cost and interest cost components for the year
N/A
772
N/A
909
N/A
952
ii. Effect on benefit obligation at year-end
N/A
19,513
N/A
18,792
N/A
20,339
b. One percent decrease in trend rate
 
 
 
 
 
 
i. Effect on total service cost and interest cost components for the year
N/A
(694)
N/A
(781)
N/A
(771)
ii. Effect on benefit obligation at year-end
N/A
(16,255)
N/A
(15,496)
N/A
(16,514)
(1)Only the United Kingdom subsidiary plan is impacted by potential future compensation increases.

Investments Policies and Strategies

The pension plans’ assets are managed according to each plan’s investment policy statement, which outlines the purpose of the plan, statement of objectives and guidelines and investment policy. The asset allocation is diversified and any use of derivatives is limited to hedging purposes only.

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Actual
allocation
Target
allocation
Actual
allocation
Target
allocation
Weighted average actual and target asset allocations of the pension plans by asset category
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities (including debt mutual funds)
 
40
%
 
46
%
 
42
%
 
53
%
Equity securities (including equity mutual funds)
 
60
%
 
49
%
 
58
%
 
47
%
Other
 
0
%
 
5
%
 
0
%
 
0
%
Total
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%

F-46

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Fair Value Measurements of Pension Plans’ Assets

The following table presents the fair value of plans’ assets by category and level of inputs used in their respective fair value determination as described in Note 2:

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Fair value determination
Fair value determination
 
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total
fair value
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total
fair value
US government and federal agencies
 
 
 
9,777
 
 
 
 
9,777
 
 
 
 
7,532
 
 
 
 
7,532
 
Non-US governments debt securities
 
 
 
23,255
 
 
 
 
23,255
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Corporate debt securities
 
 
 
36,184
 
 
 
 
36,184
 
 
 
 
68,166
 
 
 
 
68,166
 
Equity securities and mutual funds
 
 
 
102,627
 
 
 
 
102,627
 
 
11,845
 
 
91,702
 
 
 
 
103,547
 
Other
 
 
 
363
 
 
 
 
363
 
 
 
 
716
 
 
 
 
716
 
Total fair value of plans’ assets
 
 
 
172,206
 
 
 
 
172,206
 
 
11,845
 
 
168,116
 
 
 
 
179,961
 

At 31 December 2016, 31.2% (31 December 2015: 34.8%) of the assets of the pension plans were mutual funds and equity securities managed or administered by wholly-owned subsidiaries of the Bank. At 31 December 2016, 0.5% and nil % (31 December 2015: 0.3% and 1.2%) of the plans’ assets were invested in common and preference shares of the Bank respectively.

The investments of the pension funds are diversified across a range of asset classes and are diversified within each asset class. The assets are generally actively managed with the goal of adding some incremental value through security selection and asset allocation.

Estimated 2017 Bank contribution to and estimated benefit payments for the next ten years under the pension and post-retirement medical benefit plans are as follows:

 
Pension
plans
Post-
retirement
medical
benefit plan
Estimated Bank contributions for the full year ending 31 December 2017
 
330
 
 
4,571
 
Estimated benefit payments by year:
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017
 
7,300
 
 
4,571
 
2018
 
7,300
 
 
4,896
 
2019
 
7,300
 
 
5,237
 
2020
 
7,300
 
 
5,581
 
2021
 
7,300
 
 
5,942
 
2022-2026
 
36,000
 
 
34,940
 

Note 12: Credit related arrangements, repurchase agreements and commitments

Commitments

As at 31 December 2016, the Bank was committed to expenditures under contract for information technology services sourcing and leases of $69.8 million and $19.3 million respectively (31 December 2015: $16.3 million and $20.0 million respectively). Rental expense for premises leased on a long-term basis for the year ended 31 December 2016 amounted to $5.1 million (31 December 2015: $4.8 million, 31 December 2014: $5.3 million). The leases under contract as of both 31 December 2016 and 31 December 2015 are all non-cancellable operating type leases primarily for the lease of office space.

F-47

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

The following table summarises the Bank’s commitments for sourcing, long-term leases and other agreements:

Year ending 31 December
Sourcing
Leases
Other
Total
2017
 
17,157
 
 
4,761
 
 
2,503
 
 
24,421
 
2018
 
13,876
 
 
3,705
 
 
2,440
 
 
20,021
 
2019
 
13,746
 
 
2,900
 
 
2,440
 
 
19,086
 
2020
 
13,666
 
 
2,759
 
 
600
 
 
17,025
 
2021
 
11,373
 
 
2,665
 
 
600
 
 
14,638
 
2022 & thereafter
 
 
 
2,508
 
 
600
 
 
3,108
 
Total commitments
 
69,818
 
 
19,298
 
 
9,183
 
 
98,299
 

Credit-Related Arrangements

Standby letters of credit and letters of guarantee are issued at the request of a Bank customer in order to secure the customer’s payment or performance obligations to a third party. These guarantees represent an irrevocable obligation of the Bank to pay the third party beneficiary upon presentation of the guarantee and satisfaction of the documentary requirements stipulated therein, without investigation as to the validity of the beneficiary’s claim against the customer. Generally, the term of the standby letters of credit does not exceed one year, whilst the term of the letters of guarantee does not exceed four years. The types and amounts of collateral security held by the Bank for these standby letters of credit and letters of guarantee is generally represented by deposits with the Bank or a charge over assets held in mutual funds.

The Bank considers the fees collected in connection with the issuance of standby letters of credit and letters of guarantee to be representative of the fair value of its obligation undertaken in issuing the guarantee. In accordance with applicable accounting standards related to guarantees, the Bank defers fees collected in connection with the issuance of standby letters of credit and letters of guarantee. The fees are then recognised in income proportionately over the life of the credit agreements. The following table presents the outstanding financial guarantees. Collateral is shown at estimated market value less selling cost. Where the collateral is cash, it is shown gross including accrued income.

 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Gross
Collateral
Net
Gross
Collateral
Net
Outstanding financial guarantees
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Standby letters of credit
 
242,437
 
 
242,437
 
 
 
 
258,851
 
 
257,200
 
 
1,651
 
Letters of guarantee
 
4,772
 
 
4,772
 
 
 
 
9,137
 
 
8,418
 
 
719
 
Total
 
247,209
 
 
247,209
 
 
 
 
267,988
 
 
265,618
 
 
2,370
 

Commitments

The Bank enters into contractual commitments to extend credit, normally with fixed expiration dates or termination clauses, at specified rates and for specific purposes. Substantially all of the Bank’s commitments to extend credit are contingent upon customers maintaining specific credit standards at the time of loan funding. Management assesses the credit risk associated with certain commitments to extend credit in determining the level of the allowance for possible loan losses.

The Bank has a facility by one of its custodians, whereby the Bank may offer up to US$200 million of standby letters of credit to its customers on a fully secured basis. Under the standard terms of the facility, the custodian has the right to set-off against securities held of 110% of the utilised facility. At 31 December 2016, $110.3 million (31 December 2015: $123.7 million) of standby letters of credit were issued under this facility.

F-48

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
Outstanding unfunded commitments to extend credit
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commitments to extend credit
 
412,568
 
 
390,497
 
Documentary and commercial letters of credit
 
1,069
 
 
455
 
Total unfunded commitments to extend credit
 
413,637
 
 
390,952
 

Repurchase agreements

The Bank utilizes repurchase agreements and resell agreements (reverse repurchase agreements) to manage liquidity. The risks of these transactions include changes in the fair value in the securities posted or received as collateral and other credit related events. The Bank manages these risks by ensuring that the collaterals involved are appropriate and by monitoring the value of the securities posted or received as collateral on a daily basis.

As at 31 December 2016, the Bank had eight open position (31 December 2015: nil) in resell agreements with a remaining maturity of less than 30 days involving pools of mortgages issued by US federal agencies. The amortised cost of these resell agreements is $148.8 million and are included in securities purchased under agreement to resell on the consolidated balance sheets. As at 31 December 2016, there were no positions which were offset on the balance sheet to arrive at the carrying value, and there was no collateral amount which was available to offset against the future settlement amount.

Legal Proceedings

There are actions and legal proceedings pending against the Bank and its subsidiaries which arose in the normal course of its business. Management, after reviewing all actions and proceedings pending against or involving the Bank and its subsidiaries, considers that the resolution of these matters would in the aggregate not be material to the consolidated financial position of the Bank, except as noted in the following paragraphs.

As publicly announced, in November 2013, the US Attorney’s Office for the Southern District of New York applied for and secured the issuance of so-called John Doe Summonses to six US financial institutions with which the Bank had correspondent bank relationships. The Bank has been fully cooperating with the US authorities in their ongoing investigation. Specifically, the Bank has conducted an extensive review and account remediation exercise to determine the US tax compliance status of US person account holders. The review process and results have been shared with the US authorities.

Management believes that as of 31 December 2016, a provision of $5.5 million (31 December 2015: $4.8 million), which has been recorded, is appropriate. As the investigation remains ongoing at this time, the timing and terms of the final resolution, including any fines or penalties, remain uncertain and the financial impact to the Bank could exceed the amount of the provision. In this regard, we note that the US authorities have not approved or commented on the adequacy or reasonableness of the estimate. The provision is included on the consolidated balance sheets under other liabilities and on the consolidated statements of operations under other expenses.

Note 13: Exit cost obligations

During December 2015, the Bank agreed to commence an orderly wind down of the deposit taking and investment management businesses in the United Kingdom segment as reflected in management segment reporting described in Note 15: Segmented Information. In making this determination, the Bank considered the increasing regulatory pressure along with periods of negative profitability and made the determination that an orderly wind down of the deposit taking and investment management businesses in the United Kingdom was prudent for Butterfield as a group. The orderly wind down was largely completed by the end of 2016 with the change in business operations to mortgage lending services and the change

F-49

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

in name from Butterfield Bank (UK) Limited to Butterfield Mortgages Limited. The amounts expensed shown in the following table are all included in the consolidated statements of operations as restructuring costs under non-interest expenses.

Related to this orderly wind down, it was determined that the core banking system utilized in the operations of the United Kingdom segment was impaired (included in premises, equipment and computer software on the consolidated balance sheets). This determination was based upon the realisable value of this software upon completion of the orderly wind down. A total of $5.1 million was expensed in the fourth quarter of the year ended 31 December 2015 and was included in impairment of fixed assets on the consolidated statements of operations of the relevant period.

 
Expense recognised by year
Amounts paid by year
Exit cost liability
 
Year ended 31
December
2016
Year ended 31
December
2015
Costs to be
recognised in
the future
Total exit costs
expected to be
incurred
Year ended 31
December
2016
Year ended 31
December
2015
As at 31
December
2016
As at 31
December
2015
Staff redundancy expenses
 
2,810
 
 
634
 
 
116
 
 
3,560
 
 
3,329
 
 
 
 
115
 
 
634
 
Professional services
 
2,284
 
 
1,549
 
 
219
 
 
4,052
 
 
3,763
 
 
 
 
70
 
 
1,549
 
Lease termination expenses
 
 
 
 
 
1,513
 
 
1,513
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other expenses
 
1,172
 
 
 
 
924
 
 
2,096
 
 
1,172
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total
 
6,266
 
 
2,183
 
 
2,772
 
 
11,221
 
 
8,264
 
 
 
 
185
 
 
2,183
 

Note 14: Loan interest income

 
Year ended
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Contractual interest
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Contractual interest earned on mortgages
 
103,820
 
 
104,194
 
 
106,321
 
Contractual interest earned on other loans
 
81,509
 
 
79,506
 
 
82,395
 
Subtotal contractual interest earned
 
185,329
 
 
183,700
 
 
188,716
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amortisation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amortisation of fair value hedge
 
(1,120
)
 
(1,471
)
 
(1,548
)
Amortisation of loan origination fees (net of amortised costs)
 
3,791
 
 
4,257
 
 
4,818
 
Total loan interest income
 
188,000
 
 
186,486
 
 
191,986
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance of unamortised fair value hedge included in loans as at year end
 
3,215
 
 
4,335
 
 
5,806
 
Balance of unamortised loan fees included in loans as at year end
 
6,313
 
 
7,319
 
 
7,072
 

Note 15: Segmented information

The Bank is managed by its CEO on a geographic basis. The Bank’s six geographic segments are Bermuda, Cayman, Guernsey, Switzerland, The Bahamas and the United Kingdom. The geographic segments are determined based on the country’s balance sheet size and by regulatory reporting requirements in the respective jurisdiction. Each region has a managing director who reports directly to the CEO. The Group CEO and the region managing director have final authority over resource allocation decisions and performance assessment.

The geographic segments reflect this management structure and the manner in which financial information is currently evaluated by the CEO. Segment results are determined based upon the Bank’s

F-50

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

management reporting system, which assigns balance sheet and income statement items to each of the geographic segments. The process is designed around the Bank’s organizational and management structure and, accordingly, the results derived are not necessarily comparable with similar information published by other financial institutions. A description of each reportable segment and table of financial results is presented below.

Accounting policies of the reportable segments are the same as those described in Note 2. Transactions between segments are accounted for on an accrual basis and are all eliminated upon consolidation. The Bank generally does not allocate assets, revenues and expenses among its business segments, with the exception of certain corporate overhead expenses and loan participation revenue and expense. Loan participation revenue and expenses are allocated pro-rata based upon the percentage of the total loan funded by each jurisdiction participating in the loan.

Bermuda provides a full range of retail, commercial and private banking services. Retail services are offered to individuals and small to medium-sized businesses through five branch locations and through Internet banking, mobile banking, automated teller machines (“ATMs”) and debit cards. Retail services include deposit services, consumer and mortgage lending, credit cards and personal insurance products. Commercial banking includes commercial lending and mortgages, cash management, payroll services, remote banking and letters of credit. Treasury services include money market and foreign exchange activities. Bermuda’s wealth management offering consists of Butterfield Asset Management Limited, which provides investment management, advisory and brokerage services and Butterfield Trust (Bermuda) Limited, which provides trust, estate, company management and custody services. Bermuda is also the location of Bank’s head offices and accordingly, retains the unallocated corporate overhead expenses.

The Cayman segment provides a comprehensive range of retail, commercial and private banking services. Retail services are offered to individuals and small to medium-sized businesses through three branch locations and through Internet banking, mobile banking, ATMs and debit cards. Retail services include deposit services, consumer and mortgage lending, credit cards and property/auto insurance. Commercial banking includes commercial lending and mortgages, cash management, payroll services, remote banking and letters of credit. Treasury services include money market and foreign exchange activities. Cayman’s wealth management offering comprises investment management, advisory and brokerage services and Butterfield Trust (Cayman) Limited, which provides trust, estate and company management.

The Guernsey segment provides a broad range of services to private clients and financial institutions including private banking and treasury services, Internet banking, administered bank services, wealth management and fiduciary services.

The Switzerland segment provides fiduciary services. The Bahamas segment provides fiduciary and ancillary services.

The United Kingdom segment previously provided a broad range of services including private banking and treasury services, Internet banking and wealth management and fiduciary services to high net worth individuals and privately owned businesses. As described in Note 13, during the year-ended 31 December 2015, the Bank commenced an orderly wind down of the deposit taking and investment management businesses in the United Kingdom segment. The United Kingdom segment now provides mortgage services for high value residential properties.

F-51

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
Total Assets by Segment
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bermuda
 
6,765,125
 
 
5,113,718
 
Cayman
 
3,393,256
 
 
3,282,319
 
Guernsey
 
1,132,663
 
 
1,391,126
 
Switzerland
 
2,173
 
 
2,713
 
The Bahamas
 
81,604
 
 
49,434
 
United Kingdom
 
151,866
 
 
788,433
 
Total assets before inter-segment eliminations
 
11,526,687
 
 
10,627,743
 
Less: inter-segment eliminations
 
(423,142
)
 
(352,180
)
Total
 
11,103,545
 
 
10,275,563
 
Year ended 31
December 2016
Net interest income
Provision for
credit losses
Non-interest
income
Revenue
before gains
and losses
Gains and
losses
Total net
revenue
Total
expenses
Net
income
Customer
Inter-
segment
Bermuda
 
160,466
 
 
1,642
 
 
(7,263
)
 
71,765
 
 
226,610
 
 
1,412
 
 
228,022
 
 
164,503
 
 
63,519
 
Cayman
 
79,644
 
 
388
 
 
2,135
 
 
41,364
 
 
123,531
 
 
(532
)
 
122,999
 
 
60,613
 
 
62,386
 
Guernsey
 
14,469
 
 
(323
)
 
(395
)
 
24,623
 
 
38,374
 
 
(1,027
)
 
37,347
 
 
35,547
 
 
1,800
 
Switzerland
 
41
 
 
 
 
 
 
3,798
 
 
3,839
 
 
 
 
3,839
 
 
3,366
 
 
473
 
The Bahamas
 
46
 
 
30
 
 
 
 
4,666
 
 
4,742
 
 
 
 
4,742
 
 
5,032
 
 
(290
)
United Kingdom
 
3,814
 
 
(1,737
)
 
1,124
 
 
3,947
 
 
7,148
 
 
1,161
 
 
8,309
 
 
20,255
 
 
(11,946
)
Total before eliminations
 
258,480
 
 
 
 
(4,399
)
 
150,163
 
 
404,244
 
 
1,014
 
 
405,258
 
 
289,316
 
 
115,942
 
Inter-segment eliminations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(2,690
)
 
(2,690
)
 
 
 
(2,690
)
 
(2,690
)
 
 
Total
 
258,480
 
 
 
 
(4,399
)
 
147,473
 
 
401,554
 
 
1,014
 
 
402,568
 
 
286,626
 
 
115,942
 
Year ended 31
December 2015
Net interest income
Provision for
credit losses
Non-interest
income
Revenue
before gains
and losses
Gains and
losses
Total net
revenue
Total
expenses
Net
income
Customer
Inter-
segment
Bermuda
 
142,488
 
 
2,600
 
 
(3,625
)
 
61,050
 
 
202,513
 
 
(2,503
)
 
200,010
 
 
159,474
 
 
40,536
 
Cayman
 
66,317
 
 
608
 
 
(466
)
 
39,508
 
 
105,967
 
 
(793
)
 
105,174
 
 
58,115
 
 
47,059
 
Guernsey
 
17,025
 
 
(427
)
 
(103
)
 
26,171
 
 
42,666
 
 
(1,066
)
 
41,600
 
 
39,872
 
 
1,728
 
Switzerland
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3,420
 
 
3,420
 
 
 
 
3,420
 
 
3,320
 
 
100
 
The Bahamas
 
8
 
 
116
 
 
 
 
5,295
 
 
5,419
 
 
1
 
 
5,420
 
 
5,068
 
 
352
 
United Kingdom
 
13,428
 
 
(2,897
)
 
(1,547
)
 
6,307
 
 
15,291
 
 
(5,076
)
 
10,215
 
 
22,251
 
 
(12,036
)
Total before eliminations
 
239,266
 
 
 
 
(5,741
)
 
141,751
 
 
375,276
 
 
(9,437
)
 
365,839
 
 
288,100
 
 
77,739
 
Inter-segment eliminations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1,579
)
 
(1,579
)
 
 
 
(1,579
)
 
(1,579
)
 
 
Total
 
239,266
 
 
 
 
(5,741
)
 
140,172
 
 
373,697
 
 
(9,437
)
 
364,260
 
 
286,521
 
 
77,739
 
Year ended 31
December 2014
Net interest income
Provision for
credit losses
Non-interest
income
Revenue
before gains
and losses
Gains and
losses
Total net
revenue
Total
expenses
Net
income
Customer
Inter-
segment
Bermuda
 
141,528
 
 
3,164
 
 
(6,425
)
 
60,692
 
 
198,959
 
 
6,908
 
 
205,867
 
 
145,696
 
 
60,171
 
Cayman
 
58,442
 
 
928
 
 
(557
)
 
33,515
 
 
92,328
 
 
36
 
 
92,364
 
 
58,829
 
 
33,535
 
Guernsey
 
19,303
 
 
(1,242
)
 
(154
)
 
26,814
 
 
44,721
 
 
4,432
 
 
49,153
 
 
39,580
 
 
9,573
 
Switzerland
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2,486
 
 
2,486
 
 
 
 
2,486
 
 
2,867
 
 
(381
)
The Bahamas
 
(15
)
 
166
 
 
 
 
5,492
 
 
5,643
 
 
 
 
5,643
 
 
5,548
 
 
95
 
United Kingdom
 
19,229
 
 
(3,016
)
 
(912
)
 
7,717
 
 
23,018
 
 
4,312
 
 
27,330
 
 
22,164
 
 
5,166
 
Total before eliminations
 
238,487
 
 
 
 
(8,048
)
 
136,716
 
 
367,155
 
 
15,688
 
 
382,843
 
 
274,684
 
 
108,159
 
Inter-segment eliminations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1,886
)
 
(1,886
)
 
 
 
(1,886
)
 
(1,886
)
 
 
Total
 
238,487
 
 
 
 
(8,048
)
 
134,830
 
 
365,269
 
 
15,688
 
 
380,957
 
 
272,798
 
 
108,159
 

F-52

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Note 16: Derivative instruments and risk management

The Bank uses derivatives for risk management purposes and to meet the needs of its customers. The Bank’s derivative contracts principally involve over-the-counter (“OTC”) transactions that are privately negotiated between the Bank and the counterparty to the contract and include interest rate contracts and foreign exchange contracts.

The Bank may pursue opportunities to reduce its exposure to credit losses on derivatives by entering into International Swaps and Derivatives Association master agreements (“ISDAs”). Depending on the nature of the derivative transaction, bilateral collateral arrangements may be used as well. When the Bank is engaged in more than one outstanding derivative transaction with the same counterparty, and also has a legally enforceable master netting agreement with that counterparty, the net marked to market exposure represents the netting of the positive and negative exposures with that counterparty. When there is a net negative exposure, the Bank regards its credit exposure to the counterparty as being zero. The net marked to market position with a particular counterparty represents a reasonable measure of credit risk when there is a legally enforceable master netting agreement between the Bank and that counterparty.

Certain of these agreements contain credit risk-related contingent features in which the counterparty has the option to accelerate cash settlement of the Bank’s net derivative liabilities with the counterparty in the event the Bank’s credit rating falls below specified levels or the liabilities reach certain levels.

All derivative financial instruments, whether designated as hedges or not, are recorded on the consolidated balance sheets at fair value within other assets or other liabilities. These amounts include the effect of netting. The accounting for changes in the fair value of a derivative in the consolidated statements of operations depends on whether the contract has been designated as a hedge and qualifies for hedge accounting.

Notional Amounts

The notional amounts are not recorded as assets or liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets as they represent the face amount of the contract to which a rate or price is applied to determine the amount of cash flows to be exchanged. Notional amounts represent the volume of outstanding transactions and do not represent the potential gain or loss associated with market risk or credit risk of such instruments. Credit risk is limited to the positive fair value of the derivative instrument, which is significantly less than the notional amount.

Fair Value

Derivative instruments, in the absence of any compensating up-front cash payments, generally have no market value at inception. They obtain value, positive or negative, as relevant interest rates, exchange rates, equity or commodity prices or indices change. The potential for derivatives to increase or decrease in value as a result of the foregoing factors is generally referred to as market risk. Market risk is managed within clearly defined parameters as prescribed by senior management of the Bank. The fair value is defined as the profit or loss associated with replacing the derivative contracts at prevailing market prices.

Risk Management Derivatives

The Bank enters into interest derivative contracts as part of its overall interest rate risk management strategy to minimise significant unplanned fluctuations in earnings that are caused by interest rate volatility. The Bank’s goal is to manage interest rate sensitivity by modifying the repricing or maturity characteristics of certain consolidated balance sheet assets and liabilities so that movements in interest rates do not adversely affect the net interest margin. Derivative instruments that are used as part of the Bank’s risk management strategy include interest rate swap contracts that have indices related to the pricing of specific consolidated balance sheet assets and liabilities. Interest rate swaps generally involve the exchange of fixed and variable-rate interest payments between two parties, based on a common

F-53

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

notional principal amount and maturity date. The Bank uses foreign currency derivative instruments to hedge its exposure to foreign currency risk. Certain hedging relationships are formally designated and qualify for hedge accounting as fair value or net investment hedges. Risk management derivatives comprise fair value hedges, net investments hedges and derivatives not formally designated as hedges as described below.

Fair value hedges consist of designated interest rate swaps and are used to minimise the Bank’s exposure to changes in the fair value of assets and liabilities due to movements in interest rates. The Bank previously entered into interest rate swaps to convert its fixed-rate long-term loans to floating-rate loans, and convert fixed-rate deposits to floating-rate deposits. During the year ended 31 December 2011, the Bank cancelled its interest rate swaps designated as fair value hedges of loans receivable and therefore discontinued hedge accounting for these financial instruments. The fair value attributable to the hedged loans are accounted for prospectively and are being amortised to net income over the remaining life of each individual loan, which could extend to year 2029, using the effective interest method.

Net investment hedges includes designated currency swaps and qualifying non-derivative instruments and are used to minimise the Bank’s exposure to variability in the foreign currency translation of net investments in foreign operations. The effective portion of changes in the fair value of the hedging instrument is recognised in AOCL consistent with the related translation gains and losses of the hedged net investment. For net investment hedges, all critical terms of the hedged item and the hedging instrument are matched at inception and on an ongoing basis to minimise the risk of hedge ineffectiveness.

For derivatives designated as net investment hedges, the Bank follows the method based on changes in spot exchange rates. Accordingly:

The change in the fair value of the derivative instrument that is reported in AOCL (i.e. the effective portion) is determined by the changes in spot exchange rates.
The change in the fair value of the derivative instrument attributable to changes in the difference between the forward rate and spot rate are excluded from the measure of the hedge ineffectiveness and that difference is reported directly in the consolidated statements of operations under foreign exchange revenue.

Amounts recorded in AOCL are reclassified to earnings only upon the sale or substantial liquidation of an investment in a foreign subsidiary.

For foreign-currency-denominated debt instruments that are designated as hedges of net investments in foreign operations, the translation gain or loss that is recorded in AOCL is based on the spot exchange rate between the reporting currency of the Bank and the functional currency of the respective subsidiary. See Note 23 for details on the amount recognised into AOCL during the current period from translation gain or loss.

Derivatives not formally designated as hedges are entered into to manage the interest rate risk of fixed rate deposits and foreign exchange risk of the Bank’s exposure. Changes in the fair value of derivative instruments not formally designated as hedges are recognised in foreign exchange income.

Client service derivatives

The Bank enters into foreign exchange contracts and interest rate caps primarily to meet the foreign exchange needs of its customers. Foreign exchange contracts are agreements to exchange specific amounts of currencies at a future date at a specified rate of exchange. Changes in the fair value of client services derivative instruments are recognised in foreign exchange income.

The following table shows the aggregate notional amounts of derivative contracts outstanding listed by type and respective gross positive or negative fair values and classified by those used for risk management (sub-classified as hedging and those that do not qualify for hedge accounting), client services and credit derivatives. Fair value of derivatives is recorded in the consolidated balance sheets in

F-54

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

other assets and other liabilities. Gross positive fair values are recorded in other assets and gross negative fair values are recorded in other liabilities, subject to netting when master netting agreements are in place.

31 December 2016
Derivative instrument
Number of
contracts
Notional
amounts
Gross
positive
fair value
Gross
negative
fair value
Net
fair value
Risk management derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net investment hedges
Currency swaps
 
1
 
 
77,670
 
 
15,744
 
 
 
 
15,744
 
Derivatives not formally designated as hedging instruments
Currency swaps
 
11
 
 
676,856
 
 
5,901
 
 
(3,013
)
 
2,888
 
Subtotal risk management derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
754,526
 
 
21,645
 
 
(3,013
)
 
18,632
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Client services derivatives
Spot and forward foreign exchange
 
106
 
 
2,039,141
 
 
15,410
 
 
(15,267
)
 
143
 
Total derivative instruments
 
 
 
 
 
2,793,667
 
 
37,055
 
 
(18,280
)
 
18,775
 
31 December 2015
Derivative instrument
Number of
contracts
Notional
amounts
Gross
positive
fair value
Gross
negative
fair value
Net
fair value
Risk management derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net investment hedges
Currency swaps
 
1
 
 
77,670
 
 
4,122
 
 
 
 
4,122
 
Derivatives not formally designated as hedging instruments
Currency swaps
 
4
 
 
77,881
 
 
273
 
 
(95
)
 
178
 
Subtotal risk management derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
155,551
 
 
4,395
 
 
(95
)
 
4,300
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Client services derivatives
Spot and forward foreign exchange
 
128
 
 
2,572,525
 
 
16,426
 
 
(15,961
)
 
465
 
Total derivative instruments
 
 
 
 
 
2,728,076
 
 
20,821
 
 
(16,056
)
 
4,765
 

In addition to the above, as at 31 December 2016 foreign denominated deposits of £34.5 million (31 December 2015: £29.5 million), were designated as a hedge of foreign exchange risk associated with the net investment in foreign operations.

We manage derivative exposure by monitoring the credit risk associated with each counterparty using counterparty specific credit risk limits, using master netting arrangements where appropriate and obtaining collateral. The Bank elected to offset in the consolidated balance sheets certain gross derivative assets and liabilities subject to netting agreements.

The Bank also elected not to offset certain derivative assets or liabilities and all collaterals received or paid that the Bank or the counterparties could legally offset in the event of default. In the tables below, these positions are deducted from the net fair value presented in the consolidated balance sheets in order to present the net exposures. The collateral values presented in the following table are limited to the related net derivative asset or liability balance and, accordingly, do not include excess collateral received or paid.

F-55

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

31 December 2016
Gross fair
value
recognised
Less: offset
applied
under master
netting
agreements
Net fair value
presented in the
consolidated
balance sheets
Less: positions not offset in the
consolidated balance sheets
Gross fair value
of derivatives
Cash collateral
received / paid
Net
exposures
Derivative assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Spot and forward foreign exchange and currency swaps
 
37,055
 
 
(6,959
)
 
30,096
 
 
(6,811
)
 
(8,292
)
 
14,993
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Spot and forward foreign exchange and currency swaps
 
18,280
 
 
(6,959
)
 
11,321
 
 
(6,811
)
 
 
 
4,510
 
Net positive fair value
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
18,775
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
31 December 2015
Gross fair
value
recognised
Less: offset
applied
under master
netting
agreements
Net fair value
presented in the
consolidated
balance sheets
Less: positions not offset in the
consolidated balance sheets
Gross fair value
of derivatives
Cash collateral
received / paid
Net
exposures
Derivative assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Spot and forward foreign exchange and currency swaps
 
20,821
 
 
(7,127
)
 
13,694
 
 
(78
)
 
(269
)
 
13,347
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Spot and forward foreign exchange and currency swaps
 
16,056
 
 
(7,127
)
 
8,929
 
 
(78
)
 
(185
)
 
8,666
 
Net positive fair value
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4,765
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

The following tables shows the location and amount of gains (losses) recorded in either the consolidated statements of operations or consolidated statements of comprehensive income on derivative instruments outstanding. During 2016, management revised the following disclosures to segregate the gains and losses to the specific type of derivative.

 
 
Year ended
Derivative instrument
Consolidated statements of operations line item
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Spot and forward foreign exchange
Foreign exchange revenue
 
(322
)
 
110
 
 
(724
)
Currency swaps, not designated as hedge
Foreign exchange revenue
 
2,710
 
 
1,643
 
 
7,916
 
Currency swaps (net investment hedge)
Foreign exchange revenue
 
(1,091
)
 
2,331
 
 
742
 
Total net gains (losses) recognised in net income
 
1,297
 
 
4,084
 
 
7,934
 
Derivative instrument
Consolidated statements of comprehensive income line item
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Currency swaps (net investment hedge)
Net change in unrealised gains and losses on translation of net investment in foreign operations
 
12,713
 
 
4,254
 
 
6,799
 
Total net gains recognised in comprehensive income
 
12,713
 
 
4,254
 
 
6,799
 

Note 17: Fair value measurements

The following table presents the financial assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value on a recurring basis. Management classifies these items based on the type of inputs used in their respective fair value determination as described in Note 2.

Management reviews the price of each security monthly, comparing market values to expectations and to the prior month’s price. Management’s expectations are based upon knowledge of prevailing

F-56

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

market conditions and developments relating to specific issuers and/or asset classes held in the investment portfolio. Where there are unusual or significant price movements, or where a certain asset class has performed out-of-line with expectations, the matter is reviewed by the Group Asset and Liability Committee.

Financial instruments in Level 1 include actively traded redeemable mutual funds.

Financial instruments in Level 2 include corporate bonds, mortgage-backed securities and other asset-backed securities, forward foreign exchange contracts and mutual funds not actively traded.

Financial instruments in Level 3 include asset-backed securities for which the market is relatively illiquid and for which information about actual trading prices is not readily available.

There were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 or Level 2 and Level 3 during the year ended 31 December 2016 and the year ended 31 December 2015.

 
31 December 2016
Fair value
Total carrying
amount /
fair value
31 December 2015
Fair value
Total carrying
amount /
fair value
 
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Items that are recognised at fair value on a recurring basis:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading investments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
279,343
 
 
 
 
279,343
 
Non-US governments debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7,489
 
 
 
 
7,489
 
Asset-backed securities - Student loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
28,285
 
 
 
 
28,285
 
Mutual funds
 
6,091
 
 
222
 
 
 
 
6,313
 
 
5,903
 
 
279
 
 
 
 
6,182
 
Total trading
 
6,091
 
 
222
 
 
 
 
6,313
 
 
5,903
 
 
315,396
 
 
 
 
321,299
 
Available-for-sale investments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
US government and federal agencies
 
 
 
2,430,402
 
 
 
 
2,430,402
 
 
 
 
1,404,499
 
 
 
 
1,404,499
 
Non-US governments debt securities
 
 
 
27,020
 
 
 
 
27,020
 
 
 
 
29,575
 
 
 
 
29,575
 
Corporate debt securities
 
 
 
514,475
 
 
 
 
514,475
 
 
 
 
506,144
 
 
 
 
506,144
 
Asset-backed securities - Student loans
 
 
 
 
 
12,493
 
 
12,493
 
 
 
 
 
 
12,161
 
 
12,161
 
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
 
 
 
150,546
 
 
 
 
150,546
 
 
 
 
148,726
 
 
 
 
148,726
 
Residential mortgage-backed securities
 
 
 
197,802
 
 
 
 
197,802
 
 
 
 
100,244
 
 
 
 
100,244
 
Total available-for-sale
 
 
 
3,320,245
 
 
12,493
 
 
3,332,738
 
 
 
 
2,189,188
 
 
12,161
 
 
2,201,349
 
Other assets - Derivatives
 
 
 
30,096
 
 
 
 
30,096
 
 
 
 
13,694
 
 
 
 
13,694
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other liabilities - Derivatives
 
 
 
11,321
 
 
 
 
11,321
 
 
 
 
8,929
 
 
 
 
8,929
 

Level 3 Reconciliation

The Level 3 Asset-backed securities - Student loans is a federal family education loan programme guaranteed student loan security and is valued using a non-binding broker quote. The fair value provided by the broker is based on the last trading price of similar securities but as the market for the security is illiquid, a Level 2 classification is not supported.

Significant increases (decreases) in any of the preceding inputs in isolation could result in a significantly different fair value measurement. Generally a change in assumption used for the probability of defaults is accompanied by a directionally similar change in the assumption used for the loss severity.

F-57

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
 
Available-
for-sale
investments
Available-
for-sale
investments
Available-
for-sale
investments
Carrying amount at beginning of year
 
12,161
 
 
12,226
 
 
45,304
 
Proceeds from sales, paydowns and maturities
 
 
 
 
 
(36,439
)
Accretion recognised in net income
 
 
 
 
 
915
 
Realised and unrealised gains (losses) recognised in other comprehensive income
 
332
 
 
(65
)
 
(6,286
)
Realised and unrealised gains recognised in net income
 
 
 
 
 
8,732
 
Carrying amount at end of year
 
12,493
 
 
12,161
 
 
12,226
 

Items Other Than Those Recognised at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis:

 
 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
Level
Carrying
amount
Fair
value
Appreciation /
(depreciation)
Carrying
amount
Fair
value
Appreciation /
(depreciation)
Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks
Level 1
 
2,101,651
 
 
2,101,651
 
 
 
 
2,288,890
 
 
2,288,890
 
 
 
Securities purchased under agreement to resell
Level 2
 
148,813
 
 
148,813
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Short-term investments
Level 1
 
519,755
 
 
519,755
 
 
 
 
409,482
 
 
409,482
 
 
 
Investments held-to-maturity
Level 2
 
1,061,103
 
 
1,046,828
 
 
(14,275
)
 
701,282
 
 
701,495
 
 
213
 
Loans, net of allowance for credit losses
Level 2
 
3,570,478
 
 
3,566,812
 
 
(3,666
)
 
4,000,155
 
 
3,996,443
 
 
(3,712
)
Other real estate owned(1)
Level 2
 
14,199
 
 
14,199
 
 
 
 
11,206
 
 
11,206
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customer deposits
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand deposits
Level 2
 
8,193,213
 
 
8,193,213
 
 
 
 
7,654,643
 
 
7,654,643
 
 
 
Term deposits
Level 2
 
1,816,640
 
 
1,817,564
 
 
(924
)
 
1,513,025
 
 
1,514,126
 
 
(1,101
)
Deposits from banks
Level 2
 
23,796
 
 
23,796
 
 
 
 
14,478
 
 
14,478
 
 
 
Long-term debt
Level 2
 
117,000
 
 
117,683
 
 
(683
)
 
117,000
 
 
116,606
 
 
394
 
(1)The current carrying value of OREO is adjusted to fair value only when there is devaluation below carrying value.

Note 18: Interest rate risk

The following tables set out the assets, liabilities and shareholders’ equity and off-balance sheet instruments on the date of the earlier of contractual maturity, expected maturity or repricing date. Use of these tables to derive information about the Bank’s interest rate risk position is limited by the fact that customers may choose to terminate their financial instruments at a date earlier than the contractual maturity or repricing date. Examples of this include fixed-rate mortgages, which are shown at contractual maturity but which may pre-pay earlier, and certain term deposits, which are shown at contractual maturity but which may be withdrawn before their contractual maturity subject to prepayment penalties. Investments are shown based on remaining contractual maturities. The remaining contractual principal maturities for mortgage-backed securities (primarily US government agencies) do not consider prepayments. Remaining expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to prepay obligations before the underlying mortgages mature.

F-58

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

31 December 2016
Earlier of contractual maturity or repricing date
(in $ millions)
Within 3
months
3 to 6
months
6 to 12
months
1 to 5
years
After
5 years
Non-interest
bearing funds
Total
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks
 
1,991
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
111
 
 
2,102
 
Securities purchased under agreement to resell
 
149
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
149
 
Short-term investments
 
135
 
 
385
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
520
 
Investments
 
1,343
 
 
15
 
 
81
 
 
704
 
 
2,251
 
 
6
 
 
4,400
 
Loans
 
3,339
 
 
53
 
 
57
 
 
81
 
 
38
 
 
2
 
 
3,570
 
Other assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
363
 
 
363
 
Total assets
 
6,957
 
 
453
 
 
138
 
 
785
 
 
2,289
 
 
482
 
 
11,104
 
Liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Shareholders’ equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
711
 
 
711
 
Demand deposits
 
5,828
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2,385
 
 
8,213
 
Term deposits
 
1,492
 
 
166
 
 
92
 
 
71
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,821
 
Other liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
242
 
 
242
 
Long-term debt
 
92
 
 
 
 
 
 
25
 
 
 
 
 
 
117
 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 
7,412
 
 
166
 
 
92
 
 
96
 
 
 
 
3,338
 
 
11,104
 
Interest rate sensitivity gap
 
(455
)
 
287
 
 
46
 
 
689
 
 
2,289
 
 
(2,856
)
 
 
Cumulative interest rate sensitivity gap
 
(455
)
 
(168
)
 
(122
)
 
567
 
 
2,856
 
 
 
 
 
31 December 2015
Earlier of contractual maturity or repricing date
(in $ millions)
Within 3
months
3 to 6
months
6 to 12
months
1 to 5
years
After
5 years
Non-interest
bearing funds
Total
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash due from banks
 
2,178
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
111
 
 
2,289
 
Short-term investments
 
117
 
 
291
 
 
1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
409
 
Investments
 
871
 
 
79
 
 
19
 
 
620
 
 
1,629
 
 
6
 
 
3,224
 
Loans
 
3,735
 
 
84
 
 
53
 
 
67
 
 
47
 
 
14
 
 
4,000
 
Other assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
354
 
 
354
 
Total assets
 
6,901
 
 
454
 
 
73
 
 
687
 
 
1,676
 
 
485
 
 
10,276
 
Liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Shareholders’ equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
750
 
 
750
 
Demand deposits
 
5,783
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,882
 
 
7,665
 
Term deposits
 
989
 
 
296
 
 
153
 
 
79
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,517
 
Other liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
227
 
 
227
 
Long-term debt
 
92
 
 
 
 
 
 
25
 
 
 
 
 
 
117
 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 
6,864
 
 
296
 
 
153
 
 
104
 
 
 
 
2,859
 
 
10,276
 
Interest rate sensitivity gap
 
37
 
 
158
 
 
(80
)
 
583
 
 
1,676
 
 
(2,374
)
 
 
Cumulative interest rate sensitivity gap
 
37
 
 
195
 
 
115
 
 
698
 
 
2,374
 
 
 
 
 

Note 19: Long-term debt

On 28 May 2003, the Bank issued US $125 million of Subordinated Lower Tier II capital notes. The notes were issued at par and in two tranches, namely US $78 million in Series A notes due 2013 and US $47 million in Series B notes due 2018. The issuance was by way of private placement with US institutional investors. The notes are listed on the Bermuda Stock Exchange (“BSX”) in the specialist debt securities category. Part of the proceeds of the issue were used to repay the entire amount of the US $75 million outstanding subordinated notes redeemed in July 2003. The notes issued under Series A paid a fixed coupon of 3.94% until 27 May 2008 when it was redeemed in whole by the Bank. The Series B notes paid a fixed coupon of 5.15% until 27 May 2013 when they became redeemable in whole at the Bank’s option. The Series B notes were priced at a spread of 1.35% over the 10-year US Treasury yield.

F-59

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

On 27 June 2005, the Bank issued US $150 million of Subordinated Lower Tier II capital notes. The notes were issued at par in two tranches, namely US $90 million in Series A notes due 2015 and US $60 million in Series B notes due 2020. The issuance was by way of private placement with US institutional investors. The notes are listed on the BSX in the specialist debt securities category. The notes issued under Series A paid a fixed coupon of 4.81% until 2 July 2010 after which the coupon rate became floating and the principal became redeemable in whole at the Bank’s option. The Series B notes pay a fixed coupon of 5.11% until 2 July 2015 when they also become redeemable in whole at the Bank’s option. The Series A notes were priced at a spread of 1.00% over the five-year US Treasury yield and the Series B notes were priced at a spread of 1.10% over the 10-year US Treasury yield. During September 2011, the Bank repurchased a portion of the outstanding 5.11% 2005 Series B Subordinated notes (“the Note”). The face value of the portion of the Note repurchased was $15 million and the purchase price paid for the repurchase was $13.875 million, which realised a gain of $1.125 million. During January 2014, the Bank fully redeemed the 2005 issuance Series A subordinated debt for its nominal value of $90 million.

On 27 May 2008, the Bank issued US $78 million of Subordinated Lower Tier II capital notes. The notes were issued at par and in two tranches, namely US $53 million in Series A notes due 2018 and US $25 million in Series B notes due 2023. The issuance was by way of private placement with US institutional investors. The notes are listed on the BSX in the specialist debt securities category. The proceeds of the issue were used to repay the entire amount of the US $78 million outstanding subordinated notes redeemed in May 2008. The notes issued under Series A paid a fixed coupon of 7.59% until 27 May 2013 when they became redeemable in whole at the option of the Bank. In May 2013, the Bank exercised its option to redeem the Series A note outstanding at face value. The Series B notes pay a fixed coupon of 8.44% until 27 May 2018 when they also become redeemable in whole at the Bank’s option. The Series B notes were priced at a spread of 4.51% over the 10-year US Treasury yield.

No interest was capitalised during the years ended 31 December 2016, 2015 and 2014.

In the event the Bank would be in a position to redeem long-term debt, priority would go the redemption of the higher interest-bearing Series, subject to availability relative to the earliest date the Series is redeemable at the Bank’s option.

The following table presents the contractual maturity and interest payments for long-term debt issued by the Bank as at 31 December 2016. The interest payments are calculated until contractual maturity using the current LIBOR rates.

Long-term debt
Earliest date
redeemable at
the Bank’s
option
Contractual
maturity date
Interest rate
until date
redeemable
Interest rate from
earliest date
redeemable
to contractual
maturity
Principal
Outstanding
Interest payments until
contractual maturity
Within
1 year
1 to 5
years
After
5 years
Bermuda
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2003 issuance - Series B
27 May 2013
27 May 2018
 
5.15
%
3 months US$
LIBOR + 2.000%
 
47,000
 
 
1,354
 
 
672
 
 
 
2005 issuance - Series B
2 July 2015
2 July 2020
 
5.11
%
3 months US$
LIBOR + 1.695%
 
45,000
 
 
1,158
 
 
3,184
 
 
 
2008 issuance - Series B
27 May 2018
27 May 2023
 
8.44
%
3 months US$
LIBOR + 4.929%
 
25,000
 
 
2,110
 
 
6,185
 
 
2,188
 
Total
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
117,000
 
 
4,622
 
 
10,041
 
 
2,188
 

Note 20: Earnings per share

Earnings per share have been calculated using the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the year after deduction of the shares held as treasury stock. The dilutive effect of share-based compensation plans was calculated using the treasury stock method, whereby the proceeds received from the exercise of share-based awards are assumed to be used to repurchase outstanding shares, using the average market price of the Bank’s shares for the year. Numbers of shares are expressed in thousands.

F-60

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Prior to their conversion into common shares on 31 March 2015, outstanding contingent value convertible preference (“CVCP”) shares were classified as participating securities as they were entitled to dividends declared to common shareholders on a 1:1 basis and were therefore included in the basic earnings per share calculation.

During the year ended 31 December 2016, options to purchase an average of 2.6 million (2015: 2.9 million, 2014: 3.1 million ) common shares were outstanding. During the year ended 31 December 2016, the average number of outstanding awards of unvested common shares was 0.8 million (2015: 0.9 million, 2014: 1.0 million). Only awards for which the sum of 1) the expense that will be recognised in the future (i.e. the unrecognised expense) and 2) its exercise price, if any, was lower than the average market price of the Bank’s common shares were considered dilutive and, therefore, included in the computation of diluted earnings per share. An award’s unrecognised expense is also considered to be the proceeds the employees would need to pay to purchase accelerated vesting of the awards. For purposes of calculating dilution, such proceeds are assumed to be used by the Bank to buy back common shares at the average market price. The weighted-average number of outstanding awards, net of the assumed weighted-average number of common shares bought back, is included in the number of diluted participating shares.

A warrant, outstanding until the Bank repurchased it in December 2016, to purchase 0.43 million (31 December 2015 and 2014: 0.43 million) common shares issued to the Government of Bermuda in exchange for the Government’s guarantee of the preference shares, with an exercise price per share of $34.72 (31 December 2015: $34.72, 31 December 2014: $34.89) was not included in the computation of earnings per share for the years ended 31 December 2016, 2015 and 2014 because the exercise price was greater than the average market price of the Bank‘s common shares.

 
Year Ended
 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
31 December 2014
 
Net income
 
115,942
 
 
77,739
 
 
 
 
 
108,159
 
 
 
 
Less: Preference dividends declared and guarantee fee
 
(15,655
)
 
(16,455
)
 
 
 
 
(16,546
)
 
 
 
Less: Premium on preference share buyback and redemption
 
(41,913
)
 
(28
)
 
 
 
 
(96
)
 
 
 
Net income attributable to participating shares
 
58,374
 
 
61,256
 
 
 
 
 
91,517
 
 
 
 
Less: Dividend paid on common shares
 
(19,346
)
 
(24,708
)
 
 
 
 
(27,088
)
 
 
 
Less: Dividend paid on contingent value convertible preference shares
 
 
 
(138
)
 
 
 
 
(352
)
 
 
 
Undistributed earnings attributable for participating shares
 
39,028
 
 
36,410
 
 
 
 
 
64,077
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic Earnings Per Share
Common shares
Common shares
CVCP
Common shares
CVCP
Weighted average number of shares issued
 
49,128
 
 
49,842
 
 
159
 
 
54,994
 
 
699
 
Weighted average number of common shares held as treasury stock
 
(506
)
 
(1,079
)
 
N/A
 
 
(934
)
 
N/A
 
Weighted average number of participating shares (in thousands)
 
48,622
 
 
48,763
 
 
159
 
 
54,060
 
 
699
 
Allocation of undistributed earnings - Basic
 
39,028
 
 
36,292
 
 
118
 
 
63,259
 
 
818
 
Distributed earnings per share
 
0.40
 
 
0.50
 
 
0.20
 
 
0.50
 
 
0.50
 
Undistributed earnings per share
 
0.80
 
 
0.75
 
 
0.19
 
 
1.17
 
 
1.17
 
Basic Earnings Per Share
 
1.20
 
 
1.25
 
 
0.39
 
 
1.67
 
 
1.67
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Diluted Earnings Per Share
Common shares
Common shares
CVCP
Common shares
CVCP
Adjusted weighted average number of participating shares outstanding
 
48,622
 
 
48,763
 
 
159
 
 
54,060
 
 
699
 
Net dilution impact related to options to purchase common shares
 
607
 
 
472
 
 
N/A
 
 
393
 
 
N/A
 
Net dilution impact related to awards of unvested common shares
 
382
 
 
609
 
 
N/A
 
 
496
 
 
N/A
 

F-61

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
Year Ended
 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
 
31 December 2014
 
Weighted average number of diluted participating shares (in thousands)
 
49,611
 
 
49,844
 
 
159
 
 
54,949
 
 
699
 
Allocation of undistributed earnings - Diluted
 
39,028
 
 
36,294
 
 
116
 
 
63,272
 
 
805
 
Distributed earnings per share
 
0.40
 
 
0.50
 
 
0.20
 
 
0.50
 
 
0.50
 
Undistributed earnings per share
 
0.78
 
 
0.73
 
 
0.19
 
 
1.15
 
 
1.15
 
Diluted Earnings Per Share
 
1.18
 
 
1.23
 
 
0.39
 
 
1.65
 
 
1.65
 

Note 21: Share-based payments

The common shares transferred to employees under all share-based payments are either taken from the Bank’s common treasury shares or from newly issued shares. All share-based payments are settled by the ultimate parent company, which pursuant to Bermuda law is not taxed on income. There are no income tax benefits in relation to the issue of such shares as a form of compensation.

In conjunction with the 2010 capital raise, the Board of Directors approved the 2010 Omnibus Plan (the “2010 Plan”). Under the 2010 Plan, 5% of the Bank’s fully diluted common shares, equal to approximately 2.95 million shares, were initially available for grant to certain officers in the form of stock options or unvested shares awards. Both types of awards are detailed below. In 2012 and 2016, the Board of Directors approved an increase to the equivalent number of shares allowed to be granted under the 2010 Plan to respectively 5.0 million and 7.5 million shares.

Stock Option Awards

1997 Stock Option Plan

Prior to the capital raise on 2 March 2010, the Bank granted stock options to employees and Directors of the Bank that entitle the holder to purchase one common share at a subscription price equal to the market price on the effective date of the grant. Generally, the options granted vest 25 percent at the end of each year for four years, however as a result of the 2010 capital raise, the options granted under the Bank’s 1997 Stock Option Plan to employees became fully vested and options awarded to certain executives were surrendered.

2010 Plan

Under the 2010 Plan, options are awarded to Bank employees and executive management, based on predetermined vesting conditions that entitle the holder to purchase one common share at a subscription price usually equal to the price of the most recently traded common share when granted and have a term of 10 years. The subscription price is reduced for all special dividends declared by the Bank. Stock option awards granted under the 2010 Plan vest based on two specific types of vesting conditions i.e., time and performance conditions, as detailed below:

Time vesting condition

50% of each option award is granted in the form of time vested options and vests 25% on each of the second, third, fourth and fifth anniversaries of the effective grant date.

In addition to the time vesting conditions noted above, the options will generally vest immediately:

by reason of the employee’s death or disability,
upon termination, by the Bank, of the holder’s employment, unless if in relation with the holder’s misconduct, or
in limited circumstances and specifically approved by the Board, as stipulated in the holder’s employment contract.

F-62

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

In the event of the employee’s resignation, any unvested portion of the awards shall generally be forfeited and any vested portion of the options shall generally remain exercisable during the 90-day period following the termination date or, if earlier, until the expiration date, and any vested portion of the options not exercised as of the expiration of such period shall be forfeited without any consideration therefore.

Performance vesting condition

50% of each option award is granted in the form of performance options and vests (partially or fully) on a “valuation event” date (date any of the 2 March 2010 new investors transfers at least 5% of the total number of common shares or the date that there is a change in control and any of the new investors realises a predetermined multiple of invested capital (“MOIC”)). On 21 September 2016, it was determined that a valuation event occurred during which a new investor realised a MOIC of more than 200% of the original invested capital of $12.09 per share and accordingly, all outstanding unvested performance options vested. Accordingly, as at 31 December 2016 the grant date fair value not yet recognised in expenses of outstanding performance options is nil (31 December 2015: $8.7 million).

Weighted average fair value of stock options granted
Time vested
options
Performance
vested options
Year ended 31 December 2012 (most recent year during which options were granted)
$
4.20
 
$
4.40
 
Year ended 31 December 2011
$
4.10
 
$
4.30
 

The weighted average fair value of stock options granted in the years ended 31 December 2012 and 2011 was calculated using the Black-Scholes-Merton option-pricing model for the time vested options and a lattice-based binomial option-pricing model for the performance options.

Changes in Outstanding Stock Options

 
Number of shares transferable upon
exercise (thousands)
Weighted average
exercise price ($)
Weighted average
remaining life (years)
Aggregate
intrinsic value
($ thousands)
Year ended
31 December 2016
1997 Stock
Option Plan
2010 Stock
Option Plan
Total
1997 Stock
Option Plan
2010 Stock
Option Plan
1997 Stock
Option Plan
2010 Stock
Option Plan
Outstanding at beginning of year
 
218
 
 
2,608
 
 
2,826
 
 
135.19
 
 
11.60
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exercised
 
 
 
(625
)
 
(625
)
 
 
 
11.68
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
8,938
 
Forfeitures and cancellations
 
(102
)
 
(5
)
 
(107
)
 
138.79
 
 
11.50
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Resignations, retirements, redundancies
 
 
 
(28
)
 
(28
)
 
 
 
11.50
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Outstanding at end of year
 
116
 
 
1,950
 
 
2,066
 
 
132.13
 
 
11.57
 
 
1.18
 
 
3.42
 
 
38,489
 
Vested and exercisable at end of year
 
116
 
 
1,950
 
 
2,066
 
 
132.13
 
 
11.57
 
 
1.18
 
 
3.42
 
 
 
 
 
Number of shares transferable upon
exercise (thousands)
Weighted average
exercise price ($)
Weighted average
remaining life (years)
Aggregate
intrinsic value
($ thousands)
Year ended
31 December 2015
1997 Stock
Option Plan
2010 Stock
Option Plan
Total
1997 Stock
Option Plan
2010 Stock
Option Plan
1997 Stock
Option Plan
2010 Stock
Option Plan
Outstanding at beginning of year
 
352
 
 
2,678
 
 
3,030
 
 
130.70
 
 
11.70
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exercised
 
 
 
(55
)
 
(55
)
 
 
 
11.50
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
393
 
Forfeitures and cancellations
 
(134
)
 
(2
)
 
(136
)
 
123.30
 
 
11.50
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Resignations, retirements, redundancies
 
 
 
(13
)
 
(13
)
 
 
 
11.50
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Outstanding at end of year
 
218
 
 
2,608
 
 
2,826
 
 
135.19
 
 
11.60
 
 
1.78
 
 
4.67
 
 
20,594
 
Vested and exercisable at end of year
 
218
 
 
1,242
 
 
1,460
 
 
135.19
 
 
11.60
 
 
1.78
 
 
4.94
 
 
 
 

F-63

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
Number of shares transferable upon
exercise (thousands)
Weighted average
exercise price ($)
Weighted average
remaining life (years)
Aggregate
intrinsic value
($ thousands)
Year ended
31 December 2014
1997 Stock
Option Plan
2010 Stock
Option Plan
Total
1997 Stock
Option Plan
2010 Stock
Option Plan
1997 Stock
Option Plan
2010 Stock
Option Plan
Outstanding at beginning of year
 
399
 
 
2,781
 
 
3,180
 
 
128.30
 
 
11.70
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exercised
 
 
 
(103
)
 
(103
)
 
 
 
11.60
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
874
 
Forfeitures and cancellations
 
(44
)
 
 
 
(44
)
 
108.60
 
 
11.60
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Expiration at end of plan life
 
(3
)
 
 
 
(3
)
 
137.60
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Outstanding at end of year
 
352
 
 
2,678
 
 
3,030
 
 
130.70
 
 
11.70
 
 
2.38
 
 
5.66
 
 
22,233
 
Vested and exercisable at end of year
 
352
 
 
868
 
 
1,220
 
 
130.70
 
 
11.70
 
 
2.38
 
 
5.65
 
 
 
 

Share Based Plans

Recipients of unvested share awards are entitled to the related common shares at no cost, at the time the award vests. Recipients of unvested shares may be entitled to receive additional unvested shares having a value equal to the cash dividends that would have been paid had the unvested shares been issued and vested. Such additional unvested shares granted as dividend equivalents are subject to the same vesting schedule and conditions as the underlying unvested shares.

Unvested shares subject only to the time vesting condition generally vest upon retirement, death, disability or upon termination, by the Bank, of the holder’s employment unless if in connection with the holder’s misconduct. Unvested shares subject to both time vesting and performance vesting conditions remain outstanding and unvested upon retirement and will vest only if the performance conditions are met. Unvested shares can also vest in limited circumstances and if specifically approved by the Board, as stipulated in the holder’s employment contract. In all other circumstances, unvested shares are generally forfeited when employment ends.

Employee Deferred Incentive Plan (“EDIP”)

Under the Bank’s EDIP Plan, shares were awarded to Bank employees and executive management based on the time vesting condition, which states that the shares will vest equally over a three-year period from the effective grant date.

Executive Long-Term Incentive Share Plan (“ELTIP”) - Years 2012 and 2011

Under the Bank’s 2012 and 2011 ELTIP, shares were awarded to Bank employees and executive management, based on predetermined vesting conditions. Two types of vesting conditions upon which the shares were awarded comprise the ELTIP: 1) 50% of each share award was granted in the form of time vested shares, generally vesting equally over a three-year period from the effective grant date; and 2) 50% of each share award was granted in the form of performance shares, generally vesting upon the achievement of certain performance targets in the three-year period from the effective grant date.

Executive Long-Term Incentive Share Plan (“ELTIP”) - Years 2016, 2015, 2014 and 2013

The 2016 ELTIP was approved on 18 February 2016. Under the Bank’s 2016, 2015, 2014 and 2013 ELTIP, performance shares were awarded to executive management. These shares will generally vest upon the achievement of certain performance targets in the three-year period from the effective grant date.

F-64

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Changes in Outstanding ELTIP and EDIP awards (in thousands of shares transferable upon vesting)

 
Year ended
 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
31 December 2014
 
EDIP
ELTIP
EDIP
ELTIP
EDIP
ELTIP
Outstanding at beginning of year
 
226
 
 
606
 
 
265
 
 
706
 
 
218
 
 
644
 
Granted
 
115
 
 
360
 
 
175
 
 
253
 
 
150
 
 
255
 
Vested (fair value in 2016: $7.0 million, 2015: $10.6 million, 2014: $5.5 million)
 
(118
)
 
(302
)
 
(207
)
 
(322
)
 
(103
)
 
(185
)
Resignations, retirements, redundancies
 
(8
)
 
(24
)
 
(7
)
 
(31
)
 
 
 
(8
)
Outstanding at end of year
 
215
 
 
640
 
 
226
 
 
606
 
 
265
 
 
706
 

Share-based Compensation Cost Recognised in Net Income

 
Year ended
 
31 December 2016
31 December 2015
31 December 2014
 
Stock option
plans
EDIP and
ELTIP
Total
Stock option
plans
EDIP and
ELTIP
Total
Stock option
plans
EDIP and
ELTIP
Total
Cost recognised in net income
 
8,697
 
 
5,375
 
 
14,072
 
 
521
 
 
7,182
 
 
7,703
 
 
1,915
 
 
6,954
 
 
8,869
 
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
Unrecognised Share-based Compensation Cost
 
 
 
 
 
 
2010 Stock Option Plan
 
 
 
 
 
 
Time vesting options
 
 
 
8
 
Performance vesting options
 
 
 
8,689
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
EDIP
 
2,040
 
 
2,098
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ELTIP
 
 
 
 
 
 
Time vesting shares
 
2,988
 
 
21
 
Performance vesting shares
 
3,802
 
 
3,432
 
Total unrecognised expense
 
8,830
 
 
14,248
 

Note 22: Share buy-back plans

The Bank initially introduced two share buy-back programmes on 1 May 2012 as a means to improve shareholder liquidity and facilitate growth in share value. Each programme was approved by the Board of Directors for a period of 12 months, in accordance with the regulations of the BSX. The BSX must be advised monthly of shares purchased pursuant to each programme.

From time to time the Bank’s associates, insiders and insiders’ associates as defined by the BSX regulations may sell shares which may result in such shares being repurchased pursuant to each programme, provided no more than any such person’s pro-rata share of the listed securities is repurchased. Pursuant to the BSX regulations, all repurchases made by any issuer pursuant to a securities repurchase programme must be made: (1) in the open market and not by private agreement; and (2) for a price not higher than the last independent trade for a round lot of the relevant class of securities. See Note 24, in which certain large one-time share buy-back transactions are described.

Common Share Buy-Back Programme

Effective 1 April 2014, the Board approved, the 2014 common share buy-back programme authorising the purchase for treasury of up to 1.5 million common shares.

F-65

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

On 26 February 2015, the Board approved, with effect from 1 April 2015, the 2015 common share buy-back programme, authorising the purchase for treasury of up to 0.8 million common shares.

On 19 February 2016, the Board approved, with effect from 1 April 2016, the 2016 common share buy-back programme, authorising the purchase for treasury of up to 0.8 million common shares.

 
Year ended 31 December
 
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
Total
Common share buy-backs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquired number of shares (to the nearest 1)
 
97,053
 
 
250,371
 
 
856,734
 
 
403,848
 
 
726,005
 
 
2,334,011
 
Average cost per common share
 
16.36
 
 
19.42
 
 
19.86
 
 
13.89
 
 
12.40
 
 
16.31
 
Total cost (in US dollars)
 
1,588,189
 
 
4,862,248
 
 
17,018,412
 
 
5,610,907
 
 
8,999,061
 
 
38,078,817
 

Preference Share Buy-Back Programme

On 28 April 2014, the Board approved the 2014 preference share buy-back programme, authorising the purchase for cancellation of up to 26,000 preference shares.

On 26 February 2015, the Board approved, with effect from 5 May 2015, the 2015 preference share buy-back programme, authorising the purchase for cancellation of up to 5,000 preference shares.

 
Year ended 31 December
 
2016
2015
2014
2013
2012
Total
Preference share buy-backs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquired number of shares (to the nearest 1)
 
     —
 
 
183
 
 
560
 
 
11,972
 
 
4,422
 
 
17,137
 
Average cost per preference share
 
 
 
1,151.55
 
 
1,172.26
 
 
1,230.26
 
 
1,218.40
 
 
1,224.46
 
Total cost (in US dollars)
 
 
 
210,734
 
 
656,465
 
 
14,728,624
 
 
5,387,777
 
 
20,983,600
 

Note 23: Accumulated other comprehensive loss

 
Unrealised (losses)
on translation of
net investment in
foreign
operations
HTM
investments
Unrealised
gains (losses)
on AFS
investments
Employee benefit plans
 
31 December 2016
Pension
Post-retirement
healthcare
Subtotal -
employee
benefits plans
Total AOCL
Balance at beginning of year
 
(13,645
)
 
(2,350
)
 
(57
)
 
(46,331
)
 
(28,114
)
 
(74,445
)
 
(90,497
)
Transfer of AFS investments to HTM investments
 
 
 
1,442
 
 
(1,442
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of taxes
 
(6,507
)
 
(71
)
 
(21,181
)
 
(16,901
)
 
(9,523
)
 
(26,424
)
 
(54,183
)
Balance at end of year
 
(20,152
)
 
(979
)
 
(22,680
)
 
(63,232
)
 
(37,637
)
 
(100,869
)
 
(144,680
)
 
Unrealised (losses)
on translation of
net investment in
foreign
operations
HTM
investments
Unrealised
gains (losses)
on AFS
investments
Employee benefit plans
 
31 December 2015
Pension
Post-retirement
healthcare
Subtotal -
employee
benefits plans
Total AOCL
Balance at beginning of year
 
(10,506
)
 
 
 
9,021
 
 
(53,169
)
 
(22,866
)
 
(76,035
)
 
(77,520
)
Transfer of AFS investments to HTM investments
 
 
 
(2,715
)
 
2,715
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of taxes
 
(3,139
)
 
365
 
 
(11,793
)
 
6,838
 
 
(5,248
)
 
1,590
 
 
(12,977
)
Balance at end of year
 
(13,645
)
 
(2,350
)
 
(57
)
 
(46,331
)
 
(28,114
)
 
(74,445
)
 
(90,497
)

F-66

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
Unrealised (losses)
on translation of
net investment in
foreign
operations
HTM
investments
Unrealised
gains (losses)
on AFS
investments
Employee benefit plans
 
31 December 2014
Pension
Post-retirement
healthcare
Subtotal -
employee
benefits plans
Total AOCL
Balance at beginning of year
 
(7,632
)
 
 
 
(31,064
)
 
(35,616
)
 
6,724
 
 
(28,892
)
 
(67,588
)
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of taxes
 
(2,874
)
 
 
 
40,085
 
 
(17,553
)
 
(29,590
)
 
(47,143
)
 
(9,932
)
Balance at end of year
 
(10,506
)
 
 
 
9,021
 
 
(53,169
)
 
(22,866
)
 
(76,035
)
 
(77,520
)

Net Change of AOCL Components

 
 
Year ended
 
Line item in the consolidated
statements of operations, if any
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Net unrealised gains (losses) on translation of net investment in foreign operations adjustments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Foreign currency translation adjustments
N/A
 
(25,691
)
 
(9,723
)
 
(10,574
)
Gains (loss) on net investment hedge
N/A
 
19,184
 
 
6,584
 
 
7,700
 
Net change
 
 
(6,507
)
 
(3,139
)
 
(2,874
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Held-to-maturity investment adjustments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net unamortised gains (losses) transferred from AFS
N/A
 
1,442
 
 
(2,715
)
 
 
Amortisation of net gains (losses) to net income
Interest income on investments
 
(71
)
 
378
 
 
 
Foreign currency translation adjustments of related balances
N/A
 
 
 
(13
)
 
 
Net change
 
 
1,371
 
 
(2,350
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale investment adjustments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross unrealised gains (losses)
N/A
 
(19,635
)
 
(16,337
)
 
48,703
 
Net unrealised (gains) losses transferred to HTM
N/A
 
(1,442
)
 
2,715
 
 
 
Transfer of realised (gains) losses to net income
Net realised gains (losses) on AFS investments
 
(1,546
)
 
4,407
 
 
(8,680
)
Foreign currency translation adjustments of related balances
N/A
 
 
 
137
 
 
62
 
Net change
 
 
(22,623
)
 
(9,078
)
 
40,085
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Employee benefit plans adjustments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Defined benefit pension plan
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net actuarial gain (loss)
N/A
 
(19,956
)
 
5,096
 
 
(18,947
)
Amortisation of actuarial losses
Salaries and other employee benefits
 
1,702
 
 
1,703
 
 
1,058
 
Change in deferred taxes
N/A
 
1,315
 
 
(391
)
 
83
 
Foreign currency translation adjustments of related balances
N/A
 
38
 
 
430
 
 
253
 
Net change
 
 
(16,901
)
 
6,838
 
 
(17,553
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Post-retirement healthcare plan
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net actuarial (loss)
N/A
 
(5,911
)
 
(2,252
)
 
(15,892
)
Prior service cost
N/A
 
 
 
 
 
(7,901
)
Amortisation of net actuarial losses
Salaries and other employee benefits
 
2,731
 
 
3,347
 
 
922
 
Amortisation of prior service credit
Salaries and other employee benefits
 
(6,343
)
 
(6,343
)
 
(6,719
)
Net change
        
 
(9,523
)
 
(5,248
)
 
(29,590
)
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of taxes
        
 
(54,183
)
 
(12,977
)
 
(9,932
)

F-67

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Note 24: Capital structure

Authorised Capital

On 16 September 2016, the Bank began trading on the New York Stock Exchange under the ticker symbol “NTB”. The offering of 12,234,042 common shares consisted of 5,957,447 newly issued common shares sold by Butterfield and 6,276,595 common shares sold by certain selling shareholders, including 1,595,744 common shares sold by certain of the selling shareholders pursuant to the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares, which was exercised in full prior to the closing.

On 25 July 2016, the Bank’s board of directors approved a consolidation of the existing common shares on the basis of a 10 to 1 ratio, subject to shareholder approval. As a result of this consolidation, effective 6 September 2016 upon shareholder approval, every 10 common shares of par value BM$0.01 were consolidated into 1 common share of par value BM$0.10 (the “Share Consolidation”).

In addition, as of 6 September 2016, the par value of each issued common share and each authorised but unissued common share was reduced from BM$0.10 to BM$0.01 and the authorised share capital of the Bank was correspondingly reduced from 2,000,000,000 common shares of par value BM$0.10 each, 6,000,000,000 non-voting ordinary shares of par value BM$0.01 each, 110,200,001 preference shares of par value US$0.01 each and 50,000,000 preference shares of par value £0.01 each to 2,000,000,000 common shares of par value BM$0.01 each, 6,000,000,000 non-voting ordinary shares of par value BM$0.01 each, 110,200,001 preference shares of par value US$0.01 each and 50,000,000 preference shares of par value £0.01 each, without any payment by the Bank to the holders of the voting ordinary shares in respect thereof (the “Reduction in Par Value” and together with the Share Consolidation, the “Reverse Share Split”).

Immediately following the Reduction in Par Value, the Bank repurchased any and all fractions of common shares issued and outstanding following the Reduction in Par Value, from the holders thereof. All share, share-based payments and dividend information presented in these consolidated financial statements and accompanying footnotes has been retroactively adjusted to reflect the decreased number of shares resulting from this action.

Prior to the Reverse Share Split, the Bank’s total authorised share capital consisted of (i) 20 billion common shares of par value BM$0.01, (ii) 6 billion non-voting ordinary shares of par value BM$0.01; (iii) 100,200,001 preference shares of par value US$0.01 and (iv) 50 million preference shares of par value £0.01.

On 30 April 2015, Butterfield repurchased and cancelled 8,000,000 shares held by CIBC for $15.00 per share, for a total of $120 million. The remaining CIBC shareholding in Butterfield (representing 2,343,423 shares) was taken up by Carlyle Global Financial Services, L.P. at $15.00 per share and subsequently sold to other investors.

On 13 August 2015, Butterfield repurchased and cancelled 400,000 shares held by two shareholders for $14.90 per share, for a total of $5.96 million.

Preference Shares

On 22 June 2009, the Bank issued 200,000 Government guaranteed, 8.00% non-cumulative perpetual limited voting preference shares (the “preference shares”). The issuance price was US$1,000 per share. The preference share buy-backs are disclosed in Note 22: Share Buy-Back Plans.

The preference share principal and dividend payments are guaranteed by the Government of Bermuda. At any time after the expiry of the guarantee offered by the Government of Bermuda, and subject to the approval of the BMA, the Bank would have been able to redeem, in whole or in part, any preference shares at the time issued and outstanding, at a redemption price equal to the liquidation preference plus any unpaid dividends at the time.

F-68

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Holders of preference shares were entitled to receive, on each preference share only when, as and if declared by the Board of Directors, non-cumulative cash dividends at a rate per annum equal to 8.00% on the liquidation preference of US$1,000 per preference share payable quarterly in arrears. In exchange for the Government’s commitment, the Bank issued to the Government a warrant that, upon issuance, allowed the purchase of 427,960 common shares of the Bank at an exercise price of $70.10 per share. The warrant which, after adjustments in accordance with anti-dilution terms allowed for the purchase of 432,028 shares with an exercise price of $34.72 per share was repurchased and cancelled by the Bank in December 2016.

On 15 December 2016, the Bank effected a mandatory redemption of its preference shares by paying a make-whole redemption payment (the “make-whole redemption price”) of US$1,180.00 per preference share to preference shareholders of record as at 1 December 2016. The make-whole redemption price comprises the sum of the dividend per preference share for the current quarter, the $1,000 liquidation preference per preference share, discounted for present value, and the present value of future dividend payments through 22 June 2019. Following the payment of the make-whole redemption price, all issued and outstanding preference shares were redeemed, cancelled and reverted to authorised but unissued preference shares of the Bank. The preference shares were also delisted from both the BSX and the Luxembourg Stock Exchange.

On 11 May 2010, the Bank’s Rights offering was over subscribed with the maximum allowable number of rights of 10,743,801 exercised and subsequently converted on the ratio of 0.07692 CVCP shares for each right unit exercised amounting to 826,415 CVCP shares issued. The CVCP shares have specific rights and conditions attached, which are explained in detail in the prospectus of the rights offering. On 31 March 2015, all remaining CVCP shares were converted to common shares at a ratio of 1:1.

Dividends Declared

During the year ended 31 December 2016, the Bank paid cash dividends of $0.40 (31 December 2015: $0.50, 31 December 2014: $0.50) for each common share and CVCP share on record (CVCP shares were all converted to common shares on 31 March 2015) as of the related record dates. Subsequent to year-end, the Bank declared a fourth interim dividend of $0.32 per common share to be paid to shareholders of record on 13 March 2017. During the years ended 31 December 2016, 2015, and 2014, the Bank declared the full 8.00% cash dividends on preference shares in each quarter.

The Bank is required to comply with Section 54 of the Companies Act 1981 issued by the Government of Bermuda (the “Companies Act”) each time a dividend is declared or paid by the Bank and also obtain prior written approval from the BMA pursuant to the Banks and Deposit Companies Act 1999 for any dividends declared. The Bank has complied with Section 54 and has obtained BMA approval for all dividends declared during the periods under review.

Regulatory Capital

Effective 1 January 2016, the Bank’s regulatory capital is determined in accordance with current Basel III guidelines as issued by the Bermuda Monetary Authority (“BMA”). Basel III adopts Common Equity Tier 1 (“CET1”) as the predominant form of regulatory capital with the CET1 ratio as a new metric. Basel III also adopts the new Leverage Ratio regime, which is calculated by dividing Tier 1 capital by an exposure measure. The exposure measure consists of total assets (excluding items deducted from Tier 1 capital) and certain off-balance sheet items converted into credit exposure equivalents as well as adjustments for derivatives to reflect credit risk and other risks. Prior to 1 January 2016, the Bank’s regulatory capital was determined in accordance with Basel II guidelines as issued by the BMA.

F-69

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

The Bank is fully compliant with all regulatory capital requirements and maintains capital ratios in excess of regulatory minimums as at 31 December 2016 and 31 December 2015. The following table sets forth the Bank’s capital adequacy in accordance with the Basel III framework as at 31 December 2016 and the Basel II framework as at 31 December 2015:

 
31 December 2016
(Basel III)
31 December 2015
(Basel II)
 
Actual
Regulatory
minimum
Actual
Regulatory
minimum
Capital
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tier 1 capital
 
666,847
 
 
N/A
 
 
699,278
 
 
N/A
 
Common Equity Tier 1
 
666,847
 
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
Tier 2 capital
 
102,709
 
 
N/A
 
 
119,164
 
 
N/A
 
Total capital
 
769,556
 
 
N/A
 
 
818,442
 
 
N/A
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Risk Weighted Assets
 
4,365,440
 
 
N/A
 
 
4,304,074
 
 
N/A
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capital Ratios (%)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common Equity Tier 1
 
15.3
%
 
8.1
%
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
Total Tier 1
 
15.3
%
 
9.6
%
 
16.2
%
 
4.0
%
Total Capital
 
17.6
%
 
15.3
%
 
19.0
%
 
14.5
%
Leverage ratio
 
5.8
%
 
5.0
%
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 

Note 25: Income taxes

The Bank is incorporated in Bermuda, and pursuant to Bermuda law is not taxed on either income or capital gains. The Bank’s subsidiaries in the Cayman Islands and The Bahamas are not subject to any taxes in their respective jurisdictions on either income or capital gains under current law applicable in the respective jurisdictions. The Bank’s subsidiaries in the United Kingdom, Guernsey, and Switzerland are subject to the tax laws of those jurisdictions.

For the years ended 31 December 2016, 2015, and 2014, the Bank did not record any unrecognised tax benefits or expenses and has no uncertain tax positions as at 31 December 2016, 2015, and 2014.

The Bank records income taxes based on the enacted tax laws and rates applicable in the relevant jurisdictions for the years ended 31 December 2016, 2015, and 2014. For the years ended 31 December 2016, 2015, and 2014, the Bank did not incur any interest or pay any penalties.

 
Year ended
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Income taxes in consolidated statements of operations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current tax expense (benefit)
 
727
 
 
819
 
 
(169
)
Deferred tax expense
 
 
 
457
 
 
 
Total tax expense (benefit)
 
727
 
 
1,276
 
 
(169
)

F-70

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Reconciliation between the Effective Income Tax Rate and the Statutory Income Tax Rate

 
Year ended
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
 
$
%
$
%
$
%
Income tax expense at Bermuda corporation tax rate of 0%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Income tax expense in international offices taxed at different rates
 
(2,104
)
 
(2
)
 
(904
)
 
(1
)
 
1,501
 
 
2
 
Change in valuation allowance
 
87
 
 
 
 
466
 
 
1
 
 
(1,429
)
 
(2
)
Prior year tax adjustments
 
(71
)
 
 
 
80
 
 
 
 
(956
)
 
(1
)
Tax loss carried forward
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other - net
 
2,815
 
 
3
 
 
1,634
 
 
2
 
 
715
 
 
1
 
Income tax expense (benefit) at effective tax rate
 
727
 
 
1
 
 
1,276
 
 
2
 
 
(169
)
 
 
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
Deferred income taxes
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deferred income tax asset
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tax loss carried forward
 
5,770
 
 
2,540
 
Pension liability
 
1,594
 
 
365
 
Fixed assets
 
11
 
 
741
 
Allowance for compensated absence
 
8
 
 
9
 
Onerous leases
 
9
 
 
11
 
Deferred income tax asset before valuation allowance
 
7,392
 
 
3,666
 
Less: valuation allowance
 
(5,638
)
 
(3,105
)
Net deferred income tax assets
 
1,754
 
 
561
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deferred income tax liability
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other
 
 
 
 
Net deferred income tax asset
 
1,754
 
 
561
 

Management assesses the available positive and negative evidence to estimate if sufficient future taxable income will be generated to use the existing deferred tax assets. A significant piece of objective negative evidence evaluated was the cumulative loss incurred in the UK segment over the years ended 31 December 2016 and 2015. Such objective evidence limits the ability to consider other subjective evidence such as projections for future growth.

On the basis of this evaluation, as of 31 December 2016, a valuation allowance of $5.6 million (31 December 2015: $3.1 million) has been recognised to record only the portion of the deferred tax asset that more likely than not will be realised. The amount of the deferred tax asset considered realisable, however, could be adjusted if estimates of future taxable income during the carry-forward period are reduced or increased, or if objective negative evidence in the form of cumulative losses is no longer present and additional weight may be given to subjective evidence such as our projections for growth. This valuation allowance relates specifically to our UK segment.

The Bank has net taxable loss carry forwards related to the Bank’s international operations of approximately $28.2 million (31 December 2015: $13.6 million), which have an indefinite life.

F-71

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Note 26: Business combinations

Bermuda Trust Company Limited and the Private Banking Investment Management of Operations of HSBC Bank Bermuda Limited Acquisition

On 29 April 2016, the Bank and two of its subsidiaries, Butterfield Trust (Bermuda) Limited (“BTBL”) and Butterfield Asset Management Limited (“BAM”), acquired for a total purchase price of $22.0 million: 1) all outstanding shares of Bermuda Trust Company Limited (“BTCL”, a wholly–owned subsidiary of HSBC Bank Bermuda Limited (“HSBCBB”)), 2) certain assets of the asset management services operations of HSBCBB and 3) certain assets of the private banking services operations of HSBCBB. The acquisition is in line with the Bank’s growth strategy of developing core businesses in existing markets and was undertaken to add scale to the Bank capacity in these market segments where the Bank had already a significant presence and a long history.

The acquisition date fair value of consideration transferred amounted to $22.0 million comprising cash settlement of $7.0 million paid on 29 April 2016, a second payment of $2.1 million made on 6 May 2016, and contingent considerations payable in the second half of 2016 and evaluated at $12.4 million. The contingent considerations were dependent on the trust and asset management clients retention by BNTB before the end of the contingency period in September 2016 and the amount paid was $12.4 million.

The fair value of the net assets acquired and allocation of purchase is summarised as follows:

 
As at
29 April 2016
Total consideration transferred
 
21,778
 
Assets acquired
 
 
 
Intangible assets
 
21,443
 
Other assets
 
3,345
 
Total assets acquired
 
24,788
 
Liabilities acquired
 
3,010
 
Excess purchase price (goodwill)
 
 

The purchase price paid by the Bank was for BTCL’s net tangible value as well as intangible assets of $21.4 million in the form of customer relationships in all three segments with an estimated finite useful life of 15 years.

The Bank incurred transaction expenses related to this acquisition in the amount of $4.3 million, of which $3.3 million were expensed during the year ended 31 December 2016 (including $0.7 million of legal and professional fees) and $1.0 million were expensed during the year ended 31 December 2015 (including $1.0 million of legal and professional fees).

For the year ended 31 December 2016, the amount of revenues and earnings relating to the acquired HSBC Bermuda operations that are not inextricably merged into the Bank’s operations are $9.8 million and $5.0 million respectively.

The following selected unaudited pro forma financial information has been provided to present a summary of the combined results of the Bank and the acquired operations from HSBC Bermuda, assuming the transaction had been effected on 1 January 2014. The unaudited pro forma data is for informational purposes only and does not necessarily represent results that would have occurred if the transaction had taken place on the basis assumed above. The pro forma have been prepared based on the actual results realised by the Bank from operating the acquired activities, when such activities were not yet inextricably merged into the Bank’s operations.

F-72

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

 
Year ended
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Unaudited pro forma financial information
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total net revenue
 
407,453
 
 
378,915
 
 
395,612
 
Total non-interest operating expense
 
289,019
 
 
293,700
 
 
279,977
 
Pro forma net income post business combination
 
118,434
 
 
85,215
 
 
115,635
 

Note 27: Related party transactions

Financing Transactions

As of 17 May 2005, the Bank established a programme to offer loans with preferential rates to eligible Bank employees, subject to certain conditions set by the Bank and provided that such employees meet certain credit criteria. Loan payments are serviced by automatically debiting the employee’s chequing or savings account with the Bank. Applications for loans are handled according to the same policies as those for the Bank’s retail banking clients. The Bank’s ability to offer preferential rates on loans depends upon a number of factors, including market conditions, regulations and the Bank’s overall profitability. The Bank has the right to change its employee loan policy at any time after notifying participants.

The non-executive employee loans outstanding at 31 December 2016 amount to $123.2 million (31 December 2015: $204.3 million) resulting in an interest rate benefit to non-executive employees of $3.7 million (31 December 2015: $5.3 million, 31 December 2014: $6.2 million).

Certain directors and executives of the Bank, companies in which they are principal owners, and trusts in which they are involved, have loans with the Bank. Loans to directors were made in the ordinary course of business at normal credit terms, including interest rate and collateral requirements. Loans to executives may be eligible to preferential rates as described in the preceding paragraph. As at 31 December 2016, related party director and executive loan balances were $12.1 million (31 December 2015: $63.9 million). During the year ended 31 December 2016, new issuance of loans and change in directorships to directors and executives were $27.6 million and repayments and change in directorships were $25.1 million (year ended 31 December 2015: $17.5 and $17.4 million respectively, year ended 31 December 2014: $18.4 and $25.2 million respectively). Also, during the year ended 31 December 2016, a director resigned from the Board resulting in $54.3 million in loans being reclassified out of related party loans. All of these loans were considered performing loans as at 31 December 2016 and 31 December 2015.

On 27 June 2013, the Bank executed a $95 million loan agreement with an investment fund managed by a significant shareholder which provides for maturity on 30 June 2017. This loan was made in the ordinary course of business on normal commercial terms. At 31 December 2016 and 31 December 2015, nil was outstanding under this agreement. For the year ended 31 December 2016, nil (31 December 2015: $1.0 million, 31 December 2014: $2.7 million) of interest income has been recognised in the consolidated statements of operations in relation with this agreement.

Capital Transaction

Investments partnerships associated with The Carlyle Group hold approximately 14% of the Bank’s equity voting power along with the right to designate two persons for nomination for election by the shareholders as members of the Bank’s Board of Directors. Prior to 30 April 2015, Canadian Imperial Bank of Commerce (“CIBC”) held approximately 19% of the Bank’s equity voting power. On 30 April 2015, the Bank completed the transaction with CIBC to repurchase for cancellation approximately 77% of CIBC’s shares for $15.00 per share, or a total of $120 million, representing 8,000,000 common shares. The remaining 23% of CIBC’s shareholding in Butterfield (representing 2.3 million shares) were acquired by Carlyle Global Financial Services, L.P. and subsequently sold to other investors.

F-73

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Financial Transactions With Related Parties

The Bank holds seed investments in several Butterfield mutual funds, which are managed by a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Bank. As at 31 December 2016, these investments have a fair value of $5.0 million with an unrealized gain of $1.1 million (31 December 2015: $5.0 million and $0.9 million respectively) and were included in trading investments at their fair value. During the year ended 31 December 2016, the Bank earned $5.7 million (31 December 2015: $6.4 million, 31 December 2014: $4.3 million) in asset management revenue from funds managed by a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Bank.

F-74

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

Note 28: Condensed financial statements of the parent company only

Condensed financial statements of the Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited (the ultimate parent company) without consolidation of its subsidiaries were as follows:

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited (Parent company only)
Condensed Balance Sheets
(In thousands of US dollars)

 
As at
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and demand deposits with banks - Non-interest-bearing
 
28,032
 
 
28,146
 
Demand deposits with banks - Interest-bearing
 
136,373
 
 
125,826
 
Cash equivalents - Interest-bearing
 
1,042,365
 
 
691,438
 
Cash due from banks
 
1,206,770
 
 
845,410
 
Securities purchased under agreement to resell
 
148,813
 
 
 
Short-term investments
 
447,748
 
 
112,219
 
Investment in securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading
 
6,313
 
 
6,167
 
Available-for-sale
 
2,170,155
 
 
1,227,953
 
Held-to-maturity (fair value: $498,367 (2015: $421,588))
 
507,239
 
 
422,000
 
Total investment in securities
 
2,683,707
 
 
1,656,120
 
Net assets of subsidiaries - Banks
 
327,149
 
 
355,062
 
Net assets of subsidiaries - Non-banks
 
11,610
 
 
7,173
 
Loans to third parties, net of allowance for credit losses
 
1,909,093
 
 
2,096,625
 
Loans to subsidiaries - Banks
 
54,207
 
 
71,331
 
Loans to subsidiaries - Non-banks
 
55,120
 
 
60,292
 
Accrued interest
 
15,035
 
 
13,872
 
Other assets, including premises, equipment and computer software, equity method investments and other real estate owned
 
217,795
 
 
196,636
 
Total assets
 
7,077,047
 
 
5,414,740
 
Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customer deposits
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest bearing
 
1,733,684
 
 
1,348,877
 
Interest bearing
 
4,213,417
 
 
2,922,830
 
Total customer deposits
 
5,947,101
 
 
4,271,707
 
Bank deposits
 
119,331
 
 
102,574
 
Total deposits
 
6,066,432
 
 
4,374,281
 
Securities sold under agreement to repurchase
 
 
 
 
Employee benefit plans
 
133,834
 
 
122,135
 
Accrued interest
 
1,690
 
 
1,530
 
Preference share dividends payable
 
 
 
654
 
Other liabilities
 
47,348
 
 
48,786
 
Total other liabilities
 
182,872
 
 
173,105
 
Long-term debt
 
117,000
 
 
117,000
 
Total liabilities
 
6,366,304
 
 
4,664,386
 
Total shareholders’ equity
 
710,743
 
 
750,354
 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 
7,077,047
 
 
5,414,740
 

F-75

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited (Parent company only)
Condensed Statements of Operations
(In thousands of US dollars)

 
Year ended
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Non-interest income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Banking
 
21,984
 
 
19,193
 
 
18,208
 
Foreign exchange revenue
 
11,174
 
 
11,789
 
 
12,581
 
Other non-interest income
 
3,516
 
 
4,671
 
 
4,592
 
Dividends from subsidiaries - Banks
 
40,000
 
 
36,226
 
 
43,343
 
Dividends from subsidiaries - Non-banks
 
6,600
 
 
 
 
28,656
 
Total non-interest income
 
83,274
 
 
71,879
 
 
107,380
 
Interest income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans
 
123,370
 
 
117,124
 
 
119,846
 
Investments
 
44,745
 
 
39,987
 
 
38,510
 
Deposits with banks
 
6,293
 
 
1,600
 
 
1,398
 
Total interest income
 
174,408
 
 
158,711
 
 
159,754
 
Interest expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
 
6,882
 
 
7,947
 
 
8,541
 
Long-term debt
 
4,500
 
 
4,861
 
 
5,628
 
Securities sold under repurchase agreements
 
118
 
 
8
 
 
82
 
Total interest expense
 
11,500
 
 
12,816
 
 
14,251
 
Net interest income before provision for credit losses
 
162,908
 
 
145,895
 
 
145,503
 
Provision for credit losses
 
(7,263
)
 
(3,624
)
 
(6,425
)
Net interest income after provision for credit losses
 
155,645
 
 
142,271
 
 
139,078
 
Net trading gains
 
330
 
 
80
 
 
257
 
Net realised gains (losses) on available-for-sale investments
 
1,222
 
 
(2,841
)
 
8,714
 
Net losses on other real estate owned
 
(287
)
 
(543
)
 
(775
)
Impairment of fixed assets
 
 
 
 
 
(1,050
)
Net other gains (losses)
 
(325
)
 
19
 
 
(10
)
Total other gains (losses)
 
940
 
 
(3,285
)
 
7,136
 
Total net revenue
 
239,859
 
 
210,865
 
 
253,594
 
Non-interest expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Salaries and other employee benefits
 
69,770
 
 
60,132
 
 
55,276
 
Technology and communications
 
34,033
 
 
34,879
 
 
33,248
 
Property
 
5,983
 
 
5,929
 
 
6,297
 
Professional and outside services
 
9,379
 
 
19,043
 
 
14,140
 
Indirect taxes
 
10,562
 
 
8,577
 
 
7,814
 
Amortisation of intangible assets
 
113
 
 
 
 
 
Marketing
 
2,138
 
 
1,730
 
 
1,309
 
Restructuring costs
 
117
 
 
 
 
 
Other expenses
 
5,373
 
 
8,017
 
 
4,846
 
Total non-interest expense
 
137,468
 
 
138,307
 
 
122,930
 
Net income before equity in undistributed earnings of subsidiaries
 
102,391
 
 
72,558
 
 
130,664
 
Equity in undistributed earnings of subsidiaries
 
13,551
 
 
5,181
 
 
(22,505
)
Net income
 
115,942
 
 
77,739
 
 
108,159
 
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
 
(54,183
)
 
(12,977
)
 
(9,932
)
Total comprehensive income
 
61,759
 
 
64,762
 
 
98,227
 

F-76

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited (Parent company only)
Condensed Statements of Cash Flows
(In thousands of US dollars)

 
Year ended
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Cash flows from operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
 
115,942
 
 
77,739
 
 
108,159
 
Adjustments to reconcile net income to operating cash flows
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation and amortisation
 
23,687
 
 
22,267
 
 
19,836
 
(Increase) in carrying value of equity method investments
 
(949
)
 
(1,056
)
 
(1,103
)
Share-based payments and settlements
 
14,423
 
 
7,913
 
 
9,049
 
Equity in undistributed earnings of subsidiaries
 
(13,551
)
 
(5,181
)
 
22,505
 
Net realised / unrealised losses on other real estate owned
 
287
 
 
543
 
 
775
 
Net realised (gains) losses on available-for-sale investments
 
(1,222
)
 
2,841
 
 
(8,714
)
Provision for credit losses
 
7,263
 
 
3,624
 
 
6,425
 
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(Increase) decrease in accrued interest receivable
 
(1,163
)
 
6,904
 
 
(982
)
(Increase) decrease in other assets
 
(20,312
)
 
2,650
 
 
(1,284
)
Increase (decrease) in accrued interest payable
 
160
 
 
(1,909
)
 
240
 
Increase (decrease) in other liabilities and employee benefit plans
 
10,388
 
 
480
 
 
(5,763
)
Cash provided by operating activities
 
134,953
 
 
116,815
 
 
149,143
 
Cash flows from investing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(Increase) in securities purchased under agreement to resell
 
(148,813
)
 
 
 
 
Net (increase) in short-term investments
 
(335,529
)
 
(103,178
)
 
(299
)
Net change in trading investments
 
(146
)
 
704
 
 
42,910
 
Available-for-sale investments: proceeds from sale
 
25,489
 
 
404,575
 
 
84,360
 
Available-for-sale investments: proceeds from maturities and pay downs
 
341,835
 
 
256,566
 
 
163,725
 
Available-for-sale investments: purchases
 
(1,332,836
)
 
(473,834
)
 
(392,719
)
Held-to-maturity investments: proceeds from maturities and pay downs
 
38,430
 
 
10,077
 
 
4,533
 
Held-to-maturity investments: purchases
 
(124,325
)
 
(276,723
)
 
 
Net (increase) decrease in loans to third parties
 
177,823
 
 
(70,821
)
 
18,645
 
Net (increase) decrease in loans to bank subsidiaries
 
10,608
 
 
(2,761
)
 
4,318
 
Net (increase) decrease in loans to non-bank subsidiaries
 
5,172
 
 
2,057
 
 
(9,518
)
Additions to premises, equipment and computer software
 
(5,700
)
 
(4,239
)
 
(222
)
Proceeds from sale of other real estate owned
 
3,061
 
 
4,644
 
 
4,196
 
Dividends received from equity method investment
 
319
 
 
884
 
 
359
 
Return (injection) of capital from (in) subsidiary
 
(6,945
)
 
(94
)
 
607
 
Cash disbursed for business acquisition
 
(2,540
)
 
 
 
 
Cash used in investing activities
 
(1,354,097
)
 
(252,143
)
 
(79,105
)

F-77

TABLE OF CONTENTS

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements (continued)
(In thousands of US dollars, unless otherwise stated)

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited (Parent company only)
Condensed Statements of Cash Flows
(In thousands of US dollars)

 
Year ended
 
31 December
2016
31 December
2015
31 December
2014
Cash flows from financing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net decrease in demand and term deposit liabilities
 
1,696,948
 
 
457,836
 
 
242,152
 
Net (increase) in securities sold under agreement to repurchase
 
 
 
 
 
(25,535
)
Repayment of long-term debt
 
 
 
 
 
(90,000
)
Proceeds from issuance of common shares, net of underwriting discounts and commissions
 
131,600
 
 
 
 
 
Cost of issuance of common shares
 
(5,458
)
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from loans sold under agreement to repurchase
 
5,152
 
 
 
 
 
Cost of repurchase of loans under agreement to repurchase
 
(5,152
)
 
 
 
 
Common shares repurchased
 
(1,633
)
 
(130,822
)
 
(17,018
)
Preference shares repurchased
 
(212,121
)
 
(211
)
 
(656
)
Warrant repurchase
 
(100
)
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from stock option exercises
 
6,919
 
 
640
 
 
1,198
 
Cash dividends paid on common and contingent value convertible preference shares
 
(19,346
)
 
(24,846
)
 
(27,440
)
Cash dividends paid on preference shares
 
(14,629
)
 
(14,631
)
 
(14,673
)
Preference shares guarantee fee paid
 
(1,676
)
 
(1,824
)
 
(1,834
)
Cash provided by financing activities
 
1,580,504
 
 
286,142
 
 
66,194
 
Net increase (decrease) in cash due from banks
 
361,360
 
 
150,814
 
 
136,232
 
Cash due from banks at beginning of year
 
845,410
 
 
694,596
 
 
558,364
 
Cash due from banks at end of year
 
1,206,770
 
 
845,410
 
 
694,596
 
Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash interest paid
 
11,660
 
 
10,907
 
 
14,491
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-cash item
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Transfer to other real estate owned
 
8,961
 
 
3,326
 
 
2,733
 

Note 29: Subsequent events

On 12 February 2017, the Board of Directors declared a fourth interim dividend of $0.32 per common share to be paid on 27 March 2017 to shareholders of record on 13 March 2017.

F-78

TABLE OF CONTENTS

   
          Shares

The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited


Common Shares

PROSPECTUS

Joint Book-Running Managers

Goldman, Sachs & Co.
Citigroup
Sandler O'Neill + Partners, L.P.
Keefe, Bruyette & Woods
 
 
 
A Stifel Company

Co-Managers

        , 2017

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Part II

INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

Item 6.   Indemnification of Directors and Officers.

Section 98 of the Companies Act provides generally that a Bermuda company may indemnify its directors, officers and auditors against any liability which by virtue of any rule of law would otherwise be imposed on them in respect of any negligence, default, breach of duty or breach of trust, except in cases where such liability arises from fraud or dishonesty of which such director, officer or auditor may be guilty in relation to the company. Section 98 further provides that a Bermuda company may indemnify its directors, officers and auditors against any liability incurred by them in defending any proceedings, whether civil or criminal, in which judgment is awarded in their favor or in which they are acquitted or granted relief by the Supreme Court of Bermuda pursuant to section 281 of the Companies Act.

The registrant’s bye-laws provide that it shall indemnify its officers and directors in respect of their actions and omissions, except in respect of their fraud or dishonesty. In addition, under the registrant’s amended bye-laws, each shareholder has agreed to waive any claim or right of action such shareholder might have, whether individually or by or in the right of the registrant, against any director or officer on account of any action taken by such director or officer, or the failure of such director or officer to take any action in the performance of his duties with or for the registrant or any subsidiary thereof, provided such waiver shall not extend to any matter in respect of any fraud or dishonesty in relation to the registrant which may attach to such director or officer. Section 98A of the Companies Act permits the registrant to purchase and maintain insurance for the benefit of any officer or director in respect of any loss or liability attaching to him in respect of any negligence, default, breach of duty or breach of trust whether or not the registrant may otherwise indemnify such officer or director.

The registrant maintains insurance policies under which coverage is provided (a) to its directors and officers, in their respective capacities as such, against loss arising from a claim made for any actual or alleged wrongful act, and (b) to itself with respect to payments which the registrant may make to such officers and directors pursuant to the above indemnification provision or otherwise as a matter of law.

Reference is made to the form of underwriting agreement to be filed as Exhibit 1.1 hereto for provisions providing that the underwriters are obligated, under certain circumstances, to indemnify the registrant's directors, officers and controlling persons against certain liabilities under the Securities Act.

Item 7.   Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities.

None.

II-1

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Item 8.   Exhibits and Financial Statements Schedules.

(a)The following documents are filed as exhibits hereto:
Exhibit No.
Description
1.1
Form of Underwriting Agreement*
3.1
Bye-laws of The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the registrant’s registration statement on Form F-1, filed on August 4, 2016)
3.2
The N.T. Butterfield & Son Bank Act, 1904 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the registrant’s registration statement on Form F-1, filed on August 4, 2016)
4.1
Form of Specimen of Common Registered Share Certificate (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the registrant’s registration statement on Form F-1, filed on August 4, 2016)
5.1
Opinion of Conyers Dill & Pearman Limited*
10.1
Amended and Restated Investment Agreement by and among The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited, Carlyle Global Financial Services Partners, L.P., and CGFSP Coinvestment L.P., dated as of August 4, 2016 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the registrant’s registration statement on Form F-1, filed on August 4, 2016)
10.2
The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited 2010 Omnibus Share Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the registrant’s registration statement on Form F-1, filed on August 4, 2016)
21.1
List of Subsidiaries
23.1
Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers Ltd.
23.2
Consent of Conyers Dill & Pearman Limited (included in Exhibit 5.1)*
24.1
Power of Attorney of certain directors and officers of the registrant (included on signature page to the registration statement)
*To be filed by amendment.
(b)All schedules are omitted because the required information is inapplicable or the information is presented in the consolidated financial statements and the related notes.

Item 9.   Undertakings.

The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that:

(1)Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer, or controlling person of the registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered hereunder, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question of whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.
(2)For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective.
(3)For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

II-2

TABLE OF CONTENTS

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the registrant certifies that it has reasonable grounds to believe that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form F-1 and has duly caused this registration statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in Hamilton, Bermuda, on February 13, 2017.

 
The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited
 
 
 
 
 
By:
/s/ Michael Collins
 
 
Name:
Michael Collins
 
 
Title:
Chief Executive Officer

The undersigned directors and officers do hereby constitute and appoint each of Michael Collins and Michael Schrum as their true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution, to do any and all acts and things in our name and on our behalf in our capacities as directors and officers, and to execute any and all instruments for us and in our names in the capacities indicated below, that such person may deem necessary or advisable to enable the registrant to comply with the Securities Act of 1933, and any rules, regulations and requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission in connection with this registration statement, including specifically, but not limited to, power and authority to sign for us, or any of us, in the capacities indicated below, any and all amendments hereto (including pre-effective and post-effective amendments or any other registration statement filed pursuant to the provisions of Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act of 1933); and we do hereby ratify and confirm all that such person or persons shall do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this registration statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

Signatures
Title
Date
/s/ Michael Collins
Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)
February 13, 2017
Michael Collins
/s/ Michael Schrum
Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)
February 13, 2017
Michael Schrum
/s/ Jeffrey Bennett
Chief Accountant
(Principal Accounting Officer)
February 13, 2017
Jeffrey Bennett
/s/ E. Barclay Simmons
Non-Executive Chairman and Director
February 13, 2017
E. Barclay Simmons
/s/ Alastair Barbour
Director
February 13, 2017
Alastair Barbour
/s/ James F. Burr
Director
February 13, 2017
James F. Burr
/s/ Caroline Foulger
Director
February 13, 2017
Caroline Foulger
/s/ Conor O’Dea
Director
February 13, 2017
Conor O’Dea
/s/ Wolfgang Schoellkopf
Director
February 13, 2017
Wolfgang Schoellkopf
/s/ John Wright
Director
February 13, 2017
John Wright
/s/ David Zwiener
Director
February 13, 2017
David Zwiener

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Pursuant to the United States Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the undersigned, the duly authorized representative in the United States for The Bank of N.T. Butterfield & Son Limited, has signed this registration statement and any amendment hereto on February 13, 2017.

 
By:
/s/ Michael Collins
 
 
Name:
Michael Collins
 
 
Title:
Chief Executive Officer